Digitized by the Internet Archive in 2012 with funding from Research Library, The Getty Research Institute http://archive.org/details/historyofjapangi01kaem Infigiua gentilitia Principuin Imperij et Nobilium Japoiuorum A : HS4 ? l/f usrrnatfii^JortAda, cur Engelberto Kaempfero {zone- *yrca/iJi6o Copies, John Jacob Dillenius, M. D. F. R. S. John Diodate, M. D. F. R. S. James Douglas, M. D. F. R. S. Gerard Drake, Efq; E Richard Ellis, Efq; Nathaniel Ellwick, Efq-, . Eyles, Efq; Kingfmill Eyre, Efq; F. R. S. The Right Honourable the Lady Mary FIELDING. Everard Fawkener, Efq; Charles de la Faye, Efq; F. R. S. Martin Folkes, Efq; F. R. S. Thomas Fothergill, Efq; Sir Richard Fowler, Bart. John Freeman, Efq. ** John Friend, M. D. F. R. S. John Fuller, Efq; F. R. S. The Right Honourable the Earl GRANDISSON. Roger Gale, Efq; F. R. S. Patrick Garden of Lincoln* s-Inn t Efq; Mr. Ambrofe Godfrey, Chymifl. Mr. Edmund Godfrey. The Rev. Dr. Gooch, Mafter of Gonvil and Cajus College In Cambridge. Mr. George Graham, F. R. S. Mr Stephen Grainger, Merchant at Stockholm. * Thomas Green, Efq; George Grey, Efq; Richard Griffith, Surgeon. John Frederick Gronovices, M. D. H John Hadley, Efq; F. R. S. Richard Hale, M. D. F. R. Si Sir James Hal let. Mr. Denham Hammond. Henry Heathcote, Efq; F. R. S. William Heathcote, Efq; Charles Hedges, Efq; John James Heidegger, Efq; The Hon. Mrs. Herbert. Horfeman, M. D. Hugh Howard, Efq; F. R. £ Robert Subfcribers Names. Robert Hucks, Efq; F. R. S. * Maurice Hunt, Efq; I Theodore Jacobfon, Efq; Mr. Benjamin James. The Rev. Dr. Richard Ibbetfon, D. D. William Jones. Efq; F. R. S. * Thomas Med, Efq; F. R. S. James Jurin, M. D. Sec. Reg. Soc: K The Right Reverend the Lord Bifiop ofK I L M O R E. Sir John Kaye, Bart. L Smart Lethieuiller, Efq; F. R. S. Col. George Liddel. The Rev. Dr. Samuel Lille, D. Z). Henry Lloyd, Efq; The Rev. Mr. Richard Lucas, F. R. S. M * HisGrace JOHN Vu'-eofM O NTAGU. JWr. John Martin, F. R. 5. John Maubrav, M. D. * Richard Mead, JW. D. F. R. S. Mead, Efq; Mr. Montagu. Francis Mofe, Efq; N James Nam, Efq. Sir Michael Newton, Knight of the Bath. Col. Francis Nicholfcn, F. R. S. Mr. Richard Nicholfon jun. O The Right Honourable CHARLES Earl of O R R E R Y. Robert Ord, Efq; F. R. S. The Rev. Mr. Henry Ott, M. A. Sir Adolphus Oughton, Bart. P The Right Honourable THOMAS Earl of PEMBROKE. Mr. John Padrnore. Sir Gregory Page, Bart. Thomas Pellet, M. D. F. R. S. Henry Plumtre, M. D. E R. S. Plumtre, Efq. * His Excellency Mr. Stephen Poyntz, His Majeflys Envoy Extraordinary and Plenipotentiary to the Court of Sweden. R His Grace CHARLES Duke of RICHMOND. Edward Ratcliff, Efq; Richard Richardfon, M. D. John Subfcribers Names. John Roberts, Efq; Tancred Robinfon, M. D. F. R. S. * Edward Rudge, Efq, F. R. S. The Right Honourable TALBOT Earl ^/SUSSEX. Jeremy Sambrooke, Efc Jfaac de Sequeyra Samuda, M. L. F. R. S, William Sherard, L. L. D. F. R. S. Mr. Shipton, Surgeon. Mr. Samuel Skinner, jun. Sir Hans Sloane, Bart. P. S. R. &c C. M. William Sloane, /*?«. Efc William Sloane, jun. Efq; F. R. S. The Rev. Mr. Soley. Thomas Spicer, Efc Secretary to the Presentations. * Sir Conrad Sprengell, Knt. F, R. S. Ferdinand Sprinall, of the Inner Temple, Eftfi Oliver St. John, Efc F. R. S. John Stanhope of Eccle's-hill, Efq, George Stanley, Efq; F. R. S. Stanley, Efc Temple Stanyan, Efq^ F. R.S. John George Steigertnal, M. T>. F. R. S- Mr. John Stevans, Surgeon. Sir Robert Sutton, Knight of the Bath. George Lewis TeifTier, M. D. F. R. S. James Theobald, Efc, F. R. 5. 'Peter Theobald, Efc Joas Tillard, Efc Mr. Nathaniel Torriano. Mr. John Torriano. Sigifmond Trafford, Efc, The Honourable John Trevor, Efq\ F. R. S. Abraham Tucker, Efc, W Stephen Wadlworth, M. D. John Wainewright of Lincoln's-Inn, Efc William Ward, L. L. D- Mr. Thomas Watfon of Lothbury. Mr. Thomas Watfon. Sir Anthony Weftcomb, Bart. Mr. Thomas Wefton, Mafler of the Academy of Greenwich. Mr. Samuel Windor, jun. John Woodward, M. D. P. Grefi. F. R. S. Francis Woolafton, Efc F. R. 5. Mr. Zinck. Philip Henry Zolmann, Efc T H ti CONTENTS Of the firft Volume: The Author's PREFACE I. The L IFE of the A UTHO R, by the TR A NS LA TO R. V- An IntroduBion by the TRANSLATOR. XVI The HISTORY of JAPAN, BO O K I. Chap. I. ^OURN A L of the author's voyage from Batavia to Siam, with J an account of 'what happen* 'd during his fay there , pag. I Chap. II. The present (late of the Court of Siam, with a Defcription of Juthja, the Capital City and Place, of the King's Refidence 1 9 Chap. III. The Author's departure from Juthja, down the River Meinam to the harbour, and from thence to Japan. 42 Chap. IV. Of the Empire of Japan in general, as to its fituation and the largeness if its fever al IJIands 58 Chap. V. The divijion and fub-divifion of the Empire of Japan into its J "eve- ral Provinces; as alfo of its revenue and government 70 Chap. VI. The author's opinion of the true origin and defcent of the Ja- panefe 8 1 Chap. VII. Of the origin of the Japanefe, according to their own fabulous opinion 96 Chap. VIII. Of the Climate of Japan, and its produce as to minerals and metals 102 Chap: IX. Of the fertility of the country as to Plants 113 Chap. X. Of the plenty of the country as to Beafls, Birds, Reptiles and InfeEls 123 Chap. XI. Of Fifi and Shells 132 BOOK II. Of the Political State of J A T A N. Chap. I. Names of the Gods, Demi-Gods and Emperors, who are mention' d in Japanefs Hijlories, as the firfl Monarchs and Governors of that Empire 143 Chap. II. The CONTENTS. Vol. I. Chap. II. Of 'the Ecclefiaflical Hereditary Eftiperors of Japan in general , of their Succejfion, Refidence anfl Court j as alfo of the Chronology of the Japanese 148 Chap. III. Of the Ecclefiafiical Hereditary Emperors in particular , and firjl of thofie, who govern' d from the beginning of the jfapa?ith of September 1^51, at Lem- gow, a fmall town in the Circle of Weft- phalia, belonging to the Count de Lippe. His Father John Kaempfer was Minifter of the Church of S. Nicholas in that town, and his Mother Chriftiana Dreppers, a Daughter of Joachim Drepper, formerly Minifter of the fame Church. He had, fo far as his Fa- ther's circumftances would permit, a very liberal education, and becoming the profefiion he was defign'd for, which was that of Phyfick. He begun his ftudies at the fchool of Hameln, in the Dutchy of Brunfwick, and was fent from thence to Lunebourgh, Hambourgh and Lubeck, at all which places he diftinguifhed himfelf by an induftrious application and ready progrefs in the learned languages, Hiftory, Geography, and Mufick both vo* cal and inftrumental. He made fome ftay at Dantzick, where he gave the firft publick fpecimen of his proficiency, by a Dif- fertation De Majeftatis D'vvifiom, defended in 1 67 3 , and then went to Thorn. He ftaid three years at the Univerfity of Cracow in Poland, ftudying Philofophy and foreign languages, and having took his degree of Do&or in Philofophy at that place, he repair'd to Konigsberg in Pruflia, where he fpent four years in clofe ap* plication to the ftudy of Phyfick and Natural Hiftory, his Fa- b ther's vj The LIFE of the AUTHOR. ther's defign, and his own genius and inclinations, happily concurring to bend his thoughts that way. 'Twas here he laid the foundation of thofe many excellent and ufeful difcoveries and obfervations, which he had afterwards frequent opportune ties to make in the long courfe of his travels. He went from Pruffia into Sweden, where his learning and difcreet behaviour quickly brought him into great reputation, both at the Univerfity of Upfal, and at the Court of Charles XI. a munificent Patron of men of learning, infomuch that very advantageous offers were made him towards an eftablithment in that Kingdom, which he thought fit to decline, defirous as he always was of feeing foreign Countries, and chofe to prefer the phce of Secretary of the EmbaflTy , which the Court of Sweden was then fending to the King of Perfia. The main defign of this Embafly was to fettle a Commerce between the Kingdoms of Sweden and Perfia, though at the inftances of the Emperor Leopold, the Ambaffador, Luis Fa- britius, had orders, by a feparate article, to engage, ifpoffible, the King of Perfia to a rupture with the Ottoman Porte. As the firft and chief, the fettling of a Commerce, could not well be effected, unlefs their Czarian Majefties (Iwan and Peter, who then jointly governed the Ruffian EmpireJ would confent to give paffage to the European as well as Perfian Commodities, through their dominions, upon reafonable terms, the AmbafTa- dor was order'd firft of all to repair to the Court of Mofcow, and there to make an agreement concerning that matter. It is foreign to my prefent purpofe, to enter either into the defign or fuccefs of M. Fabritius his negotiations, any farther than it will lead me to follow Dr. Ksempfer through Mufcovy into Perfia. He fet out from Stockholm, with the prefents for the King of Perfia, on the ioth of March 1683, O. S. and went through Aaland, Finland, and Ingermanland to Narva, where he met the AmbafTador with a retinue of thirty perfons. A miftake in the Ambaflfadors Credentials, where the name of the King of Per- fia was through inadvertency put before that of their Czarian Majefties, and the unwillingnefs of the Way wode of Novogo- rod, to furnilh the neceffary expences to condu£t and defray him, with The LIFE of the AUTHOR. vij * ■ with his retinue, purfuant to the tenour of the Treaties fub- fifting between the two Crowns, detain'd them upon the bor- ders of Ruflia a confiderable time : But thefe difficulties having been at laft amicably adjufted, M. Fabritius purfued his journey through Novogorod to Mofcow, where he made his publick entry on the 7th of July, and was admitted to an audience of their Czarian Majefties on the 1 ith. M. Fabritius having finifh'd his Negotiations at the Ruffian Court in fomething lefs than two months, fet out from Mof- cow on his way to Perfia, falling down the Rivers Molco, Occa and Wolga, to Cafan and Aftracan, two confiderable towns 4 and the Capitals of two powerful Kingdoms, which were con- quer'd and annex'd to the Ruffian Empire by that heroick Prince Iwan Bafilowitz. After a dangerous paflage over the Cafpian Sea, where they were like to have been loft, through the vio- lence of an unexpected ftorm, and the unskilfulnefs of their Pilots, (the (hip having two Rudders, and confequently two Pilots, who did not underftand each other's language) they got fafe to the Coafts of Perfia, and landed at Nifabad, where they ftaid for fome time, living under tents after the manner of the natives. Two other Ambafladors to the Perfian Courtj one from the King of Poland, and another from their Czarian Majefties, having landed at Nifabad much about the fametime^ they proceeded jointly to Siamacbi, the Capital of the Province of Scbirxvan, in the Media of the Ancients, or, as it is now called, Georgia, where they arrived about the middle of Decem- ber, and ftaid till the Governor of that Town and Province had fent notice of their arrival to the Perfian Court, and re- ceived orders from thence after what manner they were to be treated, and which way to be fent to Court. Dr. Kaempfer, in the mean time, did not fit idle, but went all about the neigh- bourhood of Siamachi, herborizing and obferving what was re- markable in nature and art, fo far as otherwife his affairs, and a fuccefsful and not improfitable practice of Phyfick, which the reputation of his being an European Phyfician quickly brought him irjto in that populous place, would permit. We mould be ftill wanting that curious and accurate account, which he hath given viij The LIFE of AAUTHOR. given us in his Amcenitates Exotic*, of the origin and fountains of the Naphta in the Peninfula Okefra, if he had not been at the pains to go and view them upon the fpot. Few are fen- fible what a pleafure a Natural Hiftorian receives, when fome new and lingular Phenomenon in nature offers in places unfre- quented. Dr. Kaempfer had the fatisfa&ion of finding in that Median Peninfula even more than he look'd for, and inftead of one he went to fee, to meet, as he faith, with no lefs than feven wonders : The town of Baku on the Cafpian Sea, the remain- ing monuments of Antiquity in the neighbourhood thereof, the fountains of Naphta, the burning field, boiling lake, a moun- tain which threw out a fine potters-earth, and fome other Angu- larities, truly many for fo fmall a compafs of ground, made him abundant amends for the trouble, and even the hazard of his excurfion thither. Upon the return of the expreffes fent to the Court of Perfia, M. Fabritius fet out on his journey thither about the middle of January 1^84, as did alfo the Polim and Ruffian AmbafTadors with their retinues : but being order 'd to travel different ways, the Swedifh Embafly reach'd Ifpahan, the Capital of Perfia, fome time before the others. Schah Solyman, King of Perfia, a Prince of a tender and fickly conftitution, was then, by the advice of his Aftrologers, under a fort of a voluntary confinement to his Palace. Appre- henfive of the fatal confequences of a malignant conftellation, they would not permit him to go abroad, and to appear in pub- lick, till the 3 oth of July, on which day he treated his whole Couit with the utmoft fplendor and magnificence. There were at that time feveral foreign AmbafTadors at Ifpahan, from the Kings of Sweden, Poland and Siam, the Czars of Mufcovy, feveral Arabian and Tartarian Princes, and fome alfo with Let- ters Credentials from the Pope, the Emperor of Germany, and the King of France, who were feverally admitted to audience on the fame day, it being the cuftom of the Perfian Kings not to let the Ambaffadors of foreign Powers appear in their Royal Prefence, but on fome fuch folemn occafion as this was, in a full affembly of their numerous Court, and in the moft pompous man- The LIFE of the AUTHOR. ix manner poflible. M. Fabritius had the honour of being intro- duced to his audience before the reft, and indeed during the whole time of his abode at Ifpahan, which was near two years, he had very particular and diftinguifhing honours fhewn him, whereby it appear'd, that neither his perfon, nor bufinefs, had been difagreeable to the Perfian Court. Dr. Kaempfer, whofe curious and inquifitive difpofition fuffer'd nothing to efcape un* obferved, made all poffible advantages of fo long aftay in the Capital of the Perfian Empire. His main and favourite enqui- ries indeed, here and every where in his travels, tended chiefly to the improvement of Phyfick and Natural Hiftory in their fe- veral branches, and he hath abundantly fhewn, by his Amoenu tales Exotica, that his endeavours that way have not been un- fuccefsful. But he did not abfolutely confine himfelf to this fubjedr, though large and extenfive enough : The Political Hi- ftory of a Country, the fucceflion and remarkable actions of its Princes, the ftate of their Court and Government, their per- fonal qualities, vices or vertues, the cuftoms, manners, inclina- tions of the natives, their way of life, trade, commerce, the remains of antiquity, the modern buildings, whether facred or civil, the flourifhing or low condition of arts and fciences, and many other things of the like kind, equally exercifed his in- duftry and attention. As to the Perfian affairs in particular, he was not a little aflifted in his refearches by the Rev. F. du Mans, Prior of the Convent of Capuchins at Ifpahan, who had ferved the Court of Perfia, in quality of Interpreter, for thirty years and upwards, and had acquired, beyond any European before him, a thorough knowledge of the Perfian language, govern- ment and cuftoms, and a deeper infight into the ftate of that Court and Kingdom. And certainly, Dr. Kaempfer's account of Perfia, (as delivered in his Amoenitates) for accuracy and pre- cifenefs may vye with the moft confiderable before or fince. M. Fabritius having brought his negotiations at the Perfian Court to a conclufion, towards the latter end of 1^85, and preparing to return into Europe, Dr. Kaempfer, for the reafons alledged in his Preface to this Hiftory of Japan, did not think fit to go back with him. He was indeed ofFer'd the place of c chief The LIFE of the A U T H O R. chief Phyfician to a Georgian Prince, with confiderable appoint- ments, but his inclination to travelling being not yet abated led him farther into the Eaft, and the advice of Father du Mans, with whom he had contracted a particular amity, during his ftay at Ifpahan, with the recommendations he obtained of M. Fa- britius, prevail'd upon him to enter into the fervice of the Dutch Eaft- India Company, in quality of chief Surgeon to the Fleet, which was then cruizing in the Perfian Gulph, a place, as he exprefles himfelf in one of his letters, lefs honourable in- deed, but more adapted to the defign of his travels. He left Ifpahan, on his journey to Gamron, or Benderabaffi, a celebrated trading town on the Perfian Gulph, in November i6%$, and was honourably attended a mile out of town by the Ambaflador's retinue. He made fome ftay at Sijras, both to make the neceflary enquiries concerning the celebrated Perfian wines, which owe their name to that town, and to vifit the boafted remains of the ancient Perfepolis, and the Royal Palace of Darius, that noble ftrutture, which fell a facrifice to wine and wantonnefs, and whofe fcattered ruins are a ftill fubfifting undeniable monument of its former fplendor and greatnefs. The unhealthinefs of Gamron, for the fultry heat of the air, and the want of water, is fuch, that few Europeans can live there any confiderable time, without great prejudice to their health ; and even the natives are obliged, in the hot feafon, to retire up into the mountains. Dr. Kaempfer felt the effect of it foon af- ter his arrival, falling into a malignant fever, of which he lay delirious for fome days ; however it pleafed Providence to fpare him : His fever abating, flung him into a dropfy, and that into a quartan ague, and 'twas by thefe dangerous and unufual fteps he recovered his health, but not his former ftrength and vigour. As foon as he found himfelf in a condition to remove, he retired into the Country, for the change of air and the recovery of his his ftrength, as well as in queft of new difcoveries and obferva- tions, chiefly on thofe things which for the unhealthinefs of the Climate, and other difficulties, had not been before throughly and fo accurately enquired into. To 7t>e LIFE of the AUTHOR. xi To thefe his Summer expeditions, and retirement from Gam- ron, are owing : His account of the mountain Benna in the Province Laar , on the Gulph of Perfia, of its plants and animals, of the precious Bezoar, and the animal in whofe fto- maeh it is found, of the lingular hot baths, a native balfam, and other curiofities obferved on that mountain, and in the neighbourhood thereof: His defcription of the Native Mummy, that molt precious balfam, which fweats out of a rock, in the Province Daar, and is gathered once a year with great pomp and ceremony, for the fole ufe of the Perfian King : His obfer- vations on the Afa Foetida, of the Plant yielding that fubftance, which grows only in Perfia, and on the manner of gathering and preparing it : His obfervations of the Vena Medinenjis of Ara- bian writers, or Dracunculus, as he calls it, a lingular worm bred between the interftices of the mufcles, in feveral parts of the human body : His account of the Sanguis J)raconis, I mean the true Eaftern one, which he afcertains to be obtain 'd from the fruit of a Coniferous Palm : His curious and accurate Hi- ftory of the Palma Dattylifera, growing in Perfia, its differing fpecies, male and female, its culture, growth, preparation and ufes, far beyond whatever was known of this lingular Tree : With many other obfervations, equally curious and ufeful, which may perhaps one time or other be communicated to the pub- lick. He did not leave Gamron till the latter end of June 1688. The Fleet, on board which he went, having orders to touch at moft Dutch fettlements in Arabia the Happy, the Great Mogul's Country, upon the Coafts of Malabar, in the ifland Ceylon, in the Gulph of Bengale, and the ifland of Sumatra, he had an opportunity of feeing all thefe feveral Countries, every where with the fame fpirit of induftry, and the famethirft of know- ledge. Had his flay there been greater, his oblervations alfo would have been more numerous. He arrived at Batavia in September i/ Court : The LIFE o/AAUTHOR, xiij Court: And ira order to make all poffible advantages of this voyage, he obtained leave to go on board that Ship, which was order'd to touch at Siam, that thereby he might have an op- portunity of feeing alfo that Kingdom. The obfervations he made in the couTfe of this voyage, in the Kingdom of Siam, and afterwards during two years abode in the Empire of Japan, being the fubjecT: of this prefent work, it is needlefs here to en- large on the fame. Japan was not only the laft Eaftern Coun- try he intended to vifit, but alfo that which he had been long defirous to fee, and always looked upon as a deferving fub- jefit fotf a laborious enquiry. The fcarce fuperable difficulties, enough to deter even the moft induflxious, fpurr'd him on to more painful fearches, and he willingly facrificed his time, art and money, to procure, for himfelf and others, a thorough in- formation of a Country, of which, till then, no fatisfaclory ac- count had been given: With what fuccefs he hath done it, is left to the publick to determine. He quitted Japan, in order to his return into Europe, in No- vember i£5>i> and Batavia in February i^5>3- He ftaid near a month at the Cape of Good Hope, and arrived at Amfterdam in the month of October following. In April 1694* he took his degree of Do&or in Phyfick at the Univerfity of Leyden, and on this occafion, as it is cuftomary in foreign Univerfities, for Gentlemen afpiring to the like promotions, to give a pub- lick proof of their ability, by what they call Inaugural Thefes^ he communicated to the learned world ten very lingular and curious obfervations, he had made in foreign Countries, on the celebrated Agnus Scythka, or Borometz, a pretended Plant-Ani- mal, which he (hews to be a mere figment, occafioned, perhaps, by fome affinity of the name Borometz, with Borannetz in the Ruffian, and Borannek in the Polifh Language, whereby is deno- ted a particular kind of ftieep about the Cafpian Sea, in the Bulgarian Tartary and Chorafmia : On the bitter tafte of the waters in the Cafpian Sea : On the true Perfian Native Mum- my, called Muminahi : On the Torpedo, a lingular fifli, which benumbs the fingers of thole who touch it : On the Sanguis Draco- riis made out of the fruit of a Coniferous Palm : On the Dracun- d c«/«x, xiv 7heLIFE of the AUTHOR. cuius, or Vena Medeni of Arabian writers : On the Andrum, a fort of Hydrocele, or watry rupture, and the Perical, an Ulcer in the Legs, two endemial diftempers, among the Malabarians : On thejapanefe way of curing the Colick by the Acupunc* tura, and on the Moxa, a Cauftick in frequent ufe among the Chinele and Japanefe. Upon his return to his native Country, he intended forthwith to digeft his Papers and written Memoirs into proper order, and to communicate to the publick what he had oblerved in his travels, and certainly, it would have been then the beft time for it, when every thing was as yet frelh in his mind : But his reputation and experience, and the honour which the Count de Lippe, his Sovereign Prince, did him, by appointing himPhy- fician to himfelf and his family, quickly involved him into fo extenfive a practice, as with a multiplicity of other bufinefs, prevented his purfuing this laudable defign with that vigour he himfelf defired, and its own nature and importance deferved. For thefe reafons it was chiefly, that the Amoenitates Exotica did not appear in print till the year 1 7 1 z. That work, which was only intended as a Specimen and Prodromus of others, met (as indeed for the number and Angularity of new and curious obfervations it well deferved,) with a general applaufe, and be- got, in all lovers of learning, an earneft folicitation for his other works promifed in the Preface, to wit, his Hiftory of Japan, which is hereby offer'd to the publick, his Herbarium Vltra* Gangeticum, or the defcription and figures of the Plants obferved by him in feveral Eaftern Countries beyond the Ganges, and laftly, a compleat account of all his Travels. He was married in 1700, to Maria Sophia Wilftach, only daughter of Wolfrath Wilfiacb, an eminent Merchant at Stolze- nau, and had by her ilTue one fon and two daughters, who all died in their infancy. The long courfe of his Travels, the fatigues of his profefc lion, and fome private misfortunes in his family, had very much impair'd his conftitution, and in the latter part of his life he was often troubled with the Colick, of which he had two very fevere attacks, one in November 1 7 1 5, and another at the begin- The LI FE of the AUTHOR. xv beginning of 1716. This laft fit laid him up for three weeks, however he recover'd it fo far, that he was able to attend the Count de Lippe and his Family, as their Phyfician, atPyrmont, and returned, in July, to his Country Seat at Steinhof near Lemgow in pretty good health. On the 5th of September fol- lowing he was fuddenly feized with faintingfits, and a vomiting of blood, which continuing upon him all night, reduced him very low. From that time he continued in a lingring condition, though not altogether without hopes of recovery, having gathered ftrength fo far, as to be able to walk about his room : But on the 2.4th of Oftober, having been ever fince this laft attack troubled with a naufea and lofs of appetite, his vomi- ting of blood return'd upon him with great violence, and a fe- ver, which lafted till the fecond of November, on which day he died, at five in the evening, 65 years and fix weeks old. He was buried in the Cathedral Church of S. Nicolas at Lem- gow. Thus far my account of the Author's Life and remarkable Tra- vels, which I have traced chiefly from his own manufcript me- moirs, journals, letters to his friends, and the like, though I am indebted for fome circumftances to a fermon, which was pronounced on his funeral by Bertholdus Haccius y a Minifter at Lemgow, and printed at that place. AN XVJ A N INTRODUCTION By the TRANSLATOR. T would be needle fs to fay any thing by way of Apo- logy for the publication of the following Hifiory of Japan. There is fomething, in all Books of Trawls, both ufeful and entertaining to men of all ranks and profeffions. And as to this Hifiory in particular, if the Author had not already, by a former performance of his, {entituled Amcenitates Exotica?, and publiflod at Lemgow in 1712;) convinced the world of his learning, judgment, and integrity, its own curiojity and intrinjick worth, the remotenefs of the Country, which is therein fo particularly defcribed, and which hath been hitherto but little known, together with the many vexatious difficulties, the Author had to Jiruggle with in the purfuit of his enquiries, as hath been hinted by him in his Preface, and will ap* pear throughout the whole work, would fufficiently recommend it to a favourable reception. The High German Original lay, in a manner, ready for the Prefs, when the Amoenitates were printed, and it was promt fed in the Preface, that it would be fpeedily publijh d, but his ne- ceffary attendance on the praclife of Phyfick, particularly in the Count de Lippe s Family, to whom he was Phyfician in ordinary, with a multiplicity of other bujinefs, the want of good engravers, and pro' bably of encouragement too, delay d its appearing, till at leafi his Jickmfs and death put an entire flop to this and fome other . intended works INTRODUCTION. xvij works of his, the fruit of many years indefatigable fains and indujlry. Sir Hans Sloane bearing of Dr. Kdempfers death, and having otherwi/e found by his Inaugural Thefes, and bis Amcenitates Exoticae, that he mu(i have collecled and brought with him into Europe many natural and artificial curiojities, dejired Dr. Steigerthal, his Majeftys chief Phy- Jician, in one of his journies to Hanover, to enquire what was become of them. This Gentleman wasfo obliging, as to go to Lemgow himfelf and being told that they were to be difpofed of he immediately informed Sir Hans of who thereupon pur chafed them for a conjiderable fum of money , together with all his drawings and manuscript memoirs : And it is owing to his care and generous ajfifiance, that this Hiftory of Japan, the or'u ginal high German manufcript of which was bought at the fame time, is now firfi publifhed in Englifh. It was upon his intimation, which defervedly hath with me the weight of a command, that I undertook to tranflate it, a Gentleman of better abilities, who intended to do it, hav* ing been called abroad, and employ d in affairs of a different nature. And I went about it with more chearfulnefs, as out of his known com- municative difpojition, and unwearied endeavours to promote all ufeful^ and in particular natural knowledge, he was pleafed not only to grant me the ufe of his Library, which I may venture to call the completeft in its kind in Europe, but likewife to give me leave to copy out of his invaluable treafures of curiojities in nature and art, what would ferve to illuftrate and embellifh it, for which, and the many other marks of the favour and friend/hip he hath honoured me with, ever fince my arrival in this Country, I take this opportunity gratefully to return my fincereft acknow* ledgments. My dejign, in this Introduction, is, in a fhort furvey of this prefent work, to point out fome of its peculiar excellencies, and to illufirate the whole with a few additional remarks, tending to clear up fome doubtful points from the lateji difcoveries, and to explain others, which have been hitherto but /lightly, if at all, touched upon. As the tran/lation and publication of this Hiflory led me into farther fearches concerning the Empire of Japan, and put me upon enquiring what other authors have wrote on this fubjeff, I thought that it would not be un- acceptable, nor altogether ufelefs, to publijh a lift of them, with fome obfervations, 1 made upon perufal, on the char after, tranjlations and fe* veral editions of the mofi conjiderable : I have had the Jatisfa&ion to find, upon the ftricleft fearch, that there was nothing of moment wanting e in xviij INTRODUCTION. in the Library of Sir Hans Sloane : And it wiU appear by the complete* nefs of this catalogue, what an immenfe charge and trouble the worthy Poffeffor muft have been at, to bring together, from all parts of the world, fo extenfive a colle&ion of Books of Phyfick y Natural Hiftory and Tra- vels, and of what an advantage it would be to the learned world, to fee fome account of them in print, of which he was plea fed to give us fome hopes in the Introduction to thefecond volume of his Natural Hiftory of Jamaica. I. Survey of y^j Hiftory of Japan was by the Author divided into five Books. At the beginning of thefirfi Book is an account of his voyage from Ba- tavia to Siam, and from thence to Japan, together with ajhort defcrip- tion of the Kingdom of Siam. One would imagine, after the many and prolix accounts of the Kingdom of Siam, publijhed (on occafion of that memorable Embaffy, which was fent from thence into France in 16%^ and was return d by two others from France to Siam) by de L'Ifle, F. Tachard, the Abbot deChoify, Nicolas Gervaife, and the two Ambajfadors fent thither b) the King of France, the Mar que fs de Chau- mont, and Monjieur de la Loubere, not to mention many preceding writers, that there Jhould have been little or nothing left to be taken no* the of by other Travellers : But the obfervations of Dr. K<£mpfer /hew, that the fubjeft was far from being exhaufted. His narrative of the late revolution in Siam, and the fall and execution of the famous Conftantin Faulcon, for fome time Prime Minifter to the King, hath feveral circumftances entirely new, and others very much differing from the accounts given by the French writers, particularly F. D 'Orleans {who wrote the life of M. Conftance) and it may deferve fome credit, as the French, by being expelled the Country, were incapacitated to give a good account of what happen d, and as he him/elf arrived there not long after this remarkable event, when as yet it wasfrefh in every body's memory. He hath made many pertinent remarks on the Religion, Cu- ftoms, Chronology of the Siamites, and hath obferved, in lefs than a month's flay, feveral things even in and about the Capital, which efcaped the attention of other Travellers before him. The Pyramid Pukathon, and the Courts of Berklam'j Temples, which he hath Jo accurately de* fcribed and figured, are inftances of this. The Hiftory of Japan begins with a Geographical Defcription of that Empire, deliver d in two Chapters, and taken out of their own au- thors % INTRODUCTION. xix Ifland. thors, fo far as it relates to the number of Provinces, or Counties, the particular diftricls they are divided into, and the Revenues of each Pro- vince, It hath been very much doubted by feme of the lateft Geogra- jj££ d t0 be p hers, whether or no the Empire of Japan is contiguous to the neigh' homing Country of Jeffo, as the Japanefe call it, and confequently, whether it is to be reckon d among the I/lands or Peninfulas. Mon~ flew de l'lfle, a Member of the Royal Academy of Sciences at Paris, and Geographer to the King of France, feemd rather inclined to think that it is contiguous to Jeffo, and hath given the reafons of his con* jeilures in a Letter, which was publijh'd in the third volume of the Recueil des Voyages au Nord, (p. 3 2,. It will not be amifs, on this occajion, to offer fome obfervations, which wiU ferve to clear up this doubt, and to Jhew that it actually is an Ifland. And in the firfl place it mufi be obferved, that Monfieur de l'lfle lays the greateft ftrefs of his Conjectures on the uncertainty, which the Japanefe themfelves are in, about the antiquity of their Empire with a neighbouring continent, and fame paffages taken out of a Letter of F. Luis de Froes, and the memorable Embajfies of the Dutch to the Emperors of Japan, wherein it is pofitiuely afferted, that they are contiguous. He doth not difown, but that all the Maps of the Japanefe Empire, made Jince its dip coveryin 1542.J particularly thofe of Texeira, Cofmographer to the King of Portugal, and of Dudley, Duke of Northumberland, Au- thor of the Arcano del Mare, with fome others fent from China and Japan, concurring to make an I/land of it, are of no [mall weight to make one think that it is one, the rather, as this opinion k farther fup- ported by moft accounts from thofe parts. As to what he quotes out of Tavern ier, of ajhip, which, he affirms, in the third volume of his Travels, to have failed all round Japan, that indeed might be eajily given up, though never fo pojitively afferted. That Author, himfelf fcarce able to read or write, and obliged to borrow the Pen of another man to write the account of his Travels, was too fuperficial in his defcription even of thofe Countries, where he hath been, and too apt, not only to take things upon truft at firfl: hand, but afterwards alfo to confide too much to his memory, to be any ways depended on : And in hU account of that fhip, (whereby it is plain, he meant the Breskens and Caftrecoom fitted out by the Dutch Eaft India Company, and pur* pofely fent upon difcovery of the Country of Jeffo in 1*43) he bath made, xx INTRODUCTION. made, whether mi/inform d himfelf, or willing to mijinform others-, too many unaccountable blunders, to deferve the leafi credit. But without having recourfe, to what might be gathered for or againft the opinion of M. de rifle, either from the Maps or Writings of preceding authors, though I believe he hath even there by much the minority on his fide, this matter is put out of aU doubt, by the Maps of the Empire of 'Japan made by the natives, and by the lateji difcoveries of the Ruffians. The Japanefe, in all their maps, reprejent their Empire as confifiing of very many Iflands, great and fmall, the largefi whereof which is by them called Nipon, u entirely feparate from a neighbouring Northern Country, which they call Jefogafima, or the IJland Jefo, and which is in all probability^ the very fame, which F. Hieronymus ab Angelis went into from Japan, and which in his fecond account he affirms to be an I (land, contrary to what he had advanced in the fir fi. Some maps place between Japan and Jefogafima another fmall IJland called Mat- fumai. Several of thefe maps, which were brought out of the Country by Dr. Kdempfer himfelf, and which I have followed in the map an» nezed to this Hifiory, at leafi, where I was wanting in better memoirs^ are now in the hands of Sir Hans Sloane, and another was feveral years ago engraved by the learned Mr. Reland out of the collection of M. Benjamin Dutry. / mufi own, that thefe maps, for accuracy and precifenefs , fall far Jhort of our European ones, the Eafiern Geo' graphers being not skilled enough in Mathematicks and Afironomy for that : But it cannot be fuppofed, with regard to the Japanefe in par- ticular, that being fo fully apprized, as they are, of the largenejs, ex* tent and divifion of Ofiu, the moft Northern Province of their Em* pire, and one of the moft populous, they ffiould be ignorant, whether or how far it is wajh d by the Sea, and where it borders upon other Countries or Provinces. That there is a freight, which feparates the moft Northern Coafls of Japan from a neighbouring Continent, is far* Some Ac- ther confirm d by the latefi difcoveries of the Ruffians. It is but of late beria. } ears -i that the Ruffian Court hath been apprized of the largenefs of Si- beria, and the Great Tartary, and their vaft extent Eaftwards. For a long while their knowledge was in a manner bound by the River Oby, which difc barges itfelf into the fir eights of Weigats, and on which fiands Tobolskoi, the Capital of Siberia, and the ufual place of banifhment for State-Criminals. When Br, Kaempfer was at Mos- cow, I NT RODUCTION xxj cow, they had then already received feme better memoirs, but they were as yet kept very fecret. Twas from thefe, and later informations, that M. de Witfen made, feme time after, his large map of Ruffia and the Great Tartary, which goes a good way beyond the Rivers Jenifea and Lena, and which was afterwards corrected in feveral places, and a- Iridged, by Mr. Isbrand Ides, in his Voyage to China. But by the la* tefi difeoveries, particularly that of the Country of Kamchatka, which was made but a few years ago, it appears, that the Ruffian Empire, in Jargenefs and extent, far furpajfeth any as yet known, not even the dominions of the Emperor of China excepted, though that Monarch is poffefs'dof a con fider able part of the Great Tartary, and that it bor- ders upon the Kingdoms of Sweden and Poland, the Turkifh Empire, the Kingdom of Perfea, the Turkeftaan and Bulgarian Tartaries, and the Dominions of the Emperor of China, nay that further Eafiward it reaches down almoft as far as the lflands of Japan. But it is not my Jf'&S? 00 dejign here to enter into a defeription of the Ruffian Empire, and I chatfcL Jhatt confine myfelf to the Country of Kamfchatka, as the Ruffians call it, a draught of which I have added to my Map of Japan (v. Tab. VIII.) as I found it reprefented in a large Map of the Ruffian Em* pire, made according to the lateft informations, the Ruffian Court had from thofe parts> and publffid in Holland but a few months fence. This Country feems to be the very fame with that, which the Japanefe call Oku-Jefo, or Upper- Jefo, and of which they know little more, but that there is fetch a Country. According to the beft accounts, the Ruffians are as yet able to give, it is a Veninfula, feated between i 5 o and 1 70 Degrees of Longitude, and 41 and 60 of Latitude, North- ward of Japan. Northward it is contiguous to Siberia, running up almoji as far as Cape Suetoinos, which is the furthermoft Cape of Siberia to the Nortb-Eaft, but to the Eaft, South and Weft it is wafl)d by the Sea. It is inhabited by different nations, whereof thofe, who live about the middle, pay contribution to the Ruffians, but others living more North, particularly the Olutorski, as they are called in this map, are their profefs'd enemies. The Kurilski, as the Ruffians call them, who inhabit the mofi Southern part, being alfo more civilized than the reft, are by them feppofed to be Colo* nies of the Japanefe, and feo far as the accounts of the Japanefee may be depended on, they are fubjetl to the Emperor of Japan, and govern d^ f under xxij INTRODUCTION. under his authority, by a Prince, who commonly re fides at Matfumai, and xcho repairs once a year, as do all other Princes of the Empire of Japan, to Jedo, to pay homage to the Emperor. The Commerce be- tween Siberia and Kamchatka is carried on two different ways. Some go over the Gulph of Kamchatka, which runs up between it, and the Great Tartary and Siberia, near fifty- eight Degrees of Latitude, and they commonly pafs it from Lama, where the Ruffians have begun to build large Ships, to Priftan, a Town built by them in Kamchatka, and inhabited by a Rujfian Colony. But thofie inhabitants of Siberia, who live about the River Lena, and along the Icy Ocean, commonly come with their Ships round Cape Suetoinos, and this they do to avoid fal- ling into the hands of the Tfchalatzki, and Tfchutzki, two fierce and barbarous nations, poffefsd of the North-Eafi point of Siberia, and great enemies to the Ruffians. By this account, which I have taken from the curious remarks upon a Genealogical Hiftory of the Tartar s, lately publiflfd, it appears, i. That Afia is not contiguous to America to the North- Eafi, but that there is a pajfage out of the Icy Sea into the Indian Ocean, and that confequently it would be poj/ible for Ships to Jail from Europe acrofs the Icy Ocean, and from thence along the Country of Jefifo or Kamchatka, and the Eaflern Coafis of Japan to the Indies, were it not for the huge mountains of Ice continually floating in thofe frozen Seas, even in the midfi of Summer, but much more for the fear ce ever melting Ice in the Str eights of Weigats, whereby the paffage through thefe Streights is render d abfolutely impracticable, at all times of the year. 2,. That there is a Str eight which feparates the Country of Kam- chatka from Japan. According to the accounts of the Ruffians, there are fever al fmall Iflands in thefe Streights, the largeft whereof is in a map of Kamfchatka, publijhed fome years ago by J. B. Homann, calfd Matmanska, and is probably the fame with Matfumai in fome Japanefe maps. And this I think fufficient to jhew, for what reafons I have in the map of Japan, annexed to this Hiftory, made an ijland of it. From the Geographical defcription of the Empire of Japan, Dr. K&mpfer proceeds to take into his confederation the original defcent of the Natives, which he traces up to the confufion of Tongues at Babel, fuppofing, that upon the Babylonians being difper fed all over the world, the fir ft Japanefe alfo went to fettle in that part, which was allotted by Provi" INTRODUCTION. xxiij Providence for the future abode of themfehes and their pofierity. He Th r e J a " J J J J _- panefe arc confutes the opinion of thofe, who pretend, that the Japanefe are only n °t a Coio- a Colony of the Chinefe. His arguments are drawn chiefly from the Chinefe. many and thofe very material differences in the Language, Religion, Cufioms, way of Life, and inclinations of both Nations, and certainly, confidering the warlike humour and activity of the Japanefe, and the effeminate Jlothfulnefs of the Chinefe, one would rather take the former to be of Tartarian extraction. The Reverend F. Couplet, who, for his- deep injight into the Hifiories of the Chinefe, may be allowed a competent Judge, is of the fame opinion, as appears by his Introduction to the Philofoph) of Confufim, (publiffid at Paris in 1 6 8 7) p. LXXI. and he enforces it by a remarkable paffage he met with in the annals of the Chi- nefe, whereby it appears, that in the reign of "Uu Ye, (the z$th Mo- narch of the Family of Xam, being the fecond Familv of the Emperors of China) who came to the throne in the year before Chrifi wyG, (that is, upwards of 500 years before the foundation of the Japanefe Monar* chy) the barbarous Nations to the North of China, (that is, the Tartars) being grown too numerous, feveral Colonies were detactid to people the Ifiands lying in the Eaftern Ocean. But whatever Nation the Japanefe are defended from y the Conjectures of Dr. K f. p. 183) that in the year 1541, when Martinus Alfonfiis de Soufa was Viceroy of the Eaft Indies, three Portuguese, Antonius da Mota, Francifcus Zeimoto, and Antonius Peixota, and death of Tai- cofama, that illufirious Prince, who from a low fervile condition of life, by INTRODUCTION. xxxiij by bis own merit and excellent conduct, raifed himfelf to the Empire of Japan , bis war with the Cordons, the reception and fuccefs of an Em' baffy, which was fent to him upon that account by the Emperor of China, the tragical death of Quabacondono, his only nephew, whom he had already appointed to be his Succeffor, and the Revolution, which happened in Japan, upon the death of this great Monarch, are fome of the moji confiderable. There are many feparate accounts extant of thefe and fome other things, which happened in Japan in that fpace of time, but as they are all contained in this Collection, I fhall avoid troubling the Rea- der with a particular account of them, and only beg leave to add a word or two concerning that memorable Embaffy above-mentioned, which was fent to Rome by fome Princes of the Japanefe Empire in 1585, and which was fomething Jo unexpected and unujual, that the Eyes of all Europe were then turned upon it. Moji accounts of this Embaffy, which were printed in fever al parts of Europe, contain little elfe, but a narrative of its reception at Rome, and the fever al audiences, the Ambaffadors had of Gregory XIII. who died foon after their arrival, and of Sixtus V. his Succeffor. It will fuffce to mention the two following, as the mofl ample and extenjive. Relationi della venuta degli Ambafciatori Giaponefi a Roma, fino alia partita di Lisbona. Con le accoglienze fatte loro da tutti i Principi Chriftiani, per dove fono paflati. Raccolte da Girido Gualtieri, Roma 1 5 8oi, 8w. The Francifians, whofie Martyrdom is defctibed in this account, were fent Ambafiadors from the Governor of Manilhas to the Emperor Taico, and by him received and treated as filch, but having afterwards, contrary to his repeated commands, continued openly and without referve to preach at Miaco, they were fentenced to be exe- cuted at Nagafaki, as dijiurbers of the publick tranquillity, together with three Jefiuits and feventeen Japanefie, who had been aU taken Up for the fame cauje. Hiftoria de las Iflas del Archipelago y Reinos della gran China, Tartaria, Cochincbina, Malaca, Siam, Camboxa, y Japan, y deloSuccedido en ellos a los ReligiofoS defcalcos de la orden del Seraphico Padre fan Francifco de la Provincia de fan Gregorio de lasPhilippinas. Par F. Marcello de Ribadeneyra. Barcelona i Co i ■ 4to. Only the fourth, fifth andjixtb £ook of this Hijiory, relate to the affairs of the Church of Japan, and in particular to the execution of the Francificans above-mentioned. Hiftoria de las Mifliones, que hart hecho los Religiofos de la Compania de Jefus, para predicar el Saiic^o Evangelio en la India oriental, y en los Reinos della China, y Japon. Primera y fegunda parte. Por el P. Luis de Guzman. Alcala icoi, fol. The fifth andfixth Book of the firfi volume, and the whole fiecond volume of this Hifiory, contain a very ample and c'tHumfiantial account of the affairs of the Church of Japan, from its foundation by S. Fran- cis Xavier, to the end of the Jixteentb Century. Relacion annual de las cofas, que hah hecho los Padres de la Compania de Jefus en la India Oriental y Japon en los annos de \Coo y i co i, y del progreflb de la Converfion y Chriftiandad de aquellas partes. Valladolid 1604, $yo. This is a continua* tion of F. Luis Guzman his Hijiory of the Church affairs in China and Japan. It was firfi wrote in Portugueze by F. Ferdinand Guer- reiro, and tranflated into Spanifh by F. Antony Collaco. Tre Lettere annue-degii anni 1603, 1604, 1*05, & parte del 1C0C , mandate dal R. P. Francifco Pafio. Bologna 1C90. Thefi time Letters ate of F.Johannes Rodericks (Siron. Liters xxxv j INTRODUCTION. Liters Japonica? Anni 1606, Chinenfes Anni 1606 & iCoj, ilk a R. P. Joh. Rodriguez, ha? a R. P. Matthso Riccio Soc. Jefu tranfmifk ad Cl. Aquavivam, Latine reddita; a Rhetoribus Colle- 011 S.J. Antwetpiae 16 1 1, 8vo. Liters Japonic annorum 1609 & itfio. Ex Italicis Latinar facia: ab Andrea Schotto. Antwerpia: 161 5, 8vo. Hiftoire des Cliofes les plus memorables avenues tant ez Indes o- rientales, qu'autrcs pais de la decouverte de Portugais, en l'eftablifle- ment & progrez de la Foy Catholique, & principalement de ce que les Religieux de la Compagnie de Jefus y ont fait & endure pour la mefme fin, depuis qu'ils y font entrez, jufqueza Tan 1600, par Pierre du Jarric, Tolofain, de la mefme Compagnie, 1 . partie. Bourdeaux 1608, 4to. 'this Hijlory, which relates to all the Ea- flern Countries in general, was compiled chiefly from the Letters of the Jefuits, the Life and Letters of S. Francis Xavier, as pullijhed by F. Turfellin, the Writings of MafTeus, Acofta, Guzman, Joannes de Lucena, Fernandus Guerreiro, and others. The fecond Volume was publijhed at Bourdeaux 1^10, 4to. and the Third, which comes down to the Tear 1610, at the fame place, 1614, 4to. The whole Hijlory was afterwards tranflated into Latin hy Matthias Martinez, and puh- Ujhed at Cologn 161 5, 8vo. Rei Chriftiana? apud Japonios Commentarius, ex Literis annuis Soc. Jefu, Annorum i^op, 10, n,&iz. Collectus a Nicolao Trigaultio. Augufte Vindelicorum. 1615. 8vo. Relacion del fiicceflo, que tuvo nueftra fanta fe en Ios Reinos de Japon defde el anno \6\z, hafte el anno de 1 6 1 5 , imperando Cu- bofama, Compuefta por el P. Luys Pineyro. S.J. Madrid. 1617. At the latter end of this account, which was taken from the Letters of the Jefuits in Japan to F. Mutio Vitellefchi, then general of the or- der, is a Lijl of all perfons that were executed in Japan for the Chri- Jlian Religion, from the year 1564 to 16 15 : as alfo of all the Colle- ges, Schools, and Convents, which were taken from the Jefuits during the Perfecution, amounting in all to 75. A brief relation of the Perfecution lately made againfl the Ca- tholick Chriftians in the Kingdom of Japan. Divided into two Books. Taken out of the annual Letters of the Fathers of the So- ciety of Jefus, and other authentical informations, tranflated into Englifh INTRODUCTION. xxxvij En^liih by W. W. London. i£ij. 8vo. This relates chiefly to •what pa fed in the year 1619. Hiftoria y Relacion del Japon de(dc el anno 16 u, hafta cl de 1 6 1 5 . Por el P. Pedro Morejon. S. J. Lisboa 1 6 1 5 . 410. Hiftoria del Regno di Voxu del Giapone, delP antichita, nobilta e valore del fuo Re Idate Mafamune, delli favori, ch'a fatti alia Chriftianita, e defiderio che tiene d'efTer Chriftiano, e dell' aumento di noftra fanta fede in quelle parti, e dell' Ambaf- data, che ha inviata alia fantita di N. S. Papa Paolo V. e delli fuoi fucceffi, con altre varie cofe - fatta par il Dottor Scipione Amati, Romano, Interprete e Hiftorico dell' Ambafciata. Roma 1 6 1 5 , 4to. This was a fecond Embaffy from Japan to Rome. It was fent by Idate Mafamune, Prince of Voxu, that is, Osju, the moft Northern Province of the Empire of Japan, and F. Ludovicus Sotelo, a Francifcan, was at the head of it. They went into Europe by the way of the Weft-Indies, and were admitted to an audience of the Pope on the 3 o, 8vo. F. Charles Spinola was burnt alive in Japan, on the tenth of September i6tz. Hiftoria Ecclefiaftica de los fucceflbs de la Chriftiandad de Japan defde el de i6oz, que entro en el la orden de Predica- dores, hafta el de 16 20. Compuefto por el P. F. Jacinto Orfanel, de la mifma orden. Y annadida hafta el fin del anno de 1610. Por el P. F. Diego Collado. Madrid 1633, fol. This work relates chiefly to the Mijfions of Fathers of the Order of S. Dominic in Japan, as doth alfo, in good meafure, the following, which brings down the affairs of their Mijfions in the Philippine Iflands, Japan and China, from the year 1581 to 1^37. Hiftoria de la Provincia del S. Rofario de la orden de Predi- cadores en Philippinas, Japon y China, por Don Fray Diego Aduarte, Obifpo della nueva Segovia. Annadida por el P. F. Domingo Goncalez. En Manila en el Collegio de S. Thomas, 1640, fol Relation verdadera y breve de la perfecution y Martyrios, que padecieron por la confeffion de nueftra S. Fe Catholica en Japon, quinze Religiofos de la Provincia de S. Gregorio de los defcalcos del orden de S. Francifco, de las Was Philippinas, y otros muchos Martyres Religiofos de otras religiones, y feculares de diferentes eftados, todos los quales padecieron en Japon defde el anno de 161 3, hafta el de 1614. Por el P. Diego de San Francifco. Manila 16x5, 8vo. At the latter end of this fmaU Tracl are, A&a audientise a S. D. N. Paulo V. Pontifice opt. max. INTRODUCTION. xxxix max. Regis Voxu Japoni legatis Romae die 3 Nov. 161$. in pa- latio Apoftolico exhibits. Liters annus e Japonia, anni 1614. ex Italico in Latinum tranflats. Dilings i6zS, 8vo. Hiftoire Ecclefiaftique des Ifles & Royaumes de Japon par le R. P. Francois Solier. Paris 1 6i7> 4to. This is a general Hiftory of the Church of Japan, and in a Chronological order, from its foun- dation to the year 1614.. Narratio perfecutionis adverfus Chriftianos excitatae in variis Japonis Regnis, annis i£a8, *9, 3 o. Ex Italito Latine reddi- ta a Joh. Bollando. Antwerpiae, 16^5. 8vo. Hiftorie der Martelaaren die in Japan om de Roomfche Ca- tholiicke Religie, fchrickeliicke ende onverdraagelycke piinen geleedeen heben, ofte ghedoodt ziin. Bechreeven door Reyer Giisbertz. The Author of this fhort Hiftory, whkh is commonly printed with F. CaronV Hiftory of Japan, lived for fome time at JSa- gafaki in the fewice of the Dutch Eaft -India Company, and was an eye witnefs to moft of the faffs, which he therein difcourfes of and which happen d from the year i6zi to 1635*. Relatione della Provincia del Giapone fcritta dah P. Antonio Francefco Cardim. Roma 164.5, 8vo. The State of the Chriftian Religion in Japan, Tonquin, Cochinchina, Siam, Cambodia, Laos, and the Ifland Haynan, the Embaffy, which was fent by the Portu- gueze Government of Macao to the Emperor of Japan, in the year 1640, in order to get, if pojfible, the atl of the expuljion of the Poriugueze repeal d, the barbarous reception of the Ambaffadors, and the cruel execution of their Perfbns and whole Retinue, (thirteen only of the loweft rank excepted, who were fent back to Macao) on the %d of Auguft 1640, are the chief SubjetJ of this relation. Tra&atus in quo agitur de Japoniorum Religione; de Chriftianae Religionis introdu&ione in ea loca ; de ejufdem ex- tirpatione. Adjun&a eft de diverfa diverfarum gentium to- tius Telluris religione brevis informatio. Auttore Bernardo Va- renio, M. D. Amftelodami 1649, umo. This is only an Ah* ftratl of the moft material things the Author met with in Maf> feus xl INTRODUCTION. few,, fome of the Letters of the Jefuits, the account of Reyer Giisbertz and Francis Carol), reduced under certain heads. Dell' Iftoria della Compagnia di Giefu, 1' Alia, defcritta dal P. Daniello Bartoli, Parcel. & II. Roma 1660. £ %e firft part of this general Hijlory of the Society of Jefus, brings down the affairs of their Mif/ions into Japan and other parts of Afia, from the firft Voyage to the Indies of S. Fr. Xavier, whither he fet out in 1 540 to the year 1569. The fecondis wholly confined to the Church of Japan, giving a general and compleat Hijlory thereof from the year 1569, through the reigns of the Japanefe Emperors Nobunanga, Taicofama, Daifulama, or as he was alfo called Ongofchiofama, and Xongun(ama, to its final abolition under the reign of Toxungoiama in the year 1 540, when the Portugueze alfo were expelled the Country. Hiftoire de l'Egliie du Japon, par M. 1' Abb6 de T. Paris 16% 9, 4to. z Vols. This is the Hijlory of the Church of Japan of F. Solier, put into better French, enlarged fro?n federal other Memoirs, and con- tinued to the death of the Emperor Toxogunfama, which happened in 1658. It was wrote by F. CraiTet a Jefuit, whofe name was prefixed to the fecond Edition. An Englijh Tranjjation, by an unknown Hand, was printed at London 1707, in z Vols. ^.to. Dutch Wri- T^ e Dutch hawing not only ufed the trade to Japan as early as the year 1609, but having enjoy d it exclujive of all European Nations ever jmce 1 640, it is but natural to expehl more ample and fatisfaclory accounts from their Writers, whom I proceed now to take into consideration. John Hughes Linfchooten (Linfcotanus) is the firjl I meet with. He was a native of Enkhuyfen, and went into the Indies with Vincent Fonfeca, Archlijhop of Goa, in 1585, jome time before the ejfablijh- went of the Dutch Eajl India Company, It would be foreign to my pur- pofe to mention all the differing editions and tranjlations of his Travels, I will only obferve, that they make out the fecond, third, and fourth parts of de Bry's India Orientalis, and that B. Paludanus, a noted Phyjician at Enkhuyfen, hath added fome remarks, particularly on thofe things which relate to Natural Hijlory. His account of Japan, which is but jhort, and not without conjiderable mijlakes, goes no farther, than the informations, the Portugueze at Goa, were then able, or wil- ling to give him. In ters. INTRODUCTION. xlj In another work, entituled Le Grand Routier de Mer, which is by fome likewife afcribed to Linfchooten, there are many curious, and doubt- lefs then very ufeful, obfervations, relating as well to the Navigation to the Indies in general, as in particular to that of Japan, to wit, An Account of a Voyage from Liampon in China to Japan, with a defcrip- tion of the Coajls of Bxxngo, Miaco, Cacay, and the IJland T oca. : The Courfefrom Lampacon in China to Japan, and the IJland Firando : The Voyage of a Portuguese Pilot from Macao to Japan, and the Province Bungo : Another defcription of the Courfe from Macao along the Coajls of China to the IJland of Firando, and the harbour of Umbra (Omura) in Japan : A Voyage from Macao to Japan, -the IJland Cabexuma, and the harbour of Languefaque (Nagafaki) : The Voyage of Francis Pays, a Portuguese from Macao to Japan, in 1585: Directions how to difcover Meaxume. and how to enter the harbour of Nagasaki : Se- veral Voyages from Nagasaki to Macao in 1 5 8 4, 1585, and 1586: A Voyage from Firando to Macao. The account of Japan by Francis Caron, who was DirecJor of the Dutch Trade there , is in proportion to its Jhortnefs, beyond quejlion one of the bejl extant, though not altogether without mijlakes. It was writ- ten originally in Low Dutch, by way of anfwer to fever al quejlions pro- pofed to him by M. Lucas, then DireBor General of the Dutch Eajl India Company. It was afterwards tranflated into mojl European Languages. The Englijh tranflation, by Capt. Roger Manley, was printed at London 1 66 3 , $vo. Some account of this authors life and charaBer hath al- been already given by Dr. Karmpfer, p. 357 of this Hijlory. Henry Hagenaer, who had made a Voyage to Japan himfelf, made fome addi- tions to this account, which M. Caron, upon his return into Europe publickly difavow'd, and communicated a true copy of his work to Mel- chizedec Thevenot, who tranflated and publijhed it, with a port Pre- face } in the firjl Volume of his Relations de divers Voyages curieux, qui n'onc point ete publiez. The following pieces, as relating to the fame fubjeU, are extant with mojl editions of F. Caron'j Hijlory of Ja- pan, i. The remarks of Hagenaer. 2. An Account of thofe, who fuffered for the faith of Chrifi from 162.1 to 16x9, by Reyer Giis- bertz, {of which above.) 3. A defcription of the pompous reception of the fecular Monarch of Japan at Miaco, on the z$tb of OBober i6z6, when that Prince went to fee the Dairi, or Ecclefiajlical Hereditary Ejnpe- 1 rot\ xlij INTRODU CTION. ror. Written by Conrad Crammer, then the Dutch Eajl India Compa- ny s Amhaffador to the Emperors Court, and himfelf prefent at this So- lemnity. 4. A Letter from the DireUor General of the Dutch Eafi India Company to the Directors thereof in Europe, touching the trade to 'japan. 5 . A Jhort account of the vajl profit and advantages, the Dutch Eajl India Company would acquire, if they were poffefsd of the trade to China, by Leonart Camps. In the High Dutch Tra?iflation , which was printed at Numberg 1663, 8vo. there have been farther added \ 1 . A Map of the Empire of Japan , wherein it is represented as con- tiguous to J effo. z. Some additional remarks of John James Mercklin, relating chiefly to the affairs of the Dutch after M. Caron'/ time, and in particular to the hardships they were obliged to undergo after the expulfion of the Portugueze. 3. The Travels of the faid Mercklin, who ferved the Dutch Eajl India Company in quality of Surgeon from \G\^to\6^, and was himfelf for fome time in Japan. The account of M. Caron was again reprinted, from Thevenot'.* edi- dition, in the third Volume of the Recueil de Voyages au Nord, print- ed at Amjlerdam 171$, 8vo. and the following pieces added: 1. A Letter of M. de 1'Ifle, touching the queflion, Whether or no Japan be an IJland ? (This quejlion hath been amply difcufed at the beginning of this Introduction.) z. An account of the difcovery of the Country of Jeffo, or Efo, Jituated to the North of Japan, which was made by the Ship Cajlrecoom in 164.5. 3- The Map of Japan, publijhedby M. Re- land, contr ailed. 4. A defcription of the Eajlem Tartary, by F. Mar- tini, wherein, among other Provinces, fome account hath been given of the Country of Jefo. 5 . Some obfervations relating to the original defcent of the Japanefe. 6. Some memoirs touching the ejlablijhment of a Trade to Japan. Written, by order of M. Colbert, by M. Caron. To- gether with a copy of the Inflru&ions to be given to the faid M. Caron, who was to be fent in quality of Amhaffador from the King of France to the Emperors of China and Japan, and the Kings Letters to thefe two Monarchs, which are dated in the z^th year of his reign, that is, \66-j. (Dr. Karmpfer, p. 357 of this Hiflory, hath given the rea- fons, for which M. Caron did not only quit the Service of the Dutch Eajl India Company, but betray one of the mojl valuable branches of their commerce, as the trade to Japan then was, to other powers.) 7. The orders of the Emperor of Japan, touching the exclujion of the Portu- guese INTRODUCTION. xliij gueze from his dominions for ever. 8. An account of what happened at Formofa, when as jet in the hands of the Dutch Eaft-India Com- pany, between Peter Nuyts, Governor of that I/land, and fome Ja- panefe, who had been unjuftly detained by him. (This account differs in fome things from that given by Dr. Kampfer, p. $6 of the Appen- dix to this Hijiory.) p. An Hiftorical account of the fudden demoli- tion of the Dutch Eaft-India Company s new built Warehoufe at Fi- i rando in 164.0. Defcriptio Regni Japonic, cum quibufdam affinis materia, ex variis Autoribus colledla, & in ordinem redacla, per Bern* hardum Varenium, M. D. Amftelodami 1619, nmo. This is only an abridgment of the moft material things the Author met with in fever al of the above-mentioned writers, and particularly in Marco Polo, the Letters of the Jefmts, Linfchooten, Giisbertz, and Caron, reduced under certain heads. The memorable Embajfies of the Dutch to the Emperors of Japan, wherewith Ijhall conclude this lift of the Dutch writers, were written originally in Low Dutch by Arnoldus Montanus, and publiflod at Amfterdam 166 9, fol. They were foon after translated into Englifh, and publijhed by John Ogilby, by the following Title : Atlas Japan- nenfis ; being remarkable Addrefles, by way of EmbafTy, from the Eaft-India Company of the United Provinces to the Empe- ror of Japan, containing a defcription of their feveral Territo- ries, Cities, Temples and FortrefTes ; their Religions, Laws and Cuftcms ; their prodigious Wealth and gorgeous Habits ; the nature of their Soil, Plants, Beafts, Hills, Rivers and Foun- tains, with the Character of the ancient and modern Japanners. Colle&ed out of their feveral Writings and Journals by Arnol- dus Montanus. Englifhed and adorned with above a hundred feveral Sculptures, by John Ogilby, Efq;. London 1670, fol. The French Edition was publijhed at Amfterdam 16^80, fol. with fome additions and alterations. The fame Cuts ferved for the three Edi- tion. This work doth by no means anfwer, neither the ezpence beftowed on the imprejfwn, nor the promifes made in the very Title-page, nor doth it deferve the favourable reception it hath met with. It is full of large digrejfions, often altogether foreign to the purpofe, and although it was pretended to have been colle&ed from the Journals and Memoirs of the Am* xliv INTRODUCTION. Ambajfadors themfelves, yet, I believe, it will be found, upon perufal, that if it was cleared, of what the Author hath barely, and without any order, tranfcribed from the Letters of the Jefuits, and mofi of thofe other writers mentioned in the preceding Catalogue, the reft would be re- duced to a few Sheets. But what is moft material, moft of the Cuts, which are the greateft embellifhments, and, as it were, the Soul of per- formances of this kind, do greatly deviate from truth, reprefenting things not as they were, but as the Fainter fancied them to be. For as to the de- Jcriptive part, it muft be owned, that the Author hath laid the publick under fome obligations, by bringing together into one Volume, what could then be faid on the fubjecl, and was difperfed in many. Trade of the Befides the Fort ugueze and Dutch, the Englifh alfo were once pof- Japan and feffed of the Trade to Japan, though they loft it again in a few years, fomeoftheir _ . - , ,— . . n r _. " Writers. for what reajons is not known. 1 beir tactory was Jet up at rirando, under the care of Ca.pt. John Saris, who went to Japan by the way of the Molucca'/, in the Clove, one of the three Ships (the Hecror, the Thomas, and the Clove) fitted out by the Eaft-India Company in 1 6 1 1 , for their eighth voyage to the Indies. Capt. Saris upon his ar* rival in Japan, which was in June 1 6 1 3 , repaired forthwith to the Court of the Emperor Ongofchiofama, who then rtfided at Surunga, and was admitted to an audience of that Monarch on the 8 th of Sep- tember, of whom he obtained ample privileges, very honourable to the Britifh Nation, whofe fame had already reached thefe remote parts of the world, and exceedingly advantageous to the Ea ft -India Company, one of which, and certainly not the leaft conjiderable, was, that they fhould have leave to fet out upon difcovery of the Country of Jed ib, or any other part in or about the Empire of Japan, a privilege, which the Portugueze, even at the time of their higheft intereft with the Japanefe, were not able to procure on any terms whatever. The good fuccefs Capt. Saris met with in his Negotiations at the Impe- rial Court, was owing, in great meafure, to the ajfiftance of one Wil- liam Adams, a Kentijh man, who had been formerly in the fer vice of the Dutch, and was chief Pilot to a fleet of five Sails fent to the Eafi* Indies, through the Streights of Magellan, under the Command of Jaques Mahay, in 1598. The event of this voyage, the ftranding of the Ship, on board which Adams was, upon the Coafts of Bungo, and his adventures in Japan, where he got into great favour with the Emperor, INTRODUCTION. xlv Emperor, may be feen at large in Purchafe his Pilgrims, (Vol. I. p. 1 16) as fit forth by himfelfin two Letters written from Japan, one of which is dated O&ober iz, 1^11. The fame Author hath given us (p. 3 3 4> <&* f e( l- °f the firfl Volume of his Pilgrims) not only a ge- neral account of the afore/aid eighth voyage, made by order, and for the Eafl'lndia Company, but likewife a more particular narrative of the voyage of Capt. Saris to Japan, of his journey to the Court of the Ja- paneje Emperor, and his tranfa&ions there, together with the obferva- tions he made during his flay in Japan, and the fettlement of a Fa&ory at Firando, the whole out of his own Journals. Upon the departure of Capt. Saris for Europe, one Richard Cocks, a Merchant, was left at Firando, with eight Englijhmen, three Interpreters and two Servants. Several Letters of this Richard Cocks, and others, have been printed by Purchafe (p. 595, & fey. of the faidfirft Volume of his Pilgrims.) wherein an account is given of what paffed at Firando after Capt. Saris was gone to the Emperor s Court, as alfo of later occurrencies there after his departure for England, from the year 1 6 1 4 to 1 6 z o . There is nothing elfe in Purchafe relating to Japan, but ajhort Letter of one Arthur Hatch, a Minifler, then lately returned from thence, dated at Wingham in Kent, Nov. 15. 162.3, wherein there are feveral very pertinent remarks on the Government of the Japanefe Empire, and the fiate of affairs at that time. There was likewife a fhort account of Japan printed in Swedifh (Wiifingsborgh 1667* ¥0) by Oloff Erichfon Witlman, together with the voyages of Nils Matfon into Afia and Africa, the voyage of thefaid Willman to the Eafl-Indies, China and Japan, and an account of a journey through Mufcovy into China. The Natural Hiflory of Japan, and the State of Phyfick in that Country, have never been profeffedly treated of by any writer. Bejides what lating to the Dr. Kdempfer hath done himfelf, and which I have already touched upon ftory of Ja- in my account of his Life, and in fome parts of this Introduclion, the following performances of Cleyer and Ten Rhyne, are the only one tending this way, that came to my Knowledge. Specimen Medians Sinicae, five Opufcula Medica ad men- tern Sinenfium ; continens, I. De Pulfibus Libros quatuor e Sini- co tranflatos. II. Tra&atus de pulfibus ab erudito Europaeo col- ledos. III. Fragmentum Operis Medici ibidem ab erudito Eu- m • ropaeo Writers re- pan. xlvj INTRODUCTION. y ropaeo confcripti. IV. Excerpta Literis eruditi Europsei in Chi- na. V. Schemata ad meliorem praxedentium intcliegentiam. VI. De Indiciis morborum ex Linguae coloribus &; affectionibus. Cum Figuris ameis & ligneis. Edidit Andreas Cleyer, Haflb- CafTelanus. IV M. Licentiatus, Soc. Ind. in Nova Batavia Ar~ chiater, Pharmacop. Director & Chirurg. Ephorus. Franco forti 1682, 4to. This curious work, though it relates properly Jpeaking to the Phyjick of the Chineje, yet it deferves to be referrd to Japan, as the State of Phyjick is nearly the fame in that Country as it is in Chi- na. The Figures alfo agree in great meafure, with thofe of an Ana* tomical Treatife of the Japanefe, now in the hands of Sir Hans Sloane. Excerpta ex obfervationibus Japonicis, Phyficis, Sec. Wil- helmi Ten Rhyne, De Frutice Thee. This curious account of the Tea was printed by Jacobus Breynius his in Centuria prima Ex- oticarum aliarumque minus cognitarum Plantarum. Gedani 1678. fol. The fame Author hath alfo given us (p. z. of his Cen- turia) an Account of the Camphire Tree growing in Japan, chiefly from the obfervations of the faid Ten Rhyne, who fent him a Branch of it. (Ten Rhyne in the Title to the Excerpta abovemen* tioned, is wrongly called Phyfician, Botanift and Chymiftto the Emperor of Japan, where he was only, like Dr. Kdempfer, Phyfician to the Dutch Fatlory and Embaffy. Wilhelmi ten Rhyne, M. D. Diflertatio de Arthritide : Man- tilla lchematica de acupun&ura, & Orationes tres I. De Chymiae ac Botaniae antiquitate & dignitate. II. De Phyfiognomia. III. De Monftris fingula ipfius autoris notis illuftrata. Londini, 1683. This differtation of the Gout was written chiefly with regard to the cure of this diflemper by the Moxa, which had been very much re- commended by Hermannus Bufhovius, a Minifier of the Gofpel at Batavia. To the MantilTa Schematica have been added three Schemes, /hewing what parts of the human body are to be burnt with the Moxa, according to the Chinefe and Japanefe, and likewije a fi- gure of the needle, which the Japaneje make ufe of in the Acupun- dura. Writcis re- As to the Language of the Japanefe, the knowledge whereof onejhould Language of ha contracted in Tab. XXX of this Hifiory. * A ground'plot of Miaco, the Refidence of the Ecclejiafiical He- reditary Monarch, five Feet and a half long, and four Feet broad, con- tracled in Tab. XXVII of this Hifiory. * A Map of the Town of Nagafaki, and the neighbouring Country, four Feet eleven Inches long, and two Feet two Inches broad, contracted in Tab. XIX. * A Ground'plot of the Town of Ofacca, of three Feet in length, and two Feet eight Inches in breadth. * A particular Map of the Road from Nagafaki to Ofacca, with the reprefentations of the Rivers, Bridges, Towns, Caftles, Temples, an Opportunity offer'd for failing to Japan, s$*,^:a$,j$» on board a Dutch Ship, call'd De Waelfiroom, bound for that Country. I was offer'd the Place of Phyfician to the Embafiy, which the Company fends once a Year to the Japa- nefe Emperor's Court. It is now almoft a Century, fince this Empire hath been, as it were, fhut up and kept from all Commerce with foreign Na- tions, except the Dutch, who being look'd upon as the fincereft of all Foreigners, are for this Reafon admitted among them and tolerated, though under a very ftrid Infpeclion, and are allow'd this particular A Favour, The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book I. Favour, that their Refident may every Year appear at Court in order to pay their Refpeft to the Emperor. This is the only Opportunity at pre. fent, an European can have of going thither, and viewing the Majefty of that Court and Empire. Our Ship was bound firft to Siam, there to difpofe of Part of her Cargo, and to take in Goods of that Coun- try, whereby I had an Opportunity of feeing alfo this famous King, dom and its magnificent Court. Departure \ -^nt on Board on Sunday the Seventh of May 1690 early in the fromBatavia. Morning< We weig h'd Anchor the fame Day and fet Sail with a fmall, but favourable Breeze. About Noon we made the fmall Ifland Eidam, lying a few Leagues off Batavia, along which we coafted till late at Night, when we loft fight of it. On Monday the Eighth we loft Sight of the high Land of Java, but not of the neighbouring Iflands. We were becalm'd in the Afternoon and advancing but (lowly, caft Anchor in Twenty nine Fathoms, left the Currents, which run here very ftrongly, fhould carry us too much out of our Courfe. About half a League off us we faw a fmall Por- tuguefe VefTel at Anchor, with Chinefe Sailors on board, which fet £ p«nl. Sail from Batavia two days before. She was call'd the St. Paul, and had the Image of this Apoftle painted upon her Stern. She had been in Japan about five Years ago, notwithftanding that by order of the Japanefe Emperor all Portuguefe whatever are forbid entring his Do- minions under Pain of Drath and Forfeiture of their Ships and Goods. I flatter myfelf the Reader will not be difpleas'd to be inform'd of the Occafion and Event of this Voyage, which I particularly enquired into at Batavia, the rather fince it bears a near relation to the main Sub- ject of this Hiftory. About fix Years ago, a Japanefe VefTel was forc'd away, in a violent Storm, from the Coafts of Japan towards China, and having fuffer'd many Incommodities, was at laft wreck'd near Macao, a famous tra- ding Town in China, belonging to the Portuguefe. The Portuguefe Go- vernment at Macao thought this an excellent Opportunity, to recom- mend themfelves to the Japanefe Emperor, and perhaps, which they had more at heart, to recover their former advantageous Trade. For this reafon it was refolv'd to relieve the twelve Japanefe, whofe Lives had been fav'd, to treat them with kindnefs and civility, and gene- roufly to fend them back to Japan on board one of their own Ships. But the Event fell far fhort from anfwering their Expectation ^ for when they got into the Harbour of Nangafaki, all the Japanefe with- out exception were committed to Prifon, and the Portuguefe VefTel ftrictly guarded, without permitting any Body to fet foot on fhore, till the Governors of Nangafaki could give an Account of this nice Affair to the Imperial Court at Jedo, and Orders fent from thence as to their further Conduct. The Portuguefe were like to be put to Death and to have their Ship burnt, purfuant to the ftanding Imperial' Chap. I. The Hiftory of J A P A N. Imperial Orders on this head-, but the Severity of the Court being fomewhat allay'd, partly by length of time, partly by the intercefllon of Mr. Buteman, then Refident of the Dutch Eaft-India Company, they at laft, in confideration of their good Intention, obtain'd leave to return to Macao, and Provifions were offer'd them confiding chiefly in Rice and Water. The unhappy Japanefe, after a rude Imprifonment of two years, were fet at Liberty, and under a ftricl: Guard fent to their na- tive Towns. One of our Refidents, upon his return from Jedo to Nan- gafaki, met fome upon the road. Thus this Voyage ended without the leaft advantage to the City of Macao. But to proceed on our own Voyage. We weigh'd anchor after midnight, and on the Ninth in the Morn- ing made the Thoufand Iflands, as they are here call'd. We were in Sight of the high Land Lampon, in Sumatra oppofite to Bantam. We faw likewife the Weftern Mountains both of Java and Sumatra^ and particularly one in Sumatra, remarkable for its height, which to our gre3t Grief we had had fo long in Sight, fome Months before in our Voyage from Atfjn to Batavia. The Wind was variable, moft- ly S. We were almoft becalm'd in the afternoon, and could not make the Ifland Norderveachten, that is Northern Guard, before Evening. Af- ter Sunfet a frefh favourable Gale fprung up. It was cloudy all the Tenth. The Wind E. S. E. We fteer'd North out of fight of Land or Iflands, excepting fome few of the higheft Mountains in Sumatra, the tops of which we perceiv'd indiftin&ly through the Clouds. We call Anchor late at Night in fix Fathoms, to avoid running againft Land in the Night, which was feen from the great Maft the evening before, and fuppos'd to be the Ifland Lucipara 9 lying at the mouth of the Strait of Banca. On the Eleventh of May we weigh'd anchor early in the- morn- ing, but a Calm enfuing forc'd us to drop it again, and to lie by for fome hours. About two hours after Sun rifing, a brisk Gale fprung up at S. and we fteer'd North between Land, which we faw lafl evening, and found to be the Ifland Lucipara, and the Coafts of Su- matra towards the Straits of Banca. Before I proceed further, I cannot forbear obferving in general that nyagefrm the Voyage from Batavia to Siam is attended with no fmall difficul- B***»» w,sj " ties and dangers, becaufe of the many fmall low Iflands, Rocks, * Shoals and Sands. A careful and prudent Pilot muft always keep at a due diftance from Land, that is, neither too near it, nor too far off, that in cafe of ftrong ftormy Winds and Turnado*s, which frequently and unawares arife in this Paflage, he may have an opportunity of coming to an anchor, and by this means preferve the Ship from run- ning a-ground, or from being caft away too far out of her Courfe. For this Reafon Ships commonly lie at anchor over night, the rather if Land was feen the day before, or fome Signs appear'd of its be- ing, 4 The Hijlory oj J A P A N. Book T. /'. ing near. The moil, .dangerous Paffage becaufe of its Narrownefs, Shoals and Rocks, are the Straits of Banca, form'd by an Ifland of this name, and the Coafts of Sftmatra. The Coafts of Sumatra all alonT; the Straits are low, without Hills or Mountains, but well ft r'd with Woods. Banca, on the contrary, is ragged and broken with high Hills and Mountains infome Parts, and low verdant ground in others. It fcems in the main to be a very fruitful Ifland.' All the Ships bound for the Eaflern Coafts of Malacca, for Siam, Cam- 'bod'ni, (^>cMnc%ina 3 China and Japan, pafs thefe Straits. The Coafts of Sumatra, oppefite .to Banca, have two or three remarkable Points running out into the Straits. We got within half a League of the faid Coafts, .becaufe there is a good foft Clay at the bottom and eve'i gr.rn,d in. fix Fathoms Water and more. We made the fecond 'Point cf the Coafts of Sumatra before Sun fet, and lay by againft the •next morning. On the. twelfth of ./May we weigh'd anchor before Sun rifing^ and this morning got as far as the third and furthermoft Point of the Coafts q£ Sumatra. The. St. Paul (of which above) which was hither- to far a-ftern of us, was .now got confiderably a-head us. We fteer'd along the Coafts to N. N. W. The Sky was thick and cloudy, the Wind' variable, moftly S. The Coafts of Sumatra and Banca appear- ed much as yefterday. In the Afternoon the Wind turn'd contrary, which made us take in part of our Sails, and tack about for a while. On. the. Thirteenth of i$g)F > n the Evening, we got fafe to the End of the Straits, between the Mouth of the River Palimbang on our Larboard, and a very -high Rock call'd Monapin, upon the ex- tremity of Banca to the Starboard. The Mouth of the River Palim- PdlmhM & bang, which was about three quarters of a League diftant, feem'd to be at. leaft half a League broad. We could fee no Land beyond it, whither for its extent, or becaufe cf the dusk of the evening. We made 'the. bed of our way towards the faid Mouth, and the Coafts of Sumatra in .feven fathoms and a half, to avoid a dangerous Rock, call'd Freckric Henry, which lies hereabouts, and upon which a Dutch r^Roct"' Shi P call ' d ?rince WiU ' ulm i bound for Siaw > unfortunately ftranded, fome Years ago, but the Captain and Crew fav'd themfelves in the Boat. The Wind proving favourable, and we being paft the Straits of Banca, we faiPd all night. On the Fourteenth of May in the morning, we came in fight of the Iflands Poele Tsju, that is the Seven Iflands, otherwife the Seven op tbnu r '~ ombm. We directed our Courfe fo as to leave the faid Iflands to the Starboard. It was clear and cool, and a good favourable Gale all Day long. We loft fight of the Coafts of Sumatra, and in the Eve- />«/; Saya. ning made the Ifland Pull Saya. We Chap. I, The Hiftory o/JAPAN. $ We advanc'd confiderably all Night, and on the Fifteenth in the Morning left Puli Soya fo far a-ftern that we could fcarce per- f» !i fy"' ceive the Top of one of its Mountains, remarkable for its great height. About Noon we made Puli Lingan, and crofs'd fafely the y£qui- noclial Line. It now clear'd up, having rain'd pretty hard the Night before. We were almoft becalm'd in the Afternoon advancing but little-, about four we had a ftrong Turnado, the Wind blew hard out of N. W. We run with incredible Swiftnefs in thefe dangerous Seas for about two Hours, when the Wind ceafing we came to an Anchor, having been call pretty much out of our Courfe. We fet fail again on the Sixteenth in the Morning, with low vari- able Wind, and clear Weather, after a rainy Night. We advanc'd but moderately, and could not get out of fight of Puli Lingan till Eve- ning, when we caft Anchor. On the Seventeenth of May we weigh'd Anchor two Hours before Sun-rife : We fteer'd N. W. but faw no Land all Day long : The Cur- rents carried us with great Violence N. and N. N. E. It blowing but little, we came to an Anchor towards Evening in Thirty Four Fa- thoms, and fet fail again about Ten at Night. The Wind was variable all the Eighteenth, and fometimes it blew hard. We fteer'd to N. W. without Sight of Land, and refolv'd to pafs by Puli Timon, where puffuant to the Company's Inftruftions our Ships commonly put in for Wood and Water, and with thefe favoura- ble Southerly Winds, to proceed dire&ly North for Siam. We were under Sail all Night, and on the Ninteenth in the Morning, perceiving the Top of a Mountain on our Larboard Side, we hop'd 'twould be the Ifland Ptdi Thingi, and therefore flood in directly for Puli ?*»»#• it. We were not difappointed in our Hopes, and in the Afternoon got Sight of Puli Aur y or Puli Oor, and foon after of Puli Pifang. Puli Oor. On the Twentieth of May about Eight in the Morning, we came to an Anchor before the Ifland Puli Timon, bearing N. E. to E. I PitliTiman, went on Shore with fome others, partly to view the Situation of the faid Ifland, partly to obferve what Plants and other Natural Things it produces, which hath been in all my Travels one of my chief Cares and Ainufements. Puli Timon is one of the largeft Illands fituate near the Eaftern Coafts of Malacca. It is fubjedt to the King of Johof, who refides at Siperka upon the Continent of Malacca. He governs it by Two Qrang Kay's, one on each fide of the Ifland. Orang Kay in the Ma- layan Language, fignifies a Woodman, or a Man entrufted with the Care and Infpettion of Woods and Forefts. The Inhabitants are a fort of Banditto's, who have been poffefs'd of this Ifland a confiderable Time, and are of late grown fo numerous, that fome Years ago one of their Orang Kay\ who came on board one of our Ships, boafted they were no lefs than Two Thoufand in Number, tho' perhaps not half. B They The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. They live feparate from each other in poor fmall Cottages, confifling only of one fingle Room, with a fmall Window and a Door to come in. Thefe Huts are not above five or fix Paces long, and two or three broad. All the Furniture within, confifts in a Bench round the room, to fit, or lye upon ^ without, there are fome few Pinang Trees : For although the Wand confifls of fcarce any thing but rocky Precipices, yet they choofe for their Habitations fuch Places, where they can have a little flat ground round their Cottages, on purpofe to plant fome Pinang and other Trees. The Inhabitants are lively enough, and not ill fhaped. They are fomewhat blacker than the Javans, as they live alfo nearer the ^Equinoctial Line, fome of them feem'd to me to be of a very unhealthy Complexion. They pluck out the Hairs of their Beards, as do alfo the Inhabitants of Malacca and Sumatra, which makes them both look like ugly old Women. They are all Mahome- thans, this Religion having fpread almoft all over the Eafl. Their Ha- bit confifts in a Piece of coarfe Cloath, made of the Bark of a Tree, which they wear about the Wafte. They wear a piece of the fame Cloath, twilled in form of a Garland, about their Heads j fome wear Hats of G abbe Gab be Leaves. Gabbe Gab be is a common Tree all over the Eaft- Indies, and not unlike the Palm Tree. The Indians make their Saga of it, which they eat inftead of Bread. The Inhabitants came on board our Ship in fmall Boats jufl big enough to hold each a Man, and withall fo light, that one Man can eafily hawl them on Shore. The Man fits in the mid- dle his Goods laid behind him : The Oars are above a Man's Length, and fo fhap'd that the Man holding them in the middle rows with both ends on either fide of the Boat. They have alfo larger Boats, • which will hold conveniently four People, and with thefe they ven- ture as far as the Coafts of Malacca. They brought us exceeding large Mango's, bigger than ever I faw them j Pi fangs (Indian Figs) likewife of an uncommon Size, about a Span and a half in Length and a Span in their angular Circumference, very large Simrfacks, Pine Apples, fmalL Lemons, Fowl, and a very particular fort of Rams, of a rediih colour, with long Hairs and a large Tusk on each Side. They brought nothing of their Manufactures on board but Bags of Pifang neatly enough twilled, and fmall Mats of the fame Subihnce, as alfo of Gabbe Gabbe Leaves, likewife very artfully wrought. They would take no Money for their Commodities , but Linnen, Shirts, Rice, Iron, and other Bawbles were very acceptable to them. They feem to have no Knowledge at all in Money, for having fhew'd them fome Pieces, they would ask for a fmall Mat ten times its Value. On the contrary, for a fmall Piece of courfe Linnen, perhaps not worth three Farthings, they would readily exchange Victuals to the Value of two or three Shillings. The whole Ifland, as I have already obferv'd is fcarce any thing elfe but a heap of Stones, Rocks, and fleep high Mountains, and yet, what appear'd to. me remarkable, their barren Tops, where per- haps Chap. I. The Hiflory of JAPAN. 7 haps one fhould be at a Lofs to find two or three Inches of Ground, were cover'd with Trees and Bufhes. We climb'd up the rocky Shores to look for the watering Places, not- without feme difficult- and dan- ger, by the Help of the Roots of Trees, which grow up towards the Top, and which running down to the Ground ten, twenty, or more Fathoms, ferv'd us inftead of Ropes to catch hold at. Between the Heaps and Ruins, for fo may I well call them, you meet very fre- quently with fmall Lakes, or Ponds of fweet Water, which is in fome Places fo cold, that having taken the Diverfion of wafhing my felf, I was very much indifpos'd for fome Days after. One River we met was large enough to drive a couple of Mills, and it came down from the Tops of the Mountains, running over the Rocks and Stones with fo much rapidity and roaring, that {landing by we could fcarce hear one another fpeak. The Water was clear, cool, and feem'd to me to tafte fomewhat bitter. I had not leifure enough to make what Ob- fervations I wiih I cou'd have made upon the Plants of this Ifland*. I obferv'd in general that there grow many of thofe, which I found upon the Ifland Eidam, fome few Leagues diftant from Batavia^ and have defcrib'd amongft the plants of that Ifland. Along the Shores I took notice of the following Trees and Shrubs. Terum Lank, a middle fiz'd Shrub, with oblong leaves, two or three T^um Lmh Inches long, an inch and a half broad, almoft opaque, with a ftrong nerve running irregularly acrofs the middle. The Flower was Yellow, pentapetalous or confifting of five petala, difpos'd in form of a Star. The feed was exceedingly beautiful, all green and like a Star of Se- ven rays. There were three, four or five of thefe Starry Seeds grew Clofe to one another, which altogether made a very handfom fi- gure. Prija-Laitt, is a Shrub which bears a berry fomewhat larger than p rVa , L69 . our Juniper berries, green and of a fleihy fubftance. The leaves are ferrated. I obferv'd the very fame plant in Perjia about Gamron or Banderabajfi, and have figur'd and defcrib'd it at large amongft my Perfian plants. Maanbn. A pretty large Tree with feveral obtufe tender leaves, foft m»«»'k. to the touch, without a nerve in the middle, flicking together at the end of the branches. I obferv'd the fame tree at Eidam, but had not then the good luck to meet with the flowers and fruit, which I faw here in full perfection. The flower is fomewhat particular. It con- fifts of 5 petala, all on one fide difpos'd in form of a Semi Circle, or half moon. Oppofite to the flower leaves is a bent ftylus Handing upwards with a fmall round green head at the top. To the flowers fucceed five berries of a flefhy Sub-fiance. Papi?iiok y hath a white flower not unlike the flower of beans, which n . . , family it comes nearefl with regard to the leaves, there being three fet to 8 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book L to each Stalk, the middlemoft whereof is longer and larger than the two others, which ftand oppofite to one another. Another Tree, whofe name I could not learn, had large, ten- der, roundifh leaves, not unlike the leaves of the Filberd-tree, but twice, or thrice as big with many irregular nerves running lengthways and tranfverfely. The flower was Compos'd of an uncertain" number of pctala, commonly 7 or 9. The fruit was an Apple, hot unlike the apples, of which the old Women at Batavia make a particular Oint- ment, to anoint and fmooth the fkins of Children after the Mealies, of which 1 have elfewhere given fome account. tint int. Amongft the Plants there was particularly remarkable for its un- common beauty a flefh colour'd Iris with yellow Streakes, and a thorny fruit much of the bignefs and fhape of a Nutmeg, and di- vided into three Cells, in each of which were lodg'd four round white feeds about as big as Peafe. All the Ships bound from Batavia to Siam have inftru&ion from the Company to put in, if poflible, at Puli Timon for wood and water, this Ifland being very commodioufly feated for this purpofe, about half way from Batavia. I was told, and it is not improbable, that there is but little difference between Puli Timon, and Puli-Qor, as to the fituation, nature of the place and way of life of the Inhabitants. Up- on our arrival in the morning a Gun was fired to invite the Inha- bitants to trade with usj In the evening, after the Ship had taken in a good ftore of wood and water, the fame fignal was given for us, that went on Shore, to return on board. We fet fail after Supper with a brifk favourable gale. Puli Timon r which in the morning bearing N. E. by E. appear'd fmall and narrow, made now a much Llndfomer and larger appearance bearing E. N. E. about half a League diftant and feem'd to be about four Leagues long and two broad. On the Twenty firft of May in the morning we loft fight of Puli Timon and difcovered the high mountains of Malacca at a confiderable diftance a-head. We fleer'd to N. W. and N. W. by W. to draw obli- quely near Land, which we came in fight of before Sunfet, being the main continent of Malacca and fome fmall neighbouring Wands. We pafs'd the faid Iflands in the night, and got on the Twenty fecond of May in the morning within a good league of the Coaft of Malacca, along which we purfued our Courfe to the N. with a fine fa- vourable Land Breeze. The Coafts of Malacca feem'd to me to be not unlike the Coafts of Ceylon very much broken, and rocky near the Sea with fteep high mountains' up in the Country, otherwife green and full of Timber, and to all appearance very fruitful. The weather continuing fair and the wind favourable all day long, we made after Sunfet the two Iflands Puli Capas. We Chap I. The Hi(tory of J A P A N* We did not advance much on the Twenty third by reafon of calms, and contrary winds which obliged us to lay by the belt, part of the day. On the Twenty fourth of May we made the Mouth of a River, and a fmall village upon the Continent of Malacca, in Portuguefe Maps call'd Bufe. The Inhabitants, who are all Fifhermen, call'd it Tercbannu. Bu f'; The village feem'd to confift of about Fifty Houfes or Cottages, built along the Shore. A Portuguefe Ship, which, as we were told by the Inhabitants, came from Macao, lay there at anchor with her Co- lours flying. The Inhabitants fpeak both Siamifh and Malayan. Three cfthem came on board in one of their boats to fell us tifh-, and for a courfe Table-cloth we had as much fifh as Twenty hungry people could eat, and amongft others what they call Kings FiJJj, which is a Filh not unlike a Pike, and about three foot long, Korhiades call'd by the Dutch Horfe-beads, becaufe of their figure, red Steenbrajfems^ Salammets, and Jacobs En>ertzen. We were becalm'd in the afternoon, and caft anchor in fight of fome fmall Iflands call'd the Redans Re j ms j. IJlands. Some of the Ships Company diverted themfelves, as ufual,^<""k with fiihing, and one of them catch'd a very fine Starfifli with nine Curious Star- Rays. The main body held four Inches in Diameter, and each Ray was-^' near one fpan and a half long, fo that the Diameter of the whole Creature was three fpans at leaft. The upper furface was rough to the Touch, as it were full of fmall Scales. The thicknefs of the main body was two Inches reprefenting a feparate Star with nine lhort Rays rais'd above the fubftance of the body, in the Centre of which was a round hole, or mouth, pretty large and edged with two rows of fibres. The larger Rays were fquare in circumference, and of the thicknefs of a finger, ftreight, running into a point, of a white- tifh, pale colour, and mark'd on the upper furface -with Spots run- ning acrofs like Clouds, refembling thofe of a Tyger's fkin. Both fides of the upper part were lin'd up to the point with a row of prickles joyning very clofe and growing ftill clofer, as they run on to- wards the point. The under furface of this Creature was fomething fof- ter to the touch or of a white colour, and each Ray lin'd on each fide with a row of fmall feet like an Indian Millepes, or Fortyleg, which in moving confufedly together afforded an odd and diverting fight. In the main body was a cavity tolerably deep, from which Iflued a chan- nel along each Ray. The inward fubftance was white, hard and fo brittle that fome of the Rays broke in my hands, (fee Tab. i. Fig. i.) We had tolerable good weather on the twenty fifth, twenty fixth and Twenty feventh of May, fafe, that meeting every day with Turnado's which frequently arife in this paffage, we were obliged to lie by, till it blew over. The Coafts of Malacca feem'd to be all along well inhabited. On the twenty eighth of May, we made Cape Fat any, when the wind Ca t e PaU ~ turning of a fudden to N. W. by W. we tack'd about for a while advanc- es ing io The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book I. ing but little, and at laft caft anchor in fight of the faid Cape. We had feveral filhermen came on board, and fold us fifh for Linnen. A- mong the reft they brought us fome of thofe Animals, which our Sea- $ ca Cm. men call Sea Cats, and which are true Ichthyothuria having neither bones nor fibres like other fifh. We catch'd abundance of them in our voyage to Japan, whether I refer the Reader as to a more particu- lar defcription. It will not be impropef here to obferve, that Linnen is, what the Inhabitants of Malacca, as well on thefe as on the op- ppfite Coafts, towards the Straits of Malacca, and the Gulf of Ben- gale, as alfo the Inhabitants of the neighbouring Iflands, covet moft, and willingly exchange for the .product of the Country, victuals, and manufactures, to the great advantage of feafaring people. They are for the moft part fifiiermen and admirable Swimmers, as they alfo pafs the beft part of their Life at Sea. 1 was told by feveral of our Seamen, which had been that way, and were Eyewitnefles to the fad, that the K«oh* I- Inhabitants of the Kicobar Iflands, which lie in the Gulf of Bengate, f ani pel- J . _ (cjfon „f Bait- trefs of Bankok, the Key of the Kingdom, htuated on the great Ri- ^ ver Meinam fix Leagues from the Harbour. The French Sol- diers together with other troops rais'd in the Country were there put in Garrifon, and the place made ftronger by new fortifications. Thefe preparations being made, he enter'd into meafures with the French Ge- neral, and fome Mandarins, or officers of the Crown, whom he confid- ed in. Monpi Totfo, the King's Son in law, and by him adopted, a de- pendant of his and the french, was to be placed on the throne, afToon as the fick King mould be dead, whofe encreafing dropfy threatned him with a fudden diffolution. Petraatia and his Sons, the King's two brothers, as prefumptive heirs to the Crown, and whoever elfe was like to oppofe the Confpirator's defigns, were to be difpatch'd out of the way. Purfuant to this Scheme Monpfs Father, and relations, had alrea- dy rais'd fourteen thoufand Men, who lay difpers'd through the Coun- try and the better to facilitate the execution of this defign, Faulcon perfuaded the fick King, having found means to introduce himfelf in- to his apartment in private, that it would be very much for the Se- curity of his perfon during the ill flate of his health, to fend for the French General, and part of his Garrifon, up to Livo, where the King then was, being a City fifteen Leagues North of Judia, and the ufual place of the King's refidence, where he ufed to fpend moft part of his time. General des Fargues being on his way thither, the rtcyJifcoler- Confpiracy was difcover'd by Petraatia's own Son, who happening to «/. be with two of the King's Concubines in an apartment adjoyning to that where the Confpirators were, had the curiofity to Men at the door, and having heard the bloody refolution they had taken, immediately repair'd to his Father to tell him of it. Petraatia without lofs of time acquainted the King with this Confpiracy, and then fent for Monpi, It^Sfat F au k° n an ^ the Mandarines of their party, as alfo for the Captain of tors imprifon- the Guards to Court, and caufed the Criminals forthwith to be put in Irons notwithflanding the King exprefs'd the greateft difpleafure, at his fo doing. Faulcon had for fome time abfented himfelf from Court, but now being fummon'd he could no longer excufe himfelf, though dreading fome ill event, 'tis faid, he took his leave from his family in a very melancholy manner. Soon after his Silver Chair, wherein he was ufually carried, came back empty, a bad omen to his friends and domefticks, who could not but prepare themfelves to partake in their matter's misfortune. This happened the nineteenth of May in the year Miw/>i he- 1689. Two days after Petraatia order'd againft the King's will Monpi's itadcd. head to be ftruck off, throwing it at Faitlcon's feet, then loaded with Irons, with this reproach, See there is your King, The unfortunate fick Chap. II The Hiftory of JAPAN. 21 fick King heartily forry for the untimely end of his deareft Mompi, earneftly defired, that the deceafed's body might not be expofed to any further fhame, but decently buried, which was accordingly complied with. Monpis Father was feiz'd by a Stratagem upon his eftate between Judia and Livo, and all their adherents were difpers'd. Faulcon, af- Fiiu j cgn ', ter having been tortur'd and flarv'd for fourteen days, and «"«'<">. thereby almoft reduc'd to a fkeleton, had at lafl; his Irons taken off, and was carried away after Sunfet, in an ordinary chair, un- knowing what would be his fate. He was firfl carried to his Houfe, which he found rifled : His Wife lay prifoner in the Stable, who far from taking leave of him fpit in his face, and would not fo much as fuffer him to kifs his only remaining Son of four years of age, a- nother Son being lately dead and ftill unburied. From thence he was carried out of Town to the place of execution, where notwithftanding all his reluctancy he had his head cut off: His Body was divided into two parts and cover'd with a little earth, which the Dogs fcratch'd a- way in the night time, and devoured the Corpfe to the Bones. Before he died, he took his Seal, two filver CrofTes, a relick fet in gold, which he wore on his breaft, being a prefent from the Pope, as alfo the order of St. Michael, which was fent him by the King of France, and deliver'd them to a Mandarin, who flood by, defiring him to give them to his little Son. Prefents indeed, that could be of no great ufe to the poor Child, who to this day with his Mother goes begging from door to door, nobody daring to intercede for. them. Ge- what hap* neral des Farrues being in the mean time arriv'd at Livo with a fewt cwV L t0 ^ the men, could not but be extreamly furpriz'd at this unexpected turn of ml. affairs : He was indeed to all appearance well receiv'd, and in the Kings name prefented, as ufual, with a Golden Boefet, or Pinang's box: but before he was permitted to return to Bankok, he was obliged to pro- mife to deliver up this place to the Siamites, and to leave his two Sons, and twelve of his Countrymen, as Hoftages at Livo. The Ge- neral upon his return thither, being enrag'd at this difappointment, acted quite contrary to his promifes, clapt the watermen, which brought him down, in prifon, fired at the Siamites from the Fortrefs, and dif- charg'd his Guns at their Ships that pafs'd by, on which occafion two of his Garrifon, who were natives, appearing not quite fo ready as he would have them, he caufed them to be hang'd on the ramparts in fight of their Countrymen, and committed all forts of Hoftilities i- maginable. This conduct was like to provoke the Siamites to acta bloo- dy Tragedy with him and his Sons, accordingly they had already be- gun to raife forts on the banks of the River to cut off his retreat by water. But his Fire foon abated, upon which, and his laying all the blame of his conduct upon his people, who would not obey com«- mands, the Dutch Refident perfuaded the Court, that it would be more for their Honour to- take revenge of him by generoufly overlook- F ing 22 The Hiftory of JAPAN. Bock I. ins and flighting his bravadoes. This reprefentation had the effect, that foon after he obtain'd leave to depart with his people. I cannot for- bear mentioning an odd accident which happen'd on this occafion. The a Fwr* abovefaid Fourteen Hoftages having endeavour'd to make their efcape m.m M of ^ om £. vo were overtaken again, and carried back on Horfeback j Their Guards according to the cuftom of the Country put ropes about eve- ry one's necks, which ceremony put one of the Frenchmen, an Engi- neer by his profeflion, into fuch a fright, that he fell (lone dead to the Ground. There were ftill two of the King's Ships out at Sea, with Frenchmen on board, fent to cruife upon Pirates, and their return was expected much about that time. Thefe the Siamites endeavour'd to get into their power before the Captains could have notice of the rupture between the two nations. Their attempts fucceeded to expec- tation, for they attack'd the Sloop, which the French General fent down in the night, to acquaint the Captains with what had happen'd, juft as falling down the River, (he came out of reach of the Canons of the fortrefs, and after a defperate fight took and burnt her. All the other Frenchmen, who then were in Siam y either in the Service of the Country or otherwife, pay'd very dear for the treafonable practices of Faulcon, and the ill condutt of their General by fuftering a long and ■Mr. Lcuh t e di ous imprifonment. Monfieur Louis, the Metropolitan Bifliop, who cCw '"' had liv'd in the Country for feveral years, had his new-built palace out of the Town plunder'd, and was carried himfelf in Cuftody into the Court of the Royal Magazines, together with the other Jefuits his Collegues, who I think were feven or eight in number. I vifited them there, living chearfully in little Houfes built of Bambous and Reed. M. HisCbartc- Louis is a Gentleman of profound learning, and throughly verfed in the t*r Religion of Siam, and the Language of their holy books and priefts : As he is alfo a very pious man, he had by his Chriftian do&rine and exemplary Life gain'd fo much upon the Hearts of his Keepers, as a- nother Paid, that they venerated him as a holy Minifter of God Al- mighty. Three other Jefuits, who had fetled at Livo, near the Tem- ple of Wathniak prani Waan, on pretence of learning the Siamian Pali y or Language of their Holy Books from the Priefts, with whom they had alfo conform'd in (having their head, in their habit, and in their way of living, difappear'd of a fudden, nor was it ever known what was become of them. During thefe Troubles, the Dutch were aflur'd by order of Petraatia of his favour and protection. Orders alfo were fent down to Bankock to let their (hips and boats pafs by unmolefted. TheKiyn's Petraatia afterwards feiz'd the King's two Brothers, on pretence of ran Bmbers being in Faukon's Intereft, and caus'd them to be carried out of the i-lfft! ®^ °^ Livo to a neighbouring Temple, where they were beaten to death with Clubs made of Sandal-wood, the refpeel: for the Royal blooc forbidding the (hedding of it. And fo the King to his great grief liv'd to fee his own Brothers die the fame death, to which he on the ninth of Chap. II. The Hifloryof JAPAN. 23 of OElober 1656. had put his Uncle Pracitama Ratia, who had fuc- ceeded his Father, and was then in the third month of his reign, when his Nephew took pofeflion of the Throne. What added (till to the King's mortification was, that he had always look'd upon Petraatia, as his mod intimate friend, who was his Sifter's Son, whofe Sifters and Daughters were the King's Wives, and who befides having on all oc- cafions exprefs'd an abhorrence for the burthen of a Crown had ne- ver given the King room to fufpecT hira of fo cruel a defign. Under this Grief he died two days after, being the eleventh of July 1689, or h & . according to the Soncarad (which is the Epocha of Sia?n~) 2232, in the Jies. fifty fifth of his age, and the thirty fecond of his peaceable reign. In this manner Petraatia got pofleflion of the Adminiftration with Petraatia af- the Title of King of Siam, Tanajfari, Sncketa and Poifeluke, as alfo of T l r S one ' Proteclor of Cambodia, Jehoor, Pattany and Queda. By virtue of the ancient Laws of Siam upon the demife of the King, ^ aV)S re ia- the Crown devolves on his Brother, and upon the Brother's death, or if '"?> 1° the , Succefl'.on to there be none, on the eldeft Son. But this rule hath been fo often t ) :e Throw. broken through, and the right of Succefllon brought into fuch a confufion, that at prefent upon the death of the King he puts up for the Crown, who is the moft powerful in the Royal Family, and fo it feldom hap- pens, that the next and lawful Heir afcends the Throne, or is able to maintain the peaceable pofleflion of it. This uncertainty of SuccefTion even fometimes gives an opportunity o Strangers, who have no pretentions at all to afpire to the Throne, R e heiiion of wo late Inftances of which I will briefly relate. A Prince of the fa- * Prin " °f ily of the Kings of Maccaffar, having fome years ago fled for pro- tection to Siam with many of his Countrymen, fettled near the Camp of the Malagans, which the King of Siam had aflign'd to this latter Nation for their Habitation. (It mufl be obfervd here that the feueral \fpots of ground, on which the Malagans, Chinefe, Japanefe, Portuguese, Dutch and other Nations live at Siam, and which are more particularly 'xprefs'd in the annex' d Plan of the King's Refidence, are caWtl Camps.) The aid Prince form'd a defign with the afliftance of thofe Malagans y who profefs the Mahometan Religion as well as he, to feize on the Capital City and to pofTefs himfelf of the Throne. But his defign being difcover'd Defore it could take effect, the Prince was fummon'd to Court to fub- nit and beg pardon, which he refufing according to the innate obftina- :y of thofe of Maccajfar, he was- cut to pieces with all his Country- nen except his Son of eight years of age, after a bloody fight, in which hey made a brave defence, and "kili'd a great number of the Siamites. The Malagans, who had afilfted him, having fubmitted in time, efcap'd his fevere punifliment, and were pardon'd and reftored, the King De- ng of a merciful temper. This happen'd in the year 1687 in the ate King's Life time. . In *4 The Hifiory of j A P A N. Bock I. Rebellion of In the year 1689 a Prieft of Pegu, who had been formerly in cufto- Pr'uJK * ^y at Jurt**i ana " was acquainted with the affairs of that Court, made the like attempt. He went about the Country, giving out that he was the eJdeffc of the late King's brothers (who were kill'd by order of Petmatid) and confequently was the next Heir to the Crown. This Story found fo much credit, that in a lhort time he brought over to his Intereft about Ten thoufand men, being for the greater part an tindifciplined rabble. Having had notice, that the Prince Royal was to go to a certain place for his diverfion attended by his Court, he went thither, and hid himfelf in the wood, in order to murder the whole Company, afterwards to furprize the City, and to make away with the King and all his Servants. But he was diffappointed in his Scheme, for the Prince perceiving fo many people, and fufpe&ing fome iii de- fign, left them his plate for a prey and fled back to Court. The King having with great fpeed gather' d an army of Twelve thoufand Men, fent them to meet the undifciplined multitude, as they were marching towards the City. This unexpected oppofition put them under fuch a condensation, that they immediately difpers'd and fled with fo great a precipitation, that not above one hundred of them were kill'd, and but three hundred taken prifoners, whofe efcape the Victors prevent- ed by burning the Soles of their feet. Some days after the Prieft was found out himfelf lying a fleep under a Tree in the Wood, and hav- ing only a Boy with him. He was forthwith carried to Juthia, and being fetter'd with his neck and breaft againft a poft, expos'd for a publick fpectacle for fome days:, afterwards his belly was cut open he being alive, and his Inteftines given to the Dogs to tear and de- vour. officers of The King's Court confifts of the following great Officers of the Crown. ant,"*"* 1. Peja Surufak call'd alfo Peja Wanl-a and Faiwani, to whom the King hath committed the Crown affairs, as for inftance the direction of the Criminal Courts and Confifcations, as being the moft odious part of the Regal power. It is commonly thought the King by laying this truft upon him deligns to render him obnoxious to the People, but others pretend it was rather done to fecure the fuccefhon to him. 2. Peja _prah > klam, (Foreigners pronounce it Berklam) is High Chancellor, and ..hath the direction of foreign affairs. He is a more comely Perfon, and of better afpedt, than I ever met with amongft this black race of mankind who are generally fhort fiz'd and look almoft like Monkeys. He is alfo of a quick understanding and lively aftion, for which reafon he was a few years ago fent AmbafTador to France, of which Country, its Government, FortreiTes and the like, he would often entertain us in his difcourfes •, and the "hall of his Houfe, where we had a private au- dience of him, was hung with the pictures of the Royal Family of France, and European Maps, the reft of his furniture being nothing but Duft and Cobwebs. 3. Pejawam, otherwife call'd Tnau Peja Taratnafa, is great Chap II. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 25 great Chamberlain, and hath the Infpe&ion of the King's palaces and their apartments. 4 Peja Jummeraad, a learned Chinefe, is Chief Juftice. 5. Peja Polethep, Receiver general, hath the adminiflration of the Crown Lands and their Revenue. 6. Peja Tfakru, great matter of the Stables, hath the Infpe&ion over the Elephants and Horfes, and all that re- lates to the King's Train and Equipages. 7. Peja Klahom, Steward of the Houfehold, hath the command of the King's Servants, pleafure yachts, and the Royal furniture. Thefe are the chief Mandarins, or officers of State, who make up the great Council of the Kingdom. Man- darin is properly a Chineze word us'd only among foreigners, and is jn the Language of the Country exprefs'd by Tfiankrue, or Tfiant Tfam. Next to them are the State and Court officers of an inferiour rank, and an uncertain number, as for inttance: Peja Tareman, the chief of the Malagans j Opera Tfijat, the chief of the Moors, as they are call'd, or Mahometans: He is alfo Siabander, or Receiver of the cu- ftoms for foreign merchandize. Oja Pipat, wider or Deputy Berklam, was formerly a domeftick of Faidcon, of whom he learnt the {kill of pinching Strangers •, Oja Tewijata, Querry of the Elephants, is a Mahometan from Indoftan, a Man of worth. Oja Tamam Captain of the Guards. Oja De Tfiu, Captain of the Land forces. The Siamites have no he- reditary family names, but receive their denomination from the fancy of others, particularly their Superiors. Great Men are call'd afte^ their employments, and fuch are the names above related. Court Ti- tles and Dignities go in this order. 1. Peja and Oja is as much as a Prince. 2. Opera, who are about forty in number both at Court, and in the Country, are like Lords or Barons. 3. Ohtang, or Luang are their Noblemen or Gentry. This Title the King bellows alfo on his Interpret ters or Truchemans. 4. Okucen, are perfons defcended of great fami_ lies. 5. Omncen, Inferior officers of diftinction. 6 Majalacks, Pages and young Gentlemen. The Kingdom of Siam is by the Natives called Muan Thai, which , ***?" , °f is as much as to fay, the Land Thai. In their books it is founded of siam. with this Epithet, Krom Tbep Pramma baa Ikoon y (Circuitus vifitationis Deorum) tbe Circuit of tbe Vifitations of the Gods. The Malagans and Peguans call it T%iam, from whence comes the European name Siam. itsfmiution. Its Northern Latitude about the middle of it, or where the Capital Ci- ty is fituated, is fourteen degrees eighteen minutes, and its Longitude according to the common Maps 138, but according to the late Obfer- vations of the Jefuits 120 degrees. Eaftward it borders upon the King- doms Timkin, Cofynfina and Cambodia-^ on the South it is limited by the Sea, and the Countries of Malacca, of which the King of Siam pof- felfes Ligoor, TanaJJ'eri, and fome other fmall Provinces. On the Weft is the Kingdom of Pegu, and on the North that of Laos. Confidering £xUntt its extent it is but indifferently peopled being belt inhabited only along the banks of the Rivers. The great quantity of Deer and Buffalo- G fkins 26 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book I. Ikins, that are yearly exported by Sea are a proof of vaft Wocd: and Wilderneffes, the rather becaufe thofe Animals are killed only in the neighbourhood, Tygers and Moraffes hindering the hunting of them hsDi-jifion. f ar j nt0 t h e fbrefb. This Kingdom contains twelve large provinces, each of which is govern'd by an Oja, or Prince, as the King's Lieute- nant, who hath feveral Opera's, or fubaltern Officers under him. Be- fides there is an Oja at Court for every Province, who manages its Concerns, and keeps a watchful Eye over the commanding Lieutenant's conduct. The late King had added a thirteenth Province to the afore- faid twelve, which he conquer'd from the Kingdom of Laos, and in all probability he would have conquer'd more, if the fwelling of a large River had not put a flop to his progrefs. But a few years after that Province was taken from him again, fo that all the benefit of an ex- pedition undertaken in fo remote a Country, and with fo much ex. pence, was only the creating a Jealoufy between the two Nations, which ruin'd the former trade between them, and remov'd it to Cambodia. jccouKt of Since I have mention'd Laos, it will not be improper to communi- the Kingdom cate to the Reader what account I had of this Kingdom, which is o- */ La0! - therwife but little known, becaufe of its being an Inland Country, and remote from the Sea. Laos is fituated under the fame Northern Cli- mate with Tunquin, and is a large and powerful Kingdom feparate from the neighbouring States by Forefts and Defarts. It lies a month's Jour- ney North of Judia. It is very inconvenient and troublefome travelling thither by Land, on account of the high mountains, and on the River, by reafon of the rocks and Catarra&s, fo that the VeiTels, or Trows as they call them, are built in fuch a manner, that they can be taken to pieces, and carried over the eminences in order to purfue the Jour- ney by water. It is a fruitful Country. The Soil is a fat clay, which in fummer grows fo hard and firm, that the Inhabitants ufe to threfh the Rice upon it, in order to feparate it from the hulks, for which in other places they make ufe of a wooden Trough. It produces Rice of the beft kind in abundance, and furnifhes Cambodia with the belt Benzoin and Gumm Lace, though both thefe commodities grow alfo in that Country. It likewife yields the mod valuable Muflc, fome Gold, and fome precious Stones, chiefly Rubies, befides Pearls, which the Siamites call Muk, which is the more to be admired, fince I could not hear, that there was any Salt Sea in the Country. Their Religion a- grees with that of Siam, nor do they much differ in their Language and writing, except only that the Inhabitants of Laos cannot pro- nounce the Letters L. and ic. They write upon leaves like the Pegu- ans and Malabarians, and as the Siamites write their religious Books } but civil affairs are writ upon a fort of courfe paper with earthen pinns. They boaft that the Siamites have learnt the art of writing and the Language of their holy Books from them. They refemble the Chi- nefe in their fhape and mien, but are more tawny and {lender, and confequently Chap. II. The Hiftory s/JAPAN, 27 confequently of a much handfomer appearance than the Siamites. They have long Earlaps like the Vegnans, and the Inhabitants of the Sea- coaft, the Men without any ornament, but the Women, as long as they remain unmarried, with pieces of gold in them. The Men caufe their Legs to be painted from the ancle up to the knee with flowers and branches, like the Brafpintados of the Siamites, as a mark of their Religion and Manhood. An arm of the River Ganges runs through the Country, which falls into the River of Cambodia, and renders it navigable, fo that the Inhabitants of Cambodia go thither every Year in their Prows, or veffels in order to trade with the Inhabitants. The two chief Cities are Landjam and Tfiamaja. The whole Country is faid to have been formerly tributary to the King of Siam. But not to expatiate beyound our fubjed, we will return to Jutbia, Vefcrlption or Judia, the Capital City and place of refidence of the King of Siam, which in fome defcriptions of Travels is wrongly call India, perhaps by a miftake in print. This City in ancient times flood at the place, which is now call'd Bankok, on the Weftbank of the great Ri- ver Menam, from whence it was afterwards remov'd to the place, on which it now ftands, being a low Ifland form'd by the faid River. This Ifland, with the City upon it, is of the fliape of the fole of a man's foot, with the heel turning weftward, and hath about two German Miles in circumference. It is fituate in a Country all flat, as far as the Eye can reach, on a low ground, which is cut through by many Canals coming from the River, and by them divided into fo many Ifles and fquares, that one cannot go far without the help of Boats. It is furrounded with a Brick wall, which on the South and North is four fathoms and a half high, clean, well condition'd and adorn'd with Battlements, but the reft of it is lower, neglecled and decay'd. This wall is open in many places, where there are fmall gates towards the River. On the infide there are ramparts rais'd againft it at different di- ftances for placing Cannons upon them. At the lower end of the City appears a large baftion advancing into the water, befides feveral fmall ones. The firft is furnifti'd with Cannons againft the Ships com- ing up. To fence the Citywall againft the wafteing of the current, a narrow bank, or key is left, which is built upon in many places. Di- vers great Canals go out of the River quite through the City fome from Eaft to Weft, others from North to South, and abundance of fmaller Canals being derived from the great ones, Ships may come from the River up into the Town, and put on fhore near the principal Houfes and Palaces. The Streets run in a ftreight line along the Ca- nals ^ Some of them are tolerably large, but the greater part very narrow, and all, generally fpeaking, foul and dirty: Some alfo are overflow'd at high water. Confidering the bignefs of the City, it is not very populous, and in fome parts but thinly inhabited, particular- ly on the Weft fide on account of its remotenefs, and towards the South 28 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book J. South by reafon of the moraffy ground, over which people make fhift to get upon planks, or paltry bridges. This makes that in thofe parts there are abundance of empty fpaces and large gardens behind the ftreets, wherein they let nature work, fo that they are full of grafs, Herbs, Shrubs and Trees, that grow wild. The firft Street upon en- tring the City is that which runs Weflward along the turning of the Wall : it hath the beft Houfes, amongft which are thofe, that for- merly belonged to the EngliJJj, Dutch, and French, as alfo that in which Faulcon refided. The middle Street, which runs North towards the Court, is beft inhabited, and full of fhops of Tradesmen, Artificers, and Handicraftmen. In both thefe Streets are feen above one hundred Houfes belonging to the Chinefe, Hindoftanians and Moors, as they call them. They are all built alike of Stone, very fmall, being but eight paces in length, four in breadth and of two Stories, yet not above two Fathoms and a half high. They are cover'd with flat tiles, and have large doors without any proportion. The reft of the Streets are lefs inhabited, and the Houfes of ordinary Inhabitants are but mean and poor cottages, built of Bambous (which is a hollow reed, two or three Spans thick) and boards, and carelefly cover'd with Gabbe Gabb£ y Branches and leaves of Palm Trees growing wild in Moraffy places. The Mandarins or Minifters of State and Courtiers live in fepa- rate palaces, with Courtyards to them, which are very dirty. The Buildings in general, though rais'd with Lime and Stone are but indifferent, and the apartments neither clean, nor well furnifh'd. The booth, or Shops of the town are low, and very ordinary, however they ftand in good order, and in a ftreight line, as the Streets are. The many Canals occafion a great number of bridges. Thofe which are laid over the great Canal are of Stone, with Ballifters of the fame, but as there are no Waggons, nor Carts in this place, they are narrow j in the middle they are high and eighty pa- ces long} but the Bridges over the by Canals are of no Architecture, and for the greateft part of wood. (See. Tab. n.) Royal Pa- There are three Royal palaces in this, City. The firft is the new pa- Uces. lace built by the late King on the North fide towards the middle of the Town. (See. Tab. m Fig. i.) It confifts of a large fquare, with feveral fubdivifions, and many buildings, which according to the Chinefe Ar- chitecture are adorn'd with many Roofs, and Frontifpieces part of which are gilt over. Within, the walls of the Palace as well as without, are to be feen long Stables, in which fome hundred of Elephants ftand in a long row magnificently harnafs'd. Since the french trou- bles, as they are here call'd, there is but one entry left ro go into the palace, through which no perfon is admitted but on foot, though it is fo dirty, that people fometimes ftep in the mud up to the calf of their Legs, if they do not keep an exact ballance in walking over the fmall planks, that are laid for them ^ even an ordinary Mandarin dare not enter but attended only with one fervant. For this fame reafon no (hips or Chap. If The Hifloryof JAPAN. 29 or boats are allow'd to come upon the great river, as far as it runs by the walls of the palace. The gates, and other avenues of the palace are crowded with fwarms of naked fellows,* whofe tawny ikin is painted with black checquered figures, pointed in the manner, as they do with the Images at the holy fepulchre at Jerusalem \ fome of them are thus mark'd only on the arms, but others all over the body to the lovns, which are wrapt up in a cloth according to the general cuftom cf the Natives. They are call'd by a Portugueze word Braspintades. Thefe are the King's Guards, Door-keepers, and watermen, who wear inftead of arms fhort thick clubs, roving and fauntering about the pa- lace like idle Vagrants. The fecond palace, call'd the foremofi palace, , P *)!^ f ff °* is fituated in the North Eaft part of the City towards its extremity. Royal. It is of a fquare figure, but not near fo large as the firft. It was the ancient place of Refidence of the former King's, but at prefent, in 169^, it is inhabited by the Prince Royal, who is twenty years of age. The third and laft Palace is fmaller than any of the two, and fituated in the Weft and leaft inhabited part of the City. In this lives at pre- fent a Prince of the Royal Blood, and it is call'd the Palace of the Quer- Palace rf the ry of the King's Elephants, the faid Prince being the Conductor and ^Zg? eu- Manager of the Elephant, which carries the King. The Prince doth pb**u. not ride upon the Elephants neck as ufual, but lies upon its Crupper behind the King, from whence he hath a way of governing the beaft by certain figns, to which it is ufed. After the Palaces I fhall take notice of the Temples and Schools of Temples and this City. They are in great number, for as the whole Country is ° s ' ftock'd with Priefts and Monks, this City in particular abounds in all parts with Temples, the Courts of which keep a regular propor- tion with the Streets, and are full of pyramids and co- lumns of divers fhapes and gilt over. They do not equal our churches in bignefs, but far exceed them in outward beauty, by reafon of the many bended roofs, gilt frontifpieces, advanced fteps, columns, pillars, and other ornaments. Within they are adorn'd with many images as big as the life and bigger, fkilfully formed of a mixture of plaifter, rofin, oyl and hair, the outfide of which is firft varnifh'd over with black then gilt. They are placed in feveral rows on an eminence, on which the Altar ftands. In fome temples alfo along the walls in fingle rows, fitting with their legs crofs'd and naked, except the wafte, about which is tied a dark yellow cloth j over the left fhoulder down to the navel hangs another piece of cloth of the fame colour twifted clofe together. Their earlaps are cut through with a flit, and are fo long, that they reach the fhoulders. Their hair is curl'd, tied over the crown in two knots, fo that it cannot be diftinguifh'd whether it is a cap, or fome fuch ornament. The right hand refts upon the right knee, and the left lies in the lap. The chief place, which is in the middle, is chhfUoUf for an Idol of a fize far above human, fitting in the fame pofture un- the Samim - der a Canopy. It reprefents their chief Teacher, and the Founder H of go The Hiftory (/JAPAN. Book I. of their Religion. The Siamites call him Pr ah, the Saint, ax P rah Pit- di D/iau, the Saint of high defcent, or with a particular name, Sammo- na Khodam, which' the Peguans pronounce Sammona Khntama, a Man without paflions. The Japanefe and Chinefe call him Siaka, or Saka, the Ceylonefe Bttdhum and Biulha. This Prah, or Khodwn is repre- fented in a monflrous fize in fome Temples. In a Peguan Temple out of the City, call'd in the Peguan Language Tfianpmm Tfni/i, there fits on an eminence fuch an Idol ftrongly gilt, the proportion of which i s fuch, that it would be of 120 foot in length, ifftanding, and we fhall hereafter meet with another Siaka, or Idol, at Miaco, the Capital of Japan, and Refidence of its Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor, which is not inferior to this at Judia, either in fize, or beauty. The pofture of the faid Idol is the fame with that, in which Budha, and his dif- ciples placed themfelves, when they were enthufiaftically meditating upon religious Subje&s. Even to this day the priefts his followers are obliged by their rules to fit down daily at ftated times in the pofture of their Mafter, when they are exercifing their devotions of medita- tion and Enthufiafm. They alfo go about in the fame drefs, only with their heads ftav'd, covering their faceagainft the Sun with a Fan made of palm wood, and leaves. Next to the Temples are the habitations of the Monks, which are Houfes o/but poor Houfes. On one fide of them they have a publick hall, the Monkj. or or atory, call'd Prahkdi, which commonly is a pretty large timber building much like the Temples, the edges of the roof gilt, with a few fteps leading up to it, and furnifh'd with many Timberfheds in, {lead of windows to give paffage to the air, during their publick afTem- blies, or le&ures. The cieling within is fuported by two rows of co- lumns, and the room divided into divers claffes, and benches. In the midft of it, fome fteps above the floor, ftands a delk, or pulpit, curi- oufly carv'd and gilt, like thofe in our churhes, on which at certain hours appears an old prieft, who from large palm leaves ingrav'd with black Characters, reads with a flow and diftinct voice fome holy words to his audience, confiding chiefly in ftudents of their divinity, or young monks. Upon the hearing of certain words, and names the audience clap their hands together above their forehead, but upon the main fhew little attention, and devotion j for I my felf faw fome cutting Pinang, others grindinging powders, or mixing Mercury with the Juice of Herbs, or employing their Hands with fome other paftime. Near the Desk, or in fome other place is to be feen the Idol of Amida Handing upright on the flower Tarate, or Faba Aegypt'iaca, or Nymphxa magna incamata, whom they believe to be the Interceflbr of departed Souls. Round about the hall are hung up flowers and crowns, cut of paper banners, and other gilded ornaments, fufpended of Bamboureeds, which they ufe to carry in funeral proceflions. During their alTemblies I have commonly obferv'd a machine (land- ing Chap. II. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 31 in°- before the Desk or Pulpit, awkwardly join'd together of Bam- bous in the form of a table, and hung with yellow pieces of cloth, which the priefls make ufe of for their drefs, or rather covering their wafte. There were flowers ftuck about it for ornament's fake, and feveral dimes plac'd on it fill'd with Rice, Pinang, Pifang, dried Fifties, Lemons, Man- goftanges, and other fruits of the Trees of the Country, which were of- ferings and prefents made to the Convent. It happen'd once, when I was going into one of them, that on the fteps I met fuch a machine, when they were carrying it home, the aifembly being finiuVd, either the throng of the people, or the carelefsnefs of the bearers, were the oc- cafion of their breaking it to pieces, fo that the Dilhes with the eatables, and all the Trumpery together, fell upon the ground, which made me fpeedily get out of the way, for fear the Mob might fall upon me as the caufe of all the mifchief. Round the City lie many Suburbs and Villages, fome of which con- Svhwh tf fill of inhabited Ships, or Veflels, rather than Houfes, containing two, three, or more Families each ^ they remove them from time to time, and float them particularly when the waters are high, where Fairs are kept, to fell their Goods there and get their Livelyhood by it. (See Tab. III. £„«„.'" Fig. 4, 5, 6.) The Houfes in the common Villages, that ftand upon firm Ground, are generally built of Bambous, reed, planks, and other ordinary fluff:, fome of the Houfes in the Villages along the banks of the river ftand on pales a fathom high, that the waters, which overflow the Country for fome months, may freely pafs under the Houfes. Each Houfe is furniuYd with Stairs, or a Ladder, to come down in dry wea- ther, and with a boat, to go about it at high water. (See Tab. III. Fig. 7.) Other villages ftand on higher and dry ground, and confequently not being fubjeel to thofe Inundations their Houfes want neither fuch flairs nor boats. On thofe eminences alfo ftand Temples, Convents, burying Places, where they bury their dead, and Yards where they burn their bones and allies, and erect coflly Pyramids over them. On the South-fide, at a fmall diftance down the River, the Dutch have their Fa&ory and Magazines very fplendidly and conveniently built on dry ground. Lower down on the fame bank are other villages inhabited'by Dmh F4s ~ Colonies of Japonefe, (the beft Soldiers of former Kings) Peguans and Malaccans. On the oppofite fide of the River ftands a village inhabited by a Portuguefe race begot on black Women, and further down ftands a Church, dedicated to St. Domingo, to which belong the Fathers of the Dominican Order. Behind it ftands another fmall Church, which is kept by two Fathers of the Order of St. Jitjiin, who with the forelaid three Dominicans live peaceably together in a Houfe built of Reed. Not far from hence, on the fame plain, ftands a Jefuit Church nam'd St. Paul, after the chief Church at Goa, belonging to the Fathers fof this Order, who through all Afia are better pleas'd to be call'd Paulins from that Church than Jefuits. South Weft of the City, oppofite to that fide of the 32 The Hifloryof] A P A N. Book I. Set Tab. IV. the River, where it lets out the branch Klang Nam Ja the Metropoli- tan Bifhop Mr. Louis had caus'd a ftone Palace to be built, together with a fine Church, which is now lock'd up fince his Imprifonment. The Roman Catholick Ecclefiaftic£s in Siam have affur'd me, that there live above three thoufand fix hundred Chriflians in the neighbourhood of Juclja, who are pafl feven years of age, and have been admitted to the Sacrament. Pyramid * cannot forbear taking notice in a few words of two remarkable PkahTion.^ curiofities near Juclja. The firftis the famous Pyramid Pkab Thon or Puka* thon, which Hands on a plain one League North Weft of the City. It was built by the Siamites in remembrance of a great victory obtain'd in that place over the King of Pegu, whom they kill'd and defeated his numerous Army, thereby freeing themfelves of the fubjettion they were under to the Peguans, and reftoring their ancient Liberty. It is a bulky, but magnificent ftruclure, forty odd fathoms high, Handing in a fquare taken in with a low neat wall. It confifts of two ftruclures which are built one upon the other. The lowermoft ftruclure is fquare, each fide being one hundred and fifteen paces long, and rifes to the height of twelve fathoms and upwards. Three corners jet out fome few paces on each fide, which are continu'd up to the top,, and alter- ing its fquare figure make it appear, as it were, multangular. It con- fifts of four Stories, built one upon the other, the uppermoft of which growing narrower leaves at the top cf that below it an empty fpace, or walk to go round. Every Story hath its Cornilhes curioufly diver- fify'd, and all the walks, the lowermoft only excepted, are taken in with low neat walls adorn'd in each corner with fine columns. The middle- moft corner of each Story reprefents the frontifpiece of the Building. It exceeds the others in beauty and ornaments, efpecially in a magnifi- cent gable it ends into. The Stair-cafe is in the middle of it, which leads up to the upper area on which is built the fecond ftruclure, and confifts of feventy four fteps, each nine Inches high, and four paces long. The fecond ftruclure is built on the upper furface of the firft, which is fquare, each fide being thirty fix paces long. It ftands out in the middle for ornament's fake, and is taken in like the reft, with a low neat wall. It hath a walk five paces broad to go about the fecond ftruclure. The Stair-cafe ends into this walk, each fide of its entry be- ing adorn'd with columns. The bafis, or pedeftal of the fecond ftruc- ture is octangular, confifting of eight fides of different length, thofe facing South, Eaft, Weft and North, being eleven, but the North Eaft, South Eaft, South Weft, and North Weft fides, each twelve paces- long. It hath its Cornifhes much after the manner of the lowermoft ftruclure to the height of fome fathoms. It then becomes net unlike a Steeple, on whofe top ftand feveral fliort columns at fome di- ftances from each other, the fpaces between being left empty. Thefe columns fupport a pile of globes, which run up tapering, their diame- ters Chap II. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 33 ters decreafing in proportion to the height. The whole ends into a very- long Spire, and withal fo (harp, that it is very furprizing, how it could hold out for fo conliderable a fpace of time againft all the Injuries of wind and weather. (See Tab. IV. Fig. i. 2.) Next to this Pyramid are fome Temples and Colleges of the Talapoins, which are taken in with Darti- cular neat brick walls. The Temples are of a very curious Structure, cover'd with feveral roofs, fupported by columns. As to the whole, I muft refer the Reader to the annex'd figures, which will give him a much better Idea, than could be expected of the raoft accurate defcription. The other remarkable Curiofity is a double fquare joining together, Berkjam* and fituate not far from the City towards the Eaft j each fquare con- T«»j>/*. tains feveral Temples, Convents, Chapels, Columns, Pyramids and other Buildings of different forms. They are feparated by a Canal, and are each enclos'd with a fine wall. To avoid entring into tedious particu- lars, I have given the Plan of thofe Squares, together with fome of the chief buildings, at large. (See Tab. V. and VI.) In the firft Square occurs the Temple of Berklam, as it is call'd, mark'd with Lit. A. from which the whole place hath taken its name, and is become parti- cularly famous. Its Structure in general is exquifitely fine, but parti- cularly the Gate at the great Entry is a piece of admirable workmanfhip compos'd of carven Images and branched work, or foliage. The Archi- tecture refembles that of the Temple near Pka'thon, the above defcrib'd famous Pyramid, both which are reprefented in Tab. III. Fig. 2. 3. The mid- " die of the Temple is for ornament's fake cover'd with four roofs, that are bent, and lie one over another. The lowermoft of thofe roofs jets oilt on each fide of the Temple like a wing which is fupported by eight co- lumns. The infide is like all other Temples pretty dark, there being no windows, fo that all the light can come in only through the door and fome holes in the wall. The Porch is rais'd above the ground, and cover'd with feveral roofs, which are fupported by eight Columns with gilt Capitals {landing in two rows. The outer row of Columns is join'd together by a red Lettice or Grate, before the frontifpiece of the Tem- ple, to preferve the precious doors in it. There are three folding pair of doors in this frontifpiece, each pair confiding of two valves, which are very ni cely and skilfully carv'd into three Layers of branches twitt- ed together, and adorn'd with leaves and flowers, among which appear feveral fmall Images of their Idols of different forms and poftures, fome of them having four arms and hands holding divers Weapons and In- ftruments, the whole well proportion'd and adorn'd with gold and different colours. Next to the Temple ftands a fmall open houfe mark'd with Lit. a, in the midft of which hangs a bell gilt over, of two yards diameter, which they ftrike with a hammer in the mornings and evenings to call the Monks to their prayers and devotions, which they perform finging in choirs with a trembling voice, as the Monks in Europe fing Pfalms. (See Tab. VI. Fig. 7.) I Lit. 34 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. Lit. B. is another temple like the former, only without fo many ornaments. The porch of it confifts of two open rooms adorn'd with Plaifter-work and gilt fmall Idols. The Floor was cover'd with heaps of large palm-leaves, being the remains of their Pali, or religious Books, which when they grow old and worn out, are here laid afide in this manner, as in a facred place. In viewing thefe Temples I took notice, as of fomething particular, that I met with no images of beafts, and Idols of a monftrous figure, as the Brahmines and Chinefe have in theirs, for all their idols within the Temples are reprefented in hu- man fhape, either fitting, or ftanding, tho' without them, as for inftance on the gates, entries, pyramids, particularly in thefe two fquares, we are now fpeaking of, appear as by way of ornament many monftrous images, with hideous frightful faces. Lit. C. is a Pyramid in the form of a fteeple, gilt over from the top to half its height, and ftanding on a pedeftal rais'd above the ground, and taken in with a fquare walk. The uppermoft point is fur- rounded with a Crown of large extent turn'd upfide down, on which hang fmall gilt Bells, or Cymbals, which being mov'd by the wind give a found. Lit. D, is a fmall wooden Houfe, in which is kept a very heavy Sedan, painted with divers colours. Lit. E is a vaulted Chapel with a bulky Idol like that of Bacchus, call'd by the Brahmans Viccafwara. It is much beyond the ordinary fize of a man, ftrongly gilt all over, turning with his Face fmiling towards the Temple laft mention'd. Und#r and above it and on the fides flood feveral other fmaller Idols, as is reprefented in Tab. V. Fig. 2. Before it were rails, on which appear'd the marks of wax Candles, that had been burnt there. Lit. F. is another building vaulted and like the former. Within on the middle of the wall was engraven a Figure partly colour'd and part- ly gilt, in fome meafure refembling a foot with four Toes, three Spans long, and one and a half broad, which they hold as fomething very facred. (See Tab. V. Fig. 3.) Under it were plac'd divers fmall Idols. Pyramid The Pyramids ftanding in thofe Squares are built in honour of cer- tain Gods, to whom they are dedicated and named after them. They are commonly provided with fhelves on which the Devotees place their offerings for the benefit of the priefts. In the other Square (See Tab. V. Fig 1.) within its walls were rang'd Flower-pots and Boxes for plants. There flood alfo within it feve- - T( ral Topoo Trees, in the Eaft Indies call'd Rawafith, and Bipd. This is a fort of a Milk or Fig Tree, of the fize of a beach, with extend- ed branches, a fmooth grey bark, and round but long pointed leaves, bearing a round fruit, which is infipid, and nourifhment only for Bats. All the Pagans of thefe parts hold it to be holy, and pleafing to the Gods, for as much as their gteat Saint Sammana Khodum always chofe Ghap. II. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 35 chofe to fit under it, and for this reafon they love to plant it near their temples, if the Soil and Climate will allow it. The like holi- rfefs is afcrib'd to another Milk or Fig Tree, whofe branches bend- f ybl, ing towards the ground take root in it, after they touch it, and form Fig Trie as many new Stems, by which means it extends it felf far round a- bout: It hath leaves not unlike thofe of the Lauro-Cerafm, but larger and bears a fruit like the other, which bats love to eat. The Ceylo- nefe call it alfo Biulhwn Gas, that is Budhunis Tree. But it is diffi- cult to plant and not proper to Hand near the temples by reafon of its fpreading lb far. This fecond fquare contain'd two remarkable Tem- ples, the firft of which reprefented on each door in the porch two Sava^ ges with heads of Devils, (See Tab. V. Fig. 2.) and at the back door were painted two Portugueze as big as the Life. A great feftival is yearly celebrated in this Temple. There flood befides in this fecond fquare fome other Chapels with Idols in them, as alfo divers fine py- ramids, fome of which are gilt over, and others full of monftrous fi" gures. It would be too tedious to defcribe each of them in partial* lar, and I think it fufficient to have given the figures of the moft re- markable ones in Tab. VI. Fig. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Before I leave this Subjecl, I muft take notice of a Tree of a ftrange Remarkable nature, which one meets with going out of the City towards thefe ^i?3L two fquares, over the Dyke made not long ago for fhutting up the Southern arm of the great River. It is of the fize of an Apple tree, has narrow leaves, and long fpreading branches, at the extremities and fmallefl Twigs of which hang Bird's nefls, ingenioufly twifted to- gether of dry grafs and other fluff in the form of a Purfe with a long and narrow neck. The openings of thefe Nefts look to the North- weft, fo that no South wind, nor rain can come in. I told upwards of fifty of them only on this tree, and never met with the like on a- ny other. The Birds were of a dark yellowifh colour, not unlike Canary Birds, and chirping almofl like Sparrows, of which otherwife there is a great plenty in this Country. Another extraordinary thing in this Tree is, that the trunk and larger branches of it are full of crabbed excrefcencies, or warts of different figures, which the Inhabi- tants make ufe of as a Medicine againft certain diftempers. The Religion of thefe People is the Pagan Do&rine of the Brahmans, Rf /,v; „ t which ever fince many Centuries hath been profefs'd amongft all the the Sitmitta Nations from the River Indus to the extremity of the Eafl, except that at the Court of the Grand Mogul, and in his great Cities, as alfo in Siimmatra, Java, Celebes, and other neighbouring Iflands the Maho- metifm has gain'd fo much ground, that it feems to prevail above it. This general Paganifm, (which is to be diftinguifh'd from the Religi- on of the old Perfians worfhipping the Sun, now almoft extincT:) tho* branch'd out into feveral Seds and Opinions, according to the various Cuftoms, Languages and Interpretations, yet is of one and the fame Origine, Siaka ^6 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. Origine. The Siamites reprefent the firft Teacher of their Paganifm in their Temples, in the figure of a Negro fitting, of a prodigious fize, his hair curl'd, the skin black, but as it were out of refpect gilt over, accompanied on each fide by one of his chief Companions, as alfo be- fore and round about him by the reft of his Apoftles and Difciples, all of the fame colour and moft in the fame pofture. They believe according to the Brahmans, that the Deity dwelt in him, which he prov'd by his Doftrine, Way of Life, and Revelation. For Wijlnu, by which they mean the Deity, having already many hundred thoufands of years before aflum'd different forms, and vifited the World eight different times, appear' d the ninth in the perfon of this Negro, whom for this reafon they ftile Prabpuditfau, that is to fay, the Saint of high defcent 5 Sammana Kbutama, the Man without Paffions .- Prab bin TJjau, the Saint who is the Lord j or plainly Prab, the Saint, or Budba* (or Pbutba* in one fyllable, according to their guttural pronuncia- tion, like that of the Hottentots) The Ceylanefe call him Budbum, the Chinefe and Japanefe Sacka, or Siaka, or plainly Fotoge, that is, the Idol, and with an honourable Epithet Si Tfwi, the great Saint. Wbm lom. About his origine and native Country, I find the account of thofe Heathens do not agree. The Siamites call the Country of his nativity Lanca, which is the Ifland of Ceylon, from whence they fay, their Religion was firft brought over to them, and afterwards further pro- pagated through the neighbouring Countries as far as Cbina and Japan, Accordingly there are ftill to be feen fome foot fteps of their Religi- on, as well of that which they exercis'd before, as of the other fprung up in the room of it, on the top of a high mountain in the Ifland of Ceylon, by the Europeans call'd Pico d'Jdam, which they look upon as holy, and in their Maps place it in the Centre of the World. The Ceylonefe themfelves call the Country of his nativity Macca defia, mean- ing by it the Kingdom of Siam, for they make ufe of the Pali, or Bible of the Siamites, which the Peguans call Maccatapafa, in their Khom, or Language of the Khomuts, owning that they had it from the Siamites. The Chinefe and Japanefe pretend that this Saint, and the Doftrine he reveal'd, had their origine in the Country of Magatta y or as the Japanefe call it, Tenfik Magatta Kokf, that is the Heaven- landifh Magatta, which according to their defcription and opinion is the Continent of India, including Pegu and Siam, adding withal, thafi Siaka was the Son of the King of thofe Countries, the Inhabitants of which afcribe to each other the origin of their Teacher, a Prophet, as it feems, being always thought the greater for being of a foreign Country. The Benjans and learned Brahmans believe that Budba had neither Father nor Mother, and confequently own, they know nothing of his birth and native Country. They reprefent him in the figure of a man with four arms, and as for the reft have no other Legends con- cerning his miracles and attions, befides a tradition of his adorable piety Chap, tt The Hijlory °f J A P A N. 37 piety having now for 26430 years been fitting on a Tar ate flower,' and praifing the fupreme God ever fince 21639 y ears (reckoning from' the prefent 169c year of Chrift,) when he firft appear'd and reveal'd himfelf to the world. But the Siamites, and other Nations Jying further Eaft, have whole Books full of the birth, life and mi- racles of this God Prah, or Siaka. I am at a lofs how to reconcile thefe various and oppofite accounts, which I have gather'd in the above- faid Countries, unlefs by fuppofing, what I really think to be the true opinion, viz. that the Siamites and other Nations lying more Eafter- ly have confounded a younger Teacher with Budha' and miftaken the former for the latter, which confufion^of the Gods and their names is very frequent in the Hiftories of the Greeks and Egyptians-, fo that Prab or Siaka. is not the fame with Budha, much lefs with Ram. c* 1 2 or Rama, as he is call'd by Father Kircber in his Sina Illnjlrata, the ^it&aarenot latter having appear'd many hundred thoufand years before, but that tkefame i J er- he was fome new Impoflor who fet up but about five hundred years ■' oa before Chrifl's nativity. Befides this, many circumftances make it pro- bable, that the Prab, or Siaka, was no Afiatick, or Indian, but fome Egyptian Priefl of note, probably of Memphis, and a Moor, who with his Brethren being expell'd their native Country, brought the Egyti- an Religion into the Indies, and propagated it there, and this for the following Reafons. 1. There appears in feveral material Points a conformity between Eaftern Pa- this Eaftern, and the Ancient Egyptian Pagamfm^ for the Egyptians f r0> „ the wr reprefented their Gods, as thefe Heathens now do, in the form of dif- fi : P °f the ferent forts of Animals and human Monftersj whereas their Neigh- bours in Afia, as for Example, the Perfians, Chaldeans, and other Na- tions profefling the fame Religion, worfhip'd rather the Luminaries of the Heavens, particularly the Sun, and the Fire, as being its Image j and it is probable, that before the introduction of the prefent Paganifm among the Indians, they had the fame fort of worfhip with the neigh- bouring Chaldeans and Perfians. For as it cannot be fuppos'd, that thefe fenfible Nations liv'd without any Religion at all, like the brutal Hottentots, it is highly probable, that they rever'd the divine Omni- potence by worfhiping, according to the Cuftom of the Chaldeans, the Sun, and other Luminaries of the Firmament, as fuch parts of the Creation, which moll flrike the outward fenfes, and fill the under- standing with the admiration of their unconceivable proprieties. And there are ftill to this day among thofe Heathens fome remains of the Chaldean Religion, confifting in a worfhip paid to the Sun and the Stars, which however is not taught by their Priefts, but only to- lerated like fome fupererogatory worfhip, juft as there remain even in Chriflian Governments, certain antient pagan cuftoms and fuperflitions, efpecially the Bachanals. Two Articles in the Egyptian Religion, which were mofl: religioufly maintain'd, were, the Tranfmigration of Souls, K and 3 8 TheHijlwyoJ JAPAN. Bock I. and a Veneration for Cows, particularly for the holy Cow at Mem- phis, call'd Ap'u, or Serapis, which had divine honours paid her, and. was ferv'd by Priefts. Both thefe Articles are (till obferv'd among the Afiatick Heathens, particularly thofe that inhabit the Weft-fide of the Ganges •, for no body there dares to kill the leuft and moft noxi- ous Infects, as being animated by fome tranfmigrated human Soul : and the Cows, whofe Souls they think are by frequent transmigrations, as it were, deified, are ferv'd and attended with great veneration, their Dung being burnt to afhes is turn'd into holy Salve, their Urine ferves for holy Water, the Image of a Cow poflefles a peculiar Cha- pel before their Temples, is every day honour'd with frelh flowers, and hath fweet-fcented oyl poured upon her. It is alfo remarkable, that the nearer thofe Heathens are to Egypt, the greater Zeal appears among them with relation to thefe two Articles, and the more remote they are from it, the more they abate in it, fo that in Siam and the more Eaftern Kingdoms, even the Priefts themfelves make no fcruple of eating Cows Flefh, provided they have not given occafion, nor confent- ed to their killing •, nor doth the opinion of the tranfmigration of the Souls prevail there fo much, as it does among the Benjans in Hindo- jlan, for the Inhabitants of the Eafl-fide of the Ganges grant no quar- ters to Fleas or Flies, that attack their Skin. I fhall barely mention, that among thefe Afiatick Heathens we meet not only with the grea- ter Deities of the Egyptians, but alfo with the lefler, tho' they are difguifed by other names, and fabulous circumftances, which however might be eafily clear'd up and reconcil'd. 2. It is obfervable, that twenty three Centuries ago, or according to the moft exact computation in the five hundred and thirty fixth year before Chrift's nativity, Ca?nbyfes, the Perfian Tyrant, fubverted the Religion of the Egyptians, kill'd their Apis, or holy Coiv, the Pal- ladium of their Worfhip, and murder'd, or exil'd their Priefts. Now if one confiders that the Siamites, reckoning their Soncarad, or Eccle- fiaftical Epocha from the death of their great Saint, their 2233-4^ year falls in with our prefent 1690th year after Chrift's nativity, it will appear, that the faid Epocha agreed with that time, and that it may be concluded from thence, that then a notable Prieft of Memphis, to whom they gave the name of Budha, Siaka, or the great Saint, fled with his Brethren into India, where he publifh'd his Doctrine, which was fo well receiv'd, that it fpread to the extremity of the Orient. 3. This Saint being reprefented with curled Hairs, like a Negro, there is room to conclude, that he was no native of India, but was born under the hot Climate of Africa, confidering that the Air in India pro- duces on its black Inhabitants none of that curl'd Wool, but long and black Hair, quite lank, and very little curl'd: And tho' the Siamites crop theirs, fo as to leave it only of the length of a Finger ; yet as it ftands an end like briftles, it is eafily diftinguifh'd from the woolly Curls Chap. II. The Hiftory j/JAPAN. 39 Curls of a Negro, and confequently it is more probable, that Bud- ha was of African, than of Siamite extraction. The Siamites in general are a plain and good natured people. Their Ecclefi^iskf Ecclefiafticks lead a fedate and auftere life ^ for they aim at a ftate «/ -W.. of perfection in this World, acceptable to Heaven and attended with eternal rewards, by fubduing their paflions, and mortifying their defires, purfuant to the doclrine and example of their great Mafter. They never marry, as long as they continue in an Ecclefiaftical ftate, but live together in Convents near the Temples. They go almofl naked, having only a cloth, or apron, of a dark yellow colour tied about their wafte, and another piece of cloth hanging down from the left moulder in narrow pleats, which in bad rainy weather they open and fpread over their moulders, and the upper part of the body, Their heads are never cover'd, but are fhav'd clofe :, in their hands they carry a Fan made of Palm-leaves, or {havings of wood. There are different ranks and degrees among them. (1) The youngeft call themfelves Dfiaunces, or Friars and ftudents of divinity, who after having attain'd the twentieth year of their age, and undergone a rigorous Examen, are advanced to the dignity of Dfiankus, or Fathers, on which ccca- lion there is a great entertainment given. The Peguans call them Ta- lapoi, which name becoming firft known to foreigners, they now be- llow it indifferently on all the Priefts and Ecclefiafticks of the Sym- bolic Religion in Pegu, Siam, Camboja, Jracau, Parma, Laos, Tunkin, and Cochintfina. (2) Dfiauku are the common Priefts or Fathers, who live together in Societies inhabiting one, or more, buildings like Con- vents near certain Temples. Each fuch Convent is governed by (3) a Prior, whom they call Luangwad, that is to fay, the Head of the Temple, or Sampan, the Noble. All the Convents in each province depend on one (4) Prahkhru, like a Bifhop, or Metropolitan. Thefe again as well as all the reft of the Clergy in the Kingdom are un- der the (5) Prah Sankara, as it were the Primate and High Prie(t # He lives in the Capital, and the King's refidence Judia, and his au- thority is fuch, that even the King himfelf is obliged to bow to him. Thefe Ecclefiafticks are not of a particular race, like the Brahmans, but every body, who hath a mind for it, and can obtain it, may turn Monk, and even married men may leave their Wives, and go to live in the Convent. The Ecclefiafticks, as fuch, and as long as they continue in orders, cannot be punifh'd by the fecular arm for any of- fence whatsoever. For this reafon they are firft degraded, and ftript of their Ecclefiaftical habit, before they are deliver'd up to Juftice. However out of refped to the Chara&er they bore, they are treated with much lefs Severity, than fecular perfons. And even fometimes for capital crimes the King will only banifh them to an uninhabited Ifland, call'd Coccatfian, where he alfo confines his Mandarines andMi- nifters of ftate, if they fall in difgrace. There are alfo Nuns among h -^ u them 4o thd Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I* them, whom they call Kanktfj, or Bagins, who wear fuch pieces of clcth like the Monks, but of a white colour inftead of yellcw. Thefe Nuns in former times liv'd among the Priefts near the Temples, but it having happen'd at a place a league above Jiulia, where the reli- gious of both fexes liv'd promifcuoufly together in the fame village, that feveral of the Nuns prov'd with Child, they have fince been re- mov'd from the Temples to particular Houfes, the better to keep their Vow of Chaftity. The Temple of that Place ftill bears the Name of Wad ISantfij, or the Temple of Nuns. Epacta of "jfe Siamites begin their Soncarad, or Epocha, from the death, of their great God Sammona Khntama, otherwife call'd Prab, and Bndba'. In the year 1690, when I was in Siam, they told 2234. They have like cydiv of ^ ie Chinefe a Cyclus of fixty years, tho' there be but twelve years that fatty ye*rs. bear particular Names, which being live times repeated make up the whole Cyclus. For the fatisfaction of the curious Reader, I will infert the Names of the twelve Years, as alfo the Names of their Months, and of the Days of the Week, as they were communicated to me in the Country. The Years are, Names of *• P'j? Tfoelat, The Moufe-year. their years. 2 . Pije Tfaloe, or TJlu, or Tfiahu, The Cow-year, 3. Pije Kaen, The Tyger-year. 4. Pije To, or Tao, The Hare's-year. 5. Pije Marong, or Maroni, The Year of the great Serpent. 6. Pije Maceng, or Mafeeng, The Year of the fmall Serpent. 7. Pije Mamia, The Horfe-year. 3. Pije Monte, or Mamij,' The Ram's-year. 9. Pije Week, or Wo ok, or Woak, The Monkey*s-year. 10. Pije-erka, The Chicken's-year. 11. PijeTfo, or Tfjoo, or Tgio, The Dog-year. 12. Pije keen, The Swine-year. Their Montis k appears by this Lift of the twelve Years, that Pije fignifies a Year in general. The Year is divided into twelve Months, which are Lunar, of twenty nine, and thirty Days, alternatively. Every third Year they tell thirteen Months, one of the twelve being repeated twice. The general name of the Month is Duan, to which word is added the number, as they follow one another, for the names of particular Months, as for inftance, DJmn Aey, the firft Month, Dfuan Gie, or Dzi, the fe- cond Month, and fo en, Saem, for the third, Sie, for the fourth, Ha y for the fifth, Hook, fir the (ixth, Tfet, or Tfiet for the feventh, Pet, or Peijt, for the eighth, which is told twice every third Year, Can, or Knau for the ninth, Sieb, or Sib, for the tenth, Siebeet, for the eleventh, and Sieb Song for the twelfth. The firft Month is of nine and twenty Days, the fecond of thirty, the third again of twenty nine, and fo they go 011 Chap II. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 41 on alternatively, fo that the whole year is of 354 days, and every third year of 384. They tell the days of the month from the new- moon to the full moon fifteen days, then they begin again at one, and fo go on to the next new-moon. This is the reafon, why fome Daysoftbi cf their months are of thirty, others of twenty nine days. Their week" confifts of feven days, which put in parallel with ours are as follows. Sunday, is by them call'd, Wan Alit, the Day of the Sun. Monday Wan Tfan, the Day of the Moon. Tu&fdav- •• ■" — Wan Angkaen, the Day of working. Wednesday Wan Poetb, the Day of meeting. TJjurfday Wan Prabat, the Hand day. Friday Wan Sock, the day of reft. Saturday Wan Saim\ the attracting day, ord of attraction, becaufe it attracts a new week. The Siamites celebrate the firft and fifteenth day of every month, TfcirF^i- being the days of the new and full moon. Some alfo go to the Pa- * ay ' gods every firft day of the quarter, which in fome meafure anfwers to our Sunday. They have befides feveral yearly folemn feftivals, as for inftance, one at the beginning of the year, call'd Sonkraen, another call'd Kitimbac, or Ktlmbac, that is to fay, the procefllon by Land, on which, as I have been inform'd, the King goes to make his offering at a famous Temple at Kapatbat, in a Siamiih Coach, drawn by men :, another call'd Ktinam when the King attended with a magnificent train goes by water to make his devotions and offerings at a ftately temple call'd Banibin, fituated below Judia, and according to the opinion of the common people to cut the waters, which about the time of this folemnity are higheft, and to command them to with- draw. Two others of the yearly feftivals of the Siamites are known by the name of Sabutfwian, which is as much as to fay, the feftival of the warning cf the Elephants, the Heads of thefe animals being on thefe two days waih'd with great Ceremonies. The beginning of the feftival days in general is by the Siamites call'd Kanpafa y and the end thereof Oppafa. It remains that I fhould fay fomething of the current monev cf the y.omyofst- Kingdom cf Siam. Tfiani, by foreigners call'd Katti y is underftood of"" Silver, being two pound and a half, or twenty Thails, or fifty Rixdol- lars, that is, double the 'value of a Katti, as it is current at Batavia and in Japan. The Tbail is by the Siamites call'd Tamluni, though there are none coin'd in the Kingdom. It is worth four Tikals. A Tikal by the Siamites call'd B.uit is worth four Af/wx, or thirty Dutch Stievers. Every Maas, or as the Siamites call it Slmi, or Sling, hath two Fuangs. Every Fuang, (the Siamites pronounce it Pbuini y or Pu- 3 an £) h atn tw0 Siatnpais. A Siampai, or Sapai y hath two Puininis. A L Pyninl 42 The Htliory of J A P A N. Book I. Pynini contains an uncertain number of Bijas, by us call'd Cotvers, being a fmall white, or yellowifh Shell of the Concha Veneris kind, which I have defcrib'd in its proper place. The Cowers differ very much in value j One may buy for a Phitang from 500 to 8co. They are imported in great quantities from the Maldive Iflands. All the Silver money of Si am is coin'd of Dutch Crowns, which are for this purpofe coin'd in Holland, and imported by the Dutch Eaft India. Company at feven millings the Crown. CHAP. III. The Author's departure from Judia, down the Rjver Mei- nam to the harbour^ and from thence to Japan. Tte^irtoi- /AN the fourth of July 1690 towards Evening, I went with the falls dou'ti th \^/ Captain of the Ship and others of the Company in a boat, in River JvUi" *■ „am. order to fall down the River Meinam to the Ship, which lay at an- chor two days Journey from hence, and four Leagues from the mouth Bambijn a of the River. Having made two Leagues we arriv'd at the famous P*5°* temple Banibijn, by Foreigners call'd the Golden Pagod. Every year, when the water is higher!, the King goes thither with great pomp and a numerous attendance to perform his devotion, and to make his of- ferings to the Priefts. The common people call this Solemnity Kti- nam, that is to fay, the Cutting of the water, from an erroneous tra- dition they have, that the King on that occafion cuts the Water with a knife in order to make it fall. It may be, that this cuftom ob- tain'd in ancient times, but at prefent there is nothing extraordinary in this Ceremony, befides the magnificence of the proceflion, which is made by water. On the fifth of July we proceeded but flowly by reafon of the con- trary wind, which gave me frequent opportunities of going on more and gathering fimples, I found there. Brt^olc. On the fixth of July we arriv'd at Bankok in the morning, having advanced but little all night, by reafon of the difficulties we had to ftruggle with. We found the old Fort, which lies on an Ifland, in good condition-, but the new Fort, that had been built by the French on the Eaft fhore, was quite demolifh'd. Before evening we reach'd the „ n , Dutch Habitation and Store-houfe called Amfterdam. which is but two Leagues diflant from the Sea. It is built according to the fafhion of the Countrey on piles of Bambous. Stores of Deer and Buffle fkins, j jr- 00 j were kept in lofts, but the red Wood for dying, call'd Faang, or as the Japonefe name it Tfiampan, lies in an open place, till Ships come to take it in, which happens every year, and the greater part of it is parried Chap. III. The Hiftory &/JAPAN. 43 carried to Japan. It comes from the Land of Coy, or Kui, belonging to the King of Siam, and fome alfo from Bambilifoi, fituate on the Coafts of Cambodia, and from Bimen, as the Dutch call it, which lies between Bali and Timor. This wood rubb'd with fome lime and water yields the fineft violet colour, one could wifh to fee. This mixture is faid to cure fome eruptions on the fkin. The Governor of this place was a Corporal, a Swede by Birth, and Core by name, I found him under fome grief, for having loft a tame Sitri Cat, which he found again to day, but in the belly of a fnake he had kill'd, and which, as he complain'd, had robb'd him before of many of his Hens, having been always lurking in Corners, under the Houfes. We had an accident with another fort of a thief, who at night had got under the Houfe, where feven of us Fellow Travellers lay together. He had laid hold of the Corner of a waftecoat, hanging through a crevice of the Floor, which was made of fplit Bantboous, and was pulling it through with fuch a force, that one of us awaked, who fufpe&ing a thief feiz'd it, and called to his fleeping Companions for help. While they were thus pulling and hawling, who mould have it, Core, who from former experience immediately fufpe&ed a Tyger, fired a Gun, and frightened him away. Me Nam, or Meinam in the Siamite Language fignifies Mother dfDefcriftloti of humidities, which name hath been given to this River by reafon of ' ' the abundance of its water, which renders the whole Country fruitful. For it is the only River in it, very deep, rapid, full of water, and broader than the Elbe^ but below Judia, down to the Sea, it divides it felf into feveral branches. The account, which the Natives give of its fource, differs from what is reprefented in our maps :, for they fay, that it takes its rife like the Ganges of Bengali in the high moun- tains of Imaas, where it fpreads it felf into feveral arms, which run through Cambodia, Siam, and Pegu into the Sea ^ and they pretend, that thefe arms are again joyn'd by feveral fmaller branches, not only with each other, but alfo with the Ganges it felf, if they are not rather to be look'd upon altogether, as fo many branches deriving from that very River. If it was not for the vaft pains it would require to trace out its feveral Channels, through the Forefts and Defarts, and to open a navigation, it might perhaps be made poflible for Veifels to go from hence into Bengale. I will not ftand to the truth of this ac- count ^ but as for what relates to the defcription of the River from Judia to the Sea, and the draught I have given of it, this wants no fupport} forasmuch as I have had fufficient opportunity, and lei- fure, to obferve it myfelf in failing up and down. In the Draught, which I here prefent to the Reader, (See Tab. VII.) I have mark'd the natural courfe of it, with its feveral turnings meafured with a large Compafs, its feveral branches, both where they feparate and joyn a- gain, the fituation of its banks, and adjoyning forefts, villages, tem- ple? 44 ^ The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. pies, and the new Forts lately rais'd in order to prevent the efcape of, the French General and his Soldiers. Remark.Me Several remarkable particulars are to be obferv'd in this River. PanUttfa s I# i t overflows its branches like the Kile in Egypt t tho' at contrary MeituHH. ' times, and by fetting the Country under water, renders it fruitful. This overflowing begins with the Month of September or fooner, when the Sun entring the Tropick of Cancer, by its approach diffolves the Snow on the high Mountains to the North. To this alfo contri- butes not a little the rainy Seafon, which falls in with that time, and is obferv'd in all Countries fituate between the two Tropicks, when the Sun partes over the Heads of their Inhabitants. A moft remark- able Inftance of the Wifdom and Goodnefs of the Omnipotent Crea- tor. In December the Waters begin to fall by degrees, and at laft con- tine themfelves to their former Channel. 2. Tho' the Water in the Earth appears upon digging the Ground to be regularly level with the River- water, yet it is obferv'd to rife fooner, and to flow over the Surface of the Land, even before the River begins to fwell, or can let any Water run over the Banks into the flat Country. 3. All the Water that appears upon digging the Ground hath a ni- trous, not a fait, tafte all over the Country, and is confequently not fit for drinking, whereas the River-water, tho' muddy, yet is always fweet, fit for drinking and wholefome. 4. Whereas all Waters naturally run towards the Sea, as lying lowefl, with refped to the Land, yet it is obferv'd, that this Inundation does not fo much affect, the Country near the Sea-more, as it does the up- per and middle Parts of the Kingdom. 5. The Waters by overflowing the Fields that are fown, make the Rice grow fo quickly, that the Stalks grow as fait as the Water rifes, and the Ears keep above the Surface, which when ripe, are cut off by the Reapers in Boats, and gather'd, but the Straw, which often is of an incredible length, is left in the Water. 6. When the Waters fall and return to their former Channel, which happens about the beginning of the North Seafon, as it is call'd, when the Northerly Winds drive the Water down, and forward its running off", they are apprehenfive, that a great mortality will enfue among Men and Cattle, to avert which Calamity a folemn Feftival is kept throughout the whole Country, in order to appeafe the deftroying Spirits, which remain after the Water is run off. The Ceremonies are lighting paper Lanthorns near the chief Temples, in the King's Palace, and the Houfes of Perfons of Diftincfion and the Priefts ringing their Offices or Prayers in their Convents. Our Europeans have obferv- ed, that if the Northerly Winds, which commonly blow very ftrong at that time, are not high enough to pufh the Water forward, and that confequently it goes off but flowly, there appears a flime left on the Chap. III. Tix Hiftorf of J A P A N. 45 the ground, the putrefaction and ill fmell of which is not unlike to be the occafion of the faid mortality. The banks of this river are low, and for the greater part marfhy, js a »h ofth yet reckoning from Judia to Bankok, which makes at leaft three parts M**** in four of the way to the Seafhore, they are pretty well inhabited. Along them appear many villages, the houfes of which are rais'd on piles, but built of poor flight fluff, and fometimes tine Temples and Habi- tations of the priefts, with abundance of Trees fome bearing fruit, fome not. But from Bankok to the Harbour there is nothing but Forefts, Defarts and Morailes j and every where there is plenty of Bambous, and Gabbe Gabbe, (a Shrub with leaves like thofe of the Palm Tree) furnifhing the Inhabitants with materials to make Houfes, Hedges and Roofs. Three forts of animals afford much diverfion to Travellers failing Mo»k,eys. on this River. Firft are to be feen incredible numbers of Monkey's of a blackifh Colour, fome of which are cf a very large fize, and fome lefs of the common fort, and a grey colour, which walk about tame, and as it were for pleafure fake along th<* more, or climb up the Trees, but towards evening perch themfelves upon the higheft Trees on the more in great numbers like Crows. The fhe ones hold their young fo faft on their breafts, that they would not let them go, e- ven when they were fhot down. They are fond of this part of the Country on account of finding their food there on large Milk Trees, call'd Tjaak, growing there in great plenty, with light green leaves of an oval lhape, and a fruit not unlike our Apples as to their bignefs and form, except that they feem comprefs'd, and are of a very harm tafte. The Glowworms (Cicindel*^) reprefent another fhew, which fet- Glowrms tie on fome Trees, like a fiery cloud, with this furprizing circum- ftance, that a whole fwarm of thefe Infe&s, having taken poffeflion of one Tree, and fpread themfelves over its branches, fometimes hide their Light all at once, and a moment after make it appear again with the utmoft regularity and exa&nefs, as if they were in a perpetual Syftole and Diaflole. What is remarkable in the third place, are the common Gnats, or Flies, which in the day time appear but fparingly upon the Gnats very water, but at night in fuch fwarms like Bees, that it is difficult to Z ''^™ w guard againft them. There is a fort like thefe in Rujfia, with which Travellors are pefter'd, but they are fmaller, have a lefs fling, and con- fequently do not hurt fo much. This Vermin renders this Journey by water, which would be otherwife pleafant enough, very trouble- fome and difagreeable. Qn the Seventh of July, being Friday, at break of day we left *- eutrn cx the River and the Land, and with a favourable North-wind arriv'd at U ^' eieht of the clock on board our Ship, which lay at anchor four Leagues from the mouth of the River in fix fathom of water. This harbour or road, is the end of a bay between the Countries of Cambodia and Siami M It 46 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book L It hath a foft clay at the bottom, and its depth is about five or fix fathoms more or lefs. Yonks and Ships unladen may by the help • of the tide come up as far as Bankok. There lay feveral Yonks, or Chinefe Merchant-fhips near the mouth of the River, where feveral marks were fet up to avoid the fhallows. Befides thefe there were fe- veral Fifher-boats, the Filher-men catching thereabouts great numbers of Fifh, particularly Rays, of whofe fkin the Japonefe make the fineft fort of work. The Fifher-men ufe alfo to fix pales in mallow grounds, where the frefh water mixes with the fait, or Sea-water, which they take away again the next day, when it ebbs, with fo many fhells flicking to it, as fifty people are able to eat. Being come on board we found the Ships Company, Officers as well as common Sailors, very much divided with mutual jealoufies, which diforder increas'd by their exceffive drinking of Lau, a fort of Brandy made in the Coun- try. The Captain, a civil and good natur'd Man, (a Chara&er, which is very rare among the Dutch Seamen,) forthwith took care to fet them to rights, by laying fome of them in irons, and prepar'd to fet fail the next day. On the 8th of July, when we were bufy with lading the lafl part of our Cargo of Hides, there came two Officers of the Dutch Facto- ry at Judia on board to review our Ships Company according to Cuflom. The wind blowing at South Weft from Shore, they left us on the nth, and return'd to the Shore in their boat, being faluted by us, with a treble difcharge of five Guns. With the faid Wind we fteer'd South Eafl, in order to get upon the Main, and to make ufe there of the Southern Trade-wind, with which we were to fleei North North-Eafl along the Coafts of Cambodia^ Cotfijn/ina, and China towards the Harbours of Japan. The Reader will obferve, that in thefe Eaftern Parts from Malacca to Japan, there are Winds conftant- ly blowing South and South Wefl for four months together, which time onjooHs. . call'd the South orWefl Seafon, or Monfoon, then again North and North Eafl for four other months, which is call'd the North or Eafl Seafon, or Monfoon. Between thefe two Seafons there are two months, during which the wind is always variable, fhifting from one of the faid quar- ters, till at length it fettles in that, which is oppofite. It happens however in fome years, that, to the great difappointment of fea-faring people, thefe trade-winds fix fooner or la r er than ordinary, by fome weeks. Thefe Seafons obtain alfo in other parts of the Indies, with this difference only, that according to the fituation of the Countries, the Shores and the Seas, the winds blow more or lefs conftant from Eafl or Wefl, for which reafon thofe months are call'd the Eafl or Wefl Monfoons. By thefe Monfoons all navigation in the Indies and Apt muft be directed. At this time the South Weft Seafon held on, under fa- vour of which we reckon'd to fleer our courfe, as foon as we fhould have got out of this Gulf or Bay. And fo we weigh'd both our an- chors Chap. III. The Biftoryof JAPAN. 47 chors foil of good hopes., in which however we foon found ourfelves difappointed, the wind coming about South, and contrary to our courfe, fo that with tacking about, lying ftill, weighing and carting anchor, the weather being variable, and fometimes very rough, we loft many days, advancing but little all the while. I mall avoid tiring the Rea- der with a tedious account of the different winds and weather, and other minute particulars of our navigation, as I fet them down in my Journal and Map -, and therefore I will give only the main fubftance in as few words as pofhble. On the 23d of July, being Sunday, we left the coafts of Siam, and Departure the mountains of Kui, and fail'd over this Gulf, fleering South Eanv ow On the 26th we faw a long and low Ifland Pulipanjang, bearing Pwftnjang. E. N. E. at fome few leagues diftance, along which we fteer'd our courfe. On the 27th we made the Ifland Puli itbi, which appear'd to *W* »&• be compos'd of high mountains, and feveral fmall Iflands. We left it on our' Larboard-fide about four Leagues off. On the 28th of July we faw the large Ifland Puli Condor a-head. It belongs, as well as the for- . , mer,- to the King of Cambodia, and is uninhabited, but provided with a good harbour and frelh water. We fail'd by it, leaving it on our Starboard-fide, about three Leagues off, and foon after difcover'd a-head us to the Larboard two Rocks, between which we fteer'd North Eaft, the wind continuing till then at South Weft. ' The 29th in the morn- ing we perceiv'd that the current from the River of Cambodia had carried us too far out of fight of Land, which endeavouring to regain, by keeping to the North, we found to be Tfiampa. We bore away Tjiamp*. fo violently with the current towards N. N. E. that confidering the uncertainty of depths in thofe parts, tho' it brought us very much forward, we refolv'd to drop, and accordingly came to an anchor, as foon as we found ground, and lay there that night. On the 31ft, we had at two or three Leagues on one fide, a very high and for- midable wall, which on the fir ft and fecond of Auguft became a little lower, reprefenting a bare, unfruitful and rough afpecf, which drew- off fometimes to the N.-E. fometimes to the N. We purfu'd our courfe along it, having no founding, with a gentle' wind and fair wea- ther, in the evening we found our felves a little beyond the Iflands Puli Cambir de Terra, at the end of the Country of Tfiampa, and at the fide of the Kingdom of Coffin Tfina i which we coafted along. On blr de Terra. the fourth of Auguft we came in fight of the Ifland Cantaon, which r . we left behind us in the afternoon. On the fifth we fteer'd N. N. E. with a S. and E. S. E. wind, to crofs the Bay of Tunquin. On the fixth of Auguft, the weather being calm, our Ships Company took that opportunity of fifhing, in which they met with good fuccefs. One with his hook, on which there was but a glittering piece of tin in- ftead of a bait, catch'd two Sharks, (Hayes, or Tuberones) of a mid- ling fize, and foon after one another, which by the help of a line &»™<>hfer- , vatlons made tied on Sharks. Sue kjug Flfi 48 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book I tied about their bodies were pullM into the Ship. This fort of Fiftl is very frequent in all the Seas of the Indies : Its full length is ten or twelve foot, and its flefh hard, and unpleafant of tafte. It is rec- kon'd the fierceft of all Sea animals, and a great enemy to mankind, , againft which failors are oblig'd to be very much upon their guard when they go a bathing. This is the reafon, why Athenmts calls it Anthropophagos, or the Man-eater. He hath a wide mouth, not in the foremoft part of the head, but a little lower, for which reafon he is obliged to turn upon the back, when he takes in food from above. Three things appear'd to me remarkable in them. 1. A ftrange~ fmall Fifh (ticking to one's fide, and holding the flefh fo faft with its mouth, that it requir'd fome ftrength to pull it off j this little Fifh the Sea- men call Sucker. 2. There were in one's belly fix young ones alive, each one fpan and half long. It is faid, that thefe young ones creep in and out of the old one's belly, before they grow bigger. I was not able to examine into the poflibility and truth of this allertion, the failors cutting and mangling it too quickly, and hurrying it to the kitchen. 3. In the back part of the head of thofe two Fifties next to the head there lay a good quantity of a white fubftance like Crabs- eyes wrapt up in a thin membrane, which they carefully preferv'd, as an approv'd remedy againft the ftone and hard labour in women. Soon after was catch'd by another, a very fine Sea-ftar, with nin e rays, which being not unlike that we catch'd upon the coafts of Ma- lacca in our voyage from Batavia to Siam, and which I have given an account of in my Journal of that voyage, I need not repeat the defcription here. But I muft not forget to take notice in this place, that this and the., preceedin^ days we met with great numbers of certain Sea-animals, which we might juftly call Icthyoihuria , or filhy Qualms, becaufe they are fomething like fifh, and alfo ferve for food for men. The Dutch call Starts. t k em £ ea Q ats ^ a f ter the name which is given them in the Country- Language, which implies as much. The fore part refembles a Poly- pits marinifs, provided as it were with fnouts, about nine in number of different length. The belly is quite empty, open above, and may be blown up •, the flefh is trunfparent without bones or nerves. If I re- member right, Boutins gives the figure and defcription of them, to which I refer, adding only, that between the jaws the mouth is cover'd with a membrane, under which are two black, thick and crooked teeth, one above the other, ftrong enough to break the hardeft objedt. Augufl 7th, Having hitherto fail'd to the North Eaft with a South, and South Weft gale, without feeing any Land, we began to take the height of the pole, as often as we were not hinder'd by the clouds, which on the eighth of Augufl we found to be 19°, 21 \ on the tenth 21 , 4'. On the nth, 22 , 13'. When we had taken this latter neight we 'difcovered a-head of us fome of the mountains of Fekien, a Pro- Fokim. vince Chap III. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 49 vince of China. On the 12 th of AugnftM the morning we found our felves two leagues off the coafts of China, where the faid mountains end, and at noon near a famous Sandbank, along which the Ships coming from China and Japan fail towards Batavia. We met here a great num- ber of Chinefe filber-boats and the men fiihing, and at a farther diftance I counted thirty four fail of them. A little before we were board- ed by a- Prarve, fent from a Chinefe Tonk, which ofFer'd us a parcel of Tobacco to fell. This evening we alter'd our courfe to avoid South Lamos, which we guefs'd to be near, being two or three low Rocks m ° tt mark'd in the Maps at 23 . 10'. On the 13th of Auguft, being Sun- day we difcover'd the faid Rocks, at a fmall Leagues diftance from us to the lar-board, and fteer'd by with the help of the current, Sea and Air being calm. In the evening we faw other fuch Rocks on the fame fide, which we weather'd in the like manner, and then fteer'd N. E. by E. I mention thefe Iflands and Rocks, in order to make the Reader fenfible of the danger of our Voyage, particularly in the night time, and in ftorms, and that our flow progrefs, and the changing of our courfe fo often proceeded only from caution. On the 14th of Anq^ujl, four fifhermen came contrary to what they ufe to do, with Hayes and Beggers on board of us : The goods they ha^ to offer us, being of no value, we bought none but difmifs'd them, after having given each a glafs of Brandy for their trouble. This civility invited others to us, of whom we took fome of their Fifh, for which they refus'd to take Rice, or Linnen, and rather took Brandy and Pepper, which made us conclude, that they are not neceffitous. They carried Water-melons with them againft thirft. Their drefs was, Straw-hats, and dark brown Gowns coming down to the knees, and tied with a fafh. They play'd ft range gambols, and made a noify chattering like the Malabarians. The altitude was this day 23'. 58'. in a place mark- ed in the Maps at 240. 10'. We fteer'd N. E. and N. by E. under favour of the current, the weather being almoft calm. The Coafts were low with a few Hills. This evening we found our felves over againft the River Kfianjio. On the 15th of Angufl things continu'd Kfi«»fo. the fame, and the Coafts appear'd like the day before. Before Sun-fet a Chinefe Wand appear'd in view, which the following morning being the 1 6th of Angnft we had left behind us, and fo we bid farewell to the Coafts of China, and fteer'd with the fame weather and courfe through the main towards Japan. About noon we were at the height cf 2 5 . 56'. on the 17th at 27 . 13'. on the 18th, 28°. 15'. This Day after morning prayers the wind ceas'd entirely, but a little after we had a fmall breeze from N. by E. and N. N. E. 'The following days to the 25th cf Auguft, the weather varied continually, there being fometimes high, fometimes but little wind, fometimes it was calm, and all for the greateft part contrary to our Voyage, fo that it feem'd the North Eaft Monfoon was fetting in earlier than ufual. So we were N oblig'd < r 50 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. oblig'd to tack about with great trouble, and fuch lofs of time, that what we gain'd one day, we almoft loft again another, as will ap- pear by the different heights we took then, which were on the 19th of Augitft 28°. 2'. on the 20th 28 . 42'. on the 21th 28*. 52'. on the 22d 29 . i\ on the 23d. 29°. 23'. on the 24th none, on the 25th, Gree»St,h--9°' 34*- During thofe days nothing remarkable occurred, except that fiance fioat- about the 27th degree I obferv'd a yellowifh green fubftance floating m l m - on t k e f ur f ace f the Sea, which appear'd for two days, the depth being fifty fathoms, and the ground being a fandy clay with Sea-weed. Strange BhJs. There came alfo for feveral days fome Birds of a black colour, which perch'd on divers parts of the Ship, and fuffer'd themfelves to be taken with the hand. One day a Woodcock was found among them. This day we had a dead calm and exceflive hot weather. Towards evening a violent contrary Wind rcfe out of E. N. E. which oblig'd us to fteer Southward, and pafs a very troublefome night. Remarkable On the 26th of Augitft the ftorm increas'd with thunder and light- ning. Having met with mallows at thirty two fathom, we took to the other fide to S. E. and S. E. by E. On the 27th of Auguft being Sunday, the ftorm continu'd out of N. E. by E. We found thirty fix fathom depth, and fteer'd to the other fid? to E. S. E. We took the height of the Sun at noon, and by it found our felves at 29°. 50% This evening at nine of the clock, a Chinefe Jonk, with all her fails, crowded and full before the wind, rufh'd by our board to put into fome harbour. The Seamen on this coaft have certain marks, by which they forefee an impending ftorm, and retire in time to the nearefl harbour they can make. On the 28th of Auguft the ftorm increas'd with fuch vehemence that before evening we were neceffitated to tie our rudder faft, to bring to the main fheet and mizzen, and to let the lnip drive. Some Cajan, (Indian Vetches) and Rice boil'd in Wa- ter were fet down upon deck for our dinner, but the toffings of the Ship were fo violent, that only two of the Sailors, who held the por- ringer, were able to fnatch and fwallow fome of it, but the reft had enough to do, to creep off on all four to fave our bodies. This evening we found fifty fix fathom depth. On the 29th of Auguft, the wind having turn'd that night to a perfect and furious ftorm, the tof- fing became intolerable, fo that there was no ftanding any more upon one's legs. We endeavour'd to make ufe of the rudder, but night ap- proaching foon oblig'd us to tie it faft again j but we were not much the better for it, the bulky waves beating with fuch force againft the Ship, that even before day break we were fain to take our fails in again, which began to be tore in pieces, to keep the rudder tied up, and to leave our Ship to the mercy of the two raging Elements. The fails were contrary to expectation brought in, taking a lucky oppor- tunity for it. But the ftorm and impetuofity of the waves ftill in- creas'd more and more, fo that every thing was like to be broke to piec«S Chap. III. The Hiftory &/JAPAN. 51 pieces. The Cramp-irons, and ropes, with which the Cheds were fa- de n'd breaking, the goods were thrown from one fide of the Ship to the other. It was refolved to bring to the mizzen, but when the tailors were about it, the wind laid hold of it, and tore it to pieces. What made our condition the more lamentable was the darknefs of the air, which befides was full of water, which to me feem'd to pro- ceed from fome other caufe, than only the rain, and the breaking o£ the waves, which the wind mix'd with, the air. We could not fee each other at half the Ships length, and the confufed noife of the wind, the Sea, and the Ship made it impoflible to underftand one another. The waves cover'd us like fo many mountains, they beat the Doors open without intermifiion, and the water run over Deck into the Cabin in fucli quantity, that all was fill'd with it; befides the Ship began to be leaky, fo that we were obliged to throw the water out with pails, and to add to the pump, which was continually playing, a fecond one. During this noife we, heard a continual thumping at the ftern of the Ship, as if all was to be ftav'd to pieces: We had no opportu- nity to find out the caufe of it till in the afternoon, when the ftorm fhifted to the Eaft, and then we faw, that the hinges of the Rudder were broke, the Cramp Iron pull'd out, and the Rudder draggling af- ter. This misfortune augmented the danger we were in, and though we endeavour'd, as well as we were able, to faften the Rudder to its Chains, yet the thumping continued with fuch force, that we had rea- fon to apprehend, that in a few hours the Ship would be broke to pieces and funk. All the while we were driving back to the S.W« and W. S. W. towards the fatal Iflands of China, a new formida- ble appearance of danger, which was (till heigthen'd by the great confufion of our Men, who would not hearken to the command of their Officers, who were as much diforder'd by ftrong Liquors as they them- felves-, For as no drinking water could be got out of the hold, and all their food was but fome boil'd rice, they were obliged to keep up their fpirits with Arrack and Brandy, which at lad fo diforder'd diem, that any fober man would tremble at the complication of fo many dangers. To compleat all, dreadful night came on, which however feem'd to be fo far more comfortable than the day-light, as it was to hide from our Eyes the Horrours of our impending deftru&ion. The mod important point was to fave the Ship from the terrible blows Ihe receiv'd by the Rudder, every time it was lifted up by a fwelling wave, in order to which either the Rudder was to be difengaged and taken in, or fome other method to be tried j accordingly the Ship's Carpenter with his affiftants went into the Cabin, provided with leavers, hatches, ropes, and other tools. They loofen'd tables and feats, broke through the hatches in the floor into the room under it, and being tied with ropes were let out through the Cabin windows. But all their pains for mending the Rudder were in vain, it was im- poflible 52 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book I. pofftble for them to refill the force of the many raging waves, and they were neceflitated to defift, and to lave themfelves, being throughly foak'd. Upon deck they were in the mean time bufy with hoifting a- nother mizzen which they had been mending and preparing all day long, and this they were obliged to venture, or to lefe all their mails in the night tirae by the encreafing mocks. The Captain, having watch'd a proper opportunity, gave a Signal, and it was hoifted with good fuccefs almoft in a moment. It was already three hours after Sunfet, and all that could be done that night, was to pump on and hope the beft. On the 30th of Auguft early in the morning the ftorm began to abate and the waves to fubfide, whereupon immediately the fprit- fail was brought to ferve inftead of a Rudder, with the help of which we fail'd Southward before the wind, and confequently without being much tofs'd, which put our Carpenters in a condition of repairing the Rudder, the matter Carpenter being let down on a Rope fix'd a new beam to the Rudder, and in fhort the whole bufinefs was finifh'd a- but noon, when the fky clearing up, the Cook was able to make a fire, and the Tailors took the height and found it 28 31' fo we hoifted fail again, and with a fair wind fteer'd N. E. On the thirty firft of Auguft, having thus efcap'd this danger, we were comforted at break of day, by the bright appearance of the Sun, though the wind ftill continued to blow very hard, and being after five days failing very hungry, and quite difpirited by the great fa- tigue, we were in expectation of refreihing ourfelves with a hearty meal and good drink, but our fottifh fteward, who feldom was fober when on fhore, and always drunk when en board, had drank all our wine to the laft drop, a fat Hog and all our poultry had died of the bad weather, and the Cook had nothing to give us, but boil'd rice, Cajan, or Pigeon peafe, and old Bacon, on which we feafted for want of better dainties in expectation of catching fome frefh fifli in the next cairn. The firft and mod laborious of this days work was to {train the fhrewds, which were fo flacken'd by the continual tolling in the late ftorm, that they were not able to hold up the mafiV, mean time others were bufy to find out the leaks of the ihip, though with- out difcovering any as yet. Some Bales of filk, and hides, that had been wetted, were brought upon Deck to dry, as were alfo our cloaths and bedding, which bufinefs took up the two following days. Our Courfe was to the N. E. and N. N. E. the wind being Eaft, and Eaft by North. The height at 29 20' and the depth in the evening 43 fathom. On the firft of September a leak was difcover'd under the kitchen, to ftop which the Ship was for fome hours leaned on one fide. There were ftill more leaks, which obliged us ftill to pump e- very Hour, but we could not find them out and judged that they were above water. I will not detain the Reader with a long account of the winds, but only tell in general, that they continued all along va- riable, Chap. III. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 53 riable, for the greater part contrary, fometimes a little favourable, which oblig'd us to fail very much by the wind, (as the Sea term is) and tack about. At noon we found 3c . 9'. of altitude, and in the evening 23 fathom depth. On the fecond of September we had go\ 20'. of altitude, depth 90 fathom. On the third of September be- ing Sunday, the altitude was 31 . 16'. depth 16 fathom. On the fourth of September, the weather being flormy, no altitude could be taken. We had from 25 to 32 fathom depth, the ground yielding all day long a white fand. On the fifth of September at noon, the alti- • tude was 31 . 15'. the depth in the evening 26 fathom. This even- ing feveral Sea-devils, or Rays, pafs'd by our Ship, being flat Fifties Se«-AtviU* two or three fathom long of an ugly figure. On the fixth of September, the altitude was 31°. 30% This after- noon we unexpectedly met with the mod eminent danger of a nature quite different from what we had experienc'd in the late ftorm. We Secwdfto-m, were fleering Southward with a gentle gale blowing from E. S. E. when behind us in the North we obferv'd fome lightning, and foon after huge hollow waves tumbling over each other, like fo many clouds, and with great rapidity rolling towards our Ship, which thereby was brought into fo diforderly and confufed a motion, that we almoft loft our fenfes, not knowing what to do or refolve on. For the waves of the Southerly Monfoon flanding againfl our courfe, and not permitting the Ship to run fwiftly, the wind being befides but gentle, and com- ing fo obliquely, the immenfe force of the oppofite huge waves muft neceflarily fall upon the ftern of the Ship. Two hours after Sun-fet two of thofe waves almoft at the fame moment, came from behind like mountains, and overwhelm'd the whole Ship with fuch force, that they bore her down deep under water, with all the perfons (landing upon quarter deck, of whom I was one, all thinking we were going down to the bottom of the Sea. This Ihock was attended with fuch a terrible cracking and noife, that it feem'd, as if the whole ftern was tore off and broke to pieces. Our Captain and his Mate, who were both above fixty years of age, as well as others, who from their firft youth had ferv'd at Sea, own'd that they never met with the like all their life-time. They look'd immediately after the Rudder, which they found entire on its hinges, except a few planks and other things broke off. The pump was alfo fet to work, but no leak ap- pear'd. But in the Cabin almoft every thing was deflroy'd and foak'd with fait water, and our drunken Steward almoft drown'd in his bed, tho' he lay under deck in one of the fafeft places. The deck was cover'd with water knee deep, and the tackling floated about. And tho* the holes were immediately open'd to let the fait water run out, yet it had already penetrated into the inmoft parts of feveral things, as I found to my great grief it had done into my Papers and writ- ten Memoirs. We had flood the fhock of fome more waves, when a O brifk 54 The Hifiorj of J A P A N. Book I. briik Gale arifing out of the North, attended with Rain and Storm, quicken'd the courfe of our Ship towards South and Eaft, and there- by fheker'd her againjft the fury of thofe monftrous waves, tho' with tcrrble tcfiing, which continu'd the whole night following, and all the next day, being the Seventh of September, tho' without ftorm, and by tolerable weather, fo that this danger was alfo over. It was remarka- ble, that this day the wind fhifted round all the points of the Com- pafs, and contrary to the courfe of the Sun. We found no altitude this day, but had from go to 40 fathom depth. On the eighth of Septe?nber at noon we had 31 . 11'. of altitude, and in the evening 42 fathom depth. The Sea was frill very rough, and occaficn'd great toiling, and a troublefome night. On the ninth of September, the al- titude was 31°. 5', depth from 42 to 48'. fathom. On the tenth of September being Sunday the altitude was 30°. 20% but no bottom to be found. This afternoon we were again tofs'd by Third fm»,. a violent ftorm out of the North. We were oblig'd to turn about, to bring to the lower fails, to tie up the Rudder, and fo let the the Ship drive where the could, tfufting' for the reft upon providence. On the eleventh cf September towards evening, the ftorm after having lafted twenty four hours abated, fo we hoifted the main fheet again, and made ufe of the Rudder. At noon we found 29 . 55'. of alti- tude, and in the evening 60 fathom depth j and fo we had met with three different ftorms between China and Japan, during which many of the goods had been damag'd by the toiling and tumbling about. There appear'd an unwillingnefs and difcontent among the Ship's Company, on ac- count of this troublefome Voyage, the rather becaufe there was but little hopes of reaching Japan, the North Seafon, which is contrary to our courfe, feeming now to be fully fettled and fixed j for this reafon it was refolv'd on the twelfth of September to let the Ship drive more before the wind, consequently with mere eafe back to S. W. by W. This day at noon we had 29 . 30'* of altitude, and in the evening 62 fathom depth. On the 13th of September early in the morning, when they were careening the Ship, it was obferv'd, that the clamps which are like the ribs and braces of this floating Body, were grown loofe in the accident that befel us on the flxth of September. This put both Officers and common Sailors out of heart, and made them quite tired with tacking about any longer. It was thought moft advifeable to make for fome harbour in China, in order to take in frefh water, of which we had not enough for one month more, and then to return to Batavia. Some PafTengers, and whoever elfe had any credit with the Ship's council, endeavouring to make them come into the propo- fal, the fame would in all probability have been approv'd of, had not the Mate ofFer'd fome objections againft it. As for my felf, having in my cuftody a Journal of a Voyage to Japan, which I had receiv'd .from a very good hand, I look'd into it, and found, that fome years before Chap. III. The Hi(toryoj JAPAN. 55 M»f/?ra<*. before a Dutch Ship was fafely arriv'd in Japan the latter end of September. So I went privately to the Captain, arid rirft left to his confideration, that the wet hides would hardly keep in the hot air of Batavia, without being fpoiled, and he afterwards be made accoun- table for that damage, as occafion'd by his Faintheartednefs and preci- pitate return. I afterwards fhew'd him the faid pallage in the Journal at which he was ftartled, and having read it thrice over immediately, alter'd his refolution without making any further objection. On the fourteenth of September the Elevation was 2cp 36', and in the even- ing we had from 41 to 46. fathom of depth. On the fifteenth of September we found the altitude 2cT 57' depth 36 fathom. On the fixteenth of September the altitude was 30 13' depth 38 fathom. On the 17th of Sep" tember being Sunday we found no elevation, the depth was 47 fathom. On the eighteenth of September, the weather being ftormy, we could take no elevation, the depth was 34 fathom. On the nineteenth of September the altitude was 30 31', the depth in the evening 45 fa- thom. On the twentieth of September the altitude was^g cp 3 6\ the depth in the evening 58, at night 70 fathom. This morning we kill'd a Dolphin, or Dorado, with a Javelin. Its colour was of a yellowifh blue, and its length fix fpans, the flefh of it was very delicious and acceptable to our fick ftomachs. On the twenty firft of September we attained 31° 30' of elevation, which according to the common maps is the Latitude of the rocky Ifland Matfima fituate in the Japonefe Ocean, which like a Hermes is look'd out for by fea-faring people failing to or from Japan. We faw it two Hours after we had taken the elevation at nine or ten leagues diftance, bearing N. E. whence we concluded, that it lies in effecl: a little more Northerly and near 320 degrees of latitude. A little before Sunfet this fo long wilhed for Hermes appeared at five leagues diftance to the Northward. Six hours after, the Moon ihining very bright, and the Ifland lying before us a league off on our larboard, we obferved that it cenfifted of a- bout feven pointed Rocks, being rough and bare, lying near each o- ther, daubed over in moft places with the dung of birds, fo that they appear only inhabited by Sea-mews, which we faw there in great num- bers. We made the fame obfervation two years after, when we failed by it in our return from Japan. We had the good luck to catch a- nother Dorado, and in the evening we found 78 fathom depth, the ground being a fandy Mud. On the twenty fecond of Sep- tember early in the morning we faw Matfima lying W. S. W. at a great diftance, fo that we could hardly diftinguiih it. Some time af- ter we obferv'd a Chinefe Jonk from Nankin, and next two more, which by the building we judged likewife to be Chinefe, all coming from Japan. On our larboard we faw the Japonefe Iflands Gotho inhabited W^^^ by huiband-men, and before it was noon came into our view the high mountainous Country before Kagafaki, the long expected Harbour, which at Sunfet we had at fix or feven leagues diftance before us, bear- ing 5 6 The Hiftory.f] A P A N. Book I. ing N. E. by N. We fail'd with a North Weft breeze and a few fails towards it, and on the twenty third of September at midnight arriv'd at the entry of the Bay in 50 fathom water. But the faid entry being fall of rocks and Iflands, which we were unacquainted withal and which it is impoflible to fail through at night, we tack'd about Arrival in f '^ morning came on, when we found 43 fathom of water on a fan- th Harhur of &y ground, and fleer'd towards the Harbour. But being all of a fud- den becalmed, we could not proceed, and therefore notified our arrival with firing five Guns, which were heard in the Dutch place of resi- dence two leagues off. Accordingly in the afternoon four veffels came out to us, with the faclors fent by our Superiors there, and accom- panied by fwarms of Japonefe officers, clerks, foldiers, and a chief in- terpreter, who came "to receive us, and to demand the writings, and letters, we had on board. After a fhort flay they left us, being fa- luted by us with feven Guns, and we follow'd them, though very flowly, the wind being variable, as far as the mountain calPd Papenberg, from whence we tow'd our Ship off by the help of cafting anchor, till we brought her within half a league of the City of Na- gafaki, and fo after having return'd thanks to the Almighty for his protection in our Voyage, we caft anchor at ten at night. We had had neither flck, nor dead, during our whole Voyage, ex- fiexM-d. ' ' cepting only the abovementioned fleward, who being denied any more Arrack, or Brandy, was the day before feiz'd with an Apople&ick fit, which foon render'd him fenfelefs and fpeechlefs, and threw him into convulfions, which a few hours after made an end of his life. He was otherwife an able man, the fon of a noted divine at the Hague, but by indulgence early fell into debauches and a diffolute life* We were no fooner come to an anchor, but we had two Japonefe Guard- fhips put on both fides of us, which all night long went the round with great diligence. All the Chinefe Jonks that put to Sea this day, were each of them attended with a Guardlnip, till they got out of japamfi pha- the Harbour into the open Sea. Not far from our Ship we faw a jure hats. f} eet f ^ pleafure boats coming to an anchor, being the ufual pom- pous train of a great Man, who had been on a voyage. They were built much after the manner of the Strubes in Ruffia, which are a fort of boats ufed on the Wolga in going from Mofco to Cafan. This little fleet made a fine fhew with its many lights at night, and in the morn- ing, when it failed, with its fails, half cf which were white, and the other half black, which they hoifled all at once. „ , On the twenty fourth of September in the morning we mov'd with Can anchor , % . „ „ r , n , xr mar Defms. a fmall breeze half of our way, and afterwards twenty Japoneie row- ing boats faflen'd to a rope towed us the other half as far as 200 paces within the City and our habitation. This Harbour is enclos'd Harlow of with high mountains, Iflands, and rocks, and guarded by nature againft **€«M?. t h e rage of the Sea, and the fury of ftormy winds. On the tops of the Chap III. The Hilhry of J A P A N. 57 the neighbouring Mountains (land Guard-houfcs with Guards in them, who with their fpying Glades are obferving whatever happens at Sea, of which they give immediate Information to the Government at Na- zafaki, and by this method they had notice of our arrival already two days before, being the 2 2d in the morning. Along the more, which is form'd by the foot of thcfe Mountains, which encompafs the Har- bour, there Hand divers round Bafticns, en which I obferv'd only Rails, or Palifadoes, painted red, as it were for Ornament's fake, but £iw no Cannon. Befides thefe, there are on both fides cf the City, not far from the fhore, on two Eminences, as many imperial head Guards, which are hung about with cloth for Ornament, as well as to hinder people from feeing the number of Cannon and Men, that are in them. When we pafs'd by them, we faluted every Guard with twelve great Guns, and after being arriv'd at the place afiign'd to us, we dropt anchor at about three hundred paces from the City, and as far from Defima, which is the habitation of the Dutch on a feparate Dtjltna, Ifland form'd purpofely near the more without the City. Then came to us, two Buggiofes, or Gentlemen of the Governors, fent by them Japanefe with their Commiffion, with many fubordinate Clerks, Interpreters and cor '" °" io ' ! ™' Soldiers, who called all thofe that were newly arriv'd, and made them riafs in review before them one after the other, according to the Lift 7 he "' ? T0 ~ r ,. , . . . . cedtires. given them, viewing every one from top to tee, and writing his name, age and bufinefs, with a pencil on paper. Befides this, about fix per- fons more were examin'd, every one in particular, concerning our Voyage, viz. from whence we came, when we fet out, how long we had been on the way, whether we did not land fomewhere, &c. and the feveral anfwers were carefully written down. Many queftions were ask'd upon the deceafed Steward's account, and the anfwers alfo taken down, his Breaft and the reft of his Skin were narrowly view- ed, whether there was any crofs, or other mark of the Popifh. Religi- on upon it. We obtain'd fo much by our repeated Inftances, that the Corpfe was fetch'd away the lame day, but none of us could get leave to attend it, and to fee where it was interr'd. This review be- ing over, Soldiers and Clerks were put into every corner, and the whole Ship with all her cargo taken, as it were, in poileflion by the Ja- ponefe. The boat and Ik iff was left to our Men, only for this day, in order to look to their anchors. But piftols, cutlaifes, and other arms were by them demanded, and taken into cuftody, which were follow'd the next morning by the gun-powder packt in barrels. In Ihort, had I not been before hand acquainted with their ufual procee- dings, I could not have help'd thinking we were got into a hoftile Country, or had been taken for Spies. I muft alfo remember here, that in our Voyage, as foon as we difcover'd this Land, every one was oblig'd, purfuant to an order from above, and ancient cuftom, to give his Prayer-book, and other Books cf Divinity, as alfo all Euro- P pean 58 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book I- pean Money he had about him, to the Captain, who, after having taken a memorandum of every one's name for it, pack'd all up in an old cask, and hid it from the Japonefe till our return. This evening they fent us from the Dutch Factory divers forts of Refrefhments, viz. Fowls, Eggs, Shell-flfji, and other Fifh, Radifhes with their Leaves, Turneps, Onions, frefh Ginger, Pompkins, Water-melons, white Bread, and a barrel of Sacki, or Japonefe Rice-beer. On the 25th of September, early in the morning, came from Dejima on board our Ship both Refidents, or Directors of the Dutch Trade, one M. Sweras, who was to be reliev'd by the other M. Butenheim his Succeflbr, but newly arriv'd from Batavia, with three Ships laden with Merchandize. All the Ships's Company having been call'd to- gether, they read to us the orders both of the Dutch Eaft-India Com- pany, and of the Governors of Nangafaki, chiefly to this purpofe, that every one of us, ought to behave foberly and difcreetly with refpect to the Natives, and the Laws and Cuftoms of the Country. A Paper containing thefe Orders, having been read publickly, was according to the Cuftom of Japan, put up on board the Ship for every Body to read. In the afternoon I went on ihore to Defmia, on which oc- casion one is oblig'd to take out a PafTport from the Japonefe Ship. Guard to thofe on lhore, and on the return another from the Land- Guard to that on board. Finding that the ufe of the raw Garden Fruit, that was fent us yefterday, had occafion'd to me great pain, I was oblig'd to haften back to our Ship, from whence I went on the 26th of Septe?nber with my things, to live in the Habitation aflign'd to me at Defi.ma. CHAP. IV. Of the Rmpre of Japan in general, as to its Situation, and, the largenefs of its feveral Jjlands. japawfe r | ">HIS Empire is by the Europeans call'd Japan. The Natives hsliames. JL. give it feveral names and characters. The raoft common, and moft frequently us'd in their writings and converfation, is Nipon, which is fometimes in a more elegant manner, and particular to this Nation, pronounc'd Nifon, and by the Inhabitants of Nankin, and the fouthern parts of China, Sijppon. It figniiies, the foundation of the Sun, being deriv'd from Ni, Fire, and in a more fublime Senfe, the Sun, and Pon, the ground, or foundation of a thing. There Chap. IV. The Hijiory of J A P A N. $9 There are ftill fome other names and epithets, which are feldom rnention'd in conversion, but occur more frequently in their writings. Such are for inftance. i. Tenka, that is, the Sitbceleftial Empire, as if it were the only one exifting under Heaven. Hence the Emperor is call'd Tenkafama, the Sitbceleftial Monarch. In former times this Name was peculiar to the Empire of Japan alone, but fince commerce hath made known to them feveral other Countries, they now condefcend to honour them alfo with the fame epithet, particularly fuch, whofe Inhabitants are admitted and tolerated among them. Thus they call the Empire of China, To Sin Tenka, the united Provinces of the Netherlands, known to them by the name of Hoi/an J, Hollanda Tenka. i. Vino Motto, is much the fame with Nipon, and fignifies, properly fpeaking, the Root of the Sim, Fi being the Sun, and Motto, a Root •, No, is only a particle, by which thefe two words are ccmbin'd together. 3. Awadfijfima, is the original name of this Country, and is as much as to fay, a Terrefirial Sewn IJland, Awa, fignifying Scum, Dfi, the Earth, and Spina an Ifland. This Name is grounded upon the following fabulous tra- dition recorded in their Hiftories, of the origin and firft creation of the feveral Iflands, which compofe this mighty Empire, which in for- mer times, for want of communication with other Countries, was look- ed upon by the Natives, as the only inhabited part of the Globe. In the beginning of the Creation, the fupreme of the feven firft celeftial Spirits, (of which more in the feventh Chapter of this Book) ftirr'd the then Chaos, or confufe Mafs of the Earth with a Staff, which as he took out, there dropt from it a muddy Scum, which running toge- ther form'd the Japonefe Iflands, one of which, of the fourth magni- tude, ftill retains this Name, being particularly call'd Awadfijfirna. 4. d Sin Kokf, or Camino Kuni, the Country, or Habitation of the Gods. For by Sin, and Cami, are denoted the Gods, which were par- ticularly and originally worfhip'd in Japan; and both Kokf and Kuni fignify a Country. 5. Akitfima, cr according to the common pronoun- ciation, Akitfujftma, is another name given to this Country of old, and frequently to be met with in their Chronicles and Legends. 6. Tontfw, the true Morning. 7. Sio, all, viz. all the feveral Wands fubjedl to the Emperor of Japan. 8. Jamatto, which name is alfo given to one of its Provinces. Several others, as Afijwara, Aftjvpara Kokf Qiia, or Wa, and fome more, I forbear mentioning to avoid being too tedious on fo trifling a Subjed. The Empire of Japan lieth between 51 and 42 degrees of j f5 fnuation. Northern Latitude. The Jefuits in a late Map of China, made and corrected by their Aftronomical Obfervations, place it between 157 . and 1 75 . 30' of Longitude. It extends to N. E. and E. N. E. being irregularly broad, tho' in the main, pretty narrow in comparifon to its length, which from one end of the Province Fifen, to the extre- mity of the Province Ofiu, is fuppos'd to be two hundred German Miles 6o The Hifiory of J A P A N. Book I. Miles in a {freight Line, all the further diftant Coafts and Iflands, tho' fubjecr to the Japonefe Emperor, not reckon'd. likfiGnatM- ^ ma - v ' n different refpecfs be compar'd to the Kingdoms of Great tain. Britain and Ireland, being much after the fame manner, tho' in a more eminent degree, divided and broke through by corners and fore- lands, arms of the Sea, great bays and inlets running deep into the Country, and forming feveral Iflands, Peninfula's, Gulphs and Harbours. Befides, as the King of Great Britain is Sovereign of three Kingdoms, its eHvlfi- England, Scotland and Ireland, fo likewife the Japonefe Emperor hath o». the fupreme Jurifdiclion of three feparate large Iflands. The firft and xibou. largeft, is call'd Kipon, from the name of the whole Empire. It runs length ways from Eaft to Weft in the form of a Jaw-bone, whofe crooked part is turn'd to the North. A narrow Channel or Straight, full of Rocks and Iflands, fome inhabited, fome uninhabited, parts it from the feccnd, which is next to it in largenefs, and which from its fituation, lying to the South-weft of Nipo?t, is call'd Saikokf, that is, the Weftern Country. It is alfo call'd Kiufm, or the Country of Hiine, being divided into nine large Provinces. It hath 148 German Miles in circumference, and according to the Japonefe it hath 140 of their own Miles in length, and between 40 and 50 in breadth. The third Illand lies between the firft and fecond. It is near of a fquare figure, and being divided into four Provinces, the Japonefe call it Sikpkf. Sikokf,- that is the Country of four, viz. Provinces. Thefe three large Wands are encompafs'd with an almoft unconceivable number of others, fome of which are fmall, rocky and barren, others large, rich and fruitful enough to be govern'd by petty Princes, as will appear more fully by the next Chapter, wherein I propofe to lay down a more accurate geographical defcription of this Empire. jfMvicled All thefe feveral Iflands and Dominions compofing the mighty "f ° 7 T A nBs E m pi re or * Jw 1 , have been by the ecclefiaftical hereditary Monarch, Siufmn, divided into Gokijitzido, as they are call'd by the Japanefe, or feven large Tracls of Land in the year of Chrift 590. Many years after in the year of Chrift 681. Ten Mu, divided the feven chief Tracfs . , into 66 Provinces, appointing fo many Lords of his Court to com- Sixty eight - L ° J Provinces, mand and govern them, as Princes, or his Lieutenants. Two more Iflands Iki and Tfuffima, formerly belonging to the Kingdom of Corea y having been conquer'd in the laft Century, and added to the Empire of Japan, there are now in all 68 Provinces. Both thefe divifions of the Japanefe Empire, tho' they fubfift till now, yet through the mife- ry of time its 68 Provinces have been fince their firft conftirution Six bun tire J torn into 604 leffer diftricts. In the firft and happieft Agds of the %'tisT Japanefe Monarchy, every Prince enjoy'd the Government of the Pro- vince, which he was entrufted with by the Emperor, in peace and tranqui- lity. The miferies of enfuing times, the frequent quarrels and contenti- ons, which arofe among the chief branches of the Imperial Family about the Chap. IV. The Hifiory of J A P AN. 6% the fucceffion to the throne, by degrees involv'd the whole Empire into blood and confufion. Its frinces efpous'd different parties, and no fooner were arms introduced among them, as the mofl powerful and fureft means to make up their difTenfions, but every one endea- vour'd thereby to maintain himfelf in the pofTeffion of thofe lands, whofe government he was owing entirely to the Imperial bounty: Such as had not been provided for by the Emperor, took care to provide for themfelves. The Princes divided their Hereditary dominions a- mong their Sons, who, though poffefs'd of but one portion of their Father's eftate, would not be behind them in grandeur and magnificence. What wonder then if the number of princedoms and dominions went on perpetually increafing. The Emperors of the now reigning Fami- ly, ufurpers themfelves of the throne, of which they are poffefs'd, think this great divifion of the Provinces of the Empire no ways detri- mental to their Government, but rather conducive, to make them the better acquainted with the true flate of their riches, and revenues ^ therefore far from reducing them to the former flandard, they (till tear and divide them more and more, as they pleafe, or as their Intereft requires, of which there are fome late inftances. The Province of Tfihifen was not long ago divided into two Governments Janagavea and Kurume and the Prince of Tfikungo had orders from Court to furrender part of his dominions to the Prince of the two Iflands above mention'd Jki and TfuJJima, who till then had nothing in pofTeffion upon the continent of: Japan. The, borders of this Empire are its rocky, mountainous Coafts, and a Its ^ r ^ ru tempeftuous Sea, which by reafon of its fhallownefs admits none;, but fmall veflels, and even thofe not without eminent danger, the depth of moft of its Gulfs and Harbours being not yet known, and others, which the pilots of the Country are better acquainted withal, unfit for harbouring of Ships of any confiderable bulk. Indeed it feems Nature purpofely defign'd thefe Iflands to be a fort of a little world, fe- parate and independent of the reft, by making them of fo difficult an accefs, and by endowing them plentifully, with whatever is requifife to make the lives of their Inhabitants both delightful and pleafant, and to enable them to fubfift without a commerce with foreign Nati- ons. Befides the feveral Iflands and Provinces already mention'd, there NeHhurhg are fome further diftant Countries, which do not properly fpeaking be- Countries f" b ~ long to the Empire of Japan, but either acknowledge the fupremacy of^rtrofja^n the Emperor, or live under his protection. Of thefe I think it necef- fary to give fome preliminary account, before I proceed to a more particular defcription of the Japanefe. Empire it felf. They are i. The Iflands of Rhtku, or Liqnejo, the Inhabitants of which ftile themfelves fubje&s, not of the Emperor of Japan, but of the Prince of Sat Junta, by whom they were fubdued and conquer'd. 2 Tfwfm, is the third Q, and 62 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. and loweft part of the Veninfula of Corea, which is govern'd, in ths name of his Imperial Majefty, by the* Prince of Iki and TfuJJima. 3. The Iiland Jefo, which is govern'd for the Emperor by the Prince of Matfnmai, whofe own dominions make part of the great Pro- vince Osju. Liqucju i- I. The Liqnejo Illands, as they are fet down in our Maps, or the flands. Iflands of Rhikn, as they are call'd by the Inhabitants, mult not be confounded with the bifida Leuconia or the Philippine Wands. They lie to the Southwell of the Province Satzwna, which is fkua-te up- on the continent of Saikokf, and the neighbouring Ifland Tana or Tanagafima, and according to our Maps reach down almoft to the 26°. of Northern latitude. If we believe the Japanefe, they are fo fruitful, as to yield the Riceharveft twice a year. The Inhabitants, which, are for the mod part either hufbandmen or fifhermen, are a good na- tured merry fort of people, leading an agreeable contented life, di- verting themfelves, after their work is done, with a glafs of rice beer, and playing upon their mulical Inftruments, which they for this pur- pofe carry out with them into the fields. They appear by their lan- guage to be of Chinefe extraction. In the late great revolution in China, when the Tartars invaded and poifefs'd themfelves of that mighty Empire, the Natives retired in great numbers, and were di- fpers'd all over the E.ift-hulies. Not a few fled to thefe Illands where they applied themfelves chiefly to trade, being well fkill'd in navigation, and well acquainted with thofe Seas. Accordingly they flill carry on a commerce with SaV&uma, and go there once a year. Some Centuries ago thefe Illands were invaded and conquer'd by the Prince af Sat&uma, whofe fuccefflrs flill keep them in awe by their Bugios, or Lieutenants and ftrong Garrifons, though otherwife by rea- fon of their remotenefs from $&tzuma the Inhabitants are treated with much regard and kindnefs ; for they are oblig'd to give their Sove- reign only one fifth part of the produce of their Country, whilft his own natural Subjefts, the Satzumefe are tax'd at two thirds. But be- fides what they pay to the Prince of Satfuma, they raife a contribu- tion among themfelves, to to be fent by way of a prefent, once a year, to the Tartarian Monarch of China, in token of loyalty and fubmiflion. They have like the Tunquinefe and Japanefe a Tiatri of their own, or an Ecclefi iflical Hereditary Monarch, to whom they pay great refpect, fuppofing him to be lineally defcended from the Gods of their Country. He relides at Jajatna, one of the chief of thefe Iflands, (ituate not far from the Ifland Ofima, which is of the fecond magnitude. Carta. II. Corey, or Cor&a, is a Peninfula, which fhnds out from Tartary, run- ing towards Japan, oppofi-e to the coafts of China. It , hath been, as the Japanefe relate, divided of old into three Provinces. That which is loweft, and neareft to Japan, is by the Japanefe call'd Tfofjn, the fe- cond, Chap. IV. The Hi(lory of J A P A N. 63 cond, which makes up the middle part of the whole Peninfula, Corey t and the third and uppermoft, which confines upon Tartary, Fakkufai. Sometimes the name of either of thefe Provinces is given to the whole Peninfula. The natives according to the account of the Ja- panefe are of Chinefe extraction. They ferved often and under diffe- rent Matters. Their neighbours the Tartars fometimes enter'd into al- liances with them, at other times they invaded and fubdued them. Mlkaddo Tfinu At, Emperor of Japan, profecuted them with war, but he dying before he could put an end to this enterprize, Dfin Gu his Keiift, a Princefs of great parts and perfonal bravery, purfued it with the utmoft vigour, wearing the arms of the deceas'd Emperor her Huf- band, till at lad (he made them tributary to Japan about the year of Chrifl 201. Sometime after they enter'd into frefh alliances with their neighbours the Tartars, and fo continued unmolefted by the Japanefe, till Taiko poffefs'd himfelf of the Secular throne of Japan. This valiant Prince, reading the hiftories of his Empire, found it recorded, that the Coreans had been fubdued by one of his predeceflors and made tri- butary to Japan: As in the mean time he was but lately come to the throne, he doubted not, but that he (liould get time fully to fet- tle and to fecure himfelf in the poheflion thereof, if he could fend forne of the mod powerful Princes of the Empire abroad upon fome fuch military expedition, and by this means remove them from Court and Country. He therefore gladly feiz'd this opportunity, and refolv'd to renew and fupport his pretentions to the Kingdom of Corea, and through this kingdom, as he gave out his main defign was, to open to himfelf a way to the conqueft of the great Empire of China it felf. Accord- ingly he fent over fome Ambaflador's to Corey, to defire the Natives to acknowledge the fupremacy of the Japanefe Emperor, and to give tokens of their loyalty and fubmiffion. But the Coreans, inftead of an anfwer, killing the Emperor's AmbafTador, by this hoftile aft gave him juil reafons to profecute them with war. Accordingly a numerous army was fent over, without further delay, under the command of fuch of the Princes of the Empire, whofe prefence he had the moftreafon to be apprehenfive of. This war latted feven years, during which time his Generals with much a do broke at lafl: through the ftrong opposition made by the natives, and their allies the Tartars, and after a brave defence made the Country again tributary to Japan. Taiko dying about that time, and the army returning, Ijejas his fucceflor or- der'd, that they mould once in three years fend an embaffy to Court, to acknowledge his fovereignty. Since that time they relapfed by de- grees under the domination of the Tartars, and drove the Garrifons left by the Japanefe, down to the very coafts of the Province Tfwfijn, the only thing they have now remaining of all their conquefts in Corea. As things now fhnd, the Emperor of Japan feems to be fatisfied, for* the fecurity of his own dominions, to be matter of the Coafts, the 6\ The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. the care and Government whereof he committed to the Prince of the Illands lid and Tftfmia, who keeps there a Garrifon only of fifty Men under the command of a Captain, or : Bug jo, as they are'- here call'd. And the Inhabitants are order'd to fend an embafly to Court, and to take the oath of allegiaiice and fupremacy only once at the beginning of every new Emperor's Reign. The Coafts of Corea are about forty eight Japanefe Water Leagues, or fixteen German Miles, diftant from the Ifland of Tfufima, and this as much from the continent of Japan. Numbers of Rocks and fmall Iflands lie between them, which tho' they be for the moft part uninhabited, yet the Japanefe keep ftrong Garri- fons in fome of the chief, to watch what Ships fail by, and to oblige them to (hew what commodities they have on board, as claiming the fovereignty of thofe Seas. The Commodities brought from Tfiqfijn are the bell Cod, and other Filh, pickled, Wallnuts, fcarce medicinal Plants, Flowers and Roots, particularly the '"Ninfeng, fo. famous for its excel- lent Virtues, which grows in great plenty in the Provinces of Corea and Fakufai, as alfo in Sramfdi, a Province of the neighbouring Tartary ^ this Plant, tho* it be found elfewhere, yet that growing in the Pro- vinces abovefaid, is believ'd far to excel others in Goodnefs and Vir- tues. The Natives have alfo fome few Manufactures. Among the reft, a certain fort of earthen Pots, made in Japij and Ninke, two Tar- tarian Provinces, were brought over from thence by the Coreans, which were much efteem'd by the Japanefe, and bought very dear. But of late it was order'd by the Emperor, that there fhould be no more imported for the future. The Boats made ufe of by the Tfto- neefe are very bad indifferent Structures, which one fcarce would venture further then Tfuffima. III. Jefo, or Jefogafima, that is the IJlatul of Jefo, is the mod Nor_ <-l * "-' them Ifland, the Japanefe have in poffeflion out of their own Empire. It was invaded and conquer'd, as I was inform'd in "Japan, by Jori- tomo, the firftG/fo, or Secular Monarch, who left it to the Prince of Matfumai, (a neighbouring Ifland belonging to the great Province Ofm ) to be by him govern'd and taken care of. Some time after, the In- habitants weary of a foreign Government, fell upon the Garrifon, the Prince of Matfumai left there, and kill'd them all to a Man. This ad of hoftility no fooner reach'd that Prince's ears, but he fent over a good Army with three hundred Horfe, to demand, and in cafe of re- fufal, to take ample fatisfaclion, and to chaftife the Rebels. But the Prince of Jefo, to prevent further mifchievous confequences, fent over an EmMffy to Matfumai, and to take off all fufpicion of his having had any intelligence or hand in the affair, he deliver'd up twenty of the Ring-leaders, which were executed, and their heads impaled, upon the coafts of Jefo. This ad of fubmiflion entirely reconcil'd him to his Superiors, but the Natives being; ever fince look'd upon as a ftubborn and tumultuous People, ftrong Garrifons are conffantly kept upon the Southern Chap IV. The Hiftofy of J A P A N. 65 Southern coafts of this Ifland, to put it out of their power ever to attempt the like , and the Prince is oblig'd to fend once a year, an Embafly to Matfumai, with prefents to the value of one Man- gokf. This Ifland lies in 42 degrees of Northern Latitude, to the N. N. E. right oppofite to the great Province Oofiu, where its two promontories Sugaar and Taajafaki running out very far into the Sea, form a large Gulph, which directly faces it. The paflage over to this Ifland is faid to be of one day, and it is not to be made at all times, by reafon of the currents, which run ftrongly, fometimes to the Eaft and fometimes to the Weft, tho' otherwife it be but forty Japanefe water Leagues, and in fome places not above five or fix German Miles diftant from the Coafts of Japan. It is faid to be as large as the Ifland Khtfiu, but fo thoroughly full of Woods and Forefts, that it produces nothing, which might be of ufe to the Japanefe, befides fome pelts and furs, which even the Inhabitants of the Southern parts of Japan have no occafion for. Nor do the Jefoans bring over any thing elfe but that, and the famous Fifli Karafaki, which is catch'd in great plenty about the Ifland, and which the Japanefe reckon a great dainty, boil- ing and eating it like Cod. As to its figure, I could not gather any thing pofitive, neither from the accounts I had from the Japanefe, nor from the Maps, I met with in the Country, they differing much from each other. Some reprefent it very near round, others make it of a very irregular figure, with large Promontories, Gulphs and Bays, the Sea running in feveral places fo far up into the Country, that one might be eafily indue' d to believe it compos'd of feveral different Iflands. I am apt to- believe, that the Country difcover'd by cle Tries, to the North of Japan, was part of this Ifland. I took notice that in fome of the Japanefe Maps, the South-weft and larger part is call'd Matfuki, but it was generally fpeaking fo indifferently drawn, that I fhould be at a lofs to determine, whether it be an Ifland by it felf, or join'd to the reft. According to the account the Japanefe give of the Inhabitants, they are a ftrong, but favage, People, wearing long Hair and Beards, well fkili'd in the management of Bows and Ar- rows, as alfo in tifhing, the greateft part living almoft wholly on Fifth They defcribe them further, as very dirty and nafty, but the truth of this accufation is not fo ftrictly to be relied on, fince they, the japanefe themfelves, are fo extreamly nice and fuperftitious in fre- quently waftiing and cleaning their Bodies, as to have found the very fame fault with the Dutch. The Language of Jedfo is faid to have fomething of that, which is fpoke in Coraa. Behind this Ifland, to the North, lies the Continent of Okujefo, as it is call'd by the Japanefe, that is, upper or high Jefo. That there J^A is fuch a Country is not in the leaft queftion'd among Geographers, but they have not as yet been able to determine, whether it confines on Tariary, or America, confequently, where they are to place the R ftreight 66 The Eijlory of J A P A N. Book I. {freight of An/an, or the fo long wilh'd for palfage out of the North Sea into the great Indian Ocean, fuppos'd that there be fuch a one, or whether it is clofely join'd either to Tartary, or America, without any intermediate flreight, or paffage at all. I made it my bufinefs, both in my travels through Mufcovy and Perfia, and during my xftay TheJnbtf's m J a P an -> t0 enquire with all the diligence, J was capable of, info Enquiries into ' thp true State of thofe Northern Countries, tho' iri the main to very \bl Northern ty*k purpofe, having hardly met with any thing worth the notice of Countries. the publick. At Mofcow, and at AJirakan, I fpoke to feveral people, which either in their travels through Siberia and Kataya into China, or during their flay in Siberia, whither they had been banifh'd by the Czar, and liv'd many years, pick'd up what few and uncertain infor- mations they could, but could learn nothing farther, but that the great Tartary is by an Ifthmus, or Neck oi Land, join'd to a neighbouring Continent, which they fuppos'd to be America, and from thence con- cluded that in all probability there is no fuch thing as a communi- cation between the icy Sea and the Indian Ocean. In a Map of Si- beria, which was made and cut upon wood, by one who was baniih'd thither, and the names of the places mark'd in Sclavonian Cha- racters, there were feveral considerable promontories, which from the eaflern Coafls flood out into the Sea, one of which, too great to be brought upon the table, was cut off at the edge. He that fhew'd me this Map, told me at the fame time, that according to the accounts which could be procur'd from the Tartars living in thofe parts, this very promontory is nothing but an Ifthmus, which runs towards a neigh- bouring large Continent on which it confines, but that it is compos'd of high, rough, and almoft inacceflible mountains, and that in his opinion, if ever there hath been a paffage there, for the firft Inhabitants of the World to get over into America, and to people that Continent, fuch another undertaking would be at prefent utterly impoflible. This Map of Siberia, fuch as it was, that is extream ill done, and without any fcale of diftances, or degrees of Longitude or Latitude, was yet the firft, which could give the Czar of Mnfcovy, fome, tho' very imperfect, no- tions of the great extent of his Tartarian Dominions to the North. And 'tis from the fame, my particular Friend, the ingenious Mr. Wi- nius, who was by the Czar appointed Infpeetor General over the Apo- thecaries and Druggifts Shops in Mnfcovy, made the firft rude fketch of his Map of RnJJla and Tartary, which he afterwards confiderably corrected and augmented by feveral accounts procur'd from different parts, and withal reduc'd to the neceffary degrees of Longitude and Latitude. He was not a little aflifted in this undertaking by Mr. Spies hary, Creek and Latin Interpreter at the Court at Mufcovy. This learned and mduftrious Man was, by the then reigning Monarch of Rufia, fent his, Ambailador to the Emperor of China, with fecret Or- ders and Initructions to fpare neither trouble nor expences, to get himfelf __. n i l . II. I I I. Chap. IV. The Hijlory of J A P A N. 67 himfelf acquainted with the true State, Situation and Extent of the G$ar*s Dominions. Accordingly he went to Vekln through the Nor- thern parts of Rnffia and Taftary, and having difpatch'd his bufinefs at the Court of China, return'd through the Southern provinces, and came back to Mofcow about the year 1680. During my (lay at the Court of Mofcow it fo happen'd, that he was to be our Interpreter, which brought me much acquainted with him, and fed me with no fmall hopes of learning fomewhat new and more particular, than was hi- therto known, about the ftate of thofe Countries, but I found him too diftruftful and fecret, and very unwilling to communicate, what obfer- vations he made upon his Journey. The late Illuftrious Kicolans Witfen ^ tco!aslf /{t f tn L.L.D. and Burghermafter at Atnjierdam, a perfon to whom the pub- lick is greatly indebted, met with much better fnccefs in his own Enquiries, for in his lad Embaffy to the Court of Mufcovy he did, by his extraordinary good conduct, great learning and affability, in- finuate himfelf fo far into the favour of the Czar, and the Grandees of his Court, that whatever accounts they had procured from all parts of Rujfia, were without referve communicated to him, which enabled him to compofe that excellent and accurate map of all the Ruffian Empire, and the great Tartary, with its Mountains, Rivers, Lakes, Ci- ties and Provinces, for the moll part till then unknown, a work which by reafon of its great ufefulnefs could not but highly oblige the cu- rious. But however accurate this map of Doctor Witfen s was which af- terwards prov'd very ufeful to Mr. hbrand Ides, in his Journey by land to China, where he went Ambaffador, yet the full extent of the Eaftern Coafts of Siberia, and the great Tartary, remains as yet undetermined, and we are ftill in the dark, as to what relation they bear to the neighbouring Continent, which is probably that of Oku Jefo. The Japanefe on their fide arc as little acquainted with the ftate Aauttts and extent of that Country, which lies behind the Ifland Jefo Gafiina,^^}, p Vt0 'f and which is by them calPd Oku Jefo. They fay only that it is 300 Ja- Ofc* 7f°° panefe miles long. But what authority they have to fupport this af- fertion, I cannot tell. A Ship having fome years ago been accidentally call upon the Coafts of that Continent, they met among the rude and favage Inhabitants fome perfons clad in fine Chinefe Silk, by which, may be very probably conjectured fome communication the Natives have with the neighbouring Daats, or Tartary, at leaft that thefe Coun- tries are not very remote from each other. A Jonk, which was fent thither on purpofe upon difcovery, about the year 1684, returned after having been three months upon her voyage, and brought the very fame account. An experiene'd Japanefe Pilot, who was well acquain- ted with the Seas about Japan, as having been every where round this Empire, upen my enquiry could give me no other fatisfactory an- fwer, but that between Japan anh Jefogafima the Currents run alter- natively, fometimes Eaft, fometimes Weft, and that behind Jefogafima, there 68 The Hiftory o/JAPAK Book I. there is only one, which runs conftantly, and dire&ly, North, whence he concluded, that near Daats, fo they call Tartary, there muft be fome communication with another Sea to the North. A few years ago another Imperial Jonk was fent out in queft of thofe Countries. They fail'd from the Eaftern Coafts of Japan, and after many trou- bles and incommodities endur'd between 40 and 50 degrees of Nor- thern Latitude, they difcover'd a very larq;e Continent, fuppos'd to be America, where having met with a good harbour, they ftaid there during the Winter, and fo return'd the next year, without any the leaft account of that Country, or its Inhabitants, excepting only, that it run further to the North-weft. Since that time it was refolv'd at the Court of Japan to be at no further pain, or expence, about the difcovery of thofe Countries. I was little the better for confulting the Japanefe Maps of thofe Seas, tho* I faw feveral of them in different places, as at Jedo, in the palace of TfuJJimaM Cami, Governor of Nagafaki, in the Temple of Symmios near Ofacca y and in feveral other Temples. They all reprefent a large Continent, which ftands out from the great Tartary, and extends it felf behind the Ifland Jefogaflma, reaching a- bout 15 degrees of Longitude further Eali, than the Eaftern Coafts of Japan. A large fpace is left empty between it, and the neighbouring America. The Country itfelf is divided into the fol- lowing Provinces, mark'd with their common writing Characters, Ka- berfari, Orankai, Sitfij, Ferofan and Amarifi. Between the two laft Pro- vinces is mark'd a confiderable River, which lofes it felf into the Sea, behind the Ifland Jefo to the South-eaft. But as all their Maps are very indifferently done, without any fcale of diftunces or degrees, and as befides the Names of the Provinces abovemention'd are only in their Canna, or common Writing, and not, as other more authentick Records, in. their Sifi, or fignificant Characters, I fhall leave to the Reader's own Judgment to determine, how much there is to be depended upon them. And this is all I could learn in Japan about the State of thofe Countries, which lie to the North of this Empire. Before I leave off this general Geographical Defcription of the Japanefe Cold mi Empire, I muft not forget to mentkn two other Iflands, which lie fur- Sitver I/lands* thex off to the Eaft, or E.N. E. of the Coafts of Ofm, at leaft at 150 Miles diftance, but as the Japanefe pretend, belong to their Empire. They have given them very high founded Names, the fmaller, more Northern, and more remote from Japan, being call'd Ginfnna, the Sil- ver Ifland, the larger, and nearer Kinjima, the Gold Ifland. They keep their flute and fituation very fecret from all Foreigners, chiefly the Europeans, for as much as their rich Names have already tempted them to go in queft thereof. The King of Spain having been inform'd that they lie Weftwards of America, in that part of the World, which by the Pope's divifion was afllgn'd to him, as all thofe Lands, which fhould be difcover'd from the Eaft, were to the King of Portugal, fent out Chap. IV. The Hijlory of J A P A N. 6 9 out a very expert Pilot to look for them about the year 1620. But this voyage prov'd unfuccefsful. The Dutch attempted the fame at dif- ferent times with no better fuccefs. They fitted out one (hip for that purpofe at Batavia in 1639, an( ^ two others in 1643, which had orders to go further, and to attempt the difcovery of the Coafts of Tartary and America. The voyage of thefe two mips, one of which was call'd Bresken, the other the Caflrecoom, prov'd very unfortunate. For befides that they fuffer'd much by Storms, the Captain of the Bresken having hazarded himfelf on more, with fome of his fhip's company, in a port of Japan lying under the 40 Degree of Northern Latitude, they Were all feiz'd upon, put in Irons, carried Prifoners to Jedo, and fo barbaroufly treated, as if their intention had been to betray or to invade the Empire. About the year 1675, the Japanese accidentally difcover'd a very large bifcovery Ifland, one of their Barks having been forc'd there in a Storm from the jn^ ev> Ifland Fatsifio, from which they computed it to be 300 Miles diftant towards the Eaft. They met with no Inhabitants, but found it to be a very pleafant and fruitful Country, well fupplied with frefh water t and furnifhed with plenty of plants and trees, particularly the Arrack- Tree, which however might give room to conjecture, that the Ifland lay rather to the South of Japan, than to the Eaft, thefe trees grow- ing only in hot Countries. They call'd it Bunejima, or the Ifland Bum, and becaufe they found no Inhabitants upon it, they mark'd it with the character of an uninhabited Ifland. On the fhores they found an incredible quantity of Fifh and Crabs, fome of which were from four to fix foot long. \ Fatfifio, I juft now had occafion to mention, or Fatfifio Gafima, which .» j Fat n is as much as to fay, the Eighty Fathom Ifland, is the mofr re-Jjo. mote Ifland the Japanefe have in poffefTion Southward. It lies under the fame Meridian with Jedo, and is reckon'd to be about 80 Japa- nefe Water-leagues diftant from the Continent 6f Japan, being the furthermoft of a long row of fmall Iflands, almoft contiguous to each other. It is the chief Ifland, where the great Men of the Emperor's Court, when out of favour, are ufually confined, purfuant to a very ancient cuftom, and kept prifoners on a rocky Coafl, from the extraor- dinary height of which the whole Ifland hath borrow'd its name. As long as they continue on this Ifland, they rauft work for their live- lyhood. Their chief amufement is weaving, and fome of the filk fluffs wrought by them, as they are generally Men of ingenuity and good underftanding, are fo inimitably fine, that the Emperor hath forbid under fevere penalties, to export, or to fell them to foreigners. This Ifland, befides it being wafh'd by a rough tempeftuous Sea, is fo well guarded by nature itfelf, that when there is fome provifion of the common neceffaries of life, or fome new Prifoners to be brought in, or the guard to be reliev'd, the whole Boat, with all the lading, mull S be 'O The Hiftorj o/JAPAN. Bock I. be drawn up, and again let down by a crane, the coafts being fo fteep and rocky, as to admit of no other accefs. CHAP. V. The ^Divifion and Sub-divifion of the Empire of Japan into its feveral 'provinces ; as alfo oj its Revenue and Government. Crown Lands. DhHhm of X ^ ^ e g enera l Geographical Defcription of Japan, which I have the Empire of laid down in the preceding Chapter, I took notice that this Empire Japan. \12nh. been divided into feven great Tra&s of Land, which were again fub-divided into 68 confiderable Provinces, and thefe into 604 fmaller Diftricls, or Counties, as one might call them. I proceed now more particularly to confider the largenefs, extent^ fertility, produce and revenues of each Province, as I found them in a Japanefe defcription of this Empire, publim'd in Japan, by the title of Sitzi Jojfu. But before I proceed to a particular confideration of the feven large Tracls of Land, which the Empire of Japan hath been divided into, and of their feveral Provinces, I mail take notice of the Gokinai, or Gokinai goka Kokf, that is the five Provinces of the Imperial revenues, fo call'd, becaufe all the revenue, of thefe live provinces is parti- cularly appropriated for the fuppcrt and maintenance of the Imperial Court. They amount to 148 Man, and 1200 Kokf of Rice. The Reader is defir'd to obferve in general, that all the revenues in this Country are reduc'd to thefe two rpeafur.es in Rice. A Man contains icooo Kokf, and a Kokf 3000 bales or bags of Rice. Thefe five Im- perial Provinces are 1. Jamajljro, otherwife Sanfju : It is a large and fruit- ful Country. Its length from South to North is a hundred Japanefe Miles } and there are feveral gocd towns and other peaces of note within its compafs. It is divided mto 8 diftrids, Otokuni, Kadono, Okongi, Kij, Udfi, Kt/fie, Sakanaka, and Tfukngi. 2. Jamatto, or Wosjn, is like- wife a very good Country, and much of the fame length with the former going from South to North. It had formerly feveral places of note within its >: mpafs, which are at prefent reduced to a very fmall number. It is divided into 15 diftri&s, Soono Canti, Soonofimo, Feguri, Firole, Katzu-DJ'.'?:: T'ltfrnge., Okuno Umi, Utz, Jofino, Uda, Sikino Si- mo, Sik'mo Ca?ni, Takaiid-z, Tooidz and fanmianobe. 3. Kawatzij, or Kaftu, a tolerable good Countrv, about two days Journeys in length, and divided into 1 5 difiri&s. tJiftori, I^kawa., Fukaitz, Jaskabe, Ookake, Tnkajatz, Kacpats,, Sarara, Umbarada, Katanno, Wakaje, Sibukaja, Sick, Tanbokf, Jamajljro, Jamatto. Kawatfy. Chap. V. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 71 Tanbokf, and Taiwan. 4. Idfiwii, or Sensju, is a very large Country, Ufi""'- but indifferently fruitful. Its length is an hundred Japanefe miles from South to Well. It is border'd on one fide by the Sea, on the other by a ridge of high Mountains. It is plentifully fupplied with Fifth by the neighbouring Sea : It produces alfo fome buck-wheat, rice, peafe and beans, though but few, and not of the beft fort. It hath but 3 fmaller diftricls, Ootor? y Idfume, and Fine. 5. Sitzu, other- Stn». wife Tfmokuni, and Sisju. It hath two days Journey and a half in circumference. It is the furthermoft Country Weftwards on a large Gulph. The Southern parts of it are very warm, but the Northern colder, and abound more in what they call Gokokf, which are the five chief forts of peafe eat in this Country. It affords alfo fome fifh, and fait, and is in the main a very good Country. It is divided into 13 diftricls, Sijjos, or Sj/fnmios, . Kittatz, Fingajjinai, Nifijnari, Jatfan, Simajimo, Simakami, Tefipna, Kawanobe, Muko, Awara, Arbna^ and Nojje. I proceed now to the VII. large tracts of Land, which the Japa- Seven gnat nefe Empire hath been divided into by the Emperor Siufmn. trails of Land. I. The firft is Tookaido, that is, the South Eaftern, TraB. I have ob- tooKMDO.. ferved above, that the faid feven large tradls have been by the Empe- ror Tenmu further divided into 68 Provinces, the five Provinces above mention'd included, to which fome hundred years after two more were added. The Tookaido confifts of 15 of thefe 68 Provinces, which are \.Iga, otherwife Ifju, which is limited on the South and Eaft by the Sea. ig«„ To the North it is feparated from the neighbouring Provinces by a ridge of high mountains. It is a hot Country, but indifferently fruit- ful, producing fome Plants, Trees and Bambous. It is divided into four diftricls, Aije, Namanda, Iga and NabarL 2. IJie, otherwife Sefjti, is three jr ie day's Journeys long, going from South to North. It is almoft wholly encompafs'd by the Sea, but extreamly fruitful, with an agree- able variety of hills and plains. It is divided into 1 5 diftricls, Quana y Afaki, S?ifuka, Itfip y Aanki, Taato, Nifikijima, Gofafuma, Inabe, Mije, Ano, Itaka, Watakei, Ino, and Taki. 3. SJttnA or, Si/io, is but a fmall cr 1ma ^ Province, which one may travel a-crofs in half a day's time. It is a very barren Country, but the neighbouring Sea fupplies it plentifully with fifh, oyfters, (hells and the like. It hath but three diftricls, Toofij, Ako, and Kamejhna. 4. Orvari, otherwife Bifiu, is an inland Country, n vaf ^ entirely feparate from the Sea, but one of ihe moll: fruitful Pro- vinces of the whole Empire, and richly ftock'd with Inhabitants. It is three day's Journeys long, going from South to North, and divided into nine diftricls, Amabe, Nakajfiva, Kdquuri, Nirva, KaJJungale, Ja- mada y Aitfi y Tfota, and Toofjnolji-i. 5. Mikawa, otherwife Mifm, is jsktesA a very barren and poor Country, with too many (hallow Rivers and Ponds, which are very prejudicial to the growth of the Gokokf. It is one day's Journey and a half long, going from Eaft to Weft, and di- vided 72 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Etck I. vided into eight diftri&s, Awowni, Kamo, Nukada, Batz, Fori, J ana, Tfi- Tootomi. tarra, and Akumi. 6. Tootomi, otherwife Jenfju, a very good and fruit- ful Country, and one of the pleafanteft Provinces for a curious varie- ty of Hills, Rivers, fertile Plains, Towns and Villages. Its length is fuppos'd to be two days Journey and a half, going from Eaft to Weft, and it is divided into 14 diftricts, Fammana, Futz, Frmfa, Aratama, Nangakami, NagaJJimo, Sutz t Jammana, Kikoo, Faifara, Tojota, Jamaka^ Sunmgo. San/10, and Jwata. 7. Swunga, or Sinfju, deferves likewife to be commended for the variety of its Towns, Villages, Hills and fruit- ful Plains. It is of the fame length with Tootomi, going from Eaft to Weft, and divided into feven diftricls, Tfta, Mafiafn, Udo, Itabe, K»i Rofarra, Fnfij and Suringa. 8. Kai, otherwife Kaifu, and Ksjoohu. is a flat Country, and aboun Is in Rice, Fields and Pafturage, Plants and Trees. It breeds alfo fome Cattle, chiefly Horfes. It is two days Journeys long from South to North, and divided into four di- Itf"-. ftricls, famanajjiro, Jaatzfiro, Coma and Tfur. 9. Idfu, or Toofj it, a long Peninfula, being almoft furrounded by the Sea. It affords a large quan- tity of fait, and all forts of fifh, and is reckon'd in the main a tole- rable good Country. It is pretty mountainous, with fome flat ground, and fome few rice fields. It hath but 3 diftrids upon the Continent of Nipon, Takato, Kaka } and Camo, whereto are added two neighbour. Sangami. j n g Iflands, Oofima, and Firakafima. 10. Sangami or Soojiu, is three days Journeys long, a flat and barren Country, which affords hardly any thing for the fuftcnance of human life, but Tortefles, Fifh and Crabs from the Sea, befides a good quantity of timber out of its large woods. It is divided into 8 diftri&s Afikaranno Cami, Afikaranno Simu Mtfali.. Oojhni, furingi, Ajikoo Takangi, Camakwa, Mijura, and 'fefima. 1 1 Mu- fafi, or Bufiu, a very large Province having five days Journeys, and a half, in circumference. It is a flat Country, without woods and mountains, but very fruitful, abounding in Rice, Gokokf] Carder fruits, and Plants. It is divided into 21 diftricls, which are Kuraggr, Tfiikuki, Tama, Tat- finbana, Kaikura, Inima, Tofma, Fijki, JoliGtfi. Saitama, Kodama, Tjibu Sima, Fabara, Fafifawa, Naka, Kami, Adacs, Tfitfubu, Jebara, Totefima, jlwa^ and Oofato, 12. Awa, otherwife Foofru, a middling good Country with mountains, hills, rivers, and plains, affording both rice and cornj It is tolerably well inhabited and plentifully fupplied by the neighbouring Sea with fifh and oyfters, whofe fhells the inhabitants make ufe of to manure their ground. It is one dav's Journey and a half long from South to North and divided into four diftri&s, Fehiri, Aw a, Afaima, and Nakaba. 13. Kadfnfa, otherwife Koofjn is 3 days Journeys long, Kadfrfa. g j n g f rom South to North, a tolerable gocd Country, though not with- out high rough mountains, great numbers of tV Inhabitants get their livelyhood by weaving of Cannib or Hempjlnffs, which they under- hand very well. It is d ; v. J into II diftri&s, Sfuffu, Amafa, Itfuwara t Umingami, Foiko, Adooki, IJJim^ Farinib, Nagawa, Jammanobe, and Muf- fa. Chap. V. The Hijlorj of J A P A N. 73 Mufi'a. 14. Simoofa, otherwife Seosju, is faid to be three day's jour- £i»Ma. neys long going from South to North, a mountainous Country, indif- ferently fruitful, but abounding in Fowls and Cattle. It is divided into 12 diftrids, Kaddofika, T/ibba, hnba, Sooma, Sas]wna, Iimki Tooddt, Koofa, Unagami, Katori, Fannibu, and Okanda. 15. Fitats, or Sjoo y Fitats. a very large Province ; my Author makes it almoft fquare, and fays that it is three day's Journeys long on each fide. It is but a mid- dling Country, as to its fruitfulnefs, but produces a great quantity of Silk-worms and Silk, of which there are feveral Manufactures eftablifh'd there, as there are alfo of fome other Things, the inhabi- tants being a very induftrious people. They likewife carry on a trade with Cattle. It hath 11 diftrids, Nijbari, Makaije, Tfukkumka, Kaivaats, Sfuia, Umbaraki, Namingata, Naka, Kiifji, Taka, and Iengoko. Iengoko figniries a diftant Country, by which is probably meant fome neigh- bouring Iiland. The revenues of thefe 15 Provinces of the firft large Tract call'd Tookaido, amount in all to 494 Mankokf. II. Toofando, that is, the Eaftern mountainous Tract, hath 8 large Pro- TOOSANDO. vinces within its compafs, which are 1. Oomi y an extraordinary good Oom \, and fruitful Country, with variety of mountains, hills, rivers and fruitful fields, producing both rice and corn, and affording to the La- bourer a thoufand-fold reward, (according to my Japanefe Author's way of exprefling the fruitfulnefs of this Country). It hath three day's Journeys and a half in circumference, and is divided into 13 diitricts, Singa, Karimotto, Ins, Cammoo, Kanfaki, Inungami, Sakatta, 'Jetz., the upper and lower AfJ'ai, buito, Takaffiftia, Kooka and "Joofit- ■zumi. 2. Minp, or Diofiu, is not inferior to the former, neither in an Mnc> - agreeable variety of hills and plains, nor in fertility, producing plenty of Rice, Corn, and Gokokf, and other neceilaries of life. It is three day's Journeys long from South to North, and divided into 18 diftrids, Ifijntfu, Fitfa, Aivad/i, Ikenda, Oono, Mottos, Mufsijroda, Ktr takata, Atfumi, Kakumi, Iamangata, Mtiggi, Guundsjo, Camo, Cako, Tok^ ki, Jenna, and Taki. 3. Fida, otherwife Fisju, falls far fhort of the ^ two former, both in largenefs, and fertility. Its utmoft extent from South to North doth not exceed two days travelling. It abounds in woods and forefts, and yields a great quantity of Fire-wood, and Timber for buildings. It hath but four diftrids, Ofarra, Masijn- da, Ammano, and Araki. 4. Sinano, otherwife Sinsju, a very cold Coun- try. Salt and fifh are very fcarce here, becaufe of its great remote- nefs from the Sea • and it is not well provided with Cattle, by rcafon of its few paftures. It is otherwife tolerably fruitful, and produces a good quantity of Mulberry-trees, Silk, and Cannib, of which there are feveral good manufadures eftabliih'd there. It is faid to be five day's Journeys long from South to North, and is divided into n diftrids, Midfutz,, Takaij, Fanmjjina, TJifagatta, Sacht, Ina, Sfuwa, Tfikumma, Atfurni, Sara ond Si'pia. 5. Koodfuke, otherwife D/iosju, is f^jjj-t. T four 74 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book J. four clay's Journeys long, goiug from Eaft to Weft, a warm and to- lerable good Country, producing plenty of Mulberry-trees, though the Silk, they yield, is not of the bell fort, and the Stuffs brought from thence but caarfe. It is divided into 14 diftrids, UJjfiti, AaJJ'a, Sfi- kanne, Sfetta, Sai, Kitta, Kattaoka, Scora, Gumma, Kanva, Tago, Mi- SimooJj'ttke. dorino, Naba, and Jammada. 6. Shnoodfuke, or Jafjn, is three day's Journeys and a half, long, going from Eaft to Weft, a tolerable good Country, not very mountainous, but rather flat, with abundance of Pafture -ground and Rice-fields, which plentifully fupply it with Grafs Rice, Corn, and the Gokokf. It hath 9 diftrids, Afkara, Janada, Afo, Mutfh. Tfnga, Taka, Sawingawa, Survooja, Nafit, and Mukabe. 7. Mutfn, or Oosju, is by much the largeft Province in Japan, being full 16 day's Journeys long from South to North. It is an extraordinary good and fruitful Country, and wants nothing for the fupport of hu- man life. This whole Province was formerly fubjed to one Prince, together with the neighbouring Province Dewa, of which more hereafter. It is divided into 54 fand according to others 55J di- ftrids, Sijrakarva, Kurokawd, Jwtvafi, Mijaki, Aitz, Nama, Oda, Afaka^ Adatz, Sibatta, Karida, Tooda, Natori, Sinnobu, Kikkunda, Sibanne > Affomtfa, Namingata, Irpadewaga, Kawatz, Fitznngi, Takano, Wattari^ Tamadfukuri, Oonato, Kami, Sfida, Kuriwara, Jefan, Jeki, Mifatva, FJagaooka, Tojoue, Monorvara, Oofika, Gunki, Kaddono, Fajikani, Tfun- garu, Uda, Ikn, Motojes, Jfbara, Taidji, Sikamma, Inaga, Sirva, Iivafaki, Dsu-a. Kimbara, Kadfinda, Datte, Socka, Fei, and Kifen. 8. Dewa, otherwife Usjit, is five day's Journeys long, a very good Country, abounding in good pafture-ground, plants, and trees. It is faid to have the Spring 15 days earlier than other Provinces. It belong'd formerly to OJja % but is now a feparate Province, divided into 12 diftrids, Ahtmi, Ka- wanobe, Murajama, Oitama, Ookatz, Firaka, Tangaira, Dnva, Akindrt tauri, Senboku, Mognmi, and Jamamottu. All the revenues of thefe 8 Provinces amount to 563 Mangokf, according to the old Rentals, but at prefent they are confiderably improv'd. WKU R0- ni. foku Rokkudo, that is, the Northern Trad, hath 7 Provinces jVackda. within its compafs. 1. JFackafa otherwife Siakusju, is one day's Jour- ney, and a half, long, going from South to North. It is limited to the North by the Sea, which plentifully fupplies it with Fifli, Crabs, Tortoifes and the like. It hath fome Iron-mines, and is divided into „ rrr three diftrids, Ooni'm, Ooi, and Micatta. 2. Jetfiffen, otherwife Jeetf- jit. Its length from South to North is of three days travelling. It is very mountainous towards the South, but more flat and fruitful to the North, with abundance of good Pafture-ground, where the Inha- bitants breed plenty of Cattle. It produces alfo Cannib, Mulberry- , trees, and Silk, and the Gokokf very plentifully. It is divided into 12 diftrids, Tfttruga, Ni'm, Jmadats, Afjba, Oono, Sakai, Kitroda, Ikin- Kagctt garni, Takakida, Joofdfida, Sakagita 7 and Naandsjo. 3. Kaga, otherwife Kasju, Chap V. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 75 * Kafju, is two day's Journeys, and a half, long, going from Eaft to Weft, a tolerable good Country, yielding as much of the Gokokf as is neceffary for the fuftenance of the Inhabitants. Some Silk manufactures are carried on here, and it affords the beft vinegar, Sacki, and Soja, which are exported into other Provinces. It hath 4 diftrids, Jenne, No- mi, Ifkawa, and Kanga, to which fome add Kaboku. 4. Noto, otherwife ^ota. Seosju, is a fort of a Peninfula, almoft wholly encompafs'd by the Sea, and on this account plentifully fupplied with fifh. and crabs. It hath feveral Iron-mines, but not much good groiuid, and the Gokokf ripen considerably later, than in other Provinces. It is two day's Jour- neys, and a half, long, going from Eaft to Weft, and is divided into four diftrids Bagui, Noto, Fukeefund, and Sfits. 5. Jeetsju, otherwife Jaef- Jetsju. sju, hath three day's Journeys in circumference, a tolerable good Country, pretty well fupplied with Gokokf. A particular fort of earthen pots is made here. It affords alfo fome wood, which is made ufe of parti- cularly for bridges. It is divided into four diftrids, Tonami, Imidfu, Mebu, and Nijkawa. 6. Jetfingo, otherwife Jeesjit, a large Province, « ft /j HZOi having fix day's Journeys in circumference. It is very mountainous to the South, otherwife tolerably fruitful, producing Silk, Cannib, and the Gokokf, though not of the beft fort. It is divided into feven diftrids, Kabiki, Kof Mijfima, Iwoodfi, Cambara, Nittari, and Iwafune. 7. Sado, or Sasju t a pretty large Wand of three day's Journeys and saa' long, a middling good Country, producing plenty of Rice, befides fe- veral forts of Peafe and Pulfe. It affords alfo fome Fire-wood, and is divided into fix diftrids, Kuwada, Funaji, Takt } Amada, Fingamr 9 and Ikarwiga. 1. Tango, otherwife Tanfju, is one day's Journey and T a half broad, going from South to North, likewife a middling good Country, where Silk and Cannib may be had at a very eafy rate. It is plentifully fupplied by the Sea with fifh, crabs and the like. It is divided into five diftrids, Kaki, Joki, Tango, Katano, and Kumano. 3. Tafimd, otherwife Tanfju, is two day's Journeys long, going from fr mi , Eaft to Weft, a middling good Country, much like the two former, and divided into eight diftrids, Afami, Jabu, Idfu, Ketta, Kinnofaki, Flangaka, Sit&umi, and Mikummi. 4. hnaba, otherwife Insju, is much t ma y a . of the fame length and degree of fruitfulnefs with Tafima, It is li- mited to the North by the Sea, and on the South by a ridge of Mountains. It hath feveral Manufadures of coarfe Silk Stuffs, and is divided 7 6 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book I. divided into feven Provinces, Togomi, Jagami, T/idfu, Ooml, Takagufo, Tooki Ketta, and Konno. 5. Fooki, otherwife Fakusyi, is two day's Journeys, and a half, long, going from South to North, a middling good Coun- try, producing plenty of Gokokf, Cannib, and Silk, of which laft there are feveral good Manufactures carried on here. It is divided into fix iJ'n,no. diftricts, Kawamura, Kume, Jawata, Aneri, Oomi and Fino. 6. Idfnmo* otherwife Unsju, is two day's Journeys, and a half, broad, going from Eaft to Weft, almoft wholly encompafs'd by the Corean Sea, after the manner of a Peninfula. It is a very fruitful Country, producing variety of Trees, Grafs, and Plants. It hath alfo fome Manufactures of coarfe filk (luffs. It is divided into ten diftricts, Iju, Notni, Sanane, Akijika, Iwami. Tattenni, Jadfimo, Kanto, Ijis, Ninda and Oofara. 7. Iwami, other- wife Sekisju, is two day's Journeys long going from South to North, a middling good Country, producing plenty of Cannib, and affording fome Salt. The Inhabitants give twice as much a year to their Prince, as they do in other Provinces. It is divided into five diftricts, Tfikama, Na- Ohi- ka, Oots, Mbw and Canoab. 8. Oki otherwife Insju, an Wand erected into a Province, and (ituate in the Corean Sea, oppofite to the Coafts of that Peninfula. It is a very barren Country, producing a few Gokokf. It hath two day's Journeys in circumference, and is divided into five diftricts. All the yearly Revenues of thefe eight Provinces amount to 123 Mangokf. SJNjoDO. V. Sanjodo, that is, the Southern mountainous, or warm, TraEi, is com- Fcxrima. pos'd of eight Provinces, which are. 1. Farima, otherwife Bansju, hath three days Journey's and a half in circumference, a very fruitful Coun- try, producing in plenty all manner of neceffarks. It hath fe- veral manufactures of Silk-fluffs, Paper and Cloth. It is divided into fourteen diftricts, Akas, Kata, Kamo, Inamt, Sikatna, ItvOj Akato, Saijo M^afakfi. Sitz, Kanfaki, Taka, Mitzubo, Ifai, and Itto. 2. Mimafaka, otherwife Sakusju, is three day's Journeys long, going from Eaft to Weft, a mid- dling good Country, affording as much Fruits, Plants, Victuals, and Cloth as is necefTary for the fupport of its Inhabitants. It is obferv'd, as ibmewhat remarkable, that this Province is lefs fubject to Winds, than any other in the Empire. It is divided into feven di- ftricts, Aula, Katzunda, Tomanifi, Tomafigafi, Khiime, Ooba, and Ma- xima. 3. Bidfen, or Bisju, hath three day's Journeys in circumfe- rence, a middling good Country, producing plenty of Silk. Its Soil is pretty warm, and the produce of the fields and gardens are ob- ferv'd to ripen earlier, than in other Provinces. It is divided into 1 1 diftricts Kofuma, Waki, Iwanafi, Ooku, Akofaka, Xandatz, Minne, Bitsju. Ooas, Tfitaka, Tfingofima, and Kamofbna. 4. Bitsju, otherwife Fifin, is one day's Journey, and a half, long, going from Eaft to Weft, a very good Country, plentifully' fupply'd with all the neceffaries of life. The Gokokf and Cannib in particular are extreamly cheap here. It is divided into 9 diftricts, Utz } Kaboja, Kaija t Simo?mtz> AJfanguts, Oda, BiJftH. Chap. IV. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 77 Oda, Sitzuki, Teta and Fanga, to which are added two Wands Sabu- rofima, and Jorifi?na. 5. Bingo, other wife Fisju, is fomewhat more than »««• two day's Journeys long, going from South to North, a middling good Country, plentifully fupplied with Rice and Gokokf, which are like- wife obferv'd to ripen here much earlier, than they do elfewhere. It is divided into 14 diftricls, Abe, Futfitz, Kamiifi, Afuka, Nwnafimi, Bo- nitzi, Ajijdtti, Kooni, Mikami, Camidami, Mitfuki, Jejfo, Sirra, and Mijwa- ra. 6. Aki, otherwife Gesjn, is two day's Journeys, and a half, long, go- M> y ing from South to North, a mountainous and barren Country. Upon the Coafts they make Salt. Corn, Rice, and Gokokf will hardly grow here, but it abounds with woods and forefts, which afford plenty of mulhrooms. It is divided into 8. diftrids, Numada, Takatta, Tojoda^ Sada t Cammo, Sabaku, Aki, Takamija, and IknKuJfima, which lafl is the name of a place particularly famous in this Province. 7. Suwo or Stmo, Seosjit, is three day's Journeys long, going from Eaft to Weft, a mid- dling good Country, abounding chiefly in pi ants and good pafture ground. The Coafts afford as much fifh, Crabs, fhells and other fubma- rine fubftances as any other Province whatever. It is divided into fix diftrids Oofima, Kuka % Kwnade, Tfino, Sazva,"* and. Jooski. 8. Nagata, o- N*s«m» therwife Tfiosju, is two day's Journeys, and a half, long, from Eaft to Weft, a middling good Country limited to the South and Weft by the Sea, to the North by a ridge of mountains. It produces Gokokf, Fifh, Crabs, and other necefTaries, twice as much as there is requifite for the main- tenance of the Inhabitants. It is divided into fix diftrids, Atfa, Tojo- ra, Mine-, Ootz, Anni, and Mifijma.< The whole yearly revenue of thefe eight provinces amounts to 270. Mangokf, All the feveral traits of Land, Provinces and diftrids, hitherto men- tion'd, belong to the great Ifland Uipon. I proceed now to the fecond Ifland, which is next to Nipon in largenefs, and which is by the Japanefe call'd Kutsju, the Weftern Country, and Saikokf the Country of nine, kjusjlt. This offers to our view the VI. great trad of Land call'd, Saikaido, that is, the Weflem Coafl saikjwo. Traff. It is compos'd of nine large Provinces. 1. Tfikudfen, otherwife TftkpJf**' Tfihtfiii, is from South to North four day's Journeys long, a middling good Country, producing both Corn and Rice. It hath feveral China- ware manufactures, and is divided into 24 diftrids, Sima, Kama, Jaffijka, Nojtma, Mikafa, Monagatta, Onka, Mufiroda, Fonami, Sara, Naka, Cafji- ja, Siaka, Mujzma, Ito, Mufijro, Vutz,, Kurande, Nokofima, Sinotz, Kafa- kura, Kamitzka fakura, Kokuf, and Tajfai. 2. Tfihingo, otherwife Tfikusju, Tfihtnge. is from South to North five day's Journeys long, a tolerable good Coun- try producing corn, rice and peafe in great plenty:, The Coafts af- ford fifh, crabs and fhells. A great deal of fweetmeat is made here and exported into other Provinces. It is divided into 10 diftrids, Mijwara, Mi], Ihva, Mi, Mike, Kandfima, Simodfima, Jammacando, Jam- mafeta, and Takeno. 3. Bud fen, or Foosju, is four day's Journeys long B»«jT w< U from 78 J he Hiflwyof JAPAN. Book I. from South to North, a tolerable good Country, particularly famous for producing extraordinary good medicinal plants. Great numbers of Silk manufactures are carried on in this Province, fome of which the Prince takes in part of payment for his Revenue. It is divided into 2 diftricls, Tangawa, Sakku, Mijako, Nakatz, Tfniki, Kamitzki, Simotz- B " W S 9 - ki, and Ufa'. 4. Bnngo, other wife Foosju, is three day's Journeys long middling fruitful. It affords (ilk from its Mulberry-trees, cloth, hemp 1 Gokokf, and fome fcarce medicinal plants. It is divided into 8. diftricls Fit a, Kees, Nawori, Oono, Amabe, Ookata, Faijami and Kunifaki. 5. E •'"*' Fidfen, otherwife Fisju, is from South to North full rive day's Journeys long, a good, and middling fruitful, Country, befides the produce of corn and fice, plentifully ftored with tith and fowls. It hath alio fome Cloth manufactures, and is divided into n. diftricls, Kicky, Jabu, Mi- ne* Qoki, Kanfoki, Saaga, Maatfura, Kijfima, Fnfitz, Kadfuraki and Ta- Figo. kcikn. 6. Figo otherwife Fisju, hath about five day's Journeys in cir- cumference, a middling fruitful Country, affording plenty of firewood > and wood for building, as alfo corn, peafe, fifh, crabs, and other ne- ceffaries, as much as will fupply the want of the Inhabitants. It is divided into fourteen diftricls, Tamana, Jamaga, Jamamatto^ Kikntz, Afo, Taluma, Knma, Aida, Maftkif Udo, Jaadfiro^ Koos, Amahifa^ and fit ! &°> A If kit a. 7. FiugOj otherwife Nisju, is about three day's Journeys long, a poor Country, mountainous, and producing hardly what corn, rice, and fruits are neceffary for the fuftenance of its Inhabitants :, fome few Mulberry trees grow there. It is divided into five diftri&s, Uski, Oofumi. Foiju, Na'vr, Mijafaha, and Morokata. 8. Oofumi, otherwife Gmju, is from Eaft to Weft two day's Journeys long, a fmall, but fruitful pro- vince, plentifully fupplied with all the neceffaries of life, parti- cularly fuch as the Sea affords. There is a great quantity of Paper made here, and fome few (ilk fluffs. It is divided into eight diftricls, Onfwni, Fifingari, Kuwabara, Soo, Sijra KimodfuU, Komadfj, and Kwnag- Satutma. .;«• day's' Journeys long, a middling good Country, fomewhat mountainous and plentifully ftor'd with cattle, fowl, fifh, crabs and fhells. It is divided into nine diftricts, Miofi, Ojen, Nafingafi, Nanifi, Katfura^ Naka, Itauo, Arta, and Mima. 4. Sannki, otherwife Sa>isJ7t y is three SamH day's Journeys lcng, going from Eaft to Weft, a middling good and fruitful Country, with variety of rivers, mountains and fields, pro- ducing rice, corn, peafe and pulfe. The Sea affords plenty of fifh and crabs. This Province is famous for having given birth to feveral great and eminent Men. It is divided into eleven diftri&s, Owutp y Samingawd, Miki, Mino^ Jamada, Ka?idd, Ano, Utarj^ $fdkd, TaJo, and Kako. 5. Ijo, otherwife Josju, is two day's Journeys long, a middling ijo gocd Country, mountainous in fome parts, flat in others, fome cf the fields being fandy, others producing rice, hemp, mulberry trees, grafs and plants. Some fait is made upon the Coafts. It is divided into fourteen diftricts, Nij Sucfi^ Kuwa?nira^ Oot&^ Kafafaja, Nooma, Tfike^ Otfumi, Kume, Fukc^ Jio, Kita^ Uwa^ and Uma, 6. Tofa, other- Tofa, wife Tosju, is two day's Journeys long going from Eaft to Weft, a middling gocd Country, fupplied with plenty of peafe and pulfe, wood, fruits, and feveral other neceffaries of Life. It is di- vided into feven Provinces, Tofa, Agawa, Tala, Ola^ Fata 1 Nanaoka, Katafmid and Kami. The yearly Revenue of thefe fix Provinces a- mounts to 140 Mangokf. There remain {till two other Iflands not hitherto mention'd, which were conquer'd, and annex'd to the Empire of Japan, in the late War with the Inhabitants of Corea. They are call'd IkiTfu/Jima, both their names being put together, and have now a Prince of their own, •having been formerly fubje&to the Prince, or petty King, of Satznma. The firft of thefe two Iflands is //,/, otherwife h]u\ it is a day's Journey i/^v long, and- hath two diftricts, Iki] and Isijda. The fecond Ifland is Tfitffima, otherwife Taisju j this is fomewhat larger than the former, and likewife divided into two diftrifts, Akata, and Simoakata, that is, upper and lower Akata. The fruitfulnefs of thefe Iflands is faid not to be very confiderabie, but they fay, that fome foreign Curiofities are to be feen there, and 8o The Hiftoryof] A P A N. Book K and the number of Idols worfhip'd by the Inhabitants is much talk'd of. The yearly revenue of thefe two Iflands amounts to 3 Man, and 5000 Kokfi ttvtmu of The whole Revenue of all the Iflands and Provinces belonging to Ydp^T" the great Empire of Japan, makes up in all a yearly Sum of 2328 Man, and 6200 Kokf, according to the account above given. My Japanefe Author however puts it only at 2257 Mangoty Tho' it be not a proper place here to enter into particulars con- €ovirnmc»t cern i n S tne Government of the Japanefe Empire, its provinces, and ■/ $«/*». diftri&s, yet for the better underftanding of my Hiftory it feems neceffary, that before I proceed any further, fomewhat mould be faid on this Head. The whole Empire, in general, is govern'd by the Emperor, with an abfolute and monarchical Power, and fo is every Province in particular, by the Prince, who under the Emperor enjoys the government thereof. The prefent Kabo, or fecular Monarch, is tor Tfaam' T/inajos, fourth Succeffor, and Great Grandfon of Jejaflama, firft Em- tttvi reigning, peror of the now reigning Family, who ufurp'd the Throne upon the lawful Heir, and reign'd about the beginning of the 16th Century. Tfmajos hath the character of a fevere, but juft and prudent Monarch. He inherited from his anceftors along with the Crown, an abfolute and unlimited Power over all his Subje&s, from the meaneft extraction up to the higheft rank. Even the greateft Princes, and Lords of the Empire, are fo far his vaffals, that he can difgrace, exile and deprive them of their Jives and dominions, as he pleafes, or as he thinks, the peace and welfare of the Empire requires, or their crimes deferve. Da'imio, Prk- Particular Provinces are govern'd by hereditary Princes, called Dai- cesoftht Em- ^^ w jjj c jj fignifies High-named, that is, Princes and Lords of the higheft rank. Some of thefe have found means by force of Arms to enlarge their dominions. Thus the Prince of Satzuma made him- felf mafter of the two neighbouring Provinces, Oosumi and Fhigo^ and the Prince of Canga of the neighbouring Province Noto, on which account thefe two Princes are faid to be the moft powerful in the Empire. Si»mio,LtrJs. The Lords of fmaller diftrifts are call'd, Siomio, well named, Lords of an inferior rank. Their dominions whether they be Iflands, as Goto, Fitando, Amaktfa, MatfaH, and feveral others, or fituate upon the continent of the three chief Iflands, compofing the Empire of Japan, are mention'd in the lift of the 66 great Provinces, each un- der that Province whereto they belong, or in which they lie. All the Siomio are fo far fubjeft to the Emperor, that they are allow'd but fix Months fray in their hereditary dominions. The other half year they muft fpend in the Imperial Capital Jedo, where their wives and families are kept all the year round, as Hoftages of their Fidelity. Among Chap. V. The Hiftory sfJAPAN. 81 Some of thefe {mailer diftrifts are Imperial demefns, or Crown c™u-» tatJ s Lands, either, becaufe they have been appropriated of old for w s ° icr " * the fupport of the Crown, or becaufe in fuccefs of time, as occaficn offer'd, they were taken from their hereditary pofTeifors by way of puniihment, and annexed thereunto, it having been always one of the chief political maxims follow'd by the Emperors of Japan, to maintain them- felves in peaceable poilefiion of the Throne, by fplitting large domi- nions into feveral fmall ones, and by endeavouring, by all poflible means, to weaken the power and authority of the Princes of the Empire. The largeft of thefe Crown Lands are govern'd by what they call, Bugios, a&ing in the nature of Lieutenants, the fmaller ones by Daiquans, as they are call'd, or Stewards. All the revenues muft be brought into the Emperor's Exchequer. CHAP. VI. 1 be Author's opinion of the true Origin and lief cent of the Japanefe. IT hath been the conftant opinion of moft European Geographers, t>; ferine opi- that the Tapanefe are originally of Chine fe Extraction, defcended K ' m,i ^° lit r the „ , x 1 I • ri-1 T- • „, . • . . - . klctnt oj the from the Inhabitants or that mighty Empire. Inis opinion is y a p a „ef- ex** grounded upon the following two Stories, which were brought out of """'*'• the Eaft by European travellers. The lirffc is : It once happen'd in ., China, that feveral Families confpired againft the Emperor. Upon c Wlp? ac y ta difcovery of the Plot, it was order'd, that all thofe, who had any hand in it, mould be put to death without mercy. But the number of accomplices being fo extenfive, that at laft the Executioners them_ felves grew weary of fhedding fo much blood, the affair was again laid before the Emperor, who thereupon refolv'd, that their fentence of death mould be converted into tranfportation and banifh- ment into the neighbouring, then rude and uninhabited, Wands of Japan, which they peopled, and thereby became the Progenitors of that numerous and powerful Nation, they are now inhabited by. The fecond Story hath been reported as follows. One of the Empe- rors of China unwilling to part with his Empire, and all that gran- $, a rch after deur and power he was pofTefs'd of, within the fhort term human a " " m ? tr f al , * ■ , - . Medicine. life is limited to, endeavour'd to find out, if poflible, iome univerfal Medicine, which could make him immortal-, on this account he fent expert and able Men into all parts of the World. Among the reft, one of his chief Phyficians perfuaded him, that the proper In- gredients for fuch a Medicine were, to his knowledge to be met with in the X neigh- 82 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. neighbouring Wands of Japan, but that they were of fo tender and Angular a Structure, that they would wither, and lofe their Virtues, if touch'd by any ether, but chaft and pure, hands. And the better to execute this defign, he propos'd that 300 young Men, and fo many young Women, all of a ftrong and healthful conftitution, fhou'd be carried ever thither, which accordingly he did himfelf, though far from having any real intention to fatisfy his Sovereign, but rather out of a defire to efcape his Tyranny, to fettle in happier climes, and to people thefe then uninhabited Wands. As to the firfl of thefe two Stories, LinfcUctre- Llnfchoot is the author of it j but he not acquainting his Reader, what authority he had for it, or how he came by it, and there be- ing not the lead mention made, neither in Chinefe, nor Japanefe Hiftories, of any fuch Confpiracy, it deferves no credit, but ought to Ph*r Chtn k £ entirely rejected, as fcrged and fabulous. But as to the fecond, nmes over the coming over of a Chinefe Phyfician with fo many young Men, u '^ a uimy and young Women, the fame is not at all denied by the Japanefe y nay, far from it, they (till (hew a place upon Khumano (So they call the Southern Coafts of the Provinces) Kijnokuni, and feme neighbour- ing Provinces, where he landed, and afterwards fettled with his gal- lant Collony, and the remains of a temple, which was there erected to his memory, for having brought over to them from China good manners, and ufeful arts and fciences. As to the occafion of his coming over, it is recorded in Japanefe Hiftories, that there was great fearch made after an univerfal Medicine, during the reign of the Em- .0, Emfe- p eror 5; or Sikwo, or as the vulvar pronounce it, Sino Sikwo. This >or of Chr.hi. L 01 1 • Emperor was one of the three Chinefe Nero's, Sinosko, Ketzuvoo, and Tbuwo, whefe memory will be for ever abhor'd. He not only go- Ks . T -JTr y vern'd his Empire with unpmllel'd Tyranny, but liv'd with the greateft nejs. pride, and mod profufe magnificence imaginable, of which there are feveral remarkable inftances mentioned in the Hiftory of his Life. He caus'd once a large Spot of Ground to be dug up for a Lake, and having order'd it to be fill'd with Chinefe Beer, he faiPd over it in flately Barges. He caufed a ftately Palace, nam'd Kojalit, to be built for his refidence, the floors whereof were pav'd with Gold, and Silver, and the whole Building of fuch an extent, that the Empe- ror Kooll, who ufurp'd the throne upon his Grandfon, whom he put to death, with all the Imperial Family, having fet it on fire, it burnt in the afhes for the fpace of three Months, which memorable event gave- birth to a Proverb, whereby the Japanefe exprefs the fudden changes, and fhort duration, human grandeur and happinefs are liable to. 'Twas this Emperor, who out cf a ftrong defire for ever to enjoy the Em- pire, order'd that great fearch fhouldbe made after a Medicine, which could render him immortal. If it be therefore under his Reign, the a- bovefaid Phyfician went over into Japan with his Colony, it muft be •granted to the Japanefe, that they came by much too late to be the Progenitor" Chap VI. The Hiflory »f JAPAN. 83 Progenitors of their Nation, which was then already govern'd by Kuksn, their eighth Monarch - for the arrival of the Chinefe was in the 7th year of the reign of Koken, 453 years after Synmu, firft Em- peror of 'Japan, and 209 before the birth of our Saviour, the very fame year it! which Shwfikwo died in the 50th year of his age. Since therefore thefe two Stories are by no means a fufficient proof, that the Japanefe Nation is defcended from the Chinefe, it will not be amifs to enquire, whether it be not poflible to affign it another more probable origin. It is unqueftionably true, that languages, and their proprieties, are Co»jrf?«r« «- as fure and certain marks, as perhaps it is poflible to produce, h " r f , ^' ;n s» ' 1 °J different whereby to difcern, and trace out, not only the true origin of a Nation, Nations taken but like wife to find out, how in fuccefs of time it increafed, .f romtheir lan - by being, as it were, incorporated with other Nations. Of this mod Euro- pean Nations afford us evident proofs. Thus, for Inftance, we may eafily find by the language alone, that the Polanders, Bohemians and Mufcovites are cf Slavonian extraction j that the Italians, French and Spaniards defcend from the Romans 5 that the Germans, low Dutch, Danes and Swedes, are the offspring of the ancient Goths. Nay, we may go ft ill further, and affert, that the languages alone of feveral nations, and proper confiderations thereupon, will qualify and enable us to form probable conjectures, what re- volutions happen'd among them, whether, and what neighbouring na- tions they were conquer'd by, as alfo, whether, and how from time to time they increas'd by frefll fupplies and colonies from foreign parts : For it may be laid down as a conftant rule, that in propor- tion to the number of ftrangers, who come to fettle and live in a Country, words of the tongue fpoke by them will be brought into the language of that Country, and by degrees, as it were, na- tural iz'd, and become fo familiar to the Natives, as if they had been of their own growth. The number of German, French, and Danifh words, in the Englifh language, doth it not evidently prove, that En- gland was fucceflively conquer'd by the Danes, lower Saxons and French. Not even the Latin Tongue was able to preferve its purity, but Greek words were freely, and in great number? adopted into it, after the Romans became Mafter of that Country, then the feat of learning and politenefs. The language now fpoke in Tranfilvania hath a confiderable mixture both of the Latin and neighbouring Hun- garian. The language of the Inhabitants of Semigallia, (a fmall Country near Ritffia) is compos'd of the Lettifh, Slavonian and Latin. The fame obfervation holds true in other parts of the World, as well as in Europe. John de Barros in his Decades, and Flaccoitrt in his Hiflory of Madagascar affure us, that the language fpoke by the Inhabitants of that large African Ifland, is full of Javan and Malagan words, as remaining proofs of the trade and commerce, which thefe two Nations, about 2000 years ago the richeft and moft powerful of Afia, had carried 84 The Hiftory s/JAPAN. Book I. carried en with Madagascar, where they fettled in great number?. The language fpo^e in the Peninfula Crimea, or T auric a Cherfonefm in AJia, (till retains many German words, brought thither, as is fuppos'd by a colony of Gcths, who went to fettle there about 850 years after the Deluge. The late Mr. B-ufbeq, who had been Imperial Am- bailador at the Ottoman Port, collected and publifh'd a great number of thefe words in his fourth letter -, and in my own travels through that Country I took notice of many more. If we were better ac- quainted with the languages of the Javans, Ceylonefe, Malabarians, Siamites, and other Indian Nations, they would doubtlefs enable us, to trace out their origin, mixture with their neighbours and the revolutions that happ'en'd *.m£'X2- a mong them. But to apply , what hath been faid, nearer to our purpofe, I may frmt of the venture to affirm, that if the Japanefe language was to be thrcughly J;f ) £ fn™ and moft rigoroufly examin'd into, we would find it entirely pure' draivnfrcmtbe anc \ f ree f r0 m all mixture with the languages of their neighbours, at """aZ lea ^ t0 t vc h a degree, as would give room to conjecture an original g «<« s «. defeent from them. By their neighbours I mean chiefly the Chinefe, who inhabit the Eaftern maritime provinces of that Empire, and carry on a commerce to Japan. They fpeak three different languages, ac- cording to the three chief Provinces they belong to, which are Nanking, Tfiaktsju, and Foktsju. Now a native of Japan doth not underftand one word of either of thefe languages, excepting the names of a few things, which were brought by the Chinefe into Japan along with the things themfelves, and which conclude no more for an original defeent of the Japanefe from China, than fome few Portuguefe words, as Van, palma, bolan, Cappa, frafco, bidou, tante, and a few more, frill left there, would be allow'd a fufficient proof, of the Japanefe being originally defcended from the Portuguefe. Nor was the num- ber of Chinefe, who came from time to time to fettle in Japan ever confiderable enough to occafion any remarkable alteration in th e Mother-tongue of the Japanefe, tho' they could, and actually did com- municate and introduce among them the arts and fciences, which had long before flouriflied in China, nay even the knowledge of the learned and figniticant Character language of that Country, which is likewife receiv'd in Corea, Tunquin, and other neighbouring (Kingdoms, much after the fame manner as the Latin is in moft European Countries. 1 But befides, there are two other elfential proprieties of a language, I mean the conftruction and pronunciation, in the Japanefe language fo entirely different from that of the Chinefe, that there is no room left to think that thefe two Nations gave birth to each other. And firft as to the conftruction and way of writing, the Chinefe fet their, characters one below another in a row, without any intermediate par- ticles to connect them : The Japanefe indeed do the fame, but the genius of their language requires befides, that the words and cha- racters mould be fometimes tranfpos'd, fometimes joined together by other Chap. VI. The Hiftory °f J A P A N. 85 other words and particles, particularly invented for this purpofe, and which are fo abfolutely neceffary, that even in reprinting the books of the Ghinefe, they muft be added, to enable their people to read and to underftand them. And as to the pronunciation, that alfo is vaftly different in both languages, whether we ccnfider it in general, or with regard to particular letters, and this difference is fo remark- able that it feems the very inftruments of voice are differently form'd in the Japanefe, than they are in the Chinefe. The pronunciation of the Japanefe language, in general, is pure, articulate and diftincl:, there being feldom more than two or three letters (according to our Alphabet) combin'd together in one fyllable :, that of the Chinefe on the contrary, is nothing but a confufed noife of many confonants pro- nounc'd with a fort of a finging accent, very difagreeable to the Ear. The fame difference appears with regard to particular letters. Thus the Chinefe pronounce our letter H. very diftincfly, but the Japanefe can give it no other found, but that of an F. Again the japanefe pronounce the letters R and D, very diftindly, of which the Chinefe, particularly thofe of Nanking, always make an L, even fuch as are otherwife well fkill'd in the European languages. I could give fe- veral other inftances of this kind, and further fhew, that, what hath been obferv'd of the difference between the Chinefe and Japanefe languages, holds equally true with regard to the languages fpoken in Corea and Jedfo, compared with that of the Natives of Japan, but it is needlefs to give the Reader, and myfelf, fo much trouble, the rather fince no body ever pretended to draw the original defcent of the Japanefe from either of thefe two Nations. Another argument againft the defcent of the Japinefe from the F tH Chinefe, I could draw from the difference of the Religion of both Na* Difference Cecil re -\ 9' The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book I. But alfo to Colonies. fecure and pleafant abode. I am the more inclined to believe, that they tirfl: fettled in this Province, fince their pofterity ftill look upon it, as the place where their anceftors dwell'd, and as fuch honour it with frequent pilgrimages and other ails of devotion. Thus far my conjectures, for as fuch only I deliver them, concerning the true ori- ginal defcent of the Japan efe Nation. The Tncreafe Before I put an end to this Chapter, it will not be amifs to fay °f[ J*P a ' . fomething of the increafe of this firft Japanefe Colony, after they had iwm chiefly once taken the refolution to ftay, and to people the Country, where to thmjelves. donbtlefs for feveral ages, before any confiderable improvements were made in agriculture, and other arts and fciences, they led a fimple and indigent life, living on their Cattle, on what the earth produced of plants, roots and fruits, and the Sea afforded of fifli and crabs. It was un- queftionably and chiefly owing to themfelves, that in fuccefs of time they became fo numerous and powerful a Nation, and the prefent Inhabitants of Japan muft be look'd upon in general, as defcendants of thofe, who, after the confufion of languages at Babel^ came over and fettled in thefe Iflands. But on the other hand it cannot be denied, but that from time to time new Colonies were fent over thither, chiefly from China and Corea, and perhaps alfo from fome other neighbouring Countries. The Japa- nefe themfelves make frequent mention in their Hiftories of learned Chi- nefe, who brought over into Japan their books, and the knowledge of ufe- ful arts and fciences, though not till the latter Ages, when the Japa- nefe Monarchy was already become a powerful Empire. And indeed fince fo few foreign words have been brought into the Japanefe lan- guage, that it is hardly vifible, that there hath been any alteration at all made in it, and fince the religion and old cuftoms fubfift till now, it appears plainly, that whatever foreign Colonies did from time to time voluntarily, or by chance, come over into Japan, their number muft have been very inconfiderable with regard to the bulk of the Japanefe Nation. Confidering further, that the Iflands of Japan are encompafs'd with a dangerous and ftormy Sea, it is highly probable, that from time to time Ships coming from foreign Countries ftranded upon the Japanefe coafts, and that, if any of the Ships company were fortunate enough to fave their lives, they chofe rather to ftay in Japan, and to fettle among the Natives, than to truft themfelves again to the mercy of the Sea, and to run the hazard of a perillous return into their own Country. Though navigation by this time be highly improved, yet the like accidents ftill happen very frequently, and there is hardly a year, but fome Ships are forc'd upon the Coafts of Japan, coming fometimes from Countries either fo remote, or fo entirely unknown, that fcarce any conjectures can be made about them, neither by the Shape, nor the language and cuftoms of the Ships company. Several re- irfftaaces of mar k a ble inftances of fuch accidents are recorded in Japanefe Hiftories. The To Shi^ Vtreckj. this. Chap. VI. The Hiftory o/JAPAN. 93 The Japanefe having fome Centuries ago accidentally difcover'd the Ifland Genkaifima, fituate to the North of Japan, found it inhabited, Geu y^m ai as their Hiftories relate, by Om that is, Black Devils, which they pro- unijlmifa'. -ii- * i 1 -in 1 r 1-tt • tncrly inbahi' fecuted with War, and having purg d the Ifland from this Vermin, as u ^ y BIack _ u they call it, they peopled it with a Colony of their own. It is highly probable, that thefe Blacks had been forc'd upon the coafts of this then uninhabited Ifland in a ftorm. It is further obferv'd in the Hiftory of this war, that they wore long hairs fpread over their ihoulders, and that they had a ft range fort of houfhold goods, as among the reft high European Hats. As to the Japanefe calling them Devils, we need not in the lead wonder at it, confidering either their black co- lour, or the natural pride of the Japanefe Nation, which fo far delpifes all other Countries, as to call them Vmakolf that is, the Coun- tries of Devils. Otherwife, what Countrymen thefe Blacks had been, is not very difficult to conjecture, by their wearing long hairs, by their furniture, and fome other circumftances 5 and I don't believe, to Probably tii&: imnofe upon anybody, if Iaffert that they have been Malagans. It is well la l am ° known, that the Malagans to this day are extreamly fond of their own hair, and delighted with wearing them of a confiderable length, be- yond any ether of the black nations of Afia. Befides, they had in former times by much the greateft trade in the Indies, and frequented with their merchant-fhips not only all the coafts of Afia, but ventur'd over even to the coafts of Africa, particularly to the great Ifland of Madagascar. The title, which the King of the Malagans affumed to himfelf, of Lord of the Winds and Seas to tbe Eaft and to the Weft, is an evident proof of this, but much more the Malagan language, which fpread moft all over the Eaft, much after the fame manner, as formerly the Latin, and of late the French, did all over Europe.- The high Hats, which were found among the Houfhold-goods of thefe Blacks, mult have been brought out of Europe, they having never been fabricated any where elfe. It was an ancient cuftom of moft Eaftern Princes ("which fubfifts till now in the Kingdoms of Cambodia, Siam, Pegu, and fome others J to prefent their prime minifters of ftate, and chief favourites with fuch hats, as tokens of their particular favour, and they alone had the privilege of wearing them, as lingular badges of honour. They were formerly brought out of Europe by Land to Or- mus, and from thence exported all over the Eaft by the Malagans, Arme- nians, and other trading nations :, but after the Portuguefe had dif- cover'd a new way to the Indies, round the Cape of Good-hope, they exported them from Europe ( where they are now out of fafhionj directly by Sea. Now whether there was not among thefe black Inhabi- tants of Genkaifima, fome great Man, who receiv'd thefe hats from his Prince, or whether they fell by fome other accident into their hands, is not material to enquire. There is alfo mention made in Japanefe Hiftories of black Inhabitants, who were found in A a fome 94. The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I fome of the Iflands lying to the South of Japan, and who in all probj- bilitv muft have been, either Malagan Merchants, or elfe Inhabitants of tome of the Molucca Iflands, who having been forced thither in a ftorm, and finding them uninhabited, refolv'd to fhy and to people them. Not long before my arrival, and during my flay in Japan, feveral ^,o■,■e in- gj • g fl- ranc ied upon the Coafts coming from remote and unknown fiances of i t r> Sd^rtcksoa Countries. In this cafe all the Ships Company, as well thofe, that the jafraricje rema : n a ][ ve as tne bodies of fuch as are drown'd, when thrown en fhore, and all the Ship's tackle, and the boat, if any, muft be brought up to Nagafaki, as the place appointed for a general inquiry into ma- ritime affairs. The Governours of this place examine into all themoft minute circumftances of the unhappy accident, with that care and jealous circumfpection, which is peculiar only to this Nation, and in order to difcover, if poflible, what Country the Ship came from and what Language thofe, that faved their lives, fpeak, this Examination is fometimes made in prefence of the Dutch Kefident, who did me the favour, upon thefe occafions, to carry mc along with him. It is a duty incumbent on every Prince of the Empire, to take care, in cafe any Ships ftrand upon the Coafts of his Province, that they be fent up, as aforcfaid, to Nagafaki, which is commonly, out of refpecl for the Emperor, done with great expence. Not long ago a Jonk coming from Manillas, on board which were fome Topaffians, a fort of black Chrifhns, was wreck'd upon the Coafts of Satzuma. Moft of the Ship's Company were drown'd, fome died on Ihore, and only three were brought up alive to Nagafaki, the laft of whom died there in prifon, after having taken fome phyiick, order'd him by a Japanefe Phyfi- tian. Of another Ship, which ftranded upon the fame Coafts, on- ly three black Sailors were faved, which could not pronounce one diftinct word, befides that of To h acco; after having lain for fometime in prifon, they were deliver'd to us, to be tranfported on board our Ships. Another Ship was brought to Nagafaki, which hid been fore'd upon the Northern Coafts of Japan, without anv bo- dy on board. The odd uncommon ftructure of this veifel, and the re- mains of three Chinefc Characters upen the ftern, made the Japanefe con- jecture, that it came from the extremities of Jefo. Not long ago another Ship perilh'd upon the Coafts of the Ifland Rhtht, and only two of the corn- pan}' were fav'd, which were brought firft to Satzuma, and from thence to Tsagafaki, with a convoy of eight barges, which muft have put the Prince of Satzuma at the expence of feme thoufand Rixdollars. They were well fhap'd comely perfons, and had their heads fhav'd much after the manner of the Polanders, no beards, and three holes in each Ear-* They fhew'd by their decent and civil behaviour, and free, but modeft, appearance, a. tolerable education, and a good clear underftanding, by endeavouring to give the Japanefe fome notions of the number, fituation and large- ne'fs of the Iflands, from whence they came, which they did by putting ' ' III Chap. VI. The Hi (lory of JAPAN. 95 patting Hones of different fizes upon a Table, calling each by its name; ■ among the reft, that Ifland, where they liv'd themfelves, was by them call'd Patau. We had reafon to apprehend, that the good un- derstanding and quick apprehenfion they lhew'd, when under examina- tion- would be the occafion of their imprifonment for life at Nangafaki. If we believe the Japanefe, there is another unknown nation, and very different p y" mt y from theirs, as to their cuftoms, ihape and language, which inhabits the ' Ifland Kitbrtefima, one of the mod Northern Iflands belonging to Japam They defcribe them as Pygmies, and from thence call the whole Ifland the Pygwey-IJJand. What extraction they be of, and how they came to inhabit this Ifland, I will leave to themfelves to deter- mine. I will onlv add on this head, that the firft European Ship, which came into Japan, was a Portugueze Merchant-fhip, fore'd thi- ther accidentallv in a ftonu. Upon the whole, the wide difference which is ft 11 obferv'd be- t/v Japanefe tween the Tananefe Inhabitants of feveral Provinces, as to their fhape, di f"''" sh ^ n n* and Comblt- feems to argue ftrongly, that from time to time, different and new »«», branches were grafted into the original Tree of this Nation. For although the japanefe in the main, particularly the common People of Nipon, be of a very ugly appearance, fhort fiz'd, ftrong, thick- legg'd, tawny, with flattifh nofes, and thick eye-lids, (tho' the eyes ftand not fo deep in the forehead, as in the Cliinefe, ) yet the defendants of the eldeft and nobleft families, of the Princes and Lords of the Empire, have fomewhat more majeftick in their fhape arid coun- tenance, being more like the Europeans. The Inhabitants of the Provinces Sat&wna, Oofijmi, and Fiuga, are of a middle-fize, ftrong, couragious, and manly, otherwife civil and polite. The fame is obferv'd of the Inha- bitants of fome of the Northern Provinces in the great Ifland Nipon, excepting thofe of the great Province Os]u, who are faid to be beyond others cruel and unmerciful. The Inhabitants of fome Provinces of Saikokf, particularly of Ftfen, are fhort, flender, but well fhap'd, of a good handfome appearance, and extreamly polite. The Inhabitants of the great Ifland Kipon, particularly of its Eaftern Provinces, are known from others by their big heads, flat nofes, and mufculous flefhy complexion. Now to clofe this Chapter, and to fum up in a i~e\v words, what hath been therein largely dwelt on, it appears :, that in the firft Ages of the World, not long after the Deluge, when the confufion of lan- guages at Babel oblig'd the Babylonians to drop their defign of build- ing a Tower of uncommon height, and occafion'd their being difpers'd all over the World, when the Greeks, Goths and Slavonians departed for Europe, others for Afia and Africa, others for America, that then the Japa- nefe alfo fet out on their Journey : That in all probability after many years travelling, and many incommodities endur'd, they alighted at this remote part of the World; that, being well pleas'd with its fix- ation and fruitfulnefs, they refolv'd to chufe it for the place of their abode 9 6 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I abode ; that in all likelihood they fpent many Centuries in a polyar- chical way of Life, fuch as is led to this day by the Tartars, living in hoords, and wandering with their Cattle and Families up and down the Country j that being infenfibly, and by degrees, grown to be a nume- rous and powerful Nation, they thought it expedient for the good of the Country, and for their own fafety, to deliver up the Government into the hands of one Prince, and chufe for their firfl Monarch the valiant Dfin Mu Ten Oo :, that confequently they are an original Nation, no ways indebted to the Chinefe for their defcent and exiftence, and that, tho' they receiv'd from them feveral ufeful Arts and Sciences, as the Latins did from the Greeks, yet they were never made fubjecl, and conquer'd, neither by them, nor by any other neighbouring Nation. CHAP. VII. Of the Origins of the Japanefe, according to their own fa- bulous Opinion. panefe trtlk' *!\ ~^HE Japanefe fancy themfelves highly affronted by the en- thek Origine deavours of fome, who bufy themfelves to draw the original jptfjij ' defcent of their Nation from the Chinefe, or others of their Neighbours. They pretend, that they arofe within the compafs of their own Empire, tho' not out of the Earth, like Mice and Worms, as the proud Athenians, for that fame reafon, were upbraided with, by that Cynic Diogenes. They claim a birth much higher and nobler, and efteem themfelves no kfs than Offsprings of their very Deities, whom otherwife they don't look upon as eternal, but fuppofe, that in the firft motion of the Chaos, out of which all things were form'd, their Gods alfo were brought forth by its invifible Power. They have of vhc differing Genealogies of their Deities. The firft is a fucceffion of there are tv:o a a Succefpom. Celeftial Spirits, of Beings abfolutely free from all manner of mixture with corporeal Subftances, who rul'd the Japanefe World during an unde- termin'd and incomprehenfible Series of Centuries. The fecond is a race of Terreftrial Spirits, or Godmen, who were not poffefs'd of that pure Being pe- culiar only to their Predeceffors. They govern'd the Japanefe Empire by a lineal fucceflion, each a long, but limited, number of years, till at laft they begot that third race of Men, which Japan is now inha- bited by, and who have nothing left of the purity and perfections of their divine Progenitors. It will not be amifs, as a further proof of what I advance, here to infert the names of thefe two fucceffions The frfi Sue- of Deities, taken out of their own Writings. The names of the firft Bw* f '" f ucce ffi° n are purely metaphorical, and the only thing mention'd of it in their Hiftorical Books, for there is no account given, neither of their Lives Chap. VII. The Hijiory of J A P A N. 97 Lives and A&ions, nor of their Government. They fucceeded each other in the following Order. Ten d Sin Sit&i Dai, that is, the Sncceffion of the feven great Spiritu- al Gods. 1. Kitni toko Dat fij no Mikotto. 2. Kiini Satfu TJij no Mikotto. 3. Tojo Kim Nan no Mikotto. Thefe three Gods had no Wives j but the four following of the fame Succeflion were married, and begot each his Succeffor by his Wife, tho' in a manner far beyond the reach of human understand- ing. Thefe were, 4. t/ifij Nino Mikotto, and his Wife Siifitfi Nino Mikotto. 5. OoTono Tfino Mikotto, - ■■ Oo Tomafe no Mikotto. 6. Oo mo Tamo Mikotto. ■ Oo fi Wote no Mikotto. 7. Ifanagi no Mikotto, Ifanami no Mikotto. Thefe feven Gods are by them reprefented as Beings purely Spiri- tual, and the Hiftories of their Lives and Governments as Dreams. The real exiftence of fuch a time, when fuch fpiritual Beings govern- ed the Japanefe World, is what they religioufly believe, tho' at the fame time they own, that it is far above their understanding to con- ceive how it happen'd, and entirely out of their power to determine how long their Government lafted. The laft of the firft fucceffion Ifanagi Mikotto, and his Wife Ifanami Mi- Second Suc- kotto, are held in peculiar veneration by the Japanefe, as being the progenitors cefoHofcod- ofthe fecond fucceffion of God-men, of whom uTued the third race of the now exifting Inhabitants of Nipon. (Mikotto is an Epithet pecu- liar only to the firft fucceffion of Spiritual Gods, and fignifies the incom- prehensible blifs and happinefs of thefe firft Monarchs of Japan : Some- times however they will beftow it on fuch of the inferior Gods, for whom they have a peculiar veneration.J Thofe of the Japanefe, who turn'd Chriftians, call'd them their Adam and Eve. They are faid to have liv'd in the province Isje, though it is not known in what particular part of that Province they were born, liv'd or died. They obferve only, that this preadamitical Adam, ("if I ma y nave leave thus to call him) was the firft, who, taught by the Example of the Bird Sekire, or according to the vulgar, Ifitataki, lay with his Wife in a carnal manner and begot by her fons and daughters of a nature excellent indeed, and far fuperior to ours, but greatly below that of the divine Beings, of which they fprung. IfanamVs firft-born Son, and the firft of the fecond fucceffion of God-men, is fuppofed by the very law of primogeniture, to have been entitled to a fuperiority B b over p8 . The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book T. over his Brothers and Sifters, upon which, and a lineal defcent from him, is grounded the right, the Dairi's or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor's eldeft Sons claim to the Crown of Japan, upon their Fa- ther's demife. This fecond Succeffion is call'd, They me five jyfi g in q q T} a j ■ that is, th# Succeffion of five Terreftrial Gods, or in Number. J ' J God-men, who are Tenfio Dili I# Tenfio Dai Dfin, in the language of the learned, and Ama Tent Oon Garni in that of the vulgar. The characters, whereby this name is exprefs'd, fignify, a great Spirit flreaming out celeflial Rays. He is the firft-born Son of Ifanagi, and the only one that left Children behind him. For 'twas his pofterity, Creatures not of a mean extraction, but of an excellent and almoft divine nature, who inhabited the Country for many millions of years, till they begot the third race of its pre- fent fhort living Inhabitants. All the Japanefe, without exception, look upon themfelves as immediate defcendants of Tenfio Dai Dfin, becaufe they fay, that all his younger Brothers left the world without iffue. But particularly the Ecclefiaftical hereditary Emperor grounds his right to the Empire, (which is of late gone over into Secular hands, he himfelf having preferved nothing but his title, and a fhadow of his former power and grandeurj upon a lineal defcent from Tenfio Dai- Dfins firft-born Son, and fo down. Tenfio Dai Dfin committed not only during his reign many noble and heroick aclions, but even after he left this world, as is recorded in Japanefe Hiftories, he fufficiently prov'd by many miracles, and manifefted himfelf to be the moft power- ful of all the Gods of the Country, the very life, foul, light, and fupreme Monarch of nature. For this reafon he is devoutly wor- ihip'd by all the faithful adherents of the old Japanefe Religion, as it was of old eftablifh'd in Japan. And the adherents of all o- ther Seels, even their greateft Philofophers, and Atheifts, (hew a parti- cular regard and veneration for his name and memory, as that of their firft Parent. Devout pilgrimages are made yearly, by the Japa- nefe of all ranks and qualities, to the Province where he lived, and where there is a Temple erecled to his memory. Nor is there any province, or town, throughout the Empire, but what has at leaft one Temple, where Tenfio Dai Dfin is worfhipp'd, and in hopes of obtaining by his power and arfiftance great temporal bleflings, worihip'd with much more afliduity and devotion, than any other of their Gods. There is otherwife no mention made in Japanefe Hiftories of his Wife, nor of the Wives of his fucceffors, and their names are entirely loft to Po- fterity. After fome hundred thoufands of years Tenfio Dai Dfin was fucceeded by his eldeft Son Oof vii. 2. Oofiwo ni no Mikotto, or with his full title, Mafifai Ja fit Katz Katzfai ja fi Amani Oofi woni no Mikotto. His fucceifor was g. Niniki d Chap VII. The Hiftory of J A P A K 99 9. Ninikino Mikotto, or with his full title, Amatfu fiko fiko Fono ni tSmki. Niniki no Mikotto. He was fucceeded by 4. De mi no Mikotto, or with his full title, Fikofoo foo De mi no Mi- Dcmi - kotto. He was fucceeded by 5. Awafe Dfu no Mikotto, or with Jiis full title, Tnki Magifa Take Jviafedfu. Ugei Jakuffa fuli awadfi Dfuno Mikotto. With him ends this Second, or Silver-age as one might call it, of the Japanefe world. Something more iliall be faid on this he.id in the firft Chapter of the fecond Book. The names of the five terreftrial Gods of this fecond fucceflion are exprefs'd in Tab. xvi. Thefe are the two Succeffions of divine and half divine heme& G f?" tiott r °f ■^ ' thefe tv.0 juc- from whence the Japanefe draw the original defcent of their nation. The cefiousofud- account they give how thefe Gods were created, and how they begot each t!e! ' other, is no lefs chimerical and fabulous. The firft of the feven great Celeftial Spirits, they fay, was the very firft thing that arofe out of the Chaos, being its pureft and invifible part and power. His Son and Heir went out of him in a manner beyond the reach of human underftmding, or as fome pretend to explain it, and to make it intel- ligible, by the motion and a&ive power of the Heavens, and fub- celeftial Elements. Thus were begot the ^feven great Celeftial Spirits of the firft fucceflion. 'Twas the laft of them, who, knowing his Wife in a carnal manner, begot the fecond fucceflion of God-men, of Beings half divine, and half human. Thefe, though they fell far fhort of the perfe&ion of their progenitors, yet by virtue of thofe divine qualities, they had ftill left them, they preferv'd their lives, and continued the fucceflion of their Government upon their Pofterity which they begot in a more comprehenfible manner, for an im- memorial time, far exceeding the term human life is now limited to* At laft all expired in the Perfon of Awafe Dfuno, the laft of this fe- le f , . . cond race, who himfelf became the firft parent of the third, the now Race of Men living Inhabitants of Japan. To thofe of this third Race, who defcend hou ' b ^ 0t - lineally from the firft-born Son of Awafe Dfuno Mikotto, from his firft-born, and fo down, or their Iflue wanting to their next Heirs, is by the Japanefe attributed a fupernatural, almoft divine, Power, and an unlimited authority over their Fellow-creatures. This is in fome meafure exprefs'd by the great titles and high founded epithets, they give to this whole Fa- mily, but particularly to its Head, and Prince. Such are Oodai, the great generation : Mikaddo^ Emperor, (Mikotto being peculiar only to the firft and fecond fucceflion of Gods and God-men : ) Tenoo heavenly Prince, Tenfin, Son of Heaven, Tee, Prince, and Dairi, by which laft name is frequently denoted the whole Court of the Ecclefiaftical here- ditary Emperor. (See Tab. xvi.) Thus i oo The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. So-.neRemarkj Thus far the common tradition of the Japanefe about the original defcent lout \ Trail- °f tneir n ^ lon , which is efteem'd as facred among them, as the au- tkn of the thority of holy Scriptures is among Chriftians. It were needlefs to re- «/"«»Jin Mu Ten Oo, civiliz'd and brought them into better order, and became himfelf, whether by force or choice, their firft Monarch. Since that time they have been accurate and faithful, in writing the Hiftory of their Country, and the lives and reigns of their Monarchs. To conclude, as Dadsijno Mikotto is by them be- lieved to have been the greateft of the firft fucceflion of Celeftial Spirits, and Ten fio Dai Dfin^ that of the fecend of God-men, fo they lock upon Sin Mu Ten Oo, as the greateft of the third race of the now living Inhabitants, in whofe family the hereditary right to the crown with a more than human authority was continued down to Kinfan Kiwotei y the prefent 114th Mikaddo, that is 2360 years, computing to the year of Chrift, 1700. I fay, the hereditary right to the Crown, for the go- vernment of the Empire itfelf is of late gone over into Secular hands, as will be ihewn more particularly in another place. CHAP. io2 The Hijlory of ] APAN, Book I. CHAP. VIII. Of the Climate of Japan, and its Troduce as to Minerals. Climate of *Y A P A N boafts of a happy and healthful Climate. The Air is 3a}a». its ver y j ncon ft ant an( j fubjedt to frequent changes, in the Winter loaded with Snow, and liable to fharp Frofts, in the Summer on the Rains'. contrary, particularly during the Dog-days, intolerably hot. It rains frequently throughout the whole Year, but with the greateft profufion in the Months of June and July, which are for this reafon calPd Satfuki, that is, Water-month. However the rainy Seafon in Japan is far from coming up to that regularity, which is obferv'd in other and hotter parts of the Eaft-Indies. Thunders and Lightning happen very fre- quently. The Sea, which encompafles the Iflands of Japan, is very rough Se ** and flormy, which with the many rocks, clifs and fhoals, above and under water, make its navigation very dangerous. It hath two re- WhWlpals markable and dangerous Whirlpools. The one is calPd Faifaki, and lies near Simabara below Amakufa. It is dangerous, chiefly when the Tide turns j for in high water it becomes even with the furface of the Sea, but as foon as the Tide begins to go out, it alfo after fome vi- olent turnings falls in of a fudden, as I was inform'd, to the depth of fifteen fathom, fwallowing up with great force, what mips, boats, and other things happen at that fatal jun&ure to come within its reach, which are dafh'd to pieces againft the rocks at the bottom. The fhatter'd pieces fometimes remain under water, fometimes they are thrown out again at fome German Miles diftance. The other Whirlpool lies near the Coafts of the Province Ktjnokuni. It is call'd Narrotto, and from the neighbourhood of the Province Awa, Awano Narrotto, which fignifies, the rujhing of Awa, becaufe it rufhes with a great boiftering noife about a fmall rocky Ifland, which is by the vio- lence of the motion kept in perpetual trembling. This, tho' of a for- midable afpecl, is yet efteem'd lefs dangerous than the other, becaufe its noife being heard at a confiderable diftance, it may be eafily avoid- ed. Japanefe Authors, efpecially Poets, frequently allude in their Writings to the wonderful nature and motion of this Narrotto, as do alfo the Priefts in the Pulpit. Waterf pouts. Water-fpouts alfo are frequently obferv'd to rife in the Japanefe Seas, and to turn towards the Coafts. The Japanefe fancy, that they are a kind of Water Dragons with a long watry Tail, flying up into the Chap. VIII. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 103 the Air with a fwift and violent motion, for which reafon they are by them call'd Tatfmaki, that is, /pouting Dragons. The Soil of Japan, in itfelf, is for the major part mountainous, rocky iSb ' 7 - and barren, but through the indefatigable care and induftry of the Natives, it hath been made fruitful enough to fupply them with all manner of necefTaries, befides what the neighbouring Sea affords of fifli, crabs and fhells. Even the moft rocky and uncultivated places yield their plants, fruits and roots, for the fuftenance of the Inhabitants, which their in- digent Anceftors by experience learnt to drefs and to prepare, fo as not only to make them fit for food, but likewife pleating and agreeable to the tafte. Confidering this and the frugal way of living of the Japanefe in general, we need not wonder, that this vaft and populous Empire is fo abundantly provided with all the necefTaries of human Life, that as a particular World, which Nature feems pur- pofely to have feparated from the reft of the Globe, by encompafling it with a rocky and tempeftuous Sea, it eafily can fubfift of it felf without any afliftance from foreign Countries, as long as Arts and Agri- culture are follow'd and improv'd by the Natives. The Country befides is plentifully fupplied with frefh water, there being tivm &ni very many Fountains, Lakes and Rivers up and down the Empire. st '" twateTSi Some of the Rivers in particular are fo large and rapid, by reafon either of the fteep high Mountains and Rocks, where they arife, or becaufc of the profufe fhowers of Rain, which fall frequently, that they are not to be pafs'd over without danger, the rather fince fome are fo impe- tuous as to bear no bridges. Some of the moft famous Rivers are, I. Ujingava, that is, the River Ujin. It is about a quarter of a Ger- Uim^avd man Mile (or an Englilh Mile and a half) broad, and there being Ritc ''- no bridge laid over it, it muft be forded through. The force and rapidity, with which this River falls down from the Mountains, is fuch, that even when the water is low, and fcarce kneedeep five ftrong Men, well acquainted with the bed of it, muft be employ'd to ford a Horfe through, which with the many large Stones lying at the bottom, makes the paffage equally difficult and dangerous. The people, whofe bufinefs it is to ford paiTengers through this and other fuch like Rivers, left they fhould not take due care, are by the laws of the Country^, made anfwerable for their lives. This is the reafon, why there are but few unlucky accidents happen. 2. The River Oomi, is famous for its furprifing beginning •, for it is recorded in Oom R:ver ' Japanefe Hiftories, that- it fprung up of a fudden in one night in the year before Chrift 285. It borrow'd its name from the Province where it arifes. 3. The River Afkagava is remarkable, for that the dfi a S Mvg depth of its bed alters perpetually, on which account it it is frequently alluded to by Japanefe Authors, chiefly Poets. Japan 104 The Hi/lory of] APAN. Book I Earthquakes* Japan is very much fubjed to Earthquakes, which happen fo frequent- ly, that the Natives dread them no more, than we Europeans do an ordina- ry ftorm of thunder and lightning. They are of opinion, that the caufe of Earthquakes is a huge large whale's creeping under ground, and that they fignify nothing. Sometimes however the makes are fo vio- lent, and laft fo long, that whole Cities are thereby deftroy'd, and many thoufand of the Inhabitants buried under the ruins. Such a dreadful accident happen'd, as Father Lewis de Froes relateth (in ope- re de Rebus Japonicis colleBo a Job. Kayo) in the year 1586, he him- felf being then in Japan, (a) The like accidents happen'd frequent- ly fince that time. In 1704, I had a letter from Batavia, from a friend of mine, then lately arrived from Japan, wherein among other things he gave me an account of fuch a violent Ihock, which hap- pen'd there in 1703, whereby, and by a great fire, which broke out at the fame time, almoft the whole City of Jedo, and the Imperial Palace itfelf, were deftroy'd and laid in allies, and up- wards of 2oo,coc Inhabitants buried under the ruins. It is remarka- p/ lies a fmall rocky Ifland, (one of thofe, which by reafon of their great number are call'd by the Japanefe Kmkht Sima, that is, the Ninety- nine Iflands,) which, though never fo fmall, and encompafs'd by the Sea, hath been burning and trembling for many Centuries. Another fmall Ifland oppofite to Sat&uma, which is by the Japanefe call'd Fno- go, which name they borrow'd from the Vortnguefe, and retain'd ever fince, and which is mark'd in our Maps by the name of Vul- canw, hath an ignivomous mountain, which hath been likewife burn- ing, at different intervals, for many ages. At the top of a mountain in the Province Figo is to be feen a large cavern, formerly the mouth of a Volcano, but the Flame ceas'd of late, probably for want of com. buflible matter. In the fame Province there is another place call'd Afo, famous for a Temple call'd Afa no Gongen, or the Temple of the jealous God of Afo, not far from which there is an almofl per- petual flame iituing out of the top of a mountain, and more vifible in the night, than it is in the day-time. Another burning Mountain lies in the Province Tfikufen, not far from a Place call'd Kujanoffe* It was formerly a Coal-mine, which thro' the careleflhefs of the Mi- ners accidentally took fire, and continued burning ever fince. Some- times a black flench and fmoke is obferv'd to ifTue out of the top of the famous mountain Fefi, in the Province Sumga, which in height is furpafs'd by the only Pic of Teneriff, but in fhape and beauty hath I think, not its equal : The top of it is cover'd with everlafling Snow, which, being, as it frequently is, blown up into flocks by the violence of the wind, and difpers'd about, reprefents, as it were, a fmoking hat. The Japanefe Hiflories mention, that formerly the top of it burnt, but that upon a new opening which was made by the violence of the fire at the fide of the mountain, the flame ceas'd foon after. TJnfen is a deform'd, large, but not very high mountain near Simabara. At all times the top of it is bare, whitifh from the colour of the fulphur, and withal refembling a Caput Mortmim, or burnt out Ma (fa. It fmokes little, however, I could difcern the fmoke arifing from it at three miles diflance. Its foil is burning hot in feveral places, and befides fo loofe and fpongious, that a few fpots of ground excepted, on which ftand fome trees, one cannot walk over it without continual fear, for the cracking, hollow noife perceived under foot. Its fulphu- D d rous io6 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book L rous fmell is fo ftrong, that for many miles round there is not a bird to be feen ^ when it rains, the water bubbles up, and the whole moun- tain feems then, as it were boiling. Many cold Springs and hot Baths arrife on and about it. Among others there is a famous hot Bath, which they believe to be an infallible cure for the Venereal pifeafe, if the Patient fcr feveral days together goes in but a few moments a day and wafhes himfelf in it. He mud begin the cure with ano- ther hot bath, not quite fo ftreng, call'd Obatimia, fituate a few leagues off and all the while he ufes the Waters, he muff keep to a hot warming Diet* and as foon as he comes out of the Bath, go to bed, and covering him- felf very well, endeavour to fweat. Not far from this hot Bath is a Monaflery of the Sect of Tendai. The Monks of this place have given peculiar names to each of the hot Springs arifing in the neighbour, hood, borrow'd from their quality, from the nature of the froth a-top, or the fediment at bottom, and from the noife they make as they come out of the ground, and they have amgn'd them as Purgatories for feveral forts of Tradefmen and Handicrafts-men, whofe profeflions feem to bear feme relation to any of the qualities above-mention'd. Thus for Infhnce, they lodge the deceitful Beer and Sackibrewers at the bottom of a deep muddy Spring, the Cooks and Paftry-ccok's in another, which is remarkable for its white froth, wranglers and quarrelfom People in another, which rulhes out of the ground with a frightful murmuring ncife, and fo on. After this manner impofing upon the blind and fuperfti- tious Vulgar, they fqueeze large Sums of Money out of them, making them believe that by their Prayers and Intercefiion they may be deliver'd from thefe places of torment after death. In that dreadful perfe- cution, which was rais'd in Japan againft the Chriftian Religion, and which hath not its equal in Hiftory, amongft innumerable other Tor- ments inflicted on the new Converts to make them abandon their newly embrae'd Faith, and return to the Paganifm of their Fathers, they were brought hither and tortur'd with the hot Waters of this place. Of other hot Baths in Japan, that call'd Obamma , is one of the moft eminent, and moft efficacious. It lies to the Weft of the moun- tain Ufen, about 3 Miles off, and is faid to have extraordinary Ver- mes in curing feveral external and internal diftempers, as among others, by bathing and fweating, the Pox, which however is obferv'd fre- quently to return, probably becaufe they are not fkilful enough to manage this diftemper, or by reafon of their not underftanding the right ufe of baths in general. The Province F'rgo hath feveral hot fprings, about which grow, as I was inform'd, Camphire trees of an uncommon fize, hollow and full of water. The chief and moft e- minent for its virtues is a hot bath not far from the abovemention'd temple Jfano Gongen. There are alfo feveral hot Springs in the Pro- vince Fifen y one for inftance in the village Takijo^ another in the tillage Urifino. Both would prove very beneficial in curing feveral diftem- pers, ;hap VIII. The Hijloryof JAPAN. 107 • ■ :rs, if the Natives did but know how to ufe them. I obferv'd it 1 all Afiatick Countries which I pafs'd through in my travels, that ie Natives ufe the hot baths feldom more than three, or at furtheft ght days, by which, probably enough, they will find fome benefit id relief, which they are too apt to miftake for an aftual cure, and 1 cafe of a relapfe to lay all the fault on the waters. The greatefl quantity of Sulphur is brought from the Province Sat- Sut^hn wna. It is dug up in a fmall neighbouring Ifland, which from the •eat plenty it affords of this fubftance, is call'd Irvogafmia, or the ulphur Ifland. It is not above a hundred years fince they firft ven- jr'd thither. It was thought before that time to be wholly inaccef- ble, and by reafon of the thick fmoke, which was pbferved conti- ually to arife from it, and of the feveral fpecfres, and other frightful ncommon apparitions, people fancied to fee there chiefly in the night, : was believ'd to be a dwelling place of Devils, till at laft a refolute nd couragious man offer'd himfelf, and obtain'd leave accordingly, to ;o and to examine the (tare and fituation of it. He chofe fifty refolute fel- 3\vs for this expedition, who upon going on fhore found neither Hell nor )evils, but a large flat fpot of ground at the top, which was fo through- y cover'd with Sulphur, that wherever they walk'd, a thick fmoke iilu- d from under their feet. Ever fince that time this Iiland brings in the Prince of Satzuma about 20 chefts of filver per annum, arifing inly from the Sulphur dug up there, befides what he gets by the rees and timber growing along the fliore. The Country of Simabd- a, particularly about the hot baths abovemention'd, -affords alfo a fine jure native Sulphur, which however the Inhabitants dare not venture o dig up, for fear of offending the tutelar genius of the place, they hav- ng found upon trial that he was not willing to fpare it. I pafs 0- /er in filence feveral other places, for want of a thorough information. Geld, the richeft of all Metals, is dug up in feveral Provinces of coil [he Japanefe Empire. The greatefl quantity of it is melted out of its own oar. Some they wafli out of Geld fand. Some fmall quan- tity alfo is contain'd in the Copper. The Emperor claims the fu- preme Jurisdiction of all the gold mines, and indeed all other mines in the Empire, none of which may be open'd, and work'd, without his exprefs leave and confent. Of the produce of all the Mines, which are work'd, he claims two thirds, and one third is left to the Lord of the Province, in which the Mine lies, the latter however, as they reude upon the fpot, know how to improve their third parts foastofhare pretty equally with the Emperor. The richeft Gold Oar and which yields the fineft Gold, is dug up in Sado, one of the Northern Pro- vinces in the great Ifland Nipon. Some of the veins there were for- merly fo rich, that one Catti of the Oar yielded one, and fome- times two thails of Gold. But of late as I was inform'd the veins there, and in moft other Mines, not only run fcarcer, but yield not near ! o8 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book T. near the quantity of Gold they did formerly, which we were told, was the occalion, amongft other reafons of the late drift orders relat- ing to the trade and commerce with us, and the Chinefe. There is alio a very rich Gold fand in the fame Province, which the Prince eaufes to be wafiVd for his own benefit, without fo much as giving notice of it, much lefs part of the profit, to the Court at Jtr- do. After the Gold Mines of Sac/o, thofe of Sunviga were always efteem'd the richeft, for befides that this Province yielded at all times a great quantity of Gold-Oar, there is fome Gold contain'd even in the Copper dug up there. Among the Gold-mines of the Province Satzuma, there was one fo rich, that a Catti of the Oar was found upon trial to yield from four to fix thails of Gold, for which reafon the Emperor hath given ftrict orders, not to work it, for fear fo great a trcafure mould be exhaufled too foon. A mountain on the Gulf Ookus, in the diftrid of Omwa, which had lean'd on one fide for a considerable time, happen'd forne years ago to fall over into the Sea, and there was found at the bottom of the place where it flood, fo rich a Gold fand, that, as I was credibly inform'd, it yielded one half of pure gold. It lay fomewhat deep, and was to be fetch'd up by Divers^ But this rich harveft lafted not long, for a few years after, in a great ftorm and extraordinary high tide, the Sea overflow'd all that fpot of ground, and cover'd at once thefe ineflimable riches with mud and clay to the depth of fome fathom. The poor people in the neighbour- hood flill bufy themfelves wafhing the fand about this mountain which contains fome Gold, but in fo inconfiderable a quantity, that they can hardly get a livelyhood by it. There is another Goldmine in the Province T/ibitigo, not far from a village call'd Tqffino, but fo full of water, that they can not go on with working it. However the fituation of the mine is fuch, that by cutting the rock, and making an opening beneath the mouth of the Mine, the water might be eafily drawn off. This was attempted accordingly, but as they went to work, "there arofe of a fudden fuch a violent Storm of thunder and light- ning, that the workmen were obliged to defift and to fly for fh elter, which made the fuperftitious vulgar believe, that the Tutelar God and Protedor of the place, unwilling to have the bowels of the earth committed to his truff. thus riffled, rais'd this Storm purpofely to make them fenfible how much he was difpleas'd at this underta- king. Nor was there any further attempt made fince for fear of pro. voking his anger and wrath flill more. Such another accident, and which had the fame effect, happen'd at the opening of a Gold-mine in the Ifland Amakufa, for it was fo fuddenly fill'd with water, which broke out of the mountain, and deftroy'd all the works, that the Miners had fcarce time to efcape and to fave their lives, Some ■> Chap. VIII. The Hijloryof JAPAN. 109 Silver. There are fome Silver Mines in the Province Bingo. Others, and thefe much richer, at a place call'd Kattami, in one of the Northern Pro- vinces: Others in other places, which I forbear mentioning, for want cf fufficient information. The two Iflands Ginfima and Kinfima, that is, Gold and Silver Iflands, which lie to the Eaft of Japan, and which I had occafion to fpeak of in the fourth Chapter of this Book, deferve a place here, if it be true, what the Japanefe boaft, and what their very Names and Characters feem to imply, of their Wealth and Riches. Copper, is the mofr common of all Metals dug up in Japan, and Coffer. the produce of Copper-mines enriches feveral Provinces of this Empire. It is at prefent dug up chiefly in the Provinces of Suruga, Atfingo and Kijnokuni. That of Kijnokwii is the fined, moft malleable and fitteft for work of any in the World. That of Atfingo is courfe, and fe- venty Catti's of it muft be mix'd with thirty Catti's of the Kijnefe to make it malleable and fit for ufe. That of Suruga is not only ex- ceedingly fine and without faults, but* charg'd with a confider- able quantity of Gold, which the Japanefe at prefent feparate and refine, much better than they did formerly, which occafions great complaints among the Refiners and Brahmines upon the Coafts of Cormandel. There are alfo fome Copper-mines in the Province of Satzuma, which the Emperor very lately gave leave to work. All the Copper is brought to Saccai, one of the five Imperial Towns, where it is refin'd and cafl into fmall Cylinders, about a fpan and a half long, and a finger thick. As many of thefe Cylinders, as amount to one pickel, or 125 1. weight, are pack'd up into fquare wooden boxes, and fold to the Dutch from twelve to thirteen Maas the pickel. It is one of the chief- eft Commodities the Dutch buy in Japan, and they carry on a great Trade with it. There is befides a fort of courfer Copper, which is caft into large flat roundifh lumps, or cakes, and is bought a great deal cheaper than the other, as it is alfo much inferior in goodnefs and beauty. Brafs is very fcarce in Japan, and much dearer than Copper, the Calamine- ftone being imported from Tunquin in flat cakes, and fold at a very good price. The Province of Bimgo affords a a fmall quantity of Tin, which is Tin. fo exceedingly fine and white, that it almoft comes up to Silver. There is but little ufe made of this Metal in the Country. Iron is dug up only upon the confines of the three Provinces Mima- Iron, faka, Bitsju and Bifen. But it is found there in very large quantities. It is refin'd upon the fpot, and caft into Staffs or Cylinders, two fpans long. Japanefe Merchants buy it at the place, and export it all over the Empire. It is much of a price with Copper, Iron tools be- ing full as dear, or rather dearer than thofe of Copper and Brafs. Such Houlhold-goods, Hooks, Cramp-irons in Buildings and Ships, and other Inftruments, as are in other Countries made of Iron, are made ifi E e Japan no The Hijhry of J A P A N. Book L ■ - '.:> Japan of Copper or Brafs. They do not chefs their Victuals in brals pans, but have a particular fort of kettles or pans which are made of a cempefition of Iron, and are pretty thin. The old ones of this fort are very much efteem'd, and bought at a great rate, they having fomewhat particular in their ihape and make, which at prefent they have loll the art to imitate. Ce ,/ ( They have no want of Coals in Japan, they being dug up in great quantity in the Province TJikufen about Kujanijje, and in moft Nor- thern Provinces. Sab is made of Sea-water in feveral maritime Provinces. They make it thus. They clofe in a fpot of Ground, and fill it with line loofe Sand, then they pour the Sea-water upon it, and let it dry. This thev repeat feveral times, till they think the Sand is fufficiently fa- turated with Salt. Then they take it out and put it into a large Trough, with holes at the bottom, and putting frefh Sea-water upon it, let it filtrate through the Sand. The Lye is boil'd to a good con- fiftence, and the Salt thus obtain'd is calcin'd in earthen Pots, till it becomes white, and fit for ufe and fale. Agats, of feveral forts, feme extraordinary fine, of a bluifh colour not unlike Saphires, as alfo fome Cornelians and Jafpers, are brought from the mountain Tfngaar, upon the Northern extremities of the great Province Osju, oppofite to the Country of JeJo. Pearls, by the Japanefe call'd Kainotamma, which is as much as to fay, Shell Jewels, or Jewels taken out of Shells, are found almoft every where about Saikokf in Oyfters and feveral other Sea-fhells. Every body is at liberty to fiih them. Formerly the Natives had little or no value for them, till they were appriz'd of it by the Chinefe, who would pay good prices for them, the Chinefe Women being very proud of wearing Necklaces, and other Ornaments of Pearls. The largeft and fineft Pearls are found in a fmall fort of Oyfter, call'd Akoja, which is net unlike the Perfian Pearl-fhell, much of the fame fhape, both valves fhutting clofe, about a hand broad, exceeding thin and brittle, black, fmooth and fhining on the out fide, within pretty rough and unequal, of a whitiili colour and glittering like Mother of Pearl. Thefe Pearl-fhells are found only in the Seas about Sat&uma, and in the Gulf of Ottwra. Some of the" Pearls weigh from four to five Con- clon'ins, and thefe are fold for a hundred Colans a piece. The Inha_ bitants of the Rhiku Iflaiids buy moft of thefe, which are found about Satzuma, they trading to that Province. Thofe on the contary which are found in the Gulf of 0?nwa, are fold chiefly to the Chinefe and Tunquinefe, and it is computed that they buy for about 3 coo Thails a year. This great profit occafion'd the ftrict orders, which were made not long ago by the Princes both of SatMuma and Omnra, im- porting, that for the future there mould be no more of thefe Oyfters fold in the Market with other Ovfters, as had been done formerly. I %fcers Pearls. Chap. VIII. The Hi (lory of JAPAN. in I procur'd fome in private from Omtira, not without great difficulty. I was told a very extraordinary thing of this fort of Pearls, and ftrongly affur'd of the truth of the facl, which is, that they have fome what of a prolitick quality, by virtue of which, when fome of the largefi are put into a box full of a peculiar Japanefe cheek varnifh, made of another fhell call'd Takaragai (which I fhall defcribe in another place) one or two young Pearls will grow on the fides, and when come to maturity, which they do in about three years time, drop off. Thefe Pearls, by reafon of their fcarcity, are kept in private Families, and the poffeffors feldom part with them, unlefs upon urgent neceffity. All this however I deliver only upon hearfay, having my felf feen none of this fort of Pearl. There is another Shell, which fometimes yields Pearls, found plentifully upon all the Japanefe Coafts, and call'd by the Natives Awabi. It is an Univalve, in fhape almoft oval, pret- ty deep, open on one fide, where it fticks to the Rocks and to the bottom of the Sea, with a row of holes, which grow bigger, the nearer they come to the circumference of the Shell, rough and limy on its outward furface, frequently with Corals, Sea-plants and other Shells flicking to it, on the infide of an exquifite Mother of Pearl's glim- mering, fometimes rais'd into whitifh pearly excrefcencies, which are likewife obferv'd in the common Perfian Pearl-fhelh A great lump of flefh fills the cavity of this Shell, for which fole reafon they are look'd for by Filhermen, being a very good commodity for the market. They have an Inftrument made on purpofe to pull them off from the fides of the Rocks, to which they flick clofe. Another Shell, the name of which I could not learn, yields a very large Pearl, which fometimes weighs from five to fix Condonins, but they are of a dirty yellow colour, ill fhap'd, and worth but little. A pretty good fort of Pearl, is fometimes obferv'd to grow in the very Flefh of a Shell, which is call'd by the Natives Tairaggi, and is found in the Gulf of Arima, between Janagava and Ifafaje. It is a flat fort of a Shell, oblong, almoft triangular, a little crooked on each fide, about a fpan and a half long, and a fpan broad, where broadeft, thin, tranfparent, fmooth, and polifh'd like Horn, but very brittle. Naohta, of a reddifh colour, by the Japanefe call'd Tfutfono Abra 7 Kapha. which fignifies red Earth, is found in a River of the Province Jet fin- go. It is taken up in fuch places, where the water hath little or no run, and the Natives burn it in Lamps, inftead of Oyl. Some Ambergreefe is found upon the Coafts of Satzuma, and of the . , r ° r ' jimbergreeje Riuku Iflands. A much greater quantity comes from the Coafts of Kbumano, as they call them, whereby muft be underftood the Southern Coafts of Kijnokwii, Isje, and fome neighbouring Provinces. It is found chiefly in the Inteftins of a Whale, which is caught frequently upon the Japanefe Coafts, and is by the Natives call'd Fiakfiro, that is, the hundred fathofh Fifi, becaufe of the length of its Inteftins, which is fuppos'd 1 1 2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I. fuppos'd to equal that number of Fathoms. It is found, as I obferv'd, in the Inteftins of this Whale, particularly in the lower Guts, mix'd with chalky limy excrements, almoft as hard as Stone, and 'tis from the hardnefs of thefe excrements, they conjecture upon diflecting, whe- ther or no they are like to meet with Ambergreefe. The Natives have given a very defpicable name to this precious commodity, a name how- ever becoming the meannefs of its origine, for they call it Knfurano fti, that is, the excrement of Whales. The Ambergreefe, as it is tore off by the waves from the bottom of the Sea, and thrown upon the Coafts, before it is fwallow'd by the Whales is a deform'd, flat, flimy Subftance, not unlike a Cow-turd, and withal of a very difagreeable ungrateful fmell. People that find it thus floating on the furface of the Water, or lying upon the Coafts, take feveral fmall pieces, fqueeze and prefs them clofe together, into the form of a round ball, which as it grows dry, becomes alfo more folid and weighty. Others mix and knead it with Meal, or Flower of Rice -husks, by which me.tns they not only encreafe the quantity, but heighten and better the co- lour. However, the Ambergreefe thus adulterated is eafily known, for if you take any quantity and burn it, there will remain a Coal, proportionable to the quantity of the Stuff mix'd with it. It is ob- ferv'd befides that the worms get quickly into this fpurious fort of Ambergreefe. Others adulterate it, by mixing it with a certain pow- der'd Rcfin of a very agreeable fcent, but this cheat alfo is eafily difcover'd, for upon burning a piece of it, the mixture of Rofin will evidently appear by the very colour, fmell and quali- ty of the fmoke. The Chinefe have another way of trying whether it be genuine, they fcrape fome of it very fine upon hot boiling Tea- water, if genuine, it will difiblve and diffufe equally, which the adul- terated fort doth not. The Natives ufe it no otherwife but as an ingredient of other well fcented fpecies, in order, as they fay, to fix their volatile fmell. In the main they value it but little, and 'tis owing entirely to the Dutch and Chinefe, who would buy it up at any rate, that they have now learnt to prize it. And yet every body is at liberty to take it up, where he finds it, and to fell it as his own property. During my flay in Japan, there was a piece to be fold of 140 Catti's weight, and of a greyifli colour. It was too large for any fingle perfon to purchafe, for which reafon they fold it by retail, from fixty to feventy Thails a Catti. I bought my felf for a- bout thirty Thails of that which was blackeft. {A more particular Ac. count of the Ambergreefe is inserted in the Appendix) S*b'i«*cts? All forts of Submarine Plants, Shrubs, Corals, Stones, Mufhrooms, Sea-fans, Corallines, Fuci, Alga;, and the like, as alfo Shells of all kinds, are found plentifully in the Japanefe Seas, no ways inferior in beauty to thofe found about Amboina and the Spice Wands. But the Natives value them fo little, that they won't be at the trouble of looking for them Chap. VIII. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 113 them, and if by chance the}'- happen to fifh them up amongft other things, their way is to carry them to the next Temple, or Chapel of Jebus, who is the Neptune of the Country, thinking that it is not an un- pleafing offering to this God, whom they look upon, and worfhip, as the Prote&or of Sea-faring People. Ir remains to fay fomething of the Minerals and Mineral fubftances, Minerals net 1 r^i-.-v 1 • 1^, I found in Ja- w hich have not as yet been found in Japan, and are imported from beyond p an . Sea. Antimony and Salarmoniac are abfolutely wanted, nor are their qualities Mummy.- and ufes in the leaft known to the natives. Quickfdver and Borax are s ^ arr " 0, l) ac - imported by the Chinefe. I met however with two forts of Borax, Bo~n• I both phyfical and domeflick. Kiri. is a very large but fcarce Tree. See ^ fl f w< *' !V7 Oyl. It hath leaves like Burdock, flowers like the Digitalis fet to a long k*W: flalk, and feeds refembling Marfhmallow feeds. The MikadJo or Ec- clefiaflical Hereditary Emperor bears the leave of this Tree, with three flowering flalks, in his Coat of arms. (It is defcri'-'d and figured, pag. 859 of the Ameen. Exot.~) Abrafin is a middlefized Tree with the leaves of jy ra Jim a Platamts. Its flowers refemble Rofes in fliane and bignefs, and the feeds are like the feeds of the Ricimis, which made me call it Ri- cimis arboreus folio Alcex. The Afadiracht Avicennk. The Tfubaki a- bovemention'd, as alfo the Urufi, Faafi, and Kainoki Trees. The Cotton Shrub and Plant. Sefami of two kinds, with white and black feeds. Of all the Oils exprefs'd out of the feeds of thefe feveral plants, only that of the Sefamum and Kai, are made ufe of in the kitchin i2o TheHiJloryof JAPAN. Book I. kitckin, and even thefe but fparingly, victuals being commonly drefs'd in this Country without either butter or oyl. obftrvat'mu The Japanefe are as good Husbandmen, as perhaps any People in nueenumthe yj: J\^ m Nor indeed is it very {urprizing, that they have made great Stit.ofjgri. ■ a • l rj ■ 11 culture in improvements in Agriculture, conlidering not only the extream popu- • 7c f""" - loufnefs of the Country, but chiefly that the Natives are denied all commerce and communication with Foreigners, and rauft neceifarily fupport themfelves by their own labour and induftry. Hence the Laws on this head are very particular and fevere. Not only the Fields and flat Country, which are feldom or never turn'd into Meadows and pafture Ground, but likewife the Hills and Mountains, afford Corn, Rice, Peafe, Pulfe, and numberlefs edible Plants. Every inch of Ground is improv'd to the beft advantage, and it was not without great ad- miration, we beheld in our Journeys to and from Court, Hills and Mountains, many inaccefllble to Cattle, which would lie wholly neg- lected in other Countries, cultivated up to their tops. They are very dextrous and skilful in manuring their Ground, which they do in va- rious ways, and with many different fubffances, as I (hall have occa- fion to lhew in feveral places of this Hiftory. Flat low Grounds are plough'd with Oxen, fteep and high ones by Men, and both manur'd with human dung. As to Rice in particular, which is the main Food of the Natives, what Ground they can conveniently fpare, and will admit of its culture, is turn'd into Rice-lields, particularly low flat Land, which they can cut through by Canals, and where they have a command of water, which furprizingly quickens the growth of this Plant, it loving a wet muddy Soil. The Japanefe Rice accordingly is eflreem'd the belt of all AJia, particularly what grows in the Northern Provinces, which will keep many years, and which for this reafon they chufe to fill their Store -houfes withal, having firft wafh'd it in muddy water and then dried it. All Lands muft be furvey'd every year, before they are fown, by Kennne, as they call them, being fworn Surveyors, who are very big of their skill in Geometry, and have the privilege of wearing two Swords, which is ctherwife allow'd to none but to the Nobility and Soldiers. When the Harveft draws near they are furvey'd once more, at which time it is computed what the whole Crop is likely to amount to, which they do generally, in- deed by guefs, but yet with a furprizing accuracy, and thereby pre- vent the Tenants cheating their Landlords. If the Harveft is like to prove extraordinary "good, they caufe a fquare piece of Ground to be cut and threfh'd, and thence infer as to the whole. The Landlords claim Rokubu, fix parts in ten, of all the produce of their Land, whether Rice, Corn, Wheat, Peafe, Pulfe, or other, and the Tenant for his trouble and maintenance keeps Sijbu, or four parts in ten. Such as hold Lands of the Crown, give but four parts in ten to the Emperor's Stewards, the remainder is for themfelves. For encourage- ment's Chap IX. The Hiflory of JAPAN. 121 ment's fake fuch -as cultivate untill'd Ground, have the whole Crop left them for the firft two or three years. The Ground in general is divided into three forts. 1. Sso, the beft. 2. Tsju, middling, and 3. Ge, poor Ground. But they admit like wife of Dfo no fw, next to the beft, Dfo no Tsju, next to the middling, and Dfo no Ge, next to the bad. Some regard is had, as to the fcot, to the good or bad quality of the Soil, and it varies alfo confiderably in different Provinces, but in the main it amounts to fix parts in ten. Among many excellent Laws, which relate to Agriculture, they have one, by virtue of which, whoever doth not cultivate his Ground for the term of one year, forfeits his Title and Poffeflion. The chief produce of the Fields, which contributes mod to the Gokpkf. fuftenance of Life, is by the Japanefe comprehended under the name of Gokokf, that is, the five Fruits of the Fields. 'Tis by their good or bad growth they eftimate the value of the Ground, the fruitfulnefs of the Year, and the wealth of the Poffeilor. They make up the chief dilhes at their meals, and make good the want there is cf Flefh-meat, which Cuftom and Religion forbid them to eat. The Gokokf, are i. Koine or Rice. There are feveral varieties of Rice grow in the R,f '' Country. The beft fort hath not its equal in the Indies. It is per- fectly white, like Snow, and fo nourilhing and fubftantial, that Fo- reigners, who are not ufed to it, can eat but little of it at a time. Boil'd to a gcod confidence they eat it at their meals inftead cf Bread. Out of what remains from their yearly provifion, they brew a fort of ftrong fat Beer, call'd Sacki, but no more than they think their Fami- sack! Beef. lies fliall have occafion for. Foreigners can export no more Rice, or Beer, than what the Magiftrate will allow them. 2. Oomvg^i, which is as Barley. much as to fay, great Corn, is, what we call Barley. They feed their Cattle and Horfes with it : Some drefs their Victuals with the Flower, and make Cakes of it. There is a -fort of Barley grows in Japan, with pnrple-colour'd Ears, which, when ripe, are a curious Ornament to' the Fields. 3. Koomuggi, that is, fmall Corn, is what we call Wheat. jfy At . It is extreamly cheap, and I know of nothing they make cf it, but a particular fort of Cakes made of the Flower. 4. Daidfu, that is, Daidbeans, DaiJLeuns. is a certain fort of Beans, about the bignefs of Turkilh Peafe, grow- ing after the manner of Lupins. They are next to the Rice in ufe and efteem. Of the Meal of thefe Beans is made what they call Midfu, a mealy Pap, which they drefs their Victuals withal, as we do with Butter. What they call Soeju, is alfo made of it, which is a fort of an Fmbamma, as they call it, which they eat at meals to get a good Stomach. This Soeju is exported by the Dutch, and brought even into Holland. I have defcrib'd their way of making it in my Amanitates Exotic*, p. 839. where the Plant it felf bearing thefe Beans is figur'd and defcrib'd. 5. Adfuki, or Sodfu, that is Sobeans. They grow likewife after the manner of Lupins, and are black, not unlike &*"'**• H h Lentils 122 TheHiftory o/JAPAN. Book T. Lentils, or the Indian Cajan. The flower is bak'd with fugar into Mansje and other Cakes. Befides the feveral forts of Gokokf juft men- tion'd, the following Plants are comprehended under the fame name : Awa, Indian Corn, (Panicitm IndicnmTabern.) Kibi, or Milium vulgare no- flras, Millet : Fije, or Panicum vulgare juba minor e femine nigrhante : And in general ail forts of Corn, and Mami, that is peafe and pulfe. Tunics. Turneps grow very plentifully in the Country, and exceeding large ones. Of all the produce of the fields they perhaps contribute molt to the fuftenance of the Natives. But the fields being manur'd with human dung, they fmell fo flrong, that Foreigners, chiefly Eurcpeans> cannot bear them. The natives eat them raw, boil'd, or pickel'd. Horfe-radifhes, Carrots, Gourds, Melons, Cucumbers, Mala infana, Fen- nel, and fome forts of Lettice, which with us are cultivated in Gar- dens, grow wild in japan. The Pajlinaca Hortenjis, or Garden-parfnip is not to be met with. But Wild-parfnip grows plentifully every where. Parfley, Cummin, Succory, and our common European Let- tice are cultivated by the Dutch, as they were formerly by the Por- tuguese, and thrive extraordinary well. Gnat Variety Befides the plants, I have hitherto mention'd, there are numberlefs %aban. others, that grow in the Fields, upon hills and mountains, in woods and fcrefts, in morraffy grounds, in barren and uncultivated places, along the Sea-Coafts, and in fhort every where. Of all thefe there, are very few, but what afford their roots, leaves, flowers and fruits not only for the fuftenance cf the common people, but even for the delicious tables of people of quality. There is a great variety of mufhrooms, moft of which are eat. Seme indeed are poifonous, and unlucky accidents happen frequently. The ufe of feme other plants is often attended with the like dangerous confequences, the venomous being fometimes miftook for the wholefcm by ignorant people. Some indeed they know how to deprive of their hurtful and venomous qualities. Thus out of the Konjakf^ which is a poifonous fort of a Dracunmlus, they prepare a fweet mealy pap. In the like manner by exprefling the Juice, by macerating and boiling the roots of the Warabi or Fern, of the Ren, or Faba JEgyptiaca, call'd by fome Tarate flower, as alfo of what they call Kafne, they make a fine fort of flower, which is of great ufe in dreffing their victuals, and which they eat befides, by it- felf diflblv'd in water. Of all the foft fubmarine plants there is hard_ Iy one, but what the Natives eat. Fifher men's wives wafh, fort, and fell them, and they are likewife very dextrous in diving them up from the bottom of the Sea in twenty to forty fathom depth. CHAP. Chap X. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 123 CHAP. X. Of the flenty of the Country, as to Beafls, Birds, R^ptiles^ and Infers. OF the Animals of this Country fome are merely Chimerical, not Jn'maU of exifting in nature, nor invented by the Japanefe themfelves, but J J P an ' borrow'd from their Neighbours the Chinefe. Of thefe it will not be improper to give fome account, before I proceed to defcribe thofe, which really exift. Kiriri) according to the defcription and figure, which the Japanefe give Chimerical of it, is a winged Quadruped, of incredible fwiftnefs, with two foft A **m£ horns (landing before the bread, and bent backwards, with the body of a Horfe, and claws of a Deer, and a head which comes neared to that of a Dragon. The good nature and holinefs of this Animal are fo great, that they fay, it takes fpecial care, even in walking, not to trample over any the leaf! Plant, nor to injure any the mod incon- fiderable Worm, or Infecl, that might by chance come under its feet. Its conception and birth require a particular conftellation in Heaven, and the birth of a Sefm upon earth. Sejhi is a Man endow'd by na- ture with an incomparable underdanding, and a more than human penetra- tion, a Man capable to dive into the Myderies of divine and fuper- natural things, and withal fo full of love towards Mankind, as to reveal his difcoveries for their common benefit. There are famous, as fuch, the two Chinefe Emperors Gio and Sinn, the memory of vvhofe ex- cellent Government, and the great difcoveries they made in the knowledge and virtues of Plants, will be always dear in that Empire : Koofl and Moo/i, two Chinefe Philofophers : Sidka an Indian Philofopher, and great difcoverer of fupernatural truths : Darmd in China, and Sotoktais in Japan, both founders of particular Seels, and Perfons of an unfpotted holy Life. (Tab. IX. Fig, i. is the Figure of this Creature according to the Chinefe, and Fig. 2. the fame according to the Japanefe. J Befides the Kirin, there are tWo other Chimera's of the Quadruped Snugm kind: One is call'd Suugu, reprefented in Tab. 9. Fig. 3. It is not unlike a Leopard, as to its fhape, but hath two foft horns before the bread, bent backwards. The other is call'd Kaitju, or Kaifai. This Kuhfs. hath fomething of the Fox in its fhape, two horns before the bread, another horn in the forehead and a row of prickles, like the Crocodil, along the back. (See Tab. IX. Fig. ^.) After the four-footed Chimera's, the Tas, Dria, or Dsja, as it is The Dra?.*, call'd by the Japanefe, that is, the Dragon mud be mention'd. The Chr'oni- 1 24 The Hiftory of JAPA N. Book I. Chronicles and hiftories of their Gods and Heroes are full of fabulous Stories of this Animal. They believe that it dwells at the bottom of the Sea, as in its proper element. They reprefent it in their Books, as a huge, long, four-footed Snake, fcaly all-over the body, like the Crocodil, with fharp prickles, along the back, but the head is beyond the reft monftrous and terrible. The Tail of the Japanefe Dragon ends, as it were, into a two-edged fword. ( Tab. IX. Fig. 5. J Some of the Japanefe Emperor's clo'h, his arms, Scimeters, knives, and the like as alfo the furniture and hangings of the Imperial Palace, are adorn'd with figures of this Dragon, holding a round jewel, or pearl in the right fore-claw. The Japanefe Dragon hath but three claws on each foot, whereby it is diftinguifh'd from the Chinefe Imperial Dragon, Tatfmaki. which is reprefented with five. Tatfmaki, is another Dragon, with a Water-Dra- j on g wa try tail. It is believ'd, that this alfo lives at the bottom of the Sea, and by flying up from thence into the Air, occafions by its vio- lent turnings, what we call a Water-fpont, which Phcenomenon is very common on the Japanefe Seas, and obferv'd frequently to break to- wards the Coafts, (See Tab. IX. Fig. 6. ) Foottrd of f 00 i s a Chimerical, but beautiful, large Bird, of Paradife, of a near kin to the Phcenix of the ancients. It dwells in the high regions of the air, and it hath this common with the Kirin y that it never comes down from thence, as the Japanefe religioufly believe, to honour the Earth with its blelfed prefence, but upon the birth of a Sefm, or that of a great Emperor, or upon fome fuch other extraordinary occafion. The Too of the Chinefe is reprefented in Tab. IX. Tig. 7. and that of the Japanefe in Tab. IX. Tig. 8. Thus far the Chimerical Animals. I proceed now to give an account of fuch as do really exift. Arnault of Confidering the largenefs and extent of the Japanefe Empire, it is 3*/*». k ut fp ar [ n crly fupply'd with four-footed Beafts, wild or tame. The for- mer find but few defart places, where they could increafe and multi- ply, and follow their ufual fhy way of life. The latter are bred up only for carriage and agriculture. Pytbagoras's doelrine of the tranf- migration of the Soul being received almoft univerfally, the natives- eat no Flefh-meat, and living, as they do, chiefly upon Vegetables, they know hew to improve the ground to much better advantage, than by turning it into meadows and paftures for breeding of Cattle. To Hafes. begin with the tame Beafts. There are Horfes in the Country : They are indeed little in the main, but fome of them not inferior in fhape, fwiftnefs and dexterity to the Perfian Breed. They ferve for flate, for riding, for carriage and ploughing. The beft Horfes come from the Provinces Satzuma and Osju. And a certain breed of little Horfes Oxen ani from Kai is very mnch efteem'd. Oxen and Corns ferve only for ploughing and carriage. Of milk and butter they know nothing. They Eiifles. h ave a f ort f j ar g e B u ffl eS) f a rnonftrous fize, with bunches on the back, like Camels, which ferve for carriage and tranfport of goods only, in Covs. Chap. X. The Hilary of JAPAN. 125 in large Cities. They know nothing of Affes, Mules, Camels, and Ele- phants. Sheep and Goats were kept formerly by the Dutch and Per- sheefl a „j fcuguefe at Firando, where the kind ftill fubfifts. They might be bred Goats - in the Country to great advantage, if the natives were permitted to eat the flelh, or knew how to manage and manufacture the Wool. They have but few Swine, which were brought over from China, and are Sv -' ine - bred by the Country-people in Fifen, not indeed for their own Ufe, which would be contrary to their fuperftitious Notions, but to fell them to the Chinefe, who come over for trade every year, and are great admirers of Pork, tho' otherwife the do&rine of Pythagoras, a- bout the tranfmigration of Souls, hath found place likewife in China. Since the now reigning Emperor came to the throne, there are more Dogs bred in Japan, than perhaps in any one Country whatever, and Da &*' than there were before even in this Empire. They have their Matters indeed, but lie about the Streets, and are very troublefome to paffen- gers and travellers. Every ftreet mutt, by fpecial command of the Em- peror, keep a certain number of thefe Animals, and provide them with victuals. There are Huts built in every ftreet, where they are taken care of when they fall fick. Thofe that die, muft be carried up to the tops of mountains and hills, as the ufual burying-places, and very de- cently interr'd. Nobody may, under fevere penalties, infult or abufe them, and to kill them is a capital Crime, whatever mifchief they do. In this cafe, notice of their mifdemeanours muft be given to their keepers, who are alone empower'd to chaftife and to puniih them. This extraor- dinary care fcr the prefervation cf the Dog-kind is the effect of a fu- perftitious fancy of the now reigning Emperor, who was born in the Sign cf the Dog, (The Reader is defied to take notice, that the Dog is one of the twelve Celefaal Signs of the Jdpanefe, as JJjall be fiewn hereafter in Bock //. Chap. 2. J and hath for this reafon fo great an efteem for this Animal, as the great Roman Emperor Auguftus C ' ■ ' ■ ■ * M I II III ■ — P II I- I ■ I I ..... ■ » I — ..| ■ I . | . . _ _ _ : _ had been purpofely cutoff. They don't care for moufing, but lcve mighti- ly to be carried about, and carefs'd chiefly, by Women. Few footed *^ f° ur f° otec l wfld Beads the Country produces Deer, Hares and vild Beajis. Boars, all which the adherents of fome Seels are permitted to eat at certain times of the year. The Ifland Mi)ofima, or Akino Mijofima fo call'd from the neighbourhood of the Province Aki, is famous for a particular breed of Deer, which they fay are very tame and Dcer - familiar with the Inhabitants. It is contrary to the Laws of the Country to chafe and to kill them. The Country People take care to remove their dead Carcafes from their Houfes and Fields, for- afmuch as the Governor of the Ifland is empower'd by virtue of another Law, to fentence thofe, before whofe doors, or upon whofe ground fuch Carcafes are found, to fome days work, either at the Temples, or for the Publick. They have fovne few Monkeys .. , of a docile kind, with fhort tails, of a brcwnifh dark colour, with naked red faces and backs. A Mountebank IhewM one a- bout the Country, which he pretended was ic6 years old, and B which play'd feveral artful tricks with great dexterity. They have fome few Bears in the Northern Provinces, but of a fmall kind. Tamtkj. Tamtki is a very lingular kind of an Animal, of a brownifh dark co- lour, with a fnout not unlike a Fox's fnout, and pretty fmall : It feems otherwife to be of the Wolf's kind. They have likewife a fort of Wild Do-s. w ji^ Dogs, with large gaping fnouts. Itutz is a fmall Animal of a ituti. redifh colour. Another larger fort of it is call'd Tin : They both live in Tin. houfes, and lodge themfelvcs under the roofs , they are fo tame, that they might be rank'd among the domeffick Animals. They are very dex- trous at catching of Fowl, chiefly Chickens, and Filh. The whole Coun- try fwarms with Rats and Mice, The Rats are tam'd by the Natives, and taught to perform feveral tricks. Rats thus taught are the common diverfion of fome poor People. The bed of the kind, and which play with molt dexterity are to be feen at Ofacea, as the place which Mountebanks, Jugglers and Rarylhow-people refort to from all parts Foxa. f t ] ie Empire. Foxes alfo are very common. The Natives believe that they are animated by the Devil, and their Hiftorical and Sacred Writ- ings are full of flrange accounts of feveral odd accidents, which hap- pen'd with, and with regard to Foxes. The Fox-hunters however are very expert in conjuring and (tripping this animated Devil, the Hair and Wool being very much coveted for their writing and painting Pen- cils. They make the fame diftinclion between the Kis, or Fox, and Oni or Devil, as they do in Sweden between Faan, and Dieblen. Of Tygers, Panthers, Lyons, and fuch other voracious Animals Japan is entirely free. Thus much of the four footed wild and tame Beads, which are to be met with in Japan. The Infeds of the Reptile kind are next to be taken into confideration. Among thefe a mifchievous fmall Creature, known Rats. Chap. X. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 127 known all over the Eaft-Indies by the name of white Ants, claims the hrft place. It is a fmall flender Worm, perfectly white like Snow. They live together in commonalty, as our European Ants do, from whom they do not much differ in fhape and bignefs. • Their head and breaft, are of a brownifh dark colour and hard to the touch. The Japanefe call them Do Toos, which is as much as to fay, Pier- cers, an Epithet, which they very well deferve, for they pierce and perforate whatever they meet with, Stones only and Ores excepted, and when once they get into a Merchant's Ware-houfe, they are able with- in a very fhort compafs of time to ruin and to deftroy his beft Goods. Nothing hath been as yet found out, that will keep them off, but Salt laid under the Goods and fpread about them. Our common European Ants are their mortal Enemies, and whatever place the one fort takes poiTeffion of, the others muft neceffarily quit it. They are no more able than Moles to fupport the open air, and whenever they go out upon an expedition, they defend themfelves by building arches or trenches all along their march, which they know how to tie fail to the ground. Thefe arches are much of the fame fubftance with that of Wafp's-nefts. I was told furprizing and melancholly Stories of their quick and mifchievous marches and expeditions. But I will only re- late what I was an Eye-witnefs of my felf. During my flay at Coy- lang, a Dutch Fort upon the Coafls of Malabar, I had an apartment aflign'd me in the Governor's own Houfe. One Night I did not go to bed till about mid-night, having been very bufy. The next Morning, when I rofe, I took notice of the marks of fuch arches upon my table, which were about the bignefs of my little linger, and upon a more accurate infpe&ion I found, that thefe Animals had pierc'd a paffage of that thicknefs up one foot of the table, then acrofs the table (tlio' as good luck would have it, without any damage done to the papers and things I had left there) and fo down again through the middle of the other foot into the floor. All this was perform'd within a few hours time. Some attribute the caufe of fo quick and furpriz- ing a corrofion to the fharpnefs of their excrements, but wrongly as I found upon examination, for I took notice, that their fnouts were arm'd with four (harp crooked pinchers, which in my opinion, are Inftruments far more proper to do fuch quick execution, than any excrements how fharp and corrofive foever. M-n'adde, according to the common Japanefe dialed, and Goko in Uuk_aiie their fignificant or Character language, are not what we call Jfelli or Fortyhgsi Wood-lice, but the Indian Millepedes, Palmer-worms, or Forty-legs, a worm of about two or three inches in length, flender, of a brown colour, having a great number of legs on both fides, from whence it hath borrow'd its name. The Indian Forty-legs are very venomous, and their bites are reckon'd more dangerous and painful, than thofe of the Scorpion. There are but few in Japan, and thofe not very mifchie- rousi 128 The Hijloryof JAPAN. Book I. vous. The part which is ftung, or bit, is drefs'd with fpittle, and the bite feldom obferv'd to be attended with ill confequences, (See Tab. X. Fig. i.) Lizards. ^he Lizards of this Country do not differ from our common Eu- ropean Lizards. Snal There are but few Snakes in the Country. One of the moft famous is ntakiiti. call'd Fitahttz,, and Fibakari. It is of a green colour, with a flat head and (harp teeth. It hath borrow'd its name from the length of the day, or the time the Sun flays upon the Horizon, becaufe People bit by it, are faid to die before Sun-fet. Soldiers are very fond of its flern, which they eat, firmly believing, that it hath the virtue of making them bold and couragious. This Snake calcin'd in an earthen-pot, hermetically feal'd, gives that powder, which they call Gawatfio, and which is very fa- mous for its vermes in curing feveral internal difrempers. This fame Powder, put under the gutters of a houfe, is faid in a fhort time to produce young Snakes of the fame kind. I met with this fort of Snake no where elfe but upon the Coafts of Malabar, where I was fhew'd fome by the Bramines. Another fort of Snakes cf a monftrous fize, cail'd Ja- ?dinakf%«ts. makagats, or according to the common Dialed TJwabami, and fometimes Dsja, that is Dragon, is found in waters and upon mountains. It is very fcarce, and when taken, fhew'd about for money. (See Tab. X. Fig. 2.) From the Reptiles I proceed to the Birds. 7W Em/. Of tame Fowl they keep Chickens and fometimes Ducks, but being as I took notice above, imbued with the fuperftitious notions of Pythagoras, the generality will not eat them, and they are kill'd and fold to fuch as do venture to eat them, only by Perfons of a mean extraction. When a Man lies at the point of death, as alfo upon thofe days which are fas- cried to the memory of deceas'd Perfons, none of their relations and friends may kill any bird or beaft whatever. In the mourning years for the death of an Emperor, and at any other time, when the Emperor thinks fit to order it, no living creature whatever may be kill'd or The Cocks, brought to market in any part of his dominions. The Cocks oftner find pardon than Hens, and are kept alive with great care, becaufe they are held in great efteem, chiefly among the religious Orders, by reafon of their mea- furing the time, and foretelling future changes of the weather. Wild WlUFoul. Fowl, tho' naturally lliy, are in this populous Country grown fo familiar, that many kinds of them might be rank'd among the tame. The Tfuri, or Crane, is the chief of the wild Birds of the Country, and ruth this particular Imperial Privilege, that nobody may flioot him without an exprefe order from the Emperor, and only for the Emperor's own pleafure or ufe. In Saikokf however, and in other Provinces remote from Court, a lefs ftricl regard is had to the like Imperial Commands. The Cranes and Tortoifes are rcckon'd very happy Animals in themfelves, and thought to portend good luck to others, and this by reafon of their pretended long and fabulous life, of which there are feveral remarkable inlbnces recorded in Cram. Chap X. The Hi/lory of JAPAN, 129 in their Hifforical YVritings. For this reafon the Imperial Apartments, walls of Temples, and other happy places are commonly adorn'd with Figures of them, as alfo with Figures of Firs and Bambous for the like reafon. I never heard Country-people, and Carriers, call this Bird otherwife than, Tfarifama, that is, My greM Lord Crane. There are two different kinds of them, one white as Snow, the other grey or aih-colour'd. There are feveral kinds of Saggi, or Herons, Heroas - which differ in colour and fize. The chief are Sijro Saggi, the white Heron, Goi Saggi, the grey Heron, both very common, and Awoi Saggi, a Heron of a bluilh colour and almoft as big as a Crane. There are two differeut forts of wild Geefc, which couple each with their VAMGeufc. kind. One fort is as white as Snow, only the extremities of the wings are black:, the other is grey or a(h-colour'd. Both are very common in this Country, particularly the grey ones, and fo familiar, that they might be taken for tame, for they will not fly up, nor get out of the way at any body's approach. They do a great deal of mifchief in the Fields, and yet no body may diflurb, or kill them, un- der pain of death, except thofe who have bought the privilege to moot them in feme trads of ground. The Country-people, to keep them off, furround their Fields with nets, tho' to very little purpofe, for they will fly over the nets, as I have feen my felf, to get at their Food. Of Ducks alfo there are feveral differing kinds, and as tame as the Duck?. Geefe. One kind particularly I cannot forbear mentioning, becaufe of the Kinmodfni furprizing beauty of its male, call'd Kinmodfm, which is fo great, that a he«»tifid being fhew'd its prcfure in colours, I could hardly believe my own Eyes, till I faw the Bird it felf, it being a very common one. (v. Tab. X. Fig. 3.) Its feathers are wonderfully diverfify'd with the fineft co- lours imaginable, about the Neck and breaft chiefly they are red. The head is crown'd with a moft magnificent topping. The Tail rifing obliquely, and the wings Handing up over the back in a very Angu- lar manner, afford to the Eye a fight as curious, as it is uncommon. ■ There are alfo Pheafants of uncommon beauty. ' One kind par- pheafants. ticuhrly is remarkable for the various colours and luftre of its fea- thers, and for the beauty of its tail, which equals half a Man's length, and in a curious variety and mixture of the fineft colours, chiefly blue and gold, is no ways inferior to that of a Peacock. Woodcocks are a Woodcocks* very common Bird :, they are eat by the adherents of fome Seels, as are alfo the Pheafants, Geefe and Ducks. There is a fort of wild Pigeons with black and blue feathers, tho' otherwife they are no great beau- ^}y pi . ties. The Natives won't fuffer them to rieft in their Houfes, becaufe F, eo,!S - they found by experience, lhat their dung upon removal is very apt to take fire, and they fay that many an unlucky accident happen'd thereby. Storks Ray in the Country all the year round. „ , K k The 1 30 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book I Ravens. Ftmlctms. The belt Falcons are caught in the Northern Provinces, and are kept more for State than Sport. Hooks. Hawks are common here, as they are every where in the Eaft-Indifs, and a very proud Bird, as is alfo a kind of Ravens^ of a middling fize, which was firft brought over from China, as a Prefent to the. Em- peror. Another fcarce Bird was fent over from Corea, by way of Prefent Ctrtan Ra- . . ven. to the Emperor, and is thence call'd Coreigaras, that is, a Corean Ra- ven. Our common European Crows, as alfo Parrots, and fome other In- dian Birds, are not be met with in Japan. Foken * Token, cr according to the common DialecT Fototenis, is a fcarce Nigh Bird. Night Bird, of an excellent and delicious tafte, and a difli only for the tables of people of quality upon extraordinary occafions. The afhes of this Bird calcin'd, and put into old fower Sacki, are faid to reftore it to its former tafte and goodnefs. (See Tab. X. Fig. 4, J Mfago. Mi/ago, or Bifago, is a voracious Sea Bird of the Hawk-kind. It preys chiefly upon Fifh. It makes a hole in fome Rock, upon the Coafts, where it lays up its prey and provifion, which is obferv'd to keep as well as pickel'd Fifh, or Atfiaar, and is thence call'd, Eifa- gonofufi, or the Bifago' s Atfiaar. It taftes very fait, and is fold dear. Whoever knows fuch a Cave can make a good deal of Money of it provided he doth not take out too much at a time. (See Tab. X. Fig. 5. Miss i£c Mews, Sea Ravens, Snipes^ Sea-pies^ Sparrows, Swallows, and fome other fmall Birds are as common here, as in Europe. Lar h- Larks fing much better here, than they do in Europe. Nightingales. The Nightingales, if they have a good voice, are fold fometimes to curious People for twenty Cobangs a piece. Thus far, what I had to obferve concerning the Birds of this Country. Flying i»- Of flying Infe&s the Country hath Bees, confequently fome Honey /"*?• and Wax, tho' but in a fmall quantity. Humble-Bees, Wafps, com- mon Flies, Gnats, Fire-flies, feveral forts of Beetles and Bugs, as alfo Locufts, and a great variety of other Infecls of this Tribe, it hath common with Europe, befides fome other particular and remarkable forts, the chief of which I will here give a lliort account of. Among the Butterflies there is one very large fort call'd, Jamma Tfio, or the Mountain Butterfly. It is either entirely black, or party Buturfiia.1 colour'^ and curioufly diverfified with white, black and other fpots, chiefly upon its forked wings. Komuri is a large, fpotted, party co- lour'd, hairy, beautiful Nightfiy. The fame name is given alfo to Mettles ^ ats * ^ Beetles, they have feveral fcarce and beautiful kinds. One in particular is very large, in fhape not unlike the Dung-fly, irrining, black, with two crooked and branched Horns, one larger Handing over the Chap X. The Hiftory o/JAPAN. 131 the Nofe, after the manner of a Rhinoceros's Horn, the other frnaller, {landing out on one fide from the Shoulder. This Animal cannot walk eafily. It lives chiefly under ground. It is fcarce, and the Natives have as yet given it no name. A certain kind of brown Beetles call'd Sebi, and fometimes Semi, af- sebi,afortof fords feveral curious and remarkable things to the attentive Eye of an Beetles - inquifitive Naturalift. They are of three different kinds. The largeft is call'd Kuma Sebi. (Tab'. X. Fig. 6. A. B.) It refembles in fhape and bignefs that fort of Flies, which with us in Europe are generally ob- ferv'd to fly about in the Evening, but it hath no Wings. In the Spring they creep out of the Ground, (where they have lain in Winter-quarters) in the night-time, and fatten themfelves with their fharp hoary legs to Trees, their branches, or leaves, or whatever in their march they can lay hold of. A little while after they burfi, and fplit their back length- ways, to give room to another Fly not unlike a Beetle, which was en- clos'd within it, tho' much bigger than the Prifon to which it was confin'd. Some hours after, this fecond Fly flies away with a hurrying noife. This curious little Animal hath been defcribed by Qejfner by the name of Cicada. Burfting open the fhell in which it lay, and at the fame time fpreading out its four wings, it makes a fharp and loud noife, which they fay, may be heard (a thing almoft incredible) very diftindly at full an Englifh Mile's diflance. Woods and mountains are full of the noife thefe little creatures make. They difappear gradually in the Dogdays, and 'tis faid, that they creep into the ground again in order to undergo a new Metamorphofis or change, and to re -appear in the fame Mate the next year. How far this agrees with truth, I am not able to determine for want of proper Obfervations. The name Semmi or Sebi, which they bear, is borrow'd from their Mufick, which begins flowly and upon a low tune, then increafes gradually in fwiftnefs and loudnefs, and again ends pretty low. This Mufick, I thought, was not unlike the Noife a Button-maker's fpindle makes in turning. They begin to fing with the Rifing-fun, and end about Noon, The Exuvim call'd Semi no Mukigara are preferv'd for phyfical ufes, and fold publickly in fhops both in Japan and China. (Tab. IX. Fig. 6. C. D. E.) Another frnaller kind is from its fmallnefs call'd Kofebi, or the fmall Sebi. (Tab. X. Fig. 6. F. G. H. I.) They appear later in the year, much about the time when the others difappear. They fing from Noon to Sun-fet, and live till late in Au- tumn. Their mufick is not near fo loud as that of the firft kind, and is by the common people call'd Tfuku Tfukuboo. The third kind differs from the fecond neither in fhape nor bignefs, only they fing from morn- ing to night. The Females of all the three kinds are mute, and have their breaft fhut : In all other refpecls they are like the Males. (See Tab. X. Fig. 6. K. L.) The CantbariJes, or Spanifo-fiies are of the fame colour with our Spanifi- s^anifi- flits, flies, but fomewhar bigger and rounder, and very near as big as our common European 132 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book L European Beetles. Their i\fe is entirely unknown in Japan. Another particular fort of Spanim-fiies is call'd F annuo. They are extremely cauftick, and rank'd among the Poifons. Thq T are found upon Rice -Ears, and .ire long, (lender, and fmaller than the Spanifli-flies, blew or gold- colour : d, with fcarlet or crimfon fpots and lines, which makes them look very beautiful. (Tab. X. Fig. 7. J But the fineft of all the flying tribe SMglar c f jnfecls, and which by reafon of its incomparable beauty is kept by '&*P>- t j ie j^ies among their Curiofities, is a peculiar and fcarce Night-fly, about a finger Jong, ilender, round-bodied, with, four wings, two of which are tranfparent and hid under a pair of others, which are mining, as it were poliflt'd, and moll curioufly adorn'd with blew and golden lines and fpots. The following Fable ows its origin to the unparallel'd beauty of this little creature. They fay that all other Night-flies fall in love with. it, and that to get rid of their importunities it malicioufly bids them (for a trial of their conftancy) to go and to fetch fire. The blind lovers fcruple not to obey commands, and flying to the next fire or candle, they never fail to burn themfelves to death. The female is not near fo beau- tiful as the male, but grey, or afh-colour'd and fpotted. C H A P. XL Of Fifl and Shells. FroJs&iom ofT~ ~"^ H E Sea, and its Productions, contribute full as much towards tbt Sea. the fuftenance of the Natives, as the growth of the Country, Rice only excepted. The Sea all about Japan is plentifully ftor'd with all forts of Sub-marine Plants, Fifli, Crabs and Shells, of all which there are very few, but what were eat by their indigent Anceftors, and are fo to this day. There are even many which in thefe wealthy and refin'd Ages appear upon the fumptuous tables of People of the higheft quality. Both Fifh, Crabs and Shells, are comprehended under one general Name JGokai, or Iwokai. In this prefent chapter, which may be look'd upon' as an Introduction to one of the following, wherein I intend to treat of their tables and kitchin, I will fet down as many of them as came to my knowledge, along with their true Japanefe Names, though it mud be obferv'd in general, that feveral of them are found likewife in our European and other Seas. Of all the animal productions of the Japanefe Seas, I know none f fo extenfive an ufe, for rich and poor, as the Kudfuri or Whale. It is caught frequently about Japan, but particularly in the Sea Khu- ww, which wafhes the Southern Coafts of the great Ifland Nipon, as v aifo Whales. Chap. XL The Hi (lory of JAPAN. 133 alfo about the Iflands Tfitffima and Goto, and upon the Coafts of Omura and Isovio. The common way of catching them is with darts, or harping- u oVJ ra ught. irons, as they do in the G roen land-mite ry, but the Japanefe Boats feem to be fitter for this purpofe than ours, being fmall, narrow, tapering into a fharp point at one end, with five oars, or ten Men each, who row them with incredible fwiftnefs. About 1680, a rich Fifherman in the province Omura, whofe name was Gitaijo, found out a new way of catching Whales with Nets made of flrong ropes about two Inches thick. This method was afterwards follow'd with good fuccefs by a Country- man in the Wands of Gotho, whofe name was Iwonomo. They fay, that as foon as the Whale finds his head entangled in a net, he cannot without great difficulty fwim further, and may be very eafily kill'd with Harpoon-irons after the common manner. The reafcn why this new Method, which feem'd to bid very fair for fuccefs, hath not been uni- verfally receiv'd is, becaufe it requires a greater, and much more expenfive fetof proper Tackle, than common Filhermen can afford. For whereas the expence of Whale-fifhing, after the common manner, feldom exceeds 20 Cheits of Silver, this cannot be fo much as attempted with alefs Sum. There are feveral forts of Whales, which differ in their names, fhape, Difiretii fm-ts and bismefs. 1. Sehio is the chief, and indeed the larg;efl Fifh of the "■' A Whale-kind. It affords mod Train-oyl, and its flefh is very good, s,l ' i0 - and wholefom, fo far that Fifher-men and the common People attribute their good ftate of health amidft all the injuries of cold and weather, which they are continually expos'd to, chiefly to their eating this flefh, 2. Arvo Sangi, commonly KokaJfura, that is a fmall Whale, is grey or ^0 Sang. aih-colour'd, finaller than the Sebio, from which it alfo differs fomethihg in fhape. 3. Nagafs, is commonly 20 to 30 fathom long, and hath this i\>:. particular, that he can flay under water for two or three hours, du- ring which time he can travel a vafl way, whereas other Whales mufl continually come up to the furface of the water for fre(h fupplies of air. 4. Sotookadfura, that is, the Whale of blind People, fo call'd from the figure Satmkadfurai of a Bijwit, or a fort of a Lute, which blind people in this Country ufe to play upon, which is faid to be naturally reprefented on its back. It is not a very large fort, and feldom exceeds ten fathom in length. It is caught frequently about Japan, but the flefh is reckon'd unwhol- fome food, being, as they fay, too hot, and occafioning coughs, fevers, eruptions on the fkin, and fometimes the Small-pox. It is brought to market with other fifh, and fold for the fiefli of the Sehio, but thole who know it will never buy it. 5. Mako never exceeds three or four fa- M*kp t thorn in length. This fame name is given to the young ones of the other kinds. That, which I hear fpeak of, is caught frequently upon the Eaflern Coafts of Japan, as alfo upon the Coafts of Kijnohtni and Sat&uma. Ambergreefe is found in the inteftins of this Whale. The head yields a fmall quantity of Train-oyl. 6. Iwajihtra, that is, Tvalik*? Sar dins-Eater, hath a tail and fins like common Fifh. We faw this L 1 fort 34 The Hi/lory of] A P A N. Book I. fort, when we went up to Court, between Catmnofeki, and Sinuh nofeki, and I took it to be that Fifh which the Dutch call tloord Caper. Of all thefe feveral kinds of Whales nothing is thrown away as ufe- lefs, excepting only the large Shoulder-bone. The (kin which is black in moft kinds, the Flefh which is red and looks like Beef, the inteftins, which from their remarkable length are call'd Fiakfiro, that is, an hundred fathoms long, and all the inward parts are eat, pickel'd, boil'd, roafted, or fry'd. The fat or blubber is boil'd into Train-oyl, and even the fediments of the fecond boiling are eat. The bones, fuch as are of a cartilaginous fubftance, are boil'd when frefh, and eat, or fcrap'd, clean'd and dried for the ufe of the kitchin. Out of the nervous and tendi- ous parts, both white and yellow, they make cords and ropes, chiefly for their Cotton-manufactures, as alfo for their Mufical Inftruments. Not even the garbage is thrown away, but kept for feme ufe in the Kitchin. Several little things are made of the jaw-bones, fins and other bones, which are of a more folid fubftance j particularly their fine fiilyards for weighing Gold and Silver are made of them, and have borrow'd their name from thence. Sutfifo'o. Satjifoko is a Fifh two, three, and fometimes five to fix fathoms long, with two long teeth or tufks, (landing out of the mouth upwards, which are fometimes, by way of ornament, put at the top of caftles, temples, and publick buildings. I was inform'd by Fifhermen, that this Fifh is a cunning and mortal enemy of Whales, and that he kills them by creeping into the mouth, and devouring their tongues. He hath a way, as he creeps in, to put his head and teeth into fuch a pofture, that they are no hindrance to him. •£>•<«. Iniku is a known Fifh, call'd Tenije in the Indies, (Tab. XI. Fig. 1.) is-nht. Furube is another Fifh, not very large, (Tab. XI. Fig. 7.) The Dutch call him Blazer, which fignifys Blower, becaufe he can blow and fwell himfelf up into the form of a round Ball. He is rank'd among the poifo- nous Fifh, and if eat whole, is faid unavoidably to occafion death. There are three different forts of it found in the Japanefe Seas, all in great plenty. The firft fort call'd Sufimebiika is fmall, and feldom eat, The fecond is call'd Mabuhi, that is the true Bukii. This the Japanefe reckon a very delicate Fifh, and they are very fond of it. But the Head, Guts, bones, and all the garbage muft be thrown away, and the Flefh carefully wafh'd and clean'd before it is fit to eat. And yet many People die of it, for want, as they fay, of thorougly wafhing and cleaning it. People that by fome long and tedious ficknefs are grown weary of their lives, or are otherwife under miferable Circumftances, frequently chufe this poi- fonous Fifh, inftead of a knife or halter, to make away with themfelves. A Neighbour of my Servant at Nangafaki being fo ftrongly infected with the Pox, that his nofe was ready to drop off, refolv'd to take this Meal, in order to get rid at once both of his life and diftemper. Accordingly he bought a good quantity of this poifonous Fifh, cut it into pieces, boil'd it. Chap. XT. The Hifiory o/JAPAN. 135 it, and in order as he thought, to make the poifon ftill ftronger, he took foot from the thatch'd roof of his houfe, and mix'd it with the reft. After dinner he laid himfelf down to die, and foon falling mortally tick, he brought up not only the poifon he had taken, but a large quantity of vifcid, iharp, nafty matter, probably not the lead caufe of his diftem- per, and by this means found life and health, in what he fought for death, for he recover'd and was well afterwards. A few years ago five perfons of Nagafaki having eat a difh of this Fifh, fainted foon after dinner, grew convulfive and delirious, and fell into fuch a violent fpitting of Blood, as made an end of their lives in a few days. And yet the Japanefe won't deprive themfelves of a difh fo delicate in their opinion, for all they have fo many Inftances, of how fatal and dangerous a ccnfequence it is to eat it. Soldiers only and military men, are by fpecial command of the Emperor forbid to buy and to eat this Fifh. If any one dies of it, his fon forfeits the fucceflion to his father's poft, which otherwife he would have been entitled to. It is fold much dearer than common Fifh, and not eat, but when frefh. The third fort is call'd Kitamakitra, which figni- fies North Citfiton. I could not learn the reafon of this Appellation. The fame Name is given to a Perfon that fleeps with his head turn'd to the North. The poifon of this fort is absolutely mortal, no wafhing nor cleaning will take it off. It is therefore never ask'd for, but by thofe who intend to make away with themfelves. The Sea Horfe, or Sea Dog, and, as the Germans call him TVaffer- Set-Hrfe. bancb, is a very fingular fifh, much about the length of a Boy of ten years of age, without either fcales or fins, with a large Head, mouth and breaft, a large- thin belly like a bag, which will hold a large quantity of wa- ter. He hath thin fharp teeth in the chops much like a fnake. The inner parts are fo minute, that they are fcarce vifible. He hath two flat cartilaginous feet with fingers, not unlike the hands of a child, under the belly, by the means of which, he creeps, in all likelyhood or walks at the bottom of the Sea. All his parts are eat, none ex- cepted. He is caught frequently in the Gulf of Jedo, between Ka- mahtra and that Capital, where I faw him brought to market. Tat, is what the Dutch in the Indies call Steenbraflem. This is very Tai. much efteem'd by the Japanefe as the King of Fifh, and a peculiar Emblem of happinefs, partly becaufe he is facred to their Jebis, or Neptune. partly by reafon of a beautiful variety of fhining colours, which appear on him when under Water. It is a very fcarce Fifh, not unlike a Carp> and finely variegated with red and white. The Female hath fome red fpots. It is fo fcarce, that upon fome great entertainment at Court, or other extra- ordinary occafions, it is not to be had under a thoufand Cobangs. Ano- ther fort of this Fifh is call'd Kharo Tat, or black Steenbrajfetn, from the Khnro Taj colour. This is not near fo much efteem'd, and is caught frequently about Saikokf. Snfuh, 1 36 The Hijhry ofjAPAN. Book I. tuna. . Ko:. Ma ■■:■■ Itojoti. SaKitra. [:,!V.O. Ara. Ku una. Su r uki. Ta\*. K'.me. jqe. Come. Karei. Karajiti Katfwxo. Managatfwu.0 Se\e. Sitftiki, is what the Germans call K&Ukopf, that is, Baldh'ead. (Tab. XI. Fig. 3.) Funa is a fifh not unlike a Carp, and much commend- ed for his Medicinal Virtues, chiefly againft Worms. A larger kind of the fame is call'd Najos. Mebaar is a red colour'd fifh, in bignefs and fliape not unlike a Carp, or Steenbraflem, with the Eyes Hand- ing out of the head like two bills. It is caught every wherein great plenty, and is the common food of poor People. Koi is another fort of it, which alfo refembles a Carp, and is lometimes one Sack/ and a half long. This fort is caught in Rivers, chiefly about Water-falls, a- gainft which they endeavour to fwim. They are fo ftrong that two Men can hardly held them. They are exported all over the Empire, f re Ih and pickel'd. They take fome in the Lake of Saifa, or Tenfiu which are four Sakf long. Maar, the Salmon is taken in Rivers and frefh water Lakes. Itojori is a Salmonat, cr fmall Salmon. Makuts, is what the Dutch call Harder. Samara, a King's-fifh. Fiuwo is what the Dutch call Draatvij'b. Ara (Tab. XI. Fig. 5) is what the Dutch in the Indies call Jacob sEwertz, Knfwia, a Ihort nofe. Kamas a Pike. Su- fuki is the Schaarvijh of the Dutch, only a longer and narrower fort. Add is the Naasbancker of the Dutch. Of this there are feveral different kinds, the chief and largeft whereof is call'd Ooadfi. (Tab. XI. Fig, 6.) Takd is what the Dutch call a Kaye. Katne, and Takafame, (Tib. XI. Fig. ".) are Rays, of the hard flans of which they make cafes and other curious things in Japan. The fkin of this fifh is imported alfo from Siam, where it is found much finer. Jeje is a broad flat fifh with a long tail. There is one fort of it, which hath a fmall horny, or bony, fling at the end of the tail, which the Dutch in the Indies call Pijlflaart. ' The Japanefe believe, that this fling taken from a live fifh is an infallible reme- dy againft the bite of Snakes, rubbing the bitten part with it. For this reafon they carry it along with them among other Houfe Medicines. Come, or Jet, are Soles, and Karei, Eots or Emts. Bora is a fifh much like a pike, with a white and delicious flefli. Some call him Songaats Fijb, be- caufe he is taken in the Songaats, or firfl month of the Japanefe year. They pickle and fmoke them, as they do pikes at Bremen. Thefe and all pickel'd fifh in general, are call'd Karafumi. They export them from Nagasa- ki and Isomo, where they are frequently caught, and carry them to Jedo, and into feveral. other parts of the Empire, tied to ftraw- ropes, ten to a rope. They are exported by the Dutch and Chinefe. Other fifh made into Karajfnmi are valu'd but little by the Natives. The beft fort of the Katfinvo fifh is caught about Gotbo. They cut this fifh into four pieces, which they dry by degrees over the damp of hot boiling water, and bring it upon the table along with the Li- quors. The Dutch export it by the name of Coinblomaas, which how- ever is not the true name. Managatfiirvo is a flat fifh, not unlike a But, with one Eye on each fide. Sake, perhaps a fort of Cablian., is a pickel'd fifh, not unlike Cod. It is imported from the Country of J4o t Chap XL The Hijioryof JAPAN 137 Jefo, and hath borrow'd its name from its fmell, which is not unlike the fmell cf their Sake Beer. Tara is a fort of Cod imported from the Northern Tara. Provinces ; the beft of the kind comes from Tfwfijn, whence it is call'd TJioftjn Tara. Sajeri, is what the Inhabitants of Nagafaki call Sufumo- Sajor). two, and the Dutch Naadelvi/f), (Tab. XI. Fig. 8.) which (ignifies Needle- fi!h. It is a fmall fifh, not above a fpan long, thin, with a row of fliarp, long prickles along the back. Tobiwo is what the Dutch call Tobiuo. a Springer, (Flymg-fijh) becaufe it leaps out of the water. The Japa- nefe one feldom exceeds a foot in length, and is very delicious, but rare- ly taken. Iwas, is the Sardin • Kifjngo, the Smelt, or Sand-fmelt. iv>a$. Jefo by the Dutch call'd Sandkruper, is a middling fifh. between a Mfj^- Smelt and an Eel. Saba are Mackrels. Ai, or Ai no itoo, by the Dutch s«ba. At. call'd Modevifh, is a frefh-water fifh, not above a fpan long, fwimming with furprizing fwiftnefs. Sijroiwo, is what the Dutch call Kleiner St'rnd: They Sjrbmv. alfo call him Weijpuijh, that is white fifh. He is caught in the Spring about the mouths of rivers. Konofijro, call'd by the Duth SaJJap, is a Konoslyo. fort of Herring, not unlike the Swedilh Strohmlings. K/ngjo, the Gold- Fijh, is a fmall rah feldom exceeding a finger in length, red, with a beau- tiful mining, yellow or gold-colour'd tail, which in the young ones is rather black. In China and Japan, and almoft all over the Indies, this fith. is kept in ponds, and fed with flies before their wings come out. Another kind hath a filver-colour'd tail. Unagi is the com- xjuagi. mon Eel. Oounagi is another fort of Eels much larger than the com- mon. (Tab. XII. Fig. i.) Jaatzme Unagi, that is an Eel with eight Eyes, Several jbni is what is call'd in Germany NeuAaug, that is Nine-eye, or an Eel with nine eyes. (Tab. XII. Fig. i.) T)oodfio is by the Dutch call'd VuytAal. (Tab. XII. Fig. 3. J It is a fiih about a finger long, with a very large Head in proportion to the Body, found frequently in watry Rice-field:; and muddy ponds. They are of two different Kinds, the one with, the other without a beard. They have a Notion, that they may be brought forth artificially out of ftraw cut, and mix'd with mud and dirt, and expos'd to the heat of the Sun early in the morning. Farnmo, by the Dutch call Conger Aal, is larger than a common Eel, which it re- fembles, when under water, but flenderer. (Tab. XII. Fig. 4. ) Ika is a common Seaqualm. Both the Chinefe and Japanefe efteem ika. r it a fcarce and delicate bit. Fifh alfo are eafier caught with the flefh of 1"' l!: " : - this qualm, than with any other bait. (Tab. XII. Fig. 5. 6.) Jako or 340. Sepia, is another Sea-qualm with long tails or feet, at the end whereof are, as it were, fmall hooks, wherewith the creature fallens itfelf to rocks, or the bottom of the Sea. (Tab. XII. Fig. j.) It is a common Soccano or Side-diih, and eat either frefh, boil'd, or pickel'd. There are two forts of Kuragge, which is alfo of the Sea-qualm kind. One is call'd Kurazge. Midfnhtrage, that is, the white qualm. (Tab. XII. Fig. 8.) This is common in all Seas, whitifli, tranfparent, watry, and not fit to eat. The other is fcarcer, flefhy, and eatable after it hath Been prepar'd and M m depriv'd 138 TheHiflory of J A P A N. Book I. depriv'd of its fharpnefs. It is prepar'd after the following manner. They firft macerate them in a diflblution of Alum for three days toge- ther, then they rub, wafh and clean it, till it grows tranfparent, which done, it is pickel'd and preferv'd for ufe. Before the Infufion, the fkin is taken off, wafh'd, pickel'd and kept by itfelf. Some of thefe Sea-qualms are fo large, that two men can fcarce lift them up. Pickel'd, as they are brought upon the table, they are of the fame fubftance, colour and tafte with the edible Bird's-nefts (Nidi Alcyonum) brought from China, and I have been credibly inform'd by Chinefe Fiihermen, that thefe Bird's Neils are made of the very flefh of this Animal. .kp. Na/nako, by the Dutch at Batavia call'd Kajferkuff, is edible. (Tab. XIII. , Fir. 1. ) Imori is a frnall venomous Water-lizard, black, with a red bell v. 1 nomakit- * s 111 >vr. (Tab. XIII. Fig. 1.) Takanomakura, which is as much as to fay, the pil- low of the Sea-qualm Tako, is the common Sea-ftar, and is not eat. To; Of all the footed animal produce of the water, the Ki, or Came, Tortoifes, are moft efleem'd by the Japanefe, being look'd upon as peculiar Em- blem? of happinefs, by reafon of the long life which is afcrib'd to them. Emblema- That kind particularly, which hath a broad tail much like a large round beard, and which in their learned language is call'd Mooke y and by the common people Minogame, for all it doth not exift in nature, is yet fre- quently to be feen among other emblematical figures, wherewith they adorn the walls of their temples, the fides of their altars, and the apart- ments of the Emperor and Princes of the Empire. (Tab. XIII, fig. 3. 4.J LanATortoiJe The moft common Tortoifes are, Ificame, or Sanki, that is, the Stone, or Mountain Tortoife, which is fo call'd becaufe found in thefe places, and is nothing elfe but the common Land-tortoife. (Tab. XIII. Fig. 5. J Jo fat Tortoife- Game, or Doo Game, that is, FifJjy. or Water-tortoife, (Tab. XIII. Fig. 7.) becaufe of its living in the water. They fay, that upon the Southern and Eaftern Coafts of Japan there are found Tortoifes large enough to cover a Man from head to toe. Qahs and ^ ^ orts °^ Crabs and Shrimps both of frefh and fait water, are Shrimp. call'd in general Jebi. The following particular Kinds are come to my ^ebifakfi. knowledge. Jebifako is the common fmall Crab, which is found in , great plenty upon the Coafts of the Baltick. Sako fignifies all forts of Si Jebi. fmall fifh in general. Si Jebi differ but little from the common Crabs, no more than what they call Dakma Jebi, excepting only, that the latter are ' caught in frefh water, and will within a year turn black. Kiiruma Jebi, Kumma^ebi. . g ag n^h as t0 fay JFheel-crabs - they are fo call'd from the figure of Vmi Jebi. their tail. Umi Jebi, that is great Crabs or Lobfters, are commonly a foot long. They are boil'd, then cut into fmall pieces, and brought upon the- table, as a Soccana or Side-clifi. Care muft be taken not to eat their black tail, becaufe it hath been obferv'd, that it gives people the ak-xa: belly-ach, or throws them into a Cholera morbus. Siakwa, is a Crab with a broad Tail, which is caught frequently with other fmall fifh. It hath but little flefh, and almoft none at the time of the full moon. All the teftaceous Gamma. Chap XI. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 1 39 te/laceous and cruflaceous animals-, which are found in thefe Seas, and indeed every where in the Indian Ocean beyond the Eaflern fhores of the Ganges, are obferv'd to be flefhier and fuller, at the time of the new moon, contrary to what happens in our European Seas. Gambia, (Tab. XIII. Fig. 7.) otherwife Koona, is a Crab, which lives in a beautiful fhell diverfified with various colours, (This is what the Englifh call Soldier's Crab, Fre\h water Soldier, Hermit Crab, becaufe they live in other People's quarters) Kara, which figniiies Pocket Crab, is our common European frefh-water Crab. It bears the name of the whole Tribe of the frefh-water Crabs. Kabutogani, or Unliiu, is a Crab of a lingular flru&ure, with a fharp, long, ferrated prickle or fword, (landing out from the head, and a roundifli, fmooth back. (Tab. XIII. Fig. 8.) Gadfame is no bigger than the com- mon Crab, with the upper ihell tapering into a point on both fides. It hath four claws, two large ones before, and two behind, which are fmal- ler. (Tab. XIV. Fig. i.) Simagani, that is, a Striated Pocket-crab. It might be call'd Wart-crab, from the great number of warts and prickles, which cover the Shell all over, the hind Claws only excepted, which are fmooth and almoft cylindrical. (Tab. XIV. Fig. i.) They are caught frequently unon the Eaftern Coafts, as alfo in the Gulf of Suruga. Some of this fort are incredibly large. I bought one of the hind Claws at Sun/ga in a Cook-fhop, which was as long, and full as big as a Man's Shin-bone. (Tab. XIV. A. reprefents it as big as the Life. J All forts of oyfters, mufcles and fhells, of which there is a great oilers and 0-/7 plenty and furprizing variety in the Japanefe feas, are eat, none excepted, raw, pickel'd, faked, boil'd, or fryed. They are daily gather'd on die Coafts in low water. Divers dive for them to a considerable depth. Others filh them with nets. The following forts are the moft com- mon and beft known. Awabi, which I have already mentioned, when I A-aJa: fpoke of the pearls of this Country, is an open Univalve, as big as a middle fiz'd Perfian Pearl fhell, but deeper. (Tab. XIV. Fig. 3.) They lie deep underwater, flicking faft to rocks, or to the bottom of the Sea, from whence they are taken up by Fifhermen's wives, they being the beft Divers of the Country. They go down arm'd with Darts or long knifes, to defend themfelves againft Kayes and PorpefTes, and when they fee an Awabi, they pull it off fuddenly before the animal is aware, be- caufe otherwife it would faften itfelf to the rocks, cr to the bottom of the Sea, fo ftrongly, that no force would be ftrong enough to tear it off. This fhell is fill'd with a large piece of flefh o£ a yellowifh, • or whitifli colour, and a very tough fubftance, though without fibres. They fay, it was the common food of their neceflitous Anceftors, in memory whereof when they entertain company at dinner, they always provide a difh of it. It is alfo become a cuftom with them, as well among the vulgar, as among people of quality, that when they fend one a- nother prefents of money, cloth, fluffs, fruits, or any thing elfe, a firing, or at leaft a fmall bit of the dried flefh of this fhell is fent along i^o The Hiftory &/JAPAN. Book I. '..' \ ha:. r 'ttri along with them, as a good Omen, and in order to put them in mind bf the Indigency of their Forefathers. The flefh is cut into thin flices cr firings, which are extended on a beard, and dried. A large Pearl is found fometimes in this Shell, but of an ugly yellowilh co- i , a deformed fhape and of no Value. Tdiragi is a flat, long, thin, and very large bivalve, almoft tranfparent, near of a triangular Figure, r inning from a large bafe tapering into a point. The Animal is tied faft to both fides of the fhell with a ftrong tendon. (Tab. XIV. Fig. 4.) The beft of the kind are found in the Gulf of Arbna, where it fometimes yields Pearls. Akoja is a flat bivalve, about a hand broad fcaly, en its outward furface, and of a very ugly appearance, within cf an exquifite Mother of Pearl's glimmering. The beft of the kind, and which yield the fineft Pearls, are found in the Gulf of Omura. Mirakat is the common black frefli water Mufcle, which is found alfo in our Rivers and Lakes in Germany. Famaguri^ (Tab. XIV. Fig, 5.) are bivalves much of the fame fhape and bignefs, but thicker, fmooth and white within, without of a brown or chefnut colour. Divers curious figures are painted on the infide, and they ferve as an Amufement to the Court of the Dairij or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor, who play with them after the following manner. Large heaps are thrown on the ground, and every one of the Company having taken his Portion, he wins, that can (hew the mod pairs. Every pair hath proper hooks, by the means cf which they are eafily known, and brought together, tho' never fo v.v:ch mix'd. The bed are gather'd, and in greateft plenty upon the Coafts of Quano. SiJfinii is afmall bivalve not unlike the Famaguri, but thinner, and is found flicking in mud. Katji oxlltfikaki . are Oyfters. The Oyfters found about Japan are deformed, rough, Irony, gfowing together, and to recks. There are chiefly two fcrts, one remarkably large, the other fmaller. The beft and largeft are found in great plenty in the Gulf of Kama- kura, Kifa, or Akagai is alfo a bivalve, white without, with deep fur- rows running as it were parallel to each other, within of a reddifh colour. (Tab. XIV. 6.) They fix a handle to this fhell, and ufe it in the kitchen inftead of a fpoon, or pail. Nakatagai is a large, ugly, roundifh, ftriated and black fhell. Afari, is a fmall thin fhell, grey or ath eclour'd. 7V or Matee, (Tab. XIV. Fig. 7.) is an oblong thin bi- valve gaping at both ends. The Animal that lives within it, is reckon- ed very delicious. Vmi Fake is another bivalve much of the fame kind, about a fpati long, and fo big, that one can fcarce grafp it between the thumb and fore-finger. Its flefh is pickel'd and kept for ufe. This lhell is found only upon the Coafts of Tfikungo, where by exprefs order cf the Prince of that Country it is forbid to fifh them, till a fufficient quantity hath been provided for the Emperor's own Table. T?k*ragiu. Takaragai call'd in the Indies Cowers, are brought from the Maldive and other Iflands, and imported into Bengala, Fegu, and Siam, where they go for current Money. Thofe found about Japan are of different forts. : ji. Kifa. Nokfltagai, Te. Chap. XT. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 141 forts. ("Tab. XIV. Fig. 8.) The beft are brought from the R'mku Iflands, and are the chief ingredient of their white Cheek varnilh. Safai Sa f jL (Tab. XIV. Fig. 9.) is a large, thick, odoriferous, turbinated univalve, white and prickled. Its mouth is fhut clofe, with a flat, thick covering, or operculum, of a ftony fubftance, rough, on the outfide not unlike the Lapis Nl f u Judaiats, only fharper and fmooth. Nifi is an Univalve much of the fame ihape, but larger, and hath not near fo good a flefh. Both can fallen themfelves very clofe to rocks, and the bottom of the Sea, like the Awabi. Common People make ufe of the fhell inftead of Pots to fpit in. Tannifi are the common black Land Snails gather'd for Food in Taumfi. muddy Rice Fields. They have their mouth fhut with an oblong, almoft ftony operculum. Bai is a Snail in a common oblong, turbinated &». white fhell. Ras or Mina is another of the fame kind, but black and R aj# fmaller. Both are gather'd on the Ihore in low water. Kabitto is a „ , , fmall, oval, not turbinated univalve. Another fmall turbinated univalve is call'd Sugai. Sugai. N n THE i43 THE Hiftory of J A PA N. BOOK II. O F T H E Political State of JAPAN. CHAP. I. Names of the Gods, Demi-Gods and Emperors, ixho are mention d in the Japanefe Hijlories, as the firft Monarchs and Governors of that jErnpi) e. Vfy.'^^V&fN&f *Pily fo&A, '^r ^ ^ better to underftand the opinion of the Japanefe about ^ l ^ : &^S&(g» the original ftate of their Country (which formerly they 5 "°? a , I c 33 'Y «;- i u'J -. ~- .-U- i« ;~\,,u,.„a „„..<- ^r*u ..u "\ — j y f^(& 1°°^ ,( 1 upon as the only inhabited part of the earth,) and ify&ffltW&l §§*: the fucceftion of their Emperors and Monarchs down to jSk.-^SMe^ii tn ' s prefent time, I have thought fit to divide the Hiftory and Chronology of this Empire, into three ./Era's, a fabulous, a doubtful, and a certain. The firft and fabulous Epocha of the Japanefe Government reaches far The r..n. an j beyond the time of the Creation, as tix'd in Sacred writs. Japan, they fabulousAara. fay, was during that period of time, govern'd by a fucceifion (or rather evolution) of feven Celeftial Spirits cr Gods, which are by them call'd Tenhfin Sitzi Dai, that is, the feven great Celeftial Spirits, each of which Succefonaf reign'd an immenfe, but undetermin'd number of years. The Hiftory &vea s ? mtSm of the Japanefe Gods is full of ftrange wonderful adventures, and great bloody Wars, which are faid to have happen'd in this firft Age of the Ja- panefe World. The two Chronological Authors, whom I have follow'd m 144. The Hi ft or y of] A P A N. Book II. in writing this Hiftory, barely mention their Names, as alfo, that the three firft were not married, but that their four SuccefTors had each his Wife, as a Companion of his Government, whofe names are likewife fet down. Of this firft Succeflion of Gods, I have had already occafion to fpeak more amply in thefeventh Chapter of the firft Book, wherein I treated of the origin of the Japanefe Nation according to the opinion of the Na- tives. I muft therefore refei 4 the Reader to that Chapter, and beg leave here to repeat, that the laft of this firft Succeflion, Ifanagi Mikotto, having carnally known his Wife and Goddefs Ifanami Mikotto, begot a fecond race of Demi-Gods or God-men, whofucceeded the firft in the Government of Japan, and being rive in number are thence cail'd foTo/fivt W* Sin Go ® ai -> t ^ iat is > tlie fi ve & reat Terrejlrial Gods, or Monanhs. Vt.ni-GoAs. They reign'd in the following order. TenfmVai i. Ten Se Dai Sin, eldeft fen and heir of Ifanagi Mikotto^ for whofe sin ; memory, and that of his brethren and pofterity, the Japanefe ftill profefs a moft profound refpecl: and veneration. He is faid to have reign'd 25CCCO years. China, they fay, was during his reign govern'd by Ten Kwo Si, to whom they alfo attribute a long and fabulous Government, and further mention, that three defcendants of his Family fucceffively rul'd the Empire of China. OpTioNi. 2. Ofiwo Ni no Mikotto, liv'd and reign'd in all 30CCCO years. During his reign, and during the reign of his Succeffor, to the beginning of that of the fourth Japanefe Dfi Sin, Sat Teiki govern'd the Empire cf China. Tiikj. Ni ni ki 110 Mikotto reign'd 318535 years. During his whele Reign Sat- tei Ki was Emperor of China. EkpOoDe- ^ pjfc q j) emi m Mikotto reign'd 637892 years. China was then govern'd by the Emperor Katfura Kaki, who was fucceeded by five Prinees of his Family. M-afeVftt. 5. The fifth and laft of thefe Demi-Gods was Fuki Awa fe dfu no Mi- kotto. He reign'd 836042 years, fo that the whole fpaceoftime, daring which this race of God-men govern'd Japan, takes in 2342467 years. This is all the Japanefe know of the antient State and Government of their Empire, a tradition, which feme cf the wifer people, even among them, are very fenfible, is liable to great doubts and uncertainties, if not entirely fabulous and chimerical. However all, without exception, profefs a peculiar veneration for Ifanagi and his Confort Ifanami, as be- ing the progenitors of their Nation, and if I may be allowed thus to expref s my felf, their Adam and Eve. The right which the family of the Eccle- fiaftical Hereditary Emperors claims to the Crown and Government of Japan, and which they have enjoy'd free and undifturb'd during a fucceflion of many Ages, is grounded upon a lineal defcent from Ten Seo Dai Sin, Ifanagi's firft-born fon and heir, from his eldeft fon, and fo down. There is hardly a town, or village, throughout thr Empire, but what hath one, or more, Temples ere&ed to his memory, and the place of his Chap. I. The Hiftoryf JAPAN 145 his refidence, which is faid to have been in the Province Isje, is held fo facred, that, at certain times of the year, People of all ranks and qua- lities refort thither in Pilgrimage. Thus much of this firft and fabulous Epocha of the Japanefe Government, of which I have treated more at large in the above-mention'd feventh Chapter of the firft Book. I proceed now to the fecond and doubtful Aera. It is little known, Tfc '/ ff( " : ?. what was the ftate of thefe Countries, and the way or lite of the Inha- Mra fthi bitants, from the beginning of the Creation, (when according to the JW'ft- description of that great law-giver Mofes, the Supreme Being call'd this Globe of our Earth out of nothing, and form'd it, by his infinite power, into a ftate altogether beccoming his divine goodnefs and wifdom) to the time of their firft Monarch Sin Mu Ten Oo, whofe reign comes down pretty low, and within 66c years of our Saviour's Nativity. It is highly probable, that in thofe early times they liv'd up and down the Country, difpers'd in hoords, (as do to this day the Scythian Inhabitants of the great Tartary) feparate from the reft of the world by a rocky tem- peftuous Sea, which encompafies their Iflands, b;ing as yet in a ftate of nature and freedom, without a fettled form of Government, and defti- tute of arts and fciences. The neighbouring Empire of China was then already grown very powerful, arts and fciences flourifh'd there, and were by the Chinefe brought over likewife into Japan. It was owing to this, that the Japanefe became in time polite and civiliz'd, and 'tis not unlikely, that in imitation of their neighbours, by whom they were imbued with notions of a Monarchical Government, they fubmitted with more chearfulnefs, when Sin Mu Ten Oo began to reign over them, the rather as this Prinee was defcended of a family fo much belov'd, and efteem'd fo facred among them. In the mean time, that fo considerable a period of time fhould not remain empty in their Chronological Books, they have fill'd up the vacancy with the names of the moft eminent Monarchs, who after the demife of Katfurakuki and the five defendants of his family, fat on the Throne of China. The firft Chinefe Emperor mention'd in this fecond Aera is Fuki, and Ew.ferm 0/ with his full title Tat Ko Fuki, f the Chinefe pronounce it Fohi.) This^^ '" Prince had according to fome the body, and accord ing : to others the Fob;. head of a Serpent, with a moft fublime underftanding. He difcover'd the motions of the Heavens, and the twelve Celeftial Signs, and divided the time into years and months. He invented befides many other, ufeful arts and fciences, and communicated them to the world for. the common benefit of mankind. The Chinefe make him their firft Emperor and the founder of their Monarchy, and many among them pretend, that from his reign down to this prefent age, they can fhew an accurate Hiftory of their Empire, and a true Chronological fucceflion of their Emperors, which before his time had been very doubtful and fabulous. But if according to one of my Japanefe Hiftorians, he began to reign 2,0446 years be- fore Synmu, or 2 1 106 before Ch rift, that is, many thoufand years before O o the i 4 <5 TheHiflory of J A P A N. Book II. the Creation, he cannot be allow'd a place in this fccond Aera, but ought to be reje&ed into the firft and fabulous one. My other Chronological Author, with more probability, puts the beginning of his reign in the year before Synmu, 2928, which is the year before Chrifl 3588, or according to Vetavhts 396 years after the Creation. He reign'd according to one Author no, and according to the other 115 years. I think it necelfary here to acquaint the Reader, that having found the latter Author in many Inflan- ces more accurate, I chofe to follow him preferably to the firfl. The Rev. Father Couplet, in the Preface to his Chronological Tables, puts the beginning of the reign of Fohi in the year before Chrifl: 2953, which comes 520 years nearer our Saviour's nativity, being juft that fpace of time, during which Xinmtm and the feven defcendants of his family whom he omits, fat on the Throne of China. sin Koo. The fecond Chinefe Emperor was Sin Noo, (the Chinefe pronounce it Xin Bum, or Sijnmtm,) and with his full title Jen Tei Sin Noo Si. Some Authors begin the Chronology of the Chinefe Empire with the reign of this Emperor. He came to the throne in the year before Synmu, 2549, which is the year before Chrifl 3209, or according to Petavius's Chronology 775 years after the Creation. This illuflrious Prince, like another ^Egyptian Sera- pis, taught mankind agriculture, and thofe arts which relate to the fupport of our Life. For this reafon he is by fome reprefented with the head of an OXj by others only with two horns plac'd on his forehead. He alfo dif cover'd the virtues of feveral Plants, and communicated them to the world in a treatife he wrote on this fubjecl:, which was doubtlefs the firfl Herbal that ever was written. His Pi&ure is held in high efleeni among the Chinefe. The Phyficians particularly have it hung up in one of the befl apartments of their houfes, with a plant or leaf in his mouth, on which he fmells. He reign'd 140 yeats, and was fucceeded by feven defcendants of his family, who reign'd 380 years ^ fo that the Empire continu'd in this family 520 years. Kuo Tei. After the demife of the laft Emperor of the family of Jin Num, Kwo Tei, (or according to the Chinefe Hoam Ti,~) and with his full title Hon Tei Juu Hin Si, came to the Crown. The Chinefe Hiftorians unani- moufly agree, that this Prince reign'd in China. Thofe who call the exiflence of the preceding reigns in queflion, begin the Hiflory and Chro- nology of the Chinefe Empire with the reign of Hoam Ti. He begun to reign in the year before Synmu 2029, before Chrifl: 2689, or accord- ing to Father Couplet, whom Dr. Mentzelius accurately follows, 2697. He was but eleven years old when he came to the Crown. During his minority the Empire was govern'd by wife and prudent Councellors, who took great care to give the young Monarch an education becoming fo great a Prince, and to inftrucT: him in all the ufeful arts and fciences then known. The Chinefe ftand indebted to this Emperor for the art of feeling the pulfe, which he learnt himfelf from his Tutors, and afterwards commanded that it fhou'd be publifh'd to the World. He reign'd 100, and liv'd in years. Chap I. The Hiftory of J A P A K 147 years, He was fucceeded by five defcendants of his Family, in which the Empire continu'd 313 years. Of the five Princes, Hoam 7?s fucceflors, Tei Gio, or according to the r» Gio- Chinefe pronunciation Ti Jao, was the moft illuftrious. He was a great Sefin, that is, a Man incomparably well vers'd in occult arts and fciences. He was alfo a very virtuous Prince, and a true Father of his Country. His death was univerfally lamented by all his Subjects, who went into mourning for three years. He came to the Crown in the year before Synmu, 1697, before Chrift 2357. He reign'd 72 years, and dy'd under the reign of his fucceffor in the 11 8th year of his age. Tho' he had twelve Chil- dren, ten fons and two daughters, yet he deliver'd the Crown and Go- vernment of the Empire to an honeft and wife Husband-man, to whom he married his two daughters. Tei Sijun, otherwife Git, and according to the Chinefe Ju Ti Sijun, or T " s J" n ' Ju Ti Xun, was Ti Jao\ (on in law, and fucceffor. He reign'd eight and twenty years with Ti Jao, and thirty three alone, in all fixty-one. My Au- thor puts the beginning of his reign in the year before Synmu, \6^\, which is the year before Chrift 2294. During his reign a great Deluge happen'd in China, which overflow'd many provinces, and drown'd great numbers of the Inhabitants. The Country continu'd under Water in fome parts for feveral years after. Uu, and with his full title Katewu, that is, Emperor Uu, of the fami- \Jm ly Ka, or as the Chinefe pronounce it, Ju of the family Hia, reign'd feven- teen years with the Emperor Tei Sjun, and ten years after his death, in all twenty-feven years. He was crown'd in the year before Synmu 1573, before Chrift 2233. This Emperor caufed canals and fluices to be cut, to convey the Waters, which overflow'd great part of China under the reign of his PredeceiTor, down to the Sea. By this means deep rivers arofe, and the Country was freed from the floods. He liv'd an hundred years, and was fucceeded by eleven defcendants of his family, who reign'd 431 years, fo that the crown remain'd in this family 458 years. The laft of this family was famous for his uncommon ftrength, but he very much tyraniz'd his fubjects, and liv'd with fuch a profufenefs, that he caus'd a Lake to be dug by two thoufand Men, and to be fill'd with Chinefe Beer. He is faid alfo to have built a Tower of Gold and precious Stones for one of his Miftreffes. He was depos'd and banifli'd in the 52d year of his age. Sioo Sei Too, that is King Too of the family of Sjoo, or as the Chinefe ~. «j T(i(> pronounce it, King Tarn of the family of Ksjam, came to the Crown in the year before Synmu 1106, before Chrift 1766, being then eighty-feven years old. He reign'd thirteen years, and died in the hundredth year of his agr. During his reign there was a great famine in China, which lafted feven years, like that famous Egyptian famine mention'd in holy Writs. He was fucceeded by twenty-feven Princes of his family, who reign'd in all 631 years, fo that the Empire remain'd in this Family for 644 years. The laft Emperor of this family was a great tyrant, for 148 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book II. for which reafon the Princes his fubjecls rais'd war and rebellion a- gainfl: him, and having reduc'd him to great ftreights, he fet lire to his Palace, and burnt himfelf with his family and domeftics, leaving the Empire to the Conqueror $u »o En 0. Sin no Ext 0, that is, Emperor Bit of the family of Sin, or according to the Chinefe Un Van* of the family Sjen, who came to the Crown 462 years before Syntmt, and 1122 before Chrift. He reign'd feven years, and was fucceeded by thirty-feven defcendants of his family, in which the Empire conrinu'd according to the Japanefe Hiftories 868 years, that is to the year before Chrift: 255, and 206 years after Synmu. Under Sqorvoo, and according to the Chinefe pronunciation Sjoovam, the fourth Em- peror of this family, in the 22d year of his reign, which was the year before Symnu 367 ', before Chrift: 1027, upon the eighth day of the fourth SoVj Krtfc. month, was born in India the great heathen' prophet Siaka, who for his' incomparable qualities was afterwards call'd Fl the maintenance of the Dairi, and his Ecclefiaflical Court. He hath made for their for this purpofe aflign'd him the whole revenue of the City of Miaco t and all its appurtenances j but becaufe they fell far fhort of ballancing his expences, it hath been agreed, that the deficiencies fhould be made up out of the Secular Emperor's Exchequer: But thofe allowances are fo fmall, and befides fo indifferently paid, that the Court can hardly fubfift by it, at leafl, that they cannot make that figure, which they did formerly, when the Dairi was himfelf Mafter of the Empire, and had all the Revenues at his own difpofal. However, they ftill keep up their former grandeur and magnificence, and it can moft truly be faid of this Court, that it is remarkable for a fplendid poverty. The great ones run themfelves in debt, and the in- ferior officers and fervants, whofe allowances are fir from being fufficient to maintain them, muft work for their livelyhood. Accord- ingly they make and fell bafkets made of ftraw, (See Chap I. of the V. Book) tables, fhoes for Men and Horfes, and other mean things of this nature. The Mikaddo indeed, though his Revenues are but fmall, in comparifon of what they were in former times, yet as he ftill hath them in his own management, he is fure in the firft place to take care of himfelf, and to provide what is re- quisite to keep up his former fplendor, and to fatisfy his luxury and profufenefs. maintenance. 152 The Hiftoryoj] A P A N. Book II. profaferiefs. He is the better able to do this, as one very confidera- ble prerogative of the Crown and fupreme authority, he once enjoy'd, hath been ftill left him by the Secular Monarch, which is the grant- ing of titles of Honour to the great Men of the Empire, their chil- dren and relations, which brings in vaft Treafures into his Exche- quer. He follows the cuftom of his Predeceflbrs, keeping twelve w ives, one of whom, being the mother of the hereditary Prince or Princefs, hath the tide of Emprefs. It would be too tedious to relate all the fpendid and pompous ceremonies which are obferved upon his marri:ge, upon the lying in of the Emprefs, upon the enuring of a nurfe for the Heir of the Crown, and his education. It is enoueh to fay, that they are great and magnificent beyond exprefiion, and that, did all the happinefs and welfare of the Empire entirely depend upon the birth of this hereditary Prince, they could not be great- er. There are feveral eminent dignities that belong to this Ecclefiaftical Katitsand Court, and its Nobilitv is coniposM of perfons of different ranks and Titles r.f the * J r 1 t titrs. quality. The Mikaddo himfelf is the fountain of honour. There are indeed certain employments annex'd to certain Titles. But other ho- nours are meerly titular, and thefe are frequently conferr'd by the Mikaddo en Secular perfons, en the Princes of the Empire, and Men of note. This is done either at the recommendation of the Secular Monarch, or at their own defire, upon condition of paying a large fum of money. All the Honours and Titles are divided into fix I as thev call them, that is ranks or dalles. The Title of the firft clafs is Dai Seo Dai Sin. The perfen, who is honour'd with this Title, is e- fteemed fo great and facred, that they believe that his Scul becomes a Caiai, or God, the moment of her departure from the body. For this reafen the Mikaddo keeps it for himfelf, and feldom beftows it on any body. The dignity of Qvanbuku belongs likewife to this firft clafs. Quanbuku is the fecond Perfon of the Ecclefiaftical Court, and the Dairi's Vicegerent and Prime Minifter in all affairs relating to the Empire. ( This Title is ajfumed by the fecular Monarch, or given to th e preemptive heir of the Crown, and is the fame with that of Quaba- condono, of which there is fo frequent mention made in the Letters of the Jefuits. ) The following three Titles belong to the fecond I, or rank, Sa Dai Sin, U Dai Sin, and Nat Dai Sin. They are never conferr'd on more than three perfons at Court. The Dai Nagou and Tfmagon make up the third rank. Thefe two Titles are always annex'd to certain Employments. The titles, which belong to the fourth and fifth I, rank or clafs, are Seonagon^ Tfunagon, Tfufeo, Seosjo, and Sidfut. Both thefe Gaffes are very numerous, and again fubdivided into feveral differing ranks. The perfons of this Clafs are likewife call'd Tenfio bito, that is, a Heavenly people, and the whole Ecclefiaftical Court in general affumes the title of Kuge, which fignifies as much as Chap II. The Hijiory of JAPAN 153 as Eccleftiaftical Lords, and this they do by way of diftinftion from the Gege, under which name they comprehend all the Laity and inferior fort of People, who are not of fo holy and fo honourable a defcent. The titles of the fixth and laft clafs are Tai U, Goi, and many more of lefs note. All titles and degrees of honour, whatfoever, are conferred, as I have already obferv'd, by the MikadJo, and by him alone. When the Secu- lar Monarchs took the Government of the Empire into their hands, the Dairi referv'd to himfelf, along with the fupreme authority, this confiderable branch of the Imperial prerogatives. Hence whatever titles the Secular Emperors intend to bellow on their Favourites and Prime Minifters, muft be obtain'd of the Mikaddo. There are chiefly two titles, which the Secular Emperor, with the confent of the Dairi, can confer on his prime Minifters, and the Princes of the Empire, which are Maquan- dairo and CamL The firft was formerly hereditary, and fignifies as much as a Duke or Earl. The fecond denotes a Knight. It muft be obferv'd in this place, that the character, which denotes a deified Soul, is likewife pronounc'd Cam, but then it is of a nature quite different from that which expreffes the title and honour of Knighthood. All the Gods and Idols of the Country in general have the name and character of Cami. The Perfons of this Ecclefiaftical Court, among other marks of diftin- Thelr Hatjh - cticn, are clad after a particular fafhion, peculiar to themfelves, and widely differing from the habits of fecular Perfons, whom they fcorn and defpife, as being cf a mean, unholy extraction. There is fo much dif- ference even among themfelves, as to their habits, that thereby alone it is eafily known what rank they are of, or what employment they have at Court. They wear long wide breeches and a large gown over them, which is very wide and made after a lingular fafhion, chiefly about the moulders, and hath a long train, which they trail after them on the ground. They cover their heads with a black lacker'd cap, by the different fhape and figure of which, it is known, among other marks of diftin&ion, what quality they are of, or what places they have at court. Some have a broad band of black Crape, or Silk ftitch'd to their caps, which is either tied up, or hangs down behind their moulders. Others have a fort of a Lap, made after the fafhion of a Fan, ftanding out before their Eyes. Some wear a fort of Scarf, or a broad Band, which hangs down forwards from their fhoulders. The length of this Scarf is again different, according to every one's quality, or dignity, for it is the cuftom of this court, that no body bows down lower, but to reach the floor with the end of his Scarf. The Women's drefs at the Court of the Dairi is alfo very particular and different from that of Secular Women. But chiefly the Dairi $ twelve Wives are drefs'd in as many fumptuous Gowns, not lined, interwove with flowers of Gold and Silver, and withal fo large and wide, that it is a matter of great difficulty for them to walk, when thus compleatly drefs'd. Q.q Studies ,r 154. TheHiftory of J A P A N. Book II. Their i\i- Studies and learning are the chief amufement of this Eccclefiaftical Court. Not only the Kitge, or courtiers, but even many of the fair Sex have acquir'd great reputation by their Poetical, Historical and other Writ- ings. All the Almanacks were formerly made at court : But now it is a learned Citizen at Miaco that makes them. However they mult be examin'd and approv'd of at Court by Perfons commislion'd for it, who take care, that they be fent to Isje, as to a holy Place to be there printed. They are great lovers of Mufick, particularly the Women play with great dexte- rity upon all forts of Musical Instruments. Young Noblemen divert them- felves with riding, running races, dancing, fighting, playing at Tennis and fuch other exercifes becoming their quality. I did not enquire, whether they ad Comedies and Tragedies at Court. But as the Japanefe in general are very fond of Plays, and will fpend a great deal of money upon them, I am inclin'd to believe, thefe Ecclefiaftical Perfons, their gra- vity and holinefs notwithstanding, would not be willingly wanting fo agreeable and entertaining, and withal fo innocent a diversion. The vair tS j n f ormer t i mes w hen the Dairi was fele Master of the Country, he re- fided with his Court, wherever he pleas'd, honouring with his facre"d Prefence, now this, then another town, or province of his Empire, and it feldom happen'd, that two fucceeding Emperors chofe the fame place to live at. Of late their Residence hath been in a manner fix'd to Miaco. They are poflefs'd of the North-East part of this large Capital, which well deferves the name of a feparate Town, not only by reafon of its great extent, and the number of streets, palaces and houfes built within its compafs, but alfo be- caufe it is actually feparate from Miaco, and defended against the sud- den approach of an unexpected enemy, by ditches, walls, ramparts and gates. The Mikaddo himfelf lives about the middle of it, in a large and spacious palace, known from others by the height and magnificence of its tower. His Imperial Confort lives with him in the fame palace and the palaces of his other Wives ftand next to his. A little way further are the houfes of the Lords of the Dairi's Bed-chamber, and of fuch other perfons, whofe offices require a constant and more immediate attendance on his facred perfon. If a Mikaddo resigns, a fe- parate Palace is aflign'd to him, to his family and court, as is alfo another to the Hereditary Prince, and to his Court. The reft of the Itreets and houfes are divided among the Officers of this Court, ac- cording to their rank and dignity. The Secular Monarch constantly keeps a strong guard of Btigjos and Soldiers at the Dairi's Court, as it were, out of tendernefs and care for the prefervation and fafety of his facred perfon and family, but in fact to put it out of his power, ever to attempt the recovery of the throne and the fupreme authority, which he took from him. Thus much of the Dairi, his Court and Government in general. It now remains, before I proceed to the History and Succeflion of the Chap II. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 155 the Ecclefiaftical Emperors, to lay down fome general obfervations tend- ing to explain the Chronology made ufe of in the fame. The Japanefe have two principal Aera's, or Epocha's. The firft, and Jn-as of tht alfo the more common, begins with the reign of their firft Emperor "°* "' Synmu in the year before Chrift 660. Confequently the year of Chrift 1693, which was the fixth year of the Nengo Genrokf, was the 2353 from Synmu. This Epoch is by them call'd Nin 0, which properly N ' in °- fpeaking fignifies, a great and powerful Lord, or Monarch, and in a more fublime fenfe, the very firfl. The fecond Epoch made ufe of in Japan, is call'd Nengo. It was N«>gc. invented by the Chinefe for a greater certainty in Chronology, than they thought their common Epochs would admit of, and it was not introdue'd in Japan till the reign of the thirty-fixth Emperor. It takes in a period only of a few years, commonly lefs than twenty, feldom beyond this number. The beginning, as alfo the- proper figure to expreis it, are determin'd by the Emperor, which is done commonly in memory of fome remarkable accident, or of fome confiderable altera- tion in church or ftate. As the Emperor hath the fole power of infti- tuting them, fo he can continue them as long as he pleafes. The Ja- panefe character exprefiing the Nengo, then current, when I was in Japan, the fixth year of which falls in with the year of Chrift 1693, was pronoune'd Genrokf, which fignifies the Happhiefs of Nature and Art, whereby the then reigning Mikaddo alluded to the defirable happinefs and tranquillity of a private life, which the late Emperor his father re- folv'd to lead after his refignation of the Crown. This Epoch is made ufe of in their Almanacks, Orders, Proclamations, Journals, Letters and Wri-. tings. In their printed Books, chiefly fuch as relate to Hifiory and Chronology, the current year of the Epoch Nin is added to it. It mud be obferv'd, that a new Nengo begins always with a new year^ tho' it was order'd and inftituted feveral months before. Sometimes alfo it happens, that altho* a new Nengo hath been already begun, yet the years of the preceding Nengo are continued in the title pages of their Books, their Letters, Journals, and fo on. This I take to be owing either to the Peo- ple's not liking the character expreffing the new Nengo, or to its not being as yet known, which is not impoflible in an Empire of fo great an extent. Thus for inftance, the almanacks of the firft and fecond year of the Nengo Genrokf were printed with the fifth and the fixth year of the preceding Ne?igo^ D/lokio, tho' it was then already expir'd. In this cafe however care is taken, that no error, or confufion, fhou'd be oc- cafion'd in their Chronology by fuch an inadvertency. And for this reafon it was, that in the next almanack, which was that of the year of Chrift 1690, the third year of the Nengo Genrokf then current, was fet down accordingly, without any mention made of the two firft. The character of a Nengo is compos'd of two, feldom of more figures, which are, and muft be taken out of a particular table compos'd for this purpofe. There 1 56 The Hiftory ftfJAPAN. Book II. - „ ^ I " ■ II ■ ■ I — ■-■■!-' fc, PwiflA 0/ <"' r7J7; Chrift 214, and the 60th of his age. He remov'd his court and refidence to Kamtz. About this time reign'd in China, Sikwo or SinoSikd, of the family of Cin, a Prince no lefs famous in Chinefe and Japanefe Hiftories for his profufenefs and magnificence, than he was dreaded by his fubjects for his unparallel'd cruelty and tyrannical Government. He came to the Throne of China in the year before Chrift 246, and died after a reign of thirty- feven years, in the fiftieth year of his age. Of the many Inftances of his lavifhnefs and tyranny, which are fet down in my Japanefe Authors, 1 will tranfcribe only a few. He once caus'd a large Lake to be dug up, and to be fill'd with Chinefe Rice-beer, which being done, he fail'd over it in boats with his Miftrefles naked. He built the famous Chinefe Wall, which is 300 German Miles long, to fecure his Empire againft the irruptions of the Tartars. He fent 300 young Men, and fo many young Women beyond Sea, under the command of one of his Phyficians, who perfwaded him to it, in order to look for, and to bring over the Plants and other neceffary Ingredients, for preparing an univerfal Medicine, which he was very defirous to have. This Phyfician went over with his gallant Colony into Japan, and fettled there, far from harbouring, any thoughts ever to return to China. He built the famous Palace Kanjohi, which is as much as to fay, a great Hoidfe resembling Heaven, the floors whereof were cover'd with Gold and Silver, and the whole Palace fo coftly, large and magnificent, that afterwards it turn'd into a Proverb. It was fet on fire, and burnt in the year before Chrift 205, by order of Kool, who fet up againft the family of Cin, and having put to death the Emperor Syfe y S f Sikrvo's 1 62 The Hijlory of J A P A N. Book II. Sieve's fuccelior, poflefs'd himfclf of the Throne. The Japanefe and Chinefe Hiftories mention, that it burnt for the fpace of three months, before it was quite laid in afhes, from whence its largencfsand extent may- be conje&ur'd. He was extreamly cruel with regard to his fubje&s, and thought the greateft torments too fmall a punifhment for even their mod inconliderable faults. On this account he is mention'd as the firft of the three famous Chinefe NeroV, Sinofiko, Katfmvo and Tfureo, of ever dreadful memory. Kookin reign'd 56, and liv'd 116 years. ]v ',')' He was fucceeded by his fecond Son K AIKJVO, or Kai Qiw, in die y;:ir of Synmu 504, before Chrift 157, and the fifty-fecond year of his Age. This Emperor in the third year of his reign remov'd his court and residence to Ifigawa. In the feventeenth year of his reign, before Chrift 140, three violent Earthquakes happen' d in China, and the next year the moon appear'd of a purple colour. In the nineteenth year of his reign, before Chrift 138, the firft ~8engo was begun in China, by the Emperor Koo Bit, not long after his acceffion to the throne. Nengo is a particular Epoch commonly dated from fome remarkable incident, and exprefs'd by two characters. It is not limited to a certain number of years, but continu'd as long as the Emperor pleafes. The character of this firft Nengo was Ken Ken. He reign'd fifty-nine years, and died at Ifagawa 11 1 years old. D« X. His Son SIUN S IN, or SIUSIN, fucceeded him in the year of Syn- s 1 Li si n. mu ^^ before Chrift 97, and the 52d year of his age. In the fourth year of his reign, before Chrift 93, he remov'd his court and residence to Siki. In the feventh year of his reign, before Chrift 90, was a great morta- lity in Japan, In the eleventh year of his reign, before Chrift 86, was firft ere&ed the title and office of Seogun, who hath the direction of all military af- fairs, and the command of the army in cafe of war, or rebellion. The Emperor conferr'd this title on one of his fons. In the nineteenth year of his reign, before Chrift 78, the firft Fwie t Merchant-fhips and Men of War, were built in Japan. In the fixty-eighth year of his reign two Moons were feen in the Eaft. Siufin reign'd 68, and liv'd 119 years. D« XT. STNIN, his third fon, fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 632, before stUiN. chriftj 29j am f t he 41ft of his age. In the firft year of his reign they had ripe Peaches in China late in Antumn. In the thirty-fixth year of his reign it rain'd Stars from Heaven m Japan. Chap III. The Hifiory of JAPAN. 163 In the fortieth year of his reign, on a clear and ferene day, there arofe of a fudden in China a violent ftorm of thunder and lightning: Comets, Fiery-Dragons and uncommon Meteors appear'd in the Air, and it rain'd fire from Heaven. In the fixtieth year of his reign they begun to make Fifh-ponds in Jaoan, to cultivate Rice-fields, and to inclofe the fame with ditches. In the fixty-fifth year of his reign, in the feventh month, many People were kill'd in China by lightning and hail. This ftorm was follow'd by fo dreadful a famine, that People kill'd and eat one another. In the eighty-eighth year of his reign an extraordinary fwift Horfe was brought over from the Indies into Japan. He could run a thoufand miles a day. (A race between this Horfe and the famous Horfe of All, would have been a very diverting fight.) In the ninety-fifth year of his reign, Bnpo y otherwife calPd Kobotus, came over from the Indies into Japan, and brought over with him, on a white Horfe, the Kio or Book of his Religion and Doctrine. A temple was afterwards erected to him, which is ftill call'd Fakubafi, or the Temple of the White Horje. Ever fince that time, the foreign Pagan wor- fhip of the Chinefe and other Nations begun to fpread in Japan, and the num- ber of temples and religious houfes was from time to time considerably increas'd. The reign of this Emperor is the longeft of any that fat upon the throne of Japan, for he reign'd 98 years, and liv'd 139. I muft not forget, before I clofe this Chapter, to take Notice : That in the iyth year of the reign of this Emperor, ivhich was the 661 year of Synmu, the fixth and laji year of the Chinefe Emperor A I, by the Chinefe call'd HIAO N GAI TI, Qivho was then already expired and fucceeded by the Emperor HIAO PIM TIJ and the fecond year of his loft NENGO, was bomCHR 1ST, the Saviour of the World, and that in the 66th year of the reign of SY NIN, which was tbe ninth year of the reign of the Chinefe Emperor KWOO BU, he was crucify d, buried, and rofe again from the dead, fuppofmg that his death happened in the %%dyear of his Age. CHAP. 164. The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book 11. CHAP. IV. Of the JEcdefiaJlical Hereditary Kmperors, -who livd and go- vit'nd with an unlimited Authority from the Birth of our Sa- viour to Joritomo, the fir Jl Secular Monarch. Dai xii. *W7" EIKOO, Sy«z;;'s third fon, fucceeded his father in the year of keko. |^^ Synmu 73 1, the 71ft after our Saviour's Nativity, and the 84th of his Age. In the twenty third year of his reign a new Ifland rofe up near Japan, from the bottom of the Sea. It was call'd Tfikubafima, and confecrated to Nebis, who is the Neptune of the Japanefe. Three years after a Mia, or Temple, call'd Takaja?wmia, was built upon the faid Ifland in honour of Ne'm, and a fufficient number of Bonfefs or Priefts appointed to attend it. This Temple, in fucceeding ages, be- came very famous and rich, and the Ifland it felf is faid to have been always free from Earthquakes. He reign'd fixty years, and liv'd hundred and forty three. D,<; Xin. SEI Ml T J7, his fourth Son fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 791, SEiMUC. o £ Q^jfl. igi? anc i tne f ort y n j nt h f his age. He remov'd his Court and Refidence to Sigga in the Province Oo- mi. In the fixth year of his reign he fettled the confines of all the Provinces of his Empire. He reign'd 60 years, and liv'd hundred and eight. Dai XiK TSIUU AI, the fecond Son of Set Mt?s Sifter, (who was married T51U Jl. £ Q J ama tta Dakino Mikotto, ) and Keko's Grandfon, fucceeded him, in the year of Synmu 852, of Chrift 192 and the forty fourth of his age. He made his way to the Throne by the murder of Kumafi Ufomu Kuno Mikotto. He reign'd but nine years, and died fifty two years old. Dei xv. STNGUKOGU, or DJin Gmtkwoo Gnu, fucceeded him in the year of GL f . Synmu 861, of Chrift 201, and the thirtieth of her age. She was" the deceafed Emperors relict, and befides entituled to the Succeflion, by the relation fhe bore, in the fifth degree, to the Em- peror Keikoo. She carried on war againft the Coreans, and at the very begin- ning of her reign went over with a numerous Army, which (he commanded in perfon, but finding herfelf with child in a foreign Country, fhe haften'd back to Japan, and was brought to bed (in Tjikujen, in the Province Mika/fa, where- fhe then refided) of a Son, who Chap. IV. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 165 who was in his younger years call'd Wakono Oof, but when he came of age, and to the throne, Oofin Ten Oo, and after his death Jawatta Fatzman, which is as much as to fay, the Mars of Jamatta, having been for his heroic and virtuous actions related among the Gods of the Country. She refided in Tfikufen, but frequently remov'd her Court from one place of that Province to another. She died after a glorious reign of feventy years, in the hundredth year of her age, and was after her death related among the GoddefTes of the Coun- try by the name of KaJJlno Dai Miofin. During the reign of this Emprefs Earthquakes, Rebellions, Robberies, and other Calamities defolated the Empire of China. OOSIN, or Woofin, her only Son fucceeded her, in the year of Syn- D *' * J ' L mu 930, of Chrift 270, and the feventy firft of his age. He was a great Prince both in peace and war, and a true Father of his Country, which he govern'd forty three years with great pru- dence and clemency. He died hundred and thirteen years old, and was after his death honour'd with the divine Title of Fatzman y which is as much as to fay, the Mars of the Japanefe, and brother of Ten Sio Dai Sin. NlNTOKU his fourth Son, fucceeded him in the year cf Synmu z> a i xvn. 97%, of Chrift 313, and the twenty fourth of his age. MNTOKLf. In the fixty eighth year of his reign a monftrous Child was born in Fida with two faces, four arms, and four feet. He was a good and virtuous Prince, very much beloved by his Sub- jects, to whom he remitted the Taxes at different times. He reign'd eighty feven, and liv'd no years. In Tfinokuni where there is a Temple built to his memory they call him Nanivoa Takakuno Mia Korefirano Dai Mio Dfin. His eldeft Son RITSIU fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1060 , Dai XVlll. of Chrift 400, and the feventy fecond of his age. RITSIU. He refided at Koos in the Province Jamatto. He reign'd 6 years and died in the feventy eight year of his age. FAN SEI, his younger brother, and Nintokus fecond Son, fucceed- Dai XIX . ed him in the year of Synmu 1066, of Chrift 406 and the fifty fifth ^ N SEl - of his age. He refided at Siwagaki in the Province Kaawaats. He reign'd eight years, and liv'd fixty three. INKIOO, Fanfei\ younger brother, and Nintokus youngeft Son, z>*,xx. fucceeded his brother in the year of Synmu 1074 of Chrift 414, and ™ K10 °- the thirty ninth of his age. He refided at Aska in Jamatto. He fent over to China for a Phyfician of that Country, to take care of his health. He reign'd forty years, and died in the eightieth year of his age. T t ANKOO, 1 66 TheHiftoryoJ JAPAN. Book II. Vat. XXI. SKUOO. n«L xxn ANKOO, Inkioo's fecond Son, fucceeded his Father in the year of Synmu 1114, of Chrift 454, and the fifty fourth of his age. lie refided in Jamatto. His reign was but frior:, for in the third year after his acceflion to the throne, Maijwva, a near relation of his, rebell'd againft him, conquer'd and kill'd him, in the fifty lixth year of his age. JUU RIAKU, Ankvd's younger brother, and InkJoo's fifth Son fucceed- ed him in the year of Synmu y 11 17 of Chrift 457. It is faid of this Emperor, that he was bom grey. Hence it is perhaps, that fome Authors put his acceflion to the throne in the fe- venty firft year of his age, which doth not agree with the Chronolo- gy, and the age of the Emperours his Predeceffora. He revenged the death of his brother on Maijuwa, or, as fome call him Maijuwano fin, whom he put to death. In the feventh year of his reign he married the Princefs Wakaki, declar'd her Emprefs, and at the fame time made a law, which ftill fubfifts, importing, that the Children of that of the Dairis wives, who was declar'd Emprefs, fhould be acknowleg'd as lawful Heirs of the Crown. In the ninth year of his Reign the firfl Putjes were coin'd in Ja- pan by one Sinka. He reign'd twenty three Years. How long he liv'd is uncertain. Dai. xxiii. His fecond Son SE NE fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1140 of Chrift 480. and the 37th of his age. He reign'd but five years and liv'd forty two. GEN 500, the Emperor Ritfms , s Grandfon, fucceeded Se Ne, in the gensoo. y ear or " Synrnu 1145, of Chrift 485, and the 46th of his age. He reign'd three years and refign'd. He liv'd 85 years. T>M.xxr. His Brother NINKEN fucceeded him, in the year of Synmu 1148, tfNHSfc of chrift 488 ^ and the 4lft of his age# He reign'd eleven years and liv'd fifty one. Da*. XXVI. His Son BURETZ fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 11 59, of Chnlt 499. He was a cruel and barbarous Prince. He took great delight in cutting off People's Heads unawares. He ript open, with his own bar- barous hands, the bellies of women with child, on which occafion 'tis faid that Fire fell from Heaven, and that the Emperor, to guard himfelf againft it, caus'd a room to be built all of ftone. He gave many other inftances of his unparallel'd Cruelty. He pluck'd off peo- ple's nails from their hands and feet, of which my Japanefe Author fays he order'd Spades to be made for digging up roots. He tortur'd others, by plucking their hairs out of all parts of their Body. Others he commanded to climb up high Trees, and when they were got to the top of them, he would fhoot at them with arrows, or or- der the Trees to be faw'd, or ftuken, till they tumbled down, which gave Chap IV. The Hi(tory of JAPAN. 167 gave him great diverfion, and could make him laugh very heartily. In this barbarous manner he reign'd eight years. How long he liv'd, and how he died, is not mention'd. KEI TEI fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1167 , of Chrifl 507, Da j XXT ^ M - and the 54th of his age. He was the Emperor Oojin's great Grandfon, born of the Princefs Fkoarufi, who was that Emperor's Grand-daughter. He refided at Tfutfuki, in the Province Jamafjro, from whence he remov'd his Court to Fotoguani in the fame Province. In the twelfth year of his reign, which was the year of Chrifl 519, Darma, a great Devotee and Prophet of the Heathens, who was the third Son of Kafiuwo, and the 28th SuccefTor upon the holy See of Siaka, came into ' China from Seitenfku, that is, the Weftern Heavenly Country, whereby rauft be underftood the Continent of India, which lies to the Weft of China. Kei Tei, died after a glorious Reign of twenty feven years, in the eighty firft year of his age. His Death was univerfally lamented. His Succeffor deified him in Jetfjfin, and honoured him with the di- vine Title, Askano Dai Mio fin. He was fucceeded by his Son AN KAN, in the year of Synmu 11 94, D.i? xxvm, of Chrift 534, and the fixty-ninth of his age. sinkjn. Ankan refided in Jamatto, and died after a fhort reign of two years. Three years after his death he waslikewife deified, and is now worfhip'd as prote&or of the Province jamatto, by the Name of Kimbo Senno Gongin. S ENKWA,hh younger Brother fucceeded him in the year of Synmu DaiXXlX. 1 1 96, of Chrift 536, he himfelf being already feventy years of age. SEHUVA. He remov'd his court and refidence to another place in the fame Province. He reign'd near four years, and died, after he had firft deified his Bro- ther, and acknowledg'd him as Tutelar God of Jamatto. KIN M EI, or more elegantly pronounc'd Kirn Me, another Son of the Daixxx. Emperor Ke Te, fucceeded his Brother in the year of Synmu 1200, of Chrift 540, and the thirty-fecond of his Age. He refided in the little Province Skinnokori. He was a very religious Prince, and very favourably inclin'd to the foreign Pagan Budfdo Worfbip, which during his reign fpread with great fuccefs in Japan, infomuch that the Emperor himfelf caus'd feveral tem- ples to be built to foreign Idols, and order'd the Idol of Buds, or Fo- toge, to be carv'd in Fakkufai that is in China. My Japanefe Author, mentions what follows, as fomething very remarka- ble, and fays, that it happen'd in the thirty-firft year of his reign, and contributed very much to the advancement of the Budfdo Religion. About a thoufand years ago, (ays my Author, there was in Tfiutenfiku (that is the 1 68 The Hifioryof] A P A N. Book II. the Middle Tenfiku, whereby mud be uriderftood the Country of the Ma- labarians, and the Coafts of Cormandel in India ) an eminent Fotoke, call'd Mckuren, a Difciple of Siaka. About the fame time the Dofirine of Jambadan Gonno Niorai (that is, Amida, the great God and Patron of de- parted Sculs) was brought over into China, or Fakkufai, and fpread into the neighbouring Countries. This Doclrine, continues he, did ncnv manifefl if elf alfo in Tlinokuni, or Japan, at a place call'd Naniwa, where the Idol of Amida appeared at the entry of a Pond, environed with golden Rays, v.o body knowing how it was convey d thither. The pious Emperor in memory of this miraculous event, inflituted the firjl Nengo in Japan, and call'd it Konquo. The Idol if elf was by Ten da Jcfijmitz, a Prince of^reat Courage and Piety, carried into the Country of Sinano, and placed in the Temple of Sinquofi, where it afterwards by the name of Sinquofi Norai (that is the Norai or Amida of Sinquofi) wrought many great Miracles, which made thaf. Temple famous all over the Empire. Thus far my Japanefe Author. Kimme reign' d thirty-two and liv'd fixty-three years. 7 w xxxt. He was fucceeded by his fecond Son F IT AT ZU, or F I NT AT Z t ' in the year of Synmn 1232, of Chrift 572. My Author makes no mention of his Age, but fets down the following remarkable events, which hapen'd during his reign. In the third year of his reign, on the ilrft day of the firft month, was born, at the Emperor's court, Sotoktais, the great Apoftle of the Japanefe. His birth was preceded and attended with feveral remarkable circum- ftances. His Mother one night in a dream faw herfelf inviron'd with Celeftial Rays, as bright as the Sun, and heard the following Words ad- drefs'd to her : I the holy Gufobofatz mufl be born again to teach the world? and therefore I defend to enter into thy Womb : Upon which fhe awaked and found herfelf with child. Eight months after fhe heard the child fpeak diftinctly in her womb, and in the twelfth month fhe was, not only without any pain, but with great delight and pleafure deliver'd of a Son, who was then nam'd Fatffino, and after his death call'd Tais and Sotok- tais. The child very early gave tokens of his future greatnefs and piety. Dev otion and prayers were his greateft delight in his tenderer! years : When but four years old, and once in fervent prayers, the bones and relicks of the burnt body of the great Siaka were in a miraculous manner deliver'd into his hands. The Idol Worfhip in general increas'd greatly in Japan during this Emperor's reign. Abundance of Idols, and Idol-carvers, and Priefts, came over from feveral Countries beyond Sea. In the fixth year of his reign an Edict was made publick, importing, that on fix feveral days of each month all living creatures whatsoever mould be fet at liberty, and that thofe of his fubjects, who had none would do well to buy fome on purpofe, that they fhould not want op- portunities on thofe days to give publick proofs of their merciful difpofi- tion towards thefe Creatures. In Chap IV. The Hijiory of J A P A N 169 In the eighth year cf his reign the firft Image of Siaka was brought over from beyond Sea, and carried to Nara into the Temple of Kobufi, where it is ftill kept in great veneration, pofTefs'd of the chief and molt emi- nent place in that Temple. In the fourteenth year of his reign, one Moria, a great Antagonift and profefs'd Enemy of Sotoktais occafion'd great troubles and religious diflen- C\ ons in the Empire. He bore a mortal hatred to all the Fotoge, or Idols of the Country, which he took out of the Temples and burnt, wherever he could come at them. But within two years time his Ene- mies got the better of him, for he was overcome, and paid with his life for his prefumptuous Enterprize. 'Tis added, that having thrown the afhes of the Idols, which he had burnt, into a lake, there arofe fuddenly a moft dreadful Storm of thunder, lightning and rain. He reign'd fourteen years. How long he liv'd is not known. He was fucceeded by J 00 ME I, his fourth Son, in the year of Sjnmu, ?'" A ^ r /' 124.6, of Chrift 586. ' My Author is entirely filent about the age of this Emperor, and that of fome of his fuccelfors. Under his reign Mor'ia was defeated and kill'd, and the Temple Sakata- tina built in the fmall Province Tamatfukuri^ in memory of this event. He reign'd only two years. SIU SIUN, his Brother, fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1248 T>a'iXXXiU. J J ^ ' f chrift 697. Soon Chap. IV. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 173 Soon after his acceilion to the Throne he begun a new Nengo, call'd Gen, which continu'd four years, and was follow'd by the Nengos, Tenpo of three years, and Keewuun of four years, but little us'd. He was the firft that granted Tfiaps, or particular Coats of Arms, to each Province, which was done in the eighth year of his reign. In the ninth year he caus'd a fquare meafuire, (by the Japanefe call'd Seo and Maas, by the Dutch Ganten, three of which contain exactly four pound of Rice, Dutch weight) to be made of wood, and to be fent as a Pattern into all the Provinces of his Empire, with ftrid orders that thenceforward it Ihould be a ftandard for meafuring of Rice, Corn, and other Grain. He reign'd eleven years. GENMEI, the Emperor Tentfij his Daughter fucceeded him by vir- £>«;. xuit tue of her hereditary right, in the year of Synmit 1368, of Chrift GENMEL 708. She refided at Kara. She inftituted a new Nengo, Wat To, which continu'd fevert years, till the Nengo Reiki. In the firft year of her reign, fhe order'd Money to be coin'd in Gold and Silver, but the latter was again prohibited the next year. The fame firft year was born Abenokam'ar, a Prince of the Imperial blood, very famous in Japanefe Hiftories. In the third year of her reign was built the famous Temple Koobokufi, where there is an Idol of Siaka, caft in a mixt metal of brafs and gold, by the great Mafter Taifoquan. In the fixth year of her reign fhe fettled the Names of all the Pro- vinces, Cities and Villages throughout the Empire, and order'd that they ihould be enter'd into the publick Records. She reign'd feven years, and died. She was fucceeded by GENSIOO, the Emperor Tenmu's Grand-daughter by his Son, in the year of Synmu 1375, of Chrift 715, in the ninth month. This Emprefs inftituted the Kengos Reiki of two, and Jooro of feveri years. Her reign is particularly famous for the miraculous appearance of the Gods, Kbumano Gongin, Amida, Jakufi, Senfiu Quamupon, and Bijfam- monten, in feveral parts of the Empire. In the fifth year of her reign fhe made new regulations concerning the drefs of women. She reign'd nine years, and refign'd the Crown to Sioomu her Bro- ther's Son. She liv'd twenty five years after her refignation, and died in the forty eighth year of her age, and the year of Synmn 1408 in the fourth month. SIOOMU came to the Crown, by his Aunt's refignation, in the year of Synmu 1384, of Chrift 724. Xx He Vai.XLiV, GENS10. Dai.XLK SIOOMU, 1 74. The Hijhrj of J A P A N. . Book IL He firft rcfidcd at Kara, from whence he remov'd to Naniwa, four years before his death. He inftituted the Nengo Sinki m the firft year of his reign, which iafted five years, -and was follow'd by the Nengo Tempe, which con- tinu'd twenty. In the eighth year of his reign, the Japanefe Hiftories mention, that the Sea upon the Coafls of Kij looked red, like blood, for rive days fucceflively, and that the enfuing year follow'd dreadful ftorms, a great drought and a fterile crop, particularly in the Gokokf, which occafion'd a great famine. In the thirteenth year, the Small-Pox was very mortal in all parts of the Empire. (The Japanefe Phyficians diftinguifh between three forts of the Small-Pox. What we properly call the Small-Pox, is by them call'd Foofo, another fort is call'd Fafika, thefe are the Meafles. The third kind is call'd Kare, which is as much as to fay, Watry Puftules. They think it very material, in the cure of the Smaall-Pox, to wrap up the patient in red cloth. When one of the Emperor's Children falls lick of this Diftemper, not only the room and bed are furnifh'd with red, but all perfons that come near the Patient, muft be clad in gowns of the fame colour. The great Pox is not unknown in japan, and they call it NambankaJJa, that is, the Fortitgvefe Dif- eafe.~) In the fixtfysnth year of his reign, they began to build Nunneries in Japan. In the twentieth year was built the great Temple of Daibods. Sioomu reign'd in all twenty five years. He was fucceeded by his Daughter KOOKEN, in the year of Synmu KOOKEN. I 4°9» of Ch rift 749, on the fecond day of the feventh month. Whether or no fhe was married, is not mentioned in my Authors. With her reign begun the Nengo Tempe Seofo, or Foofi, which con- tinued eight years till the Nengo Tempo Shiga. In the firft year of her reign, Gold was firft dug up in Ofio, and prefented to the Emprefs. This Metal had been till then imported from China. In the fourth year of her reign Ihe built the Temple Toodaifi, purfuant to a Vow made by the late Emperor her Father, who was by his death prevented to accomplifh it. Upon the confecration of this Tem- ple, one Giogij in his prayers defir'd the afliftance of Barramoas, an emi- nent God in the weftern parts of the Indies (with regard to Japan) who accordingly came over in a miraculous manner, and appear'd to him that very inftant. About the fame time was built IJia Jamma. In the ninth year of her reign, (he begun a new Nengo, called Tempe Singo, which fubfifted during the remaining part of her reign, and during the reign of her Succeflbr, in all eight yeara. She Chap IV. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 175 She reign'd ten years. She was fucceeded by FA I T A /, the Emperor Ten Mus great Grand- D '"- f£??J' fon, and thefeventh Child of Tonneri Sin 0, in the year of Synmu 141 9, of Chrift 759. Nothing remarkable happen'd during his reign, but that in the third year he remov'd his court and refidence to For a in Oomi, in the fourth to Tairanokio, and in the fixth to Fairo in the Province Awadfi. He reign'd fix years. SEO TOKU, the Emprefs Kooken's eldeft daughter, fucceeded him in Dm.xlfiii. the year of Synmu 1425, of Chrifl: 765. She begun with her reign a new Nengo, which fhe call'd SinkokeUn, and which continued two years, till the tfengo Fooke, which continued three years. During her reign was born Kiamar, who afterwards became a very eminent Kitge, or a great Man at Court. She reign'd five years. KOONIN, Ten Tfi'fs, Grandfon, fucceeded her in the year of Synmu Dai.XLiXi 1430, of Chrift 770. KOONtN. With his reign began the Nengo, call'd Fooki, which fubfifted eleven years. In the fecond year of his feign, there happen'd a ftofm of thunder and lightning, dreadful beyond Expreftion. It rain'd fire from Heaven, like ftars, and the air was fill'd with a frightful noife. The Emperor for this reafon order'd Matjitri's, or folemn feftivals and pfocefiions, to be celebrated in all parts of the Empire, to honour and to appeafe the angry fahtfi, or the evil Spirits, who have the command of the air and fields. In the fifth year of his reign was born Kobotais, art eminent Prieft and great Saint among the Japanefe. In the eighth year the River Fuju Ufingava dried quite up. In the tenth year died in China, Abeno Nakemar, a Man very famous in Japanefe Hiftories. In the fame tenth year a dreadful fire broke out at Miaco, which deftroy'd all the Temples of that City. In the eleventh year he appointed a new Nengo, which he call'd Tenwo, and which fubfifted but one year. He reign'd in all but twelve years. He was fucceeded by his fon KWAN MU, in the year of Synmu 1442, Dai. l. of Chrift 782, and the forty-fixth of his age. Kft'ANMU. Soon after his accefiion to the Throne he begun a new Nengo call'd Jenriaku, which fubfifted twenty-four years. In the third year of his reign he remov'd his court and refidence to Na- gajoka in Jamafijro, and eleven years after to Fejanjfoo. . In the fixth year of his reign a foreign people, who were not Chinefe, but natives of fome further diftant Country, came over to invade Japan in a hoftile manner. The Japanefe did what they could to get rid of them, i 7 6 The Hiftory of) A P A N. Book II. i ■ ■ — — — — — - - - . - — — — . 1 1 1. . . .. . . them, but to little purpofe, their loffes being conftantly made good by frefh recruits. Nine years after their arrival Tamamar, a renown'd and brave General, was fent againft them with good fuccefs, for he reduced them very low, and kill'd their Trcji or Commander in chief. However they held out for fome time after, and were not entirely defeated till the year of Synmu 1^66, eighteen years after their firft arrival. • Quanmu reignd 24 years, and died 70 years old. D*i. 1. 1. He was fucceeded by his eldeft fon FEI DSIO, in the year of Synmu msi0 ' 1496, of Chrift 806. Nothing remarkable happen'd during his reign, but that a new Nengo be- gun with it, which was call'd Taito, and fubfifted four years. He reign'd four years, and died. D^. 1 u. He was fucceeded by his younger brother SA GA, the Emperor Quan- SA <•-■!• mri -> s f cconc i f ori) i n trie year of Synmu 1470, of Chrift 81c. Soon afcer his acceilionto the throne he begun the Nengo Koonin, which continued to his death, for the fpace of fourteen years, during which time nothing remarkable happen'd, but that feveral (lately Sfin, or Mija's i and Budfitffi, or Tira, that is, Temples of the Gods of the Country and of foreign Idols were erecled in feveral parts of the Empire. He reign'd in all fourteen years. Dr.LLiii- He was fucceeded by his younger brother SIUN WA, who was " ' t-he Emperor Quanmits third Son, in the year of Synmu 1484, of Chrift 824. He follow'd the cuftoms of his PredecefTors, in appointing a new Nengo footi after his accefllon to the throne, which was call'd7V» Xjfo, and fubfi- fted ten years. In the fecond year of his reign, my Author obferves, that Urajima re- turn'd from Foreifan to Japan in the 348th year of his age. He had liv'd all the while under water, with the Water-Gods, where they believe, that people do not grow old. Siunwa reign'd ten years. Dai. lik NINMIO fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1494, of Chrift KIKMIO. „ ' «34. This Emperor was Saga's fecond Son, and Siunwa's Oz, or Nephew by his Brother. In the firfl: year of his reign, he appointed the Nengo Sioa t which continued fourteen years, and was follow'd by the Nengo Kaffoo, which fubfifted three years. He reign'd feventeen years. Dal. lv. MONTOKU, or Bontoku. his firft-born Son fucceeded him. in the. year or Synmu 1511, or Chrift 851. After his accefllon to the throne, he appointed the Nengo Ninfiu, which continued three years, and was follow'd by the Nengo's Saije and Tenjan, the firft of three, the fecond of two years. In — — — — — "^ ■^^^"~— Chap IV. The Hi/lory of JAPAN iff In the fourth year of his reign, feveral violent Earthquakes happen'd in Japan, by one of which, on the fifth day of the fifth month, the head of the great Daibuts, or Idol of Siaka, was thrown down to the ground in his Temple at Miaco. Montoku reign'd eight years. He was fucceeded by his fourth Son SEIWJ, in the year of Synmu Dai in. 1519, of Chrift 859- SEWA - He follow'd his Predecefibrs, in appointing a new Nengo after his acceflion to the throne, which was call'd Toquam, and fubfifted eigh- teen years. In the fifth year of this Emperor's reign, the Books of the illuftrious Chinefe Philofopher Confutius were firft brought to Court, read and well liked. In the ninth year of kis reign, was born in Jamatto, Isje, a daughter of Tfike Kitgu, a Prince or the Imperial Blood. This Lady became after- wards very famous for her uncommon Learning, of which me gave a proof to the world by writing a Book, which is highly efteem'd in Japan to this day. Seirva reign'd eighteen years, and refign'd the crown to his fon. He died four years after his abdication, on the 8th day of the fifth month. JO SEI, Sewa's eldeft Son, was but nine years old, when his Dai lvil Father refign'd the crown to him in the year of Synmu 1537, of Chrift ^ 0SEm 877- With his reign a new Nengo was begun, which fubfifted eight years, and was call'd Genjwa. In the third year of his reign, two Suns appear'd in China. The crown was fo great a burthen to this Emperor, that in' a fhort time he loft his fenfes. For this reafon the Quanbuku, as he is, call'd, or Prime Minifter, who is the firft perfon after the Emperor, thought it neceffary to depofe him, which was done accordingly, after he had reign'd eight years. And KO KO, the Emperor Nimio's fecond Son, and Montoku s younger Dai lviii. Brother, was put into his place, in the year of Synmu 1545, of Chrift K-OOKO. 885. In the firft year of his reign, in the feventh month, it rain'd Sand and Stones, which deftroy'd almoft the whole crop of rice. With his reign begun the Nengo Ninwa, which lafted four years. He reign'd but three years. He was fucceeded by his third Son UD A, in the year of Synmu 1 548, Dai lix of Chrift 888. UDA This Emperor in the fecond year of his reign, appointed a new Nengo call'd Quanpe y which continu'd nine years. Yy The i 7 8 TheHiflory of ) A B A N. Book II. The fame year there fell much rain all the Summer, by which, and by great floods enfui'n'g, the growth of the field fufFer'd-tnuch, to the great prejudice of the Harveft. lie re ; gn'd ten years. LX; His eldefl Son DAI GO, fucceeded him in the year of Sytwiu 1553 of ;JV - Chriit 898. Tfo Kengo's appointed by this Emperor were, Sootai of three years, at the beginning of his reign, Jengi of two and twentv years, and Jentsjo of eight. In the firft year of his reign, on the third day of the fixth month, it became of a fudden fo dark (probably by a total Eclipie of the Sun) that iY pie could not fee one another. In the fecond year, died Somme Domio, who was declar'd Kiffaki, that is, the fupreme Woman, which is the title given to that of the Dairies Women, whom he declares Emprefs, and who is the mother of the pre- fumptive Heir of the Crown. In the fixteenth year, on the fecond day of the fifth month, a fire broke cut at Miaco, the Emperor's refidence, which confum'd 617 Houfes. In the fwenty-fixth year a Hare with eight legs was fent to court out of the Province Jamatto. He reign'd in all thirty-three years. i)*;.'LXt. He was fucceeded by SlUSAKU, his twelfth Child in the year SILSJKU. f Synmu 1 591 of Chrift 931. This Emperor appointed two Kengo's, one Seofei, at the beginning of his reign, which fubfifted feven years, and another Tenkei, which continued nine years to his death. In the fecond year of his reign Maffakadda , a Prince of the Im- perial Blood, and one of the chief men at Court, revolted againff. him. This rebellion could not be fupprcfs'd till feven years after, when Maffahiddo was defeated and kill'd. In the third year of his reign on the twenty feventh day of the feventh month happen'd a violent Earthquake, and another in the feventh year, on the fifteenth day of the fourth month. During his reign, Japan was much troubled with Storms of thunder and light- ning, which fell upon feveral Temples and religious Houfes, and laid them in allies. Particularly in the thirteenth year of his reign, the ftorms were almoft univerfal in all the Provinces of the Em- pire. He reign'd fixteen years. Dm. lxii. He was fucceeded by Murakami, the Emperor Dai Go's fourteenth ^ RAKA ~ Child, in the year of Synmu 1607, of Chrift 947. This Emperor, after his acceflion to the throne, begun a new Nengo call'd Tenriaku, which fubfifted ten years, and was follow'd by the / fifengo's Chap IV. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 179 Ne'go's Tentoku of four, Oowa of three, and Koofu of four years {landing. In the fourteenth year of his reign a kind of a Synod, or Council, was held at Court in the great hall Seiro deen, about matters of Religion, whereat were prefent the Heads of the feveral Seels then exifting. He reign'd twenty-one years. Da} LXUL He was fucceeded by REN S EI, or according to another Author rensei. Rei Sen, his fecond Son, who came to the Crown in the fixty firft year of his age, which was the year of Synnm 1628, of Chrift 968. He reign'd but two years, during which time continued the Nen- go Anwa, which begun with his reign. D^.txir, JENWO, or, as others pronounce it Jen Jo, his younger brother, JENlVOl and the Emperor Muracanus fifth Son, fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1630, of Chrift 970. The Nengo's of his Reign were, Tenrok of three years, begun with his acceflion to the throne, Teijen likevvife of three years, Teiquan of two years, Tengen of five years, and laftly Jeiquan of two years. He reign'd in all fifteen years. L^ Lxr . QUASSAN, or Kwajfan, the Emperor Renfes firft Son, and Jen- KWASSJM wo's Nephew, fucceeded him him in the year of Sytnu 1645, of Chrift 985, and the feventeenth of his age. He made a new Nengo, after he came to the Crown, which was call'd Gemva and continued only two years. In the fecond year of his reign, which was the fecond of the faid Nengo, he was fuddenly taken with fuch a defire of retirement and a religious life, that he left his palace privately in the night time, and retired into the Monaftery of Qiianfi, where he caus'd himfelf to be fhav'd like the reft of the Monks, and took the name of Nigugakf Foogu. In this Monaftery he liv'd twenty two years, and was for- ty one years old, when he died. Da/ . LW j : rrSI DSIO, The Emperor Jenwos Son, and the late Emperors Cou- itsi dsio. fin fucceeded him, after his retiring into a Convent, in the year of Synmu 1647, of Chrift 987. The Nengc's appointed during his Reign were, Jejen of two, Jengen of one, Soorak of five, T/10 Toku of four, Tfwofo of five, and Quanko of eight years. In the eight year of of his reign there was a great mortality all over Japan. His reign was famous for feveral eminent and learned Men, who then flourifh'd at Court. He reign'd twenty five years. b*;. lwil He was fucceeded by SANDSIO, the Emperor Renfe's fecond Son, in sandsiO. the year of Synmu 1672, of Chirft 1012, He i8o The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book II. He appointed the Nengo Dfio A, which fubftfted five years. In the third year of his reign his refidence burnt down, as did a great part of it a year after. He reign'd five years, and died 51 years old. DaiLXnn. H as fucceeded by GO IT SI DSIO, that is, It ft Mo the CQ1DSIDSIO "** J . T r ^ r I , , fecond, who was the fecond ion or lift D/io the nrlt, and came to the Crown in the year of iynmu 1677, of Chriftioi7, and the ninth of his age. The Nengo's appointed by this Emperor -were, Qnanin, of four years, begun with his acceffton to the throne, Tfijan of three years, Mansju of four, and Tfiooquan of nine. In the fifth year of his reign, Sat Sin firft obtained leave of the Em- peror to be carried about in a Khitntma, or cover'd Chariot, drawn by two Oxen, which was fo well lik'd, that the whole Eccleftaftical Court foon follow'd his Example. The fame year, on the 2 2d day of the 7th month, there was a violent itorm, which did abundance of mifchief. The fame month two Moons were feen in China. In the fixth year cf his reign the Jeki, or Plague was very fatal all over the Empire, In the 1 2th year of his reign, in the fourth month (which anfwers to our June) there fell a great quantity of Unow, which cover'd the ground to the height of four Salt and five Suns, that is about four foot and a half. In the nineteenth year of his reign, on the ninth day of the eighth fvlonth, there was again a very violent ftorm. He reign'd in all twenty years. Tciai lxix. GOSIUSAKU, that is, S'mfaku the fecond, his younger Brother, fuc- GOSIUSA- cee d e( i n j m in the year of Synnm 1697, of Chrift 1037, and the 28th of his age. The Nengos by him appointed were TJioraku of three years, Tfiokiu of four years, and Quantoht of two years. In the fifth year of his reign, on the firft day of the firft month, hap- pen'd a violent Earthquake. He reign'd nine years, and died thirty-feven years old. c s eighth Son, in the year of Synmu 1802, of Chrilt 1142. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were Kootfi of two, Tenjo of one, Khtan of fix, Nimpe of three, and Kijfu of two years. Under this Emperor liv'd Jorimaffa, a Prince of the Imperial Elocd, and another Japanefe Hercules. By the afliftance of Fatz?nan y who is the Mars of the Japanefe, he kill'd, with his arrows, the infernal Dragon Nuge, who had the head of a Monkey, the tail of a Serpent, atid the body and claws of a Tiger. This monftrous Beaft inhabited the Mikdddo's own Palace, and was very troublefome both to his fa- cred Perfon and to all his Court, particularly in the night time, fright- ing them and difturbing them out of their deep. This Jorimaffa was twenty feven years after, in the civil wars carried on between the four moft powerful families of the Empire, particularly the Feki and GenJfij^ overcome by his enemies, and extirpated with his whole family. This long and bloody War, which defolated the Empire for many years, till the entire fuppreflion of the Feki party, and the death of the Prince, who was at their head, and whom the Gendftjs kill'd with all his family, is at large and fully defer ib'd in a Book entituled, Fekbwwonogatari that is, an account of what happen' d in the War with the Fekis. In the fixth year of his reign, on the 22a day of the feventh month, sppear'd a Comet. In the tenth year of his reign, which was the fourth year of the Jsengo Khtan, was born at Court Joritomo, the firft great Seogun, or Crown General. The enfuing civil wars, which defolated the Japanefe Empire, and were like to have tore it to pieces, gave him an opportunity of encreafing his power and authority to that degree, that he is una- nimously mention'd by the Japanefe Hiftorians, as the firft of the now reigning fecular Monarchs. It was about that time the fupreme and unlimited authority of the Dairi's, or Ecclefiaffical Hereditary Em- perors, which they had fully enjoy'd till then, begun to decline. The Princes of the Empire, govern'd by ambition, jealoufy and envy, a- bandon'd by degrees the duty and allegiance they ow'd to their So- vereign, ail'umed an abfolute power in the government of their Do- minions and Principalities, enter'd into alliances for their own defence, and carried on war one againft another, to revenge what injuries they did, or fancied to have received. In this difpofition of affairs Jori- tomo was fent by the Emperor, at the head of a numerous army, and with an abfolute power to adjufl: the differences, and to terminate the wars between the Princes of the Empire. It is a known Maxim, fup- ported / Chap V. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 183 ported by the experience of all ages, that men entrufted with power feldom care to part with it. This was the cafe of JoritoTno, who glad- ly embracing fo favourable an opportunity, as was put into his hands, efpous'd the intereft of that of the contending parties, which he thought the mcft likely to fupport his own, and by this means encreafed his power to that degree, as not only to arrogate to himfelf an abfolute au- thority in the decifion of all the fecular affairs of the Empire, but to leave to his Succeflors a plaufible pretext to claim the fame. Thus the Power of the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperors receiv'd at firft a fatal fhock by the difobedience and quarrels of the Princes of the Empire, and was at laft entirely taken from them by the ufurpation of their Crown Generals, tho' without prejudice to their fupreme Dig- nity, Rank, Holinefs, and fome other Rights and Prerogatives, which do not properly relate to the government of the fecular affairs of the Empire, as will appear more fully in the following Chapter. Kon Je reign'd fourteen years* CHAP. V. Of the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperors, who livd after Joritomo, to the frefent time. KON JE was fucceeded by his elder Brother GOSIIRAKAWA, or Sijrakawa the fecond, the Emperor To Ba's fourth Son, in D ^^Tj/ the year of Synmu 1816, of Chrift 11 56. KAlVA After his acceffion to the Throne he appointed the Nengo Foogien, which fubfifted three years. In the firft year of his reign, on the eleventh day of the feventh. month, Sfi In revolted againft the Emperor. This Rebellion occafion'd a bloody and pernicious War, which from the time of its beginn- ing is call'd, Foogienno midarri, that is, the desolation ofthetimeFoogien, and is by this name defcribed at large in their Hiftories. In the third year of his reign, in the eighth month, happened a vio- lent Earthquake. After a fhort reign of three years he refign'd the Crown to his Son. Twelve years after he enter'd into religious Orders, caus'd him- felf to be (haved, and took the name of Jooffin. He died in the forty third year of his age. NIDSIOO. 1 84 The Hi/lory o/JAPAN. Book II. D«i- NIDSIOO., Gofijrakaiva's eldeft Son, was fixteen years old, when his MDSio L Q. Ellher religned the Crown to him, in the year of Synmu 181 9, of Chrift 1 1 59. The Nengo's appointed daring his reign were Feitfi of one, Jeira- ku of one, Oofo of two, Tfioquan of two, and Jeeman of one year. In the firft year of his reign, the two great Generals Nobu Jori, and Jofttomo, Joritomo 1 *, Father, both Princes of the blood, rebell'd againft the Emperor. This Rebellion, and the War occafioned there- by, are call'd from the time when they begun, and are defcrib'd in their Hi- ftories, by the name of Feitfi no tmdarri; or the Defolation of the time Feitfi. Two years after Jo/homo was kill'd in the Province Qveari, and his Son Joritomo was thereupon banifh'd to Llfu. In the fifth year of his reign, and the firft of the Nengo Tfioquan, a poor Woman was brought to bed of three children, each of which had two heads and four feet. He reign'd 7 years, and died 23 years old. TiciLXXix. He was fucceeded by his eldeft fon ROKU DSJOO in the year of Syn- VOm nw 1826, of Chrift 1 166. * He appointed the NengoNinjani, which fubfifted three years. He reign'd but three years, and died thirteen years old. Dai. LXXX. He was fucceeded by TAKAKuRA, the Emperor Gofijrakarpa's third %j Son, in the year of Synmu 1829, of Chrift 1169, and the ninth of his Age. He was married to a daughter of Kijomori, who was mention'd above, under the reign of the Emperor To Ba. He appointed the Nengo's Kavoo of two, Sioun of four, Angen of two, and Dfififo of four years. In the third year of his reign, his Father was fhav'd and turn'd Monk, taking the name of Joojfin. In the fourth year of his reign, on the twenty-third day of the firft month, a great part of the capital city and refidence of the Emperor was laid in afhes. In the feventh year the Small-pox was very fatal all over the Empire. In the eleventh year the Emperor remov'd his court and refidence to Kuivara. In the twelfth year of his reign, and the laft of the Nengo Dsijjfo, the ennemies of Joritomo were defeated in the Province Isju, and Jorimajfia was kill'd with all his family. He reign'd twelve years, and died twenty one years old. Da^LXXXl. His eldeft Son AN TOKU, born by Kjiomori's daughter, fucceeded him in the year 0$ Synmu 1841, of Chrift 1181. He appointed the Nengo'?, Joowa of one, and Siuje of two years. In the firft year of his reign, there was a great famine in Japan, occa- fion'dboth by the fterility of the crop, and the ftill raging wars. The fame year Chap V. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 18$ year died Kijomori, the Emperor's Grandfather, after the manner above related. The fame year General Kadfuwara left the Feki Party, and went over to Joritomo, who was then call'd Tiojenoski. This Kadfuwara. Was of a very mean extraction, but by his courage and heroic actions he rais'd himfelf to be one of the moft considerable Princes of the Em- pire. The fame year was born Jori Ije, Joritomo' % Son and his SuccelTor in the command of the armies and the government of fecular affairs. After a fhort reign of three years Antoku was forc'd to refign the Crown. He was fucceeded bv GO TO BA, or Toba the fecond, the Emperor Dai - LXXXIT. Takakura's fourth Son, in the year of Symnu 1844, of Chrift 1184. G TO uj\ He appointed the Neftgo's Genriaku of one, Buauitz of five, and Kenkiu of nine years. In the firft year of his reign died Jeofriaga, a great General, of whofe heroic actions frequent mention is made in the Hiltory of the Wars with the Feki's. In the third year of his reign, his Predeceffor Antoku being purfued by his enemies, was unhappily drown'd in the Weftern Seas. He was after his death call'd Antokuten 0, having after his resignation taken the name of Sen Teu About that time died Jofinaga, Joritomo^ Son in law. In the fixth year of his reign was kill'd Jo/it&ne, another very eminent Commander. His death was follow'd by that of Fidefira his Lieutenant- General, and the extirpation of his whole Family. In the eleventh year Joritomo went to court, to pay his refpefls to the Mikaddo, by whom he was honour'd with the title of Set Seogun, which hath been ever fince given to the Crown-Generals and Secular Monarchs* In the fourteenth year of his reign, a Horfe with nine feet was fent to court from the Ifland Awad/i, as a prefent to the Emperor. He reign'd fifteen years, and refign'd the Crown to his eldeft Son. . He died fixty years old. TSUTSI MIKADDO, (Mikaddo is here the Emperor's name) was but Dai. three years old, when he came to the crown by his Father's resignation, L Jf x ^l n - in the year of Synmu 1859, of Chrift 11 99. -mikaddo. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Seot&i of two, Kennin of three, Genkiu of two, Kenje of one, and Soojen of four years. In the firft year of his reign died Joritomo % Crown-general and the firft Secular Monarch. His Son Jori Ije fucceeded him in the command of the armies, and was five years after his Father's death by the Dairi honour'd with the title of Sei Seogun. He was kill'd two years after. Tfutfi Mikaddo reign'd twelve years, and refign'd the crown to his younger brother. He liv'd 37 years. A a a SIUmOKl 1 86 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book II. D« SIUNTOKlf his younger Brother, and the Emperor Gotoba's third sii'ntok'u. Son, fucceeded him in the year of Synmu 1871, of Chrift 1211. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Genriaku of two, Genpo of fix, and Seokht of three years. In the fourth year of his reign, and the fecondof the Nengo Genpo, died Foonen Seonin, founder of the Seel of Seoclosju. In the fixth year of his reign, and the fourth of the faid Nengo, the firft Fune's, or Men of War, were built in Japan by order of Sonnetomo, Jori. tamo's fecond Son, who endeavour'd by force of arms to maintain himfelf in the fucceflion to his Father's and Brother's employments. In the ninth year of his reign, on the twenty-fecond day of the fecond month, the two ftately Temples Kiomulz, and Giwon were burnt down. He reign'd 1 1 years, and liv'd 46. P««. He refis;n'd the crown to GO FORIKAWA, or Forikawa the fecond go fori- tne Emperor Takakura's Grandfon, in the year of Synmu 1882, of Chrift KAU\A. 1222, The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Teewo of two, Gen In of one y Karoku of two, AnTe of two, jQjianki of three, and Teejei of one year. In the firft year of his reign, and the firft of the Nengo Teewo, on the firft day of the fecond month, was born in the Province Awa, Nhfijren, a famous Pagan teacher, and founder of a particular Seel. Go Forjkawa reign'd eleven years, and liv'd twenty-four. SI DSIO, his eldeft Son, then but five years of age, fucceeded him in lxxxvi. & e y ear of Sy nmn l8 93, of Chrift 1233. stdsi'o. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Tempoho of one, Bunriaht of one, Kaffiuku of three, Riahiin of one, Jengo of one, and Nintzi of three years. In the feventh year of his reign the Seogitn or Crown-General Jorit&ne y who then refided at Kamakura Seogitn, came to court at Miaco, to pay his refpe&s to the Emperor. He reign'd ten, and liv'd fifteen years. £>*»• He was fucceeded by GO SA GA, or Saga the fecond, the Emperor 7 \'Y\'r r JJ jo r go S4G4. Tfutfi Mikaddo's fecond Son, in the year of Synmu 1903, of Chrift 1243. He appointed the Nengo Quan Jun, which fubfifted four years. He died after a fhor't reign of four years, in the fifty-third of his Age. fa. He was fucceeded by his fecond Son GO FIKAKUSA, or Fikakufa the Lxxxriii. fecond, in the year of Synmu 1907, of Chrift 1247. K v s^ J ' He appointed the Nengo's Qitantfi of two, Footfi of two, Gentfio of fix, Koojen, Sooka, and Sooguan each of one year. In the eleventh year of his reign, on the twenty-third day of the fecond month, happen'd a violent Earthquake. He refign'd the crown after a reign of thirteen years, and liv'd fixty. KAME Chap. V. TheHiftoryof JAPAN 187 • KAME JAMMA the late Emperor's younger brother came to the Dai. L XXXI X Crown by his Resignation, in the year of Synmu 1920, of Chrift kame l2 6o. JJMMA The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Bunwo of one, Kot- fw of three and Bunje of eleven years. In the fifth year of his reign, on the 21th day of the eleventh month, died Sinran, chief of the Ikofm Seel, and formerly a difciple of Foon'm Seonin, who was the Founder of the Seodofiu Seel. In the feventh year of his reign appear'd a great Comet, which was feen alfo in China. In the ninth year on the eighth day of the fifth month, were feen two Suns, and in the tenth, on the eleventh day of the fecond month, three Moons. In the fifteenth and laft year of his reign, Mwie Taka^ who was then Crown General, and at the head of the fecular Affairs, took up his Refidence in the City of Kamakura. He reign'd fifteen years, and refign'd the Crown to his eldeft Son. He liv'd thirty two year's after his resignation, and died in the fifty feventh year of his age, and in the fifth year of the reign of the Emperor Gonidfij. GOUDA fucceeded his Father in the" year of Synmu 1935, of Chrift ZW. :X. 1275. The Kongo's appointed during his reign, were Gent ft of two, Kentfi of four, Kooan of four, and Si 00 of three years. Some Authors men- tion only two Nengo's, Gent ft of three, and Kooati of ten years. In the ninth year of his reign, on the twenty firft day of the fifth month, the Tartar General Mooko appeared upon the Coafts of Japan with a Fleet of 4000 fail, and 240000 Men. The then reigning Tar- tarian Emperor Sijfu, after he had conquer'd the Empire of China a- bout the year of Chrift 1270, fent this General to fubdue alfo the Empire of Japan. But this Expedition prov'd unfuccefsful. The Cami (if we believe the Japanefe Writers) that is, the Gods of the Coun- try, and Proteclors of the Japanefe Empire, were fo incens'd at the infult offer'd them by the Tartars, that on the firft day of the feventh month, they excited a violent and dreadful Storm, which deftroy'd all this reputed invincible Armada. Mooko himfelf perifh'd in the waves, and but few of his Men efcaped. (This Expedition, of which more in il>e Tranjlator's Preface, is mentioned by Marcus Paulus, a noble Venetian, who was then himfelf in China, and lived at the Court of the Tartarian Emperor Sijfu. In the tenth year of his reign, on the thirteenth day of the tenth month, died in the Province Mufafi, the abovemention'd Nitjijrin. The adherents of the Eokefiu Seel ftill celebrate a yearly feftival to commemorate the day of his death. Gouds 188 TheHiftory o/JAP.AN. Book II. GoiuU reign'd thirteen years, and liv'd fifty eight. T>*i He was fucceeded by FUSIMI, Go Fikakufa's fecond Son, and his Coufin, in the year of Synmu 1948, of Chrift 1288. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were Sootfo of five, dnd Jenin of fix years. In the firft year of his reign, on the third day of the third month, was born his Son and fuccellbr, to whom he refign'd the throne af- ter a reign of eleven years. He liv'd fifty three years. zi''^f;h,i GO FUSIMI, or Fufimi the fecond, fucceeded his Father in the year of Synmu 1959, of Chrift 1299, and the twelvth of his age. He appointed a new Nengo, which was call'd Seoan^ and continued three years till he refign'd the throne. He liv'd thirty five years after his refignation, and died forty eight rears old, in the year of Synmu 1997, of Chrift 1337. Dai xcin. He refign'd the Crown to GO NIDSIO, or Nid/io the fecond the co N]j;5]0 " Emperor Gouda's eldeft Son, in the year of Synmu 1962, of Chrift 1302. This Emperor appointed the Nengefs Kagen of four, and Tokuds of two years. In the fifth year of his reign, in the eight month, happen'd a violent Earthquake. The fame year is remarkable for the death of the Emperor Kame Jamma, and the birth of Takaudji, who was af- terwards Crown-General and fecular Monarch. He reign'd fix years, and refign'd the Crown to D.ii. ~/nv. FANNJSONNO the Emperor G? Fufwiis younger brother and Fufi- sonno. mi's fecond Son, in the year of Synmu 1968, of Chrift 1308. The Nengo' s appointed during this Emperor's reign were, Jenke of three, Ootsjo of one, Sooa of two, and Bun of five years. He reign'd eleven years and refign'd the Crown to Go Daigo, Go Uidfio's younger brother, and Gouda's fecond Son. GO DAIGO, or Daigo the fecond, came to the throne in the year GOtJJGO. of Synmu 1979, of Chrift 13 19. He appointed the Nengo's Gemvo of two, Genko of three, Seotsju of two, Karakn of three, Gentoku of two, and Genko of one years. In the laft year of his reign much blood was fhed in the civil wars, which then defolated the Empire, and are defcrib'd in a Book en- tituled Teifeki. He reign'd thirteen years, and refign'd the Crown to Kwo Gien t Go Fufimis eldeft Son. - *™j KWO GIEN or Koo Glen came to the throne in the year of Synmu 1992, of Chrift 1332. He appointed the Nengo Seoke, which continued two years. I» Chap. V. The Hijloryof JAPAN. 189 In the feeond year of his reign, Takadfi, who was then Crown General and Secular Monarch, came to court to pay his duty to the Mikaddo. The fame year Takakoku, a noted General, made away with himfelf, ripping open his belly. Krvoo Gien after a fhort reign of two years refign'd the crown to his Predeeeflbr. He liv'd thirty-two years after, arid died in the year of Syntfm 2026, of Chriffc 1364. GO DJIGO therefore re-afium'd the Crown in the year of Synmu 1994, of Chrift 1334. He then appointed the Nengo'S Kemihu and Jenken, each of two years. In the third year of his feeond reign, died the late Emperor Go FuJ- fimi, as did alfo Kufnokbnaka Sngge, a famous General. The fame year, in the eighth month, Japan was fhook by violent Earthquakes. He reign'd this feeond time but three years. He was fucceeded by QUO MlO, Kwo Giens younger Brother, and the D«. XCrit: Emperor Go Fufmus fourth Son, in the year of Synmu 1997, of Chrift ^ 1337. The Nengo Jenken, which had been appointed by his PredeceflTor, was continu'd during the firft year of his reign, and was follow'd by the Nengo R'uikuwo, which lafted four years. In the feeond year of his reign, the Crown General Takaudfi was by him honour'd with the illuftrious title of Sei Dai Seogun. My two Japanefe Hiftorians differ about the length of this Emperor's reign. One pretends that he reign'd but twelve years, but the other will have it, that after a fhort reign of tv/o years he was fucceeded by GO MURA CAMI, or Muracami the feeond, the Emperor Godaigos feventh child, in the year of Synmu 1999, of Chrift 1339. This Emperor however hath no number aflign'd him in the lift of the Mikaddos. The Nengo Riakwo was continued during the three firft years of his reign, fuppofing that he was poffefs'd of the throne of japan, and it was follow'd by the Nengo's Kooje of three years, and Tewa of four years. Whoever it was, that govern'd Japan during the time of thefe feveral Nengo y s, both my Authors agree, that after the Nengo Tewa was expir'd, Shtkwo came to the crown. SIU KWO, who was tbte Emperor Koo Gen's eldeft Son, began to reign Dai. xcvin. in the year of Synmu 2009, of Chrift 1349. During the firft year of his reign, I find there was no Nengo appointed, for the Nengo Quano begun with the feeond year, and was continued two years. In the firft year of his reign, an end was put to the War Sjjdjio Nawatto. He reign'd three years. He was fucceeded by GOKWOO GEN, or Kwoogen the feeond, his G D "' K A £? younger brother, in the year of Synmu 2012, of Chrift 1352. gen: Bbb The i 9 o The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book II. The Kendo's appointed dmingthis Emperor's reign were, Bunjva of four Jenbun of live, Kooan of on«, TeeiJfi of fix, and Ooan of feven years. This laft Nengo was continued during the three firft years of the reign of his Succefl.br. , ,. ; . In the third year of his reign, Josijfakt, the Crown General Takaudfi his third fon, came to court. • . In the fourth year of his reign, Takaudfi himfelf was fent by the Em- peror into the Province Oomi, to adjuft fome differences which arofe in thofe parts of the Empire. , ■ ,»».-. In the eighth year of his reign, Takaudfi died on the 29th day of the fourth month. His Son Joofifaki fucceeded him in his Employments, and obtain'd the fame year from the Emperor the title of Sei Dai Seogun. In the eleventh year of his reign, the new Crown General Joofifaki was fent to command the Imperial army in Oomi. In the eighteenth year of his reign, Joofmitz, Joofifakis Son, was made Crown General, and gratify' d with the title of Sei Dai Seogun. Gokxooo Gen reign'd twenty years. D*. C. j_r e was fucceeded by GO JENJU his eldeft Son, in the year of Synmu 2032, or Chrilt 1372. The laft of his Fathers Nengo 1 s was continued during the three firft, years of his reign. In the fourth he appointed the Nengo Kooraku which fubfifted four years, and was follow'd by the Nengo's Sei Toku of two, and Koowa of three years, which lafl fubfifted during the firft year of the reign of his Succeflor. Ift the eighth year of his reign, there was a great famine in Japan. The fame year appear'd a Comet. He reign'd eleven years. Dai. a. He was fucceeded by his eldeft Son GOKOMjTZ, in the year of Synmu 2043, ofChrift 1383, and the third of the Nengo Koowa. The Nengo 1 s appointed during his reign were, Sitoku of three years, begun in the fecond of his reign, Kakei of two, Ikoo of one, Meetoku of four, and Oo Jei of thirty-four years. In the ninth year of his reign, there was a War in the Country of Udff In the fourteenth year, on the feventeenth day of the eleventh month, the famous Temple Kenninfi was laid in afhes. In the twentieth year appear'd a Comet in the Spring, and it was ob- Terv'd that there was a great drought and want of water the following Summer and Autumn, and that many violent Earthquakes happen'd the next Winter, In the twenty-fecond year a Mountain at Nafno, in the Province of Simotski, begun to burn, and to throw up ftones and afhes. But the flame ceas'd foon after. In G O K O- UATZ, Chap. V. The Hiflwyof J A P A N. 191 In the twenty fifth year, the autumn was very wet, which occafi- oned inundations in feveral parts of the Empire. The fame was fol- low'd by ftormy Weather and Earthquakes. He reign'd thirty years. He was fucceeded by his Son SEOKJFO, in the year of Synmu 2073, Dai - CIL of Chrift 141 3, and the twentieth of the Nengo Oojei. seokuo. The Nengo Oojei was contirm'd during the firffc fifteen years of his reign, when he appointed a new one, which was call'd Seootjjo, and fubfifted but one year. In the fourth year of his reign Uje Suggi, that is, Uje of the fami- ly of Suggi, rebelPd againft the Emperor. In the ninth year, on the twelfth day of the tenth month, appear'd two Suns. • : • ' - - • In the fixteenth year, on the eighteenth day of the firft month, died Jojimotz, then Crown General, and was fucceeded in his title and employments by Joft'pwbu. i The fame year, on the twenty feventh day of the feventh month, died the Emperor himfelf, after a reign of fixteen . years. He was fucceeded by his Son GOFUNNA SO, in the year of Synmu Du - CII ,' 2089, of Chrift 1429. ., GOFUNNA The Nengo' s appointed during his reign were, Jeiko of twelve, Ka- So - kHz of three, Bunjan of five, Fotoku of five, Kofio of two, Tjioorok of three, and Quanifjo of fix years. In the .firft year of his reign, on the fifth day of the eighth month, appear'd a very large and terrible Comet, and another in the eleventh year in the third month. In the fixteenth year, Jofijmaffa was by the Emperor honour'd with the title of Sei Seogun. In the eighteenth year, the Emperor's Palace was laid in afnes. During the feven laft years of his reign, many ft range and won- derful appearances . in Heaven are mention'd by the Japanefe Hiftori- ans, which were follow'd by famine, peftilence and a great mortali- ty all over the Empire. ,,. He reign'd thirty fix years. He was fucceeded^ by his Son GO TSUTSI MIKADDO, or TCntfi . ■ ■ . J ■■ ■ J J D dt CIV. Mikatldo the fecond, in the year of 'Synmu 2125, of Chrift 1465. • go tsotsi The Nengo* s appointed by this Emperor were, Bunfio of one year, MiKJDDO. begun in the fecond year of his reign, Onin of two, Fumjo of eigh- teen, Tfiooko of two, Jentoku of three, and Me of nine years. In the firft year of his reign, in the fecond month, appear'd a Comet, whofe tail feem'd to be three fathom long. , In the fecond year feveral Earthquakes happen'd, particularly on the twenty ninth day of the twelfth.. month.- The fame year there was fuch a famine in China, that people kill'd and devour'd one another. The io 2 The Hiftoryof] A P A K Book II. The third year was very fatal to Japan, which was fi'U'd with troubles and civil wars. This great defolation began on the fixth day of the fifth month. In the fifth year, on the tenth day of the ninth month, appear'd another Gomet, with a tail above one fathom long. In the feventh year, there was a great mortality all over the Em- pire. The fame year, en the firft day of the twelfth month appeared an- other Comet, larger than any as yet obferv'd, with a tail according to my Author, as long as a ftreet. In the ninth year, died Fojfokawa KatJ?notto, a great General, and very famous for his courage and military exploits. He was after his death henour'd with the title of Riu Ans, and that of Set Seogun was given to Joofnavo. In the eleventh year, on the fixth day of the eighth month, it blew very hard. The waters about Amagafaki in the Province Setz, fwelled to that height, that a great part of that Country was over- flow'd, and many of the Inhabitants drown'd. In the twenty fifth year, on the twenty fixth day of the third month died Jofijnavo. He was the Crown General Jq/ijmajfa's Son, and had befides the title of Bel Seogun, a fliare with his Father, in the command of the armies, and the adminiftration of the fecular affairs of the Empire. The next year, which was the year of Chrift 1490, died Jo/ijma/Ja himfelf, and was very much regretted. In the twenty ninth year, Jofijfimmy was honoured with the title of Sei Dai Seogun. He went foon after to command the army in Jafip-o. In the thirtieth year, on the feventh day of the eighth month, hap- pen'd another violent Earthquake. He reign'd in all thirty fix years, and liv'd fifty nine. ;>• cv. He was fucceded by his Son KASIUWABARA, in the year of Syn- ^M^' A ' mH 2 1 61, of Chrift 1 501. The Uengos appointed during his reign were, Bunki of three, Jeefeo of feventeen, and Teije of feven years, which la ft was continu'd during the firft year of the reign of his fucceffor. In the fourth year of his reign, there was a great famine in Japan, and another in the fixteenth year. In the fixth year, in the feventh month, appear'd a Comet. In the eighth year the title of Set Seogun, and the command of the army was given to Jof.tanne. The tenth year was fatal to Japan both by War and Earthquakes. In the twelfth year, in the fifth month, Jofijtanne went to Court, to pay his duty to the Emperor. Kafiuwabara reign'd twenty fix years, He Chap V. The Hi/lory of J A PA K 193 He was fueceeded by his Son GONARJ, in [the year of Synmu 2187, *' C ^ L r r>\- -n. G0 N AR.& of Chnlt 1527. The lafl of his Father's Nengds was continued during the firfl year of his reign, after which he appointed the Nengo's, Koraht of four, Tembuh of twenty-three, and Koodfi of three years. Soon after his acceflion to the throne, an end was put to the war betv/een FolJ'okawa and Kadfuragawa. The former of thefe two Princes made away with himfelf two years after, ripping open his belly with that courage and refolution, which is fo much admir'd by th«fe Heathens. During this Emperor's reign, the Japanefe Empire was affli&ed twice with peflilence, and a great mortality, thrice, with extraordinary wet rainy Seafons, whereby the waters increas'd to fuch a degree, that they over-flow'd great part of the country, and once with fuch a violent and univerfal florm, that thereby many {lately buildings, and part of the Emperor's own Palace, was blown down. In the fifth year, on the twenty-ninth day of the fixth month, ap- pear'd a Comet, and another again in the twelfth month of the twelfth year. In the feventh year, on the eighth day of the tenth month, was obferv'd an Eclipfe of the moon. In the twenty-firfl year, on the feventeenth day of the fecond month, Jofi. Tir receiv'd from the Emperor the title of Set Dai Seogun, with the command of the armies. Eighteen years after this Jofi Tir made away with himfelf, cutting his belly. In the twenty -fourth year, on the fourth day of the fifth month, died the Crown General and Secular Monarch Jofi] Far. Gonara reign'd thirty-one years. He was fueceeded by his Son OOKIMATZ, in the year of Synmu 2218, Dai. crih ofChrifti 5 58. ° UA $£ The Nengo's appointed during his reign were, Jeekoku of twelve, Genki of three, and Jetifoo of nineteen years, which laft continued during the firfl five years of the reign of his Succeffor. In the very firfl year of his reign, there was a great famine in Japan, preceded by an exceeding dry Summer. In the eighth year of his reign, Jofij Tir, then Crown General and Secular Monarch, made away with himfelf, as above mention'd. In the eleventh year Jofij Tira was appointed Crown General, and ho- nour'd by the Emperor with the title of Set Seogun. In the fixteenth year is mention'd, as fomething remarkable, that a Tof- toife with two heads was caught in the Spring. The fame year on the third day of the fourth month, fome Incendiaries fet fire to Kamio, that is^ the upper part of the City of Miaco, (the lower part is call'd Si Mid) where- in the Emperor himfelf then refided, by which the greatefl part of it was laid in afhes. Ccc In ip4 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book II. In the twentieth year on the twenty ninth day of the ninth month, appeared a great Comet, which did not difappear till the next year. The twenty firft year was very wet, and great part of the Coun- try was fet under water on the twelfth day of the fifth month. In the twenty third year the ficknefs and mortality was great all over the Empire. In the twenty fifth year, on the fecond day of the fixth month, the Crown-General and Secular Monarch Nobwiaaga, and his eldeft Son, were kill'd at Miaco. In the twenty lixth year fome AmbaiTadors from the Riuht Iflands came to Court. In the twenty eighth year, which was the year, of Chrift 1585, in the feventh month, Fide Jos, who afterwards tock the name of Taiko, or Taikofama, was by the Emperor honour'd with the Title ctf" Onanbuku, and entrufted with the command of the armies, and the govern- ment of the fecular affairs of the Empire. Quanbuku is the firft perfon after the Dairi, and by vertue of this title, his fupreme Lieutenant and Vice- gerent in the government. This Taiko was of a very mean extraction, and rais'd himfelf to this eminent poft merely by his courage and merit. He was, properly fpeaking, the firft abfolute Secular Monarch of Japan, that is, the firft, who affum'd to himfelf the abfolute government of the Empire, whereof the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperors till then pre- ferv'd fome fhare. Ever fince that time the Secular Monarchs continued independent of the Ecclefiaftical Emperors, to whom nothing was left but a meer fhadow of their former Authority, with fome few infignificant Prerogatives, as to their rank and holinefs, and the titles of honour, which mult be conferr'd by them. The fame 28th year, on the 29th of the nth month, happen'd a violent Earthquake, which continued by repeated, though fmaller fhocks, for almoft a whole year. In the 29th year of his reign, he refign'd the Crown to his Grandfon, and died feven years after. T)ai. crm. GO JOSEI, the Emperor Ookimatz, his Grandfon, and the eldeft Son of the Hereditary Prince Jookwo, who died the year before, on the feventh day of the eleventh month, came to the crown the year of Synnm 2247, of Chrift 1587. The laft of his Grandfather's Nengo's was continued during the five firft years of his reign, after which the following were appointed, Bunro- ku of four years, and Keitsjo, which fubfifted nineteen, or three years after his death. In the third* year of his reign, Fidetfugi (a nephew of the Secular Monarch Taiko, by whom he was declar'd his Succeflor, though after- wards difgraced and commanded to rip open his belly) a cruel and fan- guinary Prince, kill'd Foodsjo, in the Province Sagami, and extirpated all his CO JOSEI. Chap V. The Hi/lory of JAPAN 195 his family, purfuant to the rules of War obferv'd in Japan, which advife by this means to root out at once, and to deftroy the very caufe of the evil. In the fifth year, the title of Quanbuku was given to the faid Fide Tfugu In the fixth year, which was the year of Chrift 1592, Tdiko de- clared war againft the Coreans, and fent over a numerous army un- der a pretext, as he gave out, of making by the conquer! of this Penin- sula his way to the conqueft of the Empire of China it felf. This war lafted feven years. In the feventh year died Ookimatz, the Emperor's Grandfather and PredecefTor. In the eleventh year Jejias, a great favorite of Taiko's, and his firft minifter of ftate, was by the Emperor honour'd with the title of Nai Dai Sin. The fame year, on the twelfth day of the feventh month, happen'd feveral violent Earthquakes, and the trembling continu'd by fits for a whole month. About that time it rain'd Hair, four to five inches long, in feveral parts of the Empire. This Phcenomenon is often mention'd in their Hiftories. In the twelfth year, which was the year of Synmu 2258, of Chrift 1598, on the eighteenth day of the eighth month, Fide Jofi took the name of Taiko, which fignifies a great Lord. This great Monarch died the fame year, (on the fixteenth of December, N. S.) early in the morning, leaving the fecular government to his only Son Fide Jori, whom he committed to the care and tuition of Jejas. In the fourteenth year, Jofijda TJibbu, who had a place at Fide Jo- ri's Court, rebell'd againft the Emperor. The rebels were foon de- feated, and their chief with all his family exterminated. In the feventeenth year, the title of Sei Dai Seogun, which belongs to the Crown General, was given to Jejas, Tutor of the hereditary Prince Fide Juri, Taiko's only Son. The fame year Fide Juri himfelf was honour'd with the title of Nai Dai Sin. In the ninteenth year the title of Sei Dai Seogun was given to Fide Tadda, the Crown General Jejas his Son. The fame year a very extraordinary accident happen'd on the fif- teenth day of the twelfth month, for a mountain arofe out of the Sea in one night's-time, near the rocky Ifland Fatfifto, where the Grandees of the fecular Monarch's Court are ufually confin'd, when out of favour. In the twenty firft year, which was the year of Chrift 1608, an Embaffador arriv'd at Suruga, who was fent by the Chinefe Empe- ror to compliment the fecular Monarch of Japan. hi 196 TheHiftory of J A P A N. Book II. In the twenty third year, Jejas crder'd a ftrong caftle to be built in the province Owa>i. In the twenty fourth year, the Riuku Wands were invaded and con. quer'd by the Prince of Satzuma. Ever (ince they are look'd upon as belonging to the Japanefe Empire. Go Jofei reigned in all twenty fixe years. "''';. ^'Y: He was fucceeded by his Son DMSEOKJiV T£7, in the year of Synmn 22J2, of Chrift 1612. In the fourth year of his feign he appointed -the Isengo Geniwa of nine years, which was follow'd by the Nengo Quan Je, which con- tinued twenty years, during the remaining part of his reign, and the whole reign of the Emprefs his fucceflor. In the fecond year of his reign, it was again obferv'd, that Hair fell in feveral parts of the Empire, chiefly in autumn. In the third year, on the twenty fifth of the tenth month, happen'd a very violent Earthquake. The fame year Fide Juri, the late fecular Em- peror Taikos only Son and Heir, was befieg'd in the Caftle of Ofacca, by Jejas, who was his Tutor and Father-in-law. The Caftle was furrender'd in the fourth year, on the feventh day of the fifth month. But the Prince caus'd the palace, where he retir'd with his moft faithful adherents, to be fet on fire, chufing rather to perifh by the flames, than to fall into the hands of a victorious enemy, tho' fo neat- ly related to him. In the fifth year, on the feventeenth day of the fourth month, died Jejas himfelf, in full and quiet poffeflion of the fecular Throne • which he ufurped upon his Pupil, and left to his Son. This Jejas was the firft Emperor of the now reigning family. He was buried at Tsicquo and according to cuftcm related among the Gods, by the name of Gongenfama. In the eighth year, which was the year of Chrift 161 9, appear'd a very remarkable Comet. In the tenth year, the Ecclefiaftical Emperor was married with great pemp and folemnity to the fecular Monarch Fide Tada's daughter. In the twelfth year Jemitz, Fide Tada's Son, went to Miaco y to pay his duty to the fecular Emperor, of whom he obtain'd the title of Set Dai Seogun. In the eighteenth year he refign'd the Crown to his daughter. He lived fifty years after his refignaticn, and died in the ninetieth year of his age, and the eight of the isengo Tempo, on the eighth day of the eighth month, or late in autumn, when according to my Japa- nefe Author's exprefhon, the Trees had been already ftript of their Leaves. Dai ex. ^'° ^ e > or Seo Te, that is, Madam Mikaddo, or according to others, seo te. Fonin, the laft Emperor's daughter, came to the Crown in the year of SjTwnt 2290, of Chrift 1630. The Chap. V. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 197 The laft of her Father's Nengo's was continued during her whole reign. In the third year of her reign, on the twenty fourth day of the firft month, died the fecular Monarch Fide Tada. He was after his death deified according to cuftom, and call'd Teitokuin. In the fifth year the fecular Monarch Ijemitz, Fide Tada's Son and fucceffor, went to the Dairi's Court. In the feventh year, in the tenth month, the Chinefe were again fuffer'd to come to Japan, on account of their trade; which they had been forbid to do for fome time before. The beginning of that famous rebellion of the Chriftians at Sima- bara, in the Province Fifen, falls upon the eleventh month of the eighth year, being the year of Chrift 1637. In the ninth year, in the fecond month, on the 12th of April 1638, 37000 Chriftians were put to death on one day. This acl of cruelty at once put an end to the rebellion, and a finifhing ftroke to the total abolition of the Chriftian Religion in Japan. In the twelfth year, of Chrift 1641, on the fifth day of the eight month, was born Ijetzna, Father of the now reigning fecular Monarch. The fame year was a great famine and mortality in Japan, from the beginning of the Spring to the enfuing Harveft. This Emprefs reign' d fourteen years, and refign'd the Crown to her younger brother. GOKlVOMIO, commonly Goto Mio, the late Emprefs's Y mn ~ coKWOMld ger brother, fucceeded his Sifter in the year of Synmu 2303, of Chrift 1643, on the feventh day of the ninth month, though he did not take the title of Mikaddo, and full poffefuon of the throne, till the fifth day of the eleventh month. The Nengo's appointed during his reign were Seofb of four, Kejan of four, and Seoo of three years. In the third year of his reign, on the twenty third day of the fourth month, the title of Seonai Dai Nagon, was given to the Secular Monarch Ijetzna. In the eleventh year, on the twelfth day of the eighth month, a Fire broke out in the Dairi, or Palace of the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Em- peror, which confumed great part of it with feveral neighbouring Tem- ples and other buildings. The fame year fome young Lads, of twelve to fourteen years of age, were committed to prifon on fufpicion of having fet fire to it, and to feveral other parts of the City of Mia- CO. In the eleventh year, on the fixth day of the feventh month, ar- riv'd from China, Ingen an eminent Heathen Preacher. The defign of his coming over was to convert the people to his Pagan worfhip, and D d d ttf 108 The Hiftorj of JAPAN. Book II. to unite, if poflible, the differing Setts, then flourifhing, in the Empire, a talk truly hard. The fame year, on the twentieth day of the ninth month, died the Mi- kaddo y and was buried with great folemnity in the temple of Sen Oaf, on the fifteenth day of the following tenth month. ?f" ffQ He was fucceeded by his third and younger Brother SININ, in the year of Synmu 2314, of Chrift 1654. The Nengo's appointed during his-reign were, Meiruku, and Bantfi ', each of three years, and Seowo, or according to others, Quan Bun, of twelve years, which laft was continued to the eleventh year of the reign of his SuccefTor. Some Authors pretend, that it was in the firft year of this Emperor's reign, the Chinefe had obtain'd leave to renew their trade to Japan. In the third year of his reign, (of Chrift 1657) on the thirteenth day of the firft Month, a dreadful fire broke out at Jedo, the refidence of the Secular Monarch, which continued burning with great violence for three days, and laid the greateft part of that noble Capital in afhes. {An Account of this fire hath been given by Mr. Wagenaer, Ambaffador of the Eaft India Company to the Emperor of Japan, who was then at Jedo himfelf and is inserted in Montanus'j memorable EmbaJJies to the Japanefe Emperors. p. 370.J In the fifth year was firft begun the Rakujo, or Pilgrimage to the 33 Quanxoon Temples, which was fince made by many religious people of both fexes. In the feventh year, great part of the Ecclefiaftical Emperor's refidence was again laid in afhes. In the eighth year, on the firft day of the fifth month, happen'd a violent Earthquake, by which a mountain in the Province Oomi, on the river Katzira, funk down flat even with the ground, without leaving the leaft foot-ftep of its having ftood there. He reign'd eight years. t .. cxiii. He was fucceeded by his younger Brother KlNSEN, or Tei Sen, or with his full title, Kinfeokwo Tei, the Emperor Daifeokwo TePs youngeft Son, in the year of Synmu 2323, of Chrift 1663. The laft of his Brother's Nengo's was continued during the firft ten years of his reign, when he appointed the Nengo Jempo, which fubfifted eight years, and was follow'd by the Nengo's Tenwa of three, aud D/io- kio of four years. In the third year of his reign, in the fixth month, a Court of Enquiry was eftablifh'd by fpecial command of the Emperor, in all the cities and villages throughout the Empire. The bufinefs of this court is to enquire what religion, belief or fed, each family, or its individual members be- long to. This Enquiry ^is made once every year, tho' not at a certain determined time, but commonly fome days, or weeks, after the trampling over KINSEN. Chap. V. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. i 99 over the Images of our bleffed Saviour, and the Virgin Mary, hath been per- form'd in every family, as a convincing proof of their abhorrence to the Chriftian Religion. In the fourth year year, in the fourth month, the Emperor order'd the Jusja Fufe, a branch of the Fokefm Seel, to be aboliuVd, forbidding all his fubjecls, ever hereafter, to adhere thereto. The followers of this Seel entertain'd fuch ridiculous notions of their own purity and holinefs, that they thought the very converfation with other People would pollute and profane them. In the fixth year, on the firft day of the fecond month, and for forty-five days following, the City of JeJo fuffer'd much by fire, which feem'd to have been laid in defignedly, and the malicious intent levell'd chiefly at Merchant's ware-houfes, and the places where Soldiers were quarter'd. In the feventh year, there being a great famine in Japan, occafion'd by an exceffive drought the year before, the Emperor order'd that from the twentieth day of the firft month, for one hundred days fucceflively, boil'd rice mould be diftributed to the poor, at his own expence, in all parts of the Empire. In the eighth year, they had very violent ftorms at Ofacca, and in feve- ral other maritime Provinces, follow'd by Inundations, and a great mortality among men and beafts. In the ninth year, in the fourth month, as they were cleaning the river, which runs by Ofaua, they took up great quantities of gold and filver, which, in all probability, were funk there during the late Civil Wars. In the eleventh year, on the ninth day of the fifth month, a fire broke out at the Dairis court, which burnt with fuch fury, that great part of the city of Miaco itfelf was laid in afhes, and becaufe it unluckily happen'd, that among other buildings feveral publick granaries were deftroy'd by the fire, the Emperor, for the eafe and comfort of his Sub- jects, order'd, that three Kokits of rice mould be given, or lent to any family, that flood in need of it, as is done frequently in time of famine. In the twelfth year, in the fecond month, a Court of Enquiry was held, by fpecial command of the Emperor, in his Capital of Miaco, when it ap- pear'd, that in the 1850 ftreets of this city, there were 1050 of the Ten Dai's Religion, 10070 of the feci: Singon, 5402 of Fojfo, 11 01 6 of Sen, 122044 of Seodo, 9912 of Rit, 81586 of Jocke, 41586 of Nis Fonguans, 801 12 of Figas Fonguans, 7406 of Takata Monto, 8306 of Bukwoo, 21080 of Dainembuds, 6073 of the feci of Jammabos, that is in all 405643 (the Dairi's Court not computed) 182070 of which were males, and 223573 females. (See the latter End of the IXth Chapter of the Vth Book.) The fame year, on the third day of the fourth month, died in the famous Convent Obaku, the above mention'd Chinefe Miflionary Ingen, in the 200 The Hifloryof] A P A N. Bock 1 1 the four fcore and fecondyear ofhis age. The following months, the growth of the field fuffer'd much by rain and hail, whereby a great famine was occafion'd, for which reafon the Emperor iltued new orders to diftribute rice to the poor in the chief Cities. In the eighteenth year, and the eighth of the Nengo Jenpo, on the eighth day of the fifth month, (1680, on the 24th of June) died the fecular Monarch Jjetzna. He was after his death, according to cu~ from, related among the Gods, and calPd Gen Ju in den. In the nineteenth year, in the fifth month, the pompous Title of Set Dai Seogun Nai Dai Sin Sioni i nkonjeno Taifo, was by the Emperor conferr'd on the now reigning fecular Monarch Tjinajos, who was a younger brother of Geniuin, and Jjetiru, or Daijoin his third Son. In the twentieth year, and the fecond of the Nengo Tenwa (ofChrift 1682) there was again a great famine and mortality in Japan, par- ticularly in and about Miaco. In the twelfth month of the fame year, on the 28th day, a Fire broke out at Jedo t which laid the befl part of that great City in allies. In the twenty firft year, which was the third of the Nengo Tenwa, died Toktimats,, the now reigning fecular Monarch's only Son and he- reditary Prince, for whole death the Empire went into a general mourn- ing, that no mufical Inftrument was to be touch'd, nor any kind of rejoycings to be made for three years. The fame year, on the fifth day of the twelfth month, the City of Jedo fuffer'd again by Fire. This Emperor reign'd twenty four years, and refign'd the Crown to his Son. Dai cxif. KINSEN, or Kinfeokvpo Tei, hath the fame name with his Father, KINSEN. to whom he fucceeded in the year of Synmu 2347, of Chrifl 1687. In the fecond year of his reign, he appointed the Nengo Genroku, the fifth year whereof was the year ofChrift 1692, when I was in Japan my felf, which in the Cyclus of fixty years, bears the name of Mi- dfno Je Sar. The names of thefe hundred and fourteen Ecclefiaftical hereditary Emperors of Japan, taken out of a Japanefe Chronicle, printed in the learned Language of the Chinefe, are engrav'd in Tab. XVI. CHAP. Chap. VI; The Hiftory of JAPAN. 201 CHAP. VI. Of the Crown*Generals^ and Secular Monarchs, from Joritomo to the Emperor Tfinajos now reigning. I. TO RITO MO, the firft Crown-General and Secular Monarch, was J born under the reign of the LXXVI Dairi, in the year of Ghrift 1 1 54. He reign'd 20 years. II. JORI I JE, Joritomo'?, Son, reign'd five years. III. SANNETOMO, Joritomo's fecond Son, reign'd feventeen years. IV. JORITZ NE, a Son of Quan Baku Dooka, reign'd 18 years. V. JORI SANE, or Jorifuga, Joritzne's Son, reign'd 8 years. VI. MUNE TAKA SIN NO, or Soo Son Sinno, a Son of the EccleQa- ftical Hereditary Emperor Sagga the fecond, reign'd 15 years. VII. KOREJAS SINNO, MuneTaka's eldeft Son, reign'd 24 years. VIII. KIUME SINNO, or Sanno OH, the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor Fikakufa the Second's third Son, reign'd 20 years. IX. MORI KUNI SINNO, his Son, reign'd 2 5 years. X. SO NUN SINNO, or SONNUM SINNO, Daigo the Second's fecond Son, reign'd 2 years. XI. NARI JO SI SINN 00, Daigo the fecond's fonrth Son, reign'd three years. XII. TAKA UDSI, a Son of Askago Sannokino Cami Nago TJdfi, reign'd 25 years. XIII. JOSIJAKI, Takaudfi's third Son, reign'd 10 years. XIV. JO SI MIT Z, Jofi Jaki'sSon, reign'd 40 years. XV. JOSI MOT SI, Takamitz's Son reign'd 21 years. XVI. JOSI K AS SU, Jofimotfi's Son, reign'd under his Father. XVII. JOSI NOR I, Jofimitz's Son, reign'd 14 years. XVIII. JO SI K AT Z, Jofi Nori's eldeft Son, reign'd three years. XIX. JOSI MASS A, Jofi Nori's fecond Son, reign'd 49 years. XX. JOSINAVO, reign'd under his Father Jofimafa. XXI. JOSI TANNE, Jofmavo's Brother reign'd 18 years. XXII. JOSI STMMI, Jofi Tanned Son, reign'd 14 years. XXIII. JOSIFAR, Jofi Symmi's Son, reign'd 30 years. XXIV. JOSI TIR, Jofifar's Son, reign'd 16 years. XXV. JOSI TAIRA, or TIRA, Jofi TVs Son, reign'd 4 years. XXVI. JOSI AKI, JofiTaira's Son, reign'd 5 years. XXVII. NOBBENAGA, or NOBUNAGA, Oridano Danfio Taira'i fecond Son, reign'd ic years. XXVIII. FIDE, NOB II, Nobu Tada's Son, reign'd 3 years. XXIX. FIDE JOSI, afterwards call'd Taiko, maTaiko Santa. This celebrated Monarch was a Peafant's Son, and in his younger years Butler to a Nobleman. But by his courage and merit, he rais'd him- Eee felf 202 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book II. felf to be Emperor of Japan. He reduced all the Provinces of Japan, which were then as yet divided, and govern'd by particular Princes, under his- Power and Sovereignty, and became the firft abfolute Secular Monarch. He was after his death, according to the cuflom of the country, related among the Gods, and honour'd by the Dairi with the divine title Tojokuni Dahniofin. His temple, where his um is kept, Hands at Miaco, but is at prefent almofl decay'd, the Secular Empire being gone over into another Family. XXX. FIDE TSUGO\ alias Qiiabacnndono, who was the Son of Joo in Iziro, and Taicofama's Nephew, reign'd under his Uncle, tho' but a little while. XXXI. FIDE JORI, Taicofama"'?, Son, being under age, when his Father died, was by him committed to the care and tuition of IjejasSama one of his favourites and counfellors of ftate, who oblig'd himfelf by a folemn oath, fign'd with his own blood, that as foon as the young Prince fhould come of age, he would quit the regency, and deliver the Empire into his hands. On this condition Jejas his daughter was mar- ried tc the Hereditary Prince, who enjoy'd the Empire, or at leaft the title of Emperor, under his tutor and fither-in-law fourteen years. XXXII. JEJASSAMA, otherwife Ongofio, and Daifufama, ufurp'd the throne upon Fide Jori his Son-in-law. He granted the Dutch Eaft Ini ) free commerce tc Japan, in the year of Ch rift 1611. He wis after his death deify'd according to cuftom, and call'd Gon- Zenfama. He lies buried at Niko, near Miaco, the burial place of this family. He reign'd in all fourteen years, taking in fome of his regency. However fome authors pretend, that he reign'd but four or five years, on a fuppofition, that he was feventy years old, when K- '^nme poflfefs'd of the throne. • XXXIIL.F/U5 TAD A, Ijejajjama's third Son, who was after his death call'd Tuitokonni, or Taitokuinfa?na, renew'd the Priviledges, which his Father granted to the Dutch, in 161 6, or 161 7. He reign'd eighteen years. XXXIV. IJETIRVKO, otherwife Ijemitzh, Fidetada's Son, who was after his death cali'd Daijoinfama, or Taijoinfama, reign'd twenty one years.- XXXV. IJETZFAKO, his Son, who was after his death call'd Gin- joi'ifama, or Genjuinfama, reign'd thirty years, and died on the fourth of June 1680. XXXVI. TSINJJOSIKO, otherwife TJijnajoJifo, or Tfjnafofama, or with his full tittle, which he very lately obtain'd from the Dairi SEI DAI SEOGUN, NAI DAI SINIUKONJENO TAI SO, the now reigning Monarch, fucceeded his Brother. He was in the 43d year of his age, when 1 was in Japan (in 1692 J and had been 12 or 13 years on the throne. THE 203 THE Hiftory of J A PA N, BOOK III. O F T H E State of Religion in J A P A N. CHAP. I. Of the Religions of this Empire in general^ and of the Sin* tos Religion in particular. s&*gr£f*&:*& I B E R T Y of Confcience, fo far as it doth not inter- The Keiigi- ^»SSS fere Wkh the Intereft of the fecuIar Government, 0T 0ttS J **&"• «jj)S§ l P afFed the peace and tranquility of the Empire, hath 4$dW:ffi^sr* been at a ^ times allow'd in Japan, as it is in moft ^&^${£|p># other Countries of Afia. Hence it is, that foreign Re- * * ™ ^ v ligions were introduc'd with eafe, and propagated with fuccefs, to the great prejudice of that, which was eftablifti'd in the country from remoteft antiquity. In this laft hundred years there were chiefly four Religions, confiderable for the number of their ad- herents, to wit. i. S'mto, the old Religion, or Idol-worlhip, of the Japanefe. Sinto. 2. BudfJo, The worfhip of foreign Idols, which were brought over budfdo, into Japan, from the Kingdom of Siam, and the Empire of China. 3. ShttOy The Doclrine of their Moralifts and Philofophers. stot: 4. Deivus, or Kirijlando, is as much as to fay, the way of God and v e vmu Chrift, whereby muft be underftood the Chriftian Religion.- It 204. The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book III. Tate tf At It was owing to the commendable zeal, and the indefatigable care ^£S^ of the Spanifh and Portugueze Miflionaries, particularly the Jefuits, that the Chriftian Religion was firft introduced into Japan, and pro- pagated with a fuccefs infinitely beyond their expectation, infcmuch, that from the firft arrival of the Fathers of the Society in the Pro- vince Bongo, which was about the year of Chiift 1549, C or fix vears after the firft difcovery of Japan,') to the year 1625, or very near 1630, it fpread through moft Provinces of the Empire, many of the Princes and Lords openly embracing the fame. Confi- dering what a vaft progrefs it had made till then, even amidft the many ftorms and difficulties it had been expofed to, there was ve- ry good reafon to hope, that within a fliort compafs of time the whole Empire would hive been converted to the faith of our Saviour had not the ambitious views, and impatient endeavours of thefe Fa- thers, to reap the temporal, as well as the fpiritual fruits of their care and labour, fo provoked the fupreme Majefty of the Empire as to raife, againft themfelves and their converts^ a perfecution,. which hath not its parallel in Hiftory, whereby the Religion, they preach'd, and all thofe that profefs'd it, were in a few years time en- tirely exterminated. „ B . Of the three chief Religions, which now flourifti and are tolerated SntosK.tligmn " in Japan , the S I N T O S. muff be confidered in the firft place, more for its antiquity and long ftanding, than for the number of its adherents. Sinto, which is alfo called Sinsju, and Kamimitfi, is the Idol-wor- fhip, as of old eftablifhed in the Country. Sin and Kami, denote the Idols, which are the object of this worfhip. Jo and Mitfi, is as much as to fay, the way, or method, of worfhiping thefe Idols. Siu figni- fies Faith, or Religion. Sinsja, and in the plural number Sinsju, are the perfons, who adhere to this Religion. Bthef of th rp^ e more j mme( jj ate end, which the followers of this Religion propofe to themfelves, is a ftate of happinefs in this World. They have in_ deed fome, though but obfcure and imperfedt notions, of the Im- mortality of our Souls and a future ftate of blifs, or mifery. And yet, as little mindful as they are, of what will become of them in that future ftate, fo great is their care and attention to worfhip thofe Gods, whom they believe to have a peculiar fhare in the government and management of this world, with a more immediate influence, each according to his functions, over the occ'urencies and neceflities of human life. And although indeed they acknowledge a Supreme Being which, as they believe, dwells in the higheft of Heaven, and tho* they likewife admit of fome inferior Gods, whom they place among the Chap. 1. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 205 the Stars, yet they do not worfhip and adore them, nor have they any feftival days facred to them, thinking, qua fnpra nos nihil ad nos y that Beings, which are fo much above us, will little concern themfelves about our affairs. However they fwear by thefe fuperior Gods, whofe names are conftantly inferted in the form of their oath. But they wor- fhip and invoke thofe Gods, whom they believe to have the fovereign command of their Country, and the fupreme direction of its produce, of its elements, water, animals and other things, and who by vertue of this power, can more immediately affect their prefent condi- tion, and make them either happy or miferable in this life. They are the more attentive in paying a due worfliip to thefe Divinities, as they feem to be perfuaded, that this alone is fuflicient to cleanfe and to purify their hearts, and that doubtlefs by their ailiftance and inter- ceiTionj they will obtain in the future Life rewards proportionable to their behaviour in this. This Religion feems to be nearly as ancient as Cenjeffuresa* ° - J lout the An- the nation itfelf. If it is any ways probable, that the firft Japanefe are de- Equity cf the fcended of the Babylonians, and that, whilft at Babel, they acquir'd si " tos Bel,e f' fome notions of the true religion,' of the creation of the world, and its ftate before that time, as they are deliver'd to us in facred writs, we may upon as good grounds fuppcfe, that by the alteration of their language, and by the troubles and fatigues of fo long arid tedious a journey, the fame were almofl entirely worn cut of their minds, that upon their arrival in this extremity of the Eaft, they defervedly bore a moft profound refpecl to their leader, who had happily conducted them through fo many dangers aud difficulties, that after his death they deify 'd him, that in fucceeding ages other great men, who had well deferved of their Country, either by their prudence and wifdom, or by their courage and heroic actions, were likewife related among their Kami, that is, among the Immortal Spirits worthy to have divine honours paid them, and that to perpetuate their memory, Mias, or Temples, were in time erected to them. (Mia, properly fpeaking, fignifies the Houfe, or dwelling-place of a living Soul. J The refped due to thefe grsat men became in fuccefs of time fo univerfal, that ever fince it is thought to be a duty incumbent on every fincere lover of his Country, whatever feci: otherwife he adheres to, to give publick proofs of his veneration and grateful remembrance of their virtues and fig- 11 al fervices, by vifiting their Temples, and bowing to their Images, either on fuch days, as are more particularly confecrated to their me- mory, or on any other proper occafion, provided they be not in a irate of impurity, and unfit to approach thefe holy places. Thus what was at firft intended, as a fimple aft of refpedl and gratitude, turn'd by degrees into adoration and worfhip : Superftition at Jaft was carried fo far, that the Mikaddo\ or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperors, RtfpeB for being lineal defcendants of thefe great Heroes, and fuppofed heirs of their Da,v '"- excellent qualities, are look'd upon, as foon as they have taken poflefllon Ff f of 20(5 Tie Hiftory of J A P A N. Book 111. of the throne, as true and living images of their Kami's or Gods, as Kami's themfelves, poilefs'd of fuch an eminent degree of puri- ty and holinefs, that no Gege, (Gege is a vile name, which the Kuge, that is, the members of the Emperor's Ecclefuftical Court give to their Countrymen, who are not of the fame noble and divine extraction) dare prefume to appear in their prefence, nay, what is ftill mere, that all the other Kami's or God's of the Country are under an obliga- tion to vifit him once a year, and to wait upon his facred perfon, tho' in an invifible manner, during the tenth month. They are fo far perfuaded of the truth of this, that during the faid month, which is by them call'd Kaminatfuki, that is, the month without Gods, no fefti- val days are celebrated, becaufe the Gods are fupppofed not to be at He huh the home in their Temples, but at Court waiting upon their Dairi. This fole i>owr of j a p ane f e p p e a ff U mes alfo to himfelf, the fole power and authority of deifying and canonizing others, if it appears to him that they de- ferve it, either by the apparitions of their Souls after their death, or by fome miracles wrought by them. In this cafe the Emperor con- fers an eminent title upon the new God, or Saint, and orders x Mia t or Temple, to be built to his memory, which is done either at his own expence, or by the charitable contributions of pious, well- difpos'd Perfons. If afterwards it fo happens, that thofe, who worfhip in this Temple, and more particularly devote themfelves to the new God, profper in their undertakings, but much more if fome extraor- dinary miracle hath been wrought, feemingly by his power and af- fiftance, it will encourage other people to implore his protection, and by this means the number of his temples and worfhippers will quicklv encreafe. Thus the number of divinities is augmented every age. But befides all the illuftrious men, who from time to time, for their he- roic a&ions or lingular piety, have been by the Spiritual Emperors related among the Divinities of the Country, they have another Series of Gods, of a more ancient date. Of thefe two fucceflions are men- T-x» Succef- tion'd. The firft is the fuecefllon of the Tenfin Skzi Dai, or [even UvimtUs. ' ' g reat Celeftial Spirits, who are faid to have exifted in the raoft an- tient times of the Sun, long before the exiftence of men and heaven, and to have inhabited the Japanefe world (the only country in their opinion then exiftingj many millions of years. The feventh and laft of thefe great Celeftial Spirits, whofe name was I[anagi, having car- nally known his divine Confort Ifanami, in imitation of what he had obferv'd of the Bird Ifiatadakki, begot a fecond fuecefllon of Divinities, inferior indeed to the firft, but ftill fuperior to all thofe, who exifted fince their time. This fecond fuecefllon is from the number of its chief heads call'd, DJi Sin Go Dai, or the [uccejfwn of the five terreflrial Divinities, who liv'd and govern'd the Country of Japan a long, but limited time. It is needlefs here to enlarge any further on this head, a full account of the ridiculous and fabulous notions of the Japanefe, with regard to Chap. L • The Bifiory of J A P A N. 207 to thefe two fucceflions of Divinities, having been already given in Book I. ch.7. and Book II. ch. i. I will only add, that the Hiflory of the fecond fuc- cefllon is full of ftrange and uncommon adventures, knight errantries, defeats of giants, dragons and other monfters, which then defolated the country, to the great terror of its Semi-divine Inhabitants. Many cities and villages in the Empire have borrow'd their names from fome fuch memorable aclion, which happen'd in the neighbourhood. They frill preferve, in fome of their temples, fwords, arms and other warlike inftruments, which they look upon as remains of th.it ancient time, and believe to be the very fame which in the hands of thefe Semi- divine heroes prov'd fo deflruclive and fatal to the diflurbers of the peace and tranquillity of the Country. Uncommon refpeel is paid by the adherents of the Sintos Religion to thefe facred relicks, which are by fome ftill believ'd to be animated by the Souls of their former poffeffors. In fhort, the whole Syftem of the Sintos Divinity is fuch Syjiem of a lame ridiculous contexture of monflrous unconceivable fables, that „•„;,.,. even thofe, who have made it their bufinefs to fludy it, are afham'd to own, and to reveal all thofe impertinences to their own adherents, much lefs to the Budf-doijls, and the adherents of other Religions. And perhaps would it not have flood its ground fo long, had it not been for its clofe connexion with the civil cuftoms, in the obfervation of which this nation is exceedingly nice and fcrupulous. The Temples of the Sin- toifls are not attended by priefls and ecclefiaftical perfons, but by laymen, who are generally fpeaking entirely ignorant of the grounds and reafons of the Religion they profefs, and wholly unacquainted with the Hi- flory of the Gods, whom they worlhip. Some few however there are among the S'wtosju, or adherents of the Sintos Religion, chiefly of tioi]S ' e "f th " e ' the order of the Canu/i's, who will now and then make a fermon to the peo- iegmmng of pie, and be at fome pains in inflru&ing young children. During my flay in * t "'" ii ' Japan, one of thefe Canufis came from Miaco to preach at the temple of Tenfi, and afterwards at that of Srnva. He made a Sermon every day, in order to explain the Law, or Commandment Nacottominotarrai, or Uacottomibarrai, but his Sermons, at befl, were ill difpos'd, confufed compofitions of romantick and ridiculous flories of their Gods and Spirits. They will teach their fyftem of divinity to others for a proper confideration, and under an obligation of fecrecy, particularly when they come to the lafl article, which relates to the beginning of all things, they take fpecial care not to reveal the fame to their difci- ples, till he hath oblig'd himfelf with an oath, fign'd with his hand and feal, not to profane fuch facred and fublime myfleries, by dif- covering them to the ignorant and incredulous laity. The original text of this myflerious do&rine is contain'd in the following words taken out of a book, which they call Odaiki j Kai fakuno fafme Dfjitfio Fnfo Tatojaba Jujono fui Joni ukitnga Gotofi Tentfijno utfijni Itfi butfu too feofit Katats Igeno gotofi fenquas fie fin to nar kuni toko datfno Mi- kotto 2o8 The Hi/lory of J A P A N. Book III. kotto to goos : That is, In the beginning of the opening of all things, a Chaos floated, as ffies fwi?n in the water for pleafure. Out of this Chaos aroje a thing like a prickle, moveable and transformable : This thing became a Soul or Spirit, and this Spirit is calfd KUKITOKO- DATSKO MlKOTTa CHAP II, Of the iSintos Temples, Belief and Worjhtf. ramescf FjlHE Sinsju, that is, the adherents of the Sintos Religion, call Ten>}hK their Temples, or Churches, Mia, which word, as I have ob- ferv'd, (ignifies dwelling places of immortal Souls. They come nearer! to the Fana of the ancient Remans, as they are gene- faily fpeaking fo many hiring monuments erected to the memory of great men. They call them alfo Jafijro, and Sia, or Sinsja, which , , laft takes in the whole Court of the Mia, with all other buildings and dependencies belonging to the fame. The Gods, who are the fubjeel: of their worlhip, they call Sin and Garni, which fignines Souls or Spirits. Sometimes alfo they honour them with the epithet of Afiojin, fublime, illuftrious, holy j and Gongen, juft, fevere, jealous. The adherents of other religions call the convents of their religious men, and the places of their worfliip, Sifia Tira, that is, temples, and ofthihUhu the Gods themfelves, which they adore, Fotoge. All other foreign Idols, the worlhip of whom was brought into Japan from beyond Sea, are comprehended under one general name of Bofatz, or Budz,, The Alias, as indeed all convents and religious houfes in general, as well of this, as of their other feds, are feated in the pleafantefr, parts of the Country, on the beft fpcts of ground, and commonly within, or near great cities, towns, villages and other inhabited places. I will cciifine my felf in this chapter only to the Alias of the Sintoifls. A broad and fpacious walk planted with rows of fine cy- pres trees, which grow in the country, and are a tall fine tree, leads ftrait to the Alia, or elfe to the Temple-court, on which there are fometimes feveral Alias fhnding together, and in this cafe the walk aforefaid leads directly to that, which is reckon'd the chief. The Alias are, generally fpeaking, feated in a pleafant wood, cr in the afcent of a fine green hill, and have neat flone ftair cafes leading up to them. Next to the highway, at the entry of the walk, which leads to the temple, ftands, for diftinftion's fake from common roads, a particular Tmple fafhion'd gate, call'd Tori], and built either of ftone or wood. The Cms. ftructure of thefe gates is but very mean and fimple, they confiilinj of two perpendicular pofts or pillars, with two beams laid acrofs, the uppermoft of which is, for ornament's fake, deprefs'd in the middle, the two extremities Handing upwards. Between the two crofs beams is Chap II. The Hi/lory of J A P A N. 209 is placed a fquare table, commonly of Stone, whereon is engrav'd the name of the God, to whom the Mia is confecrated, in golden chara- cters, (v. Tab. XVII. A.) Sometimes fuch another gate Hands before the Mia itfelf, or before the Temple-Court, if there be feveral Mias built together in one Court. Not far from the Mia is a Bafon, commonly of ftone, and full of water for/ thofe, who go to worfhip to wafh themfelves. Clofe to the Mia Hands a great wooden Alms-chefl. The Mia itfelf is neither a fplendid, nor a magnificent building, but very mean and fimple, com- monly quadrangular, and built of wood, the beam? being ftrong and neat. It feldom exceeds twice or thrice a man's height, and two or three fathoms in breadth. It is raifed about a yard, or upwards, from the ground, being fupported by fhort wooden polls. There is a fmall walk, or gallery, to go round it, and a few Heps lead up to this walk. The frontifpiece of the Mia is as fimple as the reft, confifting only of one, or two, grated windows, for thofe that come to worfhip to look through, and to bow towards the chief place within. It is (hut at all times, and often, without any body to take care of it. Other Mia's are fomewhat larger, fometimes with an Anti-chamber, and two fide-rooms, wherein the keepers of the Mia fit, in honour of the Catnip richly clad in their fine Ecclefiaflical Gowns. All thefe feveral rooms have grated windows and doers, and the floor is cover'd with curious mats. Generally fpeaking, three fides of the temple are fhut with deal-boards, there being no opening left but in the front. The roof is cover'd with tiles of ftone, or fhavings of wood, and jets out on all fides to a confiderable diftance, to cover the walk, which goes round the temple. It differs from other buildings by its being curioufly bent, and compos'd of feveral layers of fine wooden beams, which jetting out underneath make it look very lingular. At the top of the roof there is fometimes a flrong wooden beam, bigger than the reft, laid lengthways, at the extremities of which, two other beams Hand up, eroding each other, fometimes a third one is laid a-thwart behind them. This ftrutture is in imitation, as well as in memory, of the firft Isje Temple, which tho' fimple, was yet very ingenioufly and almoft inimitably contriv'd fo, that the weight and connexion of thefe feveral beams was to keep the whole building Handing. Over the Temple-door hangs fometimes a wide flat bell, and a ftrong, long, knotted rope, wherewith thofe that come to worfhip, ftrike the bell, as it were, to give notice to the Gods of their prefence. This cuftom however is not very ancient, nor did it originally belong to the $ntos Religion, for it was borrow'd from the BuJfJo, or foreign Idol-wor- I fhip. Within the temple is hung up white paper, cut into fmall bits, '. the intent of which is to make people fenfible of the purity of the place. Sometimes a large Looking-glafs is plac'd in the middle, for 1 the worfhippers to behold themfelves, and withal to conlider, that as diftin&ly as the fpots of their face appear in the Looking-glafs, fo G g g eonfpi- 2io The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book III. >» _________ _ _____ — __ _. -—__________»_____________ confpicuous are the fecret fpots and frauds of their hearts in the eyes of the Immortal Gods. Thefe temples are very often without any Idols, or Images of the Catnl, to whom they are confecrated. Nor indeed do they keep any Images at all in their temples, unlefs they deferve it on a particular account, either for the reputation and holinefs of the carver, or becaufe of fome extraordinary miracles wrought by them. In this cafe a particular box is contrived at the chief arid upper end of the temple, oppofite to its grated front, and it is call'd Fongu, which is as much as to fay, the real, true Temple. In this box, which the worlhippers bow to, the Idol is lock'd up, and never taken out, but upon the great feftival day of the Kami, whom it reprefents, which is celebrated but once in a hundred years. In the fame fhrine are likewife lock'd up, what relicks they have, of the bones, habits, fwords, or handy-works of the fame God. The chief Mia of every place hath- Mike/*, «*« one or more Mikofi, as they call them, belonging to it, being fquare, tkey am o _ ^ Q _ e ight-corner'd Sacella, or fmaller Temples, curiouffy lacker'd,. adorn'd without with gilt cornifhes, within with looking-glaffes, cut white paper and other ornaments, and hanging oh two poles in order to be carried about upon proper occafions, which is done with great pomp arid folemnity, when upon the Jennit%, that is, the chief fefti- val-day of the God, to whom the Mia itfelf is confecrated, the Ca- niifi or Officers of the Temple celebrate the Matfuri, of which more in another place. Sometimes the Idol of the Cami, to whom the Mia is de- dicated, or fuch of his relicks, as are there kept, are carried about in thefe Mfkoffs upon the fame folemn occafion. The chief of the Canu- fis takes them out of the fhrine of the Temple, where they are kept in curious white boxes, carries them upon his back to the Mikq/i, and places them backwards into the fame, the people in the mean time retiring out of the way, as being too impure and unworthy a ~ race to behold thefe facred things. The outfide of the Mia. or the Anti- "emma, or ° ' Ornaments of chamber, and other rooms built clofe to it, are commonly hung with t..e em} c. ^- lveTS cr naii:ents, Scimiters curioufly carved, Models of Ships, Images of different forts, or other uncommon curiofities, affording an agreeable amufement for the idle fpe&ators, who come to view and to worfhip in thefe Temples upon their holidays. Thefe feveral ornaments are called Jetfma, and are generally fpeaking free gifts to the Temple, given by the adherents of this religion, purfuant to vows, which they made, either for themfelves, or for their relations and friends, when taken ill of fome violent ficknefs, or labouring under fome other misfor- tunes, «nd which they afterwards very fcrupuloufly put in execution, both to fhew the power of the Gods, whofe afliffance they implored, and their own deep fenfe of gratitude for the bleflings receiv'd -frorft them. The fame cuftom is likewife obferv'd by the adherents of the Bofatz, or ifo<^0-Religion. Tab. XVII. is a view of fome of thefe Sititos Temples and Miko/i J copied from an original drawing of the Japanefe. Thefe " ■ I " Chap. II. The Hiftory of J A P A N 211 Thefe Mias, or Sintos Temples are not attended by fpiritual perfons, Musfyvhom but by fecular married men, who are call'd Negi, and Canufi, and * ttat Siannin, and are maintained, either by the legacies left by the founder of the Mia, or by the fubfidies granted them by the Mikaddo, or by the charitable contributions of pious well-difpos'd perfons, who come to worftiip there. Mikaddo, according to the litteral fenfe of the word, Mgnifies the Sublime Port, Mi being the fame with On, Goo, Oo, Gio, high, mighty , ill uftrious, fupreme, fublime, and Kado, fignifyinga port, gate, or door. Thefe Canuji's, or Secular Priefts, when they go abroad, are for diftin&ion's fake, clad in large gowns, commonly white, fometimes yellow, fometimes of other colours, made much after the faihion of the Mikaddo's Court. However, they wear their common fecular drefs tinder thefe gowns. They fhave their beards, but let their hair grow. They wear a ftiff, oblong, lacker'd cap, in fhape not unlike a fhip, (landing out over their forehead, and tied under their chins with twifted filk-ftrings, from which hang down fringed knots, which are longer, or fhorter, according to the office, or quality, of the perfon, that wears them, who is not oblig'd to bow down lower to perfons of a fuperior rank, but to make the ends of thefe knots touch the floor. Their fuperiors have their hair twifted up under a black gauze, or crape, in a very particular manner, and they have their ears co- ve r'd by a particular fort of a lap, about a fpan and a half long f and two or three inches broad, ftanding out by their cheeks, or hang- ing down, more or lefs, according to the dignities, or honourable titles conferr'd upon them by the Mikaddo. In Spiritual Affairs, they are By vfom g«- under the abfolute jurifdiftion of the Mikaddo, but in Temporalities, ver " ' they, and all other Ecclefiaftical Perfons in the Empire, ftand under the command of two DJi Sin Bugios, as they call them, or Imperial Temple-Judges^ appointed by the Secular Monarch. They are haughty Their Chariir and proud, beyond expreffion, fancying themfelves to be of a far better Ber - make, and nobler extraction than other people. When they appear in a fecular drefs, they wear twd Scimiters, after the fafhion of the Noblemen. Tho' Secular Perfons themfelves, yet they think it their duty, and becoming their ftation, to abftain religioufly from all com- munication and intimacy with the common People. Nay, fome carry their fcrupulous conceits about their own purity and holinefs fo far, that they avoid converting, for fear of injuring the fame, even with other religious perfons, who are not of the fame Sect. As to this their conduft however, I muft own, that fomething may be faid on their behalf, for as much as this their uncommon carriage, and religious abftinence from all fort of communication with other people, feems to be the belt, means to conceal their grofs ignorance, and the enormity and incon- fiftence of their fyftem of divinity, which coulcl not but be very much ridicul'd, if in eonverfation the d'ifcourTe fhould happen to fall upon r-eligious affairs. For the whole Sintos Religion iii fo mean and fimple, 2i2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book III. fimple, that befides a heap of fabulous and romantick ftories of their Gods Demi-gods and Heroes, inconfiftent with reafon and common fenfe, their Divines have nothing, neither in their facred Books, nor by Tradition, wherewithal to fatisfy the Inquiries of curious perfons, about the nature and effence of their Gods, about their power and government, about the future ftate of our Soul, and fuch other effential points, whereof other Heathen Syftems of Divinity are not altogether filent. For this reafon it was, that when the fo- reign Pagan Budf Jo-Religion came to be introduced in Japan, it fpread not only quickly, and with furprizing fuccefs, but foon occa- fioned a difference and fchifrn even between thofe, who remain'd con- ftant and faithful to the religion of their anceftors, by giving birth to two Seels, which the Shitoifts are now divided into. The tirft of thefe theSinLjif Seels is call'd Juitz. The Orthodox Adherents of this, continued fo Th juitt. firm and conftant in the religion and cuftoms of their anceftors, that they would not yield in any the leaft point, how infignrhcant foever. But they are fo very inconfiderable in number, that the Canuft's, cr Priefts themfelves make up the beft park. The other Sect is that of HeRiohu!. the Riobif?, : Thefe are a fort of Syncretifts, who for their own fa- tisfa&ion, and for the fake of a more extenfive knowledge in religi- ous matters, particularly with regard to the future ftate of our Souls, endeavour'd to reconcile, if poffible, the foreign Pagan Religion, with that of their anceftors. In order to this they fuppofe, that the Soul of Aniula, whom the BitJfJoifts adore as their Saviour, dwelt by tranfmigration in the greateft of their Gods Ten Sio Dai Sin-, the effence^ as they call him, of light and fun. Moft Sintoifls. cenfefs themfelves to this Seel. Even the Dairi, or the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor's whole Court, perhaps fenfible enough of the falfity and inconfiftence of the religion, which they profefs,, and convine'd, how poor and weak their arguments are, whereby they endeavour to fupport the al- moft divine majefty and holinefs, which their mafter arrogates to himfelf, feem to incline to this Syncretifm. Nay they -have fhewn not long ago, that they are no great enemies even to the foreign Pagan worfhip, for they conferr'd the Arch-bilhoprick, and the two Biftiopricks of the Ikofiu, the richeft and moft numerous Se& of the ReihioK of the Budfdoijl's, upon Princes of the Imperial Blood. The Secular Mo- Semlaf Mo- narch profeiTes the religion of his forefathers, and pays his refpedl: w '" f " and duty once a year to the MikadJo, though at prefent not in perfon, as was done formerly, but by a folemn embaffy and rich prefents. He vifits in perfon the Tombs of his Imperial Predeceffors, and frequents alfo the chief Temples, and religious Houfes, where they are worfhip'd. When I was in Japan myfelf, two ftately Temples were built by order of the Secular Monarch in honour of the Chi- nefe Philofopher Koosju, or as we call him Confutius, whofe philofophy they believe, was communicated to him immediately from Heaven, whi ch r g*^j -^t, v-»-, " -.—!'- Ghap. II. The Hifioryof JAPAN. 213 ; ; — ! ■ — i. which fame opinion the , Greeks formerly had of the philofophy or* Socrates. One thing remains worth- obferving, which is, that many, and perhaps. the greateft part of thofe, who in their life-time conftant- ly profefs'd the Sintos Religion, and even fome of the Siutosjus, or Mora- lifts, recommend ; their fouls on . their death-be4 to the- care of the Budfdo clergy, defiring. that the Namanda might be fung for them, and Belieflf'ty their bodies burnt and. buried, . after .the manner of the Budfdoifts. SmoijlsahoM The adherents of the Sintos Religion do not believe the Pythagorean a f ut " re Smr Doctrine of the tranfmigratiori of Souls, altho' almoft univerfally re- ceiv'd by the eaftern nations; However, they abftain from killing and eating of thofe beafts, which are ferviceable to mankind, thinking it an act. of ,cruelty and ungratefulnefs. They believe, that the Souls, after their departure from the Bodies, tranfmigrate to a place of hap- pinefs feated jufl beneath the thirty three heavens and dwelling places of their Gods, which on this account they call Takamanofarra, which Signifies, high and fubceleftial Fields, that the Souls of thofe, who have led a good life in this, world, are admitted without delay, but that the Souls of the bad and impious are denied entrance, and condemned to err , without a time fufficient to expiate their crimes. This is all they, know of a future fhte of blifs. But befides thefe Elyfian-fields, thefe ftations of happinefs, they admit no hell, no places of torment, no Cimmerian darknefs, no unfortunate ftate attending our Souls in a .world to come. Nor do they know of any other Devil, but that which they fuppofe to animate . the . Fox, a very mifchievous animal in this Country, and fo much dreaded, that fome are of opi- nion, that the impious after their death are transform'd into Foxes, which their Priefts call Ma, that is, evil Spirits; The chief points of the Sintos Religion (and thofe, the obfervation EfTeMht whereof its adherents believe, makes them agreeable to the Gods, and Points of tht worthy to obtain from their divine mercy an immediate admifliori Sintos ReI ®' into the ftations of happinefs after their death, or what is more com- monly aim'd at, a train of temporal blefiings in this life) are, i. The inward purity of the heart. 2. A religious abftinence from whatever makes a man impure, 3. A diligent obfervation of the folemn feftival and holy days. 4. Pilgrimages to the holy places at Ifie. Of thefe, to which by fome very religious people is added, 5. Chaftizing' and mortifying their bodies, I proceed now to treat feverally. To begin therefore with the inward purity of the heart, the fame 'TV"»™H eonfifts in doing, or omitting thofe things, which they are order'd to do, $££* "^ tbt or to avoid, either by the law of nature, and the dictates of reafon, or the more immediate and fpecial command of civil magiftra'tes. The law of external purity, of which more hereafter, is the only one, the obfervation of which is more ftrictly recommended to the followers of this Religion. They have no other Laws given them, neither by Divine nor Ecclefiaftical authority, to direct and to regulate them in their H h h outward; 2i4 ThHiftoryoJ JAPAN. Book III. outward behaviour. Hence it would be but natural to think, that they fhould abandon themfelves to all manner of voluptuoufnefs and finful pleafures, and allow themfelves, without reftraint, whatever can gratify their wifhes and defires, as being free from fear of ading contrary to the will of the Gods, and little apprehenfive of the ef- fects of their anger and difpleafure. And this perhaps would be the miferable cafe of a nation in this condition, were it not for a more powerful ruler within their hearts, natural reafon, which here exerts it felf with full force, and is of itfelf capable enough to reft rain from indulging their vices, and to win over to the dominion of virtue, all thofe, that will but hearken to its di&ates. But befides, the civil ma- gistrates have taken fufficient care to fupply what is wanting on thi s head : for, by their authority, there are very fevere laws now in force againft all forts of crimes and mifdemeanors. And certainly the Ja- panefe Nation, confider'd in the main, makes it evident, that the dictates of natural reafon, and the laws cf civil magiftrates, are fure guides enough to all thofe, that will lead a good and virtuous life, and preferve their hearts in a ftate of purity. But as to the external purity, the obfervance whereof tho' lefs ma-> external°)uri- terial in it felf, hath yet been more ftticHy commanded, it confifts in &• abftaining from blood, from eating cf fiefli, and from dead bodies. Thofe, w ho have render'd themfelves impure by any of thefe things, are thereby difabled from going to the temples, from vifiting holy places, and in general from appearing in prefence cf the Gods. Who- ever is ftain'd with his own, or other blood, is Fufio for feven days, that is, impure and unfit to approach holy places. If in building a Mia, or Temple, one of the workmen fhould happen to be hurt, fo as to bleed in any part of his body, it is reckon'd a very great misfortune, and fuch a one, as makes him altogether incapable to work for the future on that facred building. If the fame accident fhould happen in building, or repairing, any of the Temples of Tetifio Dal Sin at Ifje, the misfortune doth not affecl the Work-man alone, but the Temple it felf muft be pull'd down, and rebuilt anew. No wo- man may come to the Temple, whilft fhe hath her monthly terms. It is commonly believ'd, that in their holy pilgrimages to Ifje, the monthly terms do for that time entirely ceafe, which if true, muft be owing, either to the fatigues of a long and tedious journey, or to their taking great pains to conceal it, for fear their labour and expences fhould thereby become ufelefs. Whoever eats the flefh of any four footed beafl, Deer only excepted, is Fufio for thirty days. On the contrary whoever eats a fowl, wild or tame, water fowls, pheafants and cranes excepted, is Fufio but a Japanefe hour, which is equal to two of ours. Whoever kills a beafl, or is prefent at an execution, or attends a dy- ing perfon, or comes into a houfe, where a dead body lies, is Fufio that day. But of all the things, which make us impure, none is reckon'd 1 I II I, I ■ " " ni * " "" "" "" '" '"' ' I I I Bill HI I I I Chap. III. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 215 r ■ ■ - ! !■■ - — !■■ ....... . ■- ■ — , ■ — 1 11 ■ ' 1 — ■■ m ■■ ,m ^m » i. reckoned fo very contagious, as the death of Parents and near rela- tions. The nearer you are related to the dead perfon, fo much the greater the Impurity is. All Ceremonies which are to be obferved on this occafion, the time of mourning and the like, are determined by this rule. By not obferving thefe precepts, people make themfelve9 guilty of external impurity, which is detefted by the Gods, and be- come unfit to approach their Temples. Over fcrupulous people, who would be looked upon as great Saints, drain things (till further, and fancy that even the Impurities of others will affecT them in three different ways, viz- by the Eyes, which fee impure things, by the mouth which fpeaks of them, and by the ears, which hear them. Thefe three ways to fin and impurity are reprefented by the Emblem of three Monkeys fitting at the feet of Dfijfo, and (hutting with their fore feet, one both his Eyes, the other his mouth, the third his ears. This Emblem is to be feen in moft Temples of the Budscloijls, of whom it hath been borrow'd. We found it alfo in feveral places up- on the high way. An acquaintance of mine at Nagafaki was fo ex- ceedingly nice and fcrupulous on this head, that when he received but a vifit of one, whom he had reafon to fufpecl: of being a Fufio, he caufed his houfe to be wafh'd and cleaned with water and fait from top to bottom, and yet, all this fuperftitious care notwithstanding the wifer of his Crountrymen look upon him as a downright Hypo- crite. CHAP III Of the Sintos Rcbi, that is^ their fortunate and Holidays and the Celebration thereof. TH E Celebration of folemn Feftivals and Holidays, which is the TkeCete. third effential point of the Sintos Religion, confifts in what they fc ™ f / " °/ „ .. ., , . . . , ,,. . _, , _ , J Fejitvals. call JvUjtru, that is, m going to the Alias and 1 emples of the Gods and deceafed great Men. This may be done at any time, but ought not to be neglefted on thofe days, which are particularly confe- crated to their worfhip, unlefs the faithful be in a (late of Impurity, and not duely qualify'd to appear in the prefence of the Immortal Gods, who deteft all uncleanefs. Scrupulous adorers carry things (till fur- ther, and think it unbecoming to appear in the prefence of the Gods, even when the thoughts, or memory of their misfortunes, pofTefs their mind. For, as thefe Immortal Beings dwell in an uninterrupted (late of blifs and happinefe, fuch objects, 'tis thought, would be offenfive and unpleafing to them, as the addreffes and fupplications of peo- 216 The Hiftoryof] A P A N. Book III. pie, whofe hearts, the very inmoft of which is laid open to their pe- ofthjTj,"- netrating fight, labour under deep forrow and affliction. They perform je/t tow per- their devotions at the Temples in the following manner. The wor- fliippers having firft wafh'd and clean'd themfelves, put on the verv beft cloath they have, with a Kamijijno, as they call it, or a garment of Ceremony, every one according to his ability. Thus clad they walk, with a compcs'd and grave countenance, to the Temple-court, and in. the firft place to the bafon of water, there to wafh their hands, if needful, for which purpofe a pail is hung by the fide of it, then calling down their eyes they move on, with great reverence and fub- miilion, towards the Mia itfelf, and having got up the few fteps, winch lead to the walk round the Temple, and are placed cppofite to the grated-windows of the Mia , and the looking-glafs within, they fall down upon their knees, bow their head quite to the ground, flowly and with great humility, then lift it up again, frill kneeling, and turning their eyes towards the looking-glafs, make a fhort prayer, wherein they expofe to the Gods their defires and neceilities, or fay a Takamaiio Farokami Jodo?nari, and then throw fome Putjes, or fmall pieces of money, by way of an offering to the Gods and charity to the Priefts, either through the grates upon the floor of the Mia, or into the Alms-box, which ftands clofe by : All this being done, they ftrike thrice the bell, which is hung up over the door of the Mia, 'for the diverfion of the Gods, whom they believe to be highly delighted with the found of Mufical Inftruments, and fo retire, to di- vert themfelves the remaining part of the day, with walking, exer- cifes, eating or drinking, and treating one another, in the very beft manner they can. This plain and fimple ad of devotion, which may- be repeated at any time, even when they are not clad in their beft cloaths, is on the folemn feftivals perform'd by all the Sintos Worfhip- pers, at the Temples of one, or more C&ds, whom they more pecu- liarly confide into, either for being the patrons of the profeflion they follow, or becaufe otherwife they have it in their power to affift and to forward them in their private undertakings. They have no fettled rites and church ceremonies, no beads, nor any ftated forms of prayers. Every one is at liberty to fet forth his neceiTities to the Gods, in what words, and after what manner he pleafes. Nay, there are among them, who think it needlefs to do it in any at all, upon a fuppofition, that the very inmoft of their hearts, all their thoughts, wifhes and defires, are fo fully known to the immortal Gods, as di- ftin&ly their faces are feen in the looking glafs. Nor is it in the leaft requifite, that by any particular mortification of their bodies, or other aft of devotion, they fliould prepare themfelves worthily to cele- brate their feftival days, ordinary or extraordinary, or the days of commemoration of their deceafed parents, or neareft relations. Even on thofe days, which are more particularly^ confecrated to commemo- rate Chap I1L The Hiflory of J A P A N. 217 rate the death of their Parents, and which they obferve very religi- oufly, they may eat or drink any thing they pleafe, provided it be not otherwife contrary to the cuftoms of the Country. It is obfervablc in general, that their Feftivals and Holidays are days facred rather to mutual compliments and civilities, than to ads of holinefs and devo- tion, for which reafon alfo they call them Rebi's, which implies as much as Vifiting-days. 'Tis true indeed, that they think it a duty incumbent on them on thofe days, to go to the Temple of Tenfio Daifot, the firft and principal objed of their worfhip, and the Temples of their other Gods and deceafed great men. And although they are fcrupulous enough in the obfervance of this duty, yet the beft. part of their time is fpent with viliting and complimenting their fuperiors, friends and relations. Their feafts, weddings, audiences, great entertainments, and in general all manner of publick and private Rejoicings are made on thefe days preferably to others, not only becaufe they are then more at leifure, but chiefly beeaufe they fancy, that their Gods themfelves are very much delighted, when men allow themfelves reafonable plea- fures and diverfions. All their Rebis or Holidays in general, are un- movable, and fix'd to certain days. Some are monthly, others yearly, both which I proceed now more particularly to enumerate. The Monthly Holidays are three in number. The firft is call'd Tfi- Monthly h»- tatz, and is the firft day of each month. It deferves rather to be call'd a Day of Compliments and mutual Civilities, than a Church or Nf ^M«*. Sunday. The Japanefe on this day rife early in the morning, and pafs their time going from houfe to houfe to fee their fuperiors, friends and relations, to pay their refpecls and compliments to them, and to wifh them Medito, or Joy on the happy return of the New Moon. The remainder of the day is fpent about the Temples and in other pleafant Places, where there is agreeable walking. Some divert them- felves with drinking of Soccafta, a fort of liquor peculiar to this Country* Others pafs the afternoon in company with Women. In fliort, every one follows that day, what pleafures and diverfion he likes beft. And this cuftom is grown fo univerfal, that not only the Sintoijls, but the Japanefe in general, of all ranks and religions, obferve it as a cuftom, derived down to them from their anceftors, and worthy, were it but on this fole account, that fome regard mould be paid to it. The fecond Monthly Holiday, is the fifteenth of each month, being Day of the the day of the Full-Moon. The Gods of the Country have a greater Flt " M>tn ' fhare in the vifits, the Japanefe make on this day, than their Friends and Relations. Their third Monthly holiday, is the twenty-eighth of each month, Their third being the day before the New Moon, or the laft day of the decreafing Monthly fatu Moon. Not near fo much regard is had to this, than there is to either of the two former, and the Sintes Temples are very little crowded on it. There is a greater concourfe of People on this day at the I i i Budfdos 218 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book lit Budjdos Temples, it being one of the Monthly Holidays facred to Attn'da. Yearly Fcjtf. They have five great yearly Rebi, or Sekf, that is, Feftivals or vah ' holidays, which from their number are called Gofekf, that is, the five folemn feftivals. They are purpofely laid upon thofe days, which by reafon of their Imparity are judged to be the mod unfortunate, and they have alfo borrow'd their names from thence. They are, i. Soguatz, or the new-years day. 2. Sangitatz San- iiitz, the third day of the third month. 3 . Goguatz Gonitz, the fifth day of the fifth month. 4. Sitfiguatz Fa?iuka, the feventh day of the feventh month, and 5. Kitguatz Kunitz, the ninth day of the ninth month. Thefe five great yearly feftivals are again little elfe but Fefla Po- litica, days of univerfal rejoicings. It hath been already obferv'd, that they were by their Anceftors purpofely and prudently appointed to be celebrated on thofe days, which were judgded by their imparity to be the mo ft unfortunate, and this in order to divert their Cami's or Gods by their univerfal mirth, and by their wifhing of Joy and happinefs to each other to decline, and to avoid, all un- happy accidents that might otherwife befal them : on this account alfo, and becaufe of their being days facred not fo much to the worihip of their Gods, as to joy and pleafure, they are celebrated indiffe- rently, not only by the Sintoijls, but by the generality of the Ja- panefe, whatever fed: or religion they otherwife adhere to. J*"° "" But to take them into a more particular confideration, I will begin with the Senguatz, or Vew-years-day^ which is celebrated in Japan with the utmoft folemnity, preferably to all other Holidays. The main bufinefs of the day confifts in vifiting and complimenting each other on the happy beginning of the New Year, in eating and drinking, and going to the Temples, which fome do to worfhip, but far the greater part for pleafure and diverfion. Whoever is able to ftir, gets up be- times in the morning, puts on his beft cloaths, and repairs to the houfes of his patrons, friends and relations, to whom he makes, with a a low bow, his Medito, as they call it, or compliment fuitable to the occafion, and at the fame time prefents them with a box, wherein are contained two or three fans, with a piece of the dried fiefh of the Awabi, or Auris Marina, tied to them, and his name writ upon the box, for the information of the perfon to whom the prefent is made, in cafe he ihould not be at home, or not at leifure to receive Company. The piece of the Awabi fleih in particular, is intended to remind them of the frugality, as well as the poverty of their An- ceftors, who liv'd chiefly upon the flefh of this Shell, and to make them fenfible of their prefent happinefs and plenty. In houfes of people of quality, where the number of vifiters on fuch days muft needs be very confiderable, they keep a Man on purpofe, waiting at the entry of the houfe, or in one of the lowermoft apartments, to receive both the compli- Chap 111. The Hijiorj of JAPAN 219 compliments and prefents that are made that day, and to fet down in writing the names of the perfons, who came to wait upon his ma- iler, and what prefents they brought along with them. The forenoon being thus fpent, and by repeated draughts of ftrong Liquors, which they are prefented with in feveral places, a good foundation laid for the enfuing frolick, they crown the folemnity of the day with a plen- tiful dinner, which is commonly provided by the head or chief of the family. This vifiting, and rambling about from place to place, lafts three days, but the eating and drinking, and treating one ano- ther, is not difcontinued for the whole month. The firft three or four days every thing is provided for in plenty, and every one c]ad as elegantly and handfomely as his abilities will allow. Even poor la- bouring people, on this occafion, wear a Camifijno, as they call it, or a Garment of Ceremony^ with a Scimiter flu ck in their girdle. If they have none of their own, they borrow them of other people, for fear of being excluded from honeft companies, and depriv'd of their fhare in the univerfal mirth and pleafure. Some few go to perform their devotions at the Temples, particularly that of Tenfw Dai Sin. The fecond Sekf or great yearly Feftival, is call'd Sangnatz, Samutz, y^tf. becaufe of its being celebrated on the third day of the third month. On this alfo, after the ufual compliments and vifits, which friends and relations pay one to another, and inferiors to their fuperiors, every one diverts himfelf in the beft manner he can. The feafon of the year, the beginning of the fpring, the trees, chiefly Plumb, Cherry and Apri- cock-trees, which are then in full bloffom, and loaded with numberlefs white and incarnate flowers, fingle and double, and no lefs remarka- ble for their largenefs and plenty, than for their fingular beauty, in- vite every body to take the diverfion of the Country, and to behold nature in her new and inimitable drefs. But this fame feftival is be- fides a day of pleafure and diverfion for young girls, for whofe fake a great Entertainment is commonly prepared by their Parents, where- to they invite their nearefl relations and friends. A large and fpaci- ous apartment is curioufly adorn'd with Puppets to a confiderable value, which are to reprefent the Court of the Dairt, or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor, with the Perfon of Finakuge. A Table with Japa- nefe vi&uals is plac'd before each Puppet, and among other things, cakes made of rice and the leaves of young mugwort. Thefe vi&uals, and a difh of Saki, the guefts are prefented with by the girls, for whofe diverfion the entertainment is intended, or if they be too young by their Parents. The following Story gave birth to this Bftery of cuftom. A rich man, who liv'd near Riufapava, which is as much as Bll "J'°- orthe 1 11 1 a GoJUifsof to fay, the Bird-River, had a daughter call'd Bunfjo, who was married Riches. to one Symmios Dai Miofn. Not having any children by her husband for many years, (he very earneftly addrefs'd herfelf in her prayers to the Cami's or Gods of the Country, and this with fo much fuscefs, that foon 220 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book II L foon after fhe found herfelf big, and was brought to bed of 500 eggs. The poor woman extremely furpriz'd at this extraordinary- accident, and full of fear, that the eggs, if hatch'd, would produce monftrous animals, pack'd them all up into a box, and threw them into the River Riufagawa, with this precaution however, that fhe wrote the word Fosjoroo upon the Box. Sometime after an old Fifher- man, who lived a good way down the river, found this box floating, took it up, and having found it full of eggs, he carried them home to prefent them to his wife, who was of opinion, that there could not be any thing extraordinary in them, and that certainly they had been thrown into the water for fome good reafon, and therefore fhe advi- fed him to carry them back, where he found them. But the old Man reply'd : We are both old, faid he, my dear, and juft on the brink of the grave, it will be a matter of very little confequence to us, whatever comes out of the- eggs, and therefore I have a mind to hatch them, and to fee what they will produce. Accordingly he hatch'd them in an oven, in hot fand, and between cufhions, as the way is in the Indies, and having afterwards open'd them, they found in every one a Child. To keep fuch a number of Children prov'd a very heavy bur- then for this old couple. However they made a fhift, and bred them up with mug wort-leaves minc'd, and boil'd rice. But in time they grew fo big, that the old man and his wife could not maintain them any longer, fo that they were neceflitated to fhift for themfelves, as well as they could, and took to robbing on the highway. Among; other projects, it was propos'd to them to go up the river to the houfe of a rich man, who was very famous for his great wealth in that part of the Country. As good luck would have it, this houfe proved to be that of their Mother. Upon application made at the door, one of the fervants afk'd what their names were, to whieh they an'fwer'd, that they had no names, that they were a brood of 500 eggs, that mere want and neceflity had oblig'd them to call, and that they would go about their bufinefs, if they would be fo charitable as to give them fome victuals. The fervant having brought the meffage in to his Lady, fhe fent him back to inquire, whether there had not been fomething writ upon the box, in which the eggs had been found ? and being anfwer'd, that the word Fosjoroo was found writ upon it, fhe could then no longer doubt, but that they all were her children, and accordingly acknowledg'd and receiv'd them as fuch, and made a great entertainment, whereat every one of the guefts was prefented with a difh of Sokana, cakes of mugwort and rice, and a branch of the Apri- cock-tree. This is the r«afon they give, why on this Feftivai branches of Apricock-trees are laid over the kettle, and cakes made of mugwort and rice, which they call Futfuniotzi, that is, Mug-wort-Cakef, and prepare after the following manner : The mugwort-leaves are foak'd in water over-night, then prefs'd, dry'd and reduc'd to powder, after- Chap. III. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 221 afterwards mix'd with rice, which hath been boii'd in water, then agairi reduc'd to powder and mix'd with boii'd rice and AJfuki, or red beans grofsly powder'd, and fo bak'd into cakes. The mother of thefe children was after- wards related among thegoddeffes of the country, by the name of ' Benfaiten. They believe that fhe is waited upon in the happy regions of the Gods by her five hundred fons, and they worfhip her as the goddefs of riches. The third Sekit, or yearly Feftival, is Goguatz-Gonitz,, or the fifth day The th $ of the fifth month. It is alfo call'd Tangono Seku^ and is much of the y va \ A fame nature with the laft, with this difference only, that it is intended chiefly for the diverfion of young boys, who in this, as well as in other countries, neglecT no opportunity to make a holiday, and to play about. The Inhabitants of Nvgafaki divert themfelves on the water on this and fome following days, rowing up and down in their boats, which are for this purpofe curioufly adorn'd, and crying, ac- cording to the cuftom of the Chinefe, Peirmm, Veiruun. Mugwort leaves are put upon the roofs and over the doors of their houfes. It is commonly believ'd that the Mugwort gather'd about this time of the year, and particularly on thefe holidays, makes the bell: and ftrongeft Moxa 9 when three or four years old. This Feftival owes its orisnne to the hiftory of Ve'iruun, a King of the Ifland Manrirafi- T ,.„ J 1 J . . Htjiory oj ma, of whom, and the tragical deftruction of this once rich and flourifh- p«v«»». ing Ifland, I have given a large account in my Amcenitates Exotica, Faft 3. j. 13. whereto I refer the Reader. (See the Hiftory of the Tea m the Appendix.) It begun to be celebrated at Nagafaki, by the Foktfui people, who introduc'd it at firft among the young boys, and kept it tor fome time, before elderly and grave people would conform themfelves to the cuftom. It is faid, that at the place, where the Ifland flood, fome remains of it do ftill appear in low water. The very beft earth for porcellane ware is found at the fame place, and fome- times entire veifels of a fine, thin, greenifh, old china are taken up by the Divers, which the Japanefe have a very great value for, both for their antiquity and for the good quality, which it is faid they have, . hot only to preferve Tea a long while, but even to reftore old Tea, which begins to decay, to its former ftrength and goodnefs. The fourth great yearly Feftival is call'd Sisfignatz Nanuka, becaufe Fourth yearly of its being celebrated on the feventh day of the feventh month. They F,Ji!va give it alfo the name of Siffeki Tanabatta, which implies as much, and Tanomnnofeku, which is as much as to fay, an Auxiliar Feftival. The ufual pleafures and diverfions confifting in vifiting one another, in eating and drinking, are follow'd on this day with the fame free- dom, as on other folemn days. The School-boys in particular, among various forts of plays, erett poles or pofts of Bambous, and tie verfes of their owri making to them, to fhew their application and progrefs at School. K k h T& ■2 ii the Hiftofy if J At? A K Book HI. Fifth ytat- The fifth and Ifift of the great yearly Feftivals Jf, fvmhz, or Kit- ty Fefttvai. g uat& x y no ka, fo call'd, bccaufe of its being celebrated on the ninth day of the ninth month. Drinking is the favotirite diverfton on this Feftival, tho' without prejudice to other their ufual rejoicings. No expences are fpar'd to provide victuals and good liquors in plenty every one according to his ability. The joy and mirth is univerfal. Neighbours treat one another by turns that and fome following days. Not even ftrangers and unknown perfons are fuffer'd to pafs by with- out being invited to make merry with the company. In fhort, one would imagine that the Bacchanals of the Romans had been brought over into Japan, and efhblifh'd there. At Nagafaki the folemnity is fo much the greater, as the feltival of Smva, formerly a renowned Hun- ter, and now God and Protector of hunting, luckily happens to fall upon this fame day. All forts of diverfioris and publick Ihews, dancing, plays, procefllons and the like, (which they call Mjttfufz, or an offer- ing, and Matfwn^ that is, making an offering) fo greatly divert and amufe the people, that many chufe rather to lofe their dinner, than to give over fauntering and flaring about the ftreets till late at night. othr Tefu- g ut faftfes tne f e fi ve great yearly Feftivals, there are many more Holidays obferv'd in Japan, of lefs note indeed, and facred to parti- cular Gods and Idols, in whofe honour they are celebrated, either uni- verfally and throughout the Empire, or only in fuch particular places, which in a more peculiar manner acknowledge their favour and pro- tection* It would be needlefs, and almoft endlefs, to mention them all: However, to give fome fatisfaclion to my Reader, I will confine my felf to fome of the mofl eminent. But before I proceed, I muft beg leave to obferve, that for the major part, they are not of fo great antiquity and long flanding, as the great yearly Feftivals mention'd above, but of a later date, and inftituted at different times in honour and memory of fome of their Emperors, and other great Men, who had either in their life time done fignal fervices to their Country, or by their apparitions after their death, by extraordinary miracles wrought by them, and by their powerful affiftance in private under- takings convinc'd their Countrymen, that having been tranfported into the regions of immortal Spirits, they had no fmall fhare in the go- vernment of this world, and were worthy, on this account, to have divine worfhip paid them. pefthal of Tenfio Dai Sin is the fupreme of all the Gods of the Japanefe, and acknowledg'd as Patron and Protector of the whole Empire. His an- nual Feftival falls upon the fixteenth day of the ninth month, and is celebrated in all cities and villages, throughout the Empire, among other things, with folemn Matfuri's, as they call them, or procefllons and publick fhews in honour, and often in prefence of his Idol and Priefts. It is a cuftom which obtains in all cities and villages,' to 'have tWQ Chap. III. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 2 o two fuch Mat fur? $ celebrated every year with great pomp and fo- lemnity in honour of that God, to whofe more particular care and protection they have devoted themfelves. As to Tenfio Dai Sin, befides his great yearly feftival, which is on the fixteenth day of the ninth month, the fixteenth, twenty firft and twenty fixth, days of every month are likewife facred to him, but not celebrated with any great fo- lemnity. The ninth, (common people add the nineteenth and twenty ninth) Feftival of of every month are facred to Suwa. All lovers of hunting, and fuch perfons as recommend themfelves Suwa*s more immediate protecti- on, never fail en thefe days to pay their duty and worfhip to him at his Temples. His annual feftival is celebrated with more than ordinary pomp and folemnity, on the ninth day of the fixth month. The Camtfis on this day make all thofe, that come to worfhip at Suva's Temples creep through a circle, or hoop, made of Bambous, and wound about with linnen, in memory of a certain accident, which is faid to have happen'd to the Saint in his Life time. But the greatefl of his yearly festivals is celebrated at Nagafaki on the ninth day of the ninth month. This City hath a particular veneration for Suxpa, and the Matfur?%, and other publick and private rejoycings made on this occafion, laft three days fucceflively. Ten/in hath two yearly feftivals, one on the twenty fifth day of T ^* the fecond month, the other on the twenty fifth day of the eight month, which laft is celebrated with much greater folemnity than the firft. His chief Temple is at Saif, the place of his banifhment. He hath another at Miaco, where he manifefted himfelf by many miracles. His adorers refort in pilgrimage to thefe two places from all parts of the Empire, chiefly on the twenty fifth day of the eight month. He hath alfo a private monthly holiday, every twenty fifth day of the month. The Feftival of Fatzman, a Brother of Tenfio Dai Sin, is likewife ce- Feftiwa>t of lebrated on the 25th day of the eighth month. He was in his life- time call'd Oofm^ and was the 16th Emperor of Japan. The Feftival of Mori Saki Dai Gongen, is on the nth day of the third month. Simios Dai Miofm. Sitenno. Gotfutenno, or G'vwon, hath his Feftival at Nangafaki, on the fifteenth Got r ute „ K e. day of the fixth month. His monthly holiday is the fame with Fatz- man's, but little regarded. Liari Dai Miofin, is the great C?od of the Foxes. His yearly Fefti- . val is on the eighth day of the eleventh month, and his monthly holi- day every eighth day of the month. Mfutno no Jafijro, that is, Jdfijro of the Province IJfamo, is ano- Q , - ther God, for whom they have a great refpeeL Amongft feveral glorious exploit 224 The Hi/lory of J A P A N. Book III exploits, he kill'd a mifchievous terrible Dragon. He is call'd alfo Osjuwo ni no Mikotto. Kofi™. KaJJlno Dai Miofin. She was Emprefs of Japan, and in her life-time call*d Singukoga. hmfchtn. Ben fait en. Her Feftival is on the feventh day of the eighth month. The Hiftory of this Goddefs is amply defcrib'd at the beginning of this Chapter. Kwna.no Gongen. Kattfix*. Naniwa Takakimo Mia Kokfirano Dai Miofin, was the feventeentH Emperor of Japan, and in his life time call'd Nintoku. Jfnano. Askano Dai Miofn, was the twenty feventh Emperor of Japan, and when alive call'd Kei Tei. Kiwho Seme Kimbo Senno Gogin, was in his life time call'd Ankan, and was the twenty eighth Emperor of Japan. GoJt of the The merchants wcrlhip and devote themfelves in a more peculiar manner to the four following Gods, as Gods of fortune and profpe- *ebifu. rity. i. Jebifn was Tenfo Daifins brother, but by him difgrac'd and banifh'd into an uninhabited Ifland. It is faid of him, that he could live two or three days under water. He is, as it were, the Neptune cf the Country, and the Protector of Filhermen, and Seafaring-people. They reprefent' him fitting en a rock, with an angling-rod in one hand, D«'L°'j<- cr the celebrated fifti Tai, or SteenbraJJem in the other. 2. Daikoku, is faid to have the power, that wherever he knocks with his hammer, he can fetch out from thence any thing he wants, as for inftance vice, victuals, cloth, money, &>c. He is commonly reprefented fitting on a bale of rice, with his fortunate hammer in his right hand, and Tojptoku, a bag laid by him, to put up what he knocks out. 3. Tofjitohi, and by fome call'd Kwohtfn The Japanefe worfhip him at the beginning of the new year, in order to obtain from his afliftance, fuccefs and profperity in their undertakings. He is reprefented Handing, clad in a large gown, with long fleeves, with a long beard, a huge monftrous forehead, and large ears, and a fan in his right hand. The pictures of thefe three Gods are to be feen amongft other ornaments of Tab, Tottti. VIII, or the large Map of Japan. 4. Fottei, by fome call'd Miroku t is reprefented with a great huge belly. His worfhippers expect from his benevolent afliftance, among other good things, health, riche, and children. Thefe are the greatert of their Gods, and the Feftival-days facred to them. There are many more faints and great men, whofe memory is celebrated on particular days, becaufe of their noble actions, and great fervices done to their country. But as they are confined to particular places, being call'd the Saints of fuch or fuch a place, and befides, as they were never canoniz'd by the Mikaddo, who alone can make Saints, nor honour'd with an Okurina, as they call it, or illuftri- OU5 Chap IV. ZTk flj/fory fcf JAPAN 225 ous title, which is ufually given to new Gods and Saints, I did not think it worth while to make any Enquiries about them. Thus far, what an attentive traveller can learn in the Country, concerning the Sintos Religion, and the Gods, who are the objects of its worfhip. A more extenfive and accurate account of both is con- tain'd in two Japanefe Books, one of which is call'd Nippon Odaiki, be- ing an Hiftorical and Chronological account of their Kintsju, or great men, and their memorable a&ions ^ the other Sin Dai Ki, that is, th* Hiftory and Actions of their great Gods. CHAP IV, 6/ the SANG A or pilgrimage, to ISJEi TH E Japanefe are very much addicted to Pilgrimages. They pih^gei make feveral, and to different places. The firft and chief goes of the 3«£«- to Isje, the fecond to the 33 chief Quanwon Temples of the ***' Empire, the third to fome of the moft eminent Sin, or Cami, and Foto- ge or Buck Temples, famous for the great miracles wrought there, and t he help and benefit, Pilgrims found by going to worfhip there : Such are for inftance, Nikotira, that is, the Temple of the Splendour of the Sun in the Province Osju, fome Temples of Fatzman, fome Temples of the great teacher Jakufi, and fome more, whereof every one is at li- berty to chofe, which he likes belt, or which it beft fuits his con- venience to refort to. A true Orthodox Sintoijl vifits no other Temples in Pilgrimage, but thofe of his own Gods, and the Temple Saif in Tfikufen, where Tenjtn died. It may not be amifs to obferve in general, that of the three feveral forts of Pilgrimages mention'd above, the lafl are made indifferently, by the Sintoijl s as well as the Budf- doifts, with this difference however, that every one goes only to thofe Temples, and woffhips, only thofe Gods, whom his religion com- mands him to worfhip. The fecond. which is the Pilgrimage to the 33 Qxiamvon Temples, is peculiar to neither of thefe two Religions, but made indifferently by the adherents of both, and look'd upon by the generality of the Japanefe as a fure means to obtain happinefs in this world, and blifs in that to come. But the firft of all, which is made to Isje, I propofe to take into a more particular confideration in this Chapter. Sanga, in the litteral fenfe of the word, is as much as to fay, pilgrimage tS the Jfcent, or going up the Temple, and muft be underftood only of Is i e - this moft eminent Temple of Tenfio Dai Sin, or Tenfw ko Dai Sin, that Tn ^' rtf< - is, according to the litteral fignification of thefe words, The great He- L 1 1 reditaty Jsje, 226 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book 111. reditary Imperial God of the Celejlial Generation. This Tenfio Dai Sin, is the grenteft of all the Gods of the Japanefe, and the firft and chief object of the Sintos Worfhip, on which account alfo his Temple is call'd Dai Singn, that is, the Temple of the great God, for Dai fignifics great, Sin and Ca?ni, a God, a Spirit, or Immortal Soul, and Gu in conjunction with thefe words, a Mia, that is, a Temple, or holy building erected in honour and memory of a God, or Immortal Spirit. The common people call it Isje Mia, or the Temple of Isje, from a Pro- vince of that name, wherein it ftands. A particular and extraordinary holinefs is afcrib'd to this Province, becaufe Tenfio Dai Sin was born, lived and died there, whence alfo they derive the name Isje. Tcmt'.e at ^his Temple, according to the account of thofe, that have been to fee it, is feated in a large plain, and is a forry low building of wood, cover'd with a low, flattifh, thatch'd roof. Particular care is taken to preferve it, as it was built originally, that it mould be a Handing monument of the extreme poverty and indigence of their an- cestors and founders of the Temple, or the firft men as they call them. In the middle of the Temple is nothing elfe but a looking- glafs caft of Mettal, and polifh'd, according to the fafhion of the Country, and fome cut-paper is hung round the walls j the looking- glafs is placed there, as an Emblem of the All-feeing Eye of this great God, and the knowledge he hath of what paffes in the inmoft heart of his wofhippers :, the cut white paper is to reprefent the purity of the place, and to put his adorers in mind, that they ought not to appear before him, but with a pure unfpotted heart and clean body. This principal Temple is furrounded with near an hundred fmall Chappels, built in honour of other Inferior Gods, which have little elfe of a Temple but the meer fhape, being for the greateft part fo low and fmall, that a man can fcarce ftand upright in them. Each of thefe Chapels is attended by a Canufi^ or Secular Prieft of the Sintos Religion. Next to the Temples and Chapels live multitudes of Uege, Lords or Officers of the Temple, and Taije, as they alfo ftile themfelves, that is, Evangelifs or Mejfengers of the Gods, who keep houfrs and lodgings to accommodate Travellers and Pilgrims. Not far off lies a Town, or rather a large Borough, which bears the fame name with the Temple, and is inhabited by Inn-keepers, Printers, Paper-makers, Book-binders, Cabinet-makers, Joiners and fuch other workmen, whofe bufinefs and profeflion are any ways related to the holy trade carried on at this place. Pitgriritage to Onhodox Sintoifls go in Pilgrimage to Isje once a year, or at leaft maJtjMdhffm once m their life. Nay 'tis thought a duty incumbent on every true "}'—'• Patriot, whatever feet or religion he otherwife adheres to, and a pubiick mark of refpect and gratitude, which every one ought to pay to Tenfio Dai Sin, if not, as to the God and Protector of the Nation, at leaft, as to its; founder and firft parent. But befides that they Chap IV. The Hi(lory of JAPAN. 227 they look upon it as a duty, there are many confiderable advantages, which, as they believe, accrue to thofe, that vifit in Pilgrimage thefe holy places, fuch as for inftance, abfolution and delivery frcm fin, afluran- ces of a happy ftate in the world to come, health, riches, dignities, children, and other temporal blefllngs in this life. To keep up the fuperftitious vulgar in thefe advantageous notions, every Pilgrim is prefented by the Canufis, for a fmall confideration, with an Ofaraz, as they call it, that is, a great purification, being, as it were, a publick and undoubted Inftrument of the abfolution and remilfion of their fins, infured to themfelves by this holy aft. But as many people are not able to fetch them at Isje in perfon, by reafon either of ficknefs* and old age, or becaufe of their employments, attendance upon their Prince, or for fome fuch other weighty caufe, care is taken not to let them want fo great and lingular a benefit, but to provide them at home. Many of the BudfJoifts refort in Pilgrimage to this place, at leaft once, if not oftner, in their life, were it but in order to get the reputation of a true Patriot amongft their Countrymen. But ftill there are very many who flay at home, and think it fufficient for the eafe and quiet- nefs of their confcience, befides the yearly indulgences of their own Priefts, to purchafe the Ofarrais, from Isje, great quantities whereof are fent yearly to all parts of the Empire. This Pilgrimage is made at all times of the year, but the greateft con- i< ma ^ e at a ^ courfe of people is in the three firft months {March, April and May,') when Year. the feafon of the year, and the good weather, make the journey very agreea- ble and plealant. Perfons of all ranks and qualities, rich and poor, old and young, men and women, refort thither, the Lords only of the higeft quali- ty, and the molt potent Princes of the Empire excepted, who feldom appear there in perfon. An Embaify from the Emperor is fent there once every year, in the firft month, at which time alfo another with rich prefents goes to Miaco, to the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Monarch. Moll of the Prin- ces of the Empire follow the Emperor's Example. As to the Pil- grims, who go there in Perfon, every one is at liberty to make the Journey in what manner he pleafes. Able people do it at their own expence in litters, or on horfeback, with a retinue fuitable to their quality. Poor people go a foot, living upon charity which they beg along the road. They carry their bed along with them upon their p-igrim-Jrefi back, being a Straw-mat roll'd up, and have a Pilgrim's ftaff in their hands, and a pail hung by their girdle, out of which they drink, and wherein they receive people's charity, pulling off their hats much af- ter the European manner. Their hats are very large, twilled of fplit reeds. Generally fpeaking their names , birth , and the place from whence they come, are writ upon their hats and pails, that in cafe fudden death, or any other accident, fhoul'd befall them upon the road, it might be known, who they are, and to whom they belong, Thofe that can afford it, wear a fhort white coat, without fleeves over their 228 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book HI. — i — . — —— > — — — . ^ their ufual drefs, with their names ftitch'd upon it before the breaft and on the back. Multitudes of thefe Pilgrims are feen dailr on the road. It is fcarce credible what numbers fet out, only from the Ca- pital City of Jedo, and from the large Province Osju. It is no un- common thing at Jedo for children to ran away from their parents, jn order to go in Pilgrimage to Isjt. The like attempt would be more difficult in other places, where a traveller, that is not provided with the neceflary paffports, would expofe himfelf to no fmall trouble. As to thofe that return from Isje, they have the privilege, that the Ofarraiy which they bring from thence, is allow'd every where as a good Paffport. Eftfiofbn- After the Pilgrim is fet out on his Journey to Isje, a rope with a Pilgnm!" * bit of white paper twifted round it, is hung up over the door of his houfe, as a mark for all fuch as labour under an Ima, as they call it, that is under a confiderable degree of impurity, occafion'd chiefly by the death of their parents or near relations, to avoid en- tering the fame, it having been obferv'd, that when by chance, or thro' inadvertency, fuch an impure perfon came into a Pilgrim's heufe, the Pilgrim at the fame time found himfelf very much troubled with ftrange uneafy dreams, or expos'd to fome misfortunes. The like marks of purity are alfo hung up over the walks which lead to the Miasy or Temples. Laws of pu. But it is required befides, that the Pilgrim himfelf, when he is a* rttytobe oh- b out or fafr already undertaken this holy journey, mould abftain re- ligioufly, from what will make a man impure, as amongit other things from whoring, nay, lying with his own wife, not that otherwife it be thought an aft of unholinefs, and unpleafmg to the Gods, to comply with the duties of married perfons, but becaufe they are apprehenfive that doing it at a time, when their minds mould be wholly taken up with the holy aftion, they are about to perform, would prove preju- dicial to them. The JammaboSy that is, Mountain Prieflsy (a certain religious order affe&ing a very auflere life) in order to keep up thefe ridiculous notions in the minds of the fuperflitious, never fail to report about, and to make people believe ftrange (lories of perfons in this cafe, who were fo firmly and clofely join'd one to another, that nothing but the power of their charms, and magical ceremonies could bring them afunder. Should a Fufiff, a perfon that labours under any de_ gree of impurity, prefume to undertake this holy journey, before he hath fufficiently purified himfelf, he would undoubtedly draw upon him, and his family, the Sinbatz, that is the difpleafure and vengeance of the juft and pure Gods. The Siukkie, or Priefls of the Bud/do Re- ligion, (land excluded for ever from thefe holy places, becaufe they follow an impure profeflion and are oblig'd to attend fick people, and to bury the dead. When Chap. IV. The Hifioryof JAPAN. 229 When the Pilgrim is come to Isje, the defir'd end of his journey, Pilgrim, hou> which is done daily by great numbers, and upon fome particular ['^ Zt'isiK days by feveral thoufands he repairs forthwith to one of the Canrtfi's, whom he is acquainted withai, or hath been addrefs'd to, or by whom he hath been before furnim'd with Ofarrais, and ac_ cofls him in a civil and humble manner, bowing his forehead quite down to the ground according to the country famion. The Canufi upon this, either conduces him himfelf, with other pilgrims that ap- plied to him for the fame purpofe, or commands his fervant to go along with them, to fliew them the feveral temples, and to tell them the names of the Gods, to whom they were built, which being done, he himfelf carries them before the chief temple of Tenfio Dai Sin, where with great humility they proftsate themfelves flat to the ground^ and in this abject poflure addrefs their ^applications to this powerful God, fetting forth their wants and neceflkies, and praying for hap- pinefs, riches, health, long life, and the like. After this manner it is, that they di (charge their duty towards Tenfw Dai Sin, and com- pleat the end of their Pilgrimage. They are entertained afterwards, as long as they flay at Isje, by the Canufi, who lodges them at his own houfe, if they are net able to bear the expence of a lodging at a publick Inn* The Pilgrims however, are generally fo grateful, as to make the Canufi a handfom leturn for his civility, mould it be even out of what they got by begging, and he hath complaifance enough not to refufe it. Havine performed all the acls of devotion this Pilgrimage requires, °/f ■'-'■> ^^ ,1 *t»aU Large quantities of thefe Ofarrais are fent by the Carmfis every year Yam of the mt0 a jj. p arts f tne Empire, to fupply thofe, who cannot conveniently, or are not willing to come and fetch them at Isje. Thefe Ofarrar Merchants make it their bufinefs to refort to the principal and moft populous towns towards the Sanguatz, as they call it, or Vew-years- day, this being one of their moftfolemn feftivals, and a day of great puri- fication, and certainly the time when they are moft likely to difpofe of their merchandize quickly, and to advantage. They fell at the fame time new Almanacks, which are made by the command of the MikadJo, or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor, and cannot be printed any where elfe but at Isje. One may buy an Ofarrai and an Al- manack together for a Maas, or an Itzebo. Able people will give more by way of charity. Thofe that buy them once, are fure to be called upon the next year, and to be prefented with three things, to wit, a receipt from the Canufi, or rather a compliment of* thanks to the buyer, a new Ofarrai, and a new Almanack. Such as pay handfomely, and more than is due, which common people fcldom do, receive moreover a Sakkant, or a varnifh'd wooden cup, as a fmall return for their generality. Ju ount of is- The following account of the prefent ftate and fituation of the feuks*wt4 Xemples at Isje, is taken out of Itznobe, a Japanefe Author. There Author. are two Temples at Isje, about the length of twelve ftreets diftant from each other, both indifferent low ftrucrures. The ground where- on they ftand hath not above fix mats in compafs, the place where the Canuffs fit in honour of Tenfio Dai Sin, taken in. They are both cover'd with a thatch'd roof, and both built, which is very remarka- ble, without any one of the workmen's receiving the leaft hurt in any part of his body. Behind thefe two Temples on a fmall eminence Hands the fmall, but true Temple of Tenfw Dai Sin, which is called Fongu, that is, the True Temple, and which hath been purpofely built higher than the others, in like manner as the Temple of Suva is at Nangbfala, Within this Temple, a view of which, taken from a Japanefe drawing, is reprefented in Tab. XVIII, there is nothing to be feen but a looking-glafs, and bits of white paper. The Chap. IV. 77* Hiftoryof JAPAN. 23 1 The firft of the Temples mention'd above is call'd Geku, It hath feveral Canufi's to attend it, and about fourfcore MaJJla or (mailer Temples around it, built in honour of Inferior Gods, each about four mats large, and guarded by a Canufi fitting within to receive people's charity, that being his perquifite for his attendance. The fecond Mia is call'd Naiku, and Hands about the length of twelve ftreets further off. It hath likewife great numbers of Canufi'si and forty MaJJld, of fmallef Temples round it, each with a Canufi as above. The Canufi's of thefe fmaller Temples have a very lingular title, being call'd Mia Dfufume, which fignifies Temple-Spar roves. Thofe who have a mind to fee thefe Temples, and what is re- ?" /w " , " markable in and about them, without being conducted by a Canitfi, ,-„g uhat is or his Servants, muft obferve the following Rules. They go in the "waftafc/? at firft place to the River Mijangawa, which runs by the Village Isje, oppofite to the Temples, there to warn and to clean themfelves". Thence walk- ing towards the houfes of the Canufi's, and other merchants, which are about t ne length of three cf four ftreets diftant from the banks of the river, and palling the faid houfes, they come to a broad gra- velly walk, which leads them ftreight to the Gem Mia. Here they worfhip in the firft place, and then go round to view the inferior Temples, beginning on the right hand, and fo going on till they come again to the faid Temple, from whence they proceed ftreight forward to the fe- cond, call'd Naiku, where they worfhip as before and fee the Maffia's round it. From this fecond Temple they proceed further up a neighbouring hill, fituate not far from the coafts, and having walk'd the length of about fifteen ftreets, they come to a fmall cavern, called Awano fttatta, that is, the Coaji of Heaven, which is not above twenty Ikins diftant from the Sea. 'Twas in this cavern the great Tenfio Dai Sin hid himfelf, and thereby depriving the world, fun and ftars of their light, fhew'd, that he alone is the Lord and Fountain of Light, and the fupreme of all the Gods. This Cavern is about a mat and a half large, with a fmall Temple or Chapel, wherein they keep a Cami or Idol fitting on a Cow, and call'd Dainitz, no tat, that is, the great Reprefentation of the Sun. Hard by live fome Canufi's in two houfes built upon the coafts, which are hereabouts very fteep and rocky. The Pilgrim performs his devotions alfo at this Cavern and Temple, and then prefents the Canufis with a few Putjes, defiring them withal to plant a Sugi-plant in memory of his having been there. From the top of this hill, a large Ifland is feen at a diftance, lying about a mile and a half off the coafts, which they fay arofe out of the ocean in the times of Tenfio Dai Sin. Thefe are the moft re- markable things to be feen at Isje. Curious Pilgrims before they re- turn to Isje, go a couple of Miles further to fee a ftately Budfdo- Temple, call'd Afamadaki, where they worfhip a Quanwon, call'd Kokufahofatz. CHAP 232 The Hi/lory of] A P A N. Book III CHAP. V. Of the Jammabos, or Mountain-Triefts, and other Reliai* ous Orders, iapanift in- T | J \ H E fuperftitious Japanefe are no lefs inclin'd to make reli- cim'A to Reli- eiou? Vows, than they are to vifit in pilgrimage holy places. Many among them, and thole in particular, who aim at a quick unhinder'd paflage into their Elyfian Fields, or a more eminent place in thefe ftations of happinefs, devote themfelves to enter into a v certain religious order of Hermits, call'd Jammabos in the country- language. Others, who labour under fome temporal misfortune, or am upon the point to go about fome affair of cdnfequence, frequently make vow, that in cafe of delivery from prefer danger, or good fuc- eefs in their undertakings, they will, out of refpect and gratitude to the Gods, go to worfhip at certain Temples, or keep to a rigorous abftinence on certain days, or build Temples, or make valuable^ pre- fents to the Priefts, and extenfive charities to the poor, and the like. iu'i-l! : '"f '•'' •<• Jammabos fignifies properly fpeaking, a Mountain Soldier. The cha- racter indeed, whereby this word is exprefs'd, doth not altogether an- fwer to this fignification, which depends more upon the rules of their order, and their original eftablifhment, whereby all the individual members of this fociety are oblig'd, in cafe of need, to light for the Gods and the Religion of the Country. They are a fort of Hermits who pretend to abandon the Temporal for the fake of the Spiritual' and Eternal, to exchange an eafy and commodious way of life, for an auflere and rigorous one, pleafures for mortifications, fpending molt of their time in going up and down holy mountains, and frequently warning themfelves in cold water, even in the midft of the winter. The richer among them, who are more at their eafe, live in their own houfes. The poorer go ffrolling and begging about the Country, pai> ticuiarly in the Province Syriga, in the neighbourhood of the high mountain Fuft Jamrna, to the top whereof they are by the rules cf their order oblig'd to climb every year in the fixth month. Some few have Mia's, or Temples, but generally fpeaking fo ill provided for, that they can fcarce get a livelihood by them. T/.v Order of The founder of this order was one Gienno Giofja, who liv'd about bvfoniwn- 1 {c0 y ears a g° # They can give no manner of account of his birth, Jtl parents and relations. Nor had he any iffue. He was the firft that chofe this folitary way of life for the mortification of his body. He fpent all his time erring and wandering through defart, wild, and uninha- Chap. V. The Hi/lory of J A P A N. 33 Uninhabited places, which in the end prov'd no inconsiderable fer- vice to his Country, infomuch, as thereby he difcover'd the fituation and nature of fuch places, which no body before him ventur'd to to view, or to pafs thorough, becaufe of their roughnefs and wild afpect, and by this means found out new, eafier and fhorter roads from places to places, to the great advantage of travellers. His fol- lowers, in fuccefs of time, fplit in two differing orders. One is call'd v /' : '" ' Tofanfa. Thofe who embrace this, rauft once a year climb up to r ' the top of Fikoofan, a very high mountain in the Province Bufen, upon the confines of Tfikufen, a journey of no fmall difficulty and danger, by reafon of the height and fleepnefs of this mountain, and the many precipices all round it, but much more, becaufe, as they pretend, it hath this fingular quality, that all thofe who prefume to afcend it, when Fit/id's, that is, labouring under any degree of impu- rity, are by way of punifhment for their impious rafhnefs poilefs'd with the Fox (others wou'd fay, the Devil) and turn dark mai The fecond order is call'd, Fonfanfa. Thofe who enter into this, fonfarfa'. muft vifit in pilgrimage, once a year, the grave of their Founder at the top of a high mountain in the Province Jofijijn'o, which by rea- fon of its height is call'd Omine, that is, the top of the high moun- tain. It is faid to be exceilive cold at the top of this mountain, the fleepnefs and precipices whereof make its afcent no lefs dange- rous, than that of the other mention'd above. Should any cne prefume to undertake this Journey, without having firft duly purify'd and prepar'd himfelf for it, he would run the hazard of being thrown down the horrid precipices, and dafh'd to pieces, or at leaft by a lingring ficknefs, or fome other confiderable misfortune, pay for his folly, and the contempt of the juft anger of the Gods. And yet all thefe dangers and difficulties notwithft.mding, all perfons, who enter into any of thefe two orders, muft undertake this journey once a year. In order to this they qualify themfelves by a previous mortification, by virtue whereof they muft for fome time abftain from lying with their wives, from impure food, and other things, by the ufe of which they might contract any degree of impurity, though never fo fmall, not forgetting frequently to bath and to wafh themfelves in cold water. As long as they are upon the Journey, they muft live only upon what roots and plants they find on the mountain. If they return fafe home from this hazardous Pilgrimage, they re- Rd»& andti* pair forthwith, each to the general of his order, who refides at Mid* y"^^- co, make him a fmall prefent in money, which if poor, they muft get by begging, and receive from him a more honourable title and higher dignity, which oceafions fome alteration in their drefs, and en- creafes the refped: that muft be fhewn them by their brethren of the fame order. So far is ambition from being banifh'd out of thefe re- ligious Societies. For thus they rife by degrees, much after the fame N n n manner 23+ The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book 111 manner, and in the fame order as they do in the fociety of the Blind, of which I (hall have occafion to fpeak in the latter part of this Chapter. j habit* The Religious of this order wear the common habit of Secular Perfcns, with fome additional ornaments, directed by the Statutes of the order, each of which of hath a peculiar name and meaning. They are. jMxhndor- V/akifafi, a Scimeter of Furfo, which they wear ftuck in their Gir- '"' die on the left fide. It is fomewhat fhorter than a Katanna, and kept in a flat (heath. Sakkudf.o a fmall ftaff of the Gcd Dffo y with a Copperhead, to which are fattened four Rings likewife of Copper. They rattle this ftaff in their prayers upon uttering certain wcrds. Foranokai a large fhell, which will hold about a pint of water, and is wound like a Buccimtm, or Trumpet, fmcoth, white, with beau- tiful red fpots and lines. It is found chiefly about Array in low- water. It hangs down from their Girdle, and ferves them in the nature of a Trumpet, having for this purpofe a tube faften'd to the end, through which they blow upon approach of Travellers to beg their Charity. It founds not unlike a Cowherds-horn. Dfujukake, a twifted band or fcarf, with Fringes at the end. They wear it about their neck. By the length of this Scarf, as alto by the fhape and fize of the fringes, it is known, what titles and dignities they have been raifed to by their Superiors. Foki y a Cap, or Head drefs, which they wear on their forehead. It is peculiar only to fome few among them. Oji y a bag, wherein they keep a Book, fome Money, and cloth. They carry it upon their back. Jat&nwno rvaranJzie, are their fhoes, or fandals, which are twifted of ftraw, and the ftalks of the Tarate flower, which plant is in a pe- culiar repute of Holinefs among them. They wear them chiefly in their penitential Pilgrimages to the tops of the two holy Mountains abovementioned. Iza Taka no Dfiuft, is their Rofarj, or firing of Beads, by which they fay their prayers. It is made of rough Balls. The invention and ufe of it are of a later date, than the inftitution of the order, accordingly there is no mention made of it in the fiatutes of the fame. (Thefe Beads, with fome others, fee among the ornaments of Tab. VIII. or the Map of Japan.) Kongo Dfitje y a thick ftrong ftaff, a ve- ry ufeful Internment for their Journey to the top of the Mountains aforefaid The moft eminent among them have the hair cut off fhort behind their heads. Others let it grow, and tie it together. Many (have thcmfelves clofe, as do in particular the Novices upon their en- trmg Chap V. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 235 trine the order, in imitation of the Budsdo Priefts, of whom they have borrowed this cuftom. The re Sintos Hermits are now very much degenerated from the ?£«" ft ate aufterity of their Predecefiors, who in imitation of their rounders Example, and purfuant to the rules laid down by him, lived, from their firft entring the order, upon nothing elfe but plants and roots, and expofed themfelves to perpetual and very rude trials and mor- tifications, failing, warning themfelves in cold water, erring through woods and forefts, defart and uninhabited places, and the like. In like manner, they deviated very much from the fimpliciry of the Religion, they formerly profeifed, admitting the worfhip of fuch foreign Idols, as are thought by them to have the greateft power and influence over the occurrencies of human life. They enlarged their Svftem of divinity, and encreafed the number of fuperftitious ceremonies. Among other things they betook themfelves to a fort of trade, which proves very beneficial to them, and to impofe upon the vulgar they give out,, that they are peculiarly verfed in Magi- cal arts and fciences, pretending by virtue of certain ceremonies, and myftical obfcure words and charms, to command all the Gods worfhip' d in the Country, as well of the Sintoifis as thofe of the Budsdoifis, the worfhip of whom, was brought over from beyond Sea, to conjure and drive out evil fpirits, to do many things be- yond the power of Nature, to dive into fecrets and myfteries, to recover flolen Goods, and to difcover the thieves, to fortel future events, to explain dreams, to cure defperate diftempers, to find out the guilt, or innocence, of perfons accufed of crimes and misdemea- nors, and the like. I flatter myfelf the Reader will not be difpleafed to receive feme Their farther Information about their way of proceeding in feveral of thefe *Lj£™^ ' particulars. To begin with the cure of diftempers. The patient is to give the Jammabos as good an account, as poflibly he can, of his diftemper and the condition he is in. The Jammabos after a full hearing writes fome characters on a bit of paper, which Characters, as he pretends, have a particular relation to the conftitution of the patient and the nature of his diftem- per. This done, he places the paper on an altar before hi s Idols, performing many fuperftitious ceremonies, in order, as he gives out, to communicate a healing faculty, to it after which he makes it up into pills, whereof the patient is to take one every morning, drinking a large draught of water upon it, which again muft be drawn up from the fpring or river, not without fome myftery, and towards fuch a corner of the world, the Jammabos directs. Thefe Character pills are called Goof. It muft be obferved however, that the Jamma- bos feldom adminifter, and the Patients ftill feldomer refolve to un- dergo this myfterious, cure, till they are almoft paft all hopes of re- covery 12 36 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IIL coverv. In lefs defperate cafes recourfe is had to more natural re- medies. rr ,. Their trials of the guilt or innocence of perfons accus'd of crimes ■ ■■■ I'eofie a nd mifdemeanours, are made in prefence of an Idol, call'd Ftfdo, fit- Z" '™ tnt ting amidft tire and flames, not indeed in a judicial and publick way, after the manner of the Brahmines, Siamites, and other Heathens, nor bv giving the queftion, as is often done in Europe, chiefly in cafes of witchcraft, but privately in the houfe, where the fad was com- mitted, and in prefence of the domefticks, either by a fimple conju- ring and uttering certain words, or by fire, or by a draught of Khumano Goo. If the firft, a fimple conjuration, proves ineffectual, re- courfe is had to the fecond, a trial by fire, to be perfcrm'd by making the fufpeded perfons walk thrice over a coal-fire, about a fathom long, which if they can do without being burnt on the foles of their feet, they are acquitted. Some are brought to confeilion by a draugh t of Khumano Goo. Goo is a paper fill'd with characters and pictures of black birds, as Ravens and others, and fealed with the feals of the Jammabos. If is parted to the doors of houfes, to keep off evil fpirits, and ferve's for feveral other fuperftitious purpofes. It is made indif- ferently by all Jammabos, but the beft come from Khumano, whence the name. A little bit tore off of this paper, muft be fwallow'd by the accus'd Perfon, in a draught of water, and it is faid, that if he be guilty, it will work and trouble him moft cruelly till he confefleg. They talk very big of the furprizing and wonderful virtues of their charms and conjurations, whereby they pretend, to be able to manage and handle burning coals and red-hot iron, without receiving any th» Jeaft hurt, fuddenly to extinguifh fires, to make cold water boiling hot, and hot water ice-cold in an inftant, to keep People's fwords and fci- miters fo faft in the iheath, that no force is able to draw them out, to keep themfelves from being hurt by thefe or other weapons, and to perform many more fuch uncommon and furprizing things, which, jf more nicely examin'd, would be found perhaps to be little elfe than Juggler's Tricks, and effecls of natural caufes. They call it Jamaffu y which fignifies, Conjuring Strokes. Thefe mighty ftrokes are nothing elfe but certain motions of their hands and fingers, whereby they pretend to reprefent Crocodiles, Tygers, and other monftrous animals, at the fame time uttering certain obfcure founds. By this, and by frequently altering thefe pofitions and reprefentations, as alfo by lifting up and letting fall their voice, they endeavour, they fay, as with fo many crofs-ftrokes to come within reach of the object to be charmed, till at laft having remov'd and cut through all obftacles and hindrances they obtain their defired end. their gnattji One of their chief and moft myfterious Sin, as they fbmetimes call charm. them, or charms, is, when holding up both hands, and twirling the fingers, as it were, one within another, they reprefent thie*<# TenfiO y that Chap. V. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 237 that is the four moft powerful Gods of the thirty third and laft Heaven. The pofition, which they put their Fingers in, is thus. They hold up the two middle fingers one againfl another almoft perpendi- cular, and make the two next fingers, on each fide, crofs one ano- ther in fuch a manner, that they point towards four different corners of the world, in reprefentation ofthefe four Gods, whom they call Tammonden, Tfigokten, Sofioten, and Kamokten. The two middle fingers, held up as I obferv'd, almoft perpendicularly, ferve them, as they pretend, in the nature of a Spy-glafs, whereby to fpy out the Spirits and diftempers, to fee the Kitz, or Fox, and the Ma, or evil Spirit, lodged in peoples bodies, and to find out precifely, what fort they be of, in order afterwards to fquare their charms and ceremonious fuperftitions to the more efte&ual driving of them out. But this fame pofition of the middle fingers with regard to the reft is to reprefent befides Fudo mio wo, that is, the holy great Fudo, formerly a Gio- fia, a mighty devotee of their order, who, among other extraordinary mortifications, fat down daily in the midft of a large Fire, though without receiving any hurt, and by whofe powerful afliftance they believe, on this account, to be able not only to deftroy the burn- ing quality of fire, when they pleafe, but alfo to make it ferve at command to what purpofes they think fit. A lamp fill'd with an Oyl made of a certain black venomous water lizard, calPd Bnari, is kept continually burning before the Idol of Fudo. The Jammabos make a mighty fecret of thefe charms and my- j/^jf' * flerious arts. However, for a handfome reward they will communicate and teach them to other people, though under condition of fecrecy. The account, I have given in this Chapter, of this lingular order, I had chiefly from a young Japanefe well verfed in the affairs of his Country, whom during my ftay in Japan I taught Phyfick and Sur- gery, and who had been one of their Scholars himfelf. He further told me, that before they would let him into the fecret, they made him undergo a very rude Noviciate. And in the firft place he was to abftain from every thing, that had had life in it, and to fubfift on- ly upon rice and herbs for fix days together. In the next place they commanded him to wafh himfelf feven times a day in cold water, and kneeling down on the ground, with his buttocks to his heels and clapping his hands over his head, to lift himfelf up fe- ven-hundred and fourfcore times every day. This laft part of his Tri- al he found alfo the rudeft, for by getting up and down two or three hundred times, he brought himfelf all into a fweat, and grew fo tired and weary, that he was often upon the point to run away from his Mafters, but being a young lufty fellow, fhame rather than curiofity prevailed upon him to hold it out to the kft. O 9 Thus 238 The Hiftorf of J A P A N. Book III. ac- Thus much of the Jammabos. There are frill many more reli gious orders and focieties eftablifh'd in this country, a particular count of which would fwell this Chapter to an unbecoming length. The fuperftitious veneration of the vulgar for their Eccleftafticks the eafe and pleafurej of a religious life, great as they are, 'tis no won- der, that the number of coftly temples, rich monafteries and con- vents, where under the cloak of retirement, and divine worfhip, the Monks give themfelves up to an uninterrupted purfuit of wanton- nefs and luxury, is grown to an excefs fcarce credible. But there are alfo fome particular focieties, not purely Ecclefiaftical, nor confin'd to the Cler- gy alone, but rather of a mix'd nature, with an allay of fecularity. SoeutUs.jf Q ut f man y that of the blind is not unworthy of confideration a bitna i riopie* J > fingular, but very ancient and numerous body, compos'd of Perfons of all ranks and profeflions. Originally they made up but one fociety but in procefs of time they fplit into two feparate bodies, one of which is called, FeeMfado, or the Blind Feekis, the other Bnjfetz Sato, or the luffaf the Blind Eufetz. It will not be amifs to enquire into the origin and conftitutions of both. The Buffet z Sato muft be confider'd firft, as being of a more antient {landing. At prefent this fociety is com- By wham po s ' d onl 7 of Ecclefiaftical perfons, whofe rules and cuftoms are not founded, ver y different from thofe of the Jammabos. Their Founder was Sen- ?nimar i the Emperor Jengino Mikaddo his third (and according to fome authors his fourthj Son, and the occafion of their infiitutiOn is re- corded in Japanefe Hiflories to have been as follows. Senmimar was a youth of incomparable beauty, and exceedingly belov'd by all that came near him. It happen'd that a Princefs of the Imperial Blood fell defperately in love with him : Her beauty and virtues prov'd charms as unrefiftable to the young Prince, as his graceful Perfon and princely qualities had been to her. For fome time the happy lovers enjoy'd all the fatisfa&ion and mutual returns of paf- fion and friendfhip, when the death of the Princefs intervening Sen- mimar took it fo much to heart, that not long after thro' grief and forrow he loft his fight. Upon this, to perpetuate the memory of his dearly beloved, and to make known to porter ity, what an unfor- tunate effecl: his unfeign'd concern and forrow for her lofs had had upon himfelf, he refolv'd, with his father's leave, and under his Im- perial Charter, to ereel a fociety, wliereinto none fhould be admit- ted, but fuch as had the misfortune to be blind by birth or acci- dent. His defign was put in execution accordingly. The new erefted fociety profper'd exceedingly, and flourifh'd, and got into great repute at Court, and in the Empire. For fome Centuries they continu'd Society of tie united in one body, till a new fociety of the Feki Blind, as they are ick} Mud. now caipd, fprung up, which in a fhort time got fo far the better of the former, many great men in the Empire, who were blind, volunta- rily entering into it, that by degrees they loft: "much of their reputa- tion Chap. V. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 239 tion, and were reduc'd very low in number, none being left at ]aft but ecclefiaftical Perfons, to whom it remains now confin'd* Ever fince their firft inftitution, the Feki Blind continu'd in an uninterrupted poffeffion of all the efteem and authority, the Bujfetz had once enjoy'd. Nay, being ftill more numerous, they are ulfo much more confider'd in proportion. They owe their origin occafionof to the civil wars between the Feki's and Gendzi's, both con- :h / ir I "/ i ' t "' , tion. tending for the Empire. Whole Volumes have been wrote of the long and bloody diffentions between thefe two once confidera- ble and powerful parties, and the manifold calamities which thence be- fel the Empire. The caufe of Feki and his adherents, appearing more jufl: to the then reigning Dairi, than that of Gendzi, he thought himfelf bound in confcience to fupport it, which he did fo effectually, that Gendzi, and his party were defeated and almoft totally deftroy'd. The victorious Feki, as fuccefs is often follow'd by pride and ambi- tion, foon forgot the obligations he lay under to the Dairi, and be_ hav'd himfelf with fo much infolence and ungratefulnefs towards him, that he refolv'd to efpoufe the intereft, tho' almoft totally funk, of Gendzi and his adherents, promifing all manner of encouragement and afliftance, if they would once more gather all their ftrength together, and take up arms againft Feki and his Party. Affairs upon this foon took another turn, vi&ory in a decifive battle favour'd the Gendzi 's j Feki himfelf was flain near Simonojeki, and his whole army defeated, but few efcaping. Amongft thofe who efcap'd with their lives, was Kakekigo, a General very much renowned for his valour and fuperna- ^IhiJ'othtr tural ftrength, which 'twas believ'd he obtain'd from Qiianwon, as a Founder. reward for his conflant devotion to that God. This General fled in a fmall boat. Joritomo, General of the Gendzi s, and himfelf a very refolute Soldier, knew of what confequence it was to fecure the perfon of Kakekigo, and till then thinking his victory incomplete, he caus'd him to be purfued and taken. However, when he was brought before him, he treated him kindly, and with all the refpeft due to a Perfon of his rank and character, withall confining him fo little, that Kakekigo found means feveral times to make his efcape, but was as often retaken. The generous Jorito?no had no thoughts of putting him to death, tho' his Enemy and his Prifoner. Nay, far from it, he put fuch a valu e upon the friendfhip and affection of a Perfon of his note, as to think it worth his while to purchafe it at any price. One day when he was preffing him very elofe to enter into his fervice, upon whatever terms he pleas'd, the captive General return'd him the. following refolute anfwer. / was once, faid he, a faithful Servant to a kind mafler. Now he is dead, no other jhall boafl of my faith and friendfiip. I own, that you have laid me wide* great obligations. I owe even my life to your Cle- mency. And yet fuch is my mis fortune , that I cannot fet ?ny Eves on you f i>ut ivith a defign, in revenue of him and me, to cut off your head. Thefe 240 The Hi/lory of] AP A N. Beck HI Tbqfe therefore, thefe defigning Injlmments of mischief I will offer t n you, as the only acknowledgment for your generous behaviour tmvards me, my unhappy condition will allow me to give yo?h This faid, he plucks out both his Eyes, and on a plate, prefents them to Joritoma, undaunted like that bold Roman, who in fight cf Porfenria burnt his right hand on the altar Joritomo aflonifh'd at fo much magnanimi- ty and refolution, forthwith fet the captive General at liberty, who thereupon retired into the Province Fiuga, where he learnt to play upon the Bywa, a particular mufical Inftrument ufed in Japan, and « r n cave birth to this Society of the Feki Mind, of which he himfelf was rrijrftt jta.tr o J 4 this Society, the firft Kengio, or Head. This is the account, Japanefe Hiftorie s give of the original inftitution of this Society, which is fince grown very numerous, being compofed of perfons of all ranks and profefll- ons. They fhave their heads, as do alfo the Buffetz fato, or Eccle- fiaftical blind. Otherwife, being fecular perfons, they wear alfo a fecular habit, different however from the common drefs of the Ja- panefe, and different among themfelves according to their rank and dignities. They do not live upon Charity, but make a fhift, in their feveral capacities, to get a livelyhood for themfelves, and to provide for the maintenance of their commonwealth, following divers pro- feflions not altogether inconfiflent with their unhappy condition. Many of them apply themfelves to Mufic, in which capacity they are employ'd at the Courts of Princes and great men, as alfo upon publiek fo- lemnities, feftivals, proceffions, weddings, and the like. Whoever is once admitted a member of this Society, muft remain fuch for life. They are difperfed up and down the Empire, but their General refides at Miaco, where the Cafh of the Company is kept. He is call'd Ofwkf, and hath 4300 Thails a year allow'd him for his maintenance by the Dairi. He governs the common-wealth, being aflifted by ten Courr- fellors call'd Siu Ro, which fignifies Elder men, Alder-men, of which he, the General himfelf is the eldeft. They refide at Miaco, and have, jointly with the General, power of life and death, with this reftriction however, that no perfon can be executed, unlefs the Sen- tence be approv'd of, and the dead- war rant fign'd by the Lord Chief |u- ftice of Miaco. The Council often appoint their inferior officers, who refide in the feveral Provinces : Some of thefe are call'd Kengio, as it were, Father Provincials, being each in hisProvince, what the General is with regard to the whole Society. The founder himfelf took only the title of Ken Gio. But the fociety being in procefs of time grown very numerous, 'twas thought neceflary to alter the government, and to appoint a Court fuperior to the Kengios. Every Kengio hath his Kotos, as they are call'd, to aflift and advife him. The Kotos fometimes govern particular di- ftricts by themfelves. At Nagafaki there is a Kengio and two Koto's, under whofe command fland all the Blind cf that Town, and adja- cent Country. The Kengio\ and Koto's, have many other inferior of- fireT9 Chap. VI. The Hiftory of J A P ; A N. 241 ficers fubordinate to them, who are call'd Sijbun, and are again fu- bordinate to one another. They differ from the common body off the blind, by wearing long breeches. As they have different ranks and titles among themfelves, fo they are oblig'd every five years to pur- chafe a new Quan^ that is, a new and higher title from their Ken- g'w, for 20 to 50 Thails. If they neglect, or are not able to do it, they are remov'd to a lower rank. The main body of the Blind are comprehended under one general name of Mukwan. Thefe wear no breeches, and are divided into four Quans^ ranks, or claffes. Thofe of the fourth and laft clafs are capable of being made Si'jbuns, from which office they gradually rife to the dignity of Koto, Kengio, and fo on. Sometimes, thro' money or favour they rife very fuddenly. CHAP. VI. Of the B U D S D O, or Foreign Tagan iVor/hip, and its Founder. FOREIGN Idols, for diftin&ion's fake from the Kami, or Sin, Foreign pagan which were worfhipp'd in the country in the moft ancient times, ^wM- are call'd Budfd and Fotoke. The Characters alfo, whereby thefe two words are exprefs'd, differ from thofe of Sin and Cami. Budfdo, in the litteral fenfe fignifies the way of Foreign Idols,, that is, the way of worfljipping Foreign Idols. The origine of this religion, which its Origins quickly fpread thro' mofl Afiatick Countries to the very extremities- of the Eaft, (not unlike the Indian Fig-tree, which propogates itfelf, and fpreads far round, by fending down new roots from the extremities of its branches,) muft be look'd for among the Brahmines. I have ftrong reafons to believe, both from the affinity of the name, and the Bu ^ a itl very nature of this religion, that its author and founder is the very Fomder. fame perfon, whom the Brahmines call Budba, and believe to be an effential part of Wifthnu, or their Deity, who made its ninth ap- pearance in the world under this name, and in the fhape of this Man. The Chinefe and Japanefe call him Buds and Siaka. Thefe two names indeed became in fuccefs of time a common Epithet of all Gods and Idols in general, the worfhip of whom was brought over from other Countries : fometimes alfo they were given to the Saints and great men, who preach'd thefe new do&rines. The common peo- ple in Siam, call him Prab Pudi Dfau, that is, the Holy Lord, and the learned among them, in their Pali or holy language, Sammona Khodum. The Peguans call him Sammana Khutama. (See Book I. Ch. II.) P p p His 242 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book 111, His Native His native country, according to the Japanefe (with regard to whom Q " t>,try - he is chiefly confider'd in this place) is Magattahkf, or the Province Macratta- in the Country Tenfik. Ten/ik, in the litteral fenfe, fignifies a Heavenly Country, a Country of Heavens. The Japanefe comprehend under this name the Ifland of Ceylan, the Coafts of Malabar and Cor- ■mamlel, and in general all the Countries of South Afia, the continent as well as the neighbouring Iflands, which arc inhabited by Blacks, fueh as the Peninfula of Malacca, the Iflands of Sumatra, Java, the Kingdoms of " Siam, Pegu, &c. His Bhth He was born in in the twenty-fixth year of the reign of the ChL nefe Emperor Soowo, who was fourth Succeflbr of the famous Snno Buo, on the eighth day of the fourth month. This was according * to fome the year before our Saviour's Nativity 1029, and according to .others 1027, ( when I was in Siam, in 1690, ) the Siamites then told 2232 years from their Budha, who, if he be the fame with the Siaka of the Japanefe, his birth comes up no higher than 542 years before Chrift. His father was King of Magattakokf, a power- ful Kingdom in the Country Tenjikf. I conjedure this to be the Ifland of Ceylon. The Kingdom of Slam indeed is fo call'd to this day by the common People in Japan. His Life. Siaka, when he came to be nineteen years of age, quitted his Pa- lace, leaving his wife and an only fon behind him, and voluntarily, of his own choice, became a difciple of Arara Sennin, then a Hermit of great repute, who liv'd at the top of a mountain call'd DanJokf. Under the infpe&ion of this holy man he betook himfelf to a very auftere life, wholly taken up with an almoft uninterrupted contemplation of heavenly and divine things, in a pofture very Angular in itfelf, but reckon'd very proper for this fublime way of thinking, to wit, fitting crofs-legg'd, with his hands in the bofom placed fo, that the extremities of both thumbs touch'd one another : A pofture, which is thought to engage one's mind into fo profound a meditation, and to wrap it up fo entirely within itfelf, that the body lies for a while as it were fenfelefs, unattentive, and unmoved by any external obje&s whatfoever. This profound Enthufiafm is by them call'd Safen, and the divine truths revealed to fuch perfons Satori. As to Siaka himfelf, the force of his Enthufiafm was fo great, that by its means he penetrated into the mod fecret and important points of religion, difcovering the exiftence and Hate of Heaven and Hell, as places of reward and punifhment, the ftate of our Souls in a life to come, the tranfmigration thereof, the way to eternal happinefs, the divine Power of the Gods in the government of this world, and many more things beyond the reach of humane underftanding, which he after- wards freely communicated to the numerous crowds of his difciples, who for the fake of his doctrine and inftruclions follow'd him in flocks, Chap. VI. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 243 flocks, embracing the fame auftere way of life, which he led him- felf. He liv'd feventy-nine years, and died on the fifteenth day of the fe- *& Vtatlr. cond month, in the year before Chrift 950. The moft eflential points of his doctrine are as follows. jf, s D»Sn'»» The fouls of men and animals are immortal: Both are of the fame fubftance, and differ only according to the different objects they are placed in, whether human or animal. The fouls of men after their departure from their bodies, are re- warded in a place of happinefs, or mifery, according to their be- haviour in this life. The place of happinefs is call'd Gokurakf, that is, a place of eternal Place of Hr/- pleafures. As the Gods differ in their nature, and the Souls of men in the ?" 2e ' s ' merit of their paft actions, fo do likewife the degrees of pleafure and happinefs in their Elyfian Fields, that every one may be re- warded as he deferves. However the whole place is fo throughly til I'd with blifs and pleafure, that each happy inhabitant thinks his portion the belt, and far from envying the happier ftate of others, wilhes only for ever to enjoy his own. Amida is the fovereign Commander of thefe heavenly Stations, (for ji m \i u all his doctrine hath not been introdue'd by the Brabmines, .till after our Saviour's glorious refurredtion.) He is look'd upon as the gene- ral Patron and Protector of human Souls, but more particularly as the God and Father of thofe, who happily tranfmigrate into thefe places of blifs. Through his, and his fole mediation, Men are to obtain abfolution from their fins, and a portion of happinefs in the future Life. Leading a virtuous Life, and doing nothing that is contrary to the Commandments of the Law of Siaka, is the only way to become a- greeable unto Amida, and worthy of eternal happinefs. The five Commandments of the Doctrine of Siaka, which are the ^' ve , Cm1 ' j manamenti oj flanding rule of the life and behaviour of all his faithful adherents, siaka. are call'd Gokai, which implies as much, as the Jive Cautions^ or Warn, zngs. They are, $e Seo, the Law not to kill any thing that hath Life in it. Tfu To, the Law not to Heal. Sijain, the Law not to whore. Mago, the Law not to lie. Onfht, the Law not to drink ftrong Liquors j a Law which Siaka moft earneftly recommended to his Difciples, to be by them ftrictly ob- ferv'd. Next to thefe five chief and general Commandments, which con- Their t>ktfo>: tain in fubftance the whole Law of Siaka, follow ten Sikkai, as they *" J . SH tf v !~ call them, that is Counfels, or Admonitions, being nothing elfe but the five firft Laws branch'd out, and applied to more particular actions, and 244 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book III. and tending to a ftricter obfervance of Virtue. For the fake of the learned, and fuch as aim at a more than ordinary ftate of Virtue and Perfection even in this World, a ftill further fubdivifion hath been contriv'd into Go Fiakkai, that is, five hundred Counsels and Admoni- tions wherein are fpecined, and determin'd with the utmoft exadnefs and particularity, whatever actions have, according to their notions, the leaft tendency to virtue and vice, and ought on this account to be done or omitted. jftJGo 'phg num ber of thefe Gofiakkai being fo very extenfive, 'tis no won- der that thofe, who will oblige themfelves to a ftri& obfervance there- of, are as few in proportion, the rather fince they tend to fuch a thorough mortification of their bodies, as to meafure and prefcribe the very minuted parts of their diet, allowing fcarce fo much as is necef- fary to keep them from ftarving. Nothing but the ambition of acqui- ring a great repute of Perfection and Sanctity in this World, and the delire of being rais'd to a more eminent ftaticn of happinefs in the next, can prompt any body to undergo fuch a rude and fevere dff- cipline, as is prefcribed by the Go Fiakkai, and few there are, even among the bell part of their Clergy, who, for the fake of a greater portion of happinefs in a future World, would willingly renounce the very leaft pleafures of this. Place of j^[ Perfons, Secular or Ecclefiaftic.il, who by their flnful Life and Torment. ' iiiri 1 r i ■> vitious Actions have rendered themlelves unworthy of the pleafures prepar'd for the virtuous, are fent after their death to a place of mi- fery, call'd Dfigokf] there to be confined and tormented, not indeed for ever, but only during a certain undetermined time. As the pleafures of the Elyfian Fields differ in degrees, fo do Iikewife the torments in thefe infernal places. Juftice requires that every one ihould be punilhed, according to the nature and number of his crimes, the number of years he lived in the world, the ftation he lived in, and the opportunities he had to be virtuous, and good. Jem- ma y or with a more majeftuous Character Je?nma 0, (by which fame name he is known alfo to the Brahmines, Siamites, and Chinefe,) is the fevere Judge and fove reign commander of this place of dark- nefs and mifery. All the vitious actions of mankind appear to him in all their horror and heinoufnefs, by the means of a large looking- glafs, placed before him and called, Ssofarino Kagami or the looking- glafs of knowledge. The miferies of the poor unhappy Souls confined to thefe prifons of darknefs are not fo confiderable and lafting, but that great relief may be expected from the virtuous life and good actions of their family, Friends and relations, whom they left behind. But nothing is fo conducive to this defirable end, as the prayers and offerings of the Priefts to the great and good Amiaa, who by his powerful intercefhon can prevail fo far upon the almoft inexorable Judge of this infernal place, as to oblige him to remit from the feverity of his Sen- tence, Chap. VI. The Hijioryof JAPAN. 245 ~- 11 ... _. . 1 . - .— . . ■ " -^ tence, to treat the unhappy imprifon'd Souls with kindnefs, at leaft fo far, as it is not inconfiflent with his Juftice and the punish- ment their crimes deferve, and laft of all, to fend them abroad into the world again affoon as poffible. When the miferable Souls have been confined in thefe prifons of dark- R " itr »tf* bt , . . . _, . z Soul 1 ; of the nefs a time fufhcient to expiate their Crimes, they are, by virtue of m pom mi the Sentence of Jemma 0, fent back into the world, to animate, tht v/ertl not indeed the bodies of men, but of fuch vile creatures, whofe na- ture and properties are nearly related to their former finful Inclina- tions, fuch as for inftance, Serpents, Toads, Infects, Birds, Fifties, Quadrupeds and the like. From the vileft of thefe, tranfmig rating by degrees into others and nobler, they at laft are fuffered again to enter human Bodies, by which means it is put in their power, either by a good and virtuous life to render themfelves worthy of a future uninterrupted ftate of happinefs, or by a new courfe of vices to expofe themfelves once more to undergo all the miferies of confine- ment in a place of torment, fucceeded by a new unhappy tranfmigra- tion. Thus far the moft effential points of the doctrine of Siaka. Among the difeipies of Siaka a rofe feveral eminent men, who contri- SuAjtstf* buted greatly to the propagation of his doctrine, and were fucceeded "^ es ° by others equally learned and zealous, infomuch, that we need not wonder, that his religion within a very fhoft compafs of time fpread to the very extremities of the Eaft, even all the difficulties, they had to ftruggle with, notwithftanding. The moft eminent of his difeipies were Annan and Kafia, or with their full titles Annan Sonsja, and Kafia Sonsja. They collected his wife KrtJ : rt# fentences, and what was found after his death, written with his own hands on the leaves of trees, into a book, which for its peculiar ex- cellency is call'd Fokekio, that is, the Book of fine Flowers (in compa- rifon with the holy Tarate-Flowev') and fometimes alfo by way of pre-eminence Kio, the Book, as being the moft perfect performance in its kind, and the Bible of all Eaftern Nations beyond the Ganger, who embraced Siaka's doctrine. The two compilers of it, for their care and pains, were related among the Saints, and are now worfhipp'd jointly with Siaka, in whofe Temples, and upon whofe altars' they are placed, one to his right, the other to his left hand. Before the doctrine of Siaka was brought over into China, and from of 4 v v ~ thence through Cornea into Japan, the old Sintos or Cami Wotfhip, mean on j t y e gJ£ and fimple as it was, was yet the only one flourifhing in this Em- h» e f e ani pire. They had but few Temples and few Holidays, and the yearly c,J '" e f e ' Pilgrimage to the Temple of Tenfw Dai Sin at Isje, was thought the beft and fureft way to happinefs. 'Tis true, in fuccefs of time, the number of Gods and Saints encreafed, their Syftem of Divinity was cmbellifh'd with new fables, arts alfo and fciences were improv'd, CLq q chiefly 246 The Hiftory ©/JAPAN. Book III; chiefly fince the time of Synmu Ten their firft Monarch. But ftill a certain fimplicity prevail'd, and people following the dictates of reafon, aim'd at nothing fo much as to live morally well. The Chi- nefe alfo, before that time follow'd the illuftrious examples and moral precepts, of their two great Emperors Tee Gio, that is the Emperor Gio, who according to their Chronological Computation liv'd 2359 years before Chrift, and his fucceflor Tee Siun, or the Emperor Siun, who though a Peafant, was yet for his prudence and honefty made by Gio, firft his co-partner in the government, and afterwards his fucceflor, tho' in prejudice to his, GzVs, twelve children, v'1%. ten fons and two daughters. Thefe two illuftrious Princes were the two firft Sefins. Sefin is a Philofopher, able to find out truth and wifdom, meerly by the force of his own underftanding, and without being taught by others. By miftake, this fame name hath been fometimes given to fome of their moft eminent Divines. Some hundred vears f) a..- f ° J Rocs'." ar " tcr ^ e rei § n or " ^ e ^ c P rmces , the Pagan Dodlrine of Roos arofe in China. This man was born in Sokokf, that is, the Province So, on the fourth day of the ninth month, 346 years after the death of Siaka, or 604, before our Saviour's Nativity. They fay, that his mother had been big with child 81 years, for which reafon, when fhe was brought to bed, they call'd him Roos, which implies as much as OU Son, or Old Child. They further add, that the Soul of Kaffobofatz or the holy KajJ'o, the eldeft difciple of Siaka, by tranfmigration dwelt in him, which made it eafy to him to attain to fuch a high pitch of knowledge about the nature of Gods and Spirits, the Immortality of our Souls, a future State, and fuch other important Points, as are highly conducive to the inftrudion of fuch, as are defirous of learn- ing, and fill the credulous vulgar with admiration. He liv'd eighty- four years. ■DoBrineof ]y[ ean w hile the Do&rine and Philofophy of Roos got ground in China, another incomparable Sefin appear'd upon the Philofophical Stage of that Empire. This was Koofi, or as we Europeans call him Con- futius, born in the Province Kok, on the fourth day of the eleventh His Bbth. month, 399 years after the death of Siaka, and 53 after the birth of Roofi, who was then as yet alive. His birth was in a manner mi- raculous, attended with no obfcure figns of a future Sefin. He had fome natural marks on his head, like thofe of the Emperor Gio, and his forehead was of the fame fhape with that of the Emperor Siun. At the time of his birth a Mufic was heard in Heaven, and two Dra- gons were obferv'd to attend, when the Child was wafh'd. His Sta- ture, when grown up, was very noble and majeftuous, of nine Saku, and nine Suns, proportionable to the greatnefs of his Genius. Pafling over in filence, what is fabulous and romantick, in the Hiftory of his His Liff. Life, it cannot be denied but that he had an incomparable underftan- ding and excellent Senfe, and was perhaps the greateft Philofopher the Chap. VI. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 247 the Eaft ever procrac'd. His Writings and Philofophy maintain'*! a -• pfc . / ... conftant uninterrupted reputation for now upwards of two hundred fifty, years, and are thought in China to have been brought down front Heaven, as was formerly the Philofophy of Socrates in Greece. A pro- found refpect is fhewn to his memory both in China and Japan, by publick as well as private Perfons. Very lately the Emperor of Japan caus'd two Temples to be built to him in his Capital Jedo, whither he repaired in Pcrfon, as foon as they were finifh'd, and on this occa- fion fet forth, in a handfome Speech to his Courtiers, the merits of this great Man, and the peculiar excellency of the maxims of Govern- ment laid down by him. His Pidlure is allow'd the moft honoura- ble Place in the Houfes of Philosophers, and all Perfons who apply themfelves to ftudies and learning, never mention his name with- out particular 7 tokens of refpeft. It is no wonder then, that the chime- rical, and in feveral particulars incomprehenfible doctrine of Roof was not able to ftand its ground againft the reafonable and pleaftng moral of Confutius, but was, as it were, fmothcr'd in its Infancy, and in- fenfibly decreafed, in proportion as the adherents of Confutius increas'd, of whom there was a concourfe from all parts of the Empire almoft beyond imagination. He died in the feventy third year of his age, leaving behind him many able Men, who propagated his Doclxine and Philofophy, not only by their teaching it to others, but gather'd all his wife Sentences and moral Maxims, which he communicated to them in his Life -time, into a Book, which is call'd Siudo, that is, the Phitofophical way of Life, or the way of Life agreeable to Philo- fophy, which ever fince, for now upwards of two thoufand years, hath been look'd upon as a performance incomparable in its kind, and an excellent Pattern of a good and virtuous Life j a Book extoll'd not only by the admirers of Confutius, but admir'd for its Morals and political Maxims, even by the adherents of the Budfdo and other Re- ligions, in the very fame manner, as the Writings of the ancient Greek and Roman Philofophers, which have efcap'd the common fhipwreck of time, defervedly ftand the admiration of all Europe, and a laftirig Monument of the excellent Genius of their great Authors. Whilft thus the Doftrine and pleating Philofophy of Confutius be- J^£^ gan to flourilh in Chind, and to fpread to the neighbouring Empire intnht' J i*- of Japan, the Doftrine and Religion of Siaka, which had then already f0 ^' !N ' penetrated to the Kingdoms of Si am and Laos, was not like to meet with a favourable reception in this furthermore part of the Eaft. If we believe the Japanefe Hiftorians, the firft, that taught this Religion in China, came over thither about the year of Chrift fixty three, and obtain'd leave to build a Temple, which is ftill call'd Fakubafi, that is, the Temple of the white Horfe, becaufe the Kio, or holy Book of Siaka, was brought over on a white Horfe. The greateft difficulty, the Preachers of this new Doclrine had to ftruggle withal, was the Philofophy 248 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book III Phlofcphy of Confutius, then fhining in its full luftre, and univerfally approvM. And indeed it appears that for feveral hundred years the Religion of Sjaka made a very flow and insignificant Progrefs, till a- bout the year of Chrift 5 r8, one Darma, a great Saint, and thirty third Succeffor on the holy See of Siaka, came over into China from feitenfiku, as the Japanefe Writers explain it, (that is from that part of the World which lies Weftward with regard to Japan} and laid pro- perly fpeaking the firft fure Foundations of the BuJfJoifm in that mighty Empire. The fame of his Dignity and Holinefs, the aufterity of his Life, his ardent uninterrupted Devotion, which was fo ftrong, that he did not fcruple in the height of his zeal, to cut off his own Eyelids, becaufe they had once drawn him out of his Enthufiaftic me- ditations into a fleep, foon brought a crowd of admirers about him. But the moft effectual and moft perfuafive arguments, he made ufe of to induce people to the worfhip of the Gods, were the doctrine of the Immortality of our Souls, and the promifes of a reward in a fu- ture Life, which they fliould not fail to obtain, if they would but worfhip them, as his Do&rine, Religion and Example fhould direct. This new Worfhip having once got ground in China, foon fpread into Fakknfai y (which was then the name given to the Peninfula of Corir way of They celebrate no feftivals, nor will they pay any refpecl to the Gods of *■'/* the Country, any more than common civility and good manners require. The practice of virtue, a free confcience, and a good and honeft life, is all what they aim at. They were even fufpecled of fecretly fa- vouring the Chriftian religion, for which reafon, after the faid Re- ligion had been entirely abolifhed by crofs and fire, and proper means taken to prevent its ever reviving again, they alfo were com, manded Chap. VU. The Hijtory of JAPAN. 251 manded to have, each the Idol, or at leaft the name, of one of the Gods worlhip'd in the country, put up in their houfes, in a confpicuous and honourable place, with a flower pot, and Incenfory before them. They commonly chufe Quanwon, or Amida, whofe Idols they place behind the hearth, according to the Country fafhion. Some have be- fides, of their own free choice, the Biofiu in their houfes, or elfe the name of fome learned man. In their publick Schools is hung up the pi&ure of Koofi or Confutius. Formerly this fed: was very numerous. Arts and Sciences were cultivated and improved among them, and the belt part of the nation profefs'd it. But that unpa- rallel'd perfecution of the Chriftian Religion, weaken'd it very much, and it loft ground ever fince ^ the extream rigour of the imperial E- di&s make people cautious even as to reading their books, which formerly have been the delight and admiration of the nation, held in as great an efteem as the writings of Plato, Socrates, and other hea- then Philofophers are in Europe. About thirty years ago, the Prince of Sifen and Inaba, a great Si- Hfieryof the itdofuz, and Patron of learned men, endeavour'd to revive this Phi- r^"" lofophy, then almoft extind, in his dominions. In order to this, he founded an university, endowed it with great privileges, and fettled handfome penfions upon able learned men, whom he fent for from all parts of the Empire. The defign of this undertaking was to open the Eyes of his Subjedts, and to teach them, if poflible, to make ufe of their reafon, which they no fooner did, but they began to fee thro' the impertinent and ridiculous Fables of their priefts, and difcovering their cheats refufed to grant them any further fubfiftance, whereby this numerous crew, which till then lived only upon the charity of credulous people, was reduced to a ftarving condition. Of fo dange- rous an innovation heavy complaints were made to both Emperors, and the unhappy Prince was like to fall a facrifice to his good in- tentions, had he not, by a voluntary resignation of his dominions to his Son, prevented the fatal blow of the Imperial difgrace ready to fall upon him and his family. His Son, though of a more prudent and referv'd behaviour, yet by his life and condu& leaves no room to doubt, but that his principles are nearly the fame with thofc of his Father's, an inftance whereof, though foreign to my prefent purpofe, will not be improper to clofe this Chapter and Book. On the Songuats, or We-iv-years-day, one of their greateft Feftivals, there was a numerous appearance at Court of gentlemen and ladies, who came thither in their richefl apparel, to compliment the Prince on the occafion of the day, and were by him entertatn'd at dinner. Amongft other prefents made to him that day, there happen' d to be a Peacock and Hen. Every one was delighted, and ftruck with ad- miration, by the uncommon beauty of thefe fcarce, foreign Birds, whence the Prince took occafion to aflc their opinion, which of the two 252 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book 111 two they thought was the cock, and which the hen. The gentlemen out of civility to the ladies, unanimoufly pitch'd upon the molt beautiful to be the hen \ the ladies on the contrary very modeftly apprehended, that the fineft of the two was the cock. You are in the right, anfwer'd there- upon the Prince j Nature itfelf will have the man beft ciad, and it feems to me incomprehenfible, that the wife mould have more pride, and go richer drefs'd than her husband, who muft be at the expence of maintaining her. An excellent New-year's Sermon from a Heathen Prince. THE 253 THE Hiftory of JAPAN. BOOK IV. OF NAGASACKI, The Place of Refidence for Foreigners : Of their Trade, Accommodation, CHAP. I. Of the Situation oj the City of Nagafacki, and its Harbour ; as alfo oj its publick and private Buildings. ^*£*<&<£r ;<& M O N G S T the Imperial Demefns, or Crown-lands, are - r T „,„, -^M- : &^ ! ^ij» comprehended the Gokqfio, as they call them, that is, ri«/Tow»$. •jjjip A }/&■; the five chief Maritime, or Trading Towns in the •J^ilb^&S W Empire. They are, Mijaco, the Refidence of the Ec- ^%k£ r ^'£K clefiaftical Hereditary Emperor, in the Province Jamafijra -, ■v *■ •*¥* v j ec { j-he refidence of the Secular Monarch, in the Pro- vince Muftis] ^ Oofaka, in the Province Sets j Sakai in JaJJutni, and Nagafaki in Fifen. The four firft are fituate upon the great Ifland Nipon, and all eminent for their wealth and riches, as needs they muft, confidering the fruitfulnefs of the Country about them, their manufactures and inland commodities, and many more confiderable ad- vantages, fcich as for inftance, the refidence of the two Imperial Courts, Sff the 254 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. the great number of Grangers, and amongft them, of many Noblemen Princes and Lords, who refort thither, in their way to and from Court, Whcnofx*- with great retinues. Nagafacki, on the contrary, the fubject of my trftcktisone. prefent confider.ition, is fituate at the Weftern extremity of the Ifland Kiusju, upon an indifferent and barren foil, between fteep rocks and high mountains, remote from the populous and wealthy Nipon^ and almoft fhut up even againft the Commerce with foreign nations. So many difadvantages, this City labours under, make it but thinly inhabited by Merchants, Innkeepers, Mercers, Manufacturers, or other rich people. The greater! part of its Inhabitants is made up by work- men, labourers and ordinary people, who mull get their livelyhood by their daily labour. However, the commodious and fecure (ituation of its port, makes it the common harbour for fuch foreign mips and people, as are permitted to trade to Japan, to import foreign commodities, and to fell them to Japanefe Merchants, who refort thi- ther at certain times of the year, from feveral parts of the Empirei This particular favour and privilege is granted only to the Chinefe,, or fuch Eaftern Nations as trade under their name, and to the Dutch, to both indeed with great reftridtions and under a very narrow in- fpeftion. After that cruel perfecution of the chriftian religion, which, with the lofs of many thoufand Natives of Japan, ended at laft in its to- tal extirpation, about the year of Chrift 1638, amongft many new laws which were then made, it was enacled by Imperial Authority, that for the future the harbour of Nagafacki fhould be the only one open to foreigners, and that if any (hip fhould be forc'd, thro' diftref9 of wea- ther, or otherwife, to put in for fhelter any where elfe, none of the crew fhould be fuffer'd to fet foot afhore, but that immediately, upon the dan- ger's blowing over, fhe fhould proceed on her Voyage to Nagafacki, un kr a convoy of Japanefe Guard-fhips, if needful, and fhew caufe to the Governor of that place, why fhe put in elfewhere. Harlot of The harbour begins to the North of the City. Its entrance is very Kagafacki. { ma \[ y and but a few fathom deep, with a fandy bottom. Not far from it fome rivers fall into the fea from the neighbouring mountains. It foon grows broader and deeper, and when it comes to be about half a mile broad, and five to fix fathom deep, it turns to the Southweft, and fo runs on between high land and mountains for a- bout a mile, being all along about a quarter of a mile broad, more or lefs, till it reaches an Ifland, or rather a mountain encompafs'd by the fea, and call'd Taka Jama, or Taka Boko, which is as much as to fay, BamMs Pic, or high Mountain of Bambou's. The Dutch call it Papenberg. This latter denomination is grounded upon a fabulous ftory of fome Roman Cathoiick Priefts, faid to have been thrown down that mountain into the Sea, in the time of the perfecution. All the Ships bound from Nagafacki to Batavia, commonly ride at anchor near this Ifland, to watch an opportunity of getting out of die harbour, which could Chap. I. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 255 could be eafily done in two hours time, or thereabouts, were it not for the many banks, fhoals, and cliffs, which make the {freight paf- fage equally difficult and dangerous, and to avoid which fhips muft fteer Weftwards, leaving the continent to the right, and fo paffing between fome fmall Iflands get out to the main. Some baftions are built along the harbour, as it were for defence, but they have no cannon. ltsGMT j t About half a mile from the Town are two Imperial guards, oppofite to one another, and enclofed with Pallifadoes. They confift of about 700 men each, thofe taken in, who do duty in their Guard- boats, which lie in the harbour both for its defence, and to guard foreign Ships riding at anchor. Near the Papenberg, where properly fpeaking the harbour begins, is a fmall Ifland, where the laft For- tuguefe Ship, which was feht from Macao to Japan, was burn t with all the goods on board, about the year 1642. They call it e_ ver fince the burning place of hojlile Ships, having appointed it to be the conftant place for the like executions hereafter. Number of There are feldom lefs than fifty Japanefe Ships and boats in this Skips and harbour, befides fome hundred fifher-boats and other fmall boats. Of foreign Ships there are feldom, fome few months in the winter ex- cepted, lefs than thirty, moft of which are Chinefe Yonks. The Dutch Ships never flay longer than three months in Autumn, nay feidom fo long, for about that time the South, or Weft Seafon, or Monfoon, which brought then to Japan, turns, and the North, or North Eaft Monfoon fets in, under favour of which they muft return to Batavia, or other places where they are bound to. The Anchorage is at the end of the bay, within reach of the Imperial guards, about, a mufket fhot from the Town, where Ships ride at anchor upon a foft clay in about fix fathom at high, and four and a half at low wa- ter. The town of Nagafaki, its Harbour, and part of the adjacent Coun- try are reprefented in Tab. XIX, copied in fmall from a very large map made by the Japanefe themfelves. tfagafaki lies in 32° 36' of North Latitude, and 151 degrees of situation «f Longitude, at the end of the harbour, where it is broadeft, and where the T ™' % 9 f turning North it forms a near Semicircular fhore. It hath the fhape of a half moon fomewhat inclining to a triangle. It is built along the fhore in a narrow valley, which runs Eaftward, and is form*d by the opening of the neighbouring mountains. It is about three quar- ters of a mile long, and nearly as broad, the chief and broadeft of its Streets running almoft fo far up the valley. The Mountains, which encompafs it, are not very high, but fteep, otherwife green up to their tops, and withal of a very pleafant and agreeable afpeft. Juft behind the city in going up the mountains are built many fiately Temples, beautifully adorn'd with fine Gardens and terrafs walks, ac- cording to the Country fafhion j higher up are innumerable burying places:- ifafai. 256 Tie Hijlory of J A P A N. Book IV places one behind another. Still further appear other higher moun- tains fruitful and well cultivated. In fhort the whole fituation af- ReytrkfibU f or( J s to. the Eye a moft delicious and romantick view. The moil tfc neighbour- remarkable places in the neighbourhood of Nagajaki are j Fukafori, a hooJoftiaga- plg^fant village, fituate to the S. W. about five Japanefe water Leagues, " 'i'Aafori. or two fmall german miles from the town :, It hath a fmall fort, or caftle, the refidence of a Bugjo, who governs the whole diftrict for the Prince of Fifen, as Proprietor. It affords a great quantity of firewood, and its yearly revenue amounts to near three Mangokf, though in the general lift of the revenues of the Empire it is fet down only Remarks- at one . Not far from this Village is a geat lake, or pond, which is faid to have this particular quality, that, though furrounded with trees, there is never a leaf, nor any dirty thing to be feen upon it. This they attribute to the great cleanlinefs ani purity of the fpirit, under whofe protection the pond ftands, on which account they have fuch a high veneration for it, that it is forbid under fevere penalties to filh in it. To the North of Nagafaki lies the Princely town and ©ww*. refidence Omura, fituate on a Gulf, and in the diftrid of the fame name. A fsw miles further Eaftwards lies the city Ifafai, belong- ing to the Prince of Fifen, upon an arm of the gulf of Simabara. Vtfcribtitn The Town of Nagafaki it felf is open, as moft- other Towns in 'f tht ?°y n 'fj&p&n, without either caftle, walls, fortifications, or indeed any other de- fence. The ftreets are neither ftrait nor broad, running up hill, and ending near the Temples. Three frefh water rivers run through the town, which come down from the neighbouring mountains. The middlemoft, and largeft, erodes the valley from Eaft to Weft. For the greateft part of the year they have fcarce water enough to water fome rice fields, and to drive a few mills, tho* in rainy weather they are apt to increafe fo, as to wafh away whole houfes. Its State in Nagafaki hath obtain'd its name from its former Lords, who had it in poffellion, along with its whole diftrict of 3000 Kokf yearly Revenues, from Nagafaki Kotari the firft of this name, through a fucceflion of twelve of his lineal defcendents to Nagafaki Sijn Seijemon. They ftill fhew at the top of a Hill, behind the Town, the ruins of their former refi- dence. The laft Lord of Nagafaki, I mean the abovemention'd Na- gafaki Sijn Seijemon, dying without ifTue, about 200 years ago, it fell, with its whole diftrict, to the Prince of Omura. The place, where the Town now ftands, was then nothing elfe but a poor miferable Hamlet, the abode of fome few fifhermen, and was call'd Fukaje, or Irije, that is, the long Bay, from the length of the Harbour, as well as for diftin&ion's fake from another village, fituate not far off on the laid Harbour, and call'd Fukafori, which is as much as to fay, the long Pond, which name it ftill retains. The new Lord of Fukaje then thought fit to alter the name of this Hamlet into that of Naga- faki 9 tntient times. Chap. I. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 257 faki, and 'twas owing entirely to his care and attention, that in fuc- cefs of time it became a very confiderable village or borough. Things continu'd upon this foot till fometime . after the firft arri- h > thl tm " val of the Portuguefe in Japan. This Nation for fome time enjoy'd f H '^ a free commerce, upon the fame terms with the Chinefe, then like- wife trading to thefe Iflands. For they were not bound to any par- ticular Harbour, but at liberty to put in wherever they pleas'd, or thought it molt convenient. Accordingly they made divers fettlements in the Iiland Saikoku, chiefly in the Provinces Bungo and Fifen :, and firft of all in the Province Fifen, at a . village call'd FakuJa, fituate upon the Ifland Firando, not far from the entrance, of the harbour of Nagafaki, about fix Japanefe water Leagues, or two long German Miles off this Town. This Place was under the jurifdi&ion of the Prince of Omura. Their next Settlement was in the Village Fukafori men- tion'd above. At thefe and all other Places, they ever fettled at, they made two things the chief object of their care and attention • one was to carry on their trade and commerce, the other to propagate the Chriftian Religion, and to fet up the ftandard of our Saviour in this remote Empire. They fucceeded in both according to their bed wifhes. They profper'd in their Trade beyond expectation, and by their good conduct, which at firft was humble and complaifant, they gain'd the hearts, not only of the common People, but even of great Men, the rather as there was fome natural refemblance between the minds and inclinations of both Nations. About that time the Prince of Omura himfelf openly efpous'd the intereft of the Chriftian Religion, and invited the Portuguefe to come and fettle at K^ajaki, which Place was then already grown up to a confiderable Village, confift- ing of about twenty three Streets, which now make up that part of the Town, call'd Utfimatz, or the inner Town, and containing in all twenty fix Streets. In this condition it was deliver'd up by the faid Prince into the poffeflion of the Portuguefe, both for carrying on their trade, and for propagating the gofpel. Whether or no this was done by him, with a real defign to forward the advancement of the Chriftian Religion, or rather with an intent to encreafe his revenues, and to enrich his fubjects, by making this place, as it were, the center of commerce and trade with foreigners, I will not take upon me to determine. Be this as it will, thus much is certain, that this new eftablifhment foon prov'd in many refpe&s very advantageous to this town. For the convenient and fecure fituation of its harbour, with feveral other advantages, invited alfo the Chinefe to come up thither with their fhips and goods, and the Japanefe, allur'd by the profpect of gain, came to fettle there in fuch numbers, that the old town was not large enough to contain them. Therefore new ftreets were built, and nam'd from the feveral provinces, towns or boroughs, their firft in- habitants came from, as for inftance Bungomatz, JeJomatz, Kabafima- # T t t tnatz, 258 The Htfiory o/JAPAN. Book IV tnatz, Firandomatz,, Omuramatz,, Simabaramatz. Befides thefe there are fome other ftreets call'd Bunts, from one of the firft members of this new Colony, who built them at his own expence. Thus Nagafaki, formerly a mean and inconfiderable hamlet, became by degrees a wealthy and populous town, wherein there are now about 87 ftreets, all well inhabited. h takf*fnm The flouriihing condition, and increafing wealth of the town of Omur*"a»d Uagafacki, when in polTefTion of the Portuguefe, foon afforded matter "'}'• of jealoufy and difcontent to the Court. Talco^ the then reigning Secular Monarch, reprimanded the Prince of Omura very feverely, for that he imprudently parted with a place of that importance in favour of a foreign Nation, and withal told him, that feeing he was not fit to keep and to govern it any longer, he would annex.it to his own dominions. The haughty condud of the Portuguefe contributed not a little to this refolution. Puff'd up with pride and fuccefs, they pull'd eff the mask too foon, and thought it unbecoming the honour and gravity of their nation, to pay fo much deference and refpeel to the great men of the Empire, as they had formerly condefcended to do. I was told by an old Japanefe, that the following incident, with many more of the like nature, very much incens'd the Empe- ror, and haften'd his refolution, to let the proud Portuguefe feel the effects of his Imperial difpleafure. Taico, to be nearer at hand to fe- cond his expedition into Corea^ fet up his Court and refidence for fome time at Facatta. One day a Portuguefe Prieft meeting upon the road one of the principal Counfellors of ftate in his way to court, caufed himfelf to be carried by without flopping or alighting from his chair, as is ufual in the country, nay indeed without ihew- ing him fo much as common marks of refpect and civility. It is eafy to be imagin'd, how much fuch a haughty and contemptSe conduit provok'd a man of his quality, for which reafon he refolv'd, as foon as he mould come to court, to acquaint the Emperor with what had pafs'd, which he did accordingly, and in the height of his reTent- ment made a moft odious picture of the pride and haughtinefs of the Portuguefe Nation in general, withal intimating, how inconfiftent it was with the Emperor's fchemes, and of how dangerous a confe- quence it might prove, any longer to fuffer thefe foreigners to inforce their Intereft and influence over his fubjects, they having already gain'd too much. In ihert, whether the Emperor was really dif- pleas'd at the difrefpecT: fhewn to his Minifter, or whether he look'd upon the increafing profperity of the Portuguefe Nation, and the pro- pagation of the Chriftian Religion in general, as detrimental to the peace and tranquility of the Empire, the indifcreet behaviour of this Prieft furnifh'd him with a plaufible pretext, to let thefe foreigners experience the firft proofs of his difpleafure, to take .away their town from them, and their patron the Prince of Omura, and befides, to de- prive Chap I. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 259 prive the latter of its whole diftrid and dependencies of 3000 Kokf yearly Revenues, which he annex'd to his own dominions. Thus much of the Town of Nagafacki in general, I proceed now to a more particular furvey thereof. Narafacki, Cor as it is fometimes pronounc'd, tho' not written, Dhijlan of Nangafacki) is divided into two parts : One is calPd Utfimatz, or the inner town, confiding of 26 Tsjoo, or Streets, all very irregular, as they had been built in the infancy of that town. The other is calPd Sottomatz,, which is as much as to fay, the outward city, or as it might be otherwife exprefs'd, the fuburbs. This contains 61 fkeets, fo that there are in all 87. The moft remarkable publick buildings in and about Na?igafacki, its PMuK are Some Janagura, as they call them, belonging to the Emperor, being j ana . ura% five large houfes, built of wood, on the North-fide of the town, on a low ground, not far from the more, where they keep three large Imperial Yonks, or Men of war, with all the tackle, ready to be launch'd at command. Jen Siogura, or the Powder Magazine, ftands on the fhore, oppofite p 0U ^ r -Mi- to the town. For a greater fecurity, and to prevent ill accidents^ ga-une. they have built a large vault in a neighbouring hill, where they keep the Gun-powder. The Palaces of the two refiding Governors. They take in a large Pa!aces ° the J ° Govt mors: fpot of ground, {landing fomething higher than the reft of the ftreets. The houfes are very neat and handfom, all uniform, and equally high. Strong gates, and well guarded, lead into the court. The third Governor lodges at Tattejaum, in a Temple, till his Predeceffor, by his departure for Jedo, makes him room in the Palace. Befid^s the Governor's Palaces, there are about twenty other houfes Houfes of the and fpots of ground, belonging to all the Dai Alio, and fome of the ^"dsof the moft eminent Sio Mio, (Dai Mio are Lords of the tirft rank, or Prin- £«/*'«. ces of the Empire, and Sio Alio all other Lords of an inferior rank,) of the Ifland Kiusju, or as it is otherwife call'd Saikokf, that is, the Weftem Country, wherein the town of Nangafacki lies. Some of their Noblemen conftantly refide there, upon ail occafions to take care of the affairs and intereft of their Principal, being anfwerable upon their return for what happens. If the Dai Mio's, or Sio Mio y s come up to Nagafacki themfelves, the fa id houfes ferve to lodge them and their retinue. The Foreigners live without the town, in fenarate places, where they A common- are very narrowly watch'd and guarded, like perfons fufpecled of ill pra- tt0 "% B dices. The Dutch live on a fmall Ifland, fituate in the harbour, hard by the town, and call'd De Sima, that is the Ifland De. The Chinefe, and neighbouring nations, who profefs the fame religion, and trade under the fame name, live behind the town, at the Southern extremity 260 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. extremity of it, upon a rifing ground. Their habitations are encom- pafs'd with a wall, and are call'd Jakitjin, or the Pbyfick-Garden 7 from what they were formerly, as alfo Dfiufensju from the Imperial Look-outs, who from the tops of the neighbouring hills are to look out for what foreign fhips fleer towards the harbour, and to give notice of their arrival to the Governors of the town. TmfUs. There are in all 62 Temples, within and without the town, vim. five Sinful Temples, erected to the Came, or the Gods and Idols as of old worlhipp'd in the Country, feven Temples of the Jammabos, or Mountain- Priefts, and fifty Tira, Temples of foreign Idols, the worfhip of whom was brought over from beyond fea. Of thefe laft there are 21 within, and 29 without the town, in the afcent of the hills, with beautiful flair-cafes of Hone leading up to them. Thefe Temples are facred not only to devotion and worfhip, but ferve alfo for recreation and diverfion, being for this purpofe curioufly adorn'd with pleafant gar- dens, elegant walks, and fine apartments, and by much the beft buildings of the town, for good air, a fweet fituation, and a mofl en- tertaining profpecl: over the town of Nagafacki itfelf, and good part of the harbour and adjacent country. A more particular defcripticn of thefe, and the like religious buildings, I propofe to give in the fourth Chapter of this Book. BuvJyHoufcs. My next Step fhall be, according to the cuftom of the Country from the Temples over to the Bawdy Houfes, the concourfe of peo- ple being as great at the latter, as it is at the former. That part of the Town, where they ftand, is call'd Kefiematz,, that is, the Bawdy Houfes Qjdarters. It lies to the South, on a riling hill, call'd Mariam. It confifts, according to the Japanefe, of two Streets, which an Euro- pean would be apt to miftake for more, and which contain the handfomefr. private buildings of the whole Town, all inhabited by Bawds. This and another Place in the Province TJikufe?i, tho' not fo famous, are the two only Mariams, as they call them, or publick Stews, in Saikokf, where the poor People of this Ifland, which produces the greatefl beau- ties of all Japan, (the Women of Miaco only excepted, who are faid to exceed them) can difpofe of their Daughters this way, pro- vided they be handfome and well fhap'd. The place accordingly is extraordinary well furnifh'd, and after that of Miaco the molt famous of the thole Empire, the Trade being much more profitable here than it is any where elfe, not only becaufe of the great number of fo- reigners, Nagafaki being the only place they have leave to come to, but alfo on account of the Inhabitants themfelves, who are faid to be the greateft Debauchees and lewdeft people in the Empire. The Girls are purchas'd from their Parents, when very young. The price varies in proportion to their beauty, and the number of years agreed for, which is generally fpeaking, ten or twenty, more or lefs. Every Bawd keeps as many as he is able, in one houfe together, from feven to Chap. I. The Bipryof JAPAN. 261 to thirty. They are very commodioufly lodg'd in handfome apart- ments, and great care is taken to teach them to dance, fing, play upon mufkal Inftruments, to write Letters, and in all other re- fpefts to qualify them for the way of life they are oblig'd to lead. The old ones being more fkilful and expert, inftrucT: the young ones, and thefe in their turn ferve them as their miftreiTes. Thofe who make confiderable improvements in what they are taught, and for their beauty, and agreeable behaviour, are oftner fent for, to the great advantage of their mafters, are alfo by him better accommodated in cloaths and lodging, all at the expence of their lovers, who muft pay fo much the dearer for their favours. The price paid to their Landlord, is from one Maas to two Itzebi for a night, beyond which they are forbid to afk, under fevere penalties. One of the forrieft j and almoft worn by too much ufe, muft watch the houfe over- night, in a fmall room adjoining to the door, where any paflenger may have to do with her, paying but one Maas. Others are fen- tenc'd to keep the watch by way of a punifiiment for their mifbe- haviour. After having ferv'd their time if they are married, they paf3 among the common people for hcneft women, the guilt of their paft life being by no means laid to their charge, but to that of their parents and relations, who fold them for fo fcandalous a way of getting a livelihood in their Infancy, before they were able to chufe a more honeft one. Befides, as they are generally well bred, this makes it lefs difficult for them to get husbands. The Bawds on the contrary, tho' poffefs'd of never fo plentiful an eftate, are for ever denied admittance in honeft companies. They call them by the fcandalous name of Katfuwa, which fignifies the very word fort cf Rabble, and put them upon the fame foot with the Jetta, or 'Leather- Tanners, the moft infamous fort of people in their opinion, who are oblig^i in this country to do the office of publick Executioners, and to live out of the town, in a feparate village, not far from the place of Execution. The Bawds are oblig'd alfo to fend their own fervants, to affift the Jetta at all publick executions, or to hire o- ther people to do it. Thus much of the Kefiematx. It will not be improper thence to go over to the Gokuja, Hell, or as it is otherwife call'd Roja, the Cage. By puhliekPri' this they mean the Prifon, which ftands about the middle of the fo- town, at the corner of a defcending ftreet. It confifrs of many fe- parate huts and fmall rooms, to accommodate Prifoners according to their quality, or the crimes they ftand committed for. Befides thofe who are put in prifon for crimes committed at Nagafacki, fmuglers alfo are confin'd there, and perfons taken up on fufpicion of profef- fing the Chriftian faith, fo that it often contains above an hundred Prifoners, and tho' clear'd by frequent executions feldom lefs than fifty. There are within its compafs, a place, where the Prifoners are Uuu put 262 The Hiftoryqf] A P A N. Book IV. put to the torture, a place for private executions of fuch per- forms as are not very notorious malefactors, a kitchin, a place where the prifoners are provided with victuals, a place, where at certain times they are permitted to take a walk and to air themfelves, and laftly a Tange, as they call it, or a pond for them to wa(h them- felves. Some of the prifoners ftand accufed of capital crimes, others are taken up on fufpicion, others are condemn'd to perpetual imprifon- ment. Amongft the laft is the Bimgofo as they call it, that is the Rabble of Bungo, by which name they denote the few remaining Chriftians, of whom there were upwards of 50 confin'd here, when I was in Japan, their women and children computed. Now and then they bring in fome more, tho' but feldom. In the year 1688 three Pttfint Sfte were taken up. Thefe poor people are very ignorant of the Chri- i'Su"'' y ftian Religion, knowing little more than the name of our Sa- viour and his blefTed Mother, and yet they are fo zealoufly at- tach'd to it, that they chufe rather to die miferably in goal, than by renouncing their faith, which they are often compell'd to do to procure their liberty. It firft happen'd, in the month of Sep- tember 1692 that three of the Prifoners fent fome money to the Temples of Amida, to pray for the fouls of fome of their deceafed relations. The Priefts would not receive it, without having firft afle'd the Governor's advice and leave. Nor would the Governor de- termine any thing in fo nice a cafe, before he had receiv'd inftru- clions from the Imperial Court about it. Thefe Chriftians however are not executed at prefent, as they were formerly, without mercy, and this in confideration both of their great fimplicity, and the lit- tle neceflity, there is at this time to ihew much feverity. But they are condemn'd to end their miferable life in this Temporal Hell out of which they are never fuffer'd to ftir, but when they are carried to the Governor's Palace, which is done once every two months, to be examin'd there, more indeed out of form, than with any rigour, and to be compell'd to difcover other Chriftians. All the hours of recreation thefe poor wretches are allow'd, are, to be taken out of the dungeons they are confin'd to, twice a year, in order to be burnt with Moxa, according to the cuftom of the country, to wafh themfelves fix times a year in the Tange of the Prifon, and to take a walk likewife fix times a year in a large and fpacious houfe built for this purpofe within the Prifon-walls. The reft of their miferable time they fpend in fpinning yarn of hemp, for hemming of mats. They ftitch their cloaths with needles made of Bambu's, being deny'd Iron -tools. Some know how to make focks, and other trifles of this nature. What money they get by their labour and induftry, is their own, and they may buy fome refrefh- ments for it, of which they communicate freely and without referve to their wives and children, who are kept prifoners in the fame Goal, Chap. I. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 263 Goal, tho' in feparate places. Out of the remainder of the portion of rice, which is allow'd them for their daily fuftenance, they prepare, by letting it ferment over night, a particular liquor, call'd Ama Saki y or the pleafant Saki, which, for its agreeable fweetnefs, is one of their greateft comforts. They have now and then fome cloaths fent them by their friends in Bungo, which in this prefent fcarcity of the adherents to the Chriftian Faith, and thofe too Chriftians more by name, than in fad, are fomewhat indulg'd, tho' they have many a fevere cenfure and examination to undergo. The Governors give them every year a mat to lie on. A little while ago, fome few of them obtain'd leave to make ufe of a Kagatan, or fmall knife, for their work. Among the publick buildings of Nagafacki, the Bridges muft not MJgth be forgot. There are in all 35, great and fmall, twenty whereof are built of ftone, and fifteen of wood. There is nothing remarkable in their ftru&ure, which is very fimple, they being made more for ftrength than (hew. The ftreets, in the main, are neither ftreight nor large, but irregu- Sneeu. gular, dirty, narrow, leading fome up, others down hill, becaufe of the irregularity of the ground, upon which the Town is built. Stair, cafes of ftone are built along fome of the fteepeft, for a more com- modious afcent, and defcent. They are full ftock'd with Inhabitants, as many as ever they will hold. They are feparated from each o- ther by two Wooden-gates, one at each end, which are (but up at night, and often in the day, when there is any the lead cccafion for it. There is befides in every ftreet a Qua Si Doogu, as they call it, that is, a place where they keep what is requifite in cafe of fire, which does a great deal of damage in this country, where all the buildings are made of wood ^ fuch as for inflance, a well full of water, a pail, or bucket, a fire -hook, &c. The ladder is at the difpofal of the commanding officer of the ftreet, and kept in his houfe. It muft be obferv'd, that the ftreets of Nagafacki and other towns in Japan, never run out into too great a length. However they are not all of the length of a Japanefe TJ10, which is a meafure of 60 Kins, or Fathoms, tho' they have borrow'd their name from thence, but they are built fo, that they may be commodioufly fhut with gates at each end. Thus for inftance, a ftreet may come up to the full length of a Tfio, and take in fome few houfes more, which are all under the command of one officer. As to the number of houfes, there are fel- dom more than fixty, or lefs than thirty in a ftreet. The houfes of the common people are very mean forry buildings, Uwfts. fmall, low, feldom above one ftory high. If there be two ftories, the uppermoft is fo low, that it fcarce deferves that name. The roof is cover'd with (havings of Fir-wood, which are faften'd only by other pieces of wood laid a-crofs. The houfes are built of wood, 264 The Hiftoryof JAPAN. Book IV. wood, as are all other buildings throughout the Empire. The walls within are wainfcotted, and hung with painted and varioufly colour'd paper. The floor is cover'd with mats, wove, of a confiderable thicknefs, which they take care to keep exceedingly clean and neat. The rooms are feparate from each other, by falh-windows and paper- fcreens. Seats or chairs they have none, and only fome few houfhold- goods, chiefly fuch as are abfolutely neceflary for daily ufe in the kitchin. Behind every houfe is a back-yard for fecret offices, which tho' ne- ver fo fmall, yet contains always fome curious and beautiful plants to delight the eyes, which they keep with a great deal of care. The houfes of eminent Merchants, both foreign and natives, and of other rich people, are of a far better ftruclure, commonly two fto- ries high, and built after the Chinefe manner, with a large court- yard before them, and a garden behind. Nagafaki is inhabited chiefly by merchants, fhopkeepers, tradefmen Inhabitants . , r . c , , ,, , , . „ , ' afNagafiikj. handicrafts-men, artificers, brewers, bchdes the numerous retinue of the Governors of the town, and the people employ'd in the Dutch and Bggars. Chinefe Trade. There are more poor people and beggars here, and more impudent, than any where elfe. Amongft the beggars there are many Qwanfin Eos, and jQjtanfin Bikuni, or mendicant friars, and beg_ gar women. One fingle ftreet which is call'd Jawatta Matz, and fometimes Fatfmarimatgs, contains upwards of an hundred. They are poor people, who make vow to lead a devout, chart and auftere life, like the priefts, in order to which they caufe their heads to be fhav'd, and drefs themfelves in black, like other Ecclefiafticks, the eafier to obtain people's charity. In this drefs, with a rofary, or beads, in their hands, as alfo with images, fmall bells, and other marks of an un- common devotion, they go begging through the Town. Some of thefc devotees are fhav'd publickly in one of the Temples, and confecrated to this odd way of life with great folemnity, the Priefts murmur- ing certain prayers and obfcure words. But this is done only when old rich people refolve to enter into this order, and to fpend the remainder of their days in their houfes, in a devout and retir'd wav of life. The monks of the Chinefe, and other Sensjrt monafteries fend alfo fome of the fraternity to go a begging fix times a month, which they do rather purfuant to the vow they make, when they are admitted in- to the order, to follow the example of their great Founder and Pa- tron Siaka, than out of any want or neceflity. Dogs. The Dogs alfo deferve to be mention'd among the Inhabi- tants of Nagafaki, they being full as well, nay better maintain'd and taken care of, than many of the reft, and altho' the Imperial or- ders on this head are not regarded and complied with at Nagafaki with that ftri&nefs, as they muft be in other parts of the Empire, which are not fo remote from court, yet the ftreets lie full of thefe animals, leading a moft eafy and quiet life, giving way neither to Men Chap II. The Hiftory of J A P A K 265 Men nor Horfes. If they happen to hurt any body, or otherwife to do mifchief, fo as to deferve punifhment or death, no body dares pre- fume to touch them, but the publick Executioner, and not even he, without a direft order from the Governors. Huts are built in every ftreet to keep fuch as grow old and infirm, and when they die, they muft be carried up to the tops of the mountains in order to be buried. This uncommon care and regard for the prefervation of the Dog-kind, is the effecT: of a fuperftitious whim of the now reigning Emperor, who being born in the Sign of the Dog, hath no lefs an efteem for this animal, than the great Roman Emperor Aaguftus C*far is men- tion'd in Hiftory to have had for Rams. I have elfewhere related the comical converfation of two Japanefe, who were carrying up a dead to the top of a mountain, in order to his burial. Manufactures, in the main, are not fo good at Nagafaki, as they are Mar:tfie!nr.:. in other parts of the Empire, and yet every thing is fold dearer, chiefly to foreigners. However, what is wrought in Gold, Silver and Sawaas, being not fo proper a commodity for the inland trade, as it is for the foreign, is made here with a much better tafte, and of a far more curious workmanmip, than I believe any where elfe. As to vi&uals and drink, the country about Nagafaki doth not pro- Nagafaki juce rice enough, which is the common food all over Ajia, for the ^"J/jb fuftenance of its Inhabitants, fo that the necefTary provisions muft be victual:. imported from the neighbouring Provinces of Fifen, Figo, and Tfikwigo, and from the Iflands Amakufa and Gotho, which lie to the North of this Town. The gardens in and about this City, the neighbouring mountains and villages abundantly furnifh it with all forts of fruits, plants and roots, with firewood, as alfo with fome venifon and poultry. The harbour and neighbouring fhores yield plenty of fifh and crabs. The rivers, which run through the town, provide it with clear and fweet water, very fit for daily drink. The Saki, or rice beer, as it is brew'd in Japan, being too ftrong, and that in particular which is brew'd at Nagafaki, of a difagreeable tafte. Another light and clear water fprings forth on the neighbouring mountain Tatta. The ftiips in the harbour take in their ftore of water from a clear fpring, not far from the town to the Eaft of it. The water, tho' it is very good and clear, (as indeed the water is in ail parts of the Empire) yet it hath been obferv'd to give people the cholick, or belly-ach, a diftem- per which the Inhabitants themfelvcs are very much fubjecT: to, chiefly when they drink their Saki cold, and in too large a quan- tity. This Town is never without a great deal of noife. In Jthe day r - : ver )' "°''fj- time viduals, and other merchandize, are cried up and down the ftreets. Day labourers encourage one another to work with a certain found. The Seamen in the harbour meafure the progrefs of their work ac- cording to another loud tune. In the night time, the watchmen and X x x Soldiers 266 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV- foldiers upon duty, both in the ftreets and harbour, fhew their vigi- lance, and at the fame time indicate the hours of the night, by beat- ing two ftrong pieces of wood one againft another. The Chinefe alfo contribute their (hare, chiefly in the evening, when they burn fome pieces of gilt paper, and throw them into the Sea, as an offering or facrifice, to their Idol Maatfo Eofa, or when they carry the faid Idol about its Temple, both which they do with beating of drums and cymbals. But all this is little, in comparifon to the clamour and bawling of the Priefts and relations of dying, or dead, Persons, who, either in the houfe, where the corpfe lies, or elfe upon certain days facred to the deceafed's memory, ling a Namanda with a loud voice, and ringing of bells, for the relief of his foul. Namanda is a fhort prayer, contracted from the words Namu Aniida Bud fit, and dire&ed to their God Amida, whom they pray to intercede with the fupreme Judge of the Infernal Court, in favour of the poor con- demn'd foul. The like is done by the Nembuds Koo, certain frater- nities, or focieties of devout neighbours, friends, or relations, who meet by turns in their houfes, every day in the morning, or evening, m order to ling the Namanda, by way of precaution, for the future re- lief of their own fouls. CHAP. II. Oj the Government of NAGASAKI. Government T^ VERY Imperial City is commanded by two Governors, or Cities. of the burial jp L or( j s Lieutenants, who are by their fubjefts call'd, Tono Sama, that is to fay, Supreme Lord, or Prince. They command by turns, and mean while the one is upon his government, the other ftays at Jedo^zX. the Emperor's Court, till he receives orders to return and to Of Na&f«ki- relieve his PredecefTor, who then goes up to Court himfelf. Nagafaki only is commanded by three, it having been thought proper, ever fince the year 1688, for the better fecurity of fo important a place, and in order to have a more watchful eye over the conduct of fuch fo- reign nations, as have leave to trade there, to add a third, and to put things upon fuch a foot, that there be conftantly two redding upon the fpot, and the third at Court. The two Governors, who ftay at Nagafaki, command jointly, but prefide by turns every two months, aud when two years are expir'd, the fenior of the two is reliev'd by a third, appointed by the Council of State to fucceed in his place. As foon as the new Governor is arriv'd at Nagafaki, he, whom he comes to relieve, delivers up his power, and his apartment in the palace, and Chap II. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 267 and prepares himfelf for his departure for Jedo, there to lay before the Council of State, along with the ufual prefents, an account of the moft material tranfactions of his government in writing, and to inform them more amply, by word of mouth, of other things of lefs moment. Moreover, fo long as he flays in the capital city of Jedo, he makes it his bafinefs to court and to vifit the chief miniflers and great men at court, who are mcfl in favour with the Emperor, to whom he makes rich prefents, according to his ability, both as an acknowledgment for their lafl favours, and which is more material, to fecure to him- felf the continuation of their good offices for the future. He flays at feds about fix months, during which time he is at liberty to live fi his family :, for, as foon as he hath receiv'd orders from the Council of State to depart for his laft or any other government, and hath taken his leave of its feveral members, he muft let out forthwith, leaving his wife and children at Jedo till his return, in a manner as hoftages of his fidelity. Nay all the time, he is upon his government, no woman is to be admitted within his refidence and apartments, under pain of incurring the Imperial difpleafure, the fatal confe- fequences whereof are no lefs, than death by his own hands, or elfe perpetual banifhment, or imprifonment, with the unavoidable en- tire ruin of his family, it being thought beneath the majefly of the Emperor, to inflict a lefs punifhment upon any the leafl difregard fhewn to the Imperial Commands. The conduct of the three prefent Governors, in mana^ine the af- c ° n JuB ''°l'''" fairs of their government and regulating the foreign trade, hath been Goveraorsi fuch, as turn'd very much to the fatisfaction of the Emperor and the Council of State, the rather fince the Inhabitants of Nagafaki reap'd thereby confiderable advantages, to the great prejudice, as may be eafily imagin'd, of the foreign nations trading here. For this rea- fon, and in confideration of their faithful fervices, the Emperor was pleafed, not only to continue them in their governments, but to con fer upon them the honour of knighthood, with the title of Cami, which two of them have already receiv'd in their laft Journeys to court, and the third expects to be honour'd with, upon his next going thither. Canity in the Japanefe language, fignifies feveral things, as for inftance, a great and powerful Spirit, worthy of divine wor- fhip j a fublime and immortal Soul :, a deceas'd Emperor or great Man, whom the Mikaddo hath deify'd and commanded to be wor- fhipp'd amongfl the Gods of the Country •, and laftly, in the lowefl fenfe, a Knight. Thofe Perfons, who are honour'd with it, as the title of Knighthood, commonly add to it, to give it more weight and au- thority, the name of fome Province, or part of a Province. But to return to our three Governors, it will not be improper, before I proceed any further, to mention their names, and in a few words to give their character. The 268 The Hifiory of J A P A N. Book IV. t - • The firft is Kaxvagutz, Genfejemon, or according to his prefent title (wherein he hath retain'd the name of his family) Kawaguts Tftno Ctitm. The yearly revenue of his own efhte amounts to 4700 Kokf He is a handfome well fhap'd Perfon, about 50 years of age, a cun- ning but malicious man, a great enemy to the Dutch, an unjuft and fcvere judge, but an agreeable, liberal and happy courtier. The fecond is, Jama Oka Siubjooje, or acccording to his prefent title, Jama Oka Tftffima no Cami. He was formerly High Conftabie, and appointed by the Emperor, to clear the Imperial Capital Jedo of thieves and pickpockets, whereof with the troops, that were order'd him for this expedition, he exterminated in a lhort time upwards of a thoufand, and was afterwards rewarded with this Government. The revenue of his own eftate is of 2 coo Kokf a year.. He is about 60 years of age, fhort-nYd, fincere, humble, liberal, chiefly to the poorer people in his government, to whom, when he laft went up to court he made a prefent of all his perquisites, which were fo confiderable, that fome of the inhabitants receiv'd upwards of an hundred Tails a head. Now, whether this liberality was really owing to his gene_ rous difpofition, or whether he endeavour'd thereby to rival, if not to out-do his co-partner in the government, I will not take upon me to determine. Thus much is true, that his generofity, and other good qualities notwithstanding, the exercife of his former profeffion ftill flicks fo clofe to him, that he often orders his dome/ticks to be put to death without mercy, let their faults and mifdemeanours be never fo trifling. Mjaki To- The third is, Mijaki Tonomo, a. Nobleman of great generofity, en- *""*"■ dow'd with many excellent qualities. He is much of the fame age with Jama Oka TfitJJima no Canity and hath 4000 Kokf yearly reve- nues from his own eftate, but as yet no title. l\nr Salary. Their falary is but fmall, for an employment of this importance, for it doth not exceed 1500, or 2cco Kokfs of rice, which may a- mount in money, the price of this commodity being very variable, from 7000 to about 10000 Tails. But the perquifites are fo confide- rable, that in a few years time they might get vaft eftates, did not the prefents, which mult be made to the Emperor and the Grandees of his court, confume the. bed: part of their profits. Their Com t. Out of this fmall allowance however they mull keep up all that (late, grandeur and magnificence, which is thought becoming the dig- nity of their employment, and the majefly of their mafter. Their Court confifts of ten Joriki, who are both military and civil officers and all noblemen of good families, and thirty Doosju, who are like- wife military and civil officers, but inferior to the former in their office and quality. Their bufinefs is to aflift the governor with their advice, if needful, and to execute his commands. With this defign at leaft it was, that they were firft appointed by the Emperor, of Chap. H. The Miftory of J A P A N. 269 of whom they formerly depended, and were paid out of the Imperial Exchequer. But of late, fince the year 1688, the Governors of ffagafacki, at their inftant defire, obtain'd leave to chufe them them- felves, and to pay them out of their own falary. For they took it frequently into their heads, to oppofe the Governors, meerly to fhew their authority, as Fattatnatto, that is, independant Imperial Officers, which often occafion'd great confufion, and difappointed the Gover- nors in the execution of many a good defign. For this reafon, (and in order to diftinguifh them from thofe Noblemen, who are in the fervice of the Governors of other Imperial Cities, or of the Princes of the Empire, upon the fame foot, as they had been themfelves, that is, depending of no body but the Emperor himfelf,) their titles alfo were taken from them, and they are now call'd, the one Kin Ninfiu, the other Sita Jaku, the titles of Joriki, and Doosju being given them only by the ignorant vulgar, who fometimes alfo honour the Joriki s with the title of Bugjo, which belongs to none, but fuch, as during their commiflion enjoy the privilege of having a Governor's pike car- ried before them, as a badge of the power and authority -they have been inverted with by their matter. In the court ftile, the title of Bugjo is given only to fuch Imperial commimoners, and other officers, either military or civil, who receive their commiflion from the Emperor himfelf, and are anfwerable for their conduct to him alone. But to return to the Jorikz\ or as they are now call'd Kin Kin Sju, it is their duty and office, here, and in other Governments, and at all the Courts of the Princes of the Empire, where they are eita- blifh'd, to aflift their matter with their advice, to the beft of their capacity, and faithfully to execute, what commands foever he lays upon them, either, as military officers, in cafe of war, or as magift rates in civil affairs, judicial enquiries, tryals, judgments, executions and the like. They are like wife employ'd in embaffies, meffages of moment and all other affairs, where it is requifite, that the authority of their matter mould be reprefented. Upon thefe and the like occafions, they are attended by feveral of the Doofen, and other inferior officers and fer- vants, whofe aid or affiftance they might have occafion for in the execution of their commiflion. Befides what hath been hitherto men- tion'd, they are employ'd at Nagafacki for feveral other mean offices, and in their opinion very unbecoming their character and quality of Noblemen : Such are, to have a watchful eye over the foreigners, their trade and conduct, to attend the buying and felling of goods, the lading and unlading of mips, and other things of this kind. For this reafon but few Noblemen, of good families care to enter into the fervice of the Governors of Nagafacki, the rather as they mufl depend entirely upon their favour, they having it in their power to dif- charge them, whenever they pleafe, and becaufe they are paid out Yy y of" 27 o The Hiflory 0/ J A P A N. Bcok IV. ai the G overnor's own purfe, who, as may be eafily imagin'd, al_ lows them as little as poflibly he can. They have fome diftin&ion among themfelves, as to their rank, according to the feveral offices which they ferve. The chief of thofe at Nagafacki, is the Kirijlan Bugjoo, or Ihquifitor general of the Chriftian religion, who hath the direction of all affairs relating to the further abolifhing and fupprefling there- of. The allowance of the Joriki's at Nagafacki, is fo fmall, being not above ioo Tails a year, befides the table, and a new fait, that they are fcarce able to keep the neceffary fervants, as Joriki's, fuch as for inftance, a pike-bearer, a keeper of their great fword, and a fhoe or flipper-bearer, much lefs to maintain a family. For this reafon they frequently quit their matter's fervice, which puts him under a neceffity to employ fome of his other domefticks to do their bufinefs. Feofm. The Doojln are a fort of affiftants, or helpers, to the Jorikis, and are by them, or by the Governors, employ'd for feveral meaner offices. Thus, for inftance, they ferve in the guards, do duty on board of (hips, yonks, convoy-fhips, and particularly the abovemen- tion'd guard-boats, wherein watch muft be kept over night for the fecurity of the town and harbour. Upon thefe and the like occafions, they ferve either as commanding officers, or as common foldiers, and in cafe of an attack, they are commonly for their courage, and bra- very, put at the head of the troops. Sometimes they do the office of Bailiffs, or Conftables, and put people under arreft, for which pur- pofe they always carry a halter about them. Their yearly allow- ance, befides the table, doth not exceed 50 Tails, out of which money they muft maintain each a fervant. SrSii T ^ e K* roo i Major-domo's, or Stewards of the Houfhold, are fupe- ricr to the Joriki's in rank and quality. They are two in number, and fometimes three, and have the fupreme direction of the Go- vernor's Court. All domeftick affairs are examin'd and determin'd by them, either alone, or if they be of confequence, with the advice of fome of the Joriki's, whom they call in to their affiftance, in order to avoid breeding jealoufy and miftruft in their matters, by an affeclation of too much power. If they behave themfelves well, they may be fure of a great (hare in their mafters's confidence, by whom they are often employ'd as their Secretaries, or Privy Counfellors, and fometimes in affairs of confequence, as their Deputies. They are chofen by their mafters from among their oldeft, ableft, and moil faithful fervants, or out of the deceafed Steward's nearcft relations, if there be any ca- pable to fucceed him. The fons often fucceed in their father's employ- ment. There are ftill fome other Domefticks, inferior to the Joriki's, as the Sosjo, or Gentlemen of the Bedchamber, who have leave to com- ntio the Governor's apartment at any time, it being their bufinefs to intro- ibe HoufjelJ. ;ei ». Chap. II. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 271 intorduce people, and to bring in meflages -, the Tfugosjo, or Valets Tfugosjo. de Chambre, who drefs and undrefs them j fome Juwitm, or Clerks, 3tlv , ift befides a good number of Footmen and menial Servants. Thefe feveral Perfons, hitherto mention'd, make up the Governor's 0r ^ r «/ the Court, and if he be at home, they difcharge their duty and make c,Z™° r ' $ their appearance in the following order. At the entry of the court, within the outward gate, in an open room, is kept a guard of Doofen, c-*^ Do9 ' of which there are always four or five, fitting by turns to look after the door. They have a double fword, or a fword and fcimiter, which they wear ftuck in their girdle on the left fide, and a ftrong heavy ftaff, made of what they call Iron-wood. They are alfo to take no. tice what domeftieks go in or out, every one of whom is oblig'd, if he goes abroad upon an errand, to take a maik'd fquare wooden- plate out of the ir room, and upon his return to hang it up aaain, that by the number of the plates wanting they may know at any time how many of the domeftieks are abfent. They (hut the door at fe- ven a clock, according to the Japanefe way of counting, which is a- bout four in the afternoon. Paft this time none of the fervants and inferior officers can come in without particular order. Upon great oc- cafions, or if fome perfons of quality come to vifit the Governor, two or four Doofen more are added to this guard, in order to make a better appearance. From this outward guard, having crofs'd the court, you meet ifi Stm, or the firft open apartment of the houfe, next to the great gate, which Hou f e s, liar ^ commonly hath three fteps leading up to it, the great State, or Houfe. guard, call'd Genquaban. This is kept by the Joriki's, who fit there by turns, looking towards the court, or outward-gate. The Karoo t Sosjo, and Tfugosjo, when they have nothing elfe to do, come to in- creafe the number. The Sosjo and Tfugosjo fit below the Joriki\ and the Karoo above them. One of the Joriki's of the Genquaban fits at the place, where the Genquafio, or Journal of the Guard, is kept, wherein he enters, as the cuftom is in houfes of men of quality, the names of the perfons, who went in or out that day, for the fatis- fadlion of their mafter, who fometimes at night perufes thefe me- moirs. Next to the Genquaban is the Nengiofifeja, a fmall room, for the tfaigfojifej*, Reprefentatives of the Burgher-mafters, or Mayors of Nangafakt, to fit in. They are four in number, two whereof conftantly attend at the pre- fixing, or commanding Governor's court, in the name of the faid Burgher- mafters, in order to know whether or no he hath any commands either upon them, or to the town. The inhabitants imagine, that thefe perfons make it their bufinefs to take care of their intereft, liberties and ne- ceflities, at the Governor's court, and for this reafon they ihare the expences and trouble of this office, hiring people to difcharge it, or doing duty themfelves, if call'd upon. The 2 7 2 The Hiftory c/JAPAN. Book IV. Ej*i}wtf The Governor's equipage and attendance, when he goes abroad, the Governors. con gft. s j n a Led-horfe, a Norimon, or Palankin, wherein he is carry'd, four Kats, or Footmen, walking before the Korimcn, four of his chief Tfiigosjo's, or Gentlemen of his Bedchamber, walking on each fide of the Norimon, two Jarimcts, or Pike-bearers, following the Norimon % And laftly, a numerous train of Karoos, Jorikfs, Doofen, with their own fervants and attendants. His retinue is ftill greater, and much more magnificent, in his journey to Jedo, tho' during his flay in that capital he reduces it to a Pike-bearer, and fome few Domefticks. povtr The power of the Governours of Nangafaki extends not only over *ndJutW the j apane r e inhabitants of this Town, but alfo over the foreigners eftablifh'd here, who are fubject, as well as the Natives, to th e laws of the Empire, and liable to have the fame penalties, which are put upon tranfgreflion thereof, inflicted upon them, the moderation or remiflion of which they mud commit entirely to the care and favour of the Governor, and withal upon all occafions, whether his orders and proclamations turn to their advantage, or difadvantage, exprefs their fatisfaction, and gratitude, for the pains he is at upon their ac- count. Among the foreigners are comprehended the Dutch, or the people belonging to the Dutch Factory, and employ'd in affairs rela- ting to the commerce of the Dutch Eaft India Company in Japan, and the Chinefe, or fuch of their neighbours, who trade to this Empire under their name, as for inftance, the Tunquineefe, Gambodians, Sia- mites, and others, befides fome Chinefe, who are not inhabitants of China, but fettled in feveral parts of the Eaft Indies. Befides an almoft abfolute power, which the Governors of Nangafaki have over the lives and fortunes of the inhabitants of this place, foreign as well as na- tive, they have alfo the direction of the foreign trade, the power of judicially examining Smuglers and Chriftians, and punifhing fuch perfous as are accus'd and found guilty of either of thefe crimes, the regulations relating to foreign fhips, which put into this harbour, as alfo to fuch fhips and crews, as have been by ftorm and thro' di- ftrefs of weather fore'd upon the coafts of Japan, all which, as well as the adherents of the Chriftian Religion, difcover'd in any part of this Weftern Ifland, rauft be brought up to Na?igafaki. Moreover they are to take care of all foreigners eftabliin'd in this city, and to have a watchful eye over their conduct, and laft of all to provide for the fecurity of the harbour. Check put In the mean time, that fo many affairs, and thofe of fo great an vtrnm. importance, fhould not be left entirely to the good management and fidelity of the Governors, which would be inconfiftent with the maxims of a government fo miftruftful, as that of the Japanefe, the Court hath made ample provifion, that their actions and conduct fhou'd be nar- rowly watch'd. This is done by a perfon, who refides at Nangafaki, in quality of Daiquan, or Imperial Factor. And left he too fhou'd be Chap. II. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 273 -- 1 ■ ■■■■ I — !■ I 1 , I, be won over in time to the intereft of the Governors, or willingly overlook any of their falfe fteps, it hath been thought proper to put a check likewife upon him, for which purpofe orders have been fent to all the Lords of the feveral provinces in Kiusju, that they mould command their Refidents at Nagafaki, immediately to acquaint the court, with whatever occurs remarkable. In cafe of an irruption, or in- furrection, thefe Princes rauft with all fpeed march their troops to- wards that place. So many precautions make it impoffible either for the Governors, or indeed any body elfe, to attempt any thing, but what the court, by fome means or other, would be immediately ac- quainted withal. For the fake of the trade and communication with foreign nations, ^ tttr t reterti the Emperor maintains, with yearly allowances, a competent number of Interpreters in the Dutch, Portuguefe, Tunquinefe, Siamites, the three Chinefe, and feveral other languages. But the knowledge and flcill of thefe people is, generally fpeaking, little elfe than a fimple and indifferent connexion of broken words in the languages above- mention'd, which they put together according to the Idiom of their own tongue, without regard had to the nature and genius of the lan- guage out of which they tranflate, and this they do in fo odd a manner, that often other interpreters would be requifite to make them underftood. In order to fecure the harbour againft any invafion from abroad, Provifo* and to difable the foreigners living here, from attempting any thing % a C umyJfthe againft the publick peace and tranquility, four guards of a different Harbeur. nature have been eftablifh'd, and regulated upon fuch a foot, that they ferve both to fecure the town and harbour, and to watch one another. Of thefe I proceed now to give a fhort account. The fir ft is the great Imperial Guar J, This is independant of the Great hn ?y Governor's, and kept in the Emperor's name, at the expence of the Princes of Fi&en and Tfikufen alternatively, by each for a year. It is call'd Gobanfio, Goban, and Goban Tokoro, that is, the chief guard, head guard, or the Imperial guard, becaufe of its being independant of the Gover- nor's. It is kept about half a German Mile from the town, on two eminences oppofite to one another, whereof that to the left fail- ing out of the harbour, is call'd Tomatfi, and that to the right Nifi- domari. There are no walls, ramparts, or ditches round them, nor are they provided with cannon for their defence. Upon the arrival or departure of our fhips, they are hung about with red cloath, as it were for ornament, and it is the cuftom to falute them each with a difchargs of our guns on board. There are about 700 men that do duty in both, tho' if compleat, there mould be no lefs than a thoufand. They live in huts built of wood, and are commanded by a Gobangasijra, that is, a Captain of the Imperial Guard j fome few of them are Joriki\ others Doe/en, the reft Bits, or common foldiers. Z z z They 274. TheHiJloryof JAPAN. Book IV. I They have a fine' open view over the whole harbour, and a gre„;t boat or barge, at their difpofal, which lies ready fomewhat below the town, in order to carry them with all fpeed, where their rife, fence is wanted. slty-gtM-d. The fecond Guard is the Funaban, or Ship-guard. This is com- posed of eighteen Bus, or common Soldiers, who have a competent fjumber of Guard-fhips, with the neceffary hands on board. They are to watch all the foreign mips lying at anchor near the town, and to go round the harbour in the night. As foon as a foreign fhip en- ters the harbour, two of thefe boats, each with a Dofin, as command- ing officer, are polled on the fides of her. They are reliev'd every three hours by two others. This continues fo long as fhe flays in the harbour. Upon her departure they keep her company, till fhe is got out of the harbour to the main Sea. Thefe Guard-fhips are kept at the expeuce of the inhabitants of the Water-ftreets, as they call them, or the ftreets which are built along the water-fide, who are alfo to take care, to furnifli the neceffary number of water-men. And that they fliould have no reafon to complain, of any extraordinary hard- fhips put upon them, another burden of the like kind hath been laid upon the inhabitants of the upper part of the town, towards the mountains, or of the land -ftreets, as they call them, who muft fend fix, and, if needful more Kulis, every day to the Governor's court, to be by them employ'd in the difpatch of neceffary bufinefs. No houfe nor flreet is exempted from this duty, which all the inhabi- tants muft difcharge in their turn. The Funaban, or common Ship- guard, is affifted and enforced by a third one, callM UtitiGvHxtl. Mi Okari Bum, that is to fay, the Convoying InfpeEiors, who make up the third of the chief guards apppointed for the fecurity of the harbour. Their bufinefs is to convoy the outward-bound fhips fo far out of the harbour into the Ocean, as feems neceffary to put it out of their power to return upon any pretence, or for any reafon whatfoever. For the fame purpofe, but chiefly to hinder the Chinefe from landing their yonks any where elfe, but at Nagafaki, as the only harbour they are allow'd to go to, and likewife to difcover the Japanefe Smuglers, who are often caught, feveral other Japanefe boats, rowed each by eight watermen, are continually cruifing along the Coafts. The main bufinefs of thefe people is the Whale-fifhing. They ftand all under the command of a general officer, who hath a yearly allowance of 300 Tails, and takes care of the Whale-fifhing, as well as to hinder fhips from putting in any where but at Nagafaki, and to chafe Smuglers. In this view they chufe for the Whale- fifhing, what time and upon what coafts they think it moil likely to meet with them. The Chap. II. . The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 275 The fourth, and laft, of the chief Guards of the harbour is the To- Tomi B(W , tniban, which is as much as to fay, the Spy-guard, or the farfeeing orSp y 6»*rd. Guard. It confifts of twenty odd Bus, or common Soldiers, call'd Sht Ninfi, or the Guard of ten, becaufe formerly they did not ex- ceed that number. They live with their families at the South end of the town, not far from the coafts, on an eminence, from whence they have an open profpecT: over the habitations of the Chinefe, who are their next neighbours, and of the Dutch. Their bufinefs is from the Tomi Dake, as they call them, being fmall houfes, or huts, built at the tops of the mountains round the harbour, with their fpy-glafles to look out upon the main, and as foon as they difcover a (hip fteering towards the harbour, to fend notice thereof to the Governor, as alfo to notify from time to time how fhe approaches, which is done by the means of quick paflage boats kept Tor this purpofe. The fame good look out is kept at the top of a mountain, call'd Fooqiut San, or the Jewel-flowers-mountain, not far from the town, whereupon they keep always a certain quantity of combuftible matter in readinefs to be fet on fire, in cafe a fleet of ten or more European fhips mould be dif- cover'd to fail towards the harbour, or upon certain advice of the ar- rival of any Portuguefe Ships, they being abfolutely and for ever de- nied all entrance into the Empire, or laftly in cafe of a fudden infur- re&ion in any part of this weftern Ifland Khaju. This fire, which however cannot be lighted without the confent, or exprefs order from the Governors, fuddenly alarms the country, as being a fign of fome impending great misfortune, which requires fpeedy help. It is feen as far as a high mountain in the Province Amakufa, where they light another, which is feen as far as Figo. By this means, and by fuc- ceflively lighting other fires upon feveral mountains along the Southern coafts of Japan^ warning can be given to the court at Jedo within four and twenty hours. The Town of Nagafaki, and its Inhabitants, are under the fu- . preme direction of the Imperial Governors, commanded by four N w«][" Burghermafters, or Mayors, and their Deputies. They exercife this office a year at a time, and are during their mayoralty call'd ~8inban, which in a litteral fenfe fignifies, the yearly warden, or watchman, that is, the commanding Mayor, or Burghermafter. His bufinefs is to ac- quaint the commanding Governor, with his daily tranfaclions in the execution of his office, to make his report of things of great impor- tance in perfon, in difficult cafes, or difagreements arifing between him and the other Mayors, to lay the cafe before the Emperor's Bench, or Court of Juftice, or with the confent of that Court to leave it to the Governors, to be by them determin'd in the laft refort. All civil affairs are brought before this Imperial Court of Judica- The CouH ture, the parties and their witneffes are by them examin'd, and after oftheEmpe- a formal hearing of council on both fides, judgment is given accord- ' ing 276 The Hiftoryof] A P A N. , Book IV. ing to the laws of the Empire, their printed reports, the imperial orders and proclamations, or the opinion of perfons learn'd in the Law. Sentence being once given in this Court, there is no appeal to any other. However, fuch perfons as have receiv'd fentence of death cannot be executed, without a warrant fign'd by the council of ftite at Jedo, which muft be likewife confulted in all affairs of mo- ment, and which more immediately concern the publick welfare of the Empire, provided they be of fuch a nature, as not to be pre- judiced by the delays, the fending and return of an exprefs re- quire. Tji) Jon. The four Mayors, or Burghermafters, are otherwife call'd To Sij Jori Sju, that is, according to the litteral fignification of the Characters, whereby thefe words are exprefs'd, the Seniors, or Elder Men (Alder- men) becaufe they were formerly chofen out of the oldeft and mod prudent of the Inhabitants. But of late this office is become in a manner hereditary, and in regard to the Father's merit, the Son is fometimes fufFer'd to fucceed him in his employment, provided the Governors of the Town give their confent, and the Candidate be ap- prov'd of by the Emperor's Council of State, to whom he is to return thanks in perfon for this Angular mark of favour conferr'd upon him. At this very time Takaku Goparo, an Infant of eleven years, hath inherited the title and dignity of his Father Takaku Sijro Bioje, who died about a year ago, and when he comes of age, he will be entrufted with the office it felf. Another of the prefent Mayors Takaku Saje- won, who was formerly call'd Takaku Genfo, hath already five years ago upon his Father's death inherited his title and dignity, tho' as yet he is but two and twenty years of age. Nay, there are three near relations of the family of Takaku poffefs'd at prefent of the Mayoralty, and a fourth of the fame family hath the command of the adjacent Country. The Mayors, or Burghermafters of Nagafaki, formerly depended of the Emperor's Council of State, from whom likewife they had their commiflion. They enjoy'd at that time the privilege of wearing two Scymeters, like the Noblemen of the King- dom, and of having a Pike carried before them, as a publick badge of their authority. But fince the Governors of this City, have been inverted by the Emperor with a greater power and authority, than they had before, which was done in the year 1683, the grandeur and power of the Burghermafters was reduc'd here, and in other Im- perial Cities, to a narrower compafs. Amongft many privileges and immunities, which they were then oblig'd to part with in favour of the Governors, were their elections and the laying of Taxes upon the Inhabitants. In fihort, they have little left of their former ftate and grandeur, excepting, that having difcharg'd the yearly functions of their office, they muft according to the cuftom of the Country, go up to Court, to pay their refpett to the Emperor, and to lay before the Chap II. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 277 the Imperial Council of State, an account of the mod material tran- sections during their Mayoralty, as alfo to receive from the fame frefh inftruftions as to their further conduct. In the mean time to make the di (charge of their office more eafy to them, they are al- low'd two deputies, who *pfTift them chiefly in the affairs which re- late to the management of the T/iotomatz, or new Town. The DJiojoJt, that is, in the literal fenfe, continual, or perpetual ^m" heads, or officers, becaufe their ports are for life, are next to the Tofijori, or Mayors, in rank and authority, being as it were their Lieutenants, or Deputies, in the affairs relating to the management of the Tfiotomatz, or outward town, whilft they, the Mayors thern. felves, with their Ottonas, have the immediate government of the TJtfimatz, or inner town. (Ottona is another particular Magiftrate, and as it were, Juftice of peace of the flreet wherein he lives, as I ihall Ihew more at large in the next Chapter.) It is one branch of the office of the DJiojofi, to accommodate and to make up, in company with the Ot- tona's, differences of fmall confequence arifing in that part of the Town which is committed to their care. They are chofen out of the company of the Ottona's, by the commanding Mayor, with the con- fent of the Governor, and generally taken out from amongfl the oldeft members of this company. They have, as well as the Mayors, fome fmall matter aflign'd them by the Emperor, by way of a SzW ry, and fome perquifites arifing from the foreign trade fo fir as they are concern'd in it, and yet, as the common people judge of the im- portance of their office by the figure and appearance they make, fo they eijdeavour to keep up their dignity, living always in a fplen- did poverty. Next to the D/lojoJi follow four Nengioji. The Character expreiTing Nr>r -, n n the word Ndngioji, fignifies as much, as annual heads or officers, which th.?y actually are, for as much as they are continued in their employ- ment only for a year. They are four in number, two of the Ui(i y and two of the Sotomatz. They are appointed by the Mayors, in tfieir name to make a faithful report to the Governors of the daily tranfactions in the execution of their office. They are at the lame time a kind of reprefentatives for the people, whofe intereft they are to take care of at the Governor's court. For both thefe purpo- fes they have a fmall room aflign'd them in the Governor's Pahce, next to the Getiquaban, or the great guard of the Joriki's, where they are waiting all day long, till the Governor is at leifure to re- ceive the mefl'ages, they are to deliver in the name of the Mayors, or the petitions, they are to prefent him with in the name of pri- vate perfons, and to let them know, either by word of mouth, or by fome of his Karoo, what commands he hath to lay, either upon the Tosij Jori's, or the Ottona's, or the Interpreters of the foreign nations eftabliuYd here, as alfo to acquaint them, what other bufinefs 1 A a a a he 278 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. he expedls fhould be done by the inhabitants, either at his own houfe, or elfewhere. It is a very nice and troublefome office, and. requires all the prudence and attention they are capable of, if they have it at heart to maintain themfelves in the Governor's fa- vour. They are chofen, as well as the Dfiojofi^ from amongfl the ableft Ottona's of both parts of the town. Thefe are the chief magiflrates and commanding officers of the town of Nagafaki. They have no Town-houfe, nor any other pub- lick place of affembly. When they meet upon bufinefs, it is at the prefiding Mayor's houfe. I proceed now to give a fhort account of fome other inferior offi- cers, by whofe means and affifhnce, policy and good order are kept up in this town. a>mpa»y 4 Tfwofiiio Mono, is the company of Town-meflengers, who ferve alfo as pri, Conflables and Bailiffs. They flood formerly under the command of the Mayors, but fince their power and authority hath been reduced to a narrower bottom, and that of the Governor's raifed upon their their ruin, they are employ'd chiefly in the fervice of the latter. This company confifts of about thirty families, living together in one flreet, which is from thence call'd Tfwofimatz, that is, the Town Mejfenger's flreet, and hath been in their pofTeflion time almoft out of mind. Their number increafes, in proportion as the ftrid and good re- gulations, to which the Inhabitants are kept, increafe, and very lately, a new flreet hath been begun to be built for them, which is to be call'd Sintfloofimatz, that is, the new town Meffenger's flreet. Their name is more honefl, than their profeffion, which confifls chiefly in pur- furng and arrefling of criminals. They are alfo now and then em- ploy'd at publick executions, chiefly beheading. They are all good wrefller9, and have their particular ways quickly to catch and difable their antagonifl, tho' never fo much upon his guard. For the exe- cution of their office, they always carry a halter about them. Their office, tho' low and contemptible in facl, is reputed, in law, military and noble. For this reafon, they wear two Scimiters like the Noble- men. Some of their company are of lefs note, and call'd SaJft. Thefe wear only one Scimiter. The Sons follow their Father's pro- feffion, and either fucceed them upon their death, or are admitted into the company before. T ^ punifhments could be bought off with money, it would be in the power of the rich to commit what crimes they pleafe, a thing in their opinion, and in its very nature, abfurd and inconfiftent with reafon and juflice. This is the reafon^ why they know of none but corporal punifhments, death, imprifon- ment, Chap. III. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 283 ment, banifhment, lofs of eftates, preferments, and the like. They have variety of torments to torture their criminals, and to bring them to confeflion, but when convi&ed and cad for their life, they are either beheaded, or laid on the crofs, according to the nature and heinoufnefs of the crime, for which they are to be executed. Other punifhmems, and thefe often infii&ed for crimes and mifdemeanors of others, tho fdmetimes never fo trifling, are, imprisonment for life, banifh- ment from the town, or country, with the lofs of eflate and places. Thefe and the like no body ever lives fecure from, forafmuch as they are afflrcled even for the crimes of others, and may befal one unawares. Thus the Street-officers mufl fuffer for the crimes of the Houfe-keepers, who live within the diftricl committed to their truft, the Houfe-keepers for the crimes of their domefticks and lodgers, the matters for thofe of their fervants, children for thofe of their parents ; a corporation for thofe of its individual members, and laflly, neighbours for the crimes of each other. In inflifting thefe punifh- ments however, great regard is had to the nature of the crime, the condition of the perfon who committed it, and the (hare of guilt to be laid in reafon, to the charge of his fuperiors, relations, or neighbours. Befides the burden of fo many different watches, which mufl be kept within and without the town, and in the harbour, and fo many troublefome offices which mufl be ferv'd perfonally, or by deputy's, another confiderable difadvantage, the inhabitants of Nagafaki labour under, is, that every now and then the flreets are for fome time en- tirely fhut up, and no body fuffer'd to go in or out. This is done, when they are apprehenfive of fome danger, mutiny, or infurre&ion, or in cafe of fearch after criminals, and in many other inquiries, tho' as it often happens, after very trifling things. But there is ne- ver fo much caution and ftri&nefs ufed, as upon the departure of foreign fhips and yonks, in order to prevent the inhabitants from following them, to fmuggle goods, which is a crime forbid under pain of death. When the outward-bound fhips fet fail, till they are got out of fight of the harbour, flrift fearch is made in all the flreets, to fee, whether there be none of the inhabitants wanting, that could be fufpe- pecled to be out upon fome fuch occafion or other. This fearch is made at uncertain times, but thrice every night, as for infhnce, fometime in the evening, about midnight, and the next morning, ia prefence of the Ottona, if he be at leifure, of an Ognmigafijra, or the Ottona'% deputy, of two Koogumi Oja, or Chiefs of Corporations, and the Nitzi Jofi, or Street's-mefTenger. Every body mufl be pre- fent at thefe fearches, to anfwer when callM by his name. The Street's-meflenger reads the names of all the domefticks out of the Regifler-book. For difpatches fake he fometimes fatisfies himfelf with comparing the number of heads prefent, with the number of people mention'd in his book, without afking for every one in particular. During 284 The Hiftoryof J A P A N. Book IV. During the time of this fearch, and when the Street-gates are fhut up, as alfo at other times, when they are apprehenfive of fome mif- chief, tho' the gates be not fhut, no body is fuffer'd to pafs through from one ftreet into another, without a Forifuda^ a fmall flick of wood, mark'd by the prefiding Mayor, or Burgher-mafter. Upon fiiewing this particular kind of paffport, he is by the Monban, or Round-watch of every ftreet, accompany'd from one end of the ftreet to the other, and then deliver'd up to the Monban of the next ftreet, and fo on, till he comes to the place he defign'd to go to. If an inhabitant defigns to leave the ftreet and houfe he lives in, and to re- move to another, he muft firft of all apply to the Ottona of the other ftreet, with a petition, fetting forth his defire to be admitted amongft the inhabitants of this ftreet, When he delivers the petition, he at the fame time prefents the Ottona with a dim of fifh. The Ottona upon this informs himfelf of his life, character and conduct, and then fends the Nitzi Jofi, or MefTenger of the Street, to every one of the inhabitants, defiring them to let him know, whether or no they would content to admit the petitioner as a neighbour. If any one of the Inhabitants oppofes his admiffion, and hath any thing to lay to his charge, as for inftance, that he is given to drunken- nefs, or of a quarrelling humour, or inclin'd to any other crime, the confequences whereof he protefts, that he will not be anfwerable for, it is fuflicient to exclude him. But if the petitioner obtains the con- fent of all the inhabitants, he applies to the Fijia, or publick notary of his former ftreet, for a certificate of his behaviour, and a letter of difmiflion, both fign'd by the Ottona. Thefe two Inftruments are by the Nitzi Jo/i, or Street's-mefTenger, carry'd over to the Ot- tona of the ftreet the petitioner intends to remove into, who thereupon receives him under his protection, and incorporates him amongft the in- habitants of his ftreet. In the mean time he is not anfwerable for the petitioner's behaviour, before the delivery of the faid two inftru- ments, and if he fhould be found guilty of any crimes committed before that time, it would be laid to the charge of the ftreet he for- merly liv'd in. For this reafon the Ottona of that ftreet protefts in his letter of difmiflion, that from the time of his difmiflion he will have nothing to anfwer for his conduct and behaviour, which makes it incumbent upon the petitioner to take care, that the abovefaid writs be deliver'd to his new Ottona with all poflible fpecd. After the pe- titioner hath been admitted amongft the inhabitants of the new ftreet^ and his name enter'd into the Regifter-books of the fame, he folemni- zes his entry with a handfome dinner, which he gives, either to his own Knmigafi]ra y or Corporation, or if he pleafes, to all the Corporations of the ftreet. After all this trouble, the greateft difficulty ftill re- mains, and that is, the felling of his old houfe. This again cannot be done, without the joint confent of all the inhabitants of the ftreet. Chap III. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 285 ftreet, and thefe often oppofe it for a year and upwards, the perfon of the buyer, for whofe mifdemeanors they are to fufFer for the fu- ture, being either not fufticiently known, or not agreeable to them. But all obftacles being at laft rcmov'd, and the houfe fold, the buyer is to pay 8 per cent in the Sotomatz, and {bmething upwards of 12 in the Utfimatz of the price agreed for between him and the feller, into the publick treafury of the ftreet, for the common benefit of the inhabitants. Of this money, which is call'd Fatfijbun, or the eighth part, five parts are to be equally diftributed amongft the inhabitants, for the pains they have been at upon account of his admifllon, and the three remaining parts are defign'd for a publick dinner, which however is feldom given. As foon as the new Inhabitant hath taken poiTefllon of his houfe, all his neighbours of the fame ftreet come to wifh him joy, to offer their fervices to him, and to affaire him of all friendfhip and neighbourly affiftance on their part. When an inhabitant of any of the ftreets of Nagajakz intends to go abroad, to make a pilgrimage to fome holy place, or upon any other bufinefs whatever, the Kogoml Oja, or Chief, and the reft of the members of the Corporation he belongs to, rnuft give him a certificate addrefs'd to the magiftrates of the town, wherein they te- ftify, that it is fuch or fuch an honeft and good intention, which obliges him to g« abroad, and that in the mean time they will be- come bail for his return and appearance, within a certain determin'd time. For this purpofe they have a particular book calld, Kitte no fi- ta Gaki, that is, the book for figning of paflports, wherein upon thefe occafions the inhabitants, by order of the Ottona, write their names under the abovefaid certificate, and for a ftill better fecurity put their feals thereunto. The certificate and obligation being enter'd into the faid book, it is then, by order of the Ottona, carried by the Street's-mefTenger to the houfe of the Ninban Tqfij Jori, or prefiding Mayor, and deliver'd to the Genquaban, or great Houfe-guard. The Genquaban prefents it to the Mayor, who orders his Jufitz, or Se- cretary, to write a pafTport for the petitioner, and to feal it with his great feal, which he makes ufe of only during the time of his mayoralty. This feal, is in the cuftody of the Jufitz : It is about the bignefs of a crown, and confifts of the character of his own Nanori, or Military-family Name. This paffport is afterwards brought to the Nengiosj, who puts alfo his name and feal to it, or in his place to the Dfto Jofi of the Sottomatz, if the petitioner be an inha- bitant of that part of the town. There are no fees to be paid for all this trouble, excepting only three Condors, which muft be given to the Nitzi Jofi, or Street's-mefTenger, for a ftrong thick fheet of paper, which he furnifhes for it, this being one of the per- quifites of his office. C c c e If 2 86 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. Proceedings in If an inhabitant of the ftreet is accufed of any crime, or mifde- Criminal Jf- meanor> hj s C afe is laid, in the firft place, before the Street's-council, or the affembly of its chief officers, being the Ottona, his three Kitmi Gafjra, or Deputies, and all the Kogomi Oja, or Heads of Corporations. If upon examining into the fame they find it too difficult to be made up amongft themfelves, or too intricate, and beyond their power or capacity, they lay it before the common council of the town. If the members of this meet with the fame difficulties, the Nengiofi are defir'd to confer thereupon with fome of the Governor's Karoo's, and if they find it neceflary, to communicate it to the Governors themfelves. The fame method is obferv'd in delivering the Governors commands to the inhabitants. He acquaints the Nengiofi, either in perfon, or by fome of his Karoo's. The Nengiofi commu- nicate them to the Mayors of the town, and thefe to the Ottona\ who publifh the fame in their flreets, either in perfon, or by their Nitzi Jofi's, that is, the Street's-meffengers. Sometimes the Governor publilhes his command^ by written proclamations, which are look'd upon, by all the inhabitants, as Laws and inviolable Imperial Orders. Din/ion of jf quarrels, or difputes, arife in a ftreet, whether it be between nts, c " v -" the inhabitants, or ftrangers, the next neighbours are oblig'd forthwith to part the fray, for if one fhould happen to be kill'd, tho' it be the aggreffor, the other muft inevitably fuffer death, notwithstanding his moderamen inculpate tntel Marys This is the Jefumi, that is, in the ftrideft fenfe, the figure-treading, becaufe they trample over the Image of our Bleffed Saviour extended on the crofs, and that of his holy Mother, or fome other Saint, as a convincing and unqueftionable proof, that they for ever renounce Chrift and his Religion. This deteftable folemnity begins on the fe- cond day of the firft month. They begin in two different places at the fame time, and go on from ftreet to ftreet, and houfe to houfe, difpatching four, five and more ftreets a day, till the whole is compleated, which takes up at leaft fix days. The officers of the ftreet, who muft be prefent at this aft, are, the Ottona, or head of the ftreet j his three Oogumi Oja, or deputies j the Fiziu, or Secretary, Nitzi Jofi y or meffenger of the ftreet, befides two Monban, or Watchmen, who carry the Images about. The Images are about a foot long, caft in brafs, and kept in a particular box made for this purpofe. The aft itfelf is perform'd in the following order. After the Inquifitors have feated themfelves on a mat, the landlord, his family, and all his do- me flicks, of both fexes, old or young, and whoever elfe lodges in the fame 288 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. fame houfe, and fometimes alio the next neighbours, if their houfes be not big enough, for the ad to be celebrated therein, are call'd to- gether into the room, where the above-mention' d Images are laid upori the bare floor, after which the Jefttmi Tfto cr Secretary of the Inquifition, takes the lift of the Inhabitants, and reads their names, one by one, compelling them to appear as they are call'd, and to walk over the faid Images with their feet. Young children, as yet not able to walk, are by their mothers taken upon their arms, and held down to touch the Images with their feet. This being done the landlord puts his feal to the lift, as a certificate to be laid before the Governour, that the inquifition hath been perfcrm'd in his houfe* After they have gone in this manner thro' all the ftreets and houfes of the town, the inquifitors themfelves trample over the Images, and laft of all the Ottona, they ferving as witneiles for each other, and confirming alfo their certificates with their feals. This inquifition is perform'd only at Kagafaki, in the diftricl of Omura and the Province of Bungo, where formerly the Chriftian Religion had got the ftrongeft footing. f>r»c e ( £»gs in When anybody dies, his landlord, or if the landlord dies himfelf, his Cafe efDuth. fa m \\y mu ft defire the Kogomi, or members of the corporation, which the houfe belongs to, to be witneffes of his death, both as to its being natural and unchriftian. Thefe fit on the body, and view it narrowly, to fee whether or no there be any external figns of vio- lence, or marks of the Chriftian religion, whereof if they find none, they give them a certificate fign'd with their hands and feals, which is by the Nitzi Giofi prefented to the prefiding Mayor. There are but few taxes raie'd upon the Inhabitants of Nagafaki, and only upon thofe who have fome eftate in land within the Town, either by inheritance or acquifition. The reft of the Inhabitants being not look'd upon as true Citizens, or Freemen, are alfo in regard thereof exempted from the land taxes, and other charges, notwith- ftanding they make out far the greater number. The Taxes levied upon the reft of the Inhabitants are LaxJTtx. Dfjfi Gin, is properly the Land-Tax, or Ground-rents, rais'd in the Emperor's name in the eighth month, upon all fuch perfons as have houfes, or pieces of ground of their own, within the town. The ground is not meafur'd according to the area quadrats, or fquare furface, but only according to the length, to wit, the front of the houfe, or houfes towards the ftreet, and they muft pay four Maas in the Soto, and fix Maas in the Utzi Town for every Kin they have in front. A Kin is a meafure about the length of a fathom. It is not regarded how deep the houfes run backwards, unlefs the depth ex- ceeds fifteen Kin, which if it doth but the breadth of a £w, or Straw, a double ground-rent muft be paid for it j and this, they fay, becaufe it / Chap. III. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 289 in is for the Emperor, to whom juftice muft be done in the ftricleft manner poflible. Faffaku Gin, is another Tax laid upon the Inhabitants of Nagafaki, if other- E*/H« Gi», wife itdeferves that name, being rather a voluntary contribution for a pre- fent to be made to the Governors, by all fuch perfons, as have hereditary lands Or tenements, in poifeffion within the town, or to fuperior officers by. their inferiors. This prefent is ufually made upon the firfl day of the eighth month, which being a Fefb'val-day, call'd Faffaku, it hath thence obtain'd the name of Faffaku Gin, that is, Faffaku Money, Thofe perfons, who are in publick ports, and have a (hare in the manage- ment of the town, ma^:e befides the common and general contribution, another particular prefent, each according to his pleafure or abil:: ; es, to the Governors of the town, to the Treafurer and Sur of the Imperial Lands and Rents redding at Nagafaki, and to the Mayors. Even the Interpreters fons, I mean thofe who are inftrucled in foreign languages, in hopes of , fucceeding their fathers in their employments, make upon this occafion a prefent to each of the Governors of 25 Maas, and to the other juft-mention'd fuperior officers in proportion; This contribution money is not levied upon the common people, till after the faid feftival-day :, it is gather'd in all the flreets, and then de- liver'd to the Governors. They raife it according to the extent cf the ground, which the houfes Hand upon, afking for the Kasjo of each houfe in the Sotomatz, 6, and in the Utfimatz, from 9 to 10 Maas, which makes in all 4350 Kasjo, or 2630 Tails, allowing 50 Kaf- jo fur every ftreet. Kasjo is a fquare furface, as it was meafur'd in the firfl: divifion of the ground, which the ftreet was afterwards built upon, and as it is enter'd in the publick Rental or Ground-book cf the town. In fuccefs of time feveral Kasjo's were brought tcgc- gether into one large building, others were divided into two fmall houfes. This tax upon the Kasjo's of the houfes,is levied no where but at Nagafaki, in consideration whereof, and in order to afilft the inhabi- tants of this town towards the eafier payment of thefe fupernumera'ry charges, they have invented the Famiagin. F anna gin (of which more ^- mna l in - hereafter) is call'd that money, which the Governors detain from the price of foreign commodities for the joint benefit of the inhabitants, amongft whom it is afterwards propcrtionably divided. In all other towns throughout the Empire, whether they belong to the Imperial demefns, or crown-lands, or to the Lords of particular Provinces, no other tax is levied upon the inhabitants, but the ground-rent above mention'd. The City of Miaco was by a particular privilege, granted to it by the Emperor Taiko, exempted from both, and remains fuch to this day. Befides thefe two taxes, there are fome other expences of iefs note which muft be bore by thofe inhabitants of Nagafaki, who have land in poiTefliQn within the compafs of the town. Moft of thefe are era- D d d d ploy'd 2 9 o The Hijlorj (fJAPAN. Book IV. ploy'd in honour of the God Suwa, who is the patron and prote- ctor of the town, as for inftance, 800 Sinmome's for the maintenance of his temple, and the perfons who attend it, as alfo for Comedies to be a&ed for his diverfion in his temple j, and laftly for the repairs of the temple. However, towards defraying thefe charges, nothing muft. be taken out of the Famiagin, or the funis of money arifing from the foreign trade, but the whole expence muft be rais'd by volun- tary contributions of the freemen of the town. The feftival-day of this Saint is another considerable article, being celebrated with great pomp and folemnity, with pfccefTions, drama's, plays, dancing, and all manner of publick diverfions. But' notwithstanding this is done once every year, yet the inhabitants of the town are not all oblig'd to contribute yearly towards the fame, the necefiary fums being rais'd only upon ten or eleven ftreets at a time, fo that they pay but once in feven or eight years, when their turn falls upon them. This regulation hath been made, in order to make the payment eafy to them. However, that quarter of the town, where the publick ftews Stand, is not indulg'd in this particular, for they muft contribute their quota every year. This feftival being always celebrated with the utmoft pomp and magnificence, with new plays, proceflions, fongs, dances and fo on, all the aclors appearing in new d redes, and every thing being paid for very dear, 'tis no wonder, that expences run high, infomuch that from three to four hundred Siumome muft be rais'd upon every ftreet. JJva*t*ges The Situation of this populous town, upon the extremity of the 0/ the Tou» p r0 vince Fifen, between the Sea and high mountains, almoft at the iifwg ga fioL end of a fecure and convenient harbour, though on one hand it be very the foreign advantagious for the trade and commerce with fuch foreigners, as are fuffer'd and tolerated by this jealous nation, yet on the other it is attended with this confiderable difadvantage, that the produce of the adjacent Country is by no means Sufficient to maintain the In- habitants, much lefs to enable them to pay the necefiary taxes and contributions. BeSIdes, as the very trade, for which the Town is fo commodioufly feated, puts the Inhabitants to a good deal of Supernumerary trouble, cofts, difcontents and vexations, fo reafon, and the nature of things, hath taught them, that maxim of Jujlini- ans ^ Secundum naturam ejfe, commoda cujus cunque rei eum fequi, quern fequuntur incommoda : That it is but natural, that he Jljould enjoy the advantages arifing from a thing, who hath all the trouble of it. There- fore, ailbon as the fupreme direction of the foreign trade was put into the hands of the Governours, proper ways and means were found out to make the fame advantageous and profitable to their Sub- jects j, nay, it were to be wiSh'd that they had not gone ftill fur- ther, under the pretext of a maxim, juft and reafonable in it felf, unjuftly to defraud foreigners of a reafonable and lawful gain, for no Chap. III. The Hi (lory of JAPAN. 291 no other reafon but to enable the natives to pay the necefTary taxes, and to make it eafier for them to maintain themfelves. The money thus rais'd is by them call'd Fanna Gin, which is as much as to fay, Flower Money, perhaps becaufe they are in expeclation, that ftill greater advantages, than they have already fecured to themfelves, will flow- er out of the foreign trade, or becaufe they compare this money to the flowers, and the gain of the merchants to the fruits. It conliiis of what the Governors of the Town, and their fubaltern officers, by many a fraudulent contrivance, detract and detain from the price and profit of all foreign goods, which are here expos'd to fale. Thus much how- ever muft be owned in juftice to the Governours, that they them- felves have no fhare in this money. But their fubaltern officers, and the Magistrates of the Town, and in general all perfcns, who have any thing to do with the foreign nations eftablifh'd here, on account of their trade, divide part of it among themfelves, as lawful and jufl fees, due for the trouble they muft be at, on their behalf. The remainder is fent to the Kanna Sa, or Treafury of every ftreet. This laft part Is left to the difpofal of the Ottona, who divides it equally amongft the Inhabitants, according to the number of Kafio. they are poffefs'd of, keeping always fo much in referve, as he thinks requifite for the necefTary repairs of the ftreet, of its gates, fountains, and publick build- ings, of the Inflruments for extinguishing fires, as alfo for the expences to be laid out on account of fuch publick works, as muft be done by order, and for the Governors of the Town, all which expences the OtVona accounts for annually, fending his accounts to every Inhabitant of his ftreet for their perufal. The dividend is made by order of the Gover- nors, two, three, and four, times a year, or more according to the number of Camban, that is, fales of foreign commodities allowed of. Whoever de- fires no (hare in the divifion of this publick money, is alfo for that rea- fon exempted from the common burdens of the ftreet, fuch as ferving many a troublefome office, keeping the watch and round at night, and the like, nor is he obliged to pay any other Tax, but the imperial ground- rent, and the Fajfaku Gin, or contribution money for a prefent to the Governors. But notwithftanding this is a very confiderable advantage, yet to my knowledge, there are very few, even among the richeft Inhabitants' of the Town, willing to purchafe it for their fhare of this Fan^i agin, or Flower money. Thus much of the Government of this City in general, and of the Government policy and regulation of its ftreets in particular. The account, winch if other plans. I have hitherto given, may ferve as a pattern of the Government, as it is eftablifh'd in ail other towns, burroughs, and villages, through- out the Empire, whether they belong to the Imperial demefns, or are fubjed to other Princes and Lords, with this difference only, that the magiftrates, tho' inverted with the fame power, have perhaps different names 292 The Hiftory of] A P A N. Book IV. names, an 1 that the government in general is not near fo ftricT: and rigorous in other places, as it is at Kagafaki. GevernmtHtvf Before the clofe of this chapter, it will not be improper to add a •"-'''' few words concerning the government of the neighbouring villages and adjacent countrv , which, extend fome few miles from the town up towards the mountains. The fame is in the hands cf an Imperial Steward , who in his Mailer's name gathers the yearly Ncngu, as they call it, or fcot of rice, corn, and alt the produce of cultivated fields. For fuch fpots of ground, as are planted with fruit-trees, or garden-fluff, there muft be fo much money paid a year, as, according to a reafonable computation, the fcot it- felf would amount to, if they were turn'd to rice, or corn-fields. The fcot of rice, or com, amounts to fomewhat mere than half the crop, which the husband-man muft bring to the Okw-a, or Komegnra, (Imperial Magazines, which ftand near Mangcme, or the North-fuburb) clean and ready threfii'd at his own coft, according to an eftimate made by proper furveyors, who, before the harveft begins, go out to- furvey the fields, and to make their computation accordingly, either by conjecture, or if the harveft is like to prove very good, by ordering a Tfubo, (or a fquare fpot of ground of a Kin or fathom) to be cut and threfh'd, and inferring from thence, what the whole crop will amount to. Woods and Forefts pay a fmall DJife Gin, cr Ground-rent, which differs according to the number of Tfubo's, and the eoodnefs and fruitfulnefs of the foil. The revenue of the land about Kagafaki, fumm'd up according to the cuftom of the country, mates in all 3000 Koku, which amounts in money, one year with another, the price of this commodity being very variable, to 15000 Siumonie, each Koku reckon'd at five Shimome. The management and infpe&ion of thefe lands hath been for a considerable time heredi- tary in the illuftrious Family of Sije Tfiigu Fefo, and the heirs miles thereof. They govern'd in quality of J)aiquans, or Independant Im- perial Commiilioners, with a ftate fuitable to the majefty of their mafter, and becoming the dignity of their office, and withal main- tain'd themfelves in fo much credit and favour at court, that the Go- vernor's of Nagafaki themfelves, their high rank and authority not- withstanding, fhew'd a great regard for them, and often confulted them in affairs of moment relating to the government of the town. But a fatal incident, which happen'd in the year 1676, at once put an end to the grandeur of this family, and to the dignity of this heredi- tary employment. For upon difcovery of fome fwords, and other arms, hid in a mat, which were to be fent privately to Corea, by the direction of his Fedai, or Steward, this unfortunate wretch, and his accomplice, were condemn'd to the crofs, and executed upon the fmall Ifiand Sufu da Ga/ima, oppofite to the town, after they had been carried in fhew thro' the principal ftreets of Nagafaki. His only fen, an Chap IU. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 293 an innocent: child but feven years old, was likewife carried about in this mel.incholly proceflion, upon the arms of one of the execu- tioners, and afterwards beheaded in fight of his father, who hung on the crofs : not to mention the executions and fevere punifhments of fome merchants, and other perfons concern'd in this unhappy affair. The old Daiquan had his fhare in the punifhment, according to the laws of the Empire, and was, with his two fons, baniOYd to the Iiland Okino Sima, fituate near the Province Tfugokf. His Wife, who wa9 the mother of the two fons, was exiPd to FimnJo. During my ftay in Japan, in 1692, feveral perfons of this unhappy family were as yet alive, as alio the man, who difcover'd the whole affair, and who was formerly a fervant to one that was executed, but afterwards, in c liideration of his merit, and the he zeal fhew.'d upon this occafion for the laws of the country, rais'd to the place of Dejima Ottona. Ever fince that time, no matt whatever may be fold to the Dutch, or Chi- nefe, without being firft very narrowly fearch'd. His Port was given to Fakaki Sakujemon, who now hath the inflection • and government of thefe lands, under the direction, and with the afiiftance of two of the Mayors of the town, tho' without the title of Daiquan, and which is more, without the power attending that title. For he hath not the privilege, as all the Daiquans have, of having a pike carried before him, as a badge of the independant authority they are inverted with by their mafler. Nor is he permitted to wear two fwords, like the Noblemen of the country, and the Imperial officers, both which pre- rogatives he was depriv'd of, at the very beginning of his office. He lives with no more fplendour, or magnificence, than a common inhabitant of the town, nor can he, of his own accord, undertake to do even fuch things, as otherwife his employment feems to entitle him to. This appear'd by a late inftance, when, without the confent of the Governors, he could not put to death a fervant of his, convi- cted of having twice robb'd him, notwithftanding that, according to the laws of the country, the fervants are fo far at their mafter's difpo- fal, that if in the height of their paflion they fliould unfortunately kill them, nothing would be laid to their charge, provided they can fufficiently prove the crime, which they punifh'd them for. Eeee CHAP. 294 The Hi fi° r y 0/ J A P A N. Book IV. CHAP. IV. Of the Temples and Clergy of this City Temples **i r | "10 compleat the defcription of Nagafaki, it remains to give an clergy Of No- account of its Temples and Clergy. The Clergy is divided Z a J akj ' j nt0 different Se&s and Religions. Thofe of every particular Seel have their Head, General, or Chief, refiding at Miaco, the centre of religion, devotion and holinefs, where is kept the court of the Ecclefiafti- cal hereditary Emperor, Thence they fend out their deputies or as one would call them in the ftile of Europe, Provincials, Superiors, Abbots and Friors, into every Province for the direction and government of its Clergy, Convents and Temples. At Nagafaki, and in the neighbourhood of this Town, altho' there be feveral Temples and religious Houfes belonging to one Sect, or Religion, as for inflance, the Budfdos Religi- on, yet they have no particular Head, or Bifhop of the Diocefe, as one might call him, fet over them, but ftand all under the immediate command of their General at Miacv. Amongfl the Sin or Cami, that is, the national Gods, I muft men- /'"'/'jva-' tion in the firft place, the Udfigami of this Town. Udfigami, is the l*f«k>- chief God, Saint and Prote&or of a Province, City, or Village. The Inhabitants of "Nagafaki acknowledge, and worfhip as fuch, Suwa Dai Miofin, that is, the great holy Idol Suwa. His Temple flands not far from the Town upon the mountain Tatta. A fine ftaircafe of ftone of two hundred fteps leads up to the Mia, before which he is wor- fhip'd,and which isthehighefl building of his Temple, for Suwa having had very lately a more illuftrious Title, conferr'd on him by the Dairi, or the Court of the Ecclefiaftical hereditary Emperor, his- Mia alfo was to be built higher, than it flood before. The Temple-court flands fomewhat lower than the Mia it felf, upon the declivity of the mountain aforefaid. At the entry of the Court, next to the gate, is a long open room, or gallery, where Plays are afted for the diverfion both of Suwa and his worfhippers. This room is curioufly adorn'd with many fine Pictures and carv'd Images, being the ufual prefents and gifts, which the adherents of this religion, upon occafion, vow to give to the Sinsja, or Temples of the national Gods. Further off ftand fome fmall Chapels, or Tern- pies, built of wood, clean and neat, but without any other ornaments. In the fame Court ftand the Temples of Murafaki Dai Gongen, that is, the great and jufl Murafaki, and Symios Dai Miofin, that is, the great and holy Symios j each of thefe two Gods hath alfo his Mikoft, or fmall eightangular fhrine, curioufly adorn'd and hanging in beau- tiful poles, wherein their images or relicks are carried about upon folemn Chap. IV. The Hijiory of J A P A N. 205 folemn days. I took notice alfo of another particular fmall Chapel, or Temple, built in honour of the God and Lord of thoufand Legs, hung about with numbers of his Clients, that is, with Legs of all forts and fizes, ■ given by his worfhipers to adorn it. There are feveral feftival days facred to Sitwa, the chief whereof, and at the fame time one of the great yearly holidays, is the ninth day of the ninth month, known by the name of Kwiitz, or Kuguatz Koko- noka. This being his birth-day, is celebrated with univerfal rejoycings throughout the Empire, but more particularly here at Nag/tfaki, he being the patron and protestor of this place, with univerfal pomp and mag- nificence, and a folemn Matfuri, that is, publick fpe&acles, plays, drama's, proceflions, and the like. The folemnity begins already upon the feventh day of the faid month. On the eighth day, which imme- diately preceeds the holiday it felf, the God is at the expence of rich and devout people diverted in his Temple, with a particular fort of a mufical confort, perform'd by boys beating upon drums and bells. This mufic is the very fame, which was made ufe of to appeafe the fupreme Cami, or God of the Country, Tenfio Dal Sin, when out of difdain and anger he hid himfelf in a cavern, and thereby deprived the world of light and fun. The 12th day of the ninth, or Suwa's birth month, being likewife facred to him, is celebrated chiefly with pub- lick plays and fpeftacles. The perfons attending the fervice of Suwa's Temples are call'd Nege, fometimes, tho' wrongly, Kuge, this Title belonging only to the holy Court of the Ecclefiaftical hereditary Emperor. They are like all other Sinjio, or Minifters of the Temples of the Sin, that is, national Gods of the Country, not Ecclefiaftical, but fecular and married perfons, tho' in the mean time they ail'ume to themfelves, by reafon of their honourable employment, a far higher degree of holinefs and refpecT, thati they think the com- mon bulk of fecular perfons deferve. They live with their families in houfes built for them in the defcent of the mountain aforefaid, not far from the Temple Court. Their way of Life, as well as their common drefs, at home and abroad, is no ways different from that of other Inhabitants, excepting only, that they do not (have their heads, but let their hairs grow, and tie them together behind their head : When they go to the Temple, they drefs in an Ec- clefiaftical habit, with various head dreffes, according to every one's office and quality. They maintain themfelves by the alms and of- ferings given them by the Inhabitants, at their appearance in the folemn proceflion of the Matfuri (of which more hereafter) and at other times, when they come to worfhip at the Temple. Rich people make them particular prefents the day before the great feftival of Suwa, which is the eighth day of the ninth month, and this for a particular Mufick to be perform'd extraordinary for the Idol's diverfion. Two of the Ottona's are appointed their infpeclors, one out 2 9 6 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. out of each part of the town, for which employment they receive a falary out of the publick money. They are aflifted by two other members of their company, attending them by turns, each a vear, but thefe are not paid for it. Their bufinefs is, to keep the temple, and its buildings, in repair, to take care of the maintenance of the Nege, as alfo to fee that the Matfuri, plays, and other pub- lick entertainments in honour of this Idol, be perform'd with that pomp and magnificence, which is thought becoming his great- nefs. The proceflions of this Secular Clergy, for fuch it is in fact, made in honour of this great Proteftor of Nagafaki, are perform'd with the following pomp and order, i. Two Led-horfes, halfftarv'd, and every whit as lean, as that which the Patriarch of Mo f con mounts on Pa! m-Sun Jays , when he rides to his Cathedral. 2. Several Eccle- fiaftical Enfigns, and badges of honour, fuch as were in ufe among their anceftors, and are fo to this day at the Ecclefiaflical Court at Miaco. Thefe are, for infhnce, a fhort broad lance gilt all over, a pair of fhoes remarkable for their largenefs and grofs workmanmip, a large bunch of white paper tied to the end of a fhort ffaff, as a badge of an Ecclefiaflical command. 3. Hollow benches, to place the Mikofi upon. Thefe are carried about inverted for the people to throw in their charity, for which purpofe alfo two labouring men are hir'd to carry about a ftrong large Alms-chefh 4. The Mikofi themfelves, be- ing eightangular fhrines, almoft too big to be carried by one man, lacker'd and curioufly adorn'd with gilt cornifhes, metal looking- glaffes, finely polifh'd -, and among other ornaments, a gilt crane at the top. 5. Two fmall wooden chairs, or palankins, fomewhat dif- ferent in fhape from a Norimon, and like thofe, which are in ufe at the court of the Ecclefiaflical Hereditary Emperor. In thefe are car- ried the two Superiors of the temple.. 6. Two other Led-horfes, with their full apparel, belonging to the faid fuperiors, full as lean and handfome as the two at the head of the proceflion. 7. The clergy in a body, walking on foot in good order, and with great decency. 8. The inhabitants and common people of Nagafaki, in the ufual confufion clofing the cavalcade. After the clergy are come to the temple -court, along with the Mikofi, fhrines and other ornaments, and have taken the places affign'd them, the deputies of the Governors make their appearance with their ufual retinue, and befides, becaufe of the folemnity of the day, with twenty long pikes of ftate, to the end whereof are tied bunches of fhavings of wood, lacker'd and painted, to reprefent, as it were, the feathers of an Indian Cock. Four of the chief, having firfl wafh'd their hands in the bafon flanding before the temple, walk up towards the fame, and with that humility, Avhich becomes the holinefs of the place, pay, in their matters, and in their cwn name, the ufual compliment to the two Superiors of the temple, who for this purpofe, and decently to receive the fame, have Chap. IV. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 297 have feated themfelves between the two Mikofi, or eightangular fhrines. This done, one of the Nege fills a large golden fpoon with a cer- tain fweet liquor call'd Amafaki, and pours it, in commemoration of their anceftors indigence, into a fmall, unglaz'd, earthen di(h, which he prefents to the deputies of the Governors. Amajaki is a particu- lar fort of beer brew'd out of boil'd rice, by letting it ferment over night. They ufually brew it before their great holidays, in order to drink it upon that occafion, and thereby to commemorate the fru- gal way of living of their anceftors, who knew of no other, but this eafy fimple brewing. Upon the firft of the holidays facred to Suwa, the two above mention'd bodies, I mean the clergy, and the depu- ties of the Governors, do not make their appearance till the feftiva 1 ad of the day is almoft over. But upon the third and great holiday* which is the Idols birth day, and one of the great yearly festivals* they appear early in the morning, in order to aflift at the enfuing Mat- furi. Matfuri fignifies properly fpeaking, and in a general lenfe, an offering made to a Canity in the fenfe it mud be taken in, to an- fwer the end of fo great a holiday, it denotes a folemn jubilee, to be celebrated with unufual rejoycings, proceflions, dancing, drama's and other publick fpe&acles, in honour and for the diverfion of that God or Idol, who is acknowledg'd and worfhip'd as Udfigami, that is, protec- tor of a place, upon his birth day. The Matfuri being one of the moft pompous folemnities that can be feen in this, or any other Town, I flatter my felf the reader, will not be difpleas'd to find a more particular defcription of one, which I faw myfelf at Nagafaki, and which may ferve for a pat- tern of others, as they are celebrated elfewhere. The Matfuri, as I took notice above, is celebrated at Nangafaki, in ho- particular nour of Suwa, on the ninth day of the ninth month, that being Su- tycripim »f wa's Birthday. It doth not confift in preaching, worlhipping, and go- " ing to the Temples, but in particular proceflions through the principal ftreets of the Town, and elegant publick fpe&acles, reprefented upon a large market-place built for this purpofe, which from the vifits, it receives on this day from the Idols of Suwa t and his Companion^ which are carried thither in proceflion, is call'd Oo Tabi Tokora, which is as much as to fay, the place of the high, or great Journey. On this place there is, for the folemnity of the day, built a temple of Bambou s with wings on each fide, the front laid open towards the place, and the roof cover'd with ftraw, and ending into a gable of Tfugi branches. This whole building fcarce deferves to be compared to one of our barns, it is fo mean and fimple, for it muft be purpofely built ac. cording to the forry architecture of their indigent anceftors, A tall firr ftands on each fide of the front of this temple. Three fides of the place are built round with benches and lodges for the conveniency of the fpeftators. F f f f Every 298 The Hi/lory of J A P AN. Book IV. Every thing being ready, the Sintos Clergy appears in a body, with a fplendid retinue, bringing oter in proceflion the Mikofi of their great Sinva as alio, to keep him company, that of Symios. Murafaki is left at home, becaufe there is no inftance in the Hiftory of his life and aftions, 4Vom which could be inferr'd, that he delighted in walking and travel- ling. The Sintos Clergy, upon this occafion, ftile themfelves Oota»ii t that is, the high, great retinue, which pompous title notwithftanding, the alms cheft is one of the principal things they carry about with them in the proceflion, and indeed to very good purpofe, for there is fuch a multitude of things thrown among them, by the crowds of fuperflitious fpeftators, as if they had a mind, out of a meer Chari- ty, to ftone them. When they come to the place aforefaid, the Ec- clefiafticks feat themfelves in good order, and according to their qua- lity, which appears in good meafure by their drefs, upon three benches built for them before the front of the temple. The two fuperiors of the temple take the uppermoft bench, clad in black, with a particular head ornament, and a fhort ftaff, as a badge of their authority. Four others, who are next to them in rank, fit upon the fecond bench, drefs'd in white Ecclefiaftical gowns with a black lacker'd cap, fome- thing different from that which their fuperiors wear. The majn bo- dy takes poffeflion of the third and lowermoft bench, fitting promi- fcuoufly, and all clad in white gowns, with a black lacker'd cap, fome- like thofe of the Jefuits. The fervants and porters appointed to car- ry the holy utenfils of the tern pie, and other people, who have any thing to do at this folemnity, ftand next to the Ecclefiafticks bare headed. On the other fide of the fquare, oppofite to the Ecclefiafticks, fit the deputies of the governors under a tent, upon a fine mat fome- what rais'd from the ground. For magnificences fake, and out of refpeft for this lioly aft, they have twenty pikes of ftate planted before them in the ground. They order the crowding fpeftators to be kept off with ftaffs, and are otherwife to take care, that no ac- cidents happen, and that no diforder be committed on that day by the mob, for which purpofe fome of the Joriki's are perpetually going to and fro the Governors Court, to give them notice of what happens and to enquire what commands they have for their deputies. . The publick fpeftacles fhevvn upon this occafion, are a fort of fo&tchs. plays, or rather drama's, afted by eight, twelve, or more perfons. The fubjeft is taken out of the hiftory of their Gods and Heroes. Their remarkable adventures, heroic aftions, and fometimes their love in- trigues, put in verfe, are fung by dancing-aftors, whilft others play upon all forts of mufical inftruments. If the fubjeft be thought too grave, and moving, there is now and then a comical aftor jumps out unawares upon the ftage, with his geftures and merry difcourfe in profe, to divert the people. Some of their other plays are compos'd only Chap. IV. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 299 only of ballets, or dances, like the performances of the Mimic Adors upon the Roman Stage. For the dancers do not fpeak, but en- deavour to expfefs the contents of the ftory, they are about to re- prefent, as naturally as poffible, both by their drefs, and by their ge- flures and adions, regulated according to the found of mufical inftru- ments. The chief fubjeds of the play, fuch as fountains, bridges, gates, houfes, gardens, trees, mountains, animals, and the like, are likewife reprefented, fome as big as the life, and all in general con- trived fo, that they may be remov'd at command and taken to pieces, like the fcenes in our European Plays. The Adors are commonly young girls, taken out of the bawdy- houfes, as alfo young boys and children out of thofe ftreets, at whofe expence the folemnity is perform'd. They arc all magnifi- cently clad, in varioufly colour'd filken gowns, fuitable to the chara- cters which they are to reprefent, and it mull be own'd in juftice to them, that generally fpeaking, they ad their part with that afTufance and becoming dexterity, which is not to be exceeded, nay indeed fcarce to be pa- rallels, by the befl European Adors. The ftreets, which bear the expence of the folemnity, make their appearance in the following order. Firft of all is carried a rich canopy, or elfe an umbrello, made of (ilk, being the palladium of the flreet. Over it in the mid- dle is placed a fhield, whereupon is writ in large charaders the name of the flreet. Next to the canopy follow the muficians, mafk'd, in proper liveries. The mufic is both vocal and inftrumental. The in- ftruments are chiefly flutes of different forts, and fmall drums : Now and then a large drum, cymbals and bells are brought in among the reft. This inftrumental mufic is fo poor and lamentable, that it feems much eafier to fatisfy their Gods, than any ways to pleafe a mufical ear. Nor is the vocal part much preferable to the inftru- mental, for altho* they keep to the time tolerably well, and fing ac- cording to fome notes, yet they do it in fo very flow a manner, that the mufick feems to be rather calculated to regulate their adion, and the motions of their body, in their ballets and dances, wherein I muft own, that they are very ingenious and dextrous, and little in- ferior to our European dancers, excepting only, that they feem to want a little more adion and fwiftnefs in their feet. But to return 10 the procefllon. The muficians are follow'd by the necefTary ma- chines, and the whole apparatus for the enfuing reprefentations, the largeft being carry'd by labouring people, the letter, as benches, ftaffs, flowers and the like, by the children of the inhabitants neatly clad. Next follow the adors themfelves, and after them all the in- habitants of the flreet in a body, in their holiday's, that is, finefl cloaths, with their garments of ceremony. To make the appearance fo much the greater, the procefhon is clos'd by a confidevble number of 3 oo The Hiflory ?fJAPAN, Book IV. of people, who carry ftools and other things, walking two and two. The dances and fhews of a ftreet, commonly laft about three quarters of an hour, and being over, the company marches off in the fame order they appear'd in, to make way for the appearance and fhews of another ftreet, which is again follow'd by another, and fo on. All the ftreets flrive to outdo one another in a magnificent retinue and furprizing fcenes. The proceflions and fhews begin early in the morning, and the whole ends about noon. The fhows and fcenes are nearly the fame on the feventh day of this month, as they are on the ninth, or Shiva's birth-day, with fome fmall difference in the dreffes of the aftors and their dances, as alfo in the order and march of the procefTions, they returning upon one day the fame way they came in on the other. When every thing is over, the two Superiors of the clergy, as having now difcharg'd the duties of their office, leave their benches, and walk towards the tent where the deputies of the governors fat, to whom they return thanks for their gracious prefence at this holy act, and this nearly with the fame marks of deference and fubmifhon which the faid reprefenta tives did fhew them in the morning. The fpeclacles, machines, fongs and dances muft be new every year, and it would be thought beneath the dignity and majefry of that great God, if repeating, upon occafion, the fameftory o- ver again, they did not at leaft drefs it up after a new fafhion. For the reader's farther fatisfa&ion, I have not fcrupled to infert a more ample and particular defcription of the feveral reprefentations, fcenes, machines, and fo on, of a late Matfuri, which was perform'd during my flay in Japan, and whereat I was prefent myfelf. Scenes of a Im Scene. Eight young Girls, clad in colour'd gowns, interwoven M«t/wv at w ith large white flowers, with broad hats on, as it were to defend "^ them from the heat of the fun, with fans and flowers in their hands, dancing by turns. They were from time to time reliev'd by a couple of old women dancing in another drefs. 2. Scene. A garden with fine flowers, appearing on each fide of the place, where the act was perform'd, a thatch'd houfe in the middle, out of which jump'd eight young girls, drefs'd in white and red, dancing with fans, canes, and flower-bafkets. They were re- liev'd by a very good actrefs, who dane'd by her felf. 3. Scene. Eight triumphal chariots, with oxen before them of dif- ferent colours, the whole very naturally reprefented and drawn by young boys well clad. Upon them flood a Tfubaki Tree in flower ; a mountain cover'd with trees ^ a foreft of Bambous, with a Tyger lurking j a load of flraw, with an entire tree, with its roots and branches j a ,whale under a rock, half cover'd with water : Laft of all another mountain appear'd, with a young boy alive, and magni- ficently clad, who flood at the top, under an Apricock-tree in full bloffom. This mountain was again drawn by boys. 4. Scene. Chap IV. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 301 ■ > - --- — — 4. Scene. Some dancers acting between fix flower-beds, which and a green tree were drawn upon the place by boys. Nine other boys in the fame drefs, and arm'd each with two fwords and a mufket : a peafant dancing. 5. Scene. A mountain carried upon men's moulders, a fountain with a walk round it, a large cask, and a houfe, were feverally fet upon the place. Then two giants mask'd, with prodigious large heads, re- prefenting fome Fotoge, or Indian Deities, begun a dance. They were met foon after by a third, of a (till more monftrous fize, who came forth out of the mountain arm'd with a great broad fword. He was folic w'd by feven Chinefe jumping out of the fame mountain, tho' to all appearance never fo fmall, and dancing about in company with the giants. After fome time fpent in dancing, the great monftrous giant beat the cask to pieces, out of which came a young boy very handiomiy clad, who after a fine long fpeech, which he deliver'd in a very graceful manner, dane'd with the giant alone. Mean while three monkeys as big as the life, with roe's heads, crept out of the fountain, and jumping upon the walk round it, perform'd a" dance, mimmicking that of the giant and boy. This done, every one retir'd to his place, and fo this fcene ended. 6. Scene. A round Chinefe triumphal arch, country houfe and gar- den. A dance of ten boys arm'd, and clad in gowns, lin'd with green yellow and blue, with a particular fort of breeches on. An harlequin jumping in among them, and talking to divert the people. The fcene was clos'd by two dancers in a foreign drefs, who came dancing out of the garden. 7. Scene, A mountain with bambous, and firrs growing upon it, as alfo twelve other trees in bloffom, of fo many different kinds, very naturally reprefented, were feverally drawn acrofs the ftage, follow'd by a numerous train of people magnificently clad. Then appear'd two perfons clad in white, and eight others clad in yellow, dancing and playing upon bells: They were join'd foon after by feven others dancing with flower pots upon their heads. 8. Scene. The pompous retinue of a Prince travelling with his Son very naturally reprefented by boys. 9. Scene. A green-houfe plac'd ia the middle of the ftage, acrofs and about which danced ten boys clad in black gowns, with fine breeches, each wearing two fwords. They dane'd firft with flowers in their hands, and afterwards with fwords, arrows and pikes. They were re- lieved in their dance by fome comical interlocutors. Laft of all, their fervants with boxes upon their fhoulders jump'd in and dane'd among them, whereby this Scene was clos'd. 10. Scene. A ftage plac'd near a- hill with trees growing upon it. A boy arm'd, and clad in black and yellow, appear'd upon the ftage, fpeaking and aciing about half an hour, mean while eight other boys G g g g clad 3 o2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. clad in partycolour'd gowns, interwoven with flowers, perform'd a dance, firft alone, then in company with another perfon and a monkey, who jump'd out of the hill at the fame time. ii. Scene. A handfome well fhap'd young jumper, before whom was plac'd a table, a fort of a fcaffold, or ftage, with eight fteps leading up on one fide, and as many going down on the other, a hollow bambou was laid acrofs the fcaffold, and a door, with a round hole at the upper end, which had not above two fpans and a half in] diame- ter. This fellow play'd feveral very furprizing tricks, fome of which, and thofe in my opinion not the leaft, were as follows. He lay down flat upon the tab'*, either upon his belly or back, and jump'd upon his le^s with furprizing dexterity, in a moment. He walk'd upon ftilts up one fhir-cafe of the fcaffold, then over the hollow bambou, and fo changing the ftilts down the other ftair-cafe. He jump'd from the diflance of about three fathom, through the hole in the door men- tion'd above, notwithfhnding its fmallnefs and the largenefs of the hat, which he then wore, and which was confiderably broader than the diameter of the hole. 12. Scene. Several huge machines, accurately refembling, both in fize and colour, the things they were to reprefent, but made of a thin fubftance, fo that one man could eafily carry one upon his back. But befides this load on the back, every one of thefe men had a very large drum hanging before him, which fome others play'd upon with bells. After this manner they crofs'd the ftage dancing, tho' they did not jump very high, becaufe of their load, which altho' the things were made only of very light and thin fluff, was neverthelefs fo heavy that they were oblig'd to reft before they enter'd the place, as they had already done in feveral other places in their proceffion through the flreets, on ftools plac'd for them for that purpofe. The things which they carried acrofs the ftage were, A well, with all the inftruments for extinguifhing Fires. A large church-bell with the timber-work belonging to it, and a dragon wound round it for ornament's fake. A mountain cover'd with fnow, and fhap'd like the head of a dra- gon, with an eagle fitting at the top. A brafs gun, weighing twenty four pounds, with all the tackle be- longing to it. A heavy load of travellers trunks pack'd up in twelve ftraw balls, according to the country fafhion. A whale in a difh. Several fhell fifh, and fruits, as big as the life, carried each by one perfon. Other Tm- But to proceed in my account of the Temples of this City, it fhsatNaga- mu ft b e obferv'd, that befides the Temple of Sutpa, which is one of the mofi considerable, there are many others built to the Cami, or na- tional Chap. IV. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 303 tional Gods, which are worfliip'd by the adherents of the Sintos religion, as cf old eftablifh'din the Country. Among feveral, there is one built to Tenfio Dai Sin, another to his brother Ten Sin. There are likewife fome Chapels, fcarce deserving to be call'd Temples, ere&ed to other Idols of lefs note. Thefe are not attended by Nege, or Secular Priefts of- the Cami Temples, but either by Jammabos, that is, Mountain- Soldiers, a fort of Hermits, who may marry if they pleafe, and who, in their religion and worfhip, conform themfelves in great meafure to the foreign Pagan Budjdo Doftrine j or by the Tendai, otherwife call'd S'mgon, another fort of Priefts, who in like manner make it their en- deavour to reconcile the foreign Pagan Bud/do Worfhip with the na- tional religion, as of old eftablifh'd in the country. Thefe laft may be look'd upon as followers of the Seel of Lanzu, as the Chinefe call it, or according to the Japanefe, Noojl, which begun in China in the time of of the great Philofopher Koofi, by us Europeans call'd Confii- tiits, and was afterwards receiv'd in Japan, it being not inconfiftent with either of thefe two religions. The Emperor Gongen adher'd to this fed, for which reafon there is at Anfenfn, one of the Tendai Temples, an Ifai, or a Table erected to his memory, before which the Priefts fay their prayers every day for the happinefs and welfare of his foul. All the Nege, that is, Secular Priefts of the Mia, or Cami Temples, Negt, h acknowledge the Dairi, that is, the court of the Mikaddo, or Eccle- uh ° m W vet ~ fiaftical Hereditary Emperor, as their Superiors. Accordingly by or- der and authority of this Ecclefiaftical Court, Joftjda Donno, a man of the higheft quality at the fame, hath been appointed Supe- rior, or General of all the Nege Clergy, and confecrated as fuch by the Mikaddo himfelf, who at the fame time inverted him with the power to confer greater honours and titles, not only upon the Nege, but likewife upon their Idols, and upon the fouls of deceas'd great men, tho' this was never done without the Mikaddo' s conferit and ap- probation. The Jammabos have a Head, or General, of their own, who refides at Miaco. (See Book III. Chap. VI.) Thus much of the Sintos Temples. I proceed now to the Budsdo^ ^uM'^tTem or Bupo, that i9, foreign pagan worfhip, which was originally brought />/«. over from India into Japan. Many Irately convents and temples have been built at Nagasaki, by the four chief feds of this religion, fome few of which ly within the Town, but far the greateft part with- out it, in the afcent of the neighbouring hills, and mountains. They have beautiful flair cafes of ftone leading up to them, and feveral fmall chapels, or temples built within the fame court, not fo much to be commended for their largenefs or fplendor, as for their pleafant and agreeable fituation, being moreover adorn'd within with fine rais'd altars, gilt Images, as big as the life, lacker'd columns, gates, pil- lars. «.-.«. - 304 The Hi/lory of J A P A N. Book IV; Jars, the whole very neat and pretty, rather than magnificent. All thefe Budfdo Temples are attended by Priefts of the fame religion, and every particular Temple by Priefts of that very Seel, which it be- longs to. All the temples belonging to the fame feci are diftinguiih'd into TorifL, that is the chief, or head temple, and Matfuji, which fig_ nifies filial, cr dependant temples, or convents, becaufe they are de- pendant of the former, and ftand under the direction of the fame Superiors. Kauufi. Kdtaifi, is the chief convent and temple of the Sensju, or Seel of Sen, which is of the order (or rather Schifm) of Sotofa, or Sotosju. At the fide of this temple, within its court, ftands another temple, or chapel, which is open on all fides, with the Image of Siaka, the founder of this religion, gilt, of an extraordinary fize, and fitting on a gilt Tarate-Flower t (Vaba Mgyptiaca) feveral Matfufi, or inferior tem- ples, are dependant of this, wherein are maintain'd very many Eccle- fiuftical Perfons, or Monks, old and young. Suntokjiji. Shmtokuji, is another of the chief temples of the Sensju Seel, of the order of Rinfaifa. The Superior hath likewife feveral Matfuji under his direction, wherein are maintain'd as many Monks as in thofe aforefaid. Smrinfi. Senriufi, is another temple of this laft mention'd order. The Supe- rior of this hath no Matfufi under him, tho' otherwife he ftands, as well as the two Superiors of the temples aforefaid, under the fole and immediate dependance of their General at Miaco. Thefe Senjiu Temples are frequented by molt of the inhabitants of this town. The Ecclefiafticks thereof travel much, and are often chang'd and fent to other convents, which makes their number very uncertain, tho' there are feldom lefs than goo. Dahionfi. Daiwonji, is the chief temple of the feci Siodosju. Several Matfuji ftand under the direclion of the Superior thereof. In all the tem- ples of this feci there are tables, or monuments, erecled to the me- mory of the deceas'd Emperors of the now reigning family, who pro- fefs'd themfelves of it. The Monks fay their prayers daily before thefe memorial monuments for the fouls of the deceas'd Emperors, and upon fome certain days one of their number, offers fome eatables. The number of Ecclefiafticks attending the temples of this feci, is nearly the fame with the former. FeWW«. Forinfi, is the chief temple of the feci Fokke Shi. Tfiofwji, and fome few other MatfuJPs ftand under the direclion of the Superior thereof. The Ecclefiafticks are not near fo numerous, as in the two former Seels, there being but few people who adhere to it. Vaikpof- Daikoofi, is the chief temple of the feci and order of Omotteno Ikosju, that is, of the furthermofl Iko feB, fo call'd, from the refidence of the General thereof at Miaco. Koojenji, Chap. IV. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 30$ Koojenfi, is the chief temple of the fecond order of the faid Iko- K 00 h»Jt: SeB, call'd Aurano Ikosju, that is, the hindmojl Iko Sett, which is again fo call'd from the place of refidence of their general, and the Situation thereof with regard to the former. The Monks of thefe two orders of the Iko SeEi are permitted **■• Monk.h to marry, tho' there are but few that take this liberty, and thofe only the chief among them. Thofe who are marry'd, have leave to educate their male ifTue in the convent, for which reafon the num- ber of young Ecclefiafticks is fometimes fo encreas'dj, that the revenues of the convent will fcarce fuffice to maintain them. Under thefe circumftances thofe, who are not marry'd, either retire to live in the Iko Convents of other provinces, or elfe, under pretext of conversion, go over to other feds, in order to be admitted, if pofRble, into their monafteries. The Superiors of the two Iko Temples mention'd above, have no Matfufi under them, nor are there more than twenty full grown Monks, with the families of fome in each convent. Their temples are moft frequented by the common, and almoft all the country people, becaufe they affed a great devotion and Simplicity in their converfation, preaching and writings, the latter of which are publifh'd in the vulgar charaders, call'd Kanno, on purpofe to make them underftood by the common people. There is befides another fmall temple, or chappel, belonging to this gtotmjtenfi fame Iko Sed, call'd Quanfienfi, whofe Banna, that is, the perfons who go to worShip there, contributed of late, fome ten, others an hundred Siumome for rebuilding and enlarging the fame. For this purpofe they fent laft year the Osje, or Superior of the temple, with, the colleded money to Miaco, to offer it to the difpofal of their general. But he, inftead of going to Miaco, Staid at Ofacca, where 'tis faid, he fpent almoft all the money. He left his wife and chil- dren at Nagafaki. The Danna having heard no news of him for fome time, refolv'd in the mean time, that in cafe he did not return quickly, they would drop this undertaking, and incorporate them- felves amongft the Danna, or parifliioners of another Iko Church, or Temple. The Ecclefiafticks of all the above-mention'd feds of the BitJfJo Religion have no proceflions, nor other publick fpedacles like the Sintos Clergy. They always keep within the diftrid of their convent, where befides a due care for their fupport and maintenance, they mind little elfe but their prayers in the temple at certain Stated hours. Their maintenance arifes from what fees are given them for prayers to be faid in their temples for the relief of departed fouls, as alfo from the voluntary and charitable contributions of their Danna, or parishioners. It appears, by what hath been faid above, that every convent Stands under the diredon of a Prior, or Superior, whom they call Dsjunji, or Osjo, and to whom all the Monks of the con- H h h h vent 306 The Biftory oj J A P A N. Book IV- vent are oblig'd to pay due refpeft and obedience. The Superiors themfelvcs ftond under the command of the General or Osjo in" chief of their feci, who relides at Miaco. The Superiors of the Ikosjtt Con- vents, of both orders of this feci, are call'd Sioonin. The generals of this order, who refide at Afiaco, aifume the pompous title of Monfeki, or Gomonfeki, which in the litteral fenfe fignifies, the place of thefublbne port abandon d, becaufe they were of the family and blood of Mikad- do, which they left to go over to this fed, and to embrace this dignity. On this account alfo they ftill look upon themfelves, as being neareft in rank to the very court of their Mikaddo, whereby is underftood the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor. The word Mikaddo taken in a litteral fenfe fignifies, the fublime port. •tmpUi of There are three temples at Nagafaki, which belong to the Chi- tht Qimefe. ne ^ anc j are ^ e q ua ily remarkable for their handfom ftru&ure, and the number of monks maintained therein. They belong properly to the SecT: Sen, tho' they are adorn'd within with the idols and images of feveral Chinefe Emperors and Saints, as big as the life. Fine triumphal arches and many more ftrange ornaments are to be feen in the temple-courts. The Chinefe, and fuch of their neighbouring nations who, tho' fpeaking different languages, yet trade to Japan under the fame name, have founded them after the total extirpation of the ChrifHan religion, for the free exercife of their worfhip, and the reception of their Ship-idols. For as foon as their mips put into the harbour of Nagafaki, the idols are carried on more, and plac'd into certain chapels built for them hard by the great temple. This is done with uncommon refpeel and particular ceremonies, playing upon cymbals, and beating of drums, which fame ceremonies are repeated, when upon the departure of their yonks the faid idols are carried on board again. Thefe convents and temples bear the names of the country or province of their founders, with another Epithet borrow'd from their riches. They are, .. ..j. i. Nanlindira. that is, the temple of the city of Nankin, and the neighbouring country. It is the firft temple, that was built in Japan by foreigners, particularly by the Nankineefe, and thofe of their neigh- bours, who fpeak the fame language, and who have likewife given it the name of Koofukufi, that is, the temple of fettled riehes. Tfiak.s : uJi>-a. 2 « Tfiaksjndira, or Tfansjndira, that is, the temple of the country of Aimos, whereby muft be underftood the Southern Provinces of the Empire of China. The Chinefe, who inhabit the Ifland of Formofa, and are fettled in other countries diftant from China, belong to the fame. There is a Matfufi or dependant convent under the dire- ction of its Superior. It is one of the largeft and beft ftock'd with Monks. Its other name 13 Fttkufi, that is, the temple of riches. 5. Fok/iudira. Chap. IV. The Hi(lory of J A P A N. 307 3. Fokfiudira, that is, the temple of the northern countrys, was found- ^kfudira- ed, and is frequented by thofe Chinefe, who come from the Northern parts of China. Its other name is Fuku Sarfi, that is, the temple of riches and offerings. Thefe convents were formerly attended by Chinefe Priefts only^ M«»»»«»rt and maintain'd at the fole expence of this nation. But fince the fhutting of the Mbakj. up of the Empire and the new flrid regulations made with regard to the foreign trade, they fuffer only two born Chinefe to live in each of them. Their maintenance, as well as that of other temples of this foreign Budfdo worfhip, arifes from the voluntary charitable contribu- tions of their countrymen, as alfo from fees given them for prayers to be faid, and offerings to be made, for the relief of departed fouls. If the money got by thefe means be not fufficient to maintain them, a fupply is expeded from the Imperial bounty. The Superiors of thefe three Convents ftand under the immediate difpofition of a parti- cular General of their own, who refides near Miaco, on the mountain Oobaku, and fays, that he is the third fucceilbr on the Archiepifcopal Sec of Ingen, and confequently the head of all the Clergy of this foreign pagan religion. The better to underftand this, it will be neceilary to in- fert the hiftory of this Ingen. Ingen, was a native of China, where he fucceeded upon the holy v.tfory of feat of Dartna, the firft Chinefe Pope, and himfelf the twenty eighth ^ fucceffor of Siaka, who was the founder, and is ftill acknowlcdg'd as the protector of this religion. The love for his countrymen, who lived in the three Convents mention'd above without a fettled head over them, a ftrong zeal and defire, which he felt within himfelf to pro- pagate the Bupo, or Buds Dodrine in the Empire of Japan, as alfo to fecure the eftablifhment thereof againft the Mukurrokoht, (This name is given to the Chriftians, and in general to all the Antagonifts of this Dodrine, tho' the former had beenthen already fufficiently filene'd by that famous and unparallePd perfecution which arofe in this Empire) pre- vail'd upon him to part with the high dignity and power, he was inverted with, in favour of his Succeffor, and to come over into Japan, there to eftablifh a fort of a Caliphat, or Archiepifcopal See of this Dodrine. He arriv'd in Japan in the year of Chrift 1653, an d was receiv'd with all imaginable refped. The Princes and Lords of feveral Pro- vinces came to compliment him, clad in their Camifimo, or Garments of Ceremony. The Emperor offer'd him, for his refidence, a mountain in the neighbourhood of the holy City of Miaco 1 which he call'd Obaku, by the name of his former papal refidence in China. An incident, which happen'd foon after his arrival, contributed very much to forward his defigns, and rais'd in feveral Inhabitants of this Empire an uncommon refped for his perfon, and a great opinion of his halinefs. After a very great drought, the country people, his neighbours, defir'd him to fay a Kitoo, or extraordinary folemn prayer, in order to obtain le». 308 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. obtain rain from heaven for their rice-fields. He anfwer'd, that it was not in his power to make rain, and that he could not allure them, that his Kit oo would obtain it. However, at their preffing inftances, he promis'd to do his utmoft. Accordingly he went up to the top of the mountain, and made his Kitoo. The next day there fell fuch profufe mowers, that even the fmaller bridges in the city of Miaco, were wafh'd away, which made both the city and country believe, that his Kitoo had been rather too flrong. His companions, who came over with him from China, had likewife very great refped paid them, as more immediate partakers, of his glory, infomuch, that even a cook, who came over with this learned and fanclified company, was rais'd to the dignity of Superior of Fakfmdira, one of the three convents at Nagafaki, where by his fublime understanding and repu- ted great knowledge in divine myfteries he obtain'd, and frill keeps, the name and repute of a Godo, that is, a perfon blefs'd with a divine and mod accute understanding, whom they fuppofe to be able to find out by his Satori, or Enthufiaftic Speculations, fuch mifterious truths, as are far beyond the reach of common knowledge. Upon the days facred to Siaka, this old gentleman feats himfelf in his con- vent, upon an eminent place, where he hath fo much refpecl and veneration paid him by crowds of fuperftitious fpeclators, as the Gods themfelves. He fits with a wonderful grave countenance, and without ftirring or uttering any the leaft found, as if he was entirely life, or fpeechlefs , only to exprefs his gratitude to the people for thefe extraordinary marks of honour, he is pleas'd now and then to favour them with a fmall fcarce perceptible wink. He holds a fmall fluff in his hand, with fome horfe-hair ty'd to the end, as a parti- cular mark of his mifterious manner of thinking, it being cuftomary amongft al the Safen Priefls, to carry fomething of this nature about them. Safen is a profound meditation of divine mifteries and holy things, which fo entirely takes up a man's mind, that his body lies, as it were, deflitute of all fenfe and life, unmov'd by any external objccl whatfoever. But to return to Ingen. Many adherents of the Sjuto, or Philofophical Seel, (defcrib'd above, Book III. Ch. 7.) and many of the Sintos, or national religion, as of old efhblifh'd in the country, embraced after his arrival the dodrine of Buds, and this the rather, becaufe the Chriflian Religon, whofe adherents could conveniently hide themfelves under any of thefe two, I mean either the Siuto, or Sintos Seels, being then juft in its greateft decline and upon the point of expiring, an order was iffued by the Secular Emperor, commanding all his fubjeds, of all feds, rank, and quality, to have a Dfu/i in their houfes, that is, a corner, or altar confecrated to fome Idol, which they chofe to do rather to the Fotoge^ or Gods of the Buds worfhip, than to others. This J)fufi, along with the Idol to whom it is dire- cted, every body who buys a houfe, muft purchafe in the firft place^ and Chap IV. The Hiftory of J A P A K 309 and fhew it to his neighbours, who elfe would be anfwerable for this neglect, if upon enquiry none fliould be found. This Ingen how- ever, the eminent poft he flood in, and his uncommon learning not- withfhnding, could not gain fo much upon the clergy of this Empire, then divided (as they frill are) into feveral feels, not even upon thofe of his own religion, as to perfuade them, to accept of his prote- ction, and to acknowledge him as their fupreme head. He was fuc- ceeded by one Okuffi, a man of lefs parts, learning and authority, after whofe demife a native of Japan was put into his place, and declar'd Superior of the convent on the mountain Obaku, and General of the three Chinefe Temples and Convents at Nagafaki. The Ecclefiafticks of all feds and orders, at Nagafaki, and in all Genoa's of parts of the Empire, have their General refiding at Miaco y who thro' © r ^„. the conniving indulgence, and under the protection of the Emperor, have an abfolute command, and, in a manner, fovereign authority, each over thofe of his feci: and order. They make it their bufinefs with great humility to maintain themfelves in the favour of the civil magiftrate, only becaufe, upon occafion, they might fland in need of their afliftance and protection. The Superiors of the convents, who are appointed by them, have power to give to the Monks of their, convents, the neceflary pailports for their journies. Abating this, they have very little to do with civil affairs, and are, like other fecu^ lar perfons, fubjed to the Emperor, who governs them by two Dfifia nfisja Eu^o, Bugjo, as they are call'd, or with a more ample title, Dfifia Go Bugjo, "'' J'" 1 ? 1 '' that is, Imperial CommifTioners, infpeclors, protectors, and judges of all temples, and the Monks belonging thereunto. This employment is, after the Emperor's Council of State, one of the beft in the Empire, and the perfons inverted with it, are very much confider'd at court. They hold their court at Jedo. All civil affairs relating to the clergy, fuch as law-fuits, difputes arifing about the limits' or reve- nues of their lands, profecutions for wrongs or damages receiv'd, and the like, are brought in daily in great number, to be decided in this court. Again, all criminal cafes, as rebellion, difregard to the Imperial proclamations, and commands, and in general all capital crimes committed by the Ecclefiaflicks, are tried before them, and in cafe of conviction punifh'd with death, tho' thefe criminals are much more indulg'd than other people, and cannot be executed without the confent, and a warrant fign'd by their General at Miaco. Ano- ther branch of the bufinefs of thefe Dfifia Bugjo is, to take care of the maintenance of the clergy, to keep the temples in repair, and otherwife upon all occafions, where the fecular power and authority is wanted, to aflift them. I i i i CHAP. ; io The Hiftory jfJAPAN. Book IV. CHAP. V. Of the arrival and reception of the Portuguefe and Cafti- lians in 'Japan ; of their Trade^ and honjo they '•juere banift?d the Empire. Dfiovery of ^ I 1 H E Portuguefe venturM the firft of all European Nations the E«ft-in- I U p on the Indian Ocean. In the year 1497, four (hips were Pmuyiefe. equipp'd by order of King Emanuel of Portugal, under the command of Admiral Vafco de Gama. They went fo far as Calecut, where a peace and commerce was agreed on with the Zamorin, or King of that Country. The conqueft of Goa by Alonfo de Albuquer- que, in the year 1510, was the foundation of their future power, and the firft firm fettlement they made in the Indies. From that time they vigoroufly purfued their difcoveries and conquefts amongft the defence- lefs Indians, and propagated their trade all over the Eaft, fo far as the remote Empire of China. In 1542, one of their fhips, bound for ^aban. yy China, was in a ftorm forc'd upon the then as yet unknown Iflands of Japan, where after many incommodities fuffer'd, fhe came to an anchor in an harbour of the province Bungo, one of the nine Provinces of the Ifland Kiusju. The Japanefe Hiftories mention, that the firft European Ihip feen upon their coafts, came to an anchor before Awa, oppofite to the Ifland Tfikekf. Be that as it will, the honour of the firft difcovery of Japan, by the way of the Indies is unqueftionably due to the Portuguefe, tho' it was done acciden- tally. Afterwards one of their fhips laden with commodities, was fent every other year to the fame Province of Bungo. In 1549, a young Japanefe who fled to Goa, and was there baptiz'd, gave fome hints to the Portuguefe Merchants there of the great gain, our European commodities would in all likelihood produce in his country, and at the fame time he difcours'd with the Fathers of the Society of Jefus, about the poflibility of converting his country- Firfi Eft «■ men to the faith of Chrift. Both thefe confiderations put the Portu- tinp'ortu- guefe upon thoughts of making a better eftablifhment and ere&ing a gKffe. fa&ory in Japan, in order to which this young Japanefe was fent back to his native country on board a Portuguefe fhip -, and fome Jefuits went along with him, of the number whereof was the Re- verend F. Francis Javier. The Empire of Japan was then not yet fhut up, nor the Princes or Petty Kings thereof kept to fo ftrid: an obe- dience and fubmiffton to their Emperor, as they now are. The Ja- panefe were at liberty to travel within their own country and . abroad, Chap. V. TheHiftwyof JAPAN. 3 n abroad, wherever they pleas'd, or were call'd by their bufinefs, or commerce. Foreign nations could then frequent the Empire, in what manner they pleas'd, and put into what harbours they thought it moft expedient. This was the cafe of the Portuguefe, who not only had it in their free power to go to what parts of the Empire they thought fit, but were very much carefs'd by the Princes of the Illand Kiusju, and invited to fettle upon their territories. Nay, the profits like to accrue to their Subjects, from the commerce with the Portuguefe, bred , no fmall jealoufies among them. Every one ufed his moft prefling endeavours to oblige thefe foreigners to put into his harbours preferably to others. By this means, they difpofed of their commodities freely and currently all over, the Empire. The Japanefe, curious as they are, drove who mould firil get thefe fo- reign rarities into his poffeflion, and being unacquainted with their intrinfick value, they willingly paid whatever prize was exacted. The reverend fathers of the Society of Jefus, who accompanied this firft Portuguefe colony into Japan, had it no lefs at heart to propagate the Gofpel amongft thefe Infidels. It was fo much the more eafy to the Portuguefe, to bring their trade into a flourifliing condition, and at the fame time to advance and fupport the converfion of the Ja- panefe to the faith of our Saviour, as the neighbouring Town o£ Macao in China, which they were then already poffefs'd of, could furnifii them at command, with a fufficient ftock of European and In- dian commodities, and a competent number of Priefts. Their coun- trymen the Spaniards, who were then eftablifh'd in the City of Ma~ iiilhas in the Philippine Iflands, not very far diftant from Japan, were likewife at hand to aflift them in cafe of need, and the Ci- ty of Goa itfelf, as an Indian Rome, and the Metropolis of all the Portuguefe dominions in the Eaft, though at a greater diftance from Japan, yet could eafily, and without prejudice to its own Inhabitants, fend over frefh recruits of Ecclefiafticks. Hence 'tis not to be wonder'd that the Portuguefe attain'd in a fhort time to the higheft pitch of fortune. The Merchants in exchange for their European and Indian commodi- • „ -.^ ties, as raw (ilk, fine fluffs, druggs, wines, medicines, and a great ing condition variety of other both natural and artificial curiofities, became pof- °l^ ! !{ lcc 'l ■'„ fefs'd of immenfe treafures, and the golden marrow of the country* propagating The fathers of the Society on their fide gain'd the hearts of the °" e people, always greedy of novelties, by the meek and comfortable doclrine of the Gofpel, which was new" and till then entirely un- known to the Japanefe, by the examples of their modeft and virtu- ous way of life, by their charitable and difinterefted afiiftance to the lick and poor, as alfo by the pomp and majefty of their divine fer- vice, which the Japanefe were uncommonly delighted withal. Befides all thefe advantages, a certain natural refemblance between the minds and inclinations of the Japanefe and Portuguefe, both born nearly under 3 i2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV; under the fame clime, and in particular, the great affability, and that ferious and pleating gravity common to both nations, as on one fide it contributed not a little to the advancement and flourifhing condi- tion of the Portuguefe trade, fo en the other it fill'd the Jefuits with juft grounds to hope for fuccefs in the converfion of thefe Heathens to the faith of Chrift. 'Tis true, they did not at firft, as beginnings are always difficult, meet with that docility in the Japanefe, which they expecled, infomuch that even that great Apoftle of the Indians, S. Francis Xavler, unwilling to flay any longer to fo little purpofe, refolv'd to leave the country, and to retire where he thought his prefence could be more ufeful. But thefe feeming difficulties, which at firft, they had to ftruggle with, are eafily to be accounted for, fince the fathers being then as yet unacquainted with the cuftoms, manners, language, and policy of the Japanefe, were oblig'd to get their fermons, and what elfe they had to propofe to the people, tranflated into Japanefe by not over-fkilful interpreters, and the Japa- nefe words exprefs'd in latin characters, which being done, they read out of their papers, what they did not underftand themfelves, and in a manner, as may be eafily imagin'd, which could not but expofe them to the laughter of a lefs ferious and unattentive audience. But in fuccefs of time, when they came to familiarize themfelves with the , natives, learning their language, ftudying their religion, their cuftoms and inclinations, they then met with a fuccefs infinitely beyond their expe&ation. The number of converts, chiefly upon the Ifland Khts]n t where they firft fettled, was almofl unconceivable, and this the rather, as the Princes of Bungo, Arima and Omura, did not only openly efpoufe the intereft of the Chriftian religion, but were converted them- felves, and baptiz'd, and fent in the year 1582 fome of their neareft relations, with letters and prefents, to pay homage to the then Pope Gregory XIII, and to allure his Holinefs of their filial fubmiflion to the Church, an account of which moft celebrated embaffy hath been given in the works of that incomparable Hiftorian Thuanns, and by many other Roman catholick writers. The illuftrious and pious example of thefe Frinces was quickly follow'd, not only by their own fubjecls, but likewife by the fubjects of the Princes their neighbours, with that zeal and forwardnefs, that it may be juftly faid of them, they fore'd themfelves into the kingdom of heaven. The gofpel be- ing thus propagated in Japan, flowly indeed in fome places, but with incomparable fuccefs in others, frefh recruits of workmen for fo good, tho' unexpected a harveft, were fent over from Manilhas, Macao, and Goa. In the mean time fome of the natives of Japan were bred up amongft the Jefuits, and afterwards admitted into their order. Thefe forwarded the propagation of Chriftianity, far beyond what the Euro- pean fathers could do, being able to talk to their countrymen in their own language, and to make them fenfible of the abfurdity and incon- Chap. V. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 313 inconfiftence of their religion, and Idol-worfhip. Confidering this, there was good ground to hope, that the converfion of the whola Empire of Japan would be brought about in time, when of a fudden, and unexpectedly, affairs took quite another turn. This new religion, and the great number of perfons of all ranks and qualities, who were concerted to it, occafion'd confiderable alterations in the church, prejudicial in the higheft degree to the heathen clergy, and it was fear'd, that the fame might be attended with fatal confequences, even upon the ftate, for which, and for feveral other reafons to be men- tion'd hereafter, the Secular Emperor thought it necelTary to put a ftop to this growing evil, and to forbid all his fubjedls, under pain of death, to embrace a religion like to prove fo detrimental. For this purpofe proclamations were iffued in 1586. The fame year the perfecution began, and feveral perfons were executed for having dif- obey'd the Imperial commands. This unexpected turn however was not able to ftop the progrefs of chriftianity. The common people continu'd openly to embrace and to profefs the fame, and many per- fons of quality, out of fear and circumfpe&ion, did the fame in pri- vate. Not even the raging flames of a perfecution, the mofl dreadful of any mention'd in hiftories, feem'd at firft to have that effe&, which the heathen government expected it fhould. For altho' according to the letters of the Jefuits, 20570 perfons fuffer'd death for the faith of Chrift, only in the year 1590, yet in 1591 and 1592, when all the churches were actually (hut up, they made 12000 new converts. The Japanefe writers themfelves do not difown, that the young Emperor Fidt Jori, who in the year 16 16, was put to death by his tutor Ijejas, who ufurp'd the throne upon him, was fufpe&ed of being a Chriftian, and that the greateft part of his court foldiets, and military officers, profefs'd the fame religion. The chear_ fulnefs, with which the new converts fuffer'd all imaginable tor- ments, and the moft cruel death, rather than to renounce their Savi- our, excited the curiofity of many people to know, what doctrine it was, that could make its followers fo joyful even in the pangs of death, and they were no fooner inftru&ed in the fame, but it mani- feftly appear'd fo full of truth and comfort, that many refolv'd to embrace it. Here I fhall leave for a while the affairs of religion, to fay a few S(ate e f t j, e words concerning the commerce and trade of the Portuguefe. The Portugueft merchants in their trade, and the Priefts in the propagating of the Gofpel, profper'd equally well. The merchants married the daughters of the richeft Inhabitants, and difpos'd of their goods to the beft ad- vantage. The gold of the country was exchang'd againft European and Indian curiofities, medicines, fluffs, and other things of the like nature. Upwards of 300 tuns of this precious metal were exported every year, for at that time they had full liberty to import, and to> K k k k export, 314 The Hiftwy of J A P A N. Book IV. export, what, goods, and in what quantity they pleafed. At the time of their rifing greatnefs they imported their goods in large mips, but upon the decline of their trade they came thither only with Galliots, as they call them, or fmaller vefiels. They rlrft put into the har- bours of B ungo and FiranJo. Then they came only to Nagafaki. The gain upon the goods imported was at lead: cent per cent , and they got not a little upon what they exported. It is believ'd, that had the Por- tuguefe enjoy 'd the trade to Japan but twenty years longer, upon the fame foot as they did for fome time, fuch riches would have been transported out of this Ophir to Macao, and there would have been fuch a plenty and flow of gold and filver in that town, as facred writs mention, there was at Jerusalem in the times of Solomon. It is needlefs here to enter into all the particulars of their trade, and I think it fufficient to mention, that even in the laft years of their going to Japan, when their trade was in its greateft decline, I mean, in 1636, 2350 chefts of filver, or 2350000 Thails, befides 287 Portuguefe, with their relations and families, were carried on board four fhips from Nagafaki to Macao. In 1637, they imported goods, and ex- ported money to the value of 2142365 Tbails, 4, r, on board fix fhips, and in 1638, to the value of 1259023 Thails, 7. 3. only with two Galliots. And I found it mention'd, that fome few years before they fent away on board a fmall fiiip of theirs upwards of ico Tons of gold. Ed! of tli Now as to the fall of the Portuguefe, I heard it often affirm'd, by Portugiefe. p e0 pj e f g 00 d credit amongft the Japanefe themfelves, that pride and covetoufnefs in the firft place, pride amongft the great ones, and covetoufnefs in people of lefs note, contributed very much to render the whole nation odious. Even the new converted Chriftians were aftonifh'd, and grew impatient, when they faw, that their Spiri- tual Fathers aim'd not only at the falvation of their fouls, but had an eye alfo to their money and lands, and that the merchants difpos'd of their goods in a moft ufurious and unreafonabie manner. The growing riches, and the unexpected fuccefs in the propagation of the gofpel, puff'd up both clergy and laity. Thofe who were at the head of the clergy, thought it beneath their dignity, to walk on foot any longer, in imitation of Chrift and his Apoftles. Nothing would ferve them, but they muft be carried about in ftately chairs, mimicking the pomp of the Pope and his Cardinals at Rome. They not only put themfelves upon an equal foot with the greateft men of. the Empire, but fwelFd with Ecclefiaftical pride, fancied that even a Superior rank was nothing but their due. It one day hap- pen'd, that a Portuguefe Bifhop met upon the road one of the Councellors of ftate in his way to court. The haughty prelate would not order his chair to be ftopt, in order to aLight, and to pay his refpeds to tin's great man, as is ufual in the country, but without taking Chap. V. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 315 taking any notice of him, nay indeeed without fhewing him fo much as common marks of civility, he very contemptibly bid his men carry him by. So imprudent a ftep, and withal fo contrary to the meek- nefs and humility thefe gentlemen profefs, at a time too, when the Portuguefe had already loft the beft part of that cfteem and favour, they were in formerly, could not but be attended with fatal con- fer] uences, highly prejudicial to the intereft of the whole nation. This great man, exafperated at fo fignal an affront, thenceforward bore a mortal hatred to the Pcrtugueze, and in the height of his juft refentment, made his complaints to the Emperor himfelf, with fuch an odious picture of the infolencc, pride and vanity of this na- tion, as he expected could not but raife the Emperor's utmoft indig- nation. This happen'd in 1596. The next year the perfecution againft the Chriftians began a-nevv, and twenty-fix perfons, of the number whereof were two foreign Jefuits, and feveral Fathers of the Francifcan Order, were, executed on the crofs. The inconfiftency of the Chriftian doctrine with the religion and idol-worfhip, as it was then eftablifli'd in the country, was another of the elfential caufes of that cruel perfecution rais'd againft the adherents thereof. The new converted Chriftians told their countrymen, that fo long as they con- tinu'd Heathens, they had nothing to expect but eternal damnation ^ and not only this, but they carried their zeal for their newly em- brae'd doctrine, and their hatred againft the Pagan worfhip, and its Bon;ces or Priefts, fo far, as to pull down their Temples and Idols. And it was to be fear'd, that both church and ftate would be thereby thrown into a ftill greater confufion, were not the growing evil timely remedied. The union and harmony which was obferv'd to reign among the Chriftians, and their joint endeavours to abolifli the Pagan Religions of the country, and upon the ruins thereof to raife their own, afforded matter of jealoufy and fpeculation to the prudent Emperor Taico, and his lucceilbr Ijejas, the former of whom ow'd the crown, and his greatnefs, entirely to his courage and conduct, the latter to treachery and indirect practices. Ijejas indeed had fo much the more reafon to be apprehenfive, that the increafe of the Chriftian Religion might prove prejudicial to his interests, as his pupil Fidejori, (Take's only fon, upon whom he ufurp'd the throne,) and the greater part of his court and party had been either Chriftians themfelves, or at lea.fi: very favourably inclin'd to this religion. Both Tako and his fucceiTor Ijejas, as they had no hereditary right to the throne they were polfefs'd of, made it their endeavour, for their own fecurity, to remove all obftacles, that could pcflibly tend to make the pofleilion thereof troublefome to them, and amongfl others, to put an entire flop to the further propagation of a religion fo inconfiftent with all the others, then exifting in the country, and fo like to beget en- mities and je*doufies between their fubjeefs. Firft 3 i6 The Hiftoryof] A P A N. Book IV. Firft of all therefore an Imperial Proclamation Was iffued, forbid- ing the doctrine of the Fathers, as the Japanefe then term'd the Roman Ca- tholick Religion, to be taught and propagated any further. After this, the Governors, Princes and Lords of the feveral Provinces were de- fir'd by perfuafion, or force, to oblige their Subjects to renounce the faith of our Saviour, and to return to their old Religion. The di- rectors alfo of the Portuguefe trade receiv'd Uriel orders not to bring over any more Ecclefiaftics on board their (hips, and laft of all the monks and priefts, then in the country, were order'd forthwith to depart. How- ever little regard was had at firft to thefe Imperial orders. The Princes indeed and Governors of feveral Provinces left no ftone unturn'd to make their fubjecls renounce the belief in Chrift, and return to the? worfhip of their Idols. But the Portuguefe and Caftilians did not leave off bringing over on board their mips, tho' indeed in private, frefh recruits of Ecclefiatics, nor could the Jefuits, then eftabliih'd iri the country, by any means be brought to comply with the Imperial commands, and by quitting the Empire at once to loofe what they had been fo many years labouring to bring about. Much about the fame time another unlucky accident happened. Some Francifcan Friars, whom the Governor of Manithas in the Philippine Iflands had fent as his Ambafladots to the Emperor of Japan, did during the whole time of their abode in the Country, preach openly in the publick Streets of Miaco, where they refided, and where of their own accord they built a Church, contrary to the Imperial commands, and contrary to the advice and earned follicitations of the Jefuits. They had nothing to alledge for fo imprudent and untimely a pro- ceeding, but an ardent longing after the crown of martyrdom, and the command of the Apoftle, that God ought to be obefd preferably to men, altho' it was evident to a demonftration, that fo open a drfregard to the Emperor's commands, and fo notorious a breach of the Laws of the Empire, would prove in the end not only fatal to their perfons, but highly prejudicial to the advancement of chriftianity and the good of the church. And indeed the perfecution, which was afterwards rais'd againft the chriftians, hath not its like in hiftory, and at laft, after a cruel butchery of many thoufand of its adherents, which lafted for forty whole years, it ended with its total extirpation, the lofs of that profitable trade, which the Portuguefe and Caftilians had car- ried on for near a hundred years, and the buniihment of this nation for ever. The view of the Court, as it appears by feveral inftances, was not at firft to deliver up the whole Portuguefe Nation to their refentment. Talks, once upon fome falfe informations flew into a fudden pafiion againft the fathers of the fociety, and commanded them to depart the Empire within twenty days :, but foon after, he not only mitigated this decree, but gave them leave to build a Church near Miaco, tho' at the fame time he order'd them never to preach in Chap V. The Hifiory of JAPAN. 317 in it, which fhew'd that his difaffe&ion and hatred was levell'd more at the religion they profefs'd, than at their perfons. Nor did it ap- pear, that the Emperor's fucceffors defign'd to pufh matters fo far, as to banifh the whole Nation for ever. They would not willingly be without the foreign commodities and curiofities, which were imported by the Portuguefe. Even at the latter end of that dreadful perfe- cution of the Chriftian religion, when there were but few left of all the Portugueze and Caftilian Fathers, they fpar'd the Merchants and fecular Perfons, on purpofe to continue trade and commerce with them, which they look'd upon as an affair entirely independant of the other. In order to this, the Ifland Befima, now in porTeflion of the Dutch, was rais'd in the harbour of Nagafaki, and aflign'd for them to live in. But fome time after, the fatal difcovery of a dangerous confpira- cy, which they and the yet remaining adherents of their religion en- ter' d into againft the perfon of the Emperor, as a heathen Prince, put a firrifhing ftroke to their total ruin, arid haften'd the fentence which was pronounc'd foon after, that they mould be for ever banifh'd all the Em- peror's dominions. The thing happened as follows. The Dutch allur'd by the advantageous and profitable trade of the Portuguefe in the In- dies refolv'd likewife to extend their navigation to thefe remote parts of the world, fometime before the year 1600. The firft fa&ory they had in Japan, was built at Firando, and they had liberty of a free commerce granted them by Imperial Letters Patent. The Inte- reft of their trade in the Eaft Indies, then in a hopeful and flourifh- ing condition, prompted them to do, what otherwife at that time they well might, being engaged in war with Spain, then Sovereign of all the Portuguefe dominions in Europe and the Eaft : I mean, to fup- plant the Portuguefe, and as much as lay in their power, to ruin their trade. But befides, had thefe two reafons not been fufHcient to juftifie their proceedings, there was another ftill more prefling, and this was to do juftice to themfe.lves and their characters. The Portuguefe made ufe of all the cunning malicious inventions, to blacken the Dutch, calling them Rebels to the Spaniards, their former Sovereigns, Pirates and the like, in a word, defcribing them as the very worft and molt unjuft people in the World. In this viewfurely the Dutch were not much to be blamed for whatever attempts they made afterwards to keep up theit own credit, to clear themfelves of thefe and the like calumnies laid to their charge, and withal to take what revenge they could upon their enemies. I believe every body in their circumftances would have laid hold of an excellent opportunity, which offer'd foori after : for having taken a homeward bound Portuguefe Ship near the Cape of Good Hope, on board which they found fome traiterous Let- ters to the King of "Portugal, written by one Captain Moro, who was chief of the Portuguefe in Japan, himfelf a Japanefe by birth, and a great zealot for the Chriftian Religion, they took fpecial care forth- L 1 1 1 with 1 8 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Book IV. with to deliver the faid letters to their Protector the Prince of &- ranch, who communicated them without lofs of time to the Gover- nor of Nagafaki, as fupreme director and judge in foreign affair-, who, by the by, was a great friend to the Portuguefe. Captain Moro having been taken up, boldly, and with great affurance denied, the fad, and fo did all the Portuguefe then at Nagafaki. However, neither the Governor's favour, nor their confhnt denial, were able to clear them, and to keep off the cloud, which was ready to break over their heads. Hand and Seal convinc'd them. The letter was fent up to court, and Captain Moro fentenc'd to be burnt alive on a pale, which was executed accordingly. This letter laid open the whole Plot, which the Japanefe Chriltians, in conjunction with the Portuguefe, had laid againft the Emperor's life and throne, the want, they flood in, of fhips and foldiers, which were promis'd them from Portugal, the names of the Japanefe Princes concern'd in the confpi- racy, and laftly, to crown all, the expectation of the papal blefftng. This difcovery, made by the Dutch, was afterwards conflrm'd by another letter, wrote by the faid Captain Moro to the Portuguefe Govern- ment at Macao, which was intercepted and brought to Japan by a Japanefe Ship. Confidering this, and the fufpicions, which the court had then already conceiv'd againft the Portuguefe, it was no difficult matter throughly to ruin the little credit and favour they had -as yet been able to preferve, the rather fince the ftrict Imperial orders notwiths- tanding, they did not leave of privately to bring over more Eccle- fiafticks. Accordingly in the year 1637 an Imperial Proclamation, fign'd by the chief Councilors of ftate, was fent to the Governors of Nangafaki, with orders to fee it put in execution. It was then the Empire of Japan was (hut for ever, both to foreigners and natives. Thenceforward no foreign nation fhould have leave to come into the country, and none of the Emperor's fubjefts to go abroad, as appears among others, by the following pofkive orders contain'd in the Proclamation aforefaid. To Sakaki Barra Findano Canti, and to Bala Salray Sejimon. u "V "T O Japanefe fhip,. or boat whatever, nor any. native of Japan^ a 1 ^1 fhall prefume to go out of the country: who ads contrary to " this, fhall die, and the fhip, with the crew and goods aboard, ! fhall " be fequefter'd till farther order. " All Japanefe , who return from abroad , fhall be put to " death. " Whoever difcovers a Priefl, fhall have a reward: of 400 to 500 " fljuets of filver, and for every Chriftian in proportion, (A (Imet of '"fiver Chap. V. TheHiftoryof JAPAN. 319 " filver weighs about five ounces ', fo that 500 fhuets amount to 2506 " ounces, which is about 2 500 Rix dollars, or 500 1. Sterling.) " h\\ perfons, who propagate the do&rine of the Chnftians, or bear * this fcandalous name, fhall be imprifon'd in the Ombra, or com- ** mon goal of the town. " The whole race of the Portugueze, with their mothers, nurfes, '.' and whatever belongs to them, fhall be banifh'd to Macao. " Whoever prefumes to bring a letter from abroad, or to return " after he hath been banifh'd, fhall die, with all his family j ** alfo, whoever prefumes to intercede for them, fhall be put to " death. " No nobleman, nor any foldier, fhall be fuffer'd to purchafe any " thing of a foreigner, &c. (T omit the remaining articles of this proclamation, as being foreign to my prefent purpofe.J Given in the thirteenth year of our reign, Qnanje 19, in the 5th month. Sign'd, Saccaja Sanikkeno Cami. Matzendeyro Inferno Cami. Dijno Ojeno Cami. Abono Bongono Cami. Cangano Cami. Now, altho' the Governors of Nangafaki, upon receipt of thefe fe- rheh . ma! vere Imperial commands, took care that they fhould be obey'd and Expulf.m. put in execution without delay, yet the directors of the Portuguefe trade could, with much ado, maintain themfelves in Japan for about two years longer, flill amus'd with hopes to obtain leave to fhy in the Ifland Definta, and there to continue their trade, which they were as un- willing to lofe as their lives. (This Ifland, which lies in the har- bour not far from the town, to which it was made contiguous by a bridge, hath been purpofely rais'd from the bottom of the fea in the year 1635, and furrounded with ftrong gates, pallifadoes, and guard-houfes, with an intention to fhut up the Portuguefe in it for thf fake of their trade, and to keep them as Godo's, or Hereticks, ferarate from any farther commerce with the natives.J But yet they foind themfelves at laft wholly difappointed. The Emperor was throughly refolv'd to get rid of them, and upon aflurances given him by the Dutch Eaft India Company, that they would take care for the fuure to fupply the country, with what commodities had been for- merly imported by the Portuguefe, he declared them, and the Cafti- liins, anl whoever belong'd to them, enemies of the Empire, forbid- dng, with the utmoft feverity, for ever to import even the goods of tieir country, fuch as cloath, leather, wool, fluffs, and in fhort all heir growth and manufactures, Spanifh wines only excepted, which hould be imported for the particular ufe of the court. After this manner, 320 The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book IV. manner it was, and for thefe feveral reafons hitherto given, that the Portuguefe loft their profitable trade and eommerce with Japan, and were totally expell'd the country, before the latter end of the year 1639. Jttcmi-ts The Portuguefe not difcouraged by the many hardships, and great »?.! btlTpomt- l°^ es l ^ e y ^ already undergone, before they would abColutelv give gucfe, to i-- over all hopes of continuing, or reviving this advantageous branch of Trad* r tkeir trac k> refolv'd to try one ftep more, and in the year 1640, the next after their total expulfion, the Government of Macao, fent two Ambadadors to the Emperor, attended with a numerous retinue, confifting in all of feventy three perfons. Thefe Ambaffadors, altoon as they came into the harbour of Nangafaki, were forthwith, purfu- ant to the ftanding Imperial orders aforefaid, put under arreft with their whole retinue, and their Ship alfo taken in execution, though other- wife they had no commodities on board, to (hew that they did not come with an intention to trade. Notice of their arrival apd imprifon- ment having been immediately fent to Court, the Emperor, contrary to the law of nations, fentene'd them all to be beheaded, excepting twelve men of the loweft rank, who were to be fent back to Ma- cao, to bring their countrymen the news of this unhappy fuccefs, along with a moft proud and threatening meflage from the Emperor, containing in fubftance, that mould the King of Portugal himfelf, nay the very God of the Chriftians, prefume to enter his dominions, he would ferve them in the very fame manner. What became af- terwards of thefe twelve men, is not known, for they did not reach Macao, and it is highly probable, that for want of ability and fkill in the management of their fhip, they periih'd at fea. The remain- ing unhappy perfons, who were to be executed, had according to the cuftom of the country, each his own executioner ftanding by him, fo that upon the fignal given, all their heads were ftruck off in an inftant. What lap- I n a Japanefe manufcript, written by an inhabitant of Nagapki, pen A to a sp a - w h jjyfj [ n thofe times, I find mention made of another tragical "tie ' phih ftine event, which happen'd, fometime before this execution, to a large jjlands. Spanifh fhip, which came to Japan from the Philippine Iflands, and was funk with all the goods on board, and all the fhip's compaiy butcher'd in the harbour of Nagafaki. I was willing to infrrt the hiftory of this unhappy accident, as I found it related in the manufcript aforefaid, not doubting the truth thereof, altho' there is no mention made of it in the Journal of the Dutch, who had tfcn their fettlement at Firando. The thing happen'd as follows. The Caftilians (fo the Spaniards were call'd by the Japanefe) toik a Japanefe yonk near Manilhas, and drown'd all the people on boarl, thinking by this means to fink the very memory of fo barbarous an action. But neverthelefs it foon came to be known at the Japa nef Chap. V. The Bijioryof JAPAN. 321 nefe Emperor's court. About a year after a Spanifh (hip of three decks, bound from the Philippine Iflands for Japan, came to an an- chor in the harbour of Nagafaki, whereof immediate and fpeedy no- tice was fent to court by the Governors of that town. Upon this the Prince of Arima receiv'd orders from the Emperor to deftroy and to burn the faid (hip, with all the goods and people on board. About three days before this order came, the Spaniards had warning given them by fome well-meaning people, and friends of theirs, at Nagafaki, that a ftorm was like to break out upon their heads, and were withal advis'd, by a fpeedy flight, to efcape this imminent danger. But covetoufnefs at firft, and at laft contrary winds, prevented their following fo good an Advice. They bulled themfelves day and night, lading the Ihip with gold, filver, and precious Japanefe goods, bringing as much of their riches on board, as (he could poflibly hold, and preparing themfelves for departure and defence in cafe of an attack. Mean while the Prince of Arima, who was appointed to p^t the Imperial orders irt execution, arriv'd in the harbour with a competent number of foldiers, and a great number of boats. The Spanifh (hip was furrounded immediately, which, and the wind's be- ing contrary, made it impoflible for her to make her way thro', and to efcape. The Spaniards in this extremity unanimously took a firm refolution,! to fell their lives dear and the Japanefe found it not fo eafy a matter, as they imagm'd, to take and to burn this (hip. The Prince on his fide, did what he could, by his prefence, and great promifes of reward to encourage his foldiers to a vigorous attack, but finding that none cared to be foremoft, he jump'd on board the Spaniard himfelf, and was follow'd in an inftant, by fuch a number of his foldiers, as cover'd all the deck. The Spaniards upon this retir'd under deck, (hutting the hatches after them. The Prince fufpe&ing, that this was not done without fome ill defign, jump'd over again on board his own (hip, as it were to fetch more men, and the moment after the Spaniards having rir'd fome barrels of powder, which they had laid under deck, blew it up with all the Japanefe (landing upon it. The firft blow being over, the Prince commmanded frefh troops to board the enemy a fecond time, upon which the Spaniards having retir'd under the fecond deck, blew it up in the fame manner. So they did likewife the third, after the Japanefe had made a frefh attempt upon it, the Spaniards retiring to the very bottom of the (hip. By thefe repeated blows, the harbour was cover'd with Japanefe, dead, wounded and bruis'd, before they could fo much as come at the Spaniards, who defended themfelves with the utmoft bravery for fome hours, not furrendring till they were all kill'd to a man. This attack, wherein upwards of 3000 Japanefe loft their lives, lafted full fix hours. Incredible treafures were found afterwards at the place where the (hip funk, and 'tis M m m m faid, 322 TheHiflwyof JAPAN. Book IV. faid, that about 9CO0 cherts of filver were taken up. Thus far my Japanefe author. I was told, that not many years ago fome filver had been div'd up at the fame place. ruards at The Japanefe having at laft clear'd the country of all the Pcrtu- iix topoftbe gygf^ (fome few of the fathers excepted, who continued there Ml hid up and down) the court at Jedo receiv'd advice, that they had been very favourably receiv'd in China, and that they had great in- tereft at the court of the Chinefe Emperor. This oblig'd them to be upon their guard. For this purpofe guard-houfes, or beacons, (which are ftill fubfifting) were erected at the tops of high mountains, and the foldiers upon duty order'd, upon difcovery of a fleet of ten or more European mips failing towards Japan, to give immediate notice there- of by lighting of fires, for which they have always fome combuftible matter ready at hand. Thefe fires being feen, and others lighted at the tops of difiant mountains, the court at Jedo may by this means receive warning in twenty four hours, and confequently without delay give neceffary orders for the defence of the country, the rather, be- caufe ever fince fuch good regulations were made, that as foon as thefe fires are lighted, every one knows what poll he is to take, and what part to acl: in defence of his country. CHAP. VI. Of the T>utch Trade in Japan in general. BrR Settlt Dm pan TH E Dutch, allur'd by the advantageous trade of the Portu- guefe, refolv'd, not long after the eftablifhment of their Eaft India company, and in the very infancy of their navigations into the Indiss, about the beginning of the lad century, to make proper fettlements in Japan, and to provide for the reception of the mips and goods, which they intended to fend thither every year. Their firfl factory and habitation was built on a fmall Ifland, not far from the town of Firando, and made contiguous to the fame by a bridge. They were the more welcome, and the better receiv'd, the greater enemies they were to thofe, whom the fupreme power had then already refolv'd to get rid of, and to expel the Country, I mean the Por.tuguefe. This nation indeed ufed their utmoft endeavours, and. all the influence and credit, they had as yet preferv'd with fevera.^ great men in the Empire, to crufh the Dutch eftablifhments in the very beginning, and to ingrofs the whole trade to them- feivcs, but all was in vain. The then reigning Emperor Ijejas, who was after his death call'd Gongen, granted the Dutch, in the year 1 601, a free trade to all his dominions by an exprefs Gosjunim, as Chap. VI. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 323 as they call it, which in the literal fenfe implies a great Cin- naber mark, and muft be understood of Imperial letters patents fign'd by all the Councellors of fltate, and feal'd with the red Imperial feal , whence the whole inftrument hath borrow'd its name. By vertue of thefe Imperial letters patents the Dutch had leave to import and difpofe of their goods, in all parts of the Emperor's dominions, and this permiflion was back'd with a ftrong recommen- dation to all his fubjecls to forward and to aflift them, as much as lay in their power, the whole in very fignificant and favourable terms and characters. After the death of Ijejas the Dutch apply'd for a renewal of their priviledge. This imprudent ftep being entirely con- trary to the cuftom of the Japanefe nation, which hath a great re- gard for, and inviolably keeps, the laws and promifes made by their anceftors, their demand indeed was granted, and their privilege re- new'd, much upon the fame terms, but in more difadvantageous Cha- racters. Mean while the profperity of the Portuguefe nation was dai- ly decreafing, and haftening to a fatal period, the Dutch on their fide left no ftone unturn'd, upon their impending ruin to build a foundation for their own eftablifhment. No trouble, no expences were fpar'd to pleafe the Emperor, upon whom alone all the good or bad fuccefs of their trade depended. Whatever could be thought of, was done to oblige the Counfellors of ftate, particularly the Prince of Firando, and other great men, who had it in their power to pro- mote, or to hinder their credit and intereft at court. The mod ex- quifite curiofities of nature and art were purchas'd and brought over for the annual prefents. The oddeft and fcarceft animals, in particu- lar, were bought up in the remoteft Kingdoms of Europe, Per/ia, and the Indies, to have wherewithal to fatisfie their demands, ridiculous and fanciful, as they generally were, and of animals fo ftrange in their nature, colours, and fhape, as perhaps never exifted in nature, though they pretended to give us the drawings of them in order to enable ourwiib re us to find them out. In fhort, the intereft of the Dutch, and the great % ard i0 *}* profits, which were likely to accrue to their Eaft India company from fo advantageous a branch of trade, if they could maintain themfelves in credit and favour with this nation, put them under an abfolute. necefiity blindly and paffively to obey, what commands were laid up- on them, how hard and unreafonable foever. This will appear more fuHy by the following inftances. In the year 1638 they were com- manded by the Emperor to demolifh the faclory and warehoufe, which had been lately built by them upon the Ifland Firando, and to lay the fame even with the ground, fo fuddenly, that one would think they had been his greateft Enemies, and this for no other reafon, but becaufe they were built of hewn flones, handfomer than the buildings of the country, and becaufe the year of our blefled Saviour's nativity W3S engrav'd in the front. This unexpected order, though never fo un- reafonable, they were obliged forthwith to comply with, not only with- out court 324 The HiiJoryof) A P A N. Book IV. ut (hewing die ic-.it :-zrk of diflike, but even with feeniing fatisfac^ , -. X;: ;;r; after, and the very fame year, the Court fcrupied r:: : > ;:;-.'-.: ch::r. under.-; a ft:.', feverer :rval, and :o exact moil ,- : - ?.:.?.- ?ruef>. ~. ;h cf the twc was the greater, their :_rd for the Imperial bidets, or the love for their fellow Chriflaans. The cafe was this: About 4C00G Chriftians, reduced to raoft delhbe- c:e ccunheif bv :he rr.ar.v un?a:_.-e.'d cr_:.:.r: aid tcrmeurs. vutich many thoufands of their brethren had already fufter'd, and . . .: . they themfelve; had till then very narrowly efcap'd, rofe up and re- t : i r.:: in old f;r:i:Vd place in the neighbourhood of Shu'-jrs, . uh a firm refolution to defend their lives to the utmoft of thc:r 7; — :. The P;::h upcn this. _f friends and allies cf the Empe- : :, were requefted to affift the Japanefe in the fiege cf this place, : :be :r.-.?endir.g ::::i defir.tiun •;: :he beheged Chriftians. Mr. Kockebecher, who was then director of the Dutch trade and nation at Firzado, having receivd the Emperor's order to this purpofe, repair'd thither without cei: . on board a Ditch fhip lying at anchor in the harbour of FiraaJo (all the other fhiru ; . pexhaps upon feme intimation giver, them, that fbme fuch requeft was like to be made to them from court fet fail but the day before,) and within a fortnight's time batterM the town with 426 cannon balls, both from on beard his fhip, and from a battery, whkh was rais'd on fhore, and planted vr.ir. the : 'the Dutch/ even guns. Jr..-, itrupiianee of the Dutch, and their ccr.dcft during :he fdege, was entirely to the fatisfaftion of the Jag arete, end altho the tefteg'd feerrd in no manner of fbrwardhefs to furrender, yet as by this cannonading they had been very much redue'd in number, and t^eir fttength greatly broke, Air. Kochebechir had leave at laft to depart with his fhip, after they had obligM him, to part with fix guns more, fbr the ufe of the Japanefe, befides thofe which were on fhcre already, not confidering, that the fhip was -here:.- made very defencelefs herfelf for fo infecure a voy- age, as was at that time the paffage frcm Japan to Bata-Ja. Bv this bmiffive readinefs to affift the Emperor in the execution of his de- figns, with regard "to the final defbruction of Chriftianity in his do- minions, 'tis true indeed, that we flood cur ground fo far, as to maintain our felves in die country, and to be permitted to carry on our trade, altho' the court had then fome thoughts of a total ex- clufion of all foreigners whatever. But many generous and noble perfons, at court and in the Empire, judg'd quite otherwife of our conduct, and not too favourably for the credit, vre had thereby en- deavour'd to gam. It feem'd to them inconfiftent with reafon, that the Dutch ihould ever be expected to be fincerely faithful to a fo- reign Monarch, and one too, whom they look upon a 1 ? a Heathen Prince, whillt they fhew'd fo much fcrwardcefs to affift him in the del: . fa people, with whom they cthertvue agjee n the molt -. • . ': Chap. VI. The Hiftory tf J A P A K 325 ;ntial parts of their faith, as the Japanefe had been inform' 1 by the Portuguese and Manilhefe Fathers, and to facrifice to their own worldly intereft thofe, who follow Chrift the very fame way, and enter the kingdom of heaven thro' the fame gate, £» prefli p u s which I have often hear: die r.a: -es make ofe of, when the conver&riori happen'd to turn upon this fu: eh. is (hcrt, our hum:!? cccu: and obliging conduct notw.: were Go fax from bring this proud and jealous nation to all :er confider:e :r m die in- timate friendihip, that on the aiOUUj :v : jealoufy and mifhuft feem'd to increafe, in proportion to the rr.: ..::■.-.:_-: -J finceri: fa u h:\Jnefs we em, add tfiat die better we de- ferv'd of them, the more they feem'd to hate mi it'- ... t: hft in the vear 1641, foon after die ::::. fftpnlfen of the F:::.: _ •: e ers were fent us to quit cur old ridory at Tirando, to tx:'r.t-^b the pr::.u.:n of a geed and indulgent Prince, :":: the fevere and ltr : -:::r:r.: :~ an: end:: : ■ :; v r. :::: vr inched:: :n to conhr.e umi ::. e: thai (final] Illand, I far, Pr.'.hr.. b-..: fcr the Per efe. So tree: v : ; the ::- vetoufnefs of the Dutch, and fo gfeat die alluring -;wer of die Ja- rcr.efe gold, that rathe* than to qui: :r.t :: eh ::' 2 trade indeed moft advantageous, they willingly underwent :n alrr.::: :en erca. :~- prifonment, for fuch in fact : : :ur fhv it JlV.V.r, and :hece : fuffer many hardfhips in a fere::.- and h rathefi country, to be re- is in pesfinmog divine kexyice an :h _ : - and Iblemn : fl n .-. to leave of praying and finghx; :: - in publ :'•:. entirely to a- void the fign of the crefs, the ling :pon ChrHt in pr: natives, and all the outward marts ::' :.:":::. _ ..: ?i- tiently and fubrnifiively to bean the ah. i::d -;.:::: us heha-. :_r of thele pxond infidels torwatds _-. I : rcc-.h r.g can be cret'i more {hocking to a generous and oobk mmd. QaJ non mc-::. . But I proceed to a more partarailai iefcripban of the Datcfa pi ri in - -^^ -.:,-;-, for fo I may defei rdrj call then cdon and factor- at '.'■-.: . -k/» The place where the Dutch live, is caH*d E •*«, the: is, the fori- I'..: ■..:, the Ifland iituate be fare : wn : Some: : : it Df!tM*mat& > that is, the fore-Ijltmd cv-.vn it beine, aanpr dhended amongtt the (beets of 1'.: :-_'.:'■:■. : - .i lubjecl to the fame regulations, h ftands not far from the town, ar.d hath been rais'd from tie bottom of the lea, which is hereabouts r: dv. '.- ■-; rare in :r low water. The found:: ion, for one and a half a: —:> fathoms, i? cf : it rifes ndf a fathom above high-water-ma? In (hape it neax 'embles 1 fan wirhorat a handle, being of : _ oblcn: : Bguie, :he two longer tides whereof are fegmecs rf a circle. It is Cc :he tern :-;-::: : : paces long, a; die end w h e r e of is - Brong ::ird-houfe, w> N:..:: DIG 3 2 6 The Hiftory s/JAPAN. Book IV. arc foldiers conftantly upon duty. On the North-fide of the Ifland are two ftrong gates, which they call the water-gates, which are never open'd but for lading and unlading our fhips, fome Commiffioners ap- pointed by the Governors being prefent. The whole Ifland is enclos'd with pretty high deal-boards, cover'd with fmall roofs, on the top whereof is planted a double row of pikes, like what they call a Cheval deFrize, the whole being, in the main, very weak, and una- ble in cafe of need, to hold out againft any force. Some few paces off the Ifland, in the water, are thirteen very high polls fhnding at proper diftances, with fmall wooden tables at the top, upon which is written, in large Japanefe characters, an order from the Governors, ftriclly and under fevere penalties forbidding all boats or veflels, to come within the faid rails, and to approach the Ifland. Juft before the bridge, towards the town, is a place built of fquare ftones, where they put up the Imperial Mandates and Proclamations, and the orders of the Governors. Two orders of the Governors are continually to be feen there, written on fo many boards, one of thefe orders re- lates to the regulation of the guard, and the other is directed to the ftreet-officers of Defima, and to all perfons who have any bufinefs there, and are on this account oblig'd to go in or out. Befides this, the Qttona, or chief officer of the flreet, to fhew both his vigilance, and the authority he is inverted with, chiefly at the time of the fale of our goods, caufes another order of his own, much to the fame purpofe with thofe of the Governors, to be put up on the other fide of the bridge, juft by the entry of our Ifland. All thefe feveral or- ders and proclamations, I propofe to treat of in a particular chapter. (See the ioth Chapter of this Book.) The fquare furface of our Ifland is commonly fuppos'd to be equal to that of a Stadium^ having 6oo foot in length, and 240 in breadth. By my own meafuring I found the breadth to be of 82 common paces, and the main length of 236, I fay the main length, becaufe, as will appear by the annex'd figure, it is fmaller towards the town, and larger towards the harbour. A broad flreet runs acrofs the whole Ifland. There is alfo a fmall walk to go round along the deal boards which inclofe it. This walk may be fhut up at any time, if needful. The gutters run all out into the' fea, being crooked narrow pipes, made fo on purpofe, left any thing fhould be by this means convey'd out of the Ifland, which they fuppofe could be eafily done if thev were made ftreight. That flreet only, which runs acrofs the Ifland lengthways, hath houfes built on both fides. Thefe houfes, and the whole Ifland, were built at the expence of fome inhabitants of Nagafaki, to whom, or their heirs, we ftill pay, by virtue of the firft agreement, a yearly rent of 6500 Siumome, a price far beyond the real value. All the houfes are built of wood, chiefly firr, and are withal very forry and poor, looking more like cottages. They are two ftories high, the lower- mofl Chap. VI. The Hiftwy s/JAPAN. 327 molt of which ferves inftead of warehoufes. The uppermoft we live in, and thefe we rauft fit up at our own expence, with colour'd paper, inftead of hangings, as the cuftom is in the country, and pro- vide our felres with mats to cover the floor, as alfo with doors and locks, if we have a mind to keep our things fafe, and to have the rooms fhut at night. The other buildings within the compafs of our Ifland are, three guard-houfes, Handing one at each end, and one in the middle of the Iiland : A place hard by the entry, where they keep all the neceffary inftruments to extinguifh fires, for which purpofe alfo there are feveral holes dug to fetch up water, which however ane kept fhut, and naiPd up fo, that in cafe of need they may be eafily open'd. All the water we want in the kitchin, and for common ufe, comes from the river which runs thro' the town. It is brought over in pipes made of Bambous, and runs into a referver built within the Iiland. This provifion of water, is an article to be paid for by itfelf. Behind the great ftreet the company caufed at their own expence, a con- venient houfe to be built for the fale of our goods, as alfo two warehoufes ftrong enough to hold out againft fire * ("the warehoufes abovemention'd, or the firfl ftories of our dwelling houfes being expos'd to rain and fire, and but very little fecur'd from thieves J a large kitchin j a houfe for the deputies of the Governors, who are appointed by them to direct and regulate our trade •, a houfe for the Interpreters, which is made ufe of only at the time of our fale • a kitchin and plea- fure- garden •, a place to wafh our linnen, and other things :, fome fmall private gardens, and a bagnio. The Ottona, or chief officer of the ftreet, hath alfo a houfe and garden of his own. A place hath been left empty for fome fhops, which are put up during the time, our fhips lie in the harbour. And there is likewife another corner for laying up old rubbiih, cordages, and feveral utenfils neceffary for packing of goods. Very lately fome people have been executed upon this fame place for fmugling, and the Governors upon this occafion inform'd us, that unlefs proper care be taken for the future, the Dutch fhould fufFer for this crime as well as the natives. (In the Author's original High German Manufcript, there were feveral references to a ground- plot, or view of the If and, as I fuppoje, but not finding the fame among his other drawings and papers, I was obliged to leave them out. In the mean time, the reader is defied to confult the plan of Nagafaki, Tab. XIX.) This is the prefent ftate of the Ifland, the fmall compafs whereof the Dutch have been confin'd to by the Japanefe j and as things now ftand we muft be fo far fatisfied with it, there being no hopes that we fhould ever be better accommodated, or allow'd more liberty by fo jealous and circumfpect a nation. Our fhips, which put into this har- bour once a year, after they have been thoroughly vifited by the Ja- panefe, and proper lifts taken of all the goods on board, have leave to put their men on fhore upon this Ifland to refrefh them, and to keep 328 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. keep them there, fo long as they lie in the harbour, commonly two or three months. After they have left the harbour, the Director of our trade remains in the Ifland with a fmall number of people,, about feven or more if he thinks proper. In former times, when our trade was free and more extenfive, there were feldom lefs than twenty ftaid there. Now confidering that there are fo very few Dutchmen left in the Ifland, one would imagine, that the Japanefe had no reafon in the world to be uneafy, or anywife apprehenfive of our conduct. Surely fuch a fmall number of people, and thofe too de- priv'd of arms and ammunition (the very firft thing which the Japa- nefe take into their cuftody upon the arrival of our mips) would ne- ver take it into their heads to make any attempt againft the peace and tranquility of the Empire,. As to fmugling, they have too well prevented any attempts of that kind on our fide, by taking not only an exact inventory of all our goods and commodities, but by locking them up under their own locks and feals. Even the cloth and fluffs, which are brought over for our own ufe, muft be deliver'd into the cuftody of the Ottona, till one of their own taylors, fworn for this purpofe, cuts them, allowing each of us juft fo much as will make him a good fuit. But what they have ftill lefs reafon to be apprehenfive of, is the fubverficn of their Pagan doctrine and reli- gion, fo little confpicuous are the principles of chriftianity in our lives and actions. Neverthelefs fo many guards, corporations, focie- ties, with their numerous attendants, all upon oath, and themfelves jealous and miftruftful one of another, are fet to guard, and narrowly to watch us, as if we were the greateft malefactors, traitors, fpies, in a word, the worft and moft dangerous fet of people, or to make ufe of a very fignificant expreflion of the Japanefe, as if we were, what I think we really are, Fitozitz, that is, the Emperor's Hoftages. This leads me to give an account of thefe feveral guards and watches, under whofe infpeclion we fland. Gate Guard. The firft and chief of our Guards is the Monban, or Gate-Guard, which guards the gate towards the town, that being the only paf- fage left for people to go in, or out, and for things to be carried in or out. It is mounted daily by five perfons, their fervants not computed. At the time of the fale of our goods, there are never lefs than ten, but fometimes twelve and more, their number being at that time very uncertain. At the fame time there are conftantly two men of the Funaban^ or mips and harbour guard, two of the Siumnfi, or fpy guards, a fervant of the Ninban To/ij Jori, or prefiding mayor, and a fervant of the D/iofoJ], or deputy mayor, as the chief officers of the Sottomatz, or lower town, do duty there. One of the two laft keeps the journals af the guard wherein is enter'd what na!Tcs from hour to hour, what perfons go in or out, and what things are carried in or out, for the inftru&ion of the governors of the town, who Chap. VI. The Hiflory of JAPAN. 329 who now and then, at leaft once a month, call for tfoem and look them over ^ and yet without exprefs orders from the governors, or leave given by the Ottona, nothing is fuffer'd to pafs through, but what is fent in by the perfons, who are to take care to provide us with all manner of neceffaries, and unprohibited goods. For a ftill greater fecurity three fworn fearchers are added to this guard, one or two whereof attend conftantly hard by the gate, to fearch whoever goes in or out, whether they have nothing of contraband goods about them : Nor is there any body exempted from being fearch'd, but the governors, their deputies, or commiflloners with their retinues, as alfo our ordinary Interpreters and their fons, I mean thofe, who are en- ter'd among the number of apprentices. During the time our mips' lie in the harbour, four men more muft be maintain'd at the expence of the Inhabitants of the town, who furnifh them by turns, and four others at the expence of the filk merchants : thefe, as they have their (hare of the trouble, fo they have it likewife of the profit ari- ling from it. Such a variety of people of different places, ranks and charatters, being to do duty upon one guard, it obliges on -one fide every body to difcharge their duty to the utmoft of their power and capacity, and on the other hand it puts the government out of all appre- hensions of their plotting, or confpiring together :, for in facTr, they are not only to watch us, and the people who have bufinefs with us, and on this account go in or come out of our Ifland, but them- felvcs alfo and their own a&ions. Among the things which ftand, or are hung up on the walls of the guard-houfe, are irons to put on criminals, ropes to bind them, heavy ftaffs to beat them, and a parti- cular fort of an inftniment, which they make ufe of to catch thieves and deferters, and which is commonly carried about at their publick executions. The fecond guard, or rather watch, is the Mawariban, or Round, yiwarihan, It confifts of fix of the poorer inhabitants of Nagafaki, or labouring 0T the Ro " w ' J ' people. They have their proper (rations within the narrow compafs of our Iiland, from whence they go over to one another all night long, and indicate, according to the cuftom of the country, both their vigilance, and the hours of the night, by beating two wooden cylin- ders one againft another. They are alfo to watch thieves, accidents of fire, and the like. They are reliev'd once a month. All the ftreets of Nagafaki furnifh their number by turns. During the time of the fale of our goods, the Ottona, or head of our ftreet, our landlords, and the officers of our exchequer, do duty themfelves, as being anfwerable for all accidents, or elfe fend their truftiefl fer- vants, So long as our fale lafls, another particular guard is kept on pur- jjitional pofe to watch accidents of fire, by our Ottona, his clerks, our land- Watch during lords, the officers of our exchequer, and the cooks. In their firft '^"£1? O o o o round 330 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. round they knock at every door, to ask whether there be no Japanese hid in the houfe, and to recommend to the Inhabitants to take care of the fire. The Ottona muft be prefent at it himfelf at leaft once in a night, when according to the cuftom of the country, his iron fire ftaff, hung about with iron rings, as the badge of his authority, is carried rattling after him. At the fame time the Dutch keep another watch of their own, and by their own people, who are to go their rounds in the Ifland all night long, and to take care, that their ma- tters be not robb'd by their Japanefe Guards. tumUtiy Befides all thefe feveral Guards, which I have hitherto mentioned, tS'StST tnere are *" omc otncrs appointed to have a general infpe&ion over all foreigners, (I mean the Dutch, as well as the Chinefe, and thofe Eaflern nations, who trade to Japan under their name). The chief of thefe h the Funaban, or fhips and harbour guard, which goes the round in the harbour, particularly about our Ifland, all night long. But I fhall not much enlarge at prefent upon thefe, having already m^j/uL. given fome account of them in the third chapter of this Book. I proceed therefore to our officers, I mean thofe perfons who are con- cern'd in the Government of our Ifland, and the carrying on of our trade, whether appointed by the Governors of Nagafaki, or hired by us, and pay'd out of the money, which is yearly detain'd from the price of our Goods. All thefe people, although they maintain them- felves and their families entirely upon what they get by us and our fervice, yet from their conduct one would take them to be our fworn enemies, always intent to do us what mifchief they can, and fo much the more to be fear'd, as their hatred and enmity is hid under the fpecious colour of friendfhip, deference, and good will. omna. Xhe chief of our Officers, and who ought to be mention'd in bbi firft place, is Jofjkawa Gibttjemon, our prefent Ottona, who befides the command he hath of one of the ftreets of the Town, is alfo entrufted with that of our Ifland Defima. He is next in rank to our firft In- terpreter, who is prefident of the whole company of Interpreters, which doth not ftand under the Ottona'?, difpofition. The bufinefs of his office is as follows. He is to take care of whatever relates to us, to cur Ifland and the Government thereof. He hath the infpe- ction of our trade, and of the yearly fale of our goods, in company and with the affiftance of the Company of Interpreters. He keeps a particular lift of thofe of our goods, which belong to private perfons, keeps them in his cuftody, and gives orders, when and how they are to be difpos'd of. He takes care, that our ftreets, houfes, and other buildings be kept in good repair, and likewife, fo much as lies in his power, that they be not injur'd by thieves, fire, or other accidents. He prote&s our fcrvants, cooks, mafters of the kitchin, or daily labourers, and all perfons who are within the reach of his Jurifdi&ion. He compofes the differences arifing between them. He adfhits Chap. VI. The Hiftory of JAPAN. 331 admits and fwears them into their refpe&ive employments, and dif- miifes them as he pleafes. He gives pafTports and tickets to come to Defijfia, no body being permitted to enter this Ifland without them. He is oblig'd by virtue of his office, and by the oath he hath taken to the government, narrowly to examine into the conduct, life and behaviour, not only of our fervants and officers, but alfo of our felves, and to keep us to a ftri& obedience to the Imperial orders, tho' he is very cautious in laying any commands upon us of his own accord and fole authority, knowing that we would refufe to obey them in that cafe. However, he hath fo much power over us, that in cafe any confiderable crime be committed, or any difregard lhewn to the Imperial orders, by any one of us, he can arreft him, and lay him in irons, of which there are many and almoft daily inftances. Our prefent Ottona, as on one fide he work'd himfelf into no fmall efteem and favour with the government, by his great feverity in the execution of his office, but chiefly by having betray'd us and our intereft in a late affair, fo much is he on the other hated by us. I will not take upon me to examine, what reafons he hath to alledge for his conduct in that affair, tho' I have been credibly inform'd, he had very good ones. Thus far I muft do juftice to his character, and own, that he mews a great deal of prudence in his conduct, that he is no ways given to co- vetoufnefs or falfhood, as alfo, that he is an enemy to ignorance and brutality, and fo well vers'd in the moral doctrine of Kooji, (or Confutius) and in die hiftory, laws, and religion of his country, that he hath been defir'd to write the hiftory of the Province Fifen. For the execution of his office, as Ottona, he hath the following officers under himj a Jsit&i Jofi, or Meffenger, whofe bufinefs it is, daily to examine into the condition and fafety of the locks at the water-gates, into the ftate of our waTehoufes, and other buildings, and to give his mailer notice of what he finds out of repair j feveral Fi/Ia, or Clerks, who are to make lifts of all the moveable goods belonging to pri- vate perfons, which may be difpos'd of, to feal them up in the Ot- tona's name, and to take them into fafe cuftody. Not to mention at prefent feveral other inferior officers, who are at all times in readinefs to put his orders in execution. He hath the fame falary allow'd him by the Dutch Eaft India Company, with the chief in- terpreter, and the fame (hare in the money detain'd by order of the government from the price of our goods, befides feveral other advan- tages, as for inftance, his falary as Ottona of another ftreet in the town, many prefents and gratifications made him by the proprietors of our Iiland, and a confiderable part of the yearly rents we pay for the fame, he having already purchas'd about one third of our houfes. His greateft profits arife from the Dutch goods, bought up for him at- 332 The Hijlorj of J A P A N. Book iy. at a cheap rate in other peoples names, and afterwards fold by him for much more' than their prime cofl. Proprietors of Next to the Ottona are the Defima Tfijoonin, that is, our twenty « r ijlcmA four landlords, or proprietors of our Ifland. They viflt us but feldom, excepting at the time of our fale, when they make their appearance daily, to look after the condition of our houfes, to be prefent and lend a helping hand in making a lift of all our commodities, hou- fhold-goods, and other things, and what is more, to have a watchful eye over us, their tenants, themfelves, and to examine into our be- behaviour and condud, as being, by virtue of the laws and cuftoms of the country, anfwerable for the fame, and in cafe of accidents or mifdemeanors, fentenc'd to bear a mare either in the lofs or pu- hifhment. Company «f The chief and moft ' extenfive company, or corporation of the offi- lnterp-eur,. c ^. g of Qm jjj^ j g that of the Ho n anda Tfjimnfi, or Dutch Inter- preters, a very numerous body, generally confifting of about 150 Perfons. During my flay in Japan their number was not compleat there being then not above 123. The government took care to pro- vide fuch a large number of Interpreters, on purpofe to make it needlefs for us to learn the language of the country, and by this means to keep us, as much as lies in their power, ignorant of its prefent ftate and condition, its cuftoms,. laws, commerce, hiftory and other things, which might be worthy our knowledge and enquiry. Formerly there were not near fo many, but it hath been fince thought proper to increafe their number, chiefly for two reafons, firft, that fo many more of the Inhabitants of Nagafaki fhould be enabled by this means to get an honeft livelihood, fecondly, that we fhould be more narrowly watch'd in, proportion at the time of our fale. A more particular account \of this corporation, its management, laws, and cuftoms, which may ferve as a pattern of other the like corporations efhblifh'd in this country, would be too ample a fubjecl to be enlarg'd upon at prefent, I fhall therefore defer it to the next chapter. For the fame reafons alfo, I fhall now forbear giving an account of the Defima Fijia, or Secretaries of our Ifland, who are Deputies of the Interpreters, of the Defima TJietzi, or the infpectors of our porters and daily labourers, and the Cannabana Kama, or the directors and other officers of our Treafury, all thefe feveral offices and companies having a more particular relation to our trade and commerce,, which will be the fubjed of the following chapter. tornmiKonen Next to the feveral corporations and offices aforefaid, that of the for Viifual- Kalmono Tfkal muft be confide r'd, or as they are otherwife call'd with a half Portuguefe word Compranakama, which is as much as to fay, Conimiffioners for victualling. It is compos'd at prefent of about fe- venteen houfe-keepers of Nagafaki, with their families. Their bufinef* is to provide our Ifland with victuals, drink, houfhold goods, and wha t elfe Chap VI. The Hiflory of JAPAN. 333 elf* we want, or have leave to buy of this kind. No body elfe, but the members of this corporation, is permitted to fell us any victuals or goods, tho', they exact fo much upon us, that they make us pay at leaft twice, or thrice fo much as things are fold for at the market. They alfo take care to furnifh our people on demand with whores, and truly our young failors unacquainted, as they com- monly are, with the virtue of temperance, are not afham'd to fpend five Rixdollars for one night's pleafure, and with fuch wenches too, whom a native of Nagafaki could have for about two or three Maas, they being none of the beft and handfomeft. Nor doth the Bawd get more than a Siumome, being about one third of the money, the reft is laid up in the cafh of this company for their own private ufe, and as they pretend, to hire proper fervants, to conduct the damfels over to our Ifland. Next follow the DaiJokoro Nomono, that is, the officers of the kitchin. °ff ct " "f fM This company confifts of three cooks, who ferve by turns, each a month, (for which fervice they are allow'd twenty four Siumome a piece) of two grooms of the kitchen, an apprentice, or two, who are generally the cook's own fons, and likely to fucceed their fathers in time, laftly of fome labourers to carry water. Sometimes the fervants of the Commiflioners for victualling help the ill. This is the reafon that our table is fo very expenfive, fince the beft part of the year, the time of our fale only excepted, there are actually more cooks than people to provide victuals for. And yet we have ftrict com- mands from the governors of the town, not in the leaft to alter this number, nor to get our victuals drefs'd by our own people. They were allow'd formerly, the firft and head cook, fix, the fecond four, the third three thails a month. But ever fince 1674, we have been ob- lig'd by an order from the governors to allow them 150 thails a year to the firft, 130 to the fecond, and ico to the third, that is about double their former wages. There are befides fome other people* who now and then, do fome little fervice in and for our kitchin, fuch as a gardiner, a man to look after our cattle, (tho' but very few in number, and of very little ufe to us, the males being generally fe- cretly poifon'd, or their legs broke in the night, to prevent their multiplying too much, which, 'tis apprehended, would turn to the difadvantage of the commiflioners for victualling,) and fome other me-* nial fervants. This being look'd upon by the meaner fort of peo- ple at Nagafaki, as a fmall perquifite, which every one is glad to have a {hare of in his turn, thefe fervants are relieved once a month, and others fent in their ftead to do their bufinefs, out of every ftreet of Nagafaki. But the chief reafon why they relieve them fo often is, becaufe they apprehend a longer ftay would make them too familiar with us, and perhaps too favourable for our intereft. P p p p The TraJesnitn, 334. The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. Servant of The Dutch, out of a particular favour, are permitted to have feme of tht Butch un g b y S t0 wa it upon them in the day-time. They are enter'd into the Ottona's book in quality of meffengers. They are commonly fons of the inferior interpreters, and other officers of our Ifland, who by this opportunity of learning the Dutch language qualify them- felves in time to fucceed their fathers. However care is taken, that they mould not ftay in our fervice, but fo long as they are look'd upon as fimple and ignorant of the ftate and intereft of their country, or elfe fo long as the Ottona pleafes to give them leave, but never without fufficient fecurity given upon oath, by an honeft inhabitant of Nagafaki, who obliges himfelf to be anfwerable for their mifbeha- viour. Thus much muft be own'd in juftice to thefe young boys, that more readinefs to do what they are commanded, and a greater fidelity in the cuftody of the goods they are intrufted with by their mafters, is hardly to be met with in any other nation. Laft of all, there are alfo fome tradefmen and artificers of feveral companies in Nagafaki permitted to come over to our Ifland, when fent for, provided they have leave of the Governors, which muft. be obtain'd every time they are wanted. They divide the profits with the reft of the fame company, and befides to be in favour with the Ottona and our Interpreters, as the chief managers of our burl nefs, they make them a prefent once a year. Thefe are the feveral officers concern'd in the management of our Ifland and trade, and permitted on this account, to come over to us, and to con- verfe with us, tho' never without fome plaufible pretext, and yet no fin- cere friendship, good underftanding, or familiarity, can be by any means expe&ed from them. For before they are admitted into our fervice, they . muft oblige themfelves by a folemn oath, to deny us all manner of communication, credit, or friendfhip, any ways tending to fupport or to promote our intereft. This obligation muft be frequently renew'd by them, fo long as they continue in our fervice. ©atb. The oath as it is taken at Nagafaki, and every where in the Em- pire, is a folemn obligation to do fuch or fuch things, made ac- cording to a ftated form, as it is contain'd in the laws and ftatutes of the Empire. The perfon, who takes this oath, prays the vengeance of the fupreme Gods of the heavens, and the chief magiftrates of his coun- try, upon him, his family, his domefticks, his friends and near re- lations, in cafe he doth not fincerely fulfil and fatisfy to all and eve- ry article, as they are read and fpecified to him after the form of the oath, which together with thefe articles muft be fign'd by him, and feal'd with his feal dipp'd in black Ink, pouring for a ftill ftronger confirma- tion, fome drops of his own blood upon it, which he fetches by prick- ing one of his fingers behind the nail. This oath though never fo terri- ble and binding would yet be but little regarded, by this nation, were it not for the fevere punifhment put by the civil rrlagiftrate upon any the leafl Chap. VI. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 335 leaf! tranfgreflion thereof, a crime which is not to be expiated but by fhedding the very fame blood, the oath hath been confirm'd withal. The articles thus fign'd and folemnly fworn to, differ both in num- ber and weight, according to the perfon, who takes the oath, the na- ArucUi ture of his office and the extent of the power he is entrufted with. In fa™™* the main they may be divided into three forts. The rirft, and thole of the greateft moment, the tranfgreflion whereof i3 alio punifh'd irt the moft fevere manner, are fign'd and fworn to by the Ottona, the chief interpreter, his deputy, and apprentices, as prefumptive fuccefTors to his employment. The bath is renewed to them only upon the arrival of a new Governour, who adminifters it in perfon, and in his own palace not by making the perfons, who are to take it, repeat the words af- ter him, or hold up three of their lingers, or lay their hands upon fome facred Book, as is cuftomary in European Countries, but by making them fign the articles read to them with their feals and blood, in the manner above related. The articles of the fecond fort, which are of lefs weight and confequence, are fign'd and fworn to in the fame man- ner by the main body of our interpreters, our cooks, the officers of our treafury, the fecretaries and clerks of our Ifland, the Kuli Maflers, or infpedors of our workmen, and the commiflioners for victualling. The oath is adminiftred to them by the Ottond, and chief Interpreter, in the temple Anfenfi of the feci Ten Dai, as the ufual place of their meetings. The articles of the third fort and thofe of the leaft moment, are fworn to by all our menial fervants and inferior officer's, the! young men, who are fuffer'd to wait upon us, the workmen and trades-men who have any thing to do with us, and who take the oath only in prefence of the Ottona, and in his own houfe. This laft oath, as being taken by mean, young and inconfiderable people is alfo not allow'd fufficient to be for which reafon they muft, every one of them, findanhoneft houfe-keep- er in town, who will give fecurity for their good behaviour, and be an- iwerable for their mifdemeanours. The Commiflioners for victualing being likewife anfwerable for the behaviour of the fervants belonging to their office, take a particular oath from them, to which they make them put their fcals only, but not their blood. The jealous and fufpicious magiftrate is not at all fatisfied with making our officers and fervants of the fecond and third rank take the oath once T h°' lt h \j, often repeated* a year. The fame muft be repeated twice at leaft j firft about the be- ginning of the year, at the time when they perform that folemn act: of theirs of trampling over the Image of our blelfed Saviour pendant from the Crofs, of the Virgin Mary and of other holy perfons, as' a publick and unqueftionable proof that they for ever renounce the chriftian religion. It is adminiftred to them a fecond time, after the arrival of our mips in the harbour, and this in order to remind them of the folemn obligations they lie under, and to renew their hatred to- wards us. The perfons who arc to attend us in our Journey to court muft 33<> The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. mufl immediately before their departure take a third oath, promifing in the abovemention'd folemn way, that they will have a ftrict hand and watchful eye ovet us and our conduit all along the road, and that they will not mew us any particular ads of friendship, or enter into any kind of familiarity with us. „ , , , Befides all the articles aforefaid, which are thus folemnly fwore to. Orders of the J Ottona, E$V. there are feveral particular orders made, and publifh'd by the Ottona and put up in feveral parts of our Ifland, the chief intent wherecf is to inftruct thofe, who are permitted to have any communication with us, how they are to behave themfelves with regard to us and the difpatch of our bufinefs, fo long as they ftay at Defima. There are five ofthefe or- ders ftuck up at the time of our fale 3.1 the entry of the Ottona's houfe, where he lives during the fummer. The chief relates to the vi- fitation of our Goods exported and imported. The vifitors appointed, re- ceive from the Ottona, the neceffary inftructions, a lift of all the the con- traband goods, according to which they are to regulate themfelves. A proclamation of the Governours relating to the conduct of fuch per- sons, as during the time of our fale, go in and come out of our Ifland is ftuck up at all the corners of our ftreets. The proper orders con- cerning the regulation and management of our treafury are hung up in that office, and thofe which relate to our interpeters in the houfe, where they meet. Merchants. Befides the perfons fworn into the feveral offices relating to the management of our Ifland and trade, fome others have leave to come over to us, but only during the time of our fale, and upon other de- termined days. Of the number of thefe are the merchants, who come over to buy what goods have been imported by us, and the copper- merchants, or elfe their factors, or deputies, who come chiefly from Miaco, and other parts of the Empire. When our fale is at an end, fome manufactures of the country, as lacker'd ware, feveral things made of copper, which the Japanefe work with uncommon nicety, and fome goods of the country are expos'd to fale in a particular place, built for that purpofe. None of thefe perfons hitherto mention'd can pafs through our gates, unlefs he fuffers himfelf to be fearch'd, and can produce a proper paff board, which is done generally upon their going out ; however, the commiffioners or deputies of the Governours, who have a pike carried before them, as a badge of their authority, and fuch of their retinue, as wear two fwords are exempted from being fearch'd, as are alfo the Ottona, eight of our chief Interpreters and their fons or apprentices, who are priviledged to learn our language, in or- der to qualify themfelves as their future fucceffors. This particular fa- vour is allow'd them, to the firft, as commiffion'd infpectors of our con- duct, to the reft as our profefs' d enemies, as well by virtue of their oath, as for the fake of their Intereft. Tie Chap. VI. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 337 The pafs-board, is a fmall board about three inches long and two. Paffhoari, inches broad. It hath on one fide the common, or family-name of the Ottona of that ftreet, where the bearer lives, with his feal under it in black ink, a limitation how long it is to continue in force, and the name of the bearer. On the other fide is the impreflion of the larger mark of our Ottona, made with a hot iron, with his title Defima Ottona added to it. When our mips are fhortly expe&ed in the harbour, he fends a competent quantity of boards thus mark'd to all the Ottona^ of the town, for the ufe of the inhabitants of their ftreets, or ftrangers, who at that time refort thither on account of our trade, from all parts of the Empire. The orders of the Japanefe Government to the Dutch, are partly orders of read to the director of our trade in the Imperial palace at JeJo t in the J^nefe prefence of feme of the Privy Counfellors, and partly communicated to us by the Governors of Nagafaki, either by word of mouth, or by their Bngjo's and our Interpreters. Upon the arrival of our fhips, our Interpreters take efpecial care to recommend to us to have a due regard to thofe orders, which tend chiefly to prevent fmugling of what kind foever, as it is accurately fpeeified therein for the inftruclion of new comers, to avoid all the outward marks of Chfiftianity in pre- fence of the natives, and to live in good understanding both with our own officers and fervants, and other Inhabitants of tfagafaki. Otherwife they need not recommend to us to remain within due bounds of continency, becaufe there are fo many guards and watches fet upon us in all corners of our Ifland, as one would think more than fufficient to prevent all means of being loofe and extra- vagant. . . Thus we live all the year round little better than prifoners, con- pleafum fin'd within the compafs of a fmall Ifland, under the perpetual and alloV) d * ""' narrow infpeftion of our keepers. 'Tis true indeed, we are now and then allow'd a fmall efcape, an indulgence, which, without flattering our felves, we can by no means fuppofe to be an effect of their love and friendfhip, forafmuch as it is never granted to us, unlefs it be to pay our refpecls to fome great men, or for fome other bufinefs, neceffary on our fide, and advantageous for the natives. Nor doth the coming out even upon thofe occafions give us any greater liberty, than we enjoy at home, as will appear by the great expences of our jour- nies and vifits, great or fmall, by the number of guards and infpe&ors who constantly attend us, as if we were traitors and profefs'd ene- mies of the Empire, and by enumerating the particular opportunities, which call us abroad, and are as follows. After the departure of our fhips, the director of our trade, or red- _ r r ' ' Journey dent of the Dutch Eaft India Company, fets out with a numerous re- to Court. tinue on his journey to court, to pay his refpeefs to the Emperor, and to make the ufual yearly prefents. This journey to court muft Q. q q q be 338 The Hi/lory of] A P A N. Book IV; be made once a year, not only by the Dutch, but even by all the Princes and Ldrds of the Empire, as being the Emperor's vaffals, and our own embaffy is look'd upon at court, as an homage paid by the Dutch Nation to the Emperor of Japan, as their fovereign Lord. For this very reafon it is, that before the departure of our Embaf- f'adors from Jedo, feveral orders and regulations are read to them, relating to our behaviour in this country, and that, by way of con- verfation, we are commonly call'd Fitoz'itz, that is, Hoftages, viz. of the Dutch Nation. Upon the journey it felf wc are not allow'd any more liberty, than even clofe prifoner3 could reafonably claim. We are not fuffer'd to fpeak to any body, not even without fpecial leave to the domefticks and fervants of the Inns we lodge at. As foon as we come to an Inn, we are without delay carried up flairs, if pefli- ble, or into the back apartments, which have no other view but into the yard, which for a ftill greater fecurity, and to prevent any thoughts of an efcape, is immediately fhut and nail'd up. Our retinue, which by fpecial command from the Governors of Nagafaki, guards, attends and aflifts us in our journey, is compos'd of the interpreters and cooks of our Ifland (of whom above) and moreover of a good number of foldiers, bailiffs, fervants, porters, people to look after our horfes, and bag- gage, which mull be carried on horfeback. All thefe people, tho' never fo needlefs, muft be maintained at the company's expence. rifts to the Before our departure for Jedo, and again upon our return from Governors. thence, our Captain as he is call'd by the Japanefe, or the Dire.^or of our Factory, with one of his company, goes to make a vifit to the Gover- nors of Nagafaki at their Palace, to return them thanks for their fa- vours, and to entreat the continuation of their protection. Now, not even this vifit can be made without a numerous train of guards, foldiers and bailifs, carrying halters in their pockets. The Ottona, fome of our chief Interpreters, and fome few of our fervants, are alfo of the party. The whole company is often oblig'd to flay a good while at the Genquaban, or great Houfe-guard, before they are admit- ted to audience. Another vifit, and with the like numerous attendance, is made to the Governors, by the dire&or of our fa&ory, upon the Fajfiaku, that is, the firfi day of the eighth month, when it is ufual to make them a prefent. Same mo>j ^ ^ ie Governors want to fpeak with any of the Dutch, upon any regulations particular occafion, either to communicate new orders to them, or elfe 7k7r>Kt"h. t0 § et f° me information from them, the fame means and infpedions are made ufe of to bring them over to their palaee, and they muft take it as a Angular favour, if they are admitted into the Governors prefence, who often fend only fome of their officers to let them know what they were fent for. The Chap. VI. The Hijioryof JAPAN. 339 The few Dutchmen, who remain at Defima, after the departure of our ihios, are permitted once or twice a year, to take a walk into the adjacent country, and in particular to view the temples about Naga- faki: This liberty is oftner granted to Phyfieians and Surgeons, under pretence of going to fearch for Medicinal Plants. However, this plea- fare yralk falls very expenfive to us, for it mud be made in company of the Ottona, of our ordinary Interpreters, and other officers in our fer-. vice, who are handfomely treated by us at dinner, in one of the Temples of the Ikosju SeB, and we muft on this occafion, even with feeming fatisfattion, fee our purfes flrongly fqueez'd for the moft common civilities (hewn us by the Priefts of that Temple. Another day is fet apart for viewing five large boats, which muff be confhntly kept at the expence of the Dutch Eaft India Companv, for the lading and unlading of our fhips. This is again done with the fame numerous retinue, which we afterwards entertain at dinner at one of the neighbouring temples. The feftival of Suva, the Patron and Protector of Nagafaki, of which above, falling juft upon the time, when our fhips lie in the harbour, our people are permitted to view this folemnity from a fcaftbld, built at our own expence, our prefence being not only thought honourable to their Saint, but, what they value ftill more, advantageous to many of his worfhippers. It may be eafily imagin'd, that our train and guards are not lefTen'd upon fuch an occafion. On the contrary we are examin'd and fearch'd four times, before we come to the place, where the folemnity is perform'd, and again after- wards counted over feveral times with all pofiible accuracy, when we go up and when we come down from the Scaffold, as if it were poffible for fome of us to flip out between their fingers. Our flaves alfo are ad- mitted to this folemnity, as black Dutchmen. When one of our fhips hath been difcover'd to fteer towards the harbour, fome of the Dutchmen left at Defima are fent to meet her, in order to get a preliminary information of her cargo and condition, for our own inftru&ion, and that of the governors. The company for this purpofe conftantly keeps two barges in readinefs, large enough to take on board our ufual numerous attendance, which, together with the Compra Nakama, or Commiffioners for victualling, attending in their own barge, with a good provifion of victuals and refrefhments, muft be treated in the neighbouring fmall Ifland Iwara Gafima, the whole again at the company's expence. There are likewife orders, in cafe of accidents of fire in or near Defima, to carry us and our things away into fafe cuftody to another place. Thefe and fome other orders are to be feen at large in the laft Chapter of this Book. The& 34>o The Hijiorj of J A P A N. Book IV. Cviiity of the Thefe are the days allow'd us for our recreation, if otherwife it 3afa>itjr. n be call'd a recreation to be led about like prifoners, under the narrow infpe&ion of fo many attentive eyes. Thus much however I cannot forbear owning in juftice to the natives, that even amidft all the troubles and hardfhips we are expos'd to in this country, we have at lead this comfort, that we are treated by our numerous guardians and overfeers, with apparent civility, with careffes, compliments, pre- fents of vi&uals, and other marks of deference io far as it is not in- confiflent with their reafon of ftate. But this their genteel and reafonable behaviour on our behalf is owing more to the cuftom of the coun- try, and to the innate civility and good manners of the natives, than to any particular efteem they have for us, or any favour they are Thar l, jH - w j}ij n g t0 f new us . Nay quite the contrary appears evident by their conduct towards us in many inftances, which is not only un- reasonable, but in the higheft degree difhoneft. It will not be amifs to mention a few particulars, which I know to be fad, either from my own experience, or their own confeflions in private converfa- tion. It would be endlefs to enumerate all the roguifh tricks and cheats, our Interpreters have at all times play'd us, all the unjuft de- mands laid upon us, chiefly during the time of out fale, and the unreafonable requefls made even of our Captains, as they call them, and directors of our faclory, their facred character, as publick ambaf- fadors to their own Emperor notwithihnding. Jvfiaatts No Japanefe in general, who feems to have any regard or friend- thnof. ^^ £ oj . t j ie Y) n t c h, is look'd upon as an honeft man, and true lover of his country. This maxim is grounded upon the following prin- ciple, that it is abfolutely contrary to the intereft of the country, againft the pleafure of their fovereign, nay, by virtue of the oath they have taken, even againft the fupreme will of the Gods and the di- ctates of their conscience, to fhew any favour to foreigners. Nay they purfue this falfe reafoning ftill farther, and pretend, that a friend of foreigners mull be of neceffity an enemy to his country, and a reb&l to his fovereign. For they fay, if the country mould happen to be attack'd or invaded by thefe foreigners, the laws and ties of friendship would oblige him to (land by them, and confequently to become a traitor to his country and fovereign. Hence to over-rate a Dutchman, to a Ik extravagant prices of him, to cheat and defraud him, fo much as they think will not prove prejudicial to their reputation, which they have a very tender regard for, to lefien their liberties and advantages, to propofe new projeds for making their Servitude and condition ftill worfe, and the like, are look'd. upon as good, handfom, and lawful things in themSelves, and unquestionable proofs of a good Patriot. If Chap. VI. The Hiftory if JAPAN. 34.1 If any body fteals any thing from the Dutch, and it be found upon him, (which the Kuli, or Porters, we employ during the time of our fale, are very dextrous at) there is feldom any other punilh- ment infli&ed upon him, but reftitution of the ftolen goods, and a few lathes from the foldiers upon duty at our gate. Sometimes he is ba- nifh'd from the Ifland for a fmall time, or if the crime be very .no- torious, from the town, tho' this is done but feldom. But the penalty infli&ed upon fmuglers, is no lefs than an unavoidable death, either by beheading or the crofs, according to the nature of the crime, and the degree of guilt. The lading and unlading of our {hips, and other bufinefs of this kind, rauft not be done by our own people, but by the natives, who are well paid for their Work, whilft the former ftand idle, and have nothing to do but to look at them. But this, is hot the only grievance we have reafon to complain of in this particular, for they always hire at leaft twice as many people as there is occafion for, and if they work but one hour, we muft neverthelefs pay them a whole day's wages. All the people, who have any thing to do for or with us, tho' never fo numerous and needlefs, muft be maintain'd by us, either di- rettly by appointed falaries, or indire&ly by the money, which the Governors of the town detain from the price of our commodities, in the manner above related. No Dutchman can fend a letter out of the Country, unlefs the contents be firft enter'd into a Regifter-bobk kept for this p'urpofe, and a copy of it left with the Governors. In order to this, there muft be always two equal copies deliver'd to the proper officer, one whereof is to remain, the other is fent on board the outward-bound ihips. As to the letters fent from abroad, all the publick ones muft be fent dire&ly to the Governors, before they are open'd, but as to the private ones, there are ways and means fecretly to convey them to us, which the government connives at, tho* it be contrary to law. No Japanefe is permitted to fend any letters, or prefents, to their relations abroad (there being ftill fome left from former marriages with the Dutch) or to receive any from them, unlefs they be firft carried to the Governors, to be by them open'd, and to be left en- entirely to their difpofal. Formerly when a Dutchman died at Nagafaki, his body deem'd unworthy of their ground was thrown into the fea, fomewhere with« out the harbour. But of late an empty fpot of wafte ground upon the mountain Inaffa was afiign'd us, and leave given us, decently to bury our dead there, tho' afterwards a Japanefe guard is appointed to watch the place, which is done generally with fo much care, that Rrrr z 342 The Hiftory o/JAPAN. Beck IV. a few davs after the burial it would be fcarce poillble to find out where the body was interr'd. It is an eafy matter for any body, whether i native or foreigner, to make his claims upon the Dutch ; bur we find it very difficult to obtain juftice from others. In the firft cafe the Government is al- ways willing to give the complaining party damages, without fo much as considering, whether the claim be upon the whole company, or fome of its officers and fervants, and whether it be juft to nuke the former fuffer for the mifdemeanors of the latter. In the fecend cafe, if we have any complaint to make, we generally meet with fo many diffi- culties and tedious delays, as would deter any body from purluing even the moft righteous caufe. One inftance out of many will be fufficient to make the reader fenfible of the truth of this aiTertion. The famous Chinefe Pyrate Coxeng, having made himfelf mailer of the Ifland Formofa, and of our fort Tayovan, or Zehmdia, upon the faid Ifland, we took an opportunity about the year 1660, by way of reprifals, to attack a large yonk of his bound for the faid Ifland, with about 300 men on board, and to difable her with our fire fo 4 that altho' fhe drove for about thirten days after the attack, yet not above nine of the whole company fav'd their lives. Upon this heavy complaints were made by the Chinefe to the Government of Nagafaki, and with fo good an effect, that the fame year 2700.0 Shimome da- mages were affign'd them out of our treafury. Sometime after, about $he year 1672, one of our mips, call'd the Kujlenburg^ having unfor- tunately ftranded upon the coafls of Formofa, the fhip's company was barbaroufly murder'd, and the whole cargo taken in pofleffion by the Chinefe fubjedls of Coxenga, whereupon we made our complaints be- fore the very fame court, againfl this ad: of hoftility, but with fo little fuccefs, that far from having any damages aflign'd as, we could not fo much as obtain the reftitution of one farthing. CHAP. VII. 0/ the Dutch Trade in Japan in f articular, and firp of the fever al Corporations ejiaMiJh\i for this puryofe. C*Mp*ay of ^ ave a l rea( ty in tne preceding chapter mention'd fomething of the interpreters. company of Tfjuufi, as they are call'd, or Interpreters, upon whofe faithfulnefs, a very rare talent among them, we mufl entirely depend in carrying on our profitable trade and commerce in this Country. It is a body numerous to excefs, and conGfting, when com- plcat, of no lefs than 1 50 perfons. I propofe to be fomewhat par- ticular Chap. VII. The Hiftory (/JAPAN. 34.3 ticular in my account of this corporation, its imworthinefs notwith- fhnding, and to lay down the rules, and maxims, it is govern'd by, fo far as they came within the reach of my own knowledge, becaufe it may ferve as a pattern to (hew, how other corporations are gover- ned, and what ftrict regulations the policy of this Country is fub- ject to. Tsjuunsj, cr Tsjuunfi Sju, in the literal fenfe of the characters, this - word is exprefs'd by, is as much as to fay, a through mouth, or a through mouth people, whereby muft be underftood perfons through whofe mouth things mud be difpatch'd. They differ in rank and dig- nity, and may be divided into two orders. Thofe of the firft order, who are our interpreters in ordinary, have leave to come to our Ifland, when and upon what occafion they pleafe. Thofe of the fecend or- der are admitted only during the time of our fale, and even then, not fo much to ferve us as Interpreters, as to be ufeful to the Government by having a watchful eye over our conduct. The firft order of our Interpreters confifts of e:ght peffons, call'd ...± Fon Tsjuji, or Fon Tfiuunsj, which fignifies the true Interpreters. E" vertue of their office they are obliged to afflft an: i us, when- ever there is occafion, and fo far indeed they execute the y with great precifenefs, that we can fcarce ever one moment get rid of their importunate prefence, for as they are made anfwerable for our con- duct, fo they fpare no pains, nor trouble, to have a watchful eye over it. Four of thefe are Tsjuu^ that is High, or chief Interpreter;, one whereof is Kinban, which fignifies, in the literal fenfe of the word, a ~ yearly Guardian, as alfo a perfon, who is to make his reports to a- nother. This office is only annual: our petitions, complaint; and what- ever elfe relates to us and to our commerce, muft be deliver'd to him 3 and by him with the confent of his brethren, to the commanding Go- vernor, or his deputy. He hath the greateft fhare in the management of our Ifland, in the direction of our trade, and in all our affairs in general. As Isinban he prefides in the college of the eight chief In- terpreters. The four other Interpreters, though of the fame order^ are call'd Ko Tsju/i, that is, inferior Interpreters. They have not near that power and authority, which the former are inverted with, whom they are to affift in the execution of their office. They have a }': .- ban, or Prefident of their own, who is a fort of deputy to the eh Fhnban, and hath the firft vote in the QuaJrum-Arate, or College of four, whereof he is prefident. Both 2-': -attend us in our Journey to court, and upon our return from thence to Nagafaki, they quit their fhtions, as presidents of thefe two colleges. If any thing that relates to our commerce, or perfons, is to be laid before the college of the eight chief Interpreters, in order to a determination, it muft be done in prefence of the Ottona of our Ifland, who claims his place next to the rlrft and cr ttn. 344 The Hrfwy ef J A P A N. Book IV. chief Vkt -' i, though often only that, which is next to the four chief Inr.uru-eters, is left empty for him. The TVw that is, the yearly fabric-? ar.d perquitites of our chief In- •m/w . ----•--• irnouns to a very confiderable fum, and are as follows. A Jakuido, or Salary, whkh fince the confinement of our perfons and trade :o the Mhnd DefimM 1 hath been aflign'd them by the Emperor in - 1 1 d to even- one's office and the rank he hath in the company. It was formerly a certain determined fum of money: For the prefent : cor.uTts in a certain quantity of lilk, which as I have been inform'd, rhev are permitted to buy of us, and which if fold in the Country, yields --out fo much money clear gain, as their former falarv amoun- ted to. Befides this the company allows them fome raw lilk every vear, by wav of a prefent, or reward for their trouble, to wit, a bale, or 141 ; c:;. Catti for every chief Interpreter, which we buy for about 4.C0 T.u.-;.'.-, :.r.i is worth in Japan, 850. Half this quantity is aliow'd to ever}' inferior interpreter. Another yearly gratuity is given to them by the company of copper merchants, as it were to reward them for their trou- ble, but in fact, to buy them over to their intereft, and to engage them to turn the fale of copper to the belt advantage. This puts us under an obligation to act the part of the beft bidder for their favour, and to countermine the intentions of the copper merchants by a larger : itu :v if 300, Soo, or 8co Thails, more or lefs, in proportion to the quantity and goodnefs of the copper bought by us. Mr. Cam- ~:i, when he was director of our trade, having bought 22466 Pkkeh of refin'd copper, at twelve Thails and a half the pickel, and 102 pickets of courfe copper, made the company of Interpreters a pre- fer, t of 1360 Thails, befides a pack initead of a pickel, which he gave to every chief Interpreter, and half a pack to every Inferior Inter- preter. The Kofen, that is, the tax, or duty which is laid upon fo- reign commodities belonging to private perfons, not exceeding the value of 4crrr Thails, light, as they call it, or gold-money, muft be paid by the buyer, at fo much per cent. This makes out a fum far bevoad :oooo Thails, which is allign'd for the joint benefit of the Governors, prefiimg mayor, Ottona, and the whole body of Interpreters- This tax, though it be paid by the buyer, is yet in fact indirectly exacted from us, infomuch as the buyers generally take care to make up their loiles, by giving us a lefs price for our goods. Another ve- ry advantageous perquifite both of the Interpreters and of the Ottona, is the felling of fome goods of private perfons, which remain over and above the allowed yearly fum of acccc T1:ailes, and are bought for them at a very cheap rate. Add to this 15c Cubangs, which the company alkm them from boarding during the time of our fale, becaufe at that time they muft be conftantly attending. They receive alfo very confidera- :- pr;ie-.:s for the inferior officers of our Iflani, private merchants, artifi- cer:, trades-men, and often upon particular cccafions the Dutch themfelves not Chap. VII. The History of J A P A N. 345 Not to mention all the tricks and cheats, fome notorious enough, others lefs palpable, which they perpetually play us. I had almoft forgot another considerable branch of their perquisites, the hire money for the Cu!is t or the people employ'd in lading and unlading our fhips, whereof they retain a confiderable part for their own ufe. For they make us pay fix Thails a piece, whereas they don't give them above four, and befides hire more than there is occafion for. The profits, which the two interpreters appointed to go up to court with us make only by this Journey, are fuppos'd to amount to 1200 Thails. That this is fo, the following inftar.ces will evince. There is a fettled number of twenty horfes, to carry us and our baggage by land from Ofacca to Jedo^ and as many to bring us back again from Jedo to Miaco. But they conftantly hire at leaf! twenty more, and bring them in in their accounts fifteen Thails a piece, tho' they never pay more than eight. They go the fame way to work with regard to the perfons employ'd to lade and unlade our baggage, and to take care of our horfes. Thus they make us pay the 186 Cubangs y allow'd for our horfes and porters, twice over. They likewife get fomething upon the barge, which is to carry our baggage from Kagafaki to Ofacca, for they make ufe of this opportunity to bring over goods belong- ing to private merchants there, and never fail to put the freight in their own pockets. At Jedo they receive fome gratuities from all the great men at court, to whom it is ufual to give prefents in the company's name. Thus the whole revenue bf a chief Interpre- ter may amount in all to 3000 Thails and upwards, and that of an inferior interpreter is feldom lefs than 1506, and yet with all this income, they live but fparingly, becaufe they muft maintain out of this money numerous families, and fometimes poor relations, whom, according to the innate pride of this nation, they won't fufrer to ap- pear neceffitous. Some part alfo of their revenue is fpent in prefents to be made to the Governors of Nagafaki y and their Karoo or Deputies. The company of Interpreters is not only the mod extenfive of anycon- cern'd in the management of our Ifland and trade, but alfo the moft ex- penfive, and withal the moft prejudicial to our honour, liberty and welfare. Two fundamental maxims, they go upon, are firfr, to do what lies in their power infenfibly to increafe the yearly expences of the Dutch, to the advantage of their countrymen, as becomes true Patriots :, fecondly, to conceal, fo much as poffible, all the tricks and cheats they perpetually play us, left the natives ftiould come to know them. Both thefe ends they endeavour to obtain by confining us ftill more and more, looking upon this, as the fureft means to keep us ignorant of the language of the country, and to prevent all converu- tion or familiarity with the natives. If there be any of our people, S f f f that ■j— W»>' *■ 346 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. that hath made any confiderable progrefs in the Japanefe language, they are fure, under fome pretext or other, to obtain an order from the Governors to expel him the country. The only thing wherein the Captains, as they are here call'd, or directors of our trade (a Pro- vince the Japanefe will fuffer them to have but very little to do withal,) can be ufeful to the company, and (hew their zeal for their matter's fervice, is to act contrary to thefe principles, and to find out ways and means civilly to refufe what new requefts are from time to time made to them. For if any one of their de- mands be granted bat once, or any new charge, tho' never fo fmall, fufter'd to be laid upon us, they make it a precedent for ever after : And herein they endeavour particularly to deceive new directors, who have not been in the country before, and w hem they fuppofe to be not fully appriz'd of their ways of proceeding. On this account they will often in the firft year of their prefence help them them to a very profitable trade, knowing, in cafe their demands be not granted, how to balance it the next:, with a more chargeable and lefs profitable one. Trfmorlr.' Next to the chief Interpreters the Keekotfjufi, that is, learning In- 4hZcJ\ c a e5 . terpreters, or apprentices, mufl be mention'd. There are never lefs than eight, but femetimes more, all fons to the chief Interpreters by birth or adoption. They come over to us every day, in order to learn the Dutch and Portuguefe languages, as well as the art and myftery of dealing with foreigners. They are employ'd as fpies upon feveral occalions, as alfo to infpect- the lading and unlading of our flrips, to fearch the tailors, and fuch perfons, who go on board, or come from thence, to examine the goods imported and exported, for which their trouble in thefe feveral particulars, they are allow'd by the company a reward of forty Thails a year. They have alfo a fhare in the board- ing wages, and feveral other perquifites. Private in After the Keeko Tfjuji, or apprentices, follow the Naitsju/i, that is, t "^ >t in the literal fenfe, Interior, or Houfe-Interpret ers, becaufe they are em- ploy'd by private Dutchmen within their own houfes. They have nothing to do upon our Iftand, unlefs it be during the time of our yearly fair, or fale, when after having taken a folemn oath to avoid all communication, intimacy and familiarity with us, they are by the Qttona admitted into our fervice, and for this purpofe prefented each with one of his Pafs-boards. From two to fix of thefe people are af- fign'd to eyery Dutchman, during the whole time of our fair, in qua- lity of Interpreters, but in fact, as fpies to watch his actions. For there is fcarce one in ten, that underflands a Dutch word, excepting fome few, who had been fervants to the Dutch formerly. Regulations There are upwards of an hundred of thefe Naitsjufi, who all ftand 'Ln" Cm ~ un( ^ er tne command of the chief Interpreters, and particularly the Nin ban, or Prefident for the time being. They have as well as the mem- bers Chap. VII. The Hiftorytf J A P A N. 34.7 - ______ -— ! ; bers of other Corporations, differing ranks and dignities among themfelves, and are divided into the following orders. i. Twelve of the company are Ko Gafijra, which figniiies little heads, they being fet over the reft. Two of thefe twelve are ffinbans, or Prefidents. They prefide in their affemblies, and enjoy this office by turns, each a year. All the affairs relating to this company muft be brought before them, and if beyond their power, or underlianding, kid by them before the fuperior affembly of the chief Interpreters. _. Kwmg.afijra, Heads of particular corporations, which the .reft of the members of this body are divided into. Each of thefe Kumigafijra t hath nine or ten Naitfjufi, who live next to him, under his difpofiti- cn, he imparts the orders of their fuperiors to them, and receives their requefts, in order to lay them before the faid fuperiors, and is with- al in a great meafure anfwerable for their condud. They have like- wife two Islnbans, or Presidents, who are at the iame time members of the affembly of the Koga/ijra, and enjoy their office each a year. The main body of thefe Naitfiufi, from fourfcore to about an hundred, are again divided into two orders :, the Dsjo, as they are call'd, the gentlemen of a higher rank, who alfo receive a larger mare out of the company's cafh for their falary, and Tsju, under which general name all the reft are comprehended. Their falary is an uncertain fum of money taken out of the abovemention'd taxes laid upon the merchants, which the Governors of Nagafaki, and chief Interpreters affign them from time time. It differs in proportion to the quantity of goods dif- pos'd of by us, and is fuppofed, one year with another, to amount to about fix thoufand Tbails, which they divide among themfelves, according to their rank and office, and it is computed that the twelve chief among them get at fartheft two hundred Tbails a-piece, and the reft muft take up with half that money, nay fometimes with lets. Thev have four Takwsiaku, or Treafurers, who are to take care of J n a 1 r (I • ■ 1 • Treasurers the company s cam, and to keep an account cf what is paid in, ane i curkj of ,and but ; befides two Fisja, or clerks, who receive alfo their falary out the Im^F'- of the faid cafh. No body is admitted into this company, but the fons of deceas'd Nueffary members. The admiffion is perform'd in the following manner. The q^ ! f ca \ ions 17 i ° ■ for the attmij- candidate gets fome body to write a Sosjo, or Petition for him, which f, n into the he prefents to the Ninban, or Prefident of the Kumtfafi'ira, withal re- i" ur t reters commending his -intereft by word of mbtfth, and fometimes making o.remonUs ufe of indirect means to obtain "his favour. The Ninban calls his.hxe- thereo f- thren together to confider of the cafe, and to examine whether or no the candidate be entitled by birth, age and merit, to what he pe- titions for, and if they find that he hath all the necefTary qualifica- tions, he delivers the petition to the Ninban of the Ko Gafijrj;, who likewife takes his time to examine into the matter with the .members of his company, and if they too approve of the candidate, the peti- uon 348 The Hijlory of J A P A N. Book IV. ( tion is prefented to the Ninban of the Fontsjufi, or Prefident of the College of the chief Interpreters. Here the affair hangs fometimes two or three years,, till by repeated petitions and fubmiffions, but chiefly by what they call So de no Jita, that is, acting under the* fleeve, (which by the by they wear fo wide, that a prefent can be eafily and fe- cretly convey'd into them) the Ninban is at laft perfuaded to favour the candidate. Upon this, having flrft obtain'd leave of his bre- thren, he lays the petition and the petitioner's cafe before the Governor, who feldom refufes to give his confent. All obftacles being at laft remov'd, the new Interpreter goes to vifit every member of his com- pany, to return them thanks for their favour and to receive the compli- ments of congratulation from them-. Thus far of our Interpreters. fa^d ' * proceed next to the five Dsfima Fisja, or ordinary Clerks of the Ifland Defima. They are a fort of deputies to the chief Interpreters. Their bufinefs is to keep an account of the prefents made by the Dutch, of their ordinary expences, the expences of their journey to court, and other things of this kind, which are thought beneath the dignity of a chief Interpreter. Nay, they themfelves, being not al- ways willing to difpatch their bufinefs in perfon, keep alfo their de- puties. The company allows a conftant falary only to two, and thefe are to attend us in our journey to court. The reft are re- warded by handfom gratuities at the time of our fale. hifp&ort of Amongft the officers of our Ifland, I muft not forget to mention vaV/wKnu*. thc De f ma Tfijetzkni, or Infpedors of our Kuli, or Workmen. This honourable company confifts of fifteen perfons, who keep a lift of our workmen, in order to divide the work among them, and to aflign every one his talk. One of thefe 1 5 is Quart 'er-mafler, who muft be prefent in perfon, to encourage and look after them, when there is any work to be done. The whole company is to take cire, that we be not robb'd by thefe Kulis, they being very dextrous at it, whenever a favourable opportunity offers. For this reafon our Eaft-Inda com- pany allows them a conftant falary. The Kuli's, who are employed in lading and unlading of our fhips, are people unknown to us, and taken out of the town. All we know of them is, that we muft pay them well for their trouble. In order to make it benefi- cial to the whole town, every Ottona is to keep a lift of what people in his ftreet are willing, or able, to ferve as Kidis, that in their turn they may be fent over to Defima. oficiYtoftur The Cannaba Nakama, that, is the Officers of our Treafury 7 ftill remain to gxchtqutr. jj C mention'^. They are to receive the money for the goods we have dif- pos'd of, to change it into Koban'fs of gold, and to. deliver them to us by our Interpreters, who count them before us. The Cannaba- Nakams retain one per cent for their trouble, and fifteen or more for the common benefit of the town, according to the yearly value of the Chap VII. The Hijiory of J A P A N. the Cobanj, which is from 55 to 59 Mome, or Maas in filver. Not iatisfy'd, even with this reafonable profit, they make us receive the Cohan] at 68, befides that the director of this office receives loo Tbails a year falary from the Dutch, and the reft of the members each '50 Tbails. This company confifts of thirty-fix perfons, both fuperior and inferior officers, to wit, five directors, or infpeclors, who have nothing to do but to look after, and command, their four depu- ties, who receive all the money, exchange it into gold, keep it in their cuftody, and deliver it to us by our interpreters. Thefe nine are the fuperior, or chief officers, as they call them. The inferior officers who fit by themfelves, are one who knows the marks of gold-money, another who knows the marks of filver-money, and how to diftinguifh the good money from the counterfeit :, two to weigh the filver -, two to receive the money from the Japanefe merchants j two chief clerks, or as they call them See Tsjo Kaki, that is, keepers of accounts, feveral other affiftants, deputies, domefticks and fervants, both of the chief and inferior officers, feveral perfons attending in the name of the Ottona, chief interpre- ters and mayors of the town, befides fome of their favourites whom they have a mind to fhew fome kindnefs to, and who are all enter'd as clerks. Befides the bufinefs of thefe people, as officers of our treafury, they muft be prefent at the examination of all goods, imported or exported, which belong to private perfons. 349 CHAP. VIII. Some more particulars concerning the Dutch 'Trade J A T A N. in ri-'IHE Dutch mips are expected in the harbour fometime in pnctethtg? 1 September, towards the latter end of the S. W. Monfoon, that K P m th - ar ~; being the only one proper for this navigation. As foon as ships. the fpy-guards with their glaffes difcover a fhip fleering towards the harbour , and fend notice of her approach to the Governors of Na~ gafaki, three perfons of our factory are fent with the ufual atten- dance to meet her, about two miles without the harbour, and to de- liver to our captain the neceffary Inftructions from the director of our trade, with regard to his behaviour, feal'd up. The Interpreter, and the deputies of the Governors, demand forthwith the lift of the cargo and crew, as alfo the letters on board, which are* carried to Nagafaki, where the governors firfh examine, and then deliver them to our director. The fhip follows as foon as poffible, and being enter'd the harbour, falutes every Imperial guard with all her guns, theri T 1 1 1 cafe 350 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Beck IV. cafts anchor oppofite to the town about a mufket-fhot from our Ifland. If the wind be contrary, rowing boats (kept for this purpofe by the common people of the town) are fent at our expence, but not at our defire, to tow her in by force. In flill weather they fend about ten of thefe boats j if it be flormy, and the wind contrary they encreafe the number to fifty, and fometimes to an hundred, fo many as they think neceffary, that is, at leaft twice the number there is occa- fion for. When the fhip is enter'd the harbour, two guard-boats, with a good number of foldiers are put, one on each fide of her, and continued, being mounted with frefh troops every day, till (he hath left the harbour and is got to the main Sea. As foon as the fliip hath dropt anchor great number of officers come on board, to demand all our guns, cutlafhes, fwords, and other arms, as alfo the Gunpowder pack'd up in barrels, which are taken into their cuftody and kept in a ftore- houfe built for this purpofe, till her departure. They attempted alfo in former times to take out the rudder, but having found it impra- cticable, they now leave it in. The next day after her arrival the commiilioneFS of the Governors come on board with their ufual at- tendance of foldiers, interpreters, and fubordinate officers, to make an exact review, in prefence of our director, of all the people on board, according to the lift which hath been given thern, and wherein is fet down every one's name, age, birth, place of refidence and office, examining them from top to toe. Many queftions are afk'd on account of thofe who dy'd in the voyage, when, and of what diftemper they dy'd. Even now and then a dead monkey, or parrot, may occafion a flricT enquiry to be made after the caufe and manner of their death, and they are fo fcrupulous, that they will not give their verdict, without fitting upon the body itfelf, and care- fully examining it. Upon this the orders of our refident, and like- wife of the Governors of Nagafaki, relating to our behaviour, with regard to the natives, are read in Low Dutch, and afterwards for every ones instruction ftuck up in feveral places on board the fhip and at Befima. The fame rules are obferv'd with the reft of our fhips, of which there are two, three, or four fent from Batavia to Japan every year, according to the quantity of copper they have occafion for. Formerly when the Dutch as yet enjoy'd a free trade, they fent feldom lefs than fix or feven fhips, fometimes more, in proportion to the quantity of goods they were likely to difpofe of. The review being over, or elfe at what other time they pleafe, they H>-,taJt» c proceed to unlade the fhip. In the mean time, fome Jorikis, as de- puties of the Governors, fome of the Dofen, a chief Interpreter, a de- puty Interpreter, and an apprentice, befides feveral clerks and inferior officers remain on board taking poffeflion of every corner, to fee that nothing be carried away privately. The time for unlading the fhip being Chap. VIII. TheHiftoryof JAPAN. 351 being determin'd, the water gates of our Ifland, through which the cargo is to be brought in, are open'd in prefence of the Karoo, that is, high commiffioners of the Governours, and their retinue. So long as the gates are kept open, the Karoos, with their deputies and other afiiftants, ftay in a room built for this purpofe not far off. The whole body of Interpreters, as alfo our landlords, clerks and other officers of our Ifland give their attendance, as well as neceffary afliftance, at that time* Then they fall to work with 300 or more Kul'is, or workmen, always at leaft twice the number, there is occafion for. The unlading of every fhip ought to be perform'd within two days time, but notwithftanding the great number of workmen they employ, they generally make a three days work of it, in order to make it fo much the more beneficial to the town. The goods are brought over from on board the fhip in fmall boats, cali'd Prauen, and kept only for this purpofe at the companies expence, and within the water gates laid before the commiffioners, who fet them down in writing, count them, compare them with the lift, that hath been given in, opening a bale, or two, of each fort pick'd out from a- rnong the reft, and then order that they fhould be lock'd up, under their feal, in the companies warehoufes untill the time of our iale. The trunks belonging to private perfons, are fet down at the entry of the Ifland, and there open'd and examin'd. If the owner doth no t forthwith appear with his key, they proceed without any farther ce- remony to open them with axes. All vendible goods are taken out, and lock'd up under their feals. Some other things alfo which they do not approve of, as for inftance, arms, fluff, and cloath wrought with gold and filver, as alfo all contraband goods, are taken into cuftody by the Ottona, who returns them to the owner upon his depar- ture. No European, nor any other foreign money, and in general nothing, ContrabMi that hath the figure of a crofs, faint, or beads upon it, is fuffer'd to pafs. If any fuch thing fhould be found upon any of our people,. it would occafion fuch a confufion and fright among the Japanefe, as if the v/hole Empire had been betray'd. I took notice above, in the journal of our voyage, that upon our drawing near the harbour every one was oblig'd, purfuant to orders, to deliver his prayer-books, and other books of divinity, as alfo all European money he had about liim, to the captain who pack'd them all up in an old cafk, and hid them from the natives. Thofe who are newly arriv'd, in going in or coming out of our Ifland, OrJtrsatJti muft fuffer themfelves to be fearch'd, whether or no they have any • s -* r < rfcm S* contraband goods about them, chiefly amber and corals, which they might exchange for gold, the natives being very fond of thefe com- modities. Even one of our directors (who was afterwards rais'd to the eminent poft of Director-general) had it pra&is'd upon himfelf, upon his firft arrival in Japan. However this is done but feldonu Every o 5 2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. Even'- ens that wants to go on board, whether it be for his own private bufinefs, or in the company's fervice, is oblig'd to take out a pafsboard from the commiflioners at the water-gates to thofe upon trie fliip, and in like manner when he returns on fhore, he mufltake cut another from thefe. By this means they know at all times, how many people there are on board, or on more. : At ni^ht, when the commiflioners fent on board the fhip return with their retinue to Napafaki, the cabin is feal'd up in their pre- fence, and all the Dutchmen accurately counted over, to fee that there be none wanting, which would occafion a very great confufion. Du- ring my ftay in Japan it happen'd, that a common failor unfortu- nately drown' d himfelf in the night, no body perceiving his falling down into the water. At the review made the next morning (for it is ccnlhntly made every morning and night) the fellow was mifs'd. This unlucky accident fuddenly ftopt all proceedings, and the fear, left it mould be a Roman Catholick Prieft, who made his efcape into the country, occafion'd fuch a confternation among the Japanefe, that all the officers ran about fcratching their heads, and behaving them- feives as if they had loft their fenfes, and fome of the foldiers in the guard-fhips were already preparing to rip open their bellies, be- fore fuperior orders could compel them to anfwer for their carelefT- nefs and neglect of their duty. In this ftate things continu'd, till at laft the unhappy fellow's body being taken up from the bottom of the fea, put an end to their fears and farther enquiries. Watt-ffltu At all other times, that for lading and unlading our fhips excepted, f--'- u the water gates are (hut. By this means all communication is cut off between thofe that ftay on board, and thofe that remain on fhore, both being equally confin'd within proper bounds. The Ihips whole carco having been after this manner brought over into the warehoufes, the goods lie there till they are pleas'd, in two or three days of fale, which they ca ll Cambangs, to fell them :, what remains unfold, is carried back to the warehoufes, and kept there againft the next ye?.rs fale. Coils im:- The following goods, are imported by us: Raw filk from China t d by us. Tunqitin, Bengalee and Perjia :, all forts of filk, woollen and other fluffs from the abovemention'd, and fome other countries, (provided they be not wrought with gold or filver,) fuch as, Taffaceel from Bengale and the coafts of Cormandel, large white Belangs roll'd up, white Gilangs, Anmfins, Sumongis's, Florette-yarn^ feveral forts of half filk Indian Tfitfen, and courfe cotton fluffs without flowers, and not painted j white Gwiis, Saletnpuris and faraceeh j woollen cloth from Europe, befides fome other filk and woollen fluffs, chiefly ferges, and Englifli fergesj Tftampan, or dywood, (or as we call it in Europe) brafilwood, buffle and deer hides, Ray fkins, wax and buffle horns from Siam and Cam- bodia^ Cordovans and tann'd hides from Perjia, Bengale and other places, ; ■- ' — ■ ' "" ~ — -,.-■■ Chap. VIII. The Hijloryof JAPAN. 353 places, not from Spain and the Manhilhas, under pain of incurring their utmoft difpleafure, and meeting with hard ufage from them j Pepper and Sugar in powder, and candied, from feveral parts of the Eaft In- dies j Cloves and Nutmegs from the Spice Iflands, Amboina and Banda; (Cinnamon is at prefent not ask'd for) white Sandale from Timor - Camphire de Baros, gather'd in the Ifland Borneo and in Sumatra j quickfilver, Cinnabar and Saffron from Bengalee lead, falt-petre, borax and alum from Bengale and Siam :, musk from Twiquin j gum benzoine from Atfijen-j gum lacca from Siam\ Rofmal, or fiorax liquida, and Catechu, commonly calPd Terra Japonica, from Mochait in the happy Arabia •, The root of Futsjuk, or Coftus Amara, from Suratte and Siam ; corals, amber, right antimony (which they make ufe of to colour their china ware, and looking glafles from Europe) the looking glades they break to make fpy glafles, magnifying glaifes and fpe&acles out of them. Some other things of lefs note, as Mafang de Vaca, is a medi- cinal ftone taken out of the gall bladder of cows in Mofanbek j Snake wood •, Atfiaer from Bambous :, Mangos and other unripe Eaft India fruits pickel'd with turkifh pepper, garlick and vinegar j black lead and red pencils to write withal j fublimate mercury (but no calomel)} fine files, needles, fpeclacles, large drinking glafles of the fined fort, coun- terfeit corals, ftrange birds, and other foreign curiofities both natural and artificial. Some of thefe are often fold in private by failors and private perfons, without being produc'd upon the Cambang, and in this cafe the Dutch make no fcruple to get fo much for them beyond their real value, as poflibly they can. Of all the imported goods, raw filk is the belt lik'd, tho* it yields ^ ji p rQ . the lead: profit of any, for which reafon the Portuguefe call'd the fale fi tah!e . csm - of this commodity, Pancado, which name hath been in a manner na- turaliz'd in the country, and is (till in ufe among the natives. All forts of Huffs and cloth yield a confiderable and fure profit, and fhould there be never fo much imported, the confumption in fo populous a country would be ftill greater. Tfiampan, or Brafilwood, and hides, are alfo to be difpos'd of to very good advantage. The moft profitable commodities are Sugar, Catechu, Rofmal, or Storax liquida, Patsju, Cam- phire of Borneo (which they covet above all other forts of Camphire,) looking glafles, and feveral other things of this kind, but only, wheri they have occafion for them, and when the Chinefe have imported them in fmall quantities : Ccorals and amber are two of the moft valuable commodities in thefe Eaftern parts of the world, but Japan hath been fo thoroughly provided by fmuglers, that at prefent there is fcarce fifty per cent to be got upon them, whereas formerly we could fell them ten, nay an hundred times dearer. The price of thefe things, and of all natural and artificial curiofities, varies very much according to the number and difpofition of the buyers, who may be fure to get cent per cent clear profit by them, at whit price foever they buy them* Fof- U u u u merly 3 54 The Hijlory of JAPAN. Book IV. merly, when as yet we enjoy'd a fall liberty in our trade and com- merce we fent feldom lefs than feven mips a year laden with the goods above-mention'd. At prefent we never fend above three, or four one whereof gees firft to Siam, to make up part of her cargo with the commodities of that country. What remains unfold is laid up in our Ware-houfes againft the next year's fale. The Butch The ftate of our trade and commerce in this country, fince our firft Traae in j*- . J ^ ^ k een fa^Q- t0 various changes and fatalities, with re- iftits ftveral o^ri to the commodities, which were from time to time forbid to be imported, or exported, by us, to the gradual reftri&ion of our liberties and privileges, to the lelTening of our profits, and the manner we were treated with, by the natives. Since our firfl eftablifhment, I find four remarkable periods, which I proceed now to confider fingly, in order to give the reader a true and compleat account, of this confiderable branch of the Dutch trade in the Eaft-Indies. itffrjiFe. The firft period takes in upwards of thirty years, from our firft fettlement in the town and Ifland Firando, and the privilege of a free trade and commerce, which was foon after fin the year 1611) granted us by the Emperor, till the year 1641, when we receiv'd orders from the Emperor to remove our factory to Nagafaki. The trade of the Caftilians and Portuguefe, who had a large and fiouriihing fet- tlement at Nagafaki, was then in its greateft luftre, and they had one confiderable advantage over us, in that they could furnifh Japan with raw (ilk, and filk-ftuffs, a commodity whereof there then was, and ftill is a vaft confumption in this populous Empire. We had not r.hen as yet any fettled eftablifhment in China, and the neighbouring kingdoms, where the beft and fineft filk is produced. The Empire of China itfelf, being as yet govern'd by its natural Monarch, before the late Tartarian Conqueft, was fhut up and kept from all commerce with foreign nations. The Chinefe forbid to go out of the country, and to export any of its native commodities, could furnifh us but with a fmall quantity of filk, and even that too they were fore'd to fmuggle, nor durft we go to fetch it upon their own coafts. The Portuguefe on the contrary, having a fettlement at Macao, a fmall Ifiand upon the coafts of China, which Empire it ftill belongs to, had more frequent opportunities to procure this valuable, and then much more profitable commodity. We had befides no commerce with Ton- quin, till about the year 1637, nor any fettled eftablifhments in the kingdoms of Bengale and Perfia. But when fortune and our good conduct, had once open'd us a way into thefe filk-rich countries, and after we had once made firm fettlements there, we could then furnifh the Japanefe with that and other commodities, coveted by them, full as well as the Portuguefe and Spaniards. We then as yet fold our filk and other goods free and without rcftraint to the beft bidder, and exported yearly a fum of 6o, more or lefs, tuns of gold, (according to the Dutch way Chap. VIII. The Biftory of JAPAN. 355 way of counting, that is, 6000000 of their gilders, or upwards of 500000 pound fterling. This brought in vaft profits to the company, even altho' fome of the goods imported by us did not at that time yield near fo much profit, as they now do, and altho' the navigation itfelf was then much more dangerous and fubjecl to more frequent wrecks and lofTes, for as much as we did not direft our courfe along the fecure coafts of China, then as yet not fully known, but acrcfs the dangerous and fatal feas about Formosa, and the neighbouring Mand s . Our main Capital at that time confifted in (ilver, whereof we exported every year at leaft 1200 to 1400 chefts, or 1400000 Tbath which makes a fum of 4900000 Florins, (or about 450000 /. fterling.) Sometimes our profits were ftill more confiderable, and amounted to fix millions. This was the firft and golden age of our trade in this country, during which we enjoy'd full liberty to difpofe of our goods to the beft advantage, and this by virtue of a privilege granted us, under the great Imperial red feal in the year 161 1, by the then reigning Emperor Ijejas, otherwife call'd Ongoftbio, and after his death Gonginfama. This privilege, by (which is inferted in the laft .chapter of this book, and grav'd in Tab. XX.) which, leave was granted us freely, and without difturbance, to import and fell our goods, when, and in what parts of the Empire we pleas'd, was afterwards in 16 17 re- new'd at our own defire, by his fon and fucceflfor Fidetada^ who was after his death call'd Teitokujin, tho' in fomewhat lefs advantageous terms and characters. And yet, tho' at that time every thing feem'd to fucceed according to our beft wifhes, yet we had a great deal of care and trouble to undergo, many a vexatious difficulty to overcome, and many a hard and unreafonable demand either to prevent, or pru- dently and with good manners to decline. The Spaniards and Portu- guefe left no ftone unturn'd to ruin us and our trade, to calumniate and blacken us at court, calling us Pyrates, rebels to their, the Spanifh Government, invaders of the Indian Kingdoms, opprefibrs of our law- ful fovereigns, and the like. We were reproaeh'd in moft exafpe fated and blafphemous terms, that, like the Caftilians, we did believe: in Chrift, and muft needs needs be liable, upon that fole account, entirely to lofe all favour at court. It muft be own'd, that 'twas the fear of being expell'd this golden Ophir, as the Portuguefe had already been, which neceflitated us in 1638, to aflift the Japanefe in the Siege of Simabara, and the deftru&ion of many thoufand Chriftians, (whom de- fpair and dread of torments fore'd to fhut themfelves up in that piace) and fince to leave off praying and finging of Pfalms in publick, to forbear all outward marks of chrift ianity, laftly, in 1641, after the Chriftian religion was alrnoft totally extirpated in Japan, and the Caftilians and Portuguefe expell'd the country , to exchange our fa&ory and new- built ftorehoufes at Firando, againft the Ifknd De/b/ta, in the harbour of Nagafaki, and with the lofs of our liberty, and the freedom we hi- therto 356 The Hi/lory of] A P A N. Book IV therto enjoy 'd under an indulgent protector, to confine our felves under the narrow infpeclion of the numerous keepers of this prifon. Reafins of ^any reafons contributed to make us fufpefted and hated at court, ™/ca»f»e- and occafion'd at laft the fatal change we underwent at this time, mew at Deft* ^ ut ^g p ro fefilon we make of the Chriftian religion, was one of the chief, the whole court being exafperated againft it to the higheft degree, as a pub- lick nuifance, and the only caufe of the ruin and deftruition of fo, many thoufands of the Emperor's fubje&s, and perhaps, would it not have been poflible for us to maintain our felves in the country and the pofTeflion of our trade, had we not made it our bufinefs to give the court convincing proofs, that we were Chriftians indeed, but quite of another feci, and profefs'd enemies of the Romilh Priefts, whofe dan- gerous confpiracies againft the Emperor and the /Empire we had dif- cover'd our felves. This, with the deference and readinefs we Ihew'd in aflifting the Japanefe at the (lege of Svnabara, fav'd us fo far, that we were fuffer'd to flay in the country, and to continue our trade, tho* under fo ftricl: a guard, and fo narrow an infpeftion, that ever fince there hath been fcarce any opportunity left us to converfe with the natives. As things now ftand, the main endeavour of the Japanefe Government is, to keep us ignorant of what paffes in the country, and at court, and to prevent any attempt we could make, to bring over the natives to the faith of our Saviour, which might probably occa- fion new troubles and difturbances in the Empire. They are fo much the more upon their guard, becaufe, taking it for granted, that the Spani- ards and Portuguefe would mifs no opportunities to revenge the affront and infulting ufage they had met with, they apprehend, that in order to bring this about they might one time or other combine with the Dutch, We happen'd juft at that time to build a new Warehoufe at Firando, which greatly encreas'd the jealoufy and fufpicion the Japa- nefe had already conceiv'd of us, and contributed not a little to forward our removal from thence to Nagafaki-^ for it was, contrary to the cuftom of the country, built too high, and all of ftone, fo that it look'd more like a Caftle than a warehoufe. It had befldes, which made the cafe ftill worfe, the year of our blefled Saviour's nativity engrav'd on a ftone in the front. I was told privately by a Japanefe of good credit, that as the Dutch were unlading one of their (hips, and bringing the goods on fhore, to lay them up in the new built warehoufes, it happen'd that the bottom of a large box get- ting loofe there came out, inftead of merchant's goods, a brafs mortar. How much there is to be depended upon the truth of this ftory I will not take upon me to determine.- How be it, thus much is true, that foon after we receiv'd orders fuddenlv, and under pain of death, to demo- lifh our new built warehoufe, and to exchange our residence and the li- berty we enjoy'd at Firando againft the imprifonment of Defima, which put an end to the firft and golden period cf our trade and commerce Chap VIII. The Hiftory «f JAPAN. 357 commerce in this country. Braftnan, alias Jenfejmon, our chief Inter- preter, a man of fourfcore and ten years of age, who had been already at that time in the company's fervice, affur'd me, that the proud and haughty conduct of Monfieur Caron, then director of our trade in Japan, had not been the leaft caufe of this fudden change. He faid, that the Japanefe Government could not endure any pride and haughtinefs in merchants, whom the whole nation looks upon as the fourth and meaneft degree of mankind. The chief judge of Miaco, who at that time had the direction of foreign affairs, found himfelf fo highly offended by Mr. Carols proud behaviour, that he would not admit him to an audience at Miaco, nor receive the company's prefents, and when afterwards that opportunity offer'd of our aforefaid new built warehoufe, he gladly feiz'd it, and greatly aggravating the thing, he reprefented to the Emperor the bafe intentions of the Dutch fo ftrongly, that he obtain'd orders for the demolition of the faid warehoufe, and foon after for our removal. This Mr. Car on is Xcccuntof the very fame, who publifh'd a fhort account of Japan, which M°"f- Carm - was firft written in High Dutch, and afterwards tranflated into fe, veral other languages. He firft ferv'd as cook's-mate on board a Dutch Eaft-India Man. His happy gertius, and ready apprehenfion, brought him to the pen, and by degrees he rais'd himfelf to be director of our trade in Japan, in which employment he was continu'd for feveral years. Afterwards, having been difappointed in his hopes of obtaining one of the chief places at Batavia, which he expe&ed mould be given him, he went over to offer his fervice to the Portuguefe and French, but ftranded and perifh'd in fight of the walls of Lisbon, before he could put his defigns, doubtlefs difadvantageous enough to the company he formerly ferv'd, in execution. I cannot forbear taking notice in this place of an afperfion which hath been falfly thrown upon the Dutch by fome Authors, viz. That having been afk'd by the Japanefe Govern- ment, whether they were Chriftians ? they anfwer'd, No, not Chriftians, but Dutchmen. This I particularly and with great Impartiality en- quir'd into, but could not meet with any thing of this nature in the Journals, and other writings belonging to our factory at Nagafaki which have been kept and preferv'd ever fince our firft arrival in this country. But befides, our above-mention'd chief Interpreter, who cer- tainly, had there been any fuch thing, had no reafon to conceal the truth, frequently affur'd me to the contrary, and told me, in anfwer to the like queftions, that they conftantly, and very much to their own difadvantage, profefs'd themfelves to be Chriftians, but not addicted to the feci of the Portuguefe Priefts. What probably gave birth to this rumour, was the anfwer of one Michael Sandvoort, a Dutchman, who being ftranded upon the coafts of Japan, fettled afterwards, with a countryman of his, at Nagafaki amongft the natives and indepen- dant of the Dutch. Upon the eftablifliment of the Japanefe Inqui- X x x x fition„ 358 The Hiftory of J A P A. N. Book IV. HtioH this man being alk'd, whether or no he was a chriftian, he anfwer'd, to fave his and his companion's life, what Chriftians, Cbri- (Haris, we ere Dutcbtnen j which confeflion the Inquifitors were then ■.ninglv fa:isfy*d with. I come now to the fecond period of our trade in this country, which mufl be da::d from thfe ffihe v,-e let: firanJo, and re.v.iv'd to JSagafaki. We had no fooner enter'd the harbour, but they fecur'd us forthwith in the Ifland Defima, and depriv'd us at once of all the liberties and privileges we had till then enjoy'd. Surrounded with numerous suards and watches, both within and without the Ifland we were denied all manner of converfation with the natives, thofe only excepted who were in our fervice, and who oblig'd themfelves fay a folemn and dreadful oath, fign'd with their own blood, never to enter into anv familiarity with us, nor to communicate any thing to us about the fhte and affairs of the -country. Our mips, as foon as they dropt anchor in the harbour, were by them taken in poffef- fion, suard-fhips put on every fide, the gun-powder, ball;, fwords, and cutlafhes, and all other arms brought on fhore, and kept in fafe cuftody till our departure. Even the heavieft guns, and the rudder itfelf was then taken out, and brought on fhore, but now they have left off giving themfelves fo great and withal fo needlefs a trouble. A review was made of all the people on board, according to the lift given them, and an exaft memorandum taken of every one's age, name and bafind& Thofe that were to go afhore, either in their own or the company's bufinefs, were narrowly fearch'd, their fwords and fire- arms, as alio fuch of their goods as might be difpos'd of, taken into cuftody by the Ottona ; and tho' the place, where mips ride at an- chor, is not above 300 paces diftant from Defima, yet nobedy was permitted to go afhore, or to return on board, without taking a pafT- port from the proper officers. Our fhips were unladen and the cargoes brought afhore by their own people, and lock'd up in our ware- houfes under their feals. In fhort we were then treated, and have been ever fince, like traitors and profefs'd enemies to the country. However this fudden and fatal change of our affairs, and the good op- portunity notwithstanding, which the Japanefe then had at once to re- duce our privileges and profits to as narrow a compafs as ever they pleas'd, yet as the populous town of Kagafaki, and its government, lately depriv'd of the advantageous trade with the Portuguefe, could not well fubfilt without a commerce with foreigners, fo we conti- nued for fome time to fend no lets than fix or feven fhips a year f$ :her, and to difpofe of our Cargoes to very good advantage. That very year 11:41, fo remarkable for the fatal turn it gave to our affairs, wis one of the moil profitable we ever had, for we difpos'd of our goods to the value of eighty tons of gold, or Sccccoc Florins (above Tczzzol. fterling^ aftd 6£|8>ited do lefs zr.:n i_:i thefts of lilver. Some- Chap. VIII. TheHifioryoj JAPAN. 359 Sometime after we petitioned the court for leave to take, as we had done formerly, copper in exchange and part of payment for our fo- reign commodities, the exportation of this metal having been forbid ever fince 1637. The court willingly granted what we petition'd for, but in lieu of it we were forbid for the future to export any fil- ver, which order it was our intereft gladly to comply with 5 for when we were paid in filver, we could not get above 4 per cent upon it, whereas copper yields a profit of 90 to 95 per cent , chiefly at Sttratta, where we fend about 6oco chefts a year. Thus, the many troubles and hardships we were forc'd to under- Third Piri'a go, and the unreafonable demands laid upon us at feverai times, were r f tk; , Dl>r " r ' at leaft made goid in fome meafure by the confiderable profit, as well upon the goods we imported, as, upon thofe we exported, till about thirty years after our removal to Nagafaki, in the year 1672, we fell of a fudden and unawares into the third period of our commerce in this Country. For having had the misfortune to fall under the dif- pleafure of Inaba Mino, Prime Minifter and a great favourite of the then reigning peaceable Emperor Dajjojin, (who with Uto, another cf the counfellors of ftate, and likewife in great favour with the Empe- ror, govern'd the whole Empire) the golden fleece, we had yearly fetch'd from this Colchis, was chang'd into a very ordinary one, and our trade reduc'd to low and miferable terms. It will not be improper to trace this misfortune from its early origins, were it but to give an inftance of the revengefulnefs of this nation. Mino, othenvife with the addi- tional title, which is ufually given to great men at court, Minofama, one of the prime minifters, to whom the Emperor himfelf fanciel to have no fmall obligation, and who, befides the fhare he had in the Government of the Empire in general, was entrufled with the direction of foreign affairs in particular, thought, as the main maxim, thefe courtiers aim at, is to pleafe their Sovereign, that it would be highly agreea- ble to the Emperor, to prefent the temple, where his Imperial ance- ftors were buried, with a great European Lamp, fuch as are com- monly hung up in our churches, fuch another having been prefented by the Dutch, when they were at FiranJo, to One of his PredecefTors, by whom it was very gracioufly receiv'd. It muft be obferv'd that it was look'd upon by the Emperor, as it is in general by the whole nation, as an effential part of piety and religion, to ob- ferve the filial duty towards their aneeftors and deceas'd Pcrents, by cultivating their memory, and vifiting the temples or monuments ere- cted to them. The Dutch upon this were defir'd, with all poflible fpeed, to get fuch a lamp fent over from Europe, which was done ac- cordingly : but it unluckily happen'd, thro' the imprudence and inad- vertency of the then Governors of Nagafaki, to whom it belongs to chufe and determine, what prefents are to be made to the court, that this lamp, inftead of being given to Mine, for whom it was intended, was 3 6o The Hifiory of J A P A N. Book IV. wis put amongft the prefents, which were to be made that year to the Emperor himfelf, not without hopes thereby to ingratiate them- felves into his favour. This happen'd in 1666. Mino, difappointed in his expectation, thought himfelf offended to the higheft degree, and from that moment took fuch a hatred to the whole Dutch nation, as without a fatal and fufficient revenge he knew would be purfued, according to the maxims of the natives, even after his death, by his defcendants and relations. The Japanefe in general, when once they throw a hatred on a perfon, know how to conceal it for a long while, till a favourable opportunity offers to take re- venge for the ihfults and affronts they have, or fancy to have re- ceiv'd. In like manner Mino watch'd his opportunity to put the re- venge, he meditated to take of us, in execution, and it offer'd no fooner, but he gladly embrae'd it, and chaftis'd us raoft feverely. For having obtain'd the Government of Nagafaki for Usjingomi Tfusejemon, one of his near relations, this new Governor, after he came to take poffef- fion of it in 1672, (Mr. Camphuyfen, who was afterwards rais'd to the eminent poft of Governor General of the Dutch Eaft-India Com- pany at Batavia, being then diredor of our trade in Japan) he re- duced our trade and commerce to the following deplorable condition. He demanded famples and patterns of all the goods we imported for fale, in order to fhew them to perfons, who had fome knowledge of their goodnefs and value, to be by them tax'd and eftimated. Mean- while the merchants reforted to his palace, there to view the goods* and having refolv'd what goods they intended to buy, and in what quantity, the Governor, without permitting us to be prefent, agreed with them and fold them himfelf. The agreement being made, as may be eafily imagin'd, for a price far below what we ufually fold them at, he acquainted us with it, indulging us however fo far, as to give us the choice, whether we would part with the goods for the price he had fet upon them, or elfe export them again. By this un- heard of proceeding, and unreafonable taxation, the very foundation of the privileges gracioufly granted us by the late illuftrious Emperors Gongen, and Teitokuni, was ruin'd and fubverted at once, and the golden plaifter tore off, which we had hitherto laid on, to eafe the pain of fo many hardfhips and injuftices, we had been obliged, ever fince the firft caftrophe of our fortune, patiently to fuffer. The price fet upon our commodities, after this manner, was redue'd every year, and we were neceffitated rather to part with them for a fmall profit, than to export them with lofs. They oblig'd us into the bargain, to take in payment for our goods the Cobang, (which we had hitherto taken for 59 or 60 Maas, and which is current among the natives only for 54 to 59) for 68, what was got by this way of dealing, as alfo the overplus of the prices fet upon the goods, was by them call'd AiJagin, that is, the Middle-money, and afhgn'd for Chap. VIII. The Hiftwyof JAPAN. 3S1 for the ufe and common benefit of the town of 5 Nagafaki. In this condition it would have been impoflible for us to flay in. the coun- try, and the continuation of this proceeding would infallibly have fcrc'd us to leave our trade there. We refolv'd therefore to try, what ways and means we could, to reftore our commerce to the con- dition it had been in before. Nothing could be thought of, that was like to have a better effect, than to reprefent our grievances, in an humble petition, to the Emperor, as beyond doubt ignorant of this notorious breach of the facred privileges, granted us by the Emperors his predeceffors. This petition was writ accordingly, in due form and in Chinefe characters, and by order of the Director-general at Batavia, deliver'd to the Governors of Nagafaki. For nothing can be prefcnted by foreigners to the Emperor, if it hath not been firft put into the hands of the Covernors of this place. After three years waiting, we at laft obtain'd a favourable anfwer from court, contain- ing in fubftance, that our trade fhould be reftor'd upon the fame foot, it had been before by virtue of our privileges. The confequence of an order at firft view fo favourable for our commerce, was in fact more fatal to it, than any we had as yet receiv'd, and brought it from the third to the laft and iron period, wherein it continu'd ever fince. The Governors of Nagafaki were exceedingly diffatisfy'd with this g.u« ftU new order, not only, becaufe it had not been obtain'd by their fa- 1?? ane f e i u ~ ; . J . rmz, the third vour and interceflion, purchas'd with large prefents, but becaufe they, Period of w.r and other Japanefe managers of our trade, were by it depriv'd f Tracle - confiderable fums, which they got, by taxing and fetting a price of their own malting upon our Commodities. Our Ottond once confefs'd to me, that, for his own (hare, he loft by this order a yearly profit of 3600 Thails. Minofama having not yet forgot the above-mention'd vexatious difappointment, did not lie quiet Upon this occafion, and tho' he had been four years before, upon the demife of the Emperor his mafter, and the acceffion of Tfpiajos to the throne, put out of his places, and confequently out of power to hurt us himfelf, yet he urg'd the reftriction of our privileges at court, by his fort in law, Kangofama, then one of the prime minifters and privy Councellor, and likewife prevail'd upon his nephew Genfejemon^ Governor of Nagafaki^ to do us what mifchief he could. The latter in particular, and in conjunction with his collegues, reprefented to the court, how prejudi- cial this renewal of our privileges was to the natives, and what vaft profits it brought in to us foreigners. This they did with fo much fuccefs, that as by virtue of this late order we had obtain'd leave to fell our soods freely, and to the beft bidder, it was now refolv'd, that F f u " ^1, D J ' ' ' of ourt/ude. the faid order fhould fubfift in full force, and that we fhould have leave to import, what goods, and to what quantity we pleas'd, but that we fhould be fo far reftrain'd in the fale, as not to exceed the Y y y y funt • 3<$2 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. fum of 300000 Tbails a year, and that the goods not difpos'd of Ihould be laid up in our warehoufes againft the next year's fale. And thus the reftor'd liberty prov'd more fatal to us, than the taxation it- felf was, which yet we thought fo great and infufferable a hardfhip. For it was much more profitable for us to difpofe of large cargoes with fmall gain, than of fmall cargoes with more profit. In the mean time, that it Ihould not appear as if this fatal reduction had been re- folv'd upon meerly to difoblige the Dutch nation, but rather by a political maxim, agreeable to the Emperor and advantageous to the Empire, the commerce of the Chinefe and fuch Eaftern Nations, as trade to Japan under their name, was likewife reduc'd to a yearly fum of 6coooo Tbails. The Emperor was fo well pleas'd with, the finding out of this expedient, whereby without prejudice to the liberty granted us by his late Imperial orders, our commerce was -regulated, and our profit reduced low enough indeed, but not quite fo low, as would have put us under a neceflity of leaving the country (which the court was not a little apprehenfive of) : The Empe- ror, I fay, was fo well pleas'd with the finding out of this expe- dient, and the prudent conduct of the Governors of Nagafaki, that fometime after he conferr'd upon them the honourable and illuftrious title of Cami. Sr.tte of ow The Dutch had as yet no notice given them of this new regulation, Trade in 1 6* <$ w hen in Autumn 1685, their fhips, very richly laden, arriv'd in the harbour. The joy of their fafe arrival was fo much the greater, as anew they promis'd themfelves mountains of gold, and were in no ill grounded hopes once more to fee the firft and happieft period of their commerce revive. But we had fcarce begun to unlade them, and but jiift got the Cargo of one on more, when to our unfpeakeble grief, new orders were fent from court to limit the liberty reftored to us (and to the Chinefe) to a certain determin'd fum, beyond which nothing mould be difpofed of ^ and to prevent fmugling, an exact account was to be taken of the whole cargo, the fame narrowly to be examin'd into, and afterwards to be laid up in our ware houfes under our own locks indeed, but with their feals put to them. Nor are we ever fince al- low'd the liberty of going into them to take care of our goods unlefs it be by their leave, and in their prefence. The yearly fum, to the value of which the Dutch are permitted to fell goods imported by them, and which is juft half the fum allow'd to the Chinefe, amounts in Dutch money to ten tons of gold, and a half, that is 1050000 gilders, (very near icccco 1. fterling,) and in fapanefe money to 300 chefls, or boxes of filver, each of 1000 Siumo- me, or Tbails Cwhich laft word hath been introdue'd into Japan by the Dutch) which make up in all 300000 Siumome in filver, or 5CCC0 Cobangs in gold. The higheft value of the Cobang, as current in the country, is of fixty Momi, or Ma as of filver, but the Japanefe have fa Chap. VIII. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 363 fo order'd it, as to make the Company take it for fixty eight, and yet be paid all in gold, and thus the company fells indeed for 300000 Thaih of their goods a year, but in fad doth not receive beyond the value of 260000 Thails in real filver money. By this means the government of Nagafaki, hath found out a way, to make the Directors and other offi- cers concern'd in carrying on the Dutch trade fome amends for theit trouble and hard ufage, by affigning them fome private profits, independant of thofe of the Company and by permitting them to dif- pofe of their own private goods, which formerly they fold, in what quantity they pleas'd, to the value of 40000 Thaih or $888 Cobangs which together with the above mention'd, 260000 Thails make up the yearly fum, as it hath been limited by the laft Imperial orders. It is not in the Company's power to alter this regulation, becaufe the Japanefe Government hath thought fit fo to order it, nor can they give to their officers any difturbance, or make any inhibition to prevent their difpofing of their private goods. Thefe 40000 Thails are divided amongft the feveral officers concern'd in carrying on our trade in Ja* pan, in the following manner. The Captain, as he is here cail'd or chief director for the time being, and AmbafTador to the Emperor's court, hath 10000 Thails, affign'd him, the new director, lately arrived to relieve him, 7000 Thails, his Deputy, or the fecond perfon after him, 6000 Thails, the Captains of the fhip, merchants, clerks, and other people who came over .on board the laft mips, proportionably, as they happen to be in favour with the chief managers, and the Japanefe Interpreters, to whom it belongs jointly to divide the faid fum, and to take care that there be nothing fold beyond what hath been affign'd to every one. The Reader is defir'd here to obferve, that the Company keeps con- DireSor f ftantly a Director, or as he is cail'd by the Japanefe, Captain of the theDatcbtra'de Dutch, who hath the command of all the people of our factory, with the inflection and care of our trade. The fame perfon is to be at the head of the embafly, which is fent to court once every year. He muft, according to the cuftom of the country, be reliev'd after the year is expir'd. The mips bring over from Batavia his SuccefTor* along with a deputy, fome few merchants and clerks, who are to aflift him during the time of the fale. When the fale is over, and the fhips ready to fet fail, he goes on board in order to his return to Batavia, and leaves the place to his Succeffor, who is reliev'd the next year, by another in the fame manner. The fale of our goods is perform'd in the following manner. The Sa[e * day of the Comhang, (as they call our fale) which muft be determined gWf. by the court, drawing near, a lift of all the goods is hung up at the gates without our Ifland, written in very large characters, that every body may read it at a due diftance. Mean while the government fig- nines to the feveral Ottona's of the town, and thefe to the merchants, who «w 364 The Hiftoryof JAPAN. Book IV who are come thither from divers parts of the Empire, and lodge within their diftrict, what duty there will be laid per Cant (for tli- benefit of the Inhabitants of Nagafaki) upon feveral of our goods, in order to enable them to refolve accordingly, what price they can well afford to buy them at. A tine trick indeed, whereby they tax our goods indirectly, and ridicule us into the bargain with the reftoring of our liberty and privileges. For, fay they, and fo it is in fad, when we tax'd your goods, you came with no lefs than feven fhips, and difpos'd of great cargoes :, now you can fend but three or four fhips, and fell but a few goods :, had it not been better for you, to remain as you were, than by applying for a renewal of your privileges to make your condition the worfe. The day before the Coinbang papers are put up at all the gates of the (Ireets, to invite the merchants to make their appearance the next morning at Deftma, where for their farther information, they find before every warehoufe a lift of the goods laid up therein. As the direction of our trade is entirely in the hands of the government of Nagafaki, fo particularly the Combang cannot be held, but in prefence of two ftewards of the Governors, in quality of their deputies, authoriz'd by them to afhft at it. The chief officers of our Ifland muft likewife be prefent. The lirft Interpreter prefides, and directs every thing, whilft our own triumvirs, I mean the two di- rectors, the old and new, and the deputy director have little or no- thing to fay. All perfons, who muft be prefent at the fale, having met together, our directors order a pattern of all our merchantable goods to be expos'd to view, and then give a fignal with a Gum Gum (is a. fort of a flat bell not unlike a Bafon) for the merchants to come in. The houfe, where the fale is kept, is a very neat building, built at the company's expence, and is then by removing the mutters laid open towards the ftreet for people to look in. There is a fmall gallery round it, and it is divided within into feveral partitions, very com- modioufly contriv'd for this act. The fale itfelf is performed in the following manner. Only one fort of goods is put up at a time. Thofe who have a mind to buy them, give in fome tickets each, fign'd by fham names, and fignifying how many Quan, Me, Momi, Burin, Me, and Futz, they intend to give for a piece, or a Catti of the goods which have been put up, all the whole fale goods being fold to that quantity. I took notice, that every merchant gives in feveral tickets. This is done in order to fee how matters are like to go, and to keep to a lefs price, in cafe he repents of the greater, for which fame purpofe they are fign'd only by fham names : And becaufe of the great number and fub-divifion of the fmall money, it feldom happens that two tickets exactly agree with one another. After all the bidders have given in their tickets, our directors proceed to open them, and to feparate the greater from the fmaller. They are then deliver'd to the prefiding chief Interpreter, who reads them aloud — - - ■ „, I Chap, VIII. The Hiftory «f JAPAN. 365 aloud one after another, beginning with the higheft. They ask after the bidder three times, and if there is no anfwer made, he lays that ticket afide, and takes the next to it. So he goes on, taking always a lefs, till the bidder cries out, Here I am, and then draws near to fign the note, and to put his true name to it with black ink, which the Japanefe for the like purpofes always carry about them. The goods put up being fold, they proceed to others, which they fell in the fame manner, and fo they go on, till the fum determin'd by the Emperor hath been rais'd, which is commonly done in two or three, feldom in four, Combangs, or days of fale. The day after each Corn- bang the goods are deliver'd to the buyer, and carried off from our Iiland. A company of merchants of the five Imperial cities have, by imperial letters patents, obtain'd the monopoly for buying and fell- of raw filks. This commodity is fold firft, to their great ad- vantage and our no fmall prejudice, and they would fain oblige us to make up at lead one third of our cargoes with raw filk. The Quanmotz, duty or custom laid upon goods, is but little us'd in Japan. It hath been introduc'd at Nagafaki, meerly with an intent to take off part of the vast profits, which foreigners got upon their commodi- ties, and to aflign them for the ufe and maintenance of the poorer In- habitants of this town. It was formerly moderate enough, but the late taxation, which hath been fo very beneficial to the Governors and other Magistrates of the town, having been taken off, the Gover- nors have thought fit to raife it, on purpofe to engage the Japanefe merchants to buy our goods at a lefs rate, in proportion to the duty laid upon them. This Quanmotz, when levied, is call'd by the Ja- panefe Koofen, or Kojen Gin, a reward, or money to reward one's trouble. In the distribution they call it Fannagin, or Flower-money, to fignify, that it flowers out of the foreign trade for the maintenance and advantage of the poorer Inhabitants of Nagafaki. It is distributed among them in proportion to the trouble they muft be at, on account of the pub- lick offices they muft ferve by turns, which differ according to the fituation of the ftreets they live in, as alfo to make them fome a- mends for many other troubles and hardfhips they have reafon to com- plain of, the rather fince the barrennefs of the country about Nagafaki, and many other difadvantages occafion'd by the foreign commerce, might otherwife induce them to run away from thence to fome other parts of the Empire, where they might live at a lefs charge and with more eafe. They commonly receive in this distribution from three to fifteen Thails a-piece. The duty it felf laid upon the goods belong- ing to the company is fifteen Thails per cent, which upon the whole fum of 300000 Thails produces 45000 Thails duty. The goods be- longing to private perfons, which are commonly fold at the end of the Co'r.iang, pay much more, and no lefs than 65 per cent for all fluffs and ;*oods fold by pieces, which upon 20000 Thails brings in Z z z z 13000 3 66 The Hiflory s/JAPAN. Book IV. 13000 Thails cuftom. Goods fold by the weight pay a duty of 70 Thails per cent, which upon 20000 Thails makes 14000 duty. The reafon they give for this great difference in the duty laid upon the company's, and upon private goods, is becaufe private goods are brought over on board the company's ihips, at their risk and expence, and con- fequently deferve lefs profit. The Chinefe for the like reafon, that is, becaufe they are not at the expence of fuch long and hazardous voy- ages as the Dutch, but nearer at hand, pay a duty of 60 per cent for all their goods, which upon the 600000 Thails, to the value of which they are permitted to fell every year, brings in a fum of 360000 Thails duty. If to this be added the yearly rents for our houfes and factory, which is 5580 Thails, and that of the Chinefe factory, which is 16000 Thails a year, it makes up, in all, a fum of 453580 Thails, which the foreign commerce produces a year to the Magiftrates' and Inhabitants of Nagafakz. Profits upon As to the profits, the Company gets upon the commodities imported Good by us, it differs very much and varies every year, the fame goods being not conftantly fold to an equal quantity, nor at the fame rate. The whole depends upon the price, each fort of goods hath at Mzaco, and this is commonly regulated by the confumption, and want, there is of them in the country. The profits our goods produce, may be computed to amount, one year with another, to 60 per cent, tho' if all the charges and expences of our fale be taken into confideration, we cannot well get above 40 or 45 per cent clear gain, and thus the goods we fell in Japan to the value of ten tons of gold and a half, or 1050000 Gilders, yield no more than four tons, or four and a half, that is, 400000, or 450000 Gilders clear profit. A profit indeed very inconfiderable for fo great a Company, which muff con- ftantly keep at leaft 18000 men in pay, at the expence of upwards of 260000 Gilders (near 24000 1. fterlingj a month, only in wages befides the vaft number of Ships, factories, and forts, they have to maintain and to look after, all over the Eaft-Indies. Confidering fo fmall a profit, it would be fcarce worth the company's while to continue this branch of our trade any longer, were it not that the goods we export from thence, and particularly the refin'd copper, yield much the fame profit, fo that the whole profit may be computed to amount to' 80 or 90 per cent. The charges and expences we rauft be at, are not the fame every year. They are greater, if there is any thing wants building or repairing, or if there be more prefents to be made, or if any thing extraordinary happens. For the fatisfaclion of the Reader, I will here fet down the expences of two years, as they ftood in the laft and fourth period of our commerce, to wit, in 1686. Mr. licentiate Cleyer being then Director, and the expences much higher than ufual, and in 1688, when Mr. BuUnheimb was Director, and the ex- pences fo fmall, as could pofhbly be expected. The Our Charges. Chap. VIII. The Hifiory of J A P A N. 367 The Expences of 1686 of 1688. For Visuals, Gilders. 23580 Gilder s 13 166 Boarding 9791 . 6828 Extraordinary Expences 14097 4995 Charges of the Ships 10986 7589 Prefents 107086 > 100789 Interefts and monthly wages paid off 8092 - 7318 Hire for Defima and bur warehoufes — — 19530 ■ ■- 19530 Summa Gilders 193162 1 60 213 As to the price and profit of every fort of goods in particular, I prices of ft- think it doth not become me accurately to fpecifythe fame, nor per- l eral G m haps would it be agreeable to the Reader. However to give him fome fatisfa&ion, I will here fet down the current price of foreign commodities at Miaco for the year 1692, as it hath been communica- ted to me. Chinefe filk, Cabeffa, or the beft, the Picket, or 125 lb. Dutch for 665 Siwnome, or Thails, Dito Bariga, or middle fort, a 638 Thails. Silk of Bengale, Cabeffa, or the beft, a 530 Thails, a pickel. Ditto Bariga, a 406 Thails. Tunquineefe Silk Thails 440 the Picket, or 1 2 5 lb. Florette Yarn 240 . — Cinnabar > 600 ■ • Cloves ■ 223 . Pepper 23 ■ Sugar Candy 2 1 » . Powder'd Sugar 14 Camphire of Baros, a Katti, or 1 pound and a qr. i 33 Siumome, or Thails. futfmk, or Co/lus Arabica, a 10 Thaifs a Catti. Great, white, roll'd Chinefe Pelangs, 14 Thails a piece. Armoiins, a 7 Thails, 4 Maas, the piece. Tafaeeels from Cormandel, the beft at 6 Thails^ 8 Maas a piece, the courfer fort at 6 Thails. Tafaeeels from Bengale, at 4 Thails, 3 Maas. Common white (imple Gilangs, at 4, 8, 4, a piece. Sumongis from Twiquin, at 3. 3. White Gunis Linnen, a 7 Thails. Salempuris, common bleach'd, at 3, I. Paraceels y common bleach'd, at 1, 5, 3. Before 368 The Hiftory 0/ J A P A N. Book IV. Before I clofe this fubject, and proceed to fend our four £hips, the GooOTrf with the profits and frefli cargoes on their return to Batavia, it may • ■ P«r- not be amifs to fay fomething of the profits which the goods be- longing to private perfons bring in, and in particular, what the three chief Directors of our trade can get by their places. The goods be- longing to private perfons being brought over and fold without any expence to the owner, produce all clear gain, which the great duty laid upon them notwithstanding, is no ways inferior to that of the Company, tho" they pay but a fmall duty* The two chief Directors (who purfuant to order from court) cannot hold their office longer than three years, and even that not fucceffively, being oblig'd, after they have ferv'd one year, to return, with the homeward bound ihips, to Batavia, from whence they are fent back again, either by the next mips, or two years after, have the greateft mare of it, for they are permitted to fell and difpofe of their own goods, upon their arri- val to the value of 7000 Tbails, and in their own directorship, when they are going to return to Batavia, to the value of 10000 Thails confequently for 17000 Thails in one year. The deputy Director for his fhare can £ell for 12000 Thails of his goods. If the Directors (land upon good terms witlj the chief Interpreter, and have found ways and means to fecure his favour, by making him large prefents de alie. nis, he can contrive things fo, that fome of their goods be put up and fold upon the firfl or fccond Combang, amongft the Company's goods, and will confequently, becaufe of the fmall duty, produce at lead 65 to 70 per cent profit. This too may be done without any prejudice to the Company, for in calling up the fums paid in for our goods, in order to make up the 300000 Thails, thefe articles are flipt over. If they have any goods beyond the fum, they are legally entitled to, chiefly red corals, amber, and the like, it is an eafy mat- ter to difpofe of them in private, by the affiflance of the officers of our Ifland, who generally will take them off their hands themfelves. The Ottona himfelf is very often concern'd in fuch bargains, they being very advantageous. Formerly we could fell them, by a deputy, to the foreigners , who at the time of our Combangs came over to our Ifland, and that way was far the more profitable for us. But one of our Directors, in 1686, play'd his cards fo aukwardly, that ten Japa- nefe were beheaded for fmugling, and he himfelf banifh'd the country for ever. The refiding Director who goes alfo as AmbafTador to the Emperor's court, hath befides another very confiderable advantage, in that fuch prefents, as at the governors of Nagafaki defire fhould be made to the Emperor, but are not to be found in the Company's ware- houfes, and fhould therefore be bought from the Chinefe, can be furnifh'd by him out of his own flock, if it fo happens that he hath them, in which cafe he takes all the profit to himfelf, without doing any prejudice to the company. Nay they might poffibly go flill farther in Chap. VIII. The Hijlory of J A P A N. 369 in purfuit of their own private advantages, were it not, that they endea- vour to pafs for mert of confidence and honour, or at leaft aim to appear fearful, left they mould be thought too notorioufly to injure both the confidence and intereft of their matters, f do not pretend hereby to charge them with any indirect practices, as to the annual expences, though perhaps even thefe are fometimes run up to an unncceflary height : Nor is it iri the lead my intention to detract from the repu- tation, and character of probity, of fo many worthy Gentlemen, who have fill'd this ftation with honour, and difcharg'd their duty with the utmoft faithfulnefs to their maftefs. However, to fupport what I have here aliened, and to ihew, that if the Directors had hot the com- mon intereft of the Company more at heart than their own private advantages, they could enrich themfelves by defrauding their princi- pals, I cannot forbear mentioning one inftance. The instructions from the government of Batavia, with regard to the refin'd copper, are not to buy it for lefs than twelve Tbails, or twelve and a half, a Ticket. This they do, to keep the refiners in good humour, and not to difcoufage them , by allowing them too inconfiderable a profit. Neverthelefs the Interpreters may fometimes get it for a Maas cheaper- which upon 12000 Pickets, the quantity commonly bought, makes a Sum of 600 Tbails, which they may, if they pleafe, put in their pockets, becaufe it is contrary to their instructions in their account to charge the copper for fo much lefs. Now, whether of no they actually do this, I will not take upon me to aflert. Thus much I can fay, without exaggeration, that the Directorship of the Dutch trade in Japan, is a place, which the poSTeflbr would not eafily part with for 30000 Gilders (about 3000 /. fterling). 'Tis true, it would be a great difadvantage to the Director, and corifiderably leflen his pro- fits, if he hath not a good cam in hand to provide himfelf, before his' departure, with -a fufficient quantity of goods, but muft take them upon credit, and upon his return Share the profits with his credi- tors. For befides, he muft not pfefume to leave Batavia, much lefs' to return thither, without valuable considerations to his benefactors,' unlefs he intends to be excus'd for the future the honour of any fuch employment. The goods he brings back to Batavia are, Silk- gowns, which he receiv'd as prefents from the Emperor and his Mi- nisters, and whereof he makes prefents again to his friends and paj trons j victuals, china-ware, lacker'd, or japan'd things, and other ma- nufactures of the country, which he can difpofe of at Batavia at 50 per cent profit, and befides fome Cobangs in gold. The Cobangs We took formerly at 54 Tbails a piece, and could afterwards fell them upon the coafts of Cormandel at 28 per cent profit. But fince we have been oblig'd to take them at a'^ higher rate, they yield a much lefs, and in the main very inconfiderable profit. It is much more profita- ble for the Director, if he hath any left, to buy Ambergreefe, or re- A a a a a fin'c! 37 o The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. fin'd Copper, and to fend the latter, if poflible, on board the company's lliips to Malacca, I fay, if poihble, becaufe there are Uriel: orders from the company againft it. Cargoes of r U r But it is time at laft, to fend our fhips on their return. To makeup U^Sjhipu th^ 1 cargoes, a good part of the 1050000 gilders, paid in for our com- modities, is kid out in refin'd copper, of which we buy for 12000 to 20000 pickels a year, (a pickel is 125 1. dutch weight) all the reiin'd Copper is call in fmall cylindrical ftaffs about a fpan long, and near an inch thick. Every pickel is pack'd up in a fmall box made of firr, for the eafier carriage. Every one of the three or four fhips, we fend hi- • thef, makes up part of her cargo with it. One of thefe fhips makes the bed of her way to Batavia. The others put in at Pali Thimon (an Ifland upon the coafts of Malacca) from whence they proceed on their voy- age to Malacca, to be by our Governor there bound farther either for Bengale, or the coafts of Cormanclel, or for Surate, or any other place, where they are like to difpofe of their cargoes to good advantage. We buy likewife a fmaller quantity of courfe copper, which is deliver'd to us cafl in broad flattifh round cakes, fometimes we take in fome hun^ dred Pickels, or chefts of copper Casjes, or farthings, but not unlefs they be afk'd for at Tunquin, and other places. All the copper is fold to us by a company of united merchants, who by vertue of a privi- lege from the Emperor, have the fole refining and felling of it to fo- reigners, for which they are to pay to the Imperial chief Juflice at Miaco, as Infpe&or, for the time being, of foreign affairs, 4.C0 fhuets of filver a year, by way of a prefent. To engage cur interpreters to make a good bargain for us with the copper merchants, we allow them a reward of 600, or more, Thails a year, and they generally play their cards fo well, as to receive a fum not inferior to this from the copper Company, by way of a gratuity. The other part of our Cargoes is made up by Japanefe Camphire, from 6000 to 12000, and fometimes more, pounds a year, pack'd up in wooden barrels j by fome 100 bales of China ware, pack'd in ftraw \ by a box or two of Gold thread, of an hundred rolls the box, but not unlefs it be wanted \ by all forts of japan'd cabinets, boxes, chefts of drawers and the like workmanfhip, all of the very b eft, we can meet with \ by umbrello's, fkreens, and feve- ral other manufactures of canes, wood, buffalo's, and other horns, hard (kins of fifties, which they work with uncommon neatnefs and dexte_ rity, ftone, copper, gold and Sowaas, which is an artificial metal com- pos'd of copper, iilver and gold, and efteem'd equal in value to fil- ver, if not fuperior :, by Rollangs :, by paper made tranfparent with cyl and vamifh •, by paper painted and colour'd.with falfe gold and filver for hanging of rooms ^ by rice, the fineft of all. Afia; by Sacki, a ftrcng liquor brew'd of rice^ by Soje, a fort of pickel, fit to be eat at table with roafted meat ; by pickel'd fruits pack'd up in barrils j by indented Chap. VIII. The Hilary of J A P A N. 371 indented tobacco, Tea and marmelades - befides fome thoufands Cobangs of gold in fpecie. ft**iAp Our Ihips cannot be laden, nor fet fail from the harbour, till »^»tbeh ■&- fpecial leave hath been given, and the day of their departure determin'd P artl " 1 '- by the court. When they are laden, all our private goods, and what elfe we have to bring on board, rauft be again narrowly fearch'd. For this purpofe two of our landlords, two apprentices of the Interpreters; and two clerks, either of the Ottona, or of the treafury office, with fome Kuli's or workmen, call about 2 or 3 days before the departure upon every one in his room, as well thofe, who flay at Defmia^ as thofe, who are to return, and have been lodg'd in our empty houfes during the time of the fale. Thefe people vifit every corner, exa- mine all our things piece by piece, taking an exad memorandum of what they find, then bind them together with draw ropes, and put their feals to them, along with a lift of what the parcel contains for t he information of the gate guard, who would elfe open them again. All contraband goods are feiz'd at this fearch. Such are for inftance, whatever hath the figure of an Idol of the Country, of a Kitge, or an Ecclefiaftical perfon of the Dairi's Court in his drefsj all printed books and papers, looking glaffes, or other metals with Japanefe characters upon them , filver money j fluffs woven in the Country ^ but in par- ticular arms, and whatever can be referr'd under that title, as the figure of a foldier, faddle, fhip, or boat, armour, bow ancharrows, fwords and fcimeters. Should any of thefe be found upon any Dutchman, the poffeffor would be at leafl banifh'd the Country for life, and the In- terpreters and fervants appointed to take care of his affairs, and all 0- ther fufpicious perfons, would be put to the rack, till the feller and all his accomplices be difcover'd, by whofe blood only fuch a crime is to be expi- ated. Of this we had a late inftance in the Imperial flewards own fe- cretary, who having endeavour'd to fend over fome blades of a Sci- meter to China, was executed for it, with his only fon, an innocent child, not above eight years old. Upon my own departure, altho' my things, for good reafons, were vifited but flightly, and over a bottle, yet they feiz'd upon an old Japanefe razor, and a few fmall flicks ty'd to the babies, inftead of fabres, becaufe they juft happen' d to fee them. All the gold belonging to private people rauft be exported openly, and before their leaving t)efima fhewn to the Commiflioners, to fee whether it pafs'd thro' their hands, which they know by a mark, they ftamp upon all Cobangs in the Exchequer-office. By this means they may find out, whether it hath not been got by fmugling. As $ m ^L. to this however, they cannot be fo very nice, becaufe of the great hurry of other bufinefs to be difpatch'd upon our departure. All thefe feveral flricl orders and regulations of the Japanefe, have been made chiefly with an intent to prevent fmugling, a crime feverely 372 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. forbid by the Erriperor, and indeed not without very good reafori for it not only makes the goods more common and cheaper, but by lefiening the Kofen, or duty, proves very prejudicial to the town of \fotgafake'i the inhabitants whereof muft get a confiderable part of their livelyhood upon the faid duty. The penalty put upon this crime is death, without hopes of reprieve, but it extends only to the perfon convicted, and his accomplices, and not to their families, as the pu- nilhments of other crimes do. And yet the Japanefe are fo addicted to this crime, that, according to computation, no Je'fs than 500 perfons have been executed in fix or feven years time, only for frnueling; with the Chinefe, whofe departing yonks they follow to the main Sea, and buy of them what goods they could not difpofe of at their fale at Nagafaki. There are not many lnftances of people, that were executed for fmugling with the Dutch. During my fray in Japan, which was not above two years, upwards of fifty fmuglers loft their lives, fome whereof having been apprehended made away with them- felves, others were publickly executed, and fome privately in prifon. No longer ago than 1691, two Japanefe were executed upon our Ifland, for having fmuggled from a Dutchman one pound of Cam- phire of Bares, which was found upon the buyer, juft as he endea- vour'd to carry it off from our Ifland. But I will firft fend our mips on their return, and then clofe this tedious chapter with the Hiftory of this execution. The day determin'd for the departure of our fhips draw- ing near, they proceed to lade their cargoes one after another. La ft of all, the arms and powder are brought on board, follow'd by the fhip's company, who muft again pafs in review according to the lift which was given in upon the fhip's arrival. The fhip being ready to fet fail, fhe muft weigh her anchors that inftant, and retire two leagues off the town, towards the entrance of the harbour, where fhe rides till the other fhips are laden in the fame manner. When alll the homeward-bound fhips are join'd, they proceed on their voyage, and after they have got to the main fea, to a pretty confiderable diftance from the harbour, the Japanefe Ship-guard, which never quitted them from their firft arrival till then, leave them, and return home. If the wind proves contrary to the fhips going out, a good number of Japanefe rowing boats, faften'd to a rope, tow them out by force, one after another. For the Emperor's order muft be executed in fpite of wind and weather, fhould even after- wards all the fhips run the hazard of being wreck'd. Execution of I come now to the hiftory of the execution above-mention'd, where- X°h7-' wit ^ * propos'd to clofe this tedious chapter. On the 10th of De- cember ', early in the morning, the comman ling Governor formerly call'd Ginfe'jemrm, now T/ino Cam'i, fent notice by the Ottona of our Ifland, to our Director, to keep himfelf, with the reft of the Dutch- men, in readinefs to fee the Criminals executed. About an hour after cams Chap VIII. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 373 came over the numerous flocks of our Interpreters, landlords, cooks, and all the train of Defima, with the fheriffs, and other officers of Jnftice, in all to the number of at leaft 200 people. Before the com- pany was carried a pike, with a table, whereupon the crime, for which the criminals were to fufFer, was fpecify'd in large characters, that every body might read it at a diflance. Then follow'd the two cri- minals furrounded with Bailiffs. The fifft was the buyer, a young man, of 23 years of age, upon whom the Camphite was found, as he en- deavour'd to carry it off from the Ifland, very meanly clad. The fecond was a well-looking man, and well clad, about 40 years of age, who fufFer'd only for having lent the other, formerly a fervant of his, the money to buy the Camphire. One of the Bailiffs carried an inftrumertt upright, form'd like a rake, but with iron hooks inftead of teeth, proper to bz made ufe of, if any of the malefactors mould attempt to make his efcape, becaufe it eafily catches hold of one's cloaths. Ano- ther carried another inflrument proper to cut, to flab, and to keep one fall to a wall. Then follow'd two officers of the Governor's Court, with their retinues, as Commiflioners to prefide at this aft, and at fome diflance from them came two clerks. In this order they march'd acrofs our Ifland, to the place defign'd for this execution. We Dutchmen, only (even in number, (our fhips being already return'd) refolv'd not to come near : But our Director advis'd us to go, be- caufe he had heard, that, upon refufal, we fhould be compell'd to it by force. I followd this advice, and went without delay to fee the execution done. I found the two criminals in the middle of the place, one behind the other, kneeling, their fhoulders uncover'd, and their hands ty'd to their back. Each had his executioner Handing by him, the one a Tanner (Tor Tanners do the office of executioners in this country J the other his bell friend and comrade, whom he earneftly defir'd, as the cuflom is in this country, by do- ing him this piece of fervice, to confirm the friendfhip he had always had for him. At about twenty paces from the criminals fate the two Commiffioners upon one bench, and the two clerks upon another. A third was left empty for our Director, who however did not appear. The reft of the people flood promifcuouJly, where they pleas'd. I my- felf crowded, with my Japanefe fervant, as near one of the malefactors^ as pofiibly we could. Mean while they were looking out for the reft of the Dutchmen, I over -heard a very extraordinary difcourfe be- tween the two criminals. For as the elderly man was grumbling be- tween his teeth his Qiiamvonjo, (Quanwonjo, is a fhort prayer to the Hundred-hand Idol, call'd by the Japanefe Quanwon 1 This prayer is taken out of Fatznomaki, the eighth part of the great Book Fakejo, which is compos'd of 48 parts) the other, to whom I flood neareft, rebuk'd him for it, in the following words j Fy, faith he, for foame to appear thus frighted out of your wits ! Ah, Ah, faid the other, / only B b b b b pray 374 The Hiftory c/JAPAN. Book IV. pray a little. You have had time enough to pray, reply 'd the young man, it fignifies nothing at prefent but to expofe your felf\ and to fieiv the Dutch ■what a Coward you are. This difcourfe fo wrought upon the other, that he actually left off praying. The minute the Dutch were all met together at the place of execution, a fignal was given, and that in- ftant both executioners cut off, each his criminal's head, with a fhort Scymiter, in fuch a manner that their bodies fell forward to the ground. The bodies were wrapt up, each in a courfe rufh-mat, and both their heads together in a third, and fo carried away from Dcfima to the ordinary place of execution, a field, near Mangome, a fmall village not far from Nagafaki, where, 'tis faid, young people try'd their ftrength, and the fharpnefs of their Scymiters, upon the dead bodies, by hacking them into fmall pieces, fcarce an inch long and broad, which they afterwards permitted to be buried. Both heads were fix'd upon a Pale, according to cuftom, and expos'd to view for feven days. The execution being over, the company march'd off from Defima without any order. Our Direclor went to meet the two Commiflioners, and afterwards the two Clerks upon the crofs-ftreet, as they were returning home, thank'd them fcr the trouble they had been at on this occafion, and invited them to his honfe to fmoke a pipe. He had nothing in return for his kind invitation but a fharp reprimand, with an admonition, to take care of his people, that no more fuch accidents fhould happen for the future. This was- the firfr time criminal blood was fhed upon our Ifland. CHAP. IX. Of the way of Ufe, 'Trade and privileges of the Chinefe in J AT AN. TH E Chinefe from remoteft antiquity, exported the growth and commodities of their country, chiefly raw filk, wherein it ubmejeiram. abounds, all over the Eaft. 'Tis from thence they were by the Greeks and Romans call'd Seres. They traded particularly to the Kingdoms and Iflands fituate beyond Sumatra and Malacca to the Eaft, Since the late Tartarian conqueft. many of them, unwilling to conform to the orders iffu'd by their Conqueror, to fhave their head9 after the manner of the Tartars, left their native country, and fettled in the fame Kingdoms and Iflands, which till then they had frequented only a3 traders. They had alfo, from times almoft immemorial, car- ried on a commerce with Japan, tho' but fmall, and with a few yonks. Chap. IX. The Hiflory (/JAPAN. 375 vonks. For under the reigns of fome former Emperors, China was, as Japan now is, (hut up and kept from all commerce with foreign nations, and the Inhabitants ftriAly forbid under fevere penalties, to export the growth of the country, or to have any communication with their neighbours. Neverthelefs, thofe who lived along the Sea coafts, and in the neighbouring Iflands, found means, tho' with fome difficul- ty and in private, to fit out a fmall number of yonks, and now and then to pafs over to the Kingdoms, and Iflands, which lay nearefi, whereof Japan was one. Things flood upon this foot, when the late Tartarian Conqueror of China, and his Succeffcr the now reigning Mo- narch of that mighty Empire, thinking that it would very much con- duce to the honour of his fubjefts, and to the advantage of his domini- ons, for the future to permit a free and undifturb'd commerce, refolv'd. to fuffer his fubje&s to trade abroad, and to give foreigners a free accefs to his dominions. The Chinefe ever fince exported the produce and commodities of their country to a much greater quantity, than be- fore, and enlarg'd their trade and commerce, as with mod Eafterri Nations, fo particularly with their neighbours the Japanefe, by whom they had been all along receiv'd as welcome guefts, and tolerated, be- caufe of the affinity there is between the religion, cufloms, books, learn- ed languages, arts and fciences of both nations. Formerly they fre- quented the harbour of Ofacca, and others lefs fecure, becaufe of the frequent cliffs, rocks and fhoals, which make the whole navigation that way exceedingly difficult and dangerous, and wholly impracticable for fhips of any bulk. The Portuguefe fome time after fhew'd them the way to that of Nagafaki, which is not only more fecure, but was in many other refpefls much more advantageous. The refort of mer- chants to this place, who came from all parts of the Empire to trade with the Portuguefe, was too great, not to engage the Chinefe to put in there preferably to other places. At laft orders from court, importing, that the harbour of Nagafaki fhould be for the future the only one open to foreigners, in all the Japanefe dominions, fix'd them there. Ever fince, the Chinefe, as well thofe who live in China, as others who were by the late Tartarian conqueft difpers'd into the neighbouring Countries and Iflands beyond the Ganges to the Eaft, traded to Naga- faki, either upon their own account, or that of their principals, for fometime with all the liberty they could poflibly defire. They came over when, and with what numbers of people, yonks and goods they pleas'd. So extenfive and advantageous a liberty could not but be very pleafing to them, and put them upon thoughts of a furer eftablifhment, in or- der to which, and for the free exercife of their religion, they built three temples, according to the three chief languages fpoke by them, each to be attended by priefts of their own Nation fent over from China. The R '^* Ml ' number of Chinefe, and Chinefe yonks foon encreas'd to that degree, ? ra Je t mi as made the fufpicious and circumfpeel; Japanefe extreamly jealous of the Rca J'"' them. 376 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. them. For to mention only fome late inftances, there came over to Nagafaki in the years 1683 and 1684, at leaft two hundred Chinefe yonks a year, every one with no lefs than fifty people on board (at prefent, they are not permitted to have more than thirty hands on board each yonk,) fo that no lefs than ten thoufand people came over from China to Nagafaki every year. Some of the largeft yonks, befides the necelfary hands, brought over numbers of paflengers, and other private perfons, who came to trade upon their own account, and fe- veral of them had from fifty to fourfcore, and fometimes an hundred men on board. Whoring, which is ftri&ly forbid in China, being open- ly permitted in Japan, many young rich perfons came over to Japan, purely for their pleafure, and to fpend fome part of their money with Japanefe wenches, which prov'd very beneficial to this town. Not long ago, a Tartarian Mandarin came over with a very numerous re- tinue, and in quality of Admiral of a fmall fleet of fix yonks, but he was oblig'd forthwith to return to China, for the Japanefe gave him to underftand, that their Country would not bear any other Commanders and Mandarins, but fuch as were natives of it. The liberty, which the Chinefe for fome time enjoy'd in this country, was too great to continue long without alteration, and it quickly came to a fatal end. The Japanefe had notice given them, that the Jefuits, their mortal enemies, who had been banifh'd from Japan for ever, were favourably treated at the court of the then reigning Tartarian Monarch of China, by whom they had liberty granted them to preach and propagate the Gofpel in all the extent of his vaft dominions. Some Bocks relating to the Roman Catholick Religion, which the fathers of the fociety had found means to print in China, in the language of that country, were brought over to Japan amongft other Chinefe Books, and fold pri- vately, which made the Japanefe apprehenfive, that by this means the Chriflian religion, which had been exterminated with fo much trouble, and the lofs fo many thoufand perfons, might be reviv'd again in the country. Some fufpicion of chriftianity was thrown even on the importers of thefe books, and if they were not look'd upon as adual converts, they were thought, at leaft, to be favourably inclin'd to the Roman Catho- lick Religion. For thefe feveral reafons, which were of great mo- ment with fo jealous and apprehenfive a nation, it was propes'd at court, to reduce the extenfive liberty of the Chinefe to a narrower compafs, and to put them much upon the fame foot with the Dutch, both with regard to their trade and way of life. The thoughts of the court tending at firft to alter the ftate of the Chinefe trade, and af- terwards to fhut up their perfons, as they had done the Dutch at Defima, and to make their fettlement fubjecl to the fame rigorous regulations, and narrow infpe&ion, which ours labours under, were ftrongly fupported by [the arrival of the Mandarin above-mention'd, and the daily increafe of Chinefe and Tartars, fufpe&ed of Chriftianity, the Chap. IX. The Hijioryof JAPAN. 377 f he very worft thing they could have been fufpe&ed of. And as to the firft, I mean the regulations concerning their trade, that fame year Pttfext ftate 1685, in which the Dutch had been reduc'd to the furri of 300000 ^JjJ cbuu ' 1 Tbails, or 300 chefts of filver per annum, the Court thought fit to li- mit alfo the Chinefe to a certain fum, beyond which none of their goods Ihould be fold. This fum is not to exceed 600 chefts of fil- ver, that is 600000 Siumome, or Tbails, and according to the Dutch way of computing 21 tuns of gold^ that is 2100000 gilders, (about 200000 pounds fterling.) It was order'd at the fame time, that the goods which might be reafonably fuppos'd to yield 6oocoo Thails Ihould be brought over on board feventy yonks at fartheft, and this according to the following divifion made by the Japanefe themfelves j feventeen yonks from the province Hoksju, or Foktsju, or Fukutsju, fixteen from Nan- kin, five from the city and Province Cantoo, cr Canton, five from Nefa, four from Sintsjeu, four from the Ifland Aymo, or Aynan, and the coafts of the neighbouring continent of China, three from Kootz, or Kootsja, three from the Kingdom of Si Am, or Sijam, two from the Kingdom of Tunquin, two from Gammon, two from the Kingdom of Cabot s] a, or Cambodia, two from Takkafagga, other wife Tafzpaan upon the Ifland Formofa, one from FuJafan, fituate below Raktsju, where there is a fa- mous Qiiamvon Temple, one from Kootsjj, or Cofijnfijna, and one from Tani, which is one of the moil confiderable of the Kiuht Iflands, bc- fides fome others, which I could not learn. After this manner the Japanefe have thought fit to divide the allow'd number of yonks a- mong the Chinefe fettled in the feveral Kingdoms and Iflands above mention'd. They admit alfo one from Siakkatarra, or Batavia, and one from Poking or Peking, which two laft ihould be either added to the foregoing to make up the number of feventy, or elfe admitted in lieu of fuch as ftay'd too late, or were caft away in their Voyage . And yet, the great accuracy, and nice circumfpection of the Japanefe* notwithftanding, the Chinefe will frequently impofe upon them. Thus for inftance fome of the yonks, which came to Nagafaki early in the year, after they have difpos'd of their Cargoes, return to clean and to be new painted and varnifh'd, then they take in another cargo, and other hands on board and fo make the voyage twice the fame year, without the Japanefe's being able to difcover their cheat. Others go to the province Satfuma early in the year, as if they had been caft thither by chance, or ftrefs of weather, difpofe of what goods they can, then hafte back to take in a new cargo,, and fo go up to Nagafaki. If in going to Satfuma they are met by the Japanefe- Guard de coafts, which by order of the Government cruife in thofe feas to hin- der the natives from carrying on a fmugling trade, they will then alter their courfe, as if they had been againft their inclination caft out of it, and proceed directly on their voyage to Nagafaki, as the only harbour, foreigners are permitted to put into. C g c c c As 378 TheHiJloryof JAPAN. Book IV. As to the fecond of the two abovemention'd points, which the court fhSSjf,?- Ju "M n view with regard to the Chinefe Nation, I mean to fhut them up, as they had done the Dutch at Befmia, that was not put in exe- cution till three years after-, for they as yet enjoy'd ample liberty till the year 1688, when the fine garden of Sije Sfugu Fefo, late' Steward of the Imperial Lands and Tenements about Nagafaki, (whofe fatal dilgrace I have above related) was aflign'd them for their habitation. This garden was pleafantly feated almuft at the end of the harbour not far from the more and town. It had been maintain'd with o- r eat expence, as the Emperor's own property, and was curioufly adorn'd with a great number of tine plants, both native and foreign, the pof- fefTor himfelf having been a great lover of Botany. Upon this fpot of ground feveral rows of fmall houfes were built to receive the Chi- nefe, every row cover'd with one common roof, and the whole furrounded with ditches, pallifadoes, and flrong well-o-uarded double gates. All this was done with fo much expedition, that the fame place, which at the beginning of February was one of the plea- fanteft gardens, had already towards the latter end of May the hor- rible afpecl of a flrong prifon, therein to fecure the Chinefe, who in- to the bargain, muft pay ever fince a yearly rent of 1600 Thaih for it. Whenever they : come to Nagafaki, they muft live here, and fo great is their covetoufnefs and love of gain, that they fuffer themfelves to be fo narrowly watch'd, and every bit fo badly, if not worfe, accommo- dated, than I have above defcrib'd the Dutch to be at Defmia. However, there are fome remarkable differences to be obferv'd . with regard to the accommodation of the Dutch and Chinefe. Thefe are, 1. The Chinefe are not allow'd the favour of being admitted into the prefence of the Emperor, as the Dutch are once a year, but in- ftead of this, they fave the trouble and charges of a journey of three months, and of fo many prefents, which muft be made to his Impe- rial Majefty, and his Minifters. 2. They have victuals and provifions brought and offer'd them to fale, at the very gates of their factory, whereas we muft be at the expenee of maintaining a whole com- pany of Commifhoners for victualling, all natives of Japan. 3. Beinc look d upon as private merchants, and withal encreafing the bad opi- nion the Japanefe have of them, by the frequent difputes and quar- rels arifing among them, they are not treated with fo much civility as we are, by their infpe&ors, guards and interpreters, who make no fcruple now and then to cane them by way of punifhment for fmall mifdemeanors. 4. They have no Director of their trade, con- ftantly refiding there, as the Dutch, but when the fale of their goods is over, they go all away on board their yonks, leaving in the mean time their houfes empty, They Chap. VIII. The Hilary of J A P A N. ?79 ,11^11 ■ m m ^^--n^—— — — ■. 1 1 " nr 1 i — ■ — — ^» -mm t -■ II They have three fales a year, at three different times, one in the , Spring, when they difpofe of the cargoes of twenty yonks, another in \l t hdintfe: the Summer for thirty others, and another in Autumn again for twenty. What other yonks come over beyond this number, or after the fale is over, muft return without fo much as being fuffer'd to unlade. Their cargoes confift in raw (ilk from China and Tunqjiin, and all forts of filken and woollen fluffs, which are likewife imported by the Dutch, and have been nam'd in the preceding chapter. They alfo import Su- gar from feveral parts of the Eaft-Indies, Calamine Stone from Tonqnin, for making of brafs and Brazier's wares j Turpentine (from wild Piflacho- trees) - Guram, myrrh, Agat, and Calambak-wood from Tjiampa, Cambodia and the neighbouring Countries ^ the precious Camphire of Baros from Borneo j the precious Chinefe-root Nijin, or Ninfe?ig (wild Sugar-root J from Corea, feveral other drugs and medicines, fimple and compound from China, befides feveral Philofofophical and Theological Books printed in China. As to thefe Books, it happen'd, as I have taken notice above, that feme relating to the Chriftian Religion, which were compos'd apd printed by the Jefuits in China, flipt in among the reft. When this was firft found out by the Japanefe, they oblig'd the Proprietor of the Bocks to teftify in the moft folemn manner, that he was not a Chriftian himfelf, and that he did not bring over any of thefe Books defignedly, and knowing what they were, then to make him more circumfped for the future, they fent him back with his yonk and whole cargo, without permitting him to difpofe of any one part of it. Upon this it was order'd, that for the future all the Books whatfoever, imported by the Chinefe, fhould be firft examin'd, and one of each kind read and cenfur'd, before they fhould have leave to fell them. This office of Cenfors, with a competent yearly allowance, hath been given to two learned men of this town, one whereof is Father Prior of the monaftery Siutokus, who is to read and cenfure all the Ecclefiaftical Books, the other is a Sjntos Philofo- pher, and Phyfician to the Dairi, as he fliles himfelf, who is to read and cenfure all the Philofophical, Hiflorical and other Books. This latter Gentleman refides at Tattajamma, and wears long hair, which he' ties together behind his head, as the cuftorn is amongfl the Philofo- phers, Phyficians and Surgeons of the country. The proceedings at the fale of the goods imported by the Chinefe, being p r0C(e j.ir, % i a t nearly the fame with ours, i need not add any thing to the defcription fb «r Sal - S - I have given thereof in the preceding chapter. It muft be obferv'd only, that Taxes laidufi as the voyage of the Chinefe is fhorter than ours, and not expos'd to fo many on thm ' dangers, nor liable to fo great an expence, the government in confideration of this hath laid a much greater duty upon all their commodities, to wit, 60 per cent to be pay'd by the buyer for the benefit of the feveral officers concern'd in the management of the Chinefe trade, and of other Inhabitants of Nagafaki, amongfl whom this money is afterwards di- ftributeci 380 The Hiftory of J A P A N. Book IV. ftributed. This great duty is the reafcn, why their profits are not near fo considerable, as ours, the buyers, by whom the duty is to be paid, being not willing to offer great prizes for them. It hath been order'd beSides, ever fmce the redudion of their trade, that the money- paid in for their goods fhould not be exported, as it was done for- merly > in copper cr filver money, but fhould be all laid out again in cop- nqartwt p er an( j manufactures of the country, fo that now the}' are not per- "' )C "' ; ' mitted to export one fingle It&ebo, or farthing of Japanefe money. As foon as a yonk hath difpos'd of that part of her cargo, which in the distribution hath been aflign'd her for her portion, the Funabait (or guard fhips, which as foon as fhe came into the harbour, were X*&ll r°ft e{1 on both fides of her ) attend her out of the harbour, till file gets to the main Sea. The day before her departure the Chinefe Neptunus, or Sea-idol, Piffle or Bofl'a, is fetch M from the temple, where he was kept from the time of the yonks arrival, and is with great pomp and ceremony, under the found of timbrels and other mufi- cal inftruments carried on board. This Bojfa is an idol unknown in Japan, and not worfhip'd by the Japanefe. Chinefe failors carry him along with them in all their voyages, and nuke great vows to him, when they are in danger. Every evening a gilt paper is lighted be- fore him, and thrown into the Sea as an offering, with ringing of bells, and playing upon mufieal inftruments. If they made a good voyage, particularly if they efcap'd fome considerable danger, they play Wejjangs, or Comedies, at night in the open ftreets, for his diverfion. They are like- wife faid to facrifice to him fwine and other animals, the flefh whereof they afterwards eat. For this reafon they never facrifice Cows to him, be- caufe they have a great veneration for this animal, and religioufly abfhin from eating its flefh. The Chinefe merchants returning commonly with a good quantity of undifpos'd goods on board, they are frequently follow'd by Japanefe fmuglers, who buy the remainder of their goods at a low prize. But thefe unhappy wretches are almoft as frequently caught by the Japanefe cruizers, and deliver'd up to juftice at Nagasaki, which conftantly proves fevere and unmerciful enough to them. Not long after my arrival in Japan, viz. Nov. 20. 1690, eleven perfons were caught in one boat, and brought into prifon at Nagafaki, where they were executed a few days after. Not to mention feveral other in- ftances, there fuffer'd death for fmugling twenty three perfons, upon the 28th of Bee. 1691, ten whereof were beheaded, and the others laid on the crofs. Among the latter there were five, who upon being t.iken, made away with themfelves, to avoid the Shame of an unavoidable public execution, but their bodies were neverthelefs preferv'd in fart, _ . , , on purpofe to be afterwards laid upon the crofs. LiquejoiJlanA Before I clofe this chapter, it will not be improper to mention in to jafm. a f ew WO rds, another company of merchants from the Rtuku, or Liquejo Iflands, who are permitted to carry on a particular trade to the province Sat.-z.wna. Chap. IX. The Hifiwy of JAPAN. 381 Satzmna. . By the Riuht, or Liquejo Iflands, mud be underftood that Chain of Iflands, which run down from the South Weft Coafts of Satzumd towards the Philippine ljlands. The inhabitants fpeak a broken Chi- nefe, which evinces their original defcent from China. The Chinefe at all times traded to thefe Iflands. After the late Tartarian Conqueft of China, many came over with their families to fettle there, and were well receiv'd by the Inhabitants as old acquaintance and countrymen. Some time ago thefe Iflands were invaded and conquer'd by the Prince of Satzuma, under whofe fubje&ion thev ftill remain. Tho' they look upon the Prince of Satzuma, as their Conqueror and Sovereign, to whofe Bugjos, or Lieutenants, they pay fome fmall part of the produce of their fields, by way of a tribute, yet they will not acknowledge the fupremacy of the Japanefe Empe- ror. They fend over every year a prefent to the Tartarian Mo- narch of China, in token of fubmiffion. Tho' they might be look'd upon, in fome meafure, as fubjects of the Japanefe Emperor, yet they are, as to their trade, treated like other foreigners. They are order'd. to go to the harbour of Satzuma, and not to prefume to frequent any other in the Japanefe Dominions. The import and fale of their goods hath been like wife limited to a yearly fum of 125000 Thails, beyond which nothing fhould be fold. Neverthelefs they difpofe of much greater Cargoes, thro' the connivance of the Japanefe Dire&ors of their trade, who are themfelves no lofers by it. The goods im- ported by them are all forts of filk and other fluffs, with feveral other Chinefe commodities, which they bring over from China on board their own yonks •, fome of the produce of their own country, as corn, rice, pulfe, fruits -, Awamuri, a ftrong fort of Brandy, made out of the re- mainder of their crop ; Takaragai, and Fimagai, that is, Pearl-fhells, and that fort of fmall fhells, call'd Cowries in the Indies, which are brought chiefly from the Maldive Iflands to Bengale and Siam, where they go for current money. Out of thofe, which are imported into Japan by the Inhabitants of the Riuku Iflands, upon the fhores whereof they are found in' great plenty, is prepar'd a white cheek- varnifh, which boys and girls paint themfelves withal. They likewife import a fort of large flat fhells, polifh'd and almoft tranfparent, which the Japanefe make ufe of inftead of windows, and to fhelter themfelves againft rain and cold, fome fcarce flowers and plants in pota, befides feveral other things. - Ddddd CHAP, 382 The Hijtorj of J A P A N. Book IV. CHAP. X. Some Trochmations, Tafp&rts, Orders, &c. mention d in the foregoing Chapters. i GOSJU IN, that is, Letters Patent under the red Imperial Seal, granted by the Emperor Gonggingfama (who was in his Life-time call'd Ongofchio Sama) to Jacob Spex, in behalf of the united Company of Dutch Merchants trading to the Eaft Indies, and their Fa&ory at Firando. AL L Dutch Ships, that come into my Empire of Japan, wjiat-^ ever place or port they put into, we do hereby exprefsly com- mand all and every one of our fubjects, not to moleft the fame in any ways', nor to be a hindrance to them, but on the con- trary, to fhew them all manner of help, favour and afftftance. Every one mall beware to maintain the friendfhip, in affunmce of which we have been pleas'd to give our Imperial word to thefe people, and every one fhall take care, that my commands and promifes be invio- lably kept. Dated (Stylo Japonic) on the 25th Day of the 7th Mane, be- ing the 30th of Augujl 161 1. Thefe Letters Patent, together with the red Seal, are ingrav'd in Tab. XX. Fig. 2. 3. II. In the year 161 7 upon frefh application made by the Dutch, the like Letters Patent under the red Seal, and nearly in the fame terms, were granted by the Emperor Taitokoujnfama, Ongofchiofaftia's SuccelTor, to Hendrick Brouwer, who was for this purpofe fent as Am- baffador to the faid Emperor. The direction, as it flood on the out- fide, is reprefented in Tab. XX. Fig. 4. where it muft be obferv'd, that the Japanefe, not being able rightly to pronounce the letter /, write and pronounce Horanda, inflead of Kolanda. Fanrei Borowara, is the name of the Ambaffador Henry Brower, fpelt after the Japanefe manner. As to the word Gofju In, which denotes the red Imperial Seal, I have elfewhere obferv'd, what it will not be amifs to repeat on this occafion, that Go, is the character of greatnefs and magnificence in general, but denotes in a more particular manner, the fublime high- nefs of the Emperor, as fupreme Monarch of all Japan, that Sju fignifies red, and In a Seal - y that confequently Gofju In } is as much a& to Chap X. The Hiftory ofJAPAN. 383 to fay, His Sublime HigJviefs's red Seal. The red feal of the Emperor Ongofchiofama, is reprefented in Tab. XX. Fig. 5. and that of his fucceffor Taitokujinfama, in Fig. 4. of the faid Table. III. Imperial Orders fent by the Counfellors of State to the Prince of Fi- rando, concerning die behaviour of the Dutch there. IK hafte we fend our words to you. The Dutch fhips fhall carry on their trade at Firando according to jheir Captain's pleafure, as they did heretofore. Tho' we do not command it every year, yet you fhall know once £or all, that you are to take care, that the Dutch do not fpread the doclrine of the Fathers. This we leave to you to order. We are venerating, venerating, fpeaking with refpecl. Poftfcript, or rather Interfcript. The Merchants of Miaco and Sakai, fhall likewife come to vour place to trade as they pleafe. Thus it will be well. So it is. Di reeled to Mat fur a Fijinno Cami Donno Fito Fito That is, Man's Mart. Sign'd, Doji Oje Nofshe^ (L.S.) Nagakatz. Ando Tfufjhnano Cami. (L.S.) Sigenobus. Itakura Ingano Cami. (L.S.) Katzuge Fonda Sinano Nofske. (L.S.) Maffatfungu. On the 23d day of the 8th month. IV. GODSIOMO KU. Strid Imperial Commands. i. f*~*\ L T R Imperial PredeceiTors have order'd concerning you Dutchmen, \^9 that you fhall have leave to come to Nagafaki, on account of the Japan trade, every year. Therefore, as we have commanded you hereto- fore, you fhall have no communication with the Portuguefe. If you mould have any, and we mould come to know it from foreign Coun- tries, you fhall be prohibited the navigation to Japan. You fhall im- port no Portuguefe commodities on board your fhips. 2. If you intend not to be molefted in your navigation and trade to Japan, you fhall notify to us by your fhips, whatever .comes to your knowledge, of any endeavours or attempts of the Porruguefe a- gainft us } we likewife expeel to hear from you, if the Portuguefe fhould conquer any new places or countries, or convert them to the Chriftian Seel. Whatever comes to your knowledge in all countries you trade to, we expecl that you fhould notify the fame to our Governors at Nagafaki. 3. Yotf, 3 8 4 The Hi/lory (/JAPAN, Beck IV. g. You fhall take no Chinefe yonks bound for Japan. 4, In all countries you frequent with your fhips, if there be any Por- tuguefc there, you ihall ha\'e no communication with them. If there be any countries frequented by both nations, you fhall take down in writing the names of fuch countries, or places, and by the Captains of the fhips you fend to Japan yearly, deliver the fame to cur Go- vernors at Nagafaki. 5. The Liquejans being fubje&s of Japan, you mall take none of their fhips or boats. So be it. V. V. (1.) Kinsai Defimamatz. Regulations concerning the Screet Defima. K E E Seno Foka onna irukotto. (2.) Koja fifirino foka fiuke Jam?na- bus iruktto. So qitan fin no mono narabini kdi- fufiki irukotto. Defima mawari foos Kui Jori utfijni fune norikomu kotto tfuketarri faf- fmojla fune nori tooru kotto. Juje naku fite Horanda fin Deci- ma jori idfurukotto. Migino dfio dfio- Kataku limamoru beki. Mononari, Sar. Tfino Cami. Siu Bioje. Tonomo. VV/Hores only,- but no other 7* Women % fhall be fuffer'd to go in. Only theEcclefiaflicksof the moun- tain Koja fhall be admitted. All other Priefts, and all Jam?mbos t fhall ftand excluded. All beggars, and all perfons that live upon charity, fhall be denied Entrance. No body fhall prefume, with any fhip or boat, to come within the PaliiTadoes of Defima. No- body fhall prefume, with any fhip or boat, to pafs under the bridge of Defima. No Hollander fhall be permitted to come out, but for weighty reafons. All the abovemention'd orders fhall be punctually obey'd. Thus much, year of the Monkey, ■ Month, Day. In the Sign'd, Tfino Cami. Siu Bioje. Tonomo. Defimamatz, Chap. X. The Hiftoryof JAPAN. 38$ *- ■ ■ 111 - - 1. (Defimamatz.') D?fi?na, is an Ifland rais'd by art in the harbour of Nagafaki, not far from the town. It was formerly the fa&ory of the Portuguefe. At prefent the Dutch live there. It is comprehended among the ftreets of Nagafaki, and fubjed to the fame regulations, fcr which reafon it is call'd Defimamatz, that is, the ftreet of De/ima. 2. (Koja Fifing Koja is a mountain in the neighbourhood of Miaco. Its Inhabitants, many thoufand in number, lead an Eccleliaflical Life, and are for this reafon call'd Koja Fifiri, that is to fay, the Monks, or Clergy of the mountain Koja, tho' the word Fifiri implies, that they have not near fo ftri& Rules to obferve, as other reli- gious Orders. This mountain is a fan&uary for Criminals, no Con- fhbles nor any Officers of Juftice being fufFer'd to come there. Every body is admitted, that defires it, or flies there for fhelter, and after- wards maintain'd for Life, if they can but bring in thirty Tha'ils for ■the ufe of the Convent, and are otherwife willing to ferve the com- mon-wealth in their feveral capacities. Kobodais was the founder of this order. Lamps are kept perpetually burning before his Idol, and it is thought a very good and meritorious work to found fuch a Lamp, which may be done by a fmall Legacy of an hundred Maas t the Intereft of this Money being fufficient to provide the neceffary _ quantity of Oil. Thefe Monks are not absolutely confin'd to this mountain, but may travel up and down the country in what manner or bufinefs they pleafe. Very many of them betake themfelves to trade and commerce. They do not indeed come to Nagafaki, but i£ they mould, they muft be admitted as well as other merchants. 5. (Jammabus^) Jammabus fignifies mountain priefts. It is a very lingular religious order, which hath been more particularly defcrib'd in the fifth Chapter of the third Book of this Hiftory. Eceee VI. 386 The Hifiorj of J A P A N. - Book IV. VI. Dzio SadamarL Nippon fui Ikokufiu gofatto So- muki nanigo toki JoraJJu aku- fiwo taknmi Reimotzuwo idafi ta- nomu mono korre araba kitto moofi idzubezi Tatto Jeba Dorui tarito futomo togawo Jurus fono rei mot- zno Idjii Gofoobi Kuda Sarubes mqfi Sonnin kore arum Oitewa fei- qua nanbeki, Mono nari y , Qu a pi Sign'd, VI. Orders concerning Contraband Goods. f F any foreigner, or Japanefe, •*- endeavours, contrary to orders, to difpofe of any contraband goods whatfoever, and it be difcover'd, notice fhall be given forthwith to the proper magiftrates. If any of* the accomplices difcovers himfelf, and turns evidence, he mail have his Pardon, and moreover a re- ward proportionable to the Crime. Offenders found guilty upon the evidence of their accomplices, fhall be punifhed according to law. Thus much, Month Day. Tonnomo. Shi Bioje. Setzno Came. VII. Defima Vantbixi kindsjo quafino fetz,, ait tfitomo beki Sidai, that is, Or- ders to be obferv'd in cafe of fire, if any lhould break out in the Ifland Defima, or the neighbourhood thereof. DEfima Ottona, that is, the headborough, or commanding officer of the ftreet Defima; Hollanda TJiufi, the eight chief Interpreters-, De- fima Tfioonin, the landlords, or proprietors of our Ifland and Houfes, being four and twenty in number j Kannaba bannamono, the officers of our exchequer, or treafury, being fix and thirty, Hollanda Naitfu- ufi Kogafjra, the private Interpreters of the Dutch, the number of whom is uncertain :, Defima Tfijetzki, £w/imafters and Infpe&ors of our porters and daily labourers, being fifteen in number ; Defima Daiku, carpenters, that have leave to frequent our Ifland j Daidokoronomono, the officers of our kitchin. If a fire fhould break out in the neighbourhood of Defima, all the officers aforefaid fhall repair thither, and take their own fervants along with them if they pleafe : However, they fhall not enter the Ifland, but meet at the door, and flay there, till a Kinsjo, or commanding officer Chap. X. The Hiflory of J A P A N. 387 ■ 1 v officer hath been fent by the Governors. If the fire mould rage fu- rioufly, and the danger become imminent, before the Kinsjo comes, they (hall obey the commands of Takaki Sakujemon, Mat&dofijori, Dfio- jofi, and the Ottona, or headborough of Defima, who fhall give the ne- ceffary orders quickly to extinguifh the fire. If a fire fhould break out in the Ifland Defima, at the time, when the Dutch mips lie in the harbour, all Dutchmen mail retire on board of their own fhips, in order to which a competent number of thofe boats which commonly lie near the ftreet Jedomatz, fhall wait at the great Watergate to carry them over. But if a fire fhould hap- pen, after the Dutch fhips have left the harbour, in that cafe the Dutchmen fhall be carried by our Guardboats to Nomotomiban, or the houfes of the Spy guards on the mountain Noomo, where they fhall be accommodated as well as poflible. The reporting', Interpreters and a Tfionfi, fhall repair thither along with them, and fhall, together with a Joriki and a Dofen, have the command over them at that time. Quafidoogu, that is, the proper Inftruments for extinguishing fires fhall be kept in conftant readinefs on the Ifland Defima. So be it, Given in the period Jempo, in the fifth year. Mine* Eiguatz* VIIL The Oath, as it is enter'd at the Mayor's Houfe of Nagafaki, in the Sikkimoku, as they call it, or the Mayor's B00L ALL the officers concern' d in the management of the Ifland Defi- ma, and the affairs relating thereunto, before they are entruft- ed with their refpe&ivc employments, muft oblige themfelves by a folernn Oath, religioufly to obferve the following points. 1 . Not to ferve the Dutch but in the day-time. Not to enter into any difcourfe or converfation whatever about the forbidden feci: of the Chriftians. Not to act. contrary to any ftanding Laws or orders re- lating to the Ifland Defima. To be very careful of the fire, when in any Dutchman's room. 2. Not to enter into any familiarity, of private difcouffes with the Dutch upon any fubjeft whatever. If any Japanefe fhould ask you to carry any money or goods to Defima, or to bring them away from the faid Ifland, ftri&ly to forbear complying with the like demands. To fell no Gotfiofimono, or contraband goods, much lefs to make a prefent of any to any body whatever. 3. If any Dutchman fhould ask you to buy any thing for him in the town of Nagafakt, or to bring it over to Defima, not to do the fame, 388 The Hi/lory of J A P A K. Book IV. fame, nor to buy it your felves, nor to concert proper meafures with them, how to conceal any fuch commodity, nor to throw it over the wall, which encompaffes the Ifland, nor to hide it in your bofom, nor to permit any fuch goods to be pack'd up and carried on board, at the time when the Dutch (hips are upon their departure, nor to fuf- fer any the lead thing belonging to a Dutchman to be carried in- to the town and fold there, and on the contrary, if you know of any fuch endeavours or demands, forthwith to notify the fame. Thefe, and other articles, if needful, being premifed, the general form of their oath is annex'd, fign'd with the party's name, and feal'd with his blood. The general form of the oath, whether it be taken as a neceffary qualification to accept of a publick office, cr to witnefs particular facl:s, or in juftification of one's innocence, or in confirma- tion of private contracts, or in general upon any account whatever, is as follows. Bonden Taifaku Si Dai Tenno, foofite Nippon Goktsju, Rokhtfu Josjuno, t)aifwno Singi, kotoniwa, Idzu Fakone, Rioofwno Gongin, Miff ma Dai Mioofin, Fatzman Daibofatz, Tenman Dai Sifai Ten/in, Burui kenfok fnbatz mioobatz ono ono makari, komo urubeki. Mononari, that is, If I do not religioufly and punctually maintain all thefe feveral ar- ticles heretofore fpecified, May the four great Gods of the immenfe and boundlefs Heaven, the Gods of all the (66) Provinces of this Em- pire^ all the great and little Gods, the two fuddenly punijhing fevers Gods of Idzu, the Gods of Fakkone and Rioosju, the God of Miffima, the God Fatzman, and the God Temmandai Tenfin, let their wrath and anger fall upon me, and may all my family, and my relations and friends, feel the weight of their juft difpleafnre and punijhment. So be it. Name andSeal of the Gover- nor, cr >» a Marriage Coir- traB of the Bride. Mmth. Year. Year of the Period. Kame of the Perfon that takes the oath, with hit Sea! died red with his own Blood ; in a Marriage Con- rra'fi the ncme nnd Seal of the B'-idfgrci!>\ it Chap. IX. The Hiftory s/JAPAN. 389 It may not be amifsto obferve with regard to the private fer.vants of the Dutch, who are appointed to wait upon them at their lodgings that as they are generally young boys, as yet not qualify'd to tafce fo folemn an oath, they muft find fome honeft Citizen of Nagafaki, who will Hand fecurity for their good behaviour, and enter into a bond, to take care, thr't fo long as they continue in our fervice, the feveral articles abovemention'd be punctually obferv'd by them. In this cafe however, the form of the oath aforefaid is omitted, and only a general obligation added in its ftead, in thefe or the like exprefTiens. / promife to take care, that N. N. keep all the articles tohove fpecijied : If he fbould do otherrvife, at any time, I will wil'.ingly undergo the punifljment you 11 he pleas' 'd to inflict upon me. This is done in prefence of the Mayor of the Town, and of other proper officers. IX. Orders to be obferv'd during the time of the Dutch Sale, and put up in the great ftreet of our Ifland, for the information particu- larly of fuch perfens, as come to Defvna at that time. DSJO. Abfolute Command. NO Dutchman mail be permitted to go out [of Defima without leave. No bedy ihall be fuffer'd to come into the Ifland before the fale begins, but the crdinarv officers and fervants. . ' No goods whatever fhall be carried out of the Ifland, before the fale begins. No Tfintafakt (Tent) nor any Budoosjit (Spanifh Wines) fhall be feht out of the Ifland, without fpecial licenfe. No Japanefe arms, nor the pictures, or reprefentations, or puppet- figures of any Mufia, or military people, fhall be brought to Defima, Purfuant to our often repeated flricl: commands, no goods whatever (hull be fold privately to the Dutch j no goods fhall be bought of them in the fame private Way. When the time of the departure of the Dutch fhips draws near, notice fhall be given, to the Ottona, and to the company of inter- preters, of what goods have been fold to the Dutch, together with a written lift of the fame, that fo the fums agreed on be paid in time, and all troubles and inconveniencies avoided on the laft days of their flay in the harbour. The Dutch and Portuguefe Interpreters, who frequent the Ifland, and are licens'd for fo doing, fhall not plot, nor privately con- verfe together. No body fhall come to Defima without fpecial leave, but the Bugjo, and officers of the Ifland. Fffff Mt 35?o The Hiflory of J A P A N. Book IV; All the Articles aforefaid every body is commanded duly and flriclly to obferve. Month t)ay Nagafafli. Bugjo. X. G TSIOOSi MO NO NO B J J E ; that is, Lift of the Contraband Goods, none of which the Dutch are fuffer'd to buy, or to export the Country. GO M N. The Emperor's coat of arms. All prints, pictures, goods or (turFs bearing the fame. Budoogu. Warlike Inflruments. Mufiiige. PicTures and reprefentations, printed or others, of Soldiers and military people* Jcjro no Giendji. Pictures, or reprefentations, of any perfons belong- ing to the Court of the Da'/ri, or Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Em- peror. Nippon bune no kogatta narahinije. PicTures or Models of Japanefe fhips or boats. Nipponno Jedfu. Maps of the Empire of Japan, or of any part thereof. Plans of towns, caftles, temples and the like. Jdkko kenqua Ningio. Puppets, or fmall figures reprefenting military men. Dultrn Jurigana. Crooked knives, fuch as the Carpenters ufe. Fino Ginn. A fort of filk fluffs made at F'mo. Kaga Gimi. The like ma^e at Kaga. - Both thefe are made up in long rolls, like the tilk fluffs of Tonquhi. Tjumuggi. Another fort of fluffs in long rolls, manufacTur'd in Japan. Gnmai no rui. All forts of fine filken fluffs. Nuno no ru). All forts of fluffs made of hemp. Momen no rui. Stuffs manufaclur'd of Cotton. Mawatta. Mats of Silk. Gin. Silver. Ken HollanJa gattana Nippon gofj ra)e. All forts of Scimiters, Swords and other Arms made in Japan, in imitation of thofe imported by the Dutch. XI. Chap X. The Hiftory of J A P A N. 391 XL FORMof their PASSPORTS. XJ AGASAK I. Name of the ftreet. The Perfon's Family Name. — ^ His proper name. His age. The fed he profefTes. Going to fuch or fuch a Province, for fuch or fuch particular reafons, we defire you would let him pafs unmolefted on his way thither, and oH his return. So be it. Nengo. Year. - Month. Sign'd, Dip Kagafaki Tosji Jori Name and Seal Directed. On Aratame Sui Djht. To all Viiiters and Overfeers; (Name DJl& Jafl. [ and Seal. xir. The Proclamation Cafe, as they call it, or the Place, where all the* Imperial Proclamations, orders of the Princes of the Empire, Go- vernors of Imperial Cities, Magiftrates, &c. are put up, for the in- formation of thofe, whom it concerns to know them, is reprefented in Tab. XX. Fig. i. U L. BOOK Vi After p. 392 An Explanation of the Tlates belonging to the firfi Volume of this Hijlory of Japan. TH E frontifpiece is the very fame, which the Japanefe prefix to all their printed books, to which I have added. 1. The arms of the Emperor of Japan, at the bottom of the plate, with a Angular kind of tortoife, the bambous-cane, and the fir, the ufual emblems of the Imperial greatnefs, as they are to be feen upon the walls, fkreens, hangings and other furniture of the Imperial Palace ^ as alfo the pikes, and other enMgns of honour, which are carried before the Emperor, when he appears in publick. 2. Several coats of arms of the Japanefe nobility j the whole as reprefented by themfelves in their books of heraldry. Tab. I. (hews Fig. 1. A curious ftar-tifh with nine rays caught near the Redansrlilmds upon the coafts of Malacca, defcnb'd p. 9. Fig. 2. 3. Two Prows, or boats, fuch as the Siamites ufe at their funerals, p. 15. Fig. 4. The boat on board which were carried the letters for the King of Siam, and the Berklam, on the day of our audience, p. 16. Tab. II. Shews the plan of Juthja, the capital of Siam, and relidence of the King, wherein A. is the royal palace. B. the palace of the Prince royal. C. The palace of the querry of the King's elephants. D. The church and palace of Mr. Louis the metropolitan Bifhop. E. E. The courts of Berklams temple. F. The houfe which formerly belong'd to Confiantin Faulcon. G. The Camp of the Dutch. H. The camp of the Portuguefe. /. The Arrack-brewers camp. K. Tale camps of the Japanefe, Peguans and Malaajans. L. Arm of the river running to- wards the Pyramid Pnkathon. M. Arm of the river cali'd Klang Nawja. N. N". Arm of the river cali'd Pakaufan. 0. 0. Arm of the river cali'd Klang Patnam Bija. P. P.P. The large river Meinam, as it encompaflfes the city. V. The camp of the Chinefe. it. it. The camps of the Co- chinchinefe. .V. Enclofure for the elephants. Tab. IIL mews, Fig. 1. The plan of the royal palace of Siam (p. 28.) wherein A. is the late King's palace, together with the hall of audience. B. The old royal palace. C. The dining hall, d, d,d, Several temples. e, e, . 131: Fig. 7. Sanmio, a fort of Spanifh-flies, p. 132. Tab. XI. Filhes, Fig. 1. Iruh^, p. 134. i 7 /^. 2. Furube,ibid. Fig. g. Sw/wJb' a Bald-head, Fig. 4. ifoi, a fiih not unlike a carp. Fig. 5. Ara, a Jacob's Ewertz. Fig. 6. Ooadfi, a fort of Maasbancker. Fig. 7. Fukafa?ne, the fifh, of whofe skin they make the fhagrin-cafes. Fig. 8. Sufumohvo, a needle filh, all defcrib'd, p. 136 and 137. Tab. XII. Fig. 1, 2, 3, 4. Four differing forts of Eels, defcrib'd, />. 137. Fig. 5. Ika, a Sea-qualm, />. 137, according to the Chinefe. Fig. 6. The fame as figur'd by the Japanefe. Fig. 7. Tako, another Sea-qualm. p. 137. Fig. 8. Kuragge, another Sea-qualm, p. 137. Tab. XIII. Fig. 1. Namako, refcrr'd to />. 138. Fig. 2. ///wri, a black water lizard, ibid. Fig. 3. Mooki, an emblematical tortoife, as figur'd by the Japanefe. Fig. 4. The fame according to the Chinefe. Fig. 5. ijlcame, the Land-tortoife. Fig. 6. Jogame, theWater-tortoife, all defcrib'd p. 138. Fig. 7. Gambia, Soldiers-crab. lig. 8. Kabutogami, a lingular Crab, /». 139. Trf/;. XIV. Hg. 1, 2. Two forts of Crabs, defcrib'd /?. 139: /}g. 3. Awabi t or rf»w marina, ibid. Fig. 4. Tairagi, a fort of Pinna, Fig. 5. rf, £, r, */, . 144, exprefs'd in the fignificant, or learned characters. III. The names of fome Chinefe Emperors, of whom mention is made in the firft chap- ter of the fecond Book, IV. The names of all the Ecclefiaftical Here- ditary An Explanation, &c. Vol. I. ■ • ditary Emperors of Japan, from Sinmu, who begun to reign in the year before Chrift 660, to Kinfen, who was poffefs'd of the throne, when Dr. Kampfer was in Japan. V The titles of the Ecclefiaftical Hereditary Emperor of Japan. Tab. XVII. A view of MatfuJJima, a Sintos Temple, ferving to illuftrate what hath been faid, p. 208. &c feq, copied from a Japanefe original. A. The figure of a Tori], or temple-gate. Tab. XVIII. A view of the temple of Tenfio Daifin, at Isje, (p. 23.) which the Japanefe frequent in plilgrimage, copied from an original drawing of theirs. Tab. XIX: A map of the city of Uagafaki, and of the adjacent country, referr'd to in the fourth book of this hiftory, contracted from a large map made in Japan. At the bottom are feveral forts of money current in the Japanefe Empire, to wit, A. an Obani in gold, which goes for ten Koban'is, tho' it weighs but 9 and 3qrs. It hath the Impreflion of the coat of arms of the Dairi in four places, and the ftrokes, or lines, re- prefented in the figure, engrav'd in the furface. B. One fide of the Kobani, (or Cobang) which is likewife a piece of gold, worth about 23 and a half Dutch Gilders, that is, between 41 and 42 millings fterling. It hath, befides the lines as above, the following Impreffions. a. The coat of arms of the Dairi. b. A mark fhewing the value of the piece, c; Midftfugu, the name of the mafter of the mint at Jedo and Suruga, ex- prefs'd in Sfo characters. C. The other fide of the Kobanj, wherein d is the mark of the Infpeclor-general of the gold and filver money. The reft, on both fides, are (lamps of private perfons, whereby they may know, whether or no they pafs'd thro' their hands. The Japanefe pre- fer the Kobanjs made at Jedo, which have ftrong lines, but foreigners ra- ther take the others. They try the goodnefs of them, either by ap- plying thf'm to the breaft, which the bcfr will flick to a little, or elfe by clafhing them againft their teeth, and fome alfo by cutting them with cifars. D. E. An Itzebo in gold, with the arms of the Emperor on one fide, and the mark of the mafter of the mint on the other. F. A large lump of filver, with feveral impreffions, as amongft others that of Dai' kohi, or the God of riches with his hammer, tun and bag. Thcfe are not reduced to any certain ftandard, but are taken by the weight; G. An Ita oxSchuh of filver. H. The upper fide of &■ Senni, or Putjes, a cop- per money, with the name of the Nengo, in which it was coin'd. I. The other fide of a Semi. K. L. Both fides of a double Senni. Thefe Sennis and double Senni s have a fquare hole in the middle, for the con- veniency of tying them to firings. Tab. XX. I. Shews, after what manner the Imperial orders, proclamations, &c. are put up up in publick places. II. The privilege granted to the Dutch in 1611, by the Emperor Ongofckiofa?na,zx$\zm , dip. 382. III. The Seal of the faid monarch, which was flamp'd in red. This is as large as the original, but the characters in the privilege are contracted. IV. The feal of the Emperor Taitokonynfama, who renew'd the privilege aforefaid in 1617. V. The fuperfcription of the renew'd privilege, with the name of Henry Bronwer, to whom it was granted, fpelt after the Japanefe manner. VI. The general form of the oath in Japan, explain'd.^. 388. 1 ' i r ■ ■ v.~.\ ?- ■:■. :■■::■■ ■■.-■■:- ■■-■?.<■:-■>■. y-:-:v,mwx^ zm-//. > S * 1 *5 *y ■ ■ . .-:", ■ . . ■ :;■;■-.. . : ■.:.. .-.-- ■; . . .■;-;-. . . ■.-.:..,■.-■>:■,:;, s~zzi . :■«, . . MMMM -v IIH |§l§| 11111111 , ■ • .* »-- - - - ...... i.. **.-Jt ■'!*• /.■ ^ In „ /i>/'/-"'" S / '/i//,r//////r//m tJ/lnAuitrv, gUaiewaenA'arutn ■ Icaaemur Jgaruiemu Jj>aau, .v ifth/u- Jq/wrua. ym/i<-ru;'/i/-ti// WnwVU /•/>///////////> ;//■'/•// It,/;-//-- m/n/c/jn/r .' . &V-7- sun 9^. %*• ^D^ii^t. . •>.. ■ J - I r «.-> 6 • Tab.X. ff. 7 ^tfitchr Scu/fi t r mmmmmmmmmmtmmm^---- ' ■ ■ . XI . Jl» S^aAa &amo &u «7 7- rfa s, - p-r« Tabzii &9 t. (h? Wruuji zfy %• % M- % iV '*, r ' Takxm . Sfy 2, oyva??zaA& — — 5^ 2 A m&ft . ^>— L 3c &i *? 5- III.- I x ^JvhmAi or ^ih'H#y-(Z>mc> t ft. &*9 4 4L m/rtfarf??& 1 W. 5?yr ; c-f n/unitihqa'nui ■f ftnJ s i JL uJ^I I mus ^ v Wl ^ ^ ^ $ *> § 5 rl II i $ *UJ 8 ft MH 1 1 *: ¥ i Wc i ■v. Mj ^ «• I jW I 1 iM ^ •^ q ^ « I * 1 i i «* f Zfrn iSi-h Jltzi ^ffiu . H « tS? ^- = Uet Jut it* £to . w Of X £ X •x X 3 ^ t/lu ^ . j^H 5 ^ J 7 * SfCur . ^V/t c/2 J7l&?l> . 3 ^. Zfir-z/atz. ^fuiJtTTri ^ vj «x y «i % ^ * #*'^ iS?^ * ^ dfan* 1- > ^ lljd^B^ Sfu6t\s4nsaMi£oit& . •2 Jliu SaJui. J%#7t Jet,. %3 -^}rrhr « ^ u- 1 -'^ ^V & ^V i7<7- «y2^ Ml is rr.^/V . WL &< IK 41* « {^ fen? m £ i/anG^J/o-. *^j $+ zr* m. C/& Jht &?t> . ttfc « 7<"rf .►Mir, is hk ■//-"rf ^ ^: J' 1 3n. JJ > : '^-- •'fit ^ ten EL % Hr^D V ± "?Y^A ■ >r <> c^ tz£&a,ra, . > * ; * il •■b^--. m aautmm \ V ! 1 ,\is,„u w////rN.vNr.A?.\Ki "-// /i„//,,;r , ...0} A ■>//,' t . .....if 1 I - 1 I i • > - - > 3 $ i i c T*fc & VI. z * *Y' w^f* ^ /\i w f * *J £ 1 7 X* & J S \ ~u V 1 ex 7 (2 J ■t ^7 (/^ .1 V. ■MM ■ * r '?^ •^ r - r V *. - ^ Aa I ,!■ HMMVxt; .> .. ^ . \§ SPECIE 55-& F0U0 V\blo \A THE J. PAUL GETTY Cb UBRARY